THE DA“AN$M^-SA‚NY$S^S
BRILL’S INDOLOGICAL LIBRARY EDITED BY
JOHANNES BRONKHORST IN CO-OPERATION WITH
RICHARD GOMBR...
95 downloads
1848 Views
2MB Size
Report
This content was uploaded by our users and we assume good faith they have the permission to share this book. If you own the copyright to this book and it is wrongfully on our website, we offer a simple DMCA procedure to remove your content from our site. Start by pressing the button below!
Report copyright / DMCA form
THE DA“AN$M^-SA‚NY$S^S
BRILL’S INDOLOGICAL LIBRARY EDITED BY
JOHANNES BRONKHORST IN CO-OPERATION WITH
RICHARD GOMBRICH • OSKAR VON HINÜBER KATSUMI MIMAKI • ARVIND SHARMA VOLUME 25
THE DA“AN$M^-SA‚NY$S^S The Integration of Ascetic Lineages into an Order BY
MATTHEW CLARK
BRILL LEIDEN • BOSTON 2006
This book is printed on acid-free paper.
Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Clark, Matthew (Matthew James) The Dasanami-samnyasis : the integration of ascetic lineages into an order / by Matthew Clark. p. cm. — (Brill’s Indological library ; v. 25) Revision of thesis (Ph.D.)—University of London, 2004. Includes bibliographical references and index. ISBN-13: 978-90-04-15211-3 (alk. paper) ISBN-10: 90-04-15211-3 (alk. paper) 1. Dasnamis—History. 2. Dasnamis—Customs and practices. 3. Samnyasi. I. Title. II. Series. BL1245.D27C53 2006 294.5’65—dc22 2006045404
ISSN 0925-2916 ISBN-13: 978 90 04 15211 3 ISBN-10: 90 04 15211 3 © Copyright 2006 by Koninklijke Brill NV, Leiden, The Netherlands Koninklijke Brill NV incorporates the imprints Brill Academic Publishers, Martinus Nijhoff Publishers and VSP. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, translated, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without prior written permission from the publisher. Authorization to photocopy items for internal or personal use is granted by Brill provided that the appropriate fees are paid directly to The Copyright Clearance Center, 222 Rosewood Drive, Suite 910 Danvers, MA 01923, USA. Fees are subject to change. printed in the netherlands
table of contents
v
TABLE OF CONTENTS Acknowledgements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transliteration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ix xi xiii xiv
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.1 Introduction to the Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.2 Locating ‘the saÒny§sÊ’ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.3 Sources for this book. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1 1 3 22
Chapter one. BRANCHES OF THE DA“AN$M^ ORDER 1.1 The Daáan§mÊ sect, as currently constituted, in relation to other renunciate sects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 Caste . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 Subdivisions within the Daáan§mÊ order: DaÖ·Ê . . . . . . . . 1.4 ParamahaÒsa . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 ‘ParamahaÒsa’ and ‘Daáan§mÊ’ as categories . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.6 N§g§ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
28 38 40 42 45 47
Chapter two. AKH$Œ$-S AND DA“AN$M^ FUNCTIONARIES 2.1 The akh§Ü§-s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 2.2 MaÜhÊ-s and d§v§-s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 2.3 Functionaries within the “rÊ Pañc Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§ organisation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 2.4 Mah§maÖ·aleávaras . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 2.5 “aØkar§c§ryas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Chapter three. RENUNCIATION, RULES FOR ASCETICS, AND INITIATION 3.1. Renunciation procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 3.2 Current initiation procedures: pañc-guru-saÒsk§r . . . . . . . . . 89 3.3 Current procedures: viraj§-havan/-homa (vidy§-saÒsk§r) and n§g§ initiations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 3.4 Rules for renunciates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
vi
table of contents
Chapter four. THE INTEGRATION OF VARIOUS LINEAGES: THE MA•H$MN$YA-S 4.1 “aØkara’s authorship of texts, and his date. . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Organisational structure of the Daáan§mÊs, according to the Maãh§mn§yastotra, “rÊ Maãh§mn§yasetu and other texts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Gotra, samprad§ya, Brahmac§rÊ name, Veda and mah§v§kya . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 The pÊãha-s and guru-parampar§-s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.1 K§ñcÊpuram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.2 “ÜØgerÊ and other southern maãha-s . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.3 Disputes concerning the western pÊãha . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.4 The eastern pÊãha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.5 The northern pÊãha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.6 The Sumeru pÊãha . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chapter five. “A‡KARA’S HAGIOGRAPHIES AND HIS RELIGIOUS ORIENTATION 5.1 The hagiographies of “aØkara . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 “aØkara’s life in the hagiographies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 “aØkara’s religious orientation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 PÊãha-s, maãha-s, and the installation of disciples in the hagiographies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5 The first references to the ‘ten names’ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
104
114 119 122 128 133 139 140 143 144
148 151 159 170 173
Chapter six. THE RISE AND INFLUENCE OF ADVAITA MA•HA-S 6.1 The P§áupatas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 Maãha-s and competing religious traditions in south India, 600–1500 CE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3 Religious initiation and orientation of the Vijayanagara rulers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4 The SaØgamas’ patronage of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha and its pontiffs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5 “aØkara and the founding of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha . . . . . . . . .
202 214
Chapter seven. N$G$-S, S—F^S AND PARALLEL RELIGIOUS IDENTITIES 7.1 The formation of militant ascetic orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2 The development of SåfÊ institutions in India . . . . . . . . . .
228 232
177 179 193
table of contents 7.3 Religious identity in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4 Mercenary and military activities of n§g§-s and gosain-s . . . 7.5 SaÒny§sÊ-s, fakÊr-s and rebellion in east India. . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6 Gosain traders and bankers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 SaÒny§sÊ-s and the modern political world . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.8 Concluding remarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
vii 235 247 251 256 262 266
Appendix 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Numbers and percentages of orthodox, reformist and radical s§dhu-s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . “rÊ Maãh§mn§yasetu, Mah§nuá§sanam, “eߧmn§ya . . . . . . “rÊ Maãh§mn§yasetu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . “§rad§ Maãh§mn§yaÈ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Govardhana Maãh§mn§yaÈ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Jyotir Maãh§mn§yaÈ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . “ÜØgerÊ Maãh§mn§yaÈ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mah§nuá§sanam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . “eߧmn§ya . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Translation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . “rÊ Maãh§mn§yasetu [The division of the revered traditions] . . “§rad§ Maãh§mn§ya . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Govardhana Maãh§mn§ya . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Jyotir Maãh§mn§ya . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . “ÜØgerÊ Maãh§mn§ya . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mah§nuá§sanam [The great instruction] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . “eߧmn§ya [The remaining doctrine] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The history and mythology of the Kumbh Mel§ . . . . . . . . . Appendix 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Subdivisions within the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s: maÜhÊ-s and d§v§-s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
271 271 274 274 274 274 275 275 276 277 279 281 281 281 281 282 283 284 286 287 287 300
Bibliography . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
303
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
339
300
viii
table of contents
table of contents
ix
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS This book is a revised PhD thesis that was undertaken at the School of Oriental and African Studies (University of London), between 1999 and 2004. I would like to express my unreserved thanks to the individuals and organisations who have assisted the production of this book, both financially and intellectually. My mother, Mrs Eileen Clark, magnanimously financed my MA and the first year of my PhD, while the Arts and Humanities Research Board (AHRB) generously provided a grant for three years, including a field-trip to India in 2002 to collect material. Their efficiency and commitment to academic research deserves the highest commendation. I would also like to thank the Jordan Fund for financing an essential visit to the Kumbh Mel§ in 2001. I also have a deep debt of gratitude to the teachers and supervisors who have contributed my academic development over the years. In particular, I would like to thank Daud Ali, George Botterill, Amrik Kalsi, Julia Leslie, Alexander Piatigorsky, Lucy Rosenstein, Peter Smith, Rupert Snell, Renate Söhnen-Thieme, and Cyril Williams. The staff of the all the various libraries I have used have been unfailingly helpful; in particular, I would like to commend the staff of the SOAS library for their courtesy and efficiency. Most importantly, I would also like to thank all those saÒny§sÊ-s in India who gave of their time, knowledge and experience, providing information essential to this study.
x
table of contents
table of contents
xi
PREFACE It concerns me that some of the results of this research may be objected to by traditionalists. However, my intention from the outset was simply to explore an institution that I believe is not only important within the religious environment of South Asia, but which has a great deal to teach anyone who engages with it on its own terms. No disrespect is intended either towards the Hindu tradition or saÒny§sÊ-s; but history sometimes reveals that which may be contrary to conventional understanding. It also needs to be stated that the general conclusions of the research presented in this book concerning the history of saÒny§sÊ institutions may turn out to be quite wrong in crucial respects. Should anyone find fault with any of the information provided or present data that undermine the historical arguments presented, reasoned criticism is invited. Despite considerable reluctance, it was finally decided to present this study to the general reader. To this author, it is also undeniably evident that some s§dhu-s have acquired what may be described as ‘special powers’, however such complex phenomena may be characterised or explained. It is manifestly a consequence of the philosophy, discipline and religious perspective of the saÒny§sÊ that such powers may accrue. Although throughout this study attention has been devoted to the ‘wordly’ study of saÒny§sÊ institutions and history, I would urge the reader to bear in mind that there exists another and more subtle dimension of saÒny§sÊ life, a dimension that I believe is beyond the means of any kind of conventional understanding or academic explanation: OÒ Namo N§r§yaÖa.
xii
table of contents
table of contents
ABBREVIATIONS (see the Bibliography for the editions of texts) ADh ARE ARMAD ARSIE ASI AV b. BG BSB BDh c. C“V d. EC EI fl. GDh HD“ l. MBh MS r. R§m RV “DV SV UVAT VDh v. YV
$pastambha-dharmasåtra (see Olivelle 1999) Annual Reports on Indian Epigraphy Annual Report of the Mysore Archaeological Department Annual Report on South-Indian Epigraphy Archaeological Survey of India Atharva Veda (see Griffith 1985) born BhagavadgÊt§ Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya (of “aØkara) Baudh§yana-dharmasåtra (see Olivelle 1999) circa Cidvil§sa-áaØkaravil§sa-vijaya (see Antarkar 1973) died Epigraphia Carnatica Epigraphia Indica floruit Gautama-dharmasåtra (see Olivelle 1999) History of Dharmaá§stra (see Kane 1977–1990) line Mah§bh§rata ManusmÜti reigned R§m§yaÖa Œg Veda (see Griffith 1973) “aØkara-dig-vijaya (see M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya 1986) S§ma Veda (see Griffith 1986) Uttankita Vidya Aranya Trust (1985) Vasißãha-dharmasåtra (see Olivelle 1999) verse Yajur Veda (see Griffith 1927)
xiii
xiv
table of contents
TRANSLITERATION Transliteration of Hindi terms generally follows Parikh (1996); for Sanskrit, Monier Williams (1994 [1899]), with the exceptions: ‘Ü’ instread of ‘Üi’; ‘ß’ instead of ‘sh’. Personal, place names and other terms that occur in both Hindi and Sanskrit registers are not always transliterated consistently. For example, places such as Allahabad occur in the Hindi register as ‘Pray§g’, and in Sanskrit as ‘Pray§ga’; ‘renunciate’ is usually transliterated as saÒny§sÊ, as accords with the Hindi register and the Sanskrit nominative singular, in distinction from the common rendering of the Sanskrit, as saÒny§sin. Names of Indian states (for example, Maharashtra) and well-known cities (for example, Delhi) have been transliterated according to modern English conventions, while smaller places have generally been transliterated according to Hindi conventions. A slightly unusual convention has been utilised in the text of this book, of adding a hyphen before the ‘s’ of plural Hindi and Sankrit terms. Although this occasionally results in the ‘s’ becoming detached from the term, owing to automatic formatting by the computer, an advantage gained is the clearer legibility of diacritical marks.
introduction
1
INTRODUCTION 0.1 Introduction to the Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs This book presents an account of the history and practices of Daáan§mÊs,1 or Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs, one of the largest of the orthodox2 sects3 of South Asian s§dhu-s. S§dhu4 refers to someone who has, at least formally if not in practice, renounced family life and conventional means for making a livelihood. Under a guru, assisted by several Brahman paÖ·it-s, the candidate passes through the saÒny§sa ritual, the abandoning of ‘worldly’ life, an important constituent of which is the performance of the initiate’s own funeral rites. This relieves the renunciate’s family of any future responsibility in that regard. SaÒny§sa entails not only the formal renunciation of worldly life, but simultaneously initiates the renunciate into the lineage of the sect to which the initiating guru belongs. During initiation into the Daáan§mÊs (meaning ‘he who has [one of the] ten names’), a áaiva sect,5 the neophyte is given a new dÊkߧ (‘initiation’) name, the ‘surname’ being bestowed by an initiating guru with that particular Daáan§mÊ surname.6 The ten names are: 1 The Daáan§mÊs also refer to themselves as ‘Dasn§mÊ’, in conformity with the Hindi (as opposed to Sanskrit) rendering of the term. 2 In this context and throughout the book, the term ‘orthodox’ is used to refer to the principles, beliefs, doctrines, categories and behaviour which the Brahmanical tradition itself defines as orthodox, whether or not the objects of reference define themselves as orthodox or otherwise. This is simply to conform to a norm established by the continued textual and religious authority of the Brahmanical tradition within Hinduism. 3 The term ‘sect’ is commonly used to refer to various Indian orders. In the Indian context ‘sect’ does not necessarily have the late-mediaeval Christian connotation of heretical opposition to orthodoxy, but simply that of a group of people with common religious beliefs, rituals and practices, even though some Indian sects (such as Jaina, Buddhist and C§rv§ka) did explicitly challenge Vedic authority. 4 Derived from the Sanskrit root s§dh, meaning ‘accomplish’, s§dhu also means ‘good’ or ‘virtuous’ in both Sanskrit and Hindi. 5 Most áaiva sects, including the Daáan§mÊs, perform the saÒny§sa rite for initiates, while in most vaißÖava renunciate sects, instead, a relationship is forged between the initiate and the redeeming deity. 6 The intiates of the Agni akh§Ü§ are an exception: they do not take one of the ten names, but one of the four brahmac§rÊ names (see Ch. 2.1).
2
introduction
Giri (‘hill’), PurÊ (‘town’), Bh§ratÊ (‘learning’), Vana (or Ban) (‘forest’), Parvata (‘mountain’), AraÖya (‘forest/wilderness’), S§gara (‘ocean’), TÊrtha (‘pilgrimage-place’), $árama (‘hermitage’), and SarasvatÊ (‘knowledge’).7 The saÒny§sÊ acquires a new religious identity and is initiated into a parallel social world, with its own heirarchies and implicit codes of behaviour. In the case of a large renunciate sect, such as the Daáan§mÊs, the renunciate also has potential access to an extensive network of maãha-s (‘monasteries’) and §árama-s throughout India, which may provide food and shelter. According to tradition, besides his literary activity and his tour of India—his digvijaya—when he defeated a variety of opponents with divergent religious and philosophical points of view, it was the great advaita philosopher “aØkar§c§rya8 who founded or organised the Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs and established four maãha-s (known as pÊãha-s) under the authority of his four main disciples, in the west, east, north and south of India at, respectively: Dv§rak§, in Gujarat; Jagann§th PurÊ, in Orissa; Jyoáimaãh, near BadarÊn§th in Uttaranchal; and either “ÜØgerÊ, in Karnataka, or K§ñcÊpuram, in Tamil Nadu.9 The ‘thrones’ (gaddÊ-s) of these pÊãha-s (also known as vidy§pÊãha-s, ‘seats of learning’) are occupied by pontiffs known as “aØkar§c§ryas who all trace their lineage back to $di-“aØkara, via his disciples. If “aØkara did indeed organise the Daáan§mÊs, it would have been the first Brahmanical order of ascetics. Although several scholars have commented that there is little evidence to support these claims of tradition,10 no one has yet proposed any alternative explanation for the origin of the order. The aim of this book is, firstly, to provide the most comprehensive account of the current structure and organisation of the Daáan§mÊ 7 The most common of the names are Giri, PurÊ, Bh§ratÊ and SarasvatÊ. The meaning of Bh§ratÊ and SaravatÊ, given as ‘learning’ and ‘knowledge’ respectively, is but the symbolic meaning attributed to those names by Daáan§mÊs. 8 Most scholars date “aØkara to between 788 and 820 CE, but there is still some controversy concerning his dates and what he may or may not have written (see Ch. 4.1). This “aØkara is also referred to as ‘$di’ (‘original’) “aØkara, to distinguish him from subsequent “aØkar§c§ryas. 9 The issue of the maãha-s supposedly founded by “aØkara is considered in Ch. 4.4. 10 Potter (1981:14) comments that no other Indian philosopher has been celebrated in so many legends, and that it is difficult to differentiate traditional stories from fact.
introduction
3
order; this is undertaken in Chapters 1 to 3. Secondly, having presented an overview of the various branches of the sect, the origins of the Daáan§mÊs are investigated in Chapters 4 to 7 from a variety of historical perspectives. It should not be expected that the results of the research undertaken enable the provision of a complete or exact solution to the question when the Daáan§mÊs came into existence as a distinct, recognisable sect. However, the standard claims of tradition will be critically examined, and various religious and political developments will be explored, in order to indicate particular factors that may have led to the formation of the Daáan§mÊ order, most probably in the late sixteenth or early seventeenth century.11
0.2 Locating ‘the saÒny§sÊ’ Before embarking on the presentation of the organisation and structure of the Daáan§mÊs as a renunciate sect, a preliminary concern is to tackle the prevalent notion of a renunciate as a lone, wandering individual. It is apparent that the self-projection by the Brahmanical tradition of the image of the individualised, male saÒny§sÊ has been remarkably influential on a general understanding of the dynamics of Hinduism. It will be suggested in this section that this projection has contributed to several popular misconceptions concerning the life of saÒny§sÊ-s.12 This image, while bearing a partial reflection of social reality, nevertheless detracts from the significance of saÒny§sa being conferred on a candidate by a guru within a lineage that generally operates within the framework of a sect—however loosely knit—with its own identificatory markers. A related issue, also considered in this section, is the lifestyle of the saÒny§sÊ. According to the ideal, as presented in texts, renunciates maintain celibacy and undertake austerities of some kind or other to purify the mind and body, in order to ‘realise God’ or obtain liberation (mokßa), an objective considered to be difficult in worldly life. There is, however, a complex of sociological and economic factors
11
Unless otherwise stated, all dates in this book are CE. SaÒny§sÊ is often translated as ‘monk’, and maãha as ‘monastery’. These terms derive from the Greek monos (‘alone’) and monazein (‘to live alone’), thus reinforcing a notion of ‘aloneness’ (see Meister 1990), which, it will be argued, is not entirely appropriate in a South Asian (or even Christian) context. 12
4
introduction
implicit in reasons for initiation, and in the lifestyle of the saÒny§sÊ, who generally engages not only with members of his or her own sect, but with the wider world. It is to a consideration of the ‘lone ascetic’ and his or her lifestyle that we first turn. This discussion is followed by a survey of Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs who are settled as a caste in various regions of India. From the early centuries BCE, the Brahmanical textual tradition provides us with an image of the Brahmanical ascetic. In works on Dharmaá§stra, the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s and mediaeval texts on renunciation,13 we find a lone Brahmanical ascetic wandering from one Brahman household to another, typically collecting food from the womenfolk14 in his hands or other designated receptacles, when the pestles are silent and the cooking fires are but embers.15 Open a tract or book on Ved§nta recently published in India, and there is considerable likelihood of seeing a picture of one of the “aØkar§c§ryas, portrayed as a living representative of the ancient Brahmanical practice of renunciation, saÒny§sa.16 The “aØkar§c§ryas consciously identify themselves with ancient Vedic tradition and the four-fold varÖa and §árama17 systems.18 As is well known, saÒny§sa 13
See Ch. 3 for further details. See Findly (2002). 15 Probably the earliest available evidence to be found in the Brahmanical tradition for codes of conduct for ascetics is in the Aßã§dhy§yÊ, the grammatical treatise of P§Öini, usually assigned to the fourth century BCE. P§Öini (IV.3.110–111) refers to the bhikßusåtra-s (codes of conduct for mendicants) proclaimed by P§r§áara and KarmaÖda (see P§Öini 1987). The earliest clear formulation of a Brahmanical renunciate’s lifestyle is in the Dharmasåtra-s of $pastamba (2.21.7–17), Gautama (3.11–25), Baudh§yana (2.17–18), and Vasißãha (10.1–29), texts dating from around the third to the second centuries BCE (see Olivelle 1977:21; 1999:xxvii–xxxiv). For details of renunciation procedures in these texts, see Ch. 3.1. For a summary of the lifestyle and rules for the ‘ideal’ Brahmanical renunciate, see Shiraishi (1996:27–135), and Ch. 3.4. 16 The Sanskrit term saÒny§sa originated as a specific reference to the ‘throwing down’ or abandoning of the ritual implements used by Brahmans for their daily Vedic ritual, the adoption of an ascetic way of life, and the renunciation of social obligations or ritual duties in pursuit of ‘Knowledge’. The term saÒny§sa (‘renunciation’) occurs rarely in the Veda-s and Br§hmaÖa-s, and only appears once in the classical Upanißad-s, in the MuÖ·aka Upanißad (3.2.6: liberation through “saÒny§sayoga”), one of the later classical Upanißad-s, composed in the last few centuries BCE (Olivelle 1984:127; 1996:xxxvii). 17 The §árama system became fully formulated within the Brahmanical tradition by around the beginning of the Common Era, only incorporating saÒny§sa as the ‘ideal’ fourth §árama in the final phase of its development (Olivelle 1978:28; 1993:103). Both Manu (6.33–36) and earlier dharmaá§stra commentaries—for example, 14
introduction
5
is the fourth §árama, ideally only suitable for ‘retired-from-Vedicritual’ older men who have produced at least one son. The previous “aØkar§c§rya of K§ñcÊpuram, for example, commenting on saÒny§sa (Candraáekharendra SarasvatÊ 1995:539), maintains that only a few (including, by implication, himself) “have the wisdom...necessary to skip two §árama-s” (that of the householder, gÜhastha, and forest recluse, vanaprastha). The “aØkar§c§ryas project themselves in the image of fourth-§árama saÒny§sÊ-s—austere, detached and committed to liberation—yet are the nominal heads of a large áaiva sect that has had an intricate relationship with the economy and politics of India for many centuries, instances of which are explored in the latter part of this book. The saÒny§sÊ conceived in the stereotypical image of the lone Brahmanical renouncer is often supposed, in various ways, to represent an ancient ‘individualistic’ ascetic tradition receding into India’s remote past. References to what appear to be ascetics (though this is disputed)19 with varied nomenclature in ancient Brahmanical texts,
Baudh§yana (2.11.16–27)—emphasise the importance of producing children before renouncing. The stage of forest dweller (§raÖyaka or vanaprastha)—also, like saÒny§sin, a relatively late development—was incorporated into the scheme as an §árama, but seems in practice to have had relatively little import in the general organisation of the ideal stages to be passed through. It seems to have become obsolete in the first few centuries of the Common Era, its memory only preserved in legend, poetry, drama, and works on dharma which still discussed it up to mediaeval times. A modification of the system, as seen in the Y§jñavalkya Dharmaá§stra (3.56), permitted a man to renounce without passing through the third §árama (Olivelle 1993:174). For references in Manu, see ManusmÜti (1983), Doniger and Smith (1991); for Y§jñavalkya Dharmaá§stra, see Y§jñavalkya SmÜti (1913) and Dutta (1987, Vol. 1). 18 See, for example, Candraáekharendra SarasvatÊ (1976; 1995). 19 There is still disagreement among scholars as to whether before the so-called ‘axial age’, in the sixth to fifth centuries BCE, asceticism existed in South Asia as a lifestyle, rather than as inherent periodic regimens of asceticism undertaken within the Brahmanical ritual world, such as undertaken by the yajam§na before the final bath (avabhÜtha). For the limited periods of Brahmanical asceticism, see Kaelber (1989:78); Lubin (2001). Amongst the most currently influential scholars of ancient Indian asceticism are Heesterman, Olivelle and Bronkhorst. Heesterman (see particularly 1985:34–43) famously argues that ‘orthogenetic’ developments in Vedic sacrificial ritual led to the individuation of the sacrificer, and then the ‘interiorisation of the ritual’ and the concomitant abandoning of Vedic rites in the person of the renouncer. In contrast, Olivelle’s thesis, developed in a number of publications (1980a; 1980b; 1984; 1993), is that, essentially, asceticism, as a lifestyle within the orthodox Brahmanical world, began as a parallel development within the Vedic world in the fifth to sixth centuries BCE. According to Olivelle, Brahmanical asceticism did not develop out of the Vedic ritual complex (as Heesterman maintains), but
6
introduction
if accepted uncritically, might also lend support to the notion of an individual ascetic. In the Veda-s, for example, there are references to muni-s20 and yati-s,21 who seem to exhibit classical features of asceticism and aspects of shamanism.22 The terms muni and yati are still used in the Brahmanical tradition to refer to ascetics.23 In the second century BCE, Patañjali (the grammarian) refers24 to the yati (3.1.97.82), muÖ·in (1.1.1.42, ‘shaven-headed’) and áramaÖa25 (2.4.12.2,
neither was asceticism a feature of what might be called an ‘ancient shamanic culture’ that, according to some scholars, was evident in the Indus Valley culture of the third millennium BCE. Olivelle (1993:13; discussion at SOAS, 22.02.01) maintains that muni-s, yati-s and v§taraáana-s who appear in the Veda were not ascetics (as they appear to be), and that the meaning of the terms changed. Bronkhorst (1998) cogently argues for two distinct streams in ancient India, but does not speculate on ancient origins. For a comprehensive review of opinions on the origins of Indian asceticism, see Bronkhorst (1998:1–9). 20 The muni (‘silent one’) is mentioned twice in the earlier portion (Books II–VII) of the Œg Veda: VII.51.8 (muniriva); VIII.17.14 (månÊn§Ø s§kha); and once in the S§ma Veda (I.3.2.4.3). In the well-known keáin (‘long-haired’) hymn of the Œg Veda (X.136), unmadit§ (‘intoxicated/frenzied/ecstatic’) muni-s (v.3) are described (for references in the Veda-s, see Griffith 1927, 1973, 1985, 1986). Eliade (1972:407–411) believes this passage indicates affinities, but not a strict identity, with classical shamanism. Werner (1989:35–45) maintains that the keáin muni is “a spiritual personage of very high stature” who lives predominantly outside Brahmanical culture, practising meditation (man) and what came to be later known as the yogic life of the renouncer. 21 RV (VIII.3.9; VIII.6.18; X.57.7); SV (II.3.1.22.3); AV (I.2.5.3; II.20.9.3). Doniger (1981b:14) compares the yati with a shaman or magician. Mythologically, the yati-s are identified as an ancient race of ascetics who took part in the legendary creation of the world, and are connected with the BhÜgus, a group of ancient, mythical beings who are sacrificers, renowned for the bringing of fire to men, and also associated with funeral ceremonies, the underworld and eschatology. BhÜgu became identified as one of the seven Üßi-s, who are the archetypal seers and sages who transmitted the Veda and revealed the Pur§Öa-s, and who are perhaps closer to shamans than any other figures in Indian literature, including yogin-s. The Üßi-s are usually depicted similarly to the classical áaiva ascetic, dressed in deer-skin or bark-cloth, their bodies smeared with ashes, their hair uncut, matted and tied in a knot. See Griffith, AV (1985:270); Macdonell (1974:140); Bhattacharji (1970:1); Mani (1975:139–141); Goldman (1977:5); Mitchener (1982:187–188). For the inclusion of BhÜgu within the tradition of the seven Üßi-s, in, essentially, two lists, see Mitchener (1982:4, 30, 126). 22 For attempted definitions of shamanism, see also Basilov (1999:25–30); Blacker (1999:24–26). 23 Another class of ascetics referred to in the Br§hmaÖa-s and Atharva Veda (XV) are the enigmatic vr§tya-s, variously interpreted as a yogin-s, mystics, áaiva-s, nomads, cattle-raiders, non-§rya (see Eliade 1969:103), Vedic sacrificers (Heesterman 1963), or a semi-military sodality with similarities to European death-cults (Bollée 1981). 24 Vy§karaÖa-mah§bh§ßya (ed. Kielhorn, 1892, 1906, 1909). 25 The term áramaÖa (‘ascetic striver’) has the same root as ‘shaman’ (Blacker
introduction
7
p. 476), without distinguishing them. Another term for an ascetic that occurs in the Br§hmaÖa-s and $raÖyaka-s is v§taraáana (‘living on wind’ or ‘girdled with wind’),26 a person who is described as both årdhvamanthin27 and áramaÖa. In the epics, residents of hermitages (§árama-s) are also sometimes identified as áramaÖa-s,28 Manu, who wrote around the beginning of the Common Era, uses several terms for ascetics: yati,29 muni,30 bhikßu (‘beggar’),31 ty§ga (‘renunciate’) and parivr§jaka (‘wanderer/circulator’), terms that had been used for ascetics in the older Brahmanical texts. Manu also refers to the state of renunciation as parivr§jya/pravrajya, saÒny§sa and ty§ga, without distinguishing these as different kinds of asceticism or renunciation.32 It is somewhat difficult to determine the difference between these kinds of ascetics, but Manu’s concern is with saÒny§sa and how that relates to other phases of a man’s life: he—as a Brahman—is not concerned with the aims and activities of non-Brahmanical ascetics, as any other ethnic group were considered to be áådra-s,33 and hence ineligible to renounce. Manu is the first Dharmaá§stra author to use the term saÒny§sin (Bronkhorst 1998:24),34 by which he refers to the fourth-§árama renunciate, who is characterised in the image of the ‘ideal’, lone, begging 1999:23–24), and by the time of Aáoka (mid-third century BCE) is generally used to designate all non-Brahmanical ascetics, particularly Jainas and Buddhists (Olivelle 1993:11). 26 In the TaittirÊya $raÖyaka (2.7) (of the Black Yajur Veda) v§taraáana denotes a áramaÖa wearing coloured clothes, who has control over the senses, leads a chaste life and practises austerities. The TA is also the first Brahmanical text to use the term áramaÖa (Olivelle 1993:13). 27 The term årdhvamanthin may refer to an erect penis (as a synonym for årdhvaliØga) or to the control of sperm (Olivelle 1993:13). 28 R§m, I.1.46, I.13.8, III.69.19, III.70.7. MBh, XII.150.18, XIII.135.104. 29 MS, 5.20, 11.218. 30 MS, 1.58-60, 1.110, 3.257, 3.272, 5.54, 6.5, 6.11, 6.25, 6.43, 7.29, 8.91, 8.407. 31 MS, 4.4-5, 10.116. 32 MS, 1.114, 2.97, 3.245, 4.17, 5.89, 5.108, 6.33–34, 6.38–39, 6.78. Concerning terminology, it seems that in Brahmanical sources the older terms for renunciates, such as parivr§ja and parivr§jaka (‘wanderer/circulator’) eventually became replaced with the cover-all term, saÒny§sa (Olivelle 1984:140). 33 “By failing to perform rituals or seek audiences with priests, the following castes of the ruling classes have gradually sunk in the world to the rank of servants: the ‘Sugarcane-boilers’, ‘Colas’, ‘Southerners’, ‘Kambojas’, ‘Greeks’, ‘Scythians’, ‘Quicksilvers’, ‘Chinese’, ‘Mountaineers’, ‘Precipice-dwellers’, and ‘Scabs’ ”(MS, 10.43–44, trans. Doniger). 34 See, for example, MS, 1.114, 5.108.
8
introduction
renouncer, as presented in the Dharmasåtra-s. It is this characterision of what ‘the saÒny§sÊ’35 represents that seems to have cast an interpretative shadow up to the present day.36 From the period preceding Manu until now, it seems that the status of many ascetics and ‘renouncers’ was and is far more phenomenologically and socially complex than the ideal conception might lead us to believe.37 For example, it is generally assumed that once someone has renounced, then the condition is permanent. However, in the Yama-saÒhit§ (Dutta 1987,
35 Similar conceptions of the ‘ideal’ Buddhist monk have also been challenged by Schopen (1997), who has published a series of influential articles on the differences between the textual representation of the activities of Buddhist monks, and their activities as revealed through inscriptions, the latter indicating the widespread involvement of monks in a variety of ‘worldly’ and ritual activities. 36 The theme of the ‘individual’ renouncer was famously articulated by Dumont (1960) in his seminal and influential article ‘World Renunciation in Indian Religions’. (See also Dumont 1998:184–187, 273–282). For useful critiques of Dumont, see Kolenda (1975) and Quigley (1999:21–53), who both suggest that Dumont never fully faced the relationship between social interaction and ideology. The ‘ideal’ lone renouncer is also a common motif in many recent works on Hinduism. Basham (1967:159, 175), Hopkins (1971:82–83), Fuller (1992:17), Lipner (1994:298), Klostermaier (1994:50), and Brockington (1996:198), for example, assume that the renunciate is ‘beyond’ caste and ritual (as that is the presentation of the saÒny§sÊ supplied by Brahmanical texts). Although these scholars have a sophisticated understanding of the Hindu tradition, nevertheless ‘the renouncer’ is generally presented divorced from the sect within which his or her life is embedded, with the concomitant social hierarchies, caste-restrictions and social obligations. It is also apparent that the image of the saÒny§sÊ in the western world was significantly influenced by Vivek§nanda’s presentation within the general framework of what is generally known as ‘neo-Hinduism’. By the 1890s the notion of the saÒny§sÊ had gained unprecedented significance, as a quintessential bearer of India’s spiritual culture (see Halbfass 1988:217–246; Chowdhury-Sengupta 1996; Radice 1998). However, ironically, Vivek§nanda’s cabin-class journeys to Europe and the USA, and the establishing of foreign advaita maãha-s, is almost the antithesis of the lifestyle of the traditional ancient Brahmanical ascetic. See Pagborn (1976:117) for the establishing of Advaita Ashrama maãha-s. 37 A similar idealisation by Dumont of the role of the Brahman and the king (juxtaposed with the saÒny§sÊ in terms of power, purity and caste) has also been criticised on several fronts. On kings and Brahmans, see Derrett (1976); on the ‘ideal Brahman’, see van der Veer (1997); Quigley (1999:54–86). Van der Veer (1998) observes that, far from aspiring to a ritually pure state as the ideal exemplar should, the Brahmans of Ayodhya maintain a complex set of relations, in terms of financial exchange, with the rest of the community and visiting pilgrims. He challenges (1998:xiv) a prevalent idea, articulated in various forms in Dumont (1960), Heesterman (1985), Parry (1985), and Fuller (1992), that “there is a contradiction in the Brahman’s priesthood, [that] the ‘ideal Brahman’ renounces the priesthood and the dependence on donations. I shall argue that instead of limiting our research to values we should look at behaviour”.
introduction
9
Vol. 2:282) there is a penance prescribed for a Brahman mendicant who wishes to become a householder,38 indicating that, historically, saÒny§sa was not necessarily permanent. We will also see (in Chapter 1) that—in a modern context, at least—the caste background of the renunciate loses little of its significance after saÒny§sa, and that specific sectarian identification is a crucial component of the saÒny§sÊ-’s identity. From the Brahmanical perspective, saÒny§sa is, by definition, to enter a non-ritual state, and only possible for those twice-born (nonáådra-s) with the ritual implements, fires and formulae to renounce. However, those Brahmans or other twice-born wishing to renounce had already been initiated into the Brahmanical world through the upanayana39 ritual when they earned the right to participate in orthodox ritual life and received their sacred thread.40 An important issue is whether the other kinds of ascetics mentioned in the ancient texts referred to were—as a general rule—initiated into some kind of ascetic tradition. Many commentators on life in ancient India distinguish between, essentially, two classes of ascetics, br§hmaÖa-s and áramaÖa-s. They were clearly distinguished by early Jaina and Buddhist sources,41 and also by Megasthen¿s (4th century BCE), who provides some of the earliest recorded visitors’ impressions of India. Megasthen¿s made a distinction between two kinds of ‘philosophers’: the br§hmaÖa-s, following the br§hmaÖa ritual life, and the áramaÖa-s,42 the ‘strivers’ for liberation.43 Both kinds of ‘philosopher’ practised asceticism, the br§hmaÖa-s less extremely, but the áramaÖa-s intensely, “undergoing active toil, and by the endurance of pain being able to remain motion-
38 He should perform three pr§j§patya and three c§ndr§yaÖa penances, becoming again purified with the j§ta-saÒsk§ra and other saÒsk§ra-s, previously referred to in the text. See Ch. 3.1 for an explanation of the penances. 39 For details of upanayana, see Prasad (1997). 40 This is theoretically discarded during saÒny§sa, but see Ch.1. 41 See Bronkhorst (1998:78–88); Thapar (1996:56–93). Skurzak (1948; 1967:202– 210) argues for three types of ascetic. 42 See McCrindle (1877:97–103 [Fragment XLI; Strabo XV.1.58-60]). 43 Megasthen¿s also distinguishes between two kinds of áramaÖa-s. The Hylobioi lived as celibates in the forests, subsisting on leaves and wild fruits; they were the most respected and “advised” kings. The other kind (next in honour) were the physicians who were “engaged in the study of man”. Besides these, there were the diviners and sorcerers who went around begging in towns and villages.
10
introduction
less the whole day”.44 Patañjali (the grammarian) noted the extreme and innate hostility between the br§hmaÖa-s and áramaÖa-s.45 The two kinds of ascetics were also distinguished in Aáoka’s inscriptions46 (mid-third century BCE); by Strabo47 (19 CE); by Bardesmanes of Babylon48 (second century CE); by the Chinese Buddhist scholar, Hüang Tsang49 (seventh century CE); and by Alberuni50 (eleventh century CE). According to Brahmanical norms women are not entitled to renounce51—having not passed through the saÒsk§ra-s, they are
44
Zysk’s research (1998) reveals how Indian medical knowledge was also developed between 1,000 and 200 BCE by wandering áramaÖa-s uninhibited by Brahmanical restrictions on contact with such things as ‘impure’ dead bodies. 45 I.2.4.2 (Kielhorn edn., p. 476, line 9). Here, Patañjali, citing one of P§Öini’s rules, provides the phrase áramaÖa-br§hmaÖa as an example of a compound in which the component words refer to objects that were opposed to each other. 46 Edicts of Aáoka, Rock Edicts 3, 4, 8, 9, 11; Pillar Edict 7. The Edicts indicate a double class of religious people worthy of honour and donations (see Mookerji 1928). 47 Section 70: “The Pramnai (áramaÖa) ridicule the Brachmanes who study physiology and astronomy as fools and imposters” (McCrindle 1979:76). 48 He divides Gymnosophists into two sects: Bragmanes and Samanaioi (Strabo XV.1.58–60 [McCrindle 1979:67–68 fn. 1; McCrindle 1877:97–103]). 49 See Beal (1884). 50 He refers to the antagonism between Brahmanas and Shamaniyya (Buddhists), even though they are akin (Sachav 1996, Vol. 1:21). 51 However, some Brahmanical commentary also provides evidence in support of the eligibility of women renouncers. In the JÊvanmuktiviveka (a fourteenth/fifteenth century text attributed to Vidy§raÖya, but see Ch. 6.4 of this book), it is stated that women, either before marriage or after the death of their husbands, have the right to renounce, subsist on alms, study the Upanißad-s, meditate on the Self, carry the tridaÖ·a (a form of the mendicant’s staff), and exhibit all the marks of saÒny§sa. References from Veda-s, Upanißad-s and the Mah§bh§rata are cited in support of this position (see Vidy§raÖya 1996:6–8). In his Yatidharmaprak§áa (61.39–44) (see Olivelle 1976–1977), V§sudev§árama (c.1625–1800) cites Vijñ§neávara (c.1100–1120), who cites Y§jñavalkya SmÜti (which in turn cites a såtra attributed to Baudh§yana, “strÊÖ§m caike...”) to the effect that, in some circumstances, a woman may renounce. V§sudev§árama states that the yati should not associate with women renouncers (saÒny§sinÊ-s), even though some (such as Baudh§yana) declare renunciation also for women. The Arthaá§stra of Kauãilya states that under some circumstances, such as in the case of a queen whose husband dies, women did in fact renounce. In the BÜhad§raÖyaka Upanißad (IV.5.3) there is also the well known case of MaitreyÊ, the wife of Y§jñavalkya, who announces her intention to renounce. Women renouncers were, however, generally regarded with disapproval by Kauãilya, Manu, V§sudev§árama and other orthodox commentators (see Kane HD“, Vol. 2:948; Olivelle 1977:24, 34, 175; 1984:115). Although these days women do not become saÒny§sinÊ-s in the “rÊ-VaißÖava order (see Ch. 2.1 fn. 7), there is evidence from the thirteenth century that they did so (Narayan 1993:282). For discussions of women and renunciation, see also Young (1987:68–70); Leslie (1989:318–321).
introduction
11
technically equivalent to áådra-s—yet there is ample evidence of the existence of female ascetics,52 whether or not they had ‘renounced’.53 P§Öini,54 Megasthen¿s55 and Strabo,56 who wrote in the period of the compilation of the Dharmasåtra-s, refer to both male and female áramaÖa-s (ascetic ‘strivers’).57 From references in the Mah§bh§rata and Kauãilya’s Arthaá§stra (c. second century CE) it is also apparent that ascetics had a reputation for being useful to the state for a variety of nefarious activities, including spying and assassination.58 Although there are abundant references to ascetics in South Asia— dating from the first millennium BCE until the present day—‘the
52 Women tapasvinÊ-s and áramaÖÊ-s, such as VedavatÊ, “abarÊ and SvayaÒprabh§, appear in the R§m§yaÖa (III.74.7, IV.50.38, VII.17.2) and also in the Mah§bh§rata, where several devoted themselves to life-long austerities and remained unmarried (see Bhagat 1976:206, 263). They wore deerskins, matted locks and bark garments, kept their ‘senses restrained’, and practised righteousness. 53 Nothing, to my knowledge, is revealed anywhere in the Brahmanical tradition about how women who were permitted to renounce did so. It would seem reasonable to surmise that they took saÒny§sa from a male preceptor, as is usually the procedure these days (see Ch. 1.1). 54 Aßã§dh§yÊ II.1.70, VI.2.26 (see P§Öini 1987, trans. Katre). 55 Strabo XV.1. 60, citing Megasthen¿s (McCrindle 1877:103). 56 Strabo (Sec. II, 60, 70) refers to women who study philosophy with the ‘Sarmanes’ (áramaÖa-s) and remain celibate; and also (Sec. II, 66) to women philosophers who live austerely among the ‘Brachmanes’ (McCrindle 1979 [1901]:67, 76; 72). 57 Women were admitted into the $jÊvika order (Basham 1951:106) and early Buddhist order (Hüsken 2000). 58 In Kauãilya’s Arthaá§stra, one of the recommended articles of state policy is to attempt to control all aspects of society, including ascetics. Olivelle (1987:42–59) notes that the Arthaá§stra (2.1.30–31) and Mah§bh§rata (XII.63.11–15) both state that government permission is required for entry into the ascetic life (only for vaiáya-s and áådra-s in the MBh). It is apparent from these texts that their authors considered wandering ascetics (particularly ‘fallen’ renouncers) to be the ideal spies: they should exhibit austerity (but may secretly eat), and events should, if possible, be arranged to make it seem that their predictions have come true, thus enhancing their status as visionaries and magicians. Ascetic spies (including women) were to be used by kings to infiltrate monasteries, provide a secret service, initiate conspiracies, and carry out assassinations. Ascetics are one of five kinds of people mention by Manu (7.154) to be used as spies. The dangers of ascetic spies, who are regarded with suspicion, are also evident in the Arthaá§stra. They are to be removed from the road the king is travelling along (1.21.26); they should only be granted an audience in the company of trusted armed guards (1.21.24); the queen was forbidden contact with ascetics, who were also notorious as go-betweens for lovers (1.20.18). Ascetics were to be arrested at state borders should they not be wearing or carrying the proper emblems of a renouncer (2.28.20); a close watch is maintained over their movements, and any kind of suspicious behaviour could lead to arrest (2.36.13–14); they are subject to a night-curfew (2.36.39). See Olivelle (1987); Paranjpe (1991).
12
introduction
ascetic’ is generally presented in works on the Hindu tradition as someone divorced from any historical or social context, as an unchanging ‘ahistorical’ archetype. An aim of this book is to examine the roles that saÒny§sÊ-s have played in various contexts, and to illustrate some of the social, economic and political circumstances that have impelled their activities and organisation, a survey of which illustrates to some extent the historical development of saÒny§sÊ institutions. A related point, which also needs stating, is that ascetics, as a general rule in South Asia, are initiates into a sect. The archetype of the typical ascetic usually presented within the Hindu religious tradition is a áaiva,59 usually covered with ashes, and renowned for the practice of austerities and the acquisition of extraordinary powers. “aiva ascetics are attested in Brahmanical literature from the second century BCE,60 around the same time as the production of the first Brahmanical texts that deal with renunciation. It is apparent that ascetic ‘renunciates’ were not only ageing Brahman ex-ritualists. I would argue that although there are examples of individual lone renouncers, as a general rule, like initiated Jainas, Buddhists, $jÊvikas and C§rvakas, nearly all of the various kinds of non-Brahmanical ascetics mentioned in ancient Brahmanical texts would probably have been initiated in some fashion into an ascetic tradition by a preceptor within a lineage.61 This is true today and it seems improbable that it was otherwise in the ancient world, though this would be difficult to substantiate. The significance of initiation is the acquisition of a new religious identity (and usually sectarian markers), bestowed by the initating guru. The social, political and economic significance of initiation into a sect is simply dependent on the socio-political status of the sect at the time of initiation. However, whether as an
The evolution of sectarian “aivism is discussed in Ch. 6. The first textual references to “aivism are found in Patañjali’s Mah§bh§ßya on P§Öini’s grammar, probably written in the second century BCE (Dyczkowski 1989:4). Patañjali (5.2.76, Kielhorn edition, 1906, Vol. 2:387) refers to “ivabhagat-s, whom he describes as itinerant ascetics wearing animal skins and carrying an iron lance. 61 Thapar (1996:56–93) has commented that there are essentially two types of renouncer: one is the relatively rare ‘ideal’ lone ascetic; the other is an initiated member of a group. She argues that organised groups of renouncers (of the postVedic period) were not seeking to negate or alter society, but rather to establish a parallel society, as members of an order constituting an alternative lifestyle; a kind of counter-culture, often using social heresy to organise a religious identity. 59
60
introduction
13
individual or as a member of a sect, the role of the saÒny§sÊ within the religious and social history of India is far more complex than the image represented by the archetype. Both within and between the various renunciate sects, a wide spectrum of behaviour, practice and lifestyle is apparent amongst renunciates. While most members of sects of s§dhu-s are avowedly celibate, other sects, such as the D§då, Gau·Êya, R§m§nandÊ and Vallabhac§rÊ panth-s (‘paths/sects’) also have married initiates. Within the Daáan§mÊ order, lifestyles range from that of the poor s§dhu undertaking austerities,62 to the privileges enjoyed by some of the Mah§maÖ·aleávaras63 and “aØkar§c§ryas (jagadguru-s, ‘world-gurus’), who (on occasions) display royal insignia.64 A typical Daáan§mÊ mahant, an owner or proprietor of an §árama or maãha, frequently has a demanding and complex occupation, managing the income, taxes, finances, repairs, food supplies, påj§, festivals and labour disputes of a large landed property. Successful maãha-s are run as businesses, which may expand to establish branch maãha-s; and wealthy establishments are sometimes the object of intense jealousy from other local landlords.65 In general, even poor s§dhu-s have much closer ties with the world than might be supposed from the ideal.66 Since the seventeenth century, another term that has been used
62 Depending on predilection and social factors, saÒny§sÊ-s may be more or less involved in the institutional life of maãha-s or §árama-s. Some s§dhu-s are referred to as vir§kt (meaning ‘detached’ or ‘indifferent’): they shun §árama-s and other such institutions, believing them to be contrary to the aims of saÒny§sa. (Virakta is also a generic name in south India for renunciates who belong to the VÊraáaiva sect.) 63 For the role of Mah§maÖ·aleávaras within the Daáan§mÊ order, see Ch. 2.4. 64 Such as at the great festivals of Navar§tri and “rÊ “§rad§mb§ Mah§rathotsava (but not at “aØkarajayantÊ): see Sawai (1992:170). 65 See Morinis (1984:89–96) for an account of the affairs of the mahant-s of the Tarakeávar temple in Bengal. He notes (p. 91) some cases of “extreme forms” of deviation from the ideal role of the saÒny§sÊ, including a couple of murder cases connected with mahant-s’ mistresses. 66 Formally, saÒny§sÊ-s renounce their families and the rituals connected to family life, ‘home’ and conventional means of livelihood. However, Tripathi’s statistical surveys (1978:98–109) reveal that 76% of s§dhu-s provide financial help of some kind to their families, and that only 20% earned their money mainly through begging, other sources of financial income being mainly from private offerings (26.6%), social services (19%), attention-catching devices (6.8%), landed property (4.8%), employment in an §árama (1.6%), dubious devices (1.0%), and miscellaneous sources (26.2%).
14
introduction
to refer to Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s is gosain.67 Daáan§mÊ gosain-s (nonmonastic ascetics) are often but not always married, and many lead the lives of householders (gharb§rÊ-s), pursuing a variety of business, priestly and working activities. In the Daáan§mÊ context, the term gosain usually refers to saÒny§sÊ-s who have become semi-secularised and who have married, but who have retained a nominal allegiance to their hereditary order. In the final sections of this book, the activities of saÒny§sÊ n§g§ gosain-s in the seventeenth and eighteenth centuries will be discussed. Many thousands of militant n§g§ saÒny§sÊ-s (also known as gosain-s) were involved as mercenaries in numerous political conflicts in north India during this period, becoming wealthy as bankers and traders, and acquiring substantial property. The demise of their military activities around the end of the eighteenth century resulted in the settling of gosain-s, mostly in the Gangetic delta and several places in the Himalayas. Some Daáan§mÊ gosain-s migrated and settled in south India. Ethnographic accounts dating from before Indian Independence typically treat Daáan§mÊ (or saÒny§sÊ ) gosain-s as a caste or an order engaged in a wide variety of activities, not only as mendicants (s§dhu), but also as priests, bankers, farmers, traders and mercenaries, thus illustrating the complex relationship that saÒny§sÊ-s have had with their social environment. Historically, it seems more accurate to consider the Daáan§mÊs as a caste or a sect with many facets, rather than as lone individuals.68 Writing on the castes of Mysore, Ananthakrishna
67
Gosain (or gÙssain/gos§Ên/gÙs§yi/gosaeen) is also the name for heads of monasteries of the vaißÖava Bair§gÊ/Vair§gÊ/R§m§nandÊ order, and of the followers of Vallabh§c§rya (1479–1531). One of the earliest recorded uses of the term is in the memoirs of Emperor Jah§ngÊr (r.1605–1628), where it is used to describe an ascetic with whom he had religious conversations (Clarke 1998:52). The term most probably derives from the Sanskrit gosv§min, perhaps meaning ‘the master or possessor of a cow or cows’. Sad§nanda Giri (1976:57–59) suggests that gosain may derive from go (‘sense-organ’) and sv§min (‘master’). The first six disciples of the vaißÖava Bengali mystic, Caitanya (1485–1534) are referred to as the six gosv§min-s—of VÜnd§van—(see De 1986:111–165; Dimock 1963:110–113), later followers being referred to as gosayi. (Followers of Caitanya constitute the Gau·Êya panth.) Certainly by the nineteenth century, the term gosain was used locally and by British commentators to refer to both áaiva and vaißÖava mendicants, fakÊr-s and yogis (Pinch 1996:43–44). Gosain-s are also referred to as atÊt (‘beyond’). 68 Partly in response to Dumont’s notion of the ‘lone-renunciate’, Burghart (1978; 1983a; 1983b; 1996) developed a thesis of two parallel hierarchies operating within India: one essentially religious and one essentially political. Some of his central observations are that renouncers of various sects may be married or
introduction
15
Iyer (1930:256–258) remarks that one of the chief peculiarities of the GÙs§yis is that they constitute not only a religious order, but also a caste. Besides the caste’s natural increase from within, Brahmans, kßatriya-s and women are also recruited (via initiation) to the order, which then excludes them—via rules of commensality—from their previous caste.69 Concerning the SaÒny§sÊs of the Panj§b and North-West, Crooke (1896, Vol. 2:274) remarks that “the members of the sect are supposed to be strict celibates, but of late not a few of them have taken to marriage, and still continue to beg though married”.70 Initiation into the Daáan§mÊs, whether the initiate subsequently becomes a gharb§rÊ, a celibate living in a maãha, or a wandering s§dhu, requires the performance of the viraj§-homa, the saÒny§sa
unmarried, of various and differing caste restrictions, and intrinsically involved ‘in the world’ in various types of power, ritual and material exchanges. Regarding the Daáan§mÊs, the main thrust of Burghart’s thesis seems apt. However, we will see (in Ch. 7) that the mercenary, military, trading and banking activities of the Daáan§mÊs in the seventeenth, eighteenth and nineteenth centuries transgress practically all boundaries between religion and state, and between religious and political heirarchies. The activities of the Daáan§mÊs—and indeed several other sects of renunciates in India—exhibit a complexity and diversity that seems to defy classification in any anthropological structural model. However, that said, the models of both Dumont and Burghart are particularly useful—and not invalid—as general frameworks within which the complex phenomena of renunciation may be initially apprehended. 69 Marriage between first cousins is prohibited, but widow marriage and divorce are possible. “Women are admitted into the order, when they have their heads shaved, assume the ochre coloured shirt and smear their bodies with ashes. These women are supposed to live in nunneries, leading a chaste and pious life. But many of them live with men of the order, and the sons born of such unions would be adopted as chelas or disciples of other GÙs§yis, who make them their heirs by reciprocal arrangement... During their visits to villages, they engage in intrigues, and ribald Gond songs sung at the Holi festival describe the pleasures of the village women at the arrival of a GÙs§yi owing to the sexual gratification they derive from him. Nevertheless they have done much to maintain the Hindu religion, and are the gurus or the spiritual preceptors of the middle and lower castes” (Ananthakrishna Iyer 1930:256–258). 70 “They are, as a rule, of a higher class than the Jogis, and their morality is of a higher order, but scandals about their enticing away the wives of rich Hindus are said to be not infrequent, though generally hushed up. The whole order is in theory devoted to contemplation and abstraction and abstracted from the cares of the world, and a large number of Sanny§sis are actually religious mendicants without wives and without money, who wear ochre-coloured clothes and distribute quack medicines, who refuse to touch a coin or to take in alms more food than will suffice for the day; but there are also many who work in business and are men of great wealth” (Crooke 1896, Vol. 2:274).
16
introduction
rite (see Ch. 3.3), which is theoretically irrevocable, yet there are counter-examples.71 Samanta (1997:115) lists the thirty major castes of Ujjain, which include Gosains. Maclagan (1911:304–305) provides an account of the Gos§Êns of the Punjab and North-West, who are divided into celibates72 and others who “form a separate caste, as well as an order, and are known as Sanni§sÊs or Dasn§mÊs, because they are divided into ten schools...and may be regarded as a semi-secularised offshoot of the Sanni§sÊ order”. Sherring (1879, Vol. 2:339) describes the DowrÊ Gos§vÊs, found in central India, who profess to be Hindu, dress in the ochre robe, have no permanent abode, bury their dead, and who are known to steal crops, thieve and commit highway robberies. They are non-vegetarian, with the exception of beef, and keep weapons ready for use at night. In the west Bengal area, the festival of “ivar§tri is known in many places as g§jan or ghambÊr§. Amongst the votaries of this cult of “iva are bhakta-s known as saÒny§sÊ-s (Sarkar 1972:73–87; Morinis 1984:98–102). These are villagers who, for the week-long duration of the festival—and for up to a month—take temporary vows (vrata) and are initiated (dÊkߧ) into the lineage (gotra) of “iva as saÒny§sÊ-s. They follow preliminary dietary restrictions, are adorned with sectarian marks and shaved. A måla-saÒny§sÊ, who is the chief votary, is also required during celebrations. Those castes participating are often known in west Bengal as saÒny§sÊ-s, though there are no restrictions regarding caste or gender on those taking part, who may be householders with families, and even Muslims in recent times. Maclagan (1911:304–305) describes the saÒny§sÊ gosain-s who settled at K§Øgra and Shimla in Himachal Pradesh (in the foothills of the Himalayas). In some places they became cultivators,73 gradually
71 Reference was earlier made to the Yama-saÒhit§ in this regard. I have also met a number of householders who had previously been saÒny§sÊ-s. 72 The celibates are described as being of one of three kinds: first, the maãhdh§rÊ (‘head of a monastery’), whose dwelling (maãha) is in the village, and who may engage in all worldly pursuits but not marry; second, the §sandh§rÊ (‘someone who has a place’), whose house is on the outskirts of the village; third, the avdhåt (‘someone who wanders about begging’), who does not beg for more than seven hours in one place. Maclagan also claims that the fraternities who live in the maãha-s keep women. 73 Sad§nanda Giri (1976:57–59) comments that, besides celibate gosain-s, there are a large number of gharb§rÊ (i.e. married) gosain-s—who are also religious teachers—in the GaÜhv§l and Kullå areas of the Himalayas where, generally, they either
introduction
17
accumulating much wealth from both trade and usury.74 Maclagan notes that, in theory, the Gos§Êns were celibate and recruited to the order by adopting cel§-s from pure castes who may have been willing to dedicate their sons to them. However, in practice marriage was usual, married Gos§Êns being known as gharb§rÊ, and sons succeeded to the order by becoming cel§-s. At Sirsa, there is a separate caste of gosain-s, founded by “imbu $c§rj, most of whom are either ‘Giri’s or ‘Puri’s.75 Marriage in these Himalayan sub-orders is still usually endogamous.76 Steele, whose information was obtained in N§sik, Maharashtra, also maintains (1868:444) that a gharb§rÊ gosain of the “ten sects” may only marry a female ‘Gosawnee’ if he wishes to remain a gosain.77 Exogamous marriage results in exclusion.78 While
own temples or work in the fields as manual labourers. They are also to be found in Gujarat, where many own their own maãha-s, and also in Maharashtra, where they are very rich and own large properties. Such married gosain-s dress in white, maintaining only the turban in the traditional ochre colour. Their sons and daughters are married within their own society. Married gosain-s are generally regarded as ‘outcaste’ by celibate Daáan§mÊ-s, who do not dine with them. Daáan§mÊ maãha-s and akh§Ü§-s usually have rules expressly forbidding the association of celibate saÒny§sÊ-s with women. 74 “The hill people, including their R§jas and R§n§s, were in their debt and they controlled all the trade between the hills and the plains. In their practice of usury they were rapacious to an incredible degree...To the power of capital they added the influence of their own sanctity and though the Gurkha invasions broke up their dominion they continued to exhaust the resources of the people in the Outer Sar§j tract of Kullu till quite recently. On the other hand the Gos§Êns of K§Øgra, who are principally found in N§daun and Jv§lamukhi, were an enterprising and sagacious community engaged in wholesale trade. They monopolised the trade in opium and speculated in charas, wool and cloth. Their transactions extended to the Deccan and indeed all over India...they are now impoverished” (Maclagan 1911:304–305). 75 The gurus of these lineages were, at that time (1904), presiding over maãha-s in, respectively, B§lak and Kharak, both in Hissar district. 76 The gÜhastha gosain-s of Himachal Pradesh, who are believed to have migrated from Rajasthan, marry within the same order but outside their own gotra (‘lineage’) (for example, a Giri may not marry a PurÊ). Divorce is granted on grounds of adultery, chronic mental sickness, impotency and cruelty, and a male or female divorcee may remarry (Sarkar 1986:245). 77 If a woman born to a gosain fails to marry by the age of seventeen she is obliged to pass her life in celibacy and may not become a disciple. However, once past the age of discretion, she may choose—and is apparently not coerced—to become initiated, which prohibits her from marriage. The natural son of a gosain, born to a woman even of áådra caste, has equal rights to those of an official cel§, after he has been initiated in the usual way. The initiation cannot, however, be performed by the father; the uncle or next nearest relative should officiate. 78 Divorce is said to be permissible only as a consequence of impotency, for-
18
introduction
there are exceptions, most gosain communities enjoy a relatively high caste-status, and are frequently amongst the largest land owners wherever they live.79 Daáan§mÊs, some of whom are married, also serve as priests at many temples throughout India. Samanta (1997:30–31), for example, notes that the most venerated devÊ temple of Ujjain is that of Harsiddhi m§t§, one of the fifty-two “aktipÊãha-s. The priests of the temple are gÜhastha Daáan§mÊs who have served the temple for many generations. At Janakpur in Nepal, near the border of India, a succession of ‘Giri’ mahant-s of the Daáan§mÊs has long managed the R§ma temple, said to have been founded by Catårbhåj Giri (Jha 1978:116–121). However, in general, gosain-s do not perform any priestly functions, most probably as many do not have a Brahman background. In gosain households, the functions of the purohit are generally performed by Brahmans who are not of their order. Also, in distinction from saÒny§sÊ-s, many gÜhastha saÒny§sÊ-s (gosain-s) wear the sacred thread. In some areas of Nepal there are many householder saÒny§sÊ-s, who are recognised in official surveys as being a caste. (In Nepal the term saÒny§sÊ is usually understood to refer to a caste rather than a renunciate, the term yogÊ generally being used to refer to a s§dhu.)80
malised by a divorce document (chor ciããhÊ). Interestingly, a childless wife—who is not a widow—of an absent husband may enter into what is known as a ‘lefthanded/perverse’ (v§m) relationship with another man. However, she is obliged to go back to her husband, should he so desire on return. If the returned husband decides to stay with his wife, he should reimburse the lover for expenses, though he is not obliged to support any illegitimate offspring. Otherwise, the husband may relinquish his wife to the lover, annul the marriage, and receive payment from him. Adultery committed with any woman outside the order results in expulsion. Warden (1847:75) maintains that (female) ‘Gosawunees’ must marry before the age of fifteen; otherwise, without a satisfactory explanation, they are obliged to pass their lives in celibacy. Only in the Deccan are married gosain-s accepted by other Daáan§mÊs. “ådra-s are also said to be recruited in the south. 79 See, for example, Mayer (1960:80). In one (fictitiously identified) village in Madhya Pradesh, out of twenty-five castes, the gosain-s are second only to R§jpåts in terms of land ownership. Bhattacharya (1973:307) also comments on the gÜhastha gosain-s as a very repectable caste. 80 Frank (1974:90) records that in the district of Nawakot, just north of Kathmandu, out of a population of 146,940, comprising twenty-two ethnic groups, the second largest caste—after the Tamangs, constituting 41.4% of the population—are the saÒny§sÊ-s. In the mountainous areas surveyed—which only include a few of the mountainous districts—Giris (one of the lineages of the Daáan§mÊs) numbered 21,816 persons.
introduction
19
A caste of Giris living in central Nepal around sixty miles east of Kathmandu are the subject of studies by Bouillier (1976; 1979). According to local tradition, the ancestor of the caste was N§r§yaÖa Giri, a saÒny§sÊ with a kßatriya background, who came from Banaras and arrived in the village of Kattike at the beginning of the nineteenth century. He married and had children, and up to the mid-1970s there had been seven generations of saÒny§sÊ-s.81 In lifestyle and general culture, the Giris, according to their caste, are typical for the area (Bouillier 1979:32–58). However, they follow two distinctive saÒny§sÊ customs, concerning initiation82 and funeral rites.83 Bouillier (1978) has also examined the Articles of the Nepalese penal codes (Muluki Ain) concerning ascetics, those of 1853,84 1935 and 1963.85 The term j§t is used in two senses in the codes, one
81 Kattike has a population of 2,895, of which there are 335 Giris in thirty-five houses. 90% of the Giris are descended from N§r§yaÖa Giri, and the saÒny§sÊ-s are a dominant caste in the village, in status slightly inferior to Up§dhy§ B§hun (Brahmans) and Cetri (or Kßatri). Over 90% of Giri marriages are within the caste. 17.85% of the Giris are polygamous, all are farmers, and they are non-vegetarian, but with some restrictions. 82 Formal initiation into the caste of Giris is in two stages (see Bouillier (1979:96– 101). The first is the upanayana (bratabandha), which is performed by a Brahman purohit and follows the customary rites for twice-born boys. The second stage is the gurumukha, which is a rite distinctive to the Giris. The gurumukha rite may be before or after marriage, and is performed identically for both boys and girls, who become saÒny§sÊ-s. In Kattike three people are considered ‘guru’ for the men, while there is one woman guru in Kattike for the women. Initiates receive the “ivag§yatrÊ mantra, a trident (triául ), a staff (daÖ·a), fire-tongs (cimã§), a water-pot (kamaÖ·al), a small drum (·amaru), a seed (rudr§kßa) necklace, and Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ sectarian marks. Even though a ritual confirmation of the guru-disciple relationship is enacted, henceforth the guru plays no role in the life of the initiate. If a Giri has not received gurumukha before death, the mantra is whispered into the ear of deceased by the guru and a lock of hair is cut. 83 Technically, the renouncer is automatically liberated at death from the rounds of rebirth, and does not become a spirit or ghost (piá§c), thus freeing his family from the need to feed it. However, the Giris of Kattike observe funeral rites which are similar to those of orthodox householders (Bouillier 1976); see also Parry (1982:84–85); Prasad (1995). 84 Although there were earlier legal codes—notably, those of Jayasthiti Malla (1350–1395) concerning laws applicable to sixty-four castes; and the edicts (incomplete) of R§m “§h of Gorkha (1606–1633)—the Muluki Ain of JaØg Bah§dur R§n§, promulgated in 1853, is the first code to legislate for the whole population of Nepal. 85 In the codes, ascetics are generally referred to either by the Persian term phakÊr, or as bheß dh§rÊ (a wearer of ascetic’s clothes), and specifically as saÒny§sÊ, bair§gÊ, ud§sÊ, jaØgam and seva·§, terms which refer to, repectively, Daáan§mÊ, R§m§nandÊ, Ud§sin (Sikh), VÊraáaiva and Jaina orders.
20
introduction
being ‘caste’ in general (including the particular caste a renunciate previously belonged to), and the other being the order (such as saÒny§sÊ) that the renunciate belongs to. Three categories of ascetics are considered in the code of 1853: ramt§, those always on pilgrimage, who are assumed to be Indian; maãhdh§rÊ-s, who own or reside in a monastery; and gharb§rÊ-s, married ascetics (for whom, in this code, there is less information). All three types of ascetic may initiate disciples, but only maãhdh§rÊ-s and gharb§rÊ-s are subject to the punishments prescribed for transgressions under the code. Trangressing ramt§-s, for nearly all types of offences, are shaved and expelled from the country. The two chief concerns of the legal code are (improper) initiation into the ascetic life (phakirsita mu·inya),86 and (improper) sexual relations. There is also a prohibition on renunciates performing the bratabandha for householders. Concerning sexual relations, the code makes no distinction between ascetic orders and other j§t-s in the general hierarchy of castes, no reference being made to the ascetic tradition or the ideology of renunciation which prohibits sexual relations. The code is not concerned with infraction of celibacy rules, but with infraction of caste rules of association.87 The revised penal code of 1935 contains many of the earlier provisions but also some changes.88 Only two categories of ascetic are mentioned, the
86 To summarise some of the relevant proscriptions and penalties: initiation into renunciation is forbidden to impure castes; if a girl or boy who is under twelve years old should be initiated, then the initiator ( gharb§rÊ or maãhdh§rÊ ) is subject to three years in prison and the confiscation of property (or losing all rights at a maãh); initiation of a girl under sixteen (whether married or a widow) results in a one year prison sentence; no one may be initiated against their will, and an initiator will be punished for doing so; under specified circumstances, one forceably initiated may be readmitted to his or her caste, with appropriate rites. 87 In the hierarchy of castes, at the top are (‘pure’) Up§dhy§ Brahmans, under which, respectively, are •§kuri and R§jpåt, then Jaisi, T§g§dh§ri (kßatri), and Indian Brahmans. In sixth place, regardless of renunciate order, are the aforementioned renunciate j§t-s, ranking just under Jaisi. The bheß dh§rÊ are considered as quite high caste and treated as such according to the law. The code specifies that if a Dasn§m (or another order of ascetics) has sexual relations with a woman of a caste higher than him, then, as a member of any other caste of similar rank, he is subject to punishment, the severity of which depends on the number of women violated, and the age of the girl. The most severe punishment, of ten years in prison, is for sexual relations with a girl under eleven years old. There are also provisions for the punishment of an ascetic who seduces a woman whom he has initiated (Bouillier 1978:141). 88 In general, the code of 1935 is more restrictive, in terms of caste and age, than the previous code concerning eligibility for renunciation; no one under eighteen
introduction
21
ramt§ and the maãhdh§rÊ: the gharb§rÊ is not mentioned.89 In the codes prior to 1963, renunciates were under the direct edicts of the king, who legislated against specific activities. However, that domain of influence only came to bear on the renunciate who had chosen to interefere in the ‘ways of the world’—such as the performance of bratabandha ceremonies for householders—a domain he is supposed to have renounced upon initiation. The enacting of legislation by the king nevertheless indicates the extent to which some practices of renunciates had become prevalent. This brief review indicates that Daáan§mÊ maãha-s are not only the seats of celibate saÒny§sÊ-s,90 and that a distinction between the gosain-s as a ‘caste’ and as a religious sect is not clear. A distinctive characteristic of a religious sect is obviously, but in a sense quite trivially, that the sect members are particularly ‘religious’, of whatever persuasion that may be. But a general survey of various Indian castes would reveal that, like the Daáan§mÊs, many castes trace
years old may be initiated. In this code it is also stated (p. 146) that a husband of a woman initiated into renunciation by a bheß dh§rÊ still has the right to sleep with her, so long as she has not committed adultery, for which appropriate punishments are specified. However, a man of a lower caste who seduces a woman renunciate is liable to punishment. A husband may kill a saÒny§sÊ who seduces his wife, but not if the renunciate is a Brahman (Bouillier 1978:149). 89 The 1963 Muluki Ain contains only one Article concerning ascetics, in contrast to the several contained in the two previous codes. Initiation is still limited to those over eighteen, but there is no mention of of sexual prohibitions (or discriminatory punishments related to the degree of caste-rule violation) nor of a restriction on initiating men and women from lower castes, discrimination concerning caste having been abolished not only for renunciates but for all sections of society. In the new code the justice system only intervenes concerning the initiation of those under age. Bouillier (1978:150) remarks that, “En effet, ce nouveau code, fortement inspiré par les conceptions du droit occidentales, marque une nette rupture avec les codes antérieurs; dorénavant l’accent est mis sur l’individu, en tant que citoyen népalais, et sur l’égalité des droits de tous.” 90 There have been several legal cases in the Bombay area (Kane HD“, Vol. 2:952), wherein it was decreed that a saÒny§sÊ who inherits a maãha, as a disciple of a deceased mahant, does not forfeit his rights to the trusteeship of the property—which is invariably attached to a temple—should he subsequently marry. Bouillier (1997) examines a dispute that first arose in 1923, concerning the rights and property of the Kw§ãhaÖ·o (Baneávar Mah§dev) maãha, a Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ maãha in Bhatgaon, near Kathmandu. The long-running dispute between the Kw§ãhaÖ·o maãha and the state concerned rights to the property and the surrounding fields, but Bouillier discerns that central to the claims of the various protagonists was the issue of whether entitlement to the maãha and its benefits should pass to another saÒny§sÊ or to the son of the mahant.
22
introduction
their ancestry to semi-divine beings, contain sub-castes who often have a relationship with other sub-castes in terms of caste hierarchy and commensality, and who exhibit some features of hierarchical ordering not dissimilar to those of the Daáan§mÊs.91 While a general distinction may be made between married, semi-secularised gosain-s and celibate saÒny§sÊ-s, who do not usually inhabit the same social milieux, it is apparent from current and historical evidence that distinctions between gharb§rÊ gosain and celibate saÒny§sÊ-s become tenuous when the various contexts of the Daáan§mÊs are examined. Whether as a gharb§rÊ gosain or a celibate saÒny§sÊ, the initiate is a member of a community that has complex relations with the rest of society, which in many respects defy the archetype of the ‘lone’ saÒny§sÊ that is presented in ancient Brahmanical texts.
0.3 Sources for this book Of necessity, a wide range of textual (including hagiographic), ethnographic and epigraphic sources are drawn upon throughout this book. The work of many scholars and commentators is utilised in the fields of several of India’s religious traditions, and in particular periods of the history of South Asia. Many of the insights presented in this study are not novel; however, the drawing together of research from such a wide range of areas has enabled a tentative reconstruction of the historical formation of an identity for the Daáan§mÊs. Nearly all the available ethnographic accounts of the Daáan§mÊs have been consulted, including travel accounts from the Mughal period, British Government reports from the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries, and contemporary sources. A number of Hindi publications are availed of, which provide details of the organisation, structure and mantras of the Daáan§mÊs. Some of these publications usually only circulate amongst Daáan§mÊ initiates, and I am very grateful to the s§dhu-s who made these available. Research was further informed by fieldwork conducted in 2001 and 2002.92
91 Gnanambal (1973:199), for example, observes how some of the castes of south India have substituted Sanskritic names for low-caste names, tracing their mythological origin to ancestors like S§gara, V§lmÊki and Jambava. 92 Thanks to generous grants from research organisations, I was able to attend
introduction
23
An ethnographic overview of the Daáan§mÊs is presented in Chapters 1 and 2, considering the subdivisions, hierarchies, caste and functionary positions within the order. The Daáan§mÊ order has two main wings, one being what might be called the monastic tradition, represented by the daÖ·Ê-s, who are ‘staff-carrying’ saÒny§sÊ-s, the preeminent representatives of this tradition being the reigning “aÖkar§c§ryas. The other main wing within the order is represented by paramahaÒsa ascetics and (previously) militant n§g§-s93 (‘fighting ascetics’), the latter being organised in quasi-military divisions known as akh§Ü§-s (‘wrestling ring’). While considerable use has been made of the work of other scholars in the ethnographic domain, fieldwork has yielded many details of the organisation of the Daáan§mÊs, some of which were not previously apparent, particularly concerning the hierarchies and organisation of the akh§Ü§-s. The rites of renunciation and initiation are analysed in Chapter 3. References are made to the Dharmasåtra-s, the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s and several mediaeval texts on renunciation. What is not apparent from a reading of dharmaá§stra texts—on which commentators on the Daáan§mÊ tradition generally rely for their understanding of saÒny§sa—is that initiation into the Daáan§mÊs via an akh§Ü§ transpires in two stages. The first is the pañc-guru-saÒsk§r, wherein the neophyte acquires five gurus. The second stage of initiation is the performance of the saÒny§sa rite, usually performed at a Kumbh Mel§, which brings together the two wings of the Daáan§mÊ order, with their own lineages, which generally have little contact with each other. Both the monastic and militant wings supply preceptors for the
the Kumbh Mel§ in 2001, and the M§gh Mel§ in 2002, both held at Allahabad (for details of the Kumbh Mel§, see Appendix 3). These mel§-s (‘festivals’) being the preeminent calendar event for the Daáan§mÊs, it was particularly convenient for conducting interviews (in Hindi and English) and lengthy inquiries into the hierarchies, lifestyles and organisation of the various branches of the Daáan§mÊs. I was also able to inspect various Hindi publications found in libraries in Banaras, and others kindly provided by Daáan§mÊs from maãha-s and akh§Ü§-s in Allahabad, Banaras and Haridv§r. I also attended Kumbh Mel§s at Allahabad (1986), Haridv§r (1989) and Ujjain (1992). Between 1982 and 1996 I also spent around seven years visiting Hindu holy places (a total of around 250 religious complexes) in nearly all states of India, on several occasions travelling with s§dhu-s of various orders on pilgrimage, particularly to holy places in the Himalayas, where more than 2,000 miles were covered on foot. 93 From the Hindi naØg§, meaning ‘naked’.
24
introduction
performance of the saÒny§sa rite. A third initiation rite is performed for saÒny§sÊ-s who wish to become n§g§-s. A series of short Sanskrit texts are the main source and focus of Chapter 4. Generally known as (“rÊ) Maãh§mn§ya-s,94 these texts were supposedly, but improbably, written by “aØkar§c§rya. In the Maãh§mn§ya-s, amongst other details, the ten Daáan§mÊ names are specified and attached to one of the four maãha-s putatively put under the direct charge of “aØkara’s four main disciples. It is apparent that the information in the Maãh§mn§ya-s provides the primary framework within which Daáan§mÊ identity is constituted, as no other textual or epigraphic source supplies the crucial details pertinent to the constitution and emic history of the order. The information in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, representing the locus of popular understanding of Daáan§mÊ history, is consequently central to the transmission of Daáan§mÊ tradition, though it is argued that these texts are most probably not more than three or four hundred years old. The well-known claims of the tradition regarding the founding of four maãha-s and the organisation of a sect of saÒny§sÊ-s are contrasted with historical evidence and some legal judgements, revealing numerous maãha-s all over India which have at times claimed to be founded by “aØkara, and casting some doubt on the notion that “aØkara founded any maãha. The main sources for Chapter 5 are the hagiographies of “aØkara. Use has been made of the work of Antarkar and Bader (see Bibliography), two scholars who have worked extensively on these texts. “aØkara’s own works are also examined, illustrating that “aØkara was almost certainly a vaißÖava, and not a áaiva as projected in the hagiographic tradition. An examination of the twenty or so extant hagiographic works reveals that the first mention of four maãha-s appears briefly in Cidvil§sa’s “aØkaravijaya-vil§sa, produced most probably in the late sixteenth or seventeenth century. However, no mention is made of the founding of any maãha in the most popular of “aØkara’s hagiographies, the “aØkara-dig-vijaya attributed to M§dhava, written, at the earliest, in 1650. Further, no reference to “aØkara’s founding of the Daáan§mÊ order of ascetics is to be found in any of “aØkara’s genuine works, or hagiographic texts. 94 These texts, also variously known as Maãh§mn§ya-stotra, Maãh§mn§ya-setu, MaãhetivÜtta, Maãh§mn§yaá§sanam and Mah§nuá§sanam are contained, together with translation, in Appendix 2.
introduction
25
References to the term daáan§mÊ appear to occur first in a couple of late mediaeval texts on renunciation, also produced, at the earliest, in the late sixteenth century. Within the Hindu religious tradition generally, and the Daáan§mÊ world specifically, “aØkara is intimately associated with the advaita maãha at “ÜØgerÊ (in south Karnataka) which he supposedly founded. In Chapter 6, a detailed examination is undertaken of political and religious developments during the period of the Vijayanagara empire, which flourished in south India between the fourteenth and sixteenth centuries. The work of eminent historians of the period is availed of, supplemented by epigraphic research. It is argued that in the midfourteenth century, the early Vijayanagara rulers patronised what was, essentially, a ‘new’ orthodox áaiva advaita tradition, though this had little to do with “aØkara, who appears to have been relatively unknown in this period. In the image of their áaiva royal patrons, “aØkara’s hagiographers subsequently projected “aØkar§c§rya as an incarnation of “iva who vanquished heresy and reinvigorated the orthodox Brahmanical tradition. This established “aØkara’s reputation as a great áaiva, even though it is apparent he and his immediate disciples were vaißÖava-s. As already mentioned, even the hagiographic tradition does not mention the founding of an order of Daáan§mÊ ascetics. If “aØkara did not found the Daáan§mÊs, then an explanation is needed as to how the sect came into existence. The final layer of the argument presented in this study, in Chapter 7, explores the context in which a Daáan§mÊ identity may have formed. A variety of sources show that between around the mid-sixteenth century and the end of the seventeenth century a number of groups of radical militant ascetics from N§th, Sikh-related and (nascent) ‘Hindu’ orders—including what was to become the militant division of the Daáan§mÊs—became organised in military units (akh§Ü§-s), largely as a consequence of state patronage. Relying on the work of specialists in Islam, the development of SåfÊ sects and lineages in India are explored in respect of their influential relationship with the dominant Islamicate orders of north India in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries. It will be seen how the organisation of SåfÊ lineages mirrors, in several important aspects, parallel features of Daáan§mÊ organisation. This analysis tends towards the supposition that influential SåfÊ institutions may possibly have provided both a contributory template and a political rationale for the organisation of the Daáan§mÊs, and the formation
26
introduction
of a distinct identity for an order of saÒny§sÊ-s; even though this cannot be conclusively demonstrated. In the formation of what is argued is a newly created identity, diverse lineages pertaining to both radical militant ascetics and advaita monastic traditions were merged into one order that gained its orthodox legitimacy from its putative inception by “aØkara. The integration of the two wings of the Daáan§mÊs—the n§g§ and monastic traditions—is apparent in initiation procedures. The sharing of common religious practices and sectarian markers, the identification with a distinct (advaita) philosophy, and the adoption of a common mythology—as reflected in the most popular hagiographies of “aØkara and in the maãh§mn§ya-s—provide the substance for the identification of the Daáan§mÊs as a distinct sect. Although some Daáan§mÊ lineages may stretch back indeterminately, it is argued that particular political processes most probably impelled the formation of an identity for the Daáan§mÊs, resulting in the dissemination of the frame-structure of the maãh§mn§ya-s and the integration within one sect of disparate lineages of ascetics. It is possible that traditionalists might not only disagree with some of the findings of this research but also suspect that the author may have had something like Paraáur§ma’s axe to grind in the deconstruction of oriental saints (such as “aØkara), Hindu tradition or Indian history. However, the author is aware of the extent to which not only religious but also social history has been ‘invented’ in practically all periods of human history in the service of various ideologies.95 Even a cursory investigation into hagiography and constructions of various social and religious histories frequently illustrates broadly common processes in a variety of socio-political contexts.96 If we consider Ireland in the seventh century CE (approximately the time of “aØkara), it has been remarked that, “By and large, each dynasty had its own saint, its own foundation, on a principle resembling the
95 In this regard, the popular work of Hobsbawm and Ranger (1983) might be mentioned in connection with some British traditions. This collection of learned articles illustrates the ‘invention’ of several ancient traditions, including: the kiltwearing Highland tradition of Scotland (Hugh Trevor-Roper); the rediscovery of some ‘ancient’ (but, in fact, non-authentic) Welsh traditions in the eighteenth century (Prys Morgan); and the involving of royalty in British parliamentary procedure (David Cannadine). 96 For studies in Indian hagiography, see Snell (1994); Granoff (1984,1988a,1988b); Schober (1997).
introduction
27
Continental eigenkloster...Very clearly, the saints’ lives, as propaganda for the power and influence of their subjects, had a crucial role to play in aggrandizing specific monastic centres at (inevitably) the expense of others” (Stevenson 1995:25). Such remarks would be entirely appropriate to the discussion concerning the Indian monastic tradition, “aØkara and his Vijayanagara hagiographers (presented in Chapter 6). A final but important rider to the discussion is the consideration that the Daáan§mÊs and others who find their way into this book— whether as mendicants, mahant-s, mercenaries, scholars, philosophers, political envoys, traders, raiders, property-owners or bankers—are those who by their actions have found their way into history. Those who live more closely to the ideals of saÒny§sa—as lone renunciates undergoing austerities, far removed from worldly, economic and political life—and who constitute a significant proportion of saÒny§sÊ-s, leave little, if any, trace in history; perhaps just the proverbial and barely perceptible smoke of a fire on a hill. A kind of paradox is implicit in attempting to reconstruct the history of a renunciate movement from accounts of those who have left historical traces: perhaps the true history of saÒny§sa would be simply an almost empty account.
28
chapter one
CHAPTER ONE
BRANCHES OF THE DA“AN$M^ ORDER In this chapter, the overall structure of the Daáan§mÊs is introduced from a contemporary anthropological perspective, examining the branches and customs of the sect in its constitution as an order of nominally celibate s§dhu-s. Although there are traditional Brahmanical restrictions that deny women the option of taking saÒny§sa and renouncing, it is evident that amongst Daáan§mÊs and some other renunciate sects there is a significant number of women renunciates. Also briefly considered in this chapter is the issue of sectarian identity within the South Asian context, and the ramifications within recent Daáan§mÊ history.
1.1 The Daáan§mÊ sect, as currently constituted, in relation to other renunciate sects As noted in the Introduction, there are three subdivisions of the Daáan§mÊs,1 namely: 1) the daÖ·Ê-s, who carry a staff (daÖ·a); 2) the paramahaÒsa-s; and 3) the n§g§-s (sometimes referred to as astradh§rÊ-s, ‘weapon-holders’), who belong to one of the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s (‘wrestling rings’ or ‘military formations’).2 DaÖ·Ê-s may be recognised by the daÖ·a that they carry, a stick that may be plain or embellished and which usually has a piece of saffron cloth wrapped around it, under which is tied an axe-head and the sacred thread.3 Unlike daÖ·Ê-s, paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s do not carry the mendicant’s staff.4 Although
1 See also Ghurye (1964); Tripathi (1978); Sinha and Saraswati (1978); Dazey (1990). 2 See Ch. 2.1 3 Many daÖ·Ê-s carry either a small liØga or a á§lagr§ma. “§lagr§ma-s are ammonites found in two or three places in the bed of the K§lÊ GaÖ·aki river in eastern Nepal, which are one of the most important emblems of VißÖu. They occur in as many as eighty-nine varieties, each type having a symbolic significance (see Ramachandra Rao 1997). 4 A staff is acquired by paramahaÒsa-s during the saÒny§sa rite, but it is subsequently discarded (see Ch. 3.3).
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
29
the tripartite division of daÖ·Ê, paramahaÒsa and n§g§ is recognised within the Daáan§mÊ order, the foremost means of self-classification is primarily in terms of the parampar§ of the initiating guru, in one of the ten lineages5 supposedly deriving from “aØkar§c§rya. All the three branches of the Daáan§mÊs have a large network of maãha-s, spread throughout India, though most concentrated in north India, particulary in Banaras, Allahabad and Haridv§r. Most of even the largest §árama-s and maãha-s began as a simple dwelling of a s§dhu who had ceased travelling and settled, frequently after many years of pilgrimage to holy places6 throughout the Indian subcontinent.7 Several scholars provide a general overview of around sixty sects of s§dhu-s8 functioning in India in the last decades of the twentieth century.9 The greatest concentration of s§dhu-s, both now and for the last three or four hundred years, is to be found in north India, particularly in the state of Uttar Pradesh. The three largest sects of s§dhu-s are the vaißÖava R§m§nandÊs and the áaiva sects of N§ths and Daáan§mÊs.10 There are currently, perhaps, around one hundred thou-
5 Amongst the daÖ·Ê-s, the names used are TÊrtha, $árama and SarasvatÊ. Some few are called Bh§ratÊ. Amongst the n§g§-s of today, the names attributed are Giri, PurÊ, Bh§ratÊ and SarasvatÊ, though not all saÒny§sÊ-s with that name are n§g§. AraÖyas are rare, while Vanas, S§garas and Parvatas have practically disappeared. 6 Many saÒny§sÊ-s (including the akh§Ü§-s) begin the year at the mel§ (in January) at GaØg§ S§gar, east of Calcutta. Proceeding west, Paáupatin§th and Banaras are popular for “ivar§tri (in February/March), after which many follow the GaØg§ to tÊrtha-s in the Himalayas, for the summer. Autumn and winter are the seasons when saÒny§sÊ-s may go south, occasionally visiting some of the twelve jyotir-liØgam-s en route, finally reaching R§meávaram and Kany§ KumarÊ. 7 Before the introduction of passports in the early twentieth century, some s§dhu-s also travelled widely in Central Asia and the Middle East. See Duncan (1799) for a saÒny§sÊ who went to Russia and the Middle-East. See Bennett (1965) for an account of a saÒny§sÊ who walked right round the world. 8 Some of these sects also have a substantial lay community. 9 Sinha and Saraswati’s (1978:51) study was based in Banaras; Tripathi’s (1978:156) study conducted in Uttar Pradesh. Tripathi was initiated into both Daáan§mÊ (áaiva) and Nimb§rkÊ (vaißÖava) sects (samprad§ya-s) and conducted sociological fieldwork over several years during the late 1960s and 1970s. Samanta’s (1997:49–52) study was conducted in Ujjain. See Appendix 1 for lists of sects. 10 According to Tripathi’s survey of a relatively small sample of 500 s§dhu-s, the two largest sects are the Daáan§mÊ and K§nphaãa (N§th), each of which comprises around 12% of the s§dhu population. According to Tripathi, the next largest sect is the R§m§nandÊ (6.6%). However, van der Veer (1998:xiii) believes that the R§m§nandÊ sect has become the largest monastic order of North India. Sinha and Saraswati’s research (1978:51) revealed that in Banaras—the main stronghold of “aivism in India—the two largest ascetic sects are the Daáan§mÊ and the R§m§nandÊ
30
chapter one
sand Daáan§mÊ s§dhu-s in South Asia.11 Examples of female ascetics and renunciates in ancient India were referred to in the Introduction, and census reports from the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries reveal that women saÒny§sin-s12 then constituted up to forty percent orders, the Daáan§mÊs having 610 initiates and the R§m§nandÊs 253. Statistics on s§dhu-s are notoriously hard to obtain, because where records are kept in maãha-s and akh§Ü§-s, information is rarely divulged. 11 Hartsuiker (1993:122) gives a figure of five million for the number of s§dhu-s, without, however, citing a source for that estimate. If that figure were approximately accurate it would indicate that s§dhu-s, at the time of writing, would have constituted just under 0.5% of the population of India, which at the time was around 930 million. Crooke (1896, Vol. 2: 261) cites the Punjab report of 1891, which lists the number of Daáan§mÊ Gosains in forty-six places in north-west India, most of which are now in the state of Uttar Pradesh. 103,320 Daáan§mÊs are recorded, of whom 55,347 are male, and 47,973 are female. The total population of the province in 1891 is recorded as 46,905,085 (1896, Vol. 1: clix) of whom 623,506 are ‘Fakir’. According to these figures, Daáan§mÊs would have constituted approximately 16% of the renunciate population of north-west India and 0.23% of the general population. These figures are not so different from the estimates arrived at for the percentages of Daáan§mÊs in relationship to other sects but would indicate a figure of approximately one half that of the figure estimated previously for the entire renunciate population. Briggs (1982:4–6) made a useful, if somewhat disorganised, survey of Government Census statistics concerning ‘Jogis’, ‘FaqÊrs’ and ‘Mendicants’. The census returns for 1901 (Census of India, Vol. 1, part 2, Tables, pp. 283, 288, 301) enumerate 436,803 Hindu FaqÊrs; 659,891 Hindu JogÊs; 43,139 Muhammadan JogÊs; 45,463 Hindu N§ths (K§nphaãa). This makes a total of 1,185,296 ascetics. According to the census, the population of India was at that time around 200 million, so ascetics would have constituted around 0.5% of the Indian population, a similar figure reached above by rough calculation for today. If Tripathi’s (1978:156) figure of 12% is accurate for the percentage of s§dhu-s who are Daáan§mÊs, and if we assume that the relative percentages of members belonging to the different sects remains approximately the same (even if the total number of s§dhu-s has declined since the time of Tripathi’s work in the early 1970s), then the total number of Daáan§mÊ s§dhu-s would these days be around 600,000. However, this figure seems too high. An indicator of the possible size of the Daáan§mÊ population would be the fact that at the Ujjain Kumbh Mel§ in 1992, the Jån§ akh§Ü§, one of the largest sub-branches of the sect, initiated around 3,000 new saÒny§sÊ-s (Hartsuiker 1993:64). Bedi and Bedi (1991:85) comment that over 2,500 s§dhu-s were initiated into the Jån§ akh§Ü§ at the 1989 Kumbh Mel§ at Allahabad. Nearly all initiations into all branches of the Daáan§mÊs, through the saÒny§sa rite, are performed at the Kumbh Mel§s at Haridv§r, Pray§ga (Allahabad) or Ujjain, over a periodic cycle of (almost) twelve years. If, at a rough guess, bearing in mind the relative sizes of the sub-branches of the Daáan§mÊs, perhaps 7,000 or 8,000 men take saÒny§sa in total on each occasion, then every twelve years there would be around 20,000 to 25,000 new Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s. Given an average lifespan of sixty or seventy years, a figure of around 100,000 would be reached. 12 Hindi: saÒny§sin; the term is Sanskritised by some commentators as saÒny§sinÊ, though this term is rarely used in classical sources.
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
31
of both the general s§dhu13 and Daáan§mÊ populations in certain regions of India. These days, however, women saÒny§sin-s, who are usually referred to as m§Ê or m§t§-jÊ, may constitute perhaps between approximately two and ten percent of both the general s§dhu and Daáan§mÊ populations.14 Although there are still a significant number of women ascetic renunciates in South Asia, there are very few orders where the guru-parampar§ is handed down from woman to woman.15 Most of the orders and maãha-s that comprise women are dependent on male preceptors, who in several instances are Daáan§mÊs. There have been several studies of Hindu women saints, some of whom are ascetics,16 though relatively few devoted to female Hindu renunciates.17 Caplan (1973) describes a small group of Daáan§mÊ m§Ê-s, all Giris, living in Duari in western Nepal. In this area most ascetics are unmarried women, saÒny§sÊ-s usually being a settled caste, only distinguished from other castes of a similar rank by particular customs of initiation and funeral rites.18 In the village of Duari, besides the women ascetics, there were twenty-eight Giris (2.2% of the village population) at the time of the study, in 1969. The m§Ê-s of Duari live together in a monastery (kuãÊ) which has a temple of
13
Female s§dhu-s are also referred to as s§dhvÊ. Table XVII of the Imperial Census of India for 1931, cited by Briggs (1982:4–6), shows, under the heading of AghorÊ, FaqÊr, S§dhu and Sanny§sÊ, a total of more than one million persons. According to the Censuses of 1901 and 1931, women constituted approximately 40% of the wandering ascetic population. Modern commentators, for example Denton (1981:212) and Hartsuiker (1993:62), give an estimated figure of 10%, or just under, for female ascetics, many of whom are widowed. Denton’s estimate is derived from a sample of 1,300 ascetics in Banaras, of whom 130 are girls or women. Sinha and Saraswati’s (1978) general survey of 1284 s§dhu-s in Banaras included 97 women (i.e. approximately one in twelve). However, it has been pointed out to me that estimates based on urban surveys may be significantly higher than surveys would reveal for India as a whole, which might indicate a much lower percentage of female renunciates than the 10% derived for Banaras. 15 Ramaswamy (1992:134) briefly mentions an example of a female preceptor: Ven§b§Ê, a disciple of Samartha R§mad§sa (17th century), became head of a maãha at Mir§j (in Karnataka). Also, it seems that the followers of the saint MÊr§b§Ê (15th/16th century) once constituted a sect of ‘MÊr§b§Ês’. See Sethi (1979) and Alston (1980c) for brief resumés of MÊr§b§Ê’s life. 16 See Ramanujan (1973:111–142; 1982); Gupta (1991); Ramaswamy (1992; 1997). Very few women saints married, and almost all were initiated by males. 17 For the position of (women) s§dhvÊ-s/ár§vik§-s within Jainism, see Jaini (1991); Sh§nt§ (1997); Balbir (2002); Vallely (2002). 18 One such caste of saÒny§sÊ-s is discussed in the Introduction (see Bouillier 1976; 1979). 14
32
chapter one
Bhairava. They survive by begging, donations, on the produce of the attached land, and sometimes by lending out money or grain. The head m§Ê is usually the guru for the other ascetics, her status being determined not by age but by how long she had been resident in the kuãÊ.19 [Clémentin-] Ojha has published several studies of women s§dhvÊ-s in Banaras, the first (1981) being of forty-five individual women ascetics, another (1984)20 examining three communities of female saÒny§sin-s in Banaras, most of whom are Bengalis. Two are communities of Nimb§rkÊs21 (also known as the nÊm§vat or Sanakasamprad§ya),22 the “obh§ M§ and GaØg§ M§.23 Around a dozen women ascetics live at an §árama which “obh§ M§ founded in 1950. The third community is of followers of $nanda MayÊ M§24 who live at the Kany§ PÊãha, founded in 1926. The women of the three communities live communally in maãha-s, under the guide of female preceptors,25 and dedicate part of their time to teaching in various schools. Traditionally, the orthodox Nimb§rkÊ order denies renunciation to women, so they undergo an initiation ceremony that contains fewer syllables of the sacred mantra than either householders (lay
19
Similar to the settled saÒny§sÊ castes of Nepal, the women are not of Brahman caste, but the slightly inferior Jaisi caste. Despite being saÒny§sin-s, caste still operates amongst the women, in terms of commensality, purity and pollution (p. 181). They were initiated between the ages of nine and thirty-five, two of them being daughters of ascetics. Some had become ascetics due to marriage problems, and one was widowed. 20 See also Clémentin-Ojha (1985; 1988). 21 Followers of Nimb§rka, the twelfth/thirteenth century vaißÖava bhakta, who was born in Bellary, Karnataka, but spent most of his life in the VÜnd§van/Mathur§ area; his philosophical system is dvait§dvaita, ‘difference-in-non-difference’. 22 One of the four vaißÖava samprad§ya-s (see Ch. 2.1, fn. 7). 23 Both “obha M§ and GaØg§ M§ were initiated by a Bengali, Sv§mÊ Santad§s K§ãhÊy§ B§b§ (Clémentin-Ojha 1988:WS-34). 24 A mystic (1896–1982) born in Kheo·§, East Bengal. See Lipski (1977); Ray (1983). 25 Clémentin-Ojha also presents (1985) four female ‘gurus’ (a term for which there is no exact equivalent in Sanskrit for females, owing to their traditional ineligibility to perform that role; though the term guruÖÊ is used for a woman guru amongst Jainas, see Sh§nt§ 1997:189). The female gurus (who are generally referred to as ‘M§t§jÊ’) are from the Daáan§mÊ, R§m§nandÊ, Nimb§rka and Vallabha samprad§ya-s. All were initiated by male preceptors. After $nanda MayÊ M§’s demise, “obh§ M§ became the most important female guru in Banaras, with around 1,000 disciples. The female guru from the Vallabha samprad§ya, “§rad§vallabh§ BeãÊ-jÊ, runs a temple and an educational institution, and can perform initiation (dÊkߧ) into the sect.
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
33
followers) or male renunciates (virakta). The order of $nanda MayÊ M§ is ‘heterodox’—having a woman as preceptor—yet the women are initiated by male Daáan§mÊ priests, under the name of $nanda MayÊ M§ (Ojha 1984:208). It is believed that, during the ceremony, the áakti of $nanda MayÊ M§ is transmitted to the initiate, who becomes a disciple of the guru. The women become brahmac§riÖÊ but are not fully ‘saÒny§sinÊ ’ as they do not perform the second stage of initiation, the viraj§-homa.26 Nevertheless, the saÒny§sin-s have a higher status than lay followers. While generally dressed in the typical garb of a s§dhu, women renouncers do not usually wear any jewelry, as one of the signs of their renunciation. Sinclair-Brull (1997) and King (1984:75–79) provide accounts of the nuns of the “rÊ “§rad§ Maãha, and those of the R§makÜßÖa “§rad§ Mission,27 organisations that run parallel to, but function independently, of the R§makÜßÖa Mission.28 King (1984:79–81) also discusses several branch-orders of the relatively few women ascetics in other sects, those of the Sv§mÊ N§r§yaÖ, S§Ê B§b§ of “Êrdi, Brahm§ Kum§rÊs,29 and LiØg§yats.30 C. S. J. White (1989) describes
26
See Ch. 3. The “rÊ “§rad§ Maãh, the largest of these female orders, was founded in 1954, and in 1981 had six centres, at Madras, Trichur, PåÖe, Bangalore, Banaras and Haridv§r. Women must be over thirty years old to be initiated into the order; novitiate (brahmac§riÖÊ ) vows may be taken after two years, and the full saÒny§sa rite of renunciation after another five years. Then, (theoretically) irrespective of previous caste affiliations, the women initiates may perform Vedic rites. Founded in 1960, the R§makÜßÖa “§rad§ Mission (a sister institution) has eight more branches (five in Bengal, one each in Delhi, Arunachal Pradesh and Kerala). In 1981 it had 170 monastic members (King 1984:78). See McDaniel (1995) for a profile of a Bengali saÒny§sinÊ, Arcan§ M§ (b.1928) of the R§makÜßÖa order, who has a large §árama in Calcutta, inherited, unusually, from her male guru. 28 R§makÜßÖa himself initiated a woman named GaurÊ M§ (d.1938), who became a renunciate and founded an §árama for women’s education in 1895 in Calcutta. It came to diverge in ethos from the R§makÜßÖa Mission, becoming orthodox in terms of caste and rites, and establishing a line of ascetic female initiates succeeding GaurÊ M§. Another §árama (first called M§tÜ Mandir and then “§rad§ Mandir) was opened by Sudhira Basu (d.1920) in 1914 for women to practice renunciation. The §árama was under the authority of the R§makÜßÖa Mission until 1963. Vivek§nanda also seems to have initiated several women, but only through mantra. Proper saÒny§sa was not given to women until 1947, in the first western Ved§nta convent, founded in Hollywood in 1940 (King 1984:77–78). 29 See Babb (1984) for comment on the role of women in the Brahm§ Kum§rÊs. 30 The few female ascetics of the Sv§mÊ N§r§yaÖ order are called S§Òkhya YoginÊs; they live in a separate temple and follow their own guru. “rÊ Up§sanÊ 27
34
chapter one
daráan (‘vision/spiritual presence’) and an interview with Her Holiness Sadguru “rÊ Jñ§n§nandasarasvatÊ of Madras, a woman who was previously married, raising five children. She renounced the world, most unusually taking saÒny§sa personally from the “aØkar§c§rya of K§ñcÊpuram, the first time he had performed the saÒny§sa rite for a woman. More recently, Khandelwal (2004) recounts the life of several female renouncers, focussing mainly on two female Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sinÊ-s, $nand M§t§ and B§ÊjÊ, both of whom run §árama-s in Haridv§r.31 While the Daáan§mÊ paramahaÒsa subdivision has some female ascetics, there are fewer amongst the daÖ·Ê-s and very few who are n§g§.32 Amongst the akh§Ü§-s there is only one order of m§Ê-s, who are affiliated to the Jån§ akh§Ü§,33 the largest of the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s. While most of the women come from eastern Nepal or the adjacent Kumaun district of Uttaranchal, some few come from West Bengal. They have their own Mah§maÖ·aleávara (similar to an abbot),34 and the current mahant of the m§Ê-s is MÊr§m PurÊ. Around eight hundred m§Ê-s attended the 2001 Allahabad Kumbh Mel§,
B§b§, a disciple of S§Ê B§b§, founded a nunnery, the Kany§ Kum§rÊ Sth§n in Maharashtra, in either 1917 or 1932, another branch being subsequently established in N§gpur. The women study and perform Vedic sacrifices. In 1940, the Brahm§ Kum§rÊs §árama for women ascetics was founded in Sindh. The founding ethos of female asceticism has been replaced by §árama-s catering for both men and women. In 1966, aged twenty, Mathe Mah§devÊ took saÒny§sa, to become the first female jagadguru of the LiØg§yats, a áaiva sect founded in the twelfth century in Karnataka. The Vishva Kalyan Mission was established in Bangalore (and then Hubli and DharwaÜ), where women ascetics live (King 1984:79–81). See also Llewellyn (1995) for a profile of another female renouncer, MÊr§m (b.1929), who was from an $rya Sam§j family background, and wrote an autobiography, subsequent to renouncing in 1979. 31 $nand M§t§ is said to have been initiated by a “prominent swami” (p. 49), and B§ÊjÊ by a Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ (p. 80). 32 See below for the daÖ·Ê, paramahaÒsa and n§g§ branches of the Daáan§mÊs. 33 Even though the other akh§Ü§-s do not generally admit women, Sinha and Saraswati (1978:98) note that at one time the [Mah§]Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ had a female ascetic raised to the position of Mah§maÖ·aleávara, causing a boycott by the other akh§Ü§-s. Sinha and Saraswati (1978:68) report the presence in Banaras of two female ascetics who are members of the daÖ·Ê subdivision of the Daáan§mÊs. One was residing with her male counterparts (gurubh§Ê-s) in the DakßiÖamårti maãha, and the other, GaurÊ M§, was a mahant who had succeeded the gaddÊ of the Påran§nanda Sv§mÊ $árama maãha. She was the only resident ascetic. 34 See Ch. 2.4 for an account of their role in the Daáan§mÊs.
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
35
camping in an area adjacent to the camp of the Jån§ akh§Ü§.35 During the M§gh Mel§, in January 2002, as per custom, many women camped alongside men in the daÖ·Ê camps. This is in sharp distinction to practices in the akh§Ü§-s where there are usually no women, except in the case of the Jån§ akh§Ü§ which has a separate camping area for the women saÒny§sin-s. Daáan§mÊs usually refer to only themselves as saÒny§sÊ-s, distinguishing themselves from other sects of s§dhu-s who generally refer to themselves by their sectarian names, as for example, N§th (K§nphaãa), Ud§sin (Sikh-affiliated), Bair§gÊ/Vair§gÊ (R§m§nandÊ), et cetera. S§dhu-s are typically dressed so as to indicate, in some manner, their sectarian affiliation. SaÒny§sÊ-s usually wear orange, ochre, saffron, or salmon-coloured cloth, the traditional colour of the saÒny§sÊ. Sectarian affiliation is also shown by the kind of necklace (m§l§) worn,36 and often more distinctively by sectarian marks that adorn the face and body. Hair may be shaven, short, long, or in dreadlocks (jaã§) but, unlike the custom in some other s§dhu sects, the top-knot (coãÊ) is not worn by the Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs. It is removed during initiation, as is the sacred thread (janeå) if it was previously worn,37 as a sign that the saÒny§sÊ has renounced his right to perform sacrifices.38 While Daáan§mÊs usually apply the tripuÖ·ra (or tripuÖ·) to the forehead, a sectarian mark of three parallel lines of holy ashes (vibhåtÊ), it is usually only n§g§-s who cover the body entirely with ashes. The equipment carried by itinerant Daáan§mÊ s§dhu-s usually consists of fire-tongs (ciÒt§), blankets, sometimes a deer or tiger skin, a water-
35 The author spent three weeks in October 1987 living with a female initiate of the Jån§ akh§Ü§ at her roadside shelter near Barkot, in GaÜhv§l, Uttaranchal. Her husband had died some years previously in a road accident and she had taken saÒny§sa. She was well respected locally and her brother helped her with many practical affairs. She died in 1995. 36 VaißÖava-s wear tulsÊ beads, which are beads carved from the wood of a basil plant (ocimum sanctum) which grows all over the subcontinent. “aiva-s wear rudr§kßa seeds, which come from a tree (elaeocarpus ganitrus) that grows mostly in Nepal. Necklaces and bracelets usually comprise 108 seeds, but may also be worn singly or in other numbers. Accounts of the properties, associated mantras and significance of the number of segments vary considerably and may be found in several texts, including: “iva Pur§Öa (Vidyeávara SaÒhit§); Padma Pur§Öa (ch. 57); “rimaddevÊbhagavat (11th Skandha, ch. 3–7); Rudr§kßaj§bala Upanißad. See Rai (1993a); Majupuria (1982:223). 37 DaÖ·Ê-saÒny§sÊ-s keep the janeå concealed under a cloth that is attached to their daÖ·a. 38 This is in distinction from the practice of the vaißÖava R§m§nandÊs who maintain the top-knot after initiation, and may still perform sacrifices.
36
chapter one
pot (kamaÖ·al) made from coconut,39 wood or metal, sometimes a trident (triáål), and a small bag ( jholÊ) for a few belongings such as religious pamphlets, identity papers, money, holy ash, soap, and for members of some akh§Ü§-s, smoking materials. The ancient notion of tapas/tapasy§ (√tap, ‘heat’), to be found in the Œg Veda, is that austerities (tapas)—particularly celibacy—produce a kind of internal heat40 that is associated with spiritual and creative powers, and in the later context of the Pur§Öa-s, liberation.41 While most Daáan§mÊs periodically perform limited regimens of austerity (tapas/tapasy§), such as taking a vow (vrata) to fast on a particular day or during a certain period,42 or of limiting their diet,43 some few also perform haãha-yoga postures. A few s§dhu-s practise more radical forms of tapasy§, not infrequently for a period of twelve years.44 There is a
39 The most sought kind of coconut used is the extra large variety from the Seychelle Islands. 40 On tapas in a Vedic context, see Knipe (1975); Kaelber (1989). 41 The acquisition of power, through tapas, is also used for immoral purposes. Historically, tapas is not essentially related to ethics, and its association with ‘penance’ is misleading (see Rüping 1977). In the Veda-s and Br§hmaÖa-s, tapas is characterised—broadly—as heat, poetic inspiration, and the life-force born through the power of tapas, while in the Mah§bh§rata (MBh 1.25.10–18; 1.101.25; 1.166.9; 1.208.15–20; 1.36.8–19; 3.95.1–4) are to be found instances of powers accrued, and curses being exercised, through the tapas of a renouncer or ascetic (see Olson 1997:8–13). In the epics, tapas is seldom used for liberation, but for worldly gain (such as a son), revenge, status, honour, glory, and military success (see Holck 1969). For psychological interpretations of austerities, see Masson (1976); Cantlie (1977). 42 Vrata-s (‘vows’), particularly to fast on a particular day, are a general feature of traditional Hindu culture. See Kane (HD“, Vol. 5, part II:255–462) for an exhaustive list of around 1,500 different vrata-s. See also Dutt (2002). On women householders’ religious vows, see Babb (1975:110), who describes the solah somv§r vrat (the ‘sixteen Mondays vow’); McGee (1991); Iltis (1996); Pearson (1996). 43 The most common form of limiting diet is phal§h§r, technically fruitarian, but usually also consisting of milk, fruits, nuts, and—if a grain is consumed—r§md§n, a kind of reddish millet. The important point about a phal§h§r diet is that all foodstuff may ‘fall’ into the recipients hands. 44 Practices include those when the s§dhu does not lie down or remains seated (when he is known as khaÜeávarÊ), usually supported by suspended sling, or keeps one arm permanently in the air (årdhvab§hu). Some permanently wear a metal chastity belt (a practice more common amongst Vair§gÊs); while others lie on a bed of nails (a practice far less common today than even in the 1970s). Particularly at mel§-s, s§dhu-s may be seen supporting large weights (usually rocks) tied to the genitals; while some Daáan§mÊs hang upside-down (årdh-mukhi) for some time on a wooden contraption that supports the feet. Long periods of immersion in water (jal-áayyÊ), particularly the river GaØg§, are undertaken on a regular basis by some s§dhu-s. Another, and it seems ancient, form of tapas is the pañc§gnitapasy§. For performing
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
37
general public perception that a s§dhu-’s powers, accumulated from tapasy§, are real—and they are feared—though attitudes to s§dhu-s vary widely. While in north India s§dhu-s are generally revered—particularly by villagers—sometimes almost as a form (mårti) of deity,45 s§dhu-s who have toured south India frequently complain of the difficulties they have experienced there. In distinction from the usual Hindu practice of cremation, when a saÒny§sÊ dies he is usually buried in a grave (known as a sam§dhi), facing east or north-east, supported on the wooden ‘T-shaped’ frame (baragan) that is used for meditation, which maintains the corpse in a seated posture. He is usually buried with some cannabis leaves (bh§Øg) and a water-pot gourd. Salt and spices are thrown in to assist the process of putrefaction.46 Some time after the burial the saÒny§sÊ-’s disciples will organise a meal (bhand§r§) for associated ascetics and Brahmans. Tombs and sometimes temples are erected over the graves of important heads of monasteries (mahant-s and mah§maÖ·aleávaras) and worship of the sam§dhi continues. Mahant-s are occasionally entombed in stone coffins (taØka) which are thrown into the Ganges, notably in holy places along the river, such as Haridv§r, Banaras and Pray§g. Poorer ascetics are sometimes merely thrown into the river GaØg§ with stones attached to their limbs.47
this austerity, the ascetic sits in the noonday sun surrounded, in the first stage, by five heaps of smouldering cow-dung. He utters mantras of the Lord’s name, with the aid of a necklace (m§l§) hidden under a cloth. In the following stages the number of smouldering fires is then increased to seven, twelve, eighty-four, and ‘innumerable’ fires. In the final stage a fire is lit in a clay pot (known as kap§r) and placed on the meditating ascetic’s head (kap§r), leaving him surrounded by fire. This form of tapasy§ is typically performed for three consecutive summers, usually only by s§dhu-s of the R§m§nandÊ order. For pictures of these activities, see Hartsuiker (1993). 45 See Gross (1992:161). 46 A number of castes use a method for burials similar to that of saÒny§sÊ-s; for example, the Pisharotis, a settled caste of Kerala (see Ananthakrishna Iyer 1912:143). 47 Thurston (1909, Vol. 2:299) reports that a dead saÒny§sÊ-’s head is broken with a coconut, to facilitate mokßa, and that his body is then wrapped with a reddish cloth and thrown into the Ganges. A south Indian Brahman saÒny§sÊ-’s head is also said to be so broken, but his body is buried.
38
chapter one 1.2 Caste
Regarding the Brahmanical textual tradition, according to the BÜhad§raÖyaka Upanißad (4.4.22; 3.5.1), the MuÖ·aka Upanißad (1.2.12), Manu (4.38; 6.97), and the Kårma Pur§Öa, (II.28.2), only Brahmans may renounce. Such is the opinion of the advaita commentators, “aØkara and Sureávara, and most mediaeval authors. However, the J§b§la Upanißad (4)48 and Y§jñavalkya SmÜti (3.61)49 maintain that all twice-born (dvija: br§hmaÖa, kßatriya, vaiáya) may renounce. In the mediaeval period, Brahmanical commentators were still undecided as to whether only Brahmans or all twice-born were eligibile to renounce,50 an ambivalence also apparent amongst more recent commentators.51 The majority view is that the three higher varÖa-s are entitled to saÒny§sa.52 However, in the VißÖu SmÜti (5.115)53 and Y§jñavalkya SmÜti (2.241) a punishment is specified for those who entertain a áådra parivr§jaka in rites for the gods or manes, indicating that, disregarding varÖa prescriptions, there were instances of áådra renunciates, which seems to also pertain in more recent times.54 In a landmark ruling in 1980 by the Supreme Court, which is frequently reiterated, a áådra has the right to become a saÒny§sÊ.55 The judge48
See Olivelle (1992). See Dutta (1987, Vol. 1). 50 See Olivelle (1977:33–34). V§sudev§árama, for example, in his Yatidharmaprak§áa (composed between 1675 and 1800), expressed both views. 51 See Sarkar (1958:65). 52 See Killingley (1991) for a useful discussion of varÖa, j§ti and caste, and how these categories have been interpreted by several influential commentators. 53 See Jolly (1991). 54 Sinha and Saraswati (1978:180) report that an $c§rya MaÖ·aleávara, NarsiÒh Giri, had a highly educated disciple from the Kunbi caste (a ‘clean’ áådra caste). Steele (1868:440) remarks that if a person of too inferior a caste has through inadvertance been admitted to the order, should he be discovered he is branded with a hot coin and expelled. However, Thurston (1909, Vol. 2:299) notes that ‘GÙs§yis’ never marry, and that br§hmaÖa-s, kßatriya-s, vaißya-s and áådra-s may all become GÙs§yi. Crooke (1896, Vol. 2:260, citing Maclagan, Panj§b Census Report 1891:112) states that some lineages of Daáan§mÊs have lower-caste initiates. Rose (1914, Vol. 3:358) believes that originally only Brahmans were admitted, and that R§jpåts were subsequently admitted in the recruitment of n§g§-s. Vaiáya-s, who administered finance, were later admitted, and even men of impure ‘castes’. However, Rose maintains that the order is mostly made up of Brahmans and kßatriya-s, and that caste restrictions concerning commensality are maintained. 55 The case (Krishna Singh v. Mathura Ahir) ran from 1951 to 1980, and originated from a dispute over a áådra saÒny§sÊ-’s right to inherit property (see Narayanan 1993:286–291). 49
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
39
ment on this case was reached primarily on the basis of custom within a community, which was interpreted as taking legal precedence over the proscriptions of dharmaá§stra in this regard. After initiation by an §c§rya-guru, the initiate theoretically loses his previous caste identification. Nevertheless, caste remains an important background element in the life of the saÒny§sÊ,56 as his pre-saÒny§sa caste position is often known by other saÒny§sÊ-s, higher caste initiates generally being accorded greater respect. Three of the four daÖ·Ê lineages, namely the TÊrtha, $árama and SarasvatÊ, initiate only Brahmans57 and regard themselves as superior to the paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s. Bh§ratÊs are to be found amongst both daÖ·Ê-s, paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s, while the non-daÖ·Ê lineages appear to also admit lower-caste initiates. It seems probable that when the akh§Ü§-s first formed, most probably between the mid-sixteenth and mid-seventeenth centuries,58 lower-caste initiates were admitted as n§g§-s to some of the lineages. In accounts of events in northern India during this period it is apparent that it is the names ‘Giri’ (particularly), ‘Puri’ and ‘Bh§ratÊ’ which figure most prominently in n§g§ armies.59 Many of these may have been recruited from lower castes (see Chapter 7). Amongst the akh§Ü§-s, my research has made clear that it is
56 Sad§nanda Giri (1976:28) maintains that before acceptance for initiation the neophyte is questioned about his caste and religion. Brahmans and kßatriya-s from some parts of India are not accepted, for reasons he has not managed to determine, and ‘Untouchables’ are also excluded. 57 See Wilson (1861:197); Oman (1903:161); Anantakrishna Iyer (1930:255); Kane (HD“, Vol. 2:951); Tripathi (1978:64-67); Sinha and Saraswati (1978:69). Hartsuiker (1993:31) claims that $áramas are of solely Brahman backgrounds, and that Brahmans predominate in the TÊrtha, Bh§ratÊ and SarasvatÊ sub-sects. There are five main southern divisions (P§nc-Dr§vi·a) of Brahmans, who reside south of the river Narmad§ (with the exception of the Gujarati Brahmans who live to its north), and five northern divisions (P§ñc-Gau·a). There are numerous further sub-divisions, and yet further sub-divisions of those. In the south are: Mah§r§ßãra (12 sub-divisions), TailaØga (or $ndhra) (8), Dr§vi·a (6), Karn§ãak (7) and Gurjara (84). The five northern divisions are the S§rasvat (4), Gau· (15), K§nkubja (or Kanaujia or K§nyakubja) (5), Maiãhila (4) and Uãkala (3). There have, of course, been extensive migrations of all castes of Brahmans over thousands of years; and caste is sometimes contrived. See Steele (1868:79); Sherring (1872:19–113). 58 See Ch. 7. 59 See Sarkar (1958). Many n§g§ Giris figure in Sarkar’s account; also mentioned (p. 266) are three battalions of PurÊs and one of Bh§ratÊs, in the service of the Jodhpur state in the latter half of the eighteenth century.
40
chapter one
extremely difficult to determine with any certainty the caste background of many initiates, for the obvious reason that some of them might wish to escape it. However there is a general tendency by informants to emphasise the Brahmanical nature of initiates, some akh§Ü§-s, such as the NirañjanÊ, claiming that all initiates are Brahmans. The initiate should also be physically fit and without any disabilities, yet it is clear that there are exceptions.60 In general, it seems that apart from daÖ·Ê saÒny§sÊ-s, many s§dhu-s, particularly those wandering, are from lower castes.61
1.3 Subdivisions within the Daáan§mÊ order: DaÖ·Ê DaÖ·Ê-s are sometimes referred to as á§stradh§rÊ-s (‘scripture holders’), or as daÖ·adh§rÊ-s, and constitute the monastic wing of the Daáan§mÊs.62 Many of them have some knowledge of Sanskrit, and their higher caste status is generally recognised (Tripathi 1978:64). They have a reputation for observing convention and conservatism (rå·hiv§dÊ), usually keep their hair cut short, and often maintain deep caste prejuices.63 They generally disassociate themselves from the Daáan§mÊs of the akh§Ü§-s, tending to regard only themselves
60 Tripathi’s (1978:88) survey elicited a figure of 8.4% for s§dhu-s with disabilities. 61 The openness of renunciate orders to low-caste initiates varies from order to order. R§mn§mÊ s§dhu-s, for example, are almost exclusively low-caste, while one branch of the usually strictly Brahmanical “rÊ-VaißÖavas, the s§tt§ ek§ki, were an order of celibate áådra ascetics who performed important ritual service at the Tirupati temple complex in the fifteenth century (Stein 1968:89). Lamb (2002:18 fn. 15) comments that although (daÖ·Ê) saÒny§sÊ-s are high-caste, many n§g§-s and other wandering s§dhu-s are low-caste. 62 During the M§gh Mel§ at Allahabad in 2002, I visited camps of daÖ·Ê-s for around ten days, interviewing numerous s§dhu-s. 63 See Sinha and Saraswati (1978:70): daÖ·Ê-s from one of the five main northern Brahmanical castes neither eat nor reside in the same maãha-s with those from the five main southern Brahmanical castes. Tamils and Keralites do not associate with members of either group of Brahmans. Further, amongst the gau·a Brahmans of Uttar Pradesh there is a further sub-division, the K§nyakubj—from Kanauj, one of the five main divisions of northern Brahmans, see Sherring (1872:23)—and S§ryåpari, who do not dine together in the maãha-s. DaÖ·Ê maãha-s also maintain certain rules about the succession of the gaddÊ. At the MachlÊbandar maãha, only a Saryåpari/Sarjuparia (one of the five main divisions of K§nyakubj Brahmans) can accede, whereas the daÖ·Ê maãha at Pushkar only appoints K§nyakubj ascetics.
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
41
as the ‘true saÒny§sÊ-s’.64 DaÖ·Ê-s take initiation from a guru from a daÖ·Ê maãha, while paramahaÒsa-s usually take initiation from a Mah§maÖ·§leávara of an akh§Ü§. Common to both the monastic and n§g§ traditions are a shared understanding of the founding and organising of the sect. Further, at times of initiation the two traditions are united. The two traditions are not entirely distinct, though they are distinguished by their institutional independence and their different roles in India’s political and religious history. DaÖ·Ê maãha-s are nominally affiliated to one of the four (or five) main maãha-s (known as pÊãha-s) supposedly established by “aØkar§c§rya. Although daÖ·Ê-s generally acknowledge the affiliation of their maãha to a pÊãha with some pride, apart from branch-maãha-s of the main pÊãha-s, daÖ·Ê maãha-s function independently, with no connection to the pÊãha to which they may be nominally affiliated.65 The greatest concentration of daÖ·Ê-s is to be found in Banaras where they have many maãha-s,66 and where between approximately twenty-five and fifty percent of all daÖ·Ê-s are to be found (Sawyer 1993:159), forming approximately one fifth of the ascetic population.67 At the M§gh
64 I have even heard daÖ·Ê-s remark that “we are not Daáan§mÊs”, emphasizing their non-identification with the akh§Ü§-s. 65 The daÖ·Ê-s whom I have interviewed regard the southern pÊãha of “ÜØgeri as genuine and do not recognise the K§ñcÊpuram pÊãha. 66 Sinha and Saraswati (1978:68–72) report 37 daÖ·Ê maãha-s in nine of the districts of Banaras, 23 affiliated to the “§rad§ pÊãha, of Dv§rak§, and 14 to the “ÜØgerÊ pÊãha. Surprisingly, none of the Banaras daÖ·Ê maãha-s are associated with the Govardhan pÊãha of PurÊ or with the Jyotir pÊãha of Jyoáimath. According to the scheme presented in the normative texts of the Daáan§mÊs, the Maãh§mn§ya, Mah§nuáasanam etc., the maãha-s of Banaras should be under the jurisdiction of the JyotÊr pÊãha of Jyoáimaãh. Four of the maãha-s claim to have been established before the fifteenth century, whereas 27 were most probably built between 1800 and 1968. Only three daÖ·Ê maãha-s have been built since Independence, whereas the number of paramahaÒsa maãha-s has significantly increased. Sinha and Saraswati calculate a total resident ascetic population (in distinction from the numerous permanently wandering ascetics) for Banaras as 1,284 (providing a ratio of 1 ascetic for every 250 people in Banaras), of whom áaiva saÒny§sÊ-s constitute 48.8%. DaÖ·Ê-s, numbering 239, form approximately one fifth of the ascetic population. According to Tripathi (1978:67), in Banaras there are twenty-eight maãha-s managed by daÖ·Ê-s and fifteen managed by paramahaÒsa-s. The two groups are said not to be on good terms and do not take meals together. 67 Sawyer (1993:163), notes that maãha-s continually change, sometimes expanding and becoming more prominent—with new branches being established—under a dynamic head; or alternatively, rapidly declining after the demise of an influential leader. Many of the maãha-s included in Appendix 2 of Sinha and Saraswati’s book
42
chapter one
Mel§68 in Allahabad in 2002, around seventy daÖ·Ê maãha-s were camped, the largest camp being that of the MachlÊbandar (‘fishmonkey’) Maãh which was represented by the six maãha-s it owns in Banaras, where it has its headquarters.69 DaÖ·Ê-s have usually been householders before becoming saÒny§sÊ-s, and on initiation to the order—but before the final rite of saÒny§sa— they are given one of four brahmac§rÊ names; either Svaråp, Prak§áa, $nanda or Caitanya. The name given usually depends on which of the four main pÊãha-s the maãha—via which the candidate was initiated—is nominally affiliated to. DaÖ·Ê-s will have been initiated by a daÖ·Ê guru, usually a Mah§maÖ·aleávara, but in rare cases directly by a “aØkar§c§rya at one of the four important pÊãha-s. 1.4 ParamahaÒsa Like all Daáan§mÊs, paramahaÒsa-s 70 acknowledge that “aØkara founded four pÊãha-s, yet, similarly to the daÖ·Ê-s, their affiliation to a pÊtha has virtually no practical relevance. However, their affiliation to an akh§Ü§ is significant,71 as it derives either from their own saÒny§sa initiation—performed by a Mah§maÖ·aleávara of an akh§Ü§—or from a historical connection, via the parampar§ of their guru, whose own guru or guru’s guru may have been in an akh§Ü§. ParamahaÒsa-s generally reside in maãha-s that have little connection or no connection with the life of the akh§Ü§, and apart from some
no longer exist, while new institutions have arisen since the time of their study. Sawyer (1993:171) maintains that the largest daÖ·Ê maãha in Banaras is the Mumukßu Bhavan, established in 1929 by Sv§mÊ Ghanaßy§m§nanda. In response to various enquiries, I was informed, albeit unreliably, that there are perhaps 10,000 to 15,000 daÖ·Ê-saÒny§sÊ-s in India today. 68 For details of both the M§gh Mel§ and Kumbh Mel§, see Appendix 3. 69 The name ‘MachlÊbandar’ derives from a story about the land which is the headquarters of the maãha in Nagva, Banaras. (At one time it was a jungle, with monkeys and fish-ponds.) The maãha has a total of fifteen properties, six in Banaras, and others at Haridv§r, SÊt§pur, Citrakåã, D§dri (Haryana), Karnal (Haryana) Kurukßetra and K§npur. The current chief guru is Kail§áa Bhus§r $árama. 70 In a number of classical texts, paramahaÒsa is a term also used, in an idealised sense, to refer to the highest category of renouncer (see Ch. 3.4). 71 Sinha and Saraswati found that the 296 paramahaÒsa-s of Banaras are affiliated to three akh§Ü§-s, the Jån§, NirañjanÊ and Nirv§ÖÊ (or Mah§nirv§ÖÊ), over 50% belonging to the Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§.
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
43
few paramahaÒsa-s who may participate in the life of an akh§Ü§ with a view to becoming n§g§—which requires a further initiatory rite—the inclusion of paramahaÒsa-s in the ‘military wing’ of the Daáan§mÊs simply stems from their initiation from an akh§Ü§. Although not usually involved, paramahaÒsa-s may actively participate in the life of the akh§Ü§ on certain occasions, such as during bhaÖ·§r§-s (communal feasts with the distribution of alms), which may be for a single akh§Ü§ or for several together. They take place on particular holy days and when an ascetic succeeds to the gaddÊ of the maãha, during which rite the successor is presented with a scarf (c§dar) by the s§dhu-s present. The paramahaÒsa-s have the greatest number of ascetics and maãha-s in Banaras, the maãha-s comprising one fifth of all the maãha-s there (Sinha and Saraswati 1978:72–81).72 Seven of the paramahaÒsa maãha-s admit women s§dhu-s (also known as avadhåtin),73 two of which are exclusively female, five being mixed male and female. All the m§Ê-s are reported to come from Bengal and Nepal. The author’s fieldwork has established that some also come from the Kumaun area of Uttaranchal. In contrast to the daÖ·Ê-s of Banaras, who run only one educational institution, the Dharma SaØgha “ikߧ MaÖ·ala, which is in decline, the paramahaÒsa-s run five Sanskrit p§ãhaá§l§-s.74 The significance of the prestigious role, financial viability and expansive programme of paramahaÒsa educational institutions in the context of recent Daáan§mÊ history can be understood against the background of the militant history of the akh§Ü§-s, and the curtailment of their activities. It seems that some individuals who had been actively involved in the mercenary activities of the akh§Ü§-s had accumulated considerable
72 There are fifty-seven paramahaÒsa maãha-s, none of them established before the fifteenth century, over 82% appearing between 1800 and 1968, and thirty-nine instituted since independence. Of all the various ascetic institutions of Banaras (see Appendix 1), the paramahaÒsa is the fastest growing, a new maãha being founded, on average, every two years. 73 This term is sometimes used derogatorily, as an avadhåtin is traditionally the female partner of a Tantric practitioner. 74 The oldest and most efficient is the SaÒny§sÊ SaÒskÜta Mah§vidy§laya, run by the Aparn§th maãha and established in 1906 by Sv§mÊ Gobind§nandajÊ MaÖ·aleávara. The students who have passed through this institution include not only saÒny§sÊ-s but also students from the Sikh-derived Ud§sin and Nirmala orders. Many of the saÒny§sÊ-s have become eminent MaÖ·aleávaras. Sinha and Saraswati (1978:78) note that in 1957, when the institution celebrated its Golden Jubilee, it emerged that practically all the MaÖ·aleávaras of that time had been its students.
44
chapter one
wealth, which was then channelled into land and property. Around the beginning of the twentieth century educational institutions were first established, as part of a process of reforming the general ethos of the paramahaÒsa-s and the akh§Ü§-s, particularly in the Gangetic heartland of their activities. At that time, some of the paramahaÒsa-s were well-known as businessmen and landlords (see Ch. 7). The inheritance of a maãha, which is invariably attached to a temple, is usually decided by the reigning mahant, his decision committed in writing or announced in the witness of others. If the mahant dies suddenly, the issue may be settled by the mutual consent of the disciples. However, Sinha and Saraswati (1978:74ff.) comment that practically every maãha in Banaras, of whatever denomination, has been involved in legal disputes at one time or another over property.75 They also note that mahant-s often have histories of affiliations and initiations into more than one akh§Ü§,76 sometimes as a consequence of internal disagreements. Kane (HD“, Vol. 2:972–973) also records several of the numerous legal disputes that have engaged saÒny§sÊ-s over the centuries.77 Regarding the trusteeship of maãha-s and the required comportment of the mahant, there is now a code for religiously endowed properties, enshrined in the Madras Hindu Religious and Charitable Endowment Act of 1959.78
75
See Katju (1961:233–245) for a lively account of his professional involvement as a lawyer with several cases involving property disputes between maãha-s and mahant-s. 76 Confirmed by the author. 77 Derrett (1974:67) also comments on the frequency with which disputes over the property of maãha-s end up in court. Kane (HD“, Vol. 2:910–911) cites the remark of Sir T. Strange (Hindu Law, Vol. 1, 1839:32) that “Hindu law is meagre in its provisions relating to religious endowments”, observing that in modern times however, courts of India have laid down that an idol is a juridical person capable of holding property, and that an idol or a maãha is in the trusteeship of the manager of the temple or of the mahant. Taylor (2001:50) remarks that legal cases, known as ‘debutter’ cases, concerning the devat§ (the technical owner of the temple or property) and the áebait (usually a priest, standing as the surrogate legal owner on the divinity’s behalf) were extremely frequent at the beginning of the twentieth century in the civil litigation before the Calcutta High Court. 78 Mahant-ship and the maãha are not alienable or partible, but the mahant may be removed on the following grounds: 1. Being of unsound mind; 2. Suffering from a mental or physical defect that renders him unfit to be a trustee; 3. Having ceased to profess the Hindu religion; 4. Being convicted of an offence of moral turpitude; 5. Breaching the trust bestowed upon him in respect of any of the properties under that trust; 6. Misappropriating or wasting funds on purposes or properties unconnected with the institution; 7. Diverting funds intended for the benefit of the institution; 6.
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
45
1.5 ‘ParamahaÒsa’ and ‘Daáan§mÊ’ as categories A tripartite division amongst the Daáan§mÊs has been discussed. However, it needs to be considered that in some instances there are branches of saÒny§sÊ-s and Daáan§mÊs that are but tangentially connected with the core Daáan§mÊ tradition. By way of illustration, there are other maãha-s in Banaras founded in the name of wellknown paramahaÒsa-s, notably TailaØga Sv§mÊ and Harihar B§b§, but disciples of those orders are not recognised as either Daáan§mÊs or as paramahaÒsa-s. Similarly, the final initiation—leading to his nirvikalpasam§dhi—of the famous Bengali Tantric, Gad§dhara Caããop§dhy§ya (1836–1886), who was given the name R§makÜßÖa ParamahaÒsa, was performed by Toãa PurÊ, who, it is believed, belonged to the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§. However, the order of saÒny§sÊ-s founded by R§makÜßÖa’s chief disciple, Sv§mÊ Vivek§nanda, has no sectarian connection to the Daáan§mÊs.79 On this point, there is some need to examine briefly the notion of ‘sectarian connection’ and by implication the categories of ‘Daáan§mÊ’ and ‘paramahaÒsa’. In terms of self-identification, it is primarily the parampar§, the guru-áißya relationship—the ‘vertical’ order—that is paramount within the Indian tradition in general, and the renunciatory environment in particular. An initiate may be vague or unclear as to what the identificatory parameters of his or her sect, or branch of a sect, may be, while certain about their guru-parampar§. As an example, we might consider the Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s of the HaÖdiy§ B§b§ Yog§laya.80 When asked about which kind of s§dhu they are, they will usually say “Daáan§mÊ” or “saÒny§sÊ ”, invariably qualifying this statement with the remark that they are devotees of HaÖ·iy§81 B§b§,
Conducting an immoral life or behaving in a manner likely to bring his office into contempt; 8. Persistent and wilful default in discharging his duties or performing his functions under the act or any other law (Singh 1998:90–91). 79 Although Vivek§nanda publicly identified himself as a monk of the “oldest order of saÒny§sÊ-s...founded by “aØkara”, there is no record of Vivek§nanda ever formally taking saÒny§sa. Further, he initiated all his gurubh§Ê-s himself (in January 1887), with no links to religious structures or authorities of any sort, telling them that they were neither householders, nor exactly saÒny§sÊ-s, but “quite a new type” (Michelis 2004:79, 108, 112). 80 At TriveÖÊ Bandh, Allahabad. 81 HaÖ·iy§ means ‘small clay pot’, which HaÖ·iy§ B§b§ always carried and in which he collected alms. By all accounts he was a great yogÊ who lived simply for
46
chapter one
who died in 1954.82 Further, some s§dhu-s, but not all, informed me that they were “[a member of] the Jån§ akh§Ü§”. The current disciples of HaÖ·iy§ B§b§ took direct initiation into saÒny§sa from their guru, BißÖudev§nand, who in turn was initiated by HaÖ·iy§ B§b§. It seems most probable, though I was unable to establish this, that Yog§nandsarasvatÊ (the guru of the Mah§r§ja of Darbh§Øga) was initiated into the Jån§ akh§Ü§, and hence the current identification with the Jån§ akh§Ü§, even though the current disciples of HaÖ·iy§ B§b§ have not been initiated by, nor do they have anything to do with, the Jån§ akh§Ü§. Thus, in terms of their own self-identification, the saÒny§sÊ-s will say that they are Daáan§mÊ and, perhaps, Jån§ akh§Ü§, as their lineage traces back through the Jån§ akh§Ü§. However, the disciples of HaÖ·iy§ B§b§ were not initiated via an akh§Ü§ or a daÖ·Ê maãha, nor are they Daáan§mÊ daÖ·Ê-s, paramahaÒsa-s or n§g§-s, criteria outsiders may use for identiying Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s. Yet the disciples’ claim to being Daáan§mÊ is, in their view, legitimised through lineage. Another example, of which there are many, of a saÒny§sÊ lineage which traces its ancestry to “aØkar§c§rya, and which might be similarly described as Daáan§mÊ, is the lineage of the Kail§s $áram, founded in 1880 at Muni-kÊ-Reti, Œßikeá. The current lineage derives from Sv§mÊ Dhanr§j Giri, who was born in 1871 (TulÊ 2001:5). The resident Mah§maÖ·aleávara performs traditional Brahmanical rites of initiation for the disciples, who are usually Sanskrit students. After the first initiation, as Brahmac§rÊ, they keep the top-knot, wear the sacred thread and do japa. In the second initiation they perform the viraj§-havan and have their top-knot removed; they are now unquestionably saÒny§sÊ-s, and many have one of the ‘ten names’.83 around fifty years near TriveÖÊ Bandh, feeding people when he could and teaching haãha-yoga techniques for curing the sick. For an account of his life and legacy, see Bishnudevanand (1977). 82 His sam§dhi was erected in that year, around which an §árama has been constructed. The resident saÒny§sÊ-s of the §árama perform daily observances and meditation at the sam§dhi. HaÖ·iy§ B§b§ learned yoga from Yog§nandsarasvatÊ, who was guru to the Mah§r§ja of Darbh§Øga, Bihar, and had four disciples: BißÖudev§nandsarasvatÊ, Bhagvat§nandsarasvatÊ, Sahaj§nandsarasvatÊ and Puny§nandsarasvatÊ. BißÖudev§nandsarasvatÊ is said to have initiated twenty-five men, five of whom were his main disciples. Two of those, Sad§nand and “§nt§nand, manage the property on the TriveÖÊ Bandh, In Daraganj, Allahabad. (Two other properties, one nearby and one in the Banda District of Uttar Pradesh, are affiliated.) 83 For information on the traditions of the Kail§s $áram, see Vidy§nand Giri (1993).
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
47
Sarkar (1958:94) mentions several Daáan§mÊ institutions, including the GÊt§ Mandir, established at Ahmadabad, BaÜaud§ and other cities by Sv§mÊ Vidy§nanda, who was a n§g§ of the Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§;84 a maãha at AmÜts§r, founded by Sv§mÊ KÜßÖ§nanda, and a maãha founded at KaØkhal by Sv§mÊ Bhagavat§nanda, who joins the n§g§-s of the Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ at Kumbh Mel§s. The main connections that tie all these institutions together are linkages of guru-parampar§-s at times of initiation, initiates of one institution frequently being initiated by a guru from another institution.
1.6 N§g§ During the first stage of initiation, Daáan§mÊs are usually given one of the ‘ten names’.85 ParamahaÒsa-s may then take a further initiation to become a n§g§ of an akh§Ü§. Akh§Ü§ is a technical name for the institutions governing the n§g§-s, and also has the sense of ‘wrestling ring’ and ‘military formation’, where n§g§-s train for fighting. These arenas are separate from the large network of traditional wrestling akh§Ü§-s which are training institutions with their own history, gurus and organisation.86 A distinguishing feature of life in several of the n§g§ akh§Ü§-s, notably the Jån§ akh§Ü§, is the consumption of very large quantities of cannabis, either smoked with tobacco in a cilam (‘clay pipe’), or eaten or drunk in the form of bh§Øg, a preparation of the leaves of the plant.87
84
The organisation has a press, GÊt§ Dharma Press, at Banaras. However, an exception are Daáan§mÊs from the Agni akh§Ü§, (one of the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s), who do not ever take one of the ‘ten names’. Similarly to the daÖ·Ê-s, they are given one of the four brahmac§rÊ names (Svaråp, Prak§áa, $nanda or Caitanya), depending on nominal pÊãha affiliation. 86 See Alter (1992) for an account of Indian wrestling. There are around 150 akh§Ü§-s in Banaras, and around 20 to 30 in surrounding areas. The larger akh§Ü§-s have 50 to 60 members, most wrestlers being relatively low-caste. Akh§Ü§-s specialise in different techniques, such as weights, clubs or maces. The wrestlers’ patron deity is Hanum§n. 87 The cannabis is smoked either in the form of dried buds of the female plant (g§ñj§), which is grown in many regions of the subcontinent, or in the form of a resin (caras), rubbed by hand from the buds of the female plant. Caras is made almost exclusively in the Indian and Nepalese Himalayas. The term hashish (for cannabis) is used, traditionally, only by Muslims, and refers to a different preparation of the resin of the plant, which is manufactured with the use of sieves. N§g§-s typically 85
48
chapter one
At Kumbh Mel§s, Mah§maÖ·aleávaras and usually one or more of the reigning “aØkar§c§ryas preside over saÒny§sa initiations at large formal ceremonies. However, many Mah§maÖ·aleávaras are not affiliated to the seven akh§Ü§-s of the Daáan§mÊ order. Most are the heads of §árama-s located in north India.88 Around two hundred Mah§maÖ·aleávaras attended the 2001 Kumbh Mel§ but only four or five dozen are affiliated to the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s. Several informants maintained that there were more than thirty Mah§maÖ·aleávaras affiliated to the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§, the largest number for any of the akh§Ü§-s. Those Mah§maÖ·aleávaras who are affiliated to the akh§Ü§-s, and those who specifically preside over initiations in the role of §c§rya-guru,89 have very little to do with the activities or organisation of the akh§Ü§-s, only being consulted in extreme or unusual circumstances. Many, however, will have spent time as a s§dhu in an akh§Ü§ before becoming established as a Mah§maÖ·aleávara in charge of an institution. Traditionally, n§g§ initiation was three years (but sometimes between two and twelve years) after the saÒny§sa initiation. After saÒny§sa but before being n§g§, a saÒny§sÊ within an akh§Ü§ is known as a vastradh§rÊ (‘wearer of cloth’). This is in distinction from the n§g§-s who are traditionally naked, only covered with ash from the dhånÊ.90 These days, however, most wear loin-cloths in public, and many wear cloth of the traditional saÒny§sÊ orange, or sometimes black.
begin smoking heavily at 4.00 or 5.00 a.m. After noon, they usually rest for few hours, resuming smoking in the late afternoon, until evening or the early hours of the morning. Usually, they do not smoke for a couple of hours after eating. 88 A survey of most of the camps of the Mah§maÖ·aleávaras at the Allahabad Kumbh Mel§ in 2001 revealed that their main §árama-s are most commonly situated in Delhi, Haridv§r, KaØkhal, Œßikeá, Banaras, Allahabad, Ujjain and Citrakåã. 89 In most Sanskrit colleges there are five grades: Entrance; First; Intermediate; “§strÊ; $c§rya. The title of the $c§rya Guru derives from his Sanskrit qualification. 90 The ‘holy ash’ worn by n§g§-s is known as vibhåti (also meaning ‘majesty’, ‘dignity’ or ‘superhuman power’), or bhabhåt, or bhasm(a). Besides its religious associations, ash protects against the cold and wards off insects. Although n§g§-s may use ash straight from a dhånÊ in which no ‘unclean’ wood (such as bamboo, which causes itching) has been burnt, ‘pure’ bhasm is made from the faeces of cows grazing in the forest. The dried cow-pats are burned, and the ash is mixed with water and filtered through cloth. The water and fine-ash mixture is then left to stand for the night, after which the water is decanted. The remaining, soggy ash is shaped into balls or lumps, which are placed in a pit walled with other cow-pats, and burned again. The resultant ash is a fine, whitish powder.
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
49
The vibhåti from their dhånÊ-s is one of the most common offerings to visiting devotees or pilgrims, who generally believe in its magical and restorative properties. These days, n§g§ initiation ususally occurs a day or two after the saÒny§sa initiation. It is performed, usually at a Kumbh Mel§, by a mahant belonging to the akh§Ü§ to which the n§g§ will be affiliated. N§g§-s train, to a limited extent, in weapons, fighting and wrestling91 in an akh§Ü§. The occasion of the Kumbh Mel§ is the preeminent event in the calendar of the Daáan§mÊs, particularly for the akh§Ü§-s, when initiations and important meetings take place and decisions relating to the activities of the akh§Ü§ are made. During a crisis, such as when a mahant dies, the members of the akh§Ü§ will meet and attempt to settle any dispute, which is frequent, over succession or acquisition of the maãha he previously occupied. In Banaras, Sinha and Saraswati (1978:82) survey a total of twentyfour n§g§ centres (akh§Ü§-s),92 which are found to house ninety-one ascetics, who are members of one of the seven major akh§Ü§-s. The akh§Ü§-s with the largest membership are the Jån§ and Nirv§ÖÊ with membership of thirty-three and nineteen respectively. These are followed by the $nanda (fourteen), Agni (ten), $v§han (six), NirañjanÊ (five), Aãal (two) and, curiously, GådaÜa (two).93 A total of six female n§g§-s are reported, three belonging to the Jån§ akh§Ü§ 94 and three belonging to the $nanda akh§Ü§.95 Five of the female n§g§-s (or avad-
91 Martial training also has a long history in Kerala. The art of kalari-payattu was first systematised by Brahmans and kßatriya-s around the eleventh century, during a period of wars between the Ceras, CÙÏas and PaÖ·yas. The kalari (practice arena) is presided over by between seven and twenty-seven deities, including one or more forms of the goddess (usually either Bhadrak§lÊ or BhagavatÊ), “iva-“akti combined, GaÖapati, past gurus who go back to Paraáur§ma and DroÖa, Hanum§n, Ayyappan, and local heroes or ancestors (Zarrilli 1998:67–78). 92 Fourteen were founded between 1800 and 1968, five trace their origin to the sixteenth or seventeenth century. Five claim to have been founded between the ninth and eleventh centuries, though these early dates seem highly improbable (see Ch. 7). 93 The GådaÜa akh§Ü§ is recorded as having two male ascetics. The mention of this akh§Ü§ is anomalous as I have found no record of it either in other published sources or during interviews conducted in the field. It is not currently a recognised Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§. Its identity is analysed in the following chapter. 94 A woman n§g§ (originally of French descent) of the Jån§ akh§Ü§, named Santoß Giri, has run an §árama near Porbandar (Gujarat) for many years. She was initiated by a “aØkar§c§rya and is well known in the area. I have not visited her. 95 Female membership of the $nanda akh§Ü§ is not in evidence currently. Contemporary female n§g§-s belong exclusively to the Jån§ akh§Ü§.
50
chapter one
håtin-s) are reported to have come from Nepal and one from Bengal. All were aged over thirty-five, and in the akh§Ü§-s of Banaras they were residing with the males.96 The akh§Ü§-s are organised according to what is called the pañc§yatÊ system, meaning that the organisation is run by elected representatives. One may see at the gateway of all akh§Ü§-s throughout India the prefix ‘“rÊ pañc ... akh§Ü§’. Although Sinha and Saraswati (1978:196) acknowledge that succession to the leadership of the akh§Ü§ is through lineage—being in accordance with the mutual maÜhÊ (lineage)97 of the guru and successor—they also make a substantial claim about the democratic nature of the akh§Ü§-s, stating that in this organisation no decision, great or small, may be taken by a single person of whatever rank, age or personal achievement. As an example, a letter addressed to the th§n§pati 98 is opened only in the presence of two other ascetics. According to Sad§nanda Giri (1976:27), in the akh§Ü§-s the relationship between n§g§-s and their gurus is described as the relationship of siddha-s§dhaka. He claims that it differs somewhat from the gurucel§ relationship found in some other sects, whereby the disciple is exclusively devoted to the guru, also claiming that in the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s no one is formally a disciple of anyone else. DaÖ·Ê-s, who are outside the akh§Ü§, and those of the Agni akh§Ü§ (one of the seven akh§Ü§-s), specifically maintain the guru-cel§ relationship, and the usual hierarchy of guru and disciple. In the other akh§Ü§-s, however, the initiating saÒny§sÊ does not, in the technical terminology employed by the akh§Ü§-s, become the guru of the initiate, the term ‘guru’ being reserved for the presiding deity of the akh§Ü§. A n§g§ is usually attached to a senior ascetic who becomes his s§dhaka-guru. The siddha-s§dhaka relationship means that the disciple serves a siddha-guru, supplying water, sweeping, offering påj§ and so on. In return, the siddha-guru looks after the well-being of the aspirant. Notwithstanding the sometimes fierce independence of the n§g§-s, in practice, besides the unique arrangement amongst ascetic organisa-
96 Sinha and Saraswati report, somewhat confusingly, that one akh§Ü§ is occupied exclusively by female n§g§-s, but supply no further information. It is most probable that females referred to are those in the female branch of the Jån§ akh§Ü§. 97 MaÜhÊ is a technical term for a subdivision within the akh§Ü§ (see Ch. 2.2). 98 One of the more important officials within the akh§Ü§ with a responsibility, amongst others, for the welfare of the tutelary deity of the akh§Ü§ (see below).
branches of the daáan§mÊ order
51
tions for the democratic election of mahant-s and other officials—which takes place during Kumbh Mel§s,99 and which is a distinguishing feature of n§g§ social life—the important social structures within the akh§Ü§-s are hierarchical.100 While paramahaÒsa-s and junior n§g§-s may serve other n§g§ saÒny§sÊ-s or mahant-s, and this relationship may not be on a unique basis as in some renunciate sects, all paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s have their own gurus to whom they afford the highest respect. It is not the case that no one is the guru of anyone else, even though the arrangements and hierarchy of service within the Daáan§mÊ order may differ somewhat from other orders. In practice, the saÒny§sÊ usually has five gurus, to whom he usually refers as ‘guru’, including a digambara-guru if he is a n§g§. (A n§g§ is also referred to as digambara.)101 The highest respect to a human guru is accorded to someone who is sometimes known as the saÒny§sÊ-’s siddha-guru, whom he may encounter at any point along the renunciate path. Although several commentators have been cited who claim that the akh§Ü§-s function, essentially, in a non-hierarchical way, it is evident that clear hierarchies of both spiritual and practical authority operate between n§g§-s and within the akh§Ü§-s. In general, n§g§-s do not beg for alms. While some are actively engaged in various forms of minor business, such as selling herbal medicines or religious articles such as rudr§kßa seeds, some few others have semi-clandestine businesses. However, it should be emphasised that business is pursued by but a small percentage of n§g§-s and that stipends are paid to all n§g§-s, usually by the th§n§pati of the n§g§-’s akh§Ü§. As a consequence of a combination of mercenary, banking, smuggling and other mercantile activity—which is outlined in Chapter
99
Witnessed by the author at the 2001 Kumbh Mel§. Dazey (1987:557; 1990:309) also endorses Sinha and Saraswati’s suggestion that relationships within the akh§Ü§-s are democratic and non-hierarchical, noting that the n§g§-s are guru-bhai-s (‘brothers’) under a guru, but the real guru of the akh§Ü§ is the presiding deity of the akh§Ü§. However, Dazey (1987:542–544) also maintains that “the practice of maintaining a sacred dhånÊ fire (for cooking and oblations) is unique to the n§g§-s among the Daáan§mÊ renouncers”: the “formless guru” of the akh§Ü§ is said to be the dhånÊ. While it is true that the dhånÊ is generally regarded as holy, and prayers made to it, one only has to spend a short time in any akh§Ü§ to see both the clear hierarchical ordering amongst n§g§-s and mahant-s and also the enormous respect accorded to the human gurus within the akh§Ü§. 101 Digambara (lit. ‘sky-clad’) meaning ‘naked’ (as does n§g§), is an epithet of “iva and also the name of one of the two main branches of Jainism (see Dundas 2002). 100
52
chapter one
7—the saÒny§sÊ akh§Ü§-s had, by the middle of the nineteenth century, accumulated extensive properties and large sums of money. Many princely states, such as Kacch, Jodhpur, BaÜaud§, Indore and Gvalior used to pay money to the akh§Ü§-s for services rendered in protecting local interests in conflict with external aggressors. Substantial income is still generated these days from the land held by the akh§Ü§-s, the structures of which are the main focus of the following chapter.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
53
CHAPTER TWO
AKH$4$-S AND DA“AN$M^ FUNCTIONARIES 2.1 The akh§Ü§-s
While Daáan§mÊ daÖ·Ê-s are affiliated to their own monastic maãha-s, the other wing of the Daáan§mÊs (comprising paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s) are affiliated to one of the seven extant Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s. In this chapter, the overall hierarchy of the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s will be considered, and some brief comparisons with akh§Ü§-s of other orders will also be noted. It is apparent that the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s have a radically different background to that of the monastic tradition, illustrated in their mercenary activities and inter-sectarian conflicts during the previous four centuries.1 Most akh§Ü§ members are n§g§, the formation and functioning of the akh§Ü§-s being fully evident at Kumbh Mel§s.2 At the Allahabad Kumbh Mel§, 2001, a total of thirteen akh§Ü§-s were represented. These are the extant akh§Ü§-s of the subcontinent.3 Seven of these are the áaiva Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s, namely the NirañjanÊ, Jån§, Mah§nirv§ÖÊ, $nanda, $v§han, Aãal and Agni.4 Besides these, there
1
See Ch. 7. The Kumbh Mel§, the largest festival on earth, is attended by the majority of s§dhu-s of all orders. While there is evidence—for the last 1500 years—of the periodic gathering of ascetics at what have become the four sites of the Kumbh Mel§ (Haridv§r, Ujjain, Allahabad and N§sik), it seems that the linking of the four sites (as sites of the Kumbh Mel§), and the supporting mythology and astrology, is probably not more than around 130 years old. See Bonazzoli (1977); Bhattacharya (1977); Dubey (1988); and, particularly, Maclean (2001; 2003). Appendix 3 of this book reviews the work of these and other scholars. 3 Sarkar (1958:107) cites a report by Mr. T. Benson on the Kumbh Mela of 1882. He describes six “sects” of akh§Ü§-s that were present: 1. Nirv§ÖÊ n§g§ gosain-s; 2. NirañjanÊ, associated with the Jån§; 3. Three sects of Vair§gÊ; 4. Cho㧠Ud§sin; 5. Baܧ Ud§sin, with the Bandhua (?) akh§Ü§. 6. Nirmala, with the VÜnd§vanÊ (?). 4 Members of some of the akh§Ü§-s may sometimes be identified by hairstyle, the NirañjanÊ tying their ja㧠(dreadlocks) in the middle, the Jån§ on the left, and the Nirv§ÖÊ on the right. 2
54
chapter two
are three vaißÖava anÊ-s:5 the Digambara, Nirv§ÖÊ6 and Nirmohi, all of which are of the R§m§nandÊ order.7 (R§m§nandÊ ty§gÊ-s8 are also
5 In vaißÖava terminology the equivalent of a Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§ is referred to as anÊ (‘army corps’), akh§Ü§ referring to a sub-division of an anÊ. 6 This akh§Ü§ should not to be confused with the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§ which is also sometimes referred to as the Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§. 7 The R§m§nandÊ samprad§ya is constituted of both lay and s§dhu communities, and is one of the four current vaißÖava samprad§ya-s (catuÈ samprad§ya), a classification of four vaißÖava orders that has changed twice during the last four centuries. Since 1938, when the R§m§nandÊs split from the R§m§nujas, the four vaißÖava samprad§ya-s have been constituted as follows (confirmed during fieldwork in 2001). 1) “rÊ (or R§m§nuja or N§thamuni) / Caudah [=14] Bh§Ê Mah§-Ty§gÊ. 2) R§m§nandÊ (or Dakor). 3) Harby§sÊ (or Nimb§rka/Sanak§dÊ) / B§rah [=12] Bh§Ê DaÖ·iya. 4) “y§m§nandÊ (or Gau·Êya/Madhva) / Terah [=13] Bh§Ê Ty§gÊ. The current formation of the catuÈ-samprad§ya-s does not correspond to the formation to be found in the important R§m§nandÊ hagiographical text, Bhaktam§la, by N§bh§d§sa (N§bh§-jÊ), written at the behest of Agra D§sa (disciple of Payah§rÊ KÜßÖa D§sa, who was a disciple of R§m§nanda) in the late sixteenth or early seventeenth century. According to Pollet (1963:11), this was between 1595 and 1624; according to Varma (1977:5), 1585; according to Snell (1991:12), possibly before 1585. In the Bhaktam§la (v. 28, l.1–5), the four samprad§ya-s are attributed to R§m§nuja, VißÖusv§mÊ, Nimb§ditya and Madhv§c§rya. Instead of the R§m§nandÊ samprad§ya, the VißÖusv§mÊ is listed as one of the four samprad§ya-s (see Pollet 1963:74, 168); it is now defunct. The VißÖusv§mÊs (Rudra samprad§ya) were almost entirely absorbed into the newer Vallabhac§rÊ order (Gokul§stha samprad§ya). Van der Veer’s (1998:110) account of the current relationship between the ‘Ty§gÊs’, ‘Mah§ty§gÊs’ and the Terah/B§rah Bh§Ês is slightly inaccurate, as it is based on earlier accounts of the catuÈ samprad§ya-s as found in the Bhaktam§la. A link between the Gau·Êya lineage of Caitanya (1486–1533) and the Madhva samprad§ya seems to have been established only in the eighteenth century, by B§ladeva Vidyabhußana (Dimock 1963:106). A total of eight sects (of followers R§m§nuja, Harid§sa, Madhva, Nimb§rka, VißÖusv§mÊ, R§m§nanda, Vallabha and Caitanya) were absorbed into the scheme of the catuÈ-samprad§ya in different stages. For an overview of the catuÈ-samprad§ya-s see Clémentin-Ojha (1992). For an interpretation of the conflict between the R§m§nandÊs and the R§m§nujÊs, which first began in 1918 and led to the most recent reclassification of the catuÈ samprad§ya, see Pinch (1998). The catuÈ samprad§ya-s were organised into systems of dv§ra-s, anÊ-s and akh§Ü§-s under the leadership of B§b§ Abhay R§m D§s in 1720, according to Sharma (1998:128–135). However, Thiel-Horstmann (unpublished paper cited by van der Veer 1988:136) believes the organisation took place in two steps during four successive conferences, in VÜnd§van (c.1713), Brahmapåri (Jaipur) (c.1726), Jaipur (1734), and Galta (east of Jaipur) (1756). It was B§l§nand who probably organised the army of n§g§-s (r§m·§l) for service to Madho Singh, regent of Jaipur. The 52 dv§ra-s (‘door’/‘gate’) or gaddÊ-s—which are essentially lineages—are assigned to places throughout India and mirror not only the 52 maÜhÊ-s of the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s (see Ch. 2.2), but also the 52 phonemes of the Sanskrit alphabet, the 52 á§kta-pÊãha-s, and the legendary 52 clans of kßatriya-s of Maharashtra. “52 varÖa-s and 18 j§ti-s”
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
55
referred to as Bair§gÊ or Vair§gÊ). The other three (of the thirteen) extant akh§Ü§-s are affiliated to the Sikh tradition. Two of these are Ud§sin akh§Ü§-s, the Baܧ (large) Ud§sin (or Baܧpañc§yatÊ Ud§sin) and the Cho㧠(small) Ud§sin (or Nay§pañc§yatÊ Ud§sin). The other Sikh-affiliated akh§Ü§ is the Nirmala akh§Ü§. Both the Ud§sin akh§Ü§-s and the Nirmala akh§Ü§ are sects which have historical connections with the Sikh movement but which nowadays function as independent organisations.9 Besides the thirteen,10 previously militant, akh§Ü§-s so
was a standard expression for describing the entire class structure of Maharashtra in the late eighteenth century; see Wagle (1997:143). The four samprad§ya-s each comprise several of the 52 dv§ra-s: R§m§nandÊ (36); Nimb§rkÊ (10); Madhva (3); VißÖusv§mÊ (3). This constitutes one of the three levels of organisation of the vaißÖava orders. Another level of organisation is the system of anÊ-s and akh§Ü§-s (which does not directly correspond to the akh§Ü§-s of the Daáan§mÊs). The three anÊ-s of the R§m§nandÊ samprad§ya are subdivided into eight akh§Ü§-s: Nirmohi (3); Digambar (2); Nirv§ÖÊ (3). The eight akh§Ü§-s are further sub-divided into eighteen sections. The D§då panth also has an akh§Ü§ (see ThielHorstmann 1991) which joins the Nirmohi anÊ for bathing at Kumbh Mel§s. The catuÈ-samprad§ya-s, which meet at the Kumbh Mel§, have an administrative body, the Akhil Bh§ratÊ Kh§ls§, which oversees 412 sub-branches known as kh§ls§-s, a system not more than 150 years old. This is a third level of organisation. 8 R§m§nandÊ ty§gÊ-s have a lifestyle and appearance almost identical to that of Daáan§mÊ n§g§-s: see van der Veer (1987:688). While the ty§gÊ-s are R§m§nandÊ asectics, the n§g§-s are soldiers who carry weapons and are given money by ty§gÊ mahant-s at mel§-s to protect the order. Technically, only the n§g§-s are said to be in the akh§Ü§. Unlike the ty§gÊ-s, R§m§nandÊ n§g§-s wear stitched cloth and do not wear jaã§. A R§m§nandÊ disciple wishing to enter an akh§Ü§ has to pass through seven levels before he becomes a vaißÖava n§g§, who is known as n§g§-atÊt: 1. y§trÊ, collects neem-sticks for his superiors, and wanders alone or with the Jam§t; 2. chor§, serves, draws water and makes leaf-plates; 3. bandagÊdar, looks after food stores, serves food and cleans n§g§-atÊt-s’ untensils; 4. huÜdaØg, cooks, offers food to the deity, calls “Harihar” (hence huÜdaØg meaning ‘commotion’ or ‘uproar’), carries the insignia and flag of the akh§Ü§, masters weapons; 5. mureãhiya, worships deities, supervises sevak-s, calls “jay” (a sequence of calls uttered before undertaking any work), and is experienced in the use of weapons; 6. n§g§, administers the akh§Ü§, worships the deity, protects the samprad§ya-’s property, leads the Jam§t, and prepares for the Kumbh Mel§; 7. atÊt, decides important issues for the order and guides n§g§-s. It takes twelve years to become n§g§, after which he may vote in the akh§Ü§, as a member of the pañc (see Sharma 1998:128–135). N§g§-s are organised in four divisions (selÊ), according to where they were initiated, the divisions being: Haridv§rÊ (at Haridv§r), UjjayinÊya (at Ujjain), S§garÊya (at GaØg§ S§gar, near Calcutta), and BasantÊya (other places) (van der Veer 1998:139). 9 The Ud§sin (Ud§sÊn/Ud§sÊ) and Nirmala akh§Ü§-s revere the Guru Granth Sahib, the Sikh text that occupies a central place in all gurdv§ra-s. The tutelary deity of both Ud§sin akh§Ü§-s is Candra Bhagv§n (believed to be an incarnation of “iva), who was “rÊ Cand, the eldest of the two sons of Guru N§nak (1469–1539). Upon N§nak’s demise, the leadership of the Sikhs passed to Guru AØgad, and not
56
chapter two
far mentioned, the N§ths are another sect which had political and military liaisons with various akh§Ü§-s in different periods. The N§ths, however, camp at a distance from the other akh§Ü§-s at Kumbh Mel§s, and bathe later than the other ‘orthodox’ akh§Ü§-s.11 Despite the to his son. According to Ud§sin tradition (Singh (1951:59–64), “rÊ Cand was initiated by N§nak and founded the Ud§sins. Although “rÊ Cand is not recognised as a guru within the Sikh guru-parampar§, neither is he rejected, and links remained strong between the communities. However, there is other historical evidence (Pinch 1996:36) that “rÊ Cand and his followers were expelled from the Sikh community in the sixteenth century. “rÊ Cand lived past the age of a hundred, up to the time of Guru Hargobind (1595–1644), the sixth guru of the Sikh tradition. This means that the Ud§sin order was founded, according to the traditional account, between—at the limits—the early part of the sixteenth century and the first decades of the seventeenth century. The gaddÊ passed from “rÊ Cand to the son of Hargobind, B§b§ Gurdita (a householder and soldier), who had four preaching disciples (masand) who founded four dhånÊ-s (dhå§n) in 1636, which are the four divisions of the Baܧ (‘large’) Ud§sin akh§Ü§. They are: 1. Balu Hasna; 2. Phul Sahib (or Mʧn Sahib); 3. Almast; 4. Bhagat Bhagv§n (or Gonda). According to one account (Singh 1951:64), Mʧn Sahib and Bhagat Bhagv§n (=Bhagat Gir, a saÒny§sÊ ) did not found dhå§n-s, but missionary centres, known as bhakßÊ-s. The Cho㧠(‘small’) Ud§sin akh§Ü§ was founded by Bh§Ê Pheru, supposedly with the permission of Guru Gobind Singh (1666–1708), who is also believed to have founded the Nirmala akh§Ü§ (Ahuja 1994). However, Oberoi (1997:124–127) questions the antiquity of the Nirmalas, observing that references to them in Sikh literature are scarce in the early eighteenth century but abundant at the end of that century. Between the 1790s and 1840s, the Ud§sin and Nirmala orders received extensive state patronage, and the number of their establishments increased five-fold. 10 An article appeared in an Allahabad newspaper (Dainik J§graÖ, Il§h§b§d, 12 January 2001, p. 3) annoucing the coming into being of the AkhaÖ· akh§Ü§, a new akh§Ü§ instituted by Sv§mÊ Param§nand, who, along with ten others, was made ‘Mah§maÖ·aleávara’ ($c§rya Mah§maÖ·aleávara Yugpuruß “rÊ Sv§mÊ Param§nand JÊ Mah§r§j). The sv§mÊ, who has published several books, has an ever expanding §árama (AkhaÖ· Param Dham) on the outskirts of Haridv§r, and is quite well known internationally. He addressed the United Nations assembly in New York on 28th August 2000, a lecture published as Transformation of Religion Based Conflicts into World Peace: Identification of Dharma and its Utility. Whether the akh§Ü§ attracts many saÒny§sÊ-s remains to be seen. 11 The N§ths (or N§th-Siddhas), also known as yogÊ-s, were supposedly organised by Gorakhn§th, most probably in the thirteenth century (see White 1996:93–100). They are haãha-yogÊ-s, renowned as wonder-workers. As power-brokers and mercenaries, they played a significant role in political and military intrigues during the seventeenth, eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, particularly in Rajasthan. For accounts of the N§ths, see Briggs (1982); Gold and Gold (1984); Gold (1996; 1999); White (1996; 2001). For resumés of the doctrine of the N§th-Siddhas, see Ramana Sastri (1956:300–308); Bannerjea (1983; 1988); Vil§sn§th (1998). See also Chapter 7. For the marginal status of the N§ths in relationship to other more ‘orthodox’ orders of ascetics, see Gupta (2001); White (1996). See Vil§sn§th (1998) for N§th parampar§-s and mantras. See Kaly§Ö (TÊrth§Øk) (1997:580–586) for N§th holy places.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
57
military background of all the akh§Ü§-s, these days ‘dharmic’ activity is generally emphasised by their main spokesmen, which includes the founding of many educational institutions with traditional Sanskrit and Vedic studies.12 The Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s are currently constituted as follows: AKH$4$-S,13 supposed founding dates V. S.)15 and Tutelary Deities
14(Vikram
SaÒvat –
1. NirañjanÊ, 960 V. S. [1904 CE]16 (K§rttikeya), founded in
12 See, for example, PurÊ (2001:198–210) on educational programmes fostered by the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§. 13 The author visited the headquarters of all the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s in Allahabad and Banaras for inquiries (during January and February 2002), and other branches in Haridv§r, OÒk§reávar, Jv§l§mukhÊ and Jån§gaÜh. The information concerning the regional branches of the akh§Ü§-s is based partly on fieldwork, with some additional points on the supposed founding places and branches provided by Sinha and Saraswati (1978:85). The information on the regional branches of the akh§Ü§-s relates to the most important branches. There are also many small maãha-s or temples owned by the akh§Ü§-s that may be administered by a single functionary of an akh§Ü§, which are not mentioned. From a number of quite unsatisfactory enquiries, an approximate estimate of the number of initiates is also given. There are also a few Daáan§mÊ institutions in Kathmandu, the main one being the “aØkar§c§rya Maãha in Deopatan, founded by R§ma Giri in 1877. See Michaels (1994:172–173) for further details. 14 Dates according to Sarkar (1958:82–90). 15 To convert traditional (Vikram SaÒvat) dates (as contained in manuscripts) to Roman dates: for the first nine and a half months of a Vikram year, subtract 57 years; for the remaining two and half months, subtract 58. 16 Sarkar’s scheme combines traditional dates, and in the case of some akh§Ü§-s, the addition of 1,000 years, indicated in the square brackets. Sarkar believes that the Portuguese system of reckoning, which adds 1,000 years to traditional dates, had not been taken into account by the bards. However, the reckoning is inconsistent: adding 1,000 years to the supposed founding date of the NirañjanÊ akh§Ü§, given as 960 V. S., would, according to Sarkar’s calculation, be 1903 CE, yet the presence of the NirañjanÊ akh§Ü§ was reported at the Kumbh Mel§ of 1840 by a Protestant missionary (Sinha and Saraswati 1978:86). For founding dates, see also Sad§nanda Giri (1976:22); Tripathi (1978:70); Sinha and Saraswati (1978:85); Dazey (1987): their repetitions are in several instances erroneous or different, adding unreliability to an account that was already declaredly unreliable. According to the Hindi newspaper, $j (Mah§kumbh ViáeߧØk, 14 January 2001), the founding dates (CE) of the akh§Ü§-s are: $v§han, 547, by Mißã Giri and DÊn§n§th Giri; Aãal, 647, by VankhaÖ·bh§ratÊ, S§garbh§ratÊ and “ivn§r§yaÖbh§ratÊ; Nirv§ÖÊ, 649; $nand, 855, by Keth§ Giri and R§meávar Giri; NirañjanÊ, 904, by MaunÊ SiÒh and Sarajån§th Purußottam Giri; Jån§, 1060, by Mohk§m Giri, Sundar Giri and MaunÊ Digambar; Agni, 1149 [no founder mentioned]. Keemattam (1997:83) cites
58
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
chapter two M§ndavÊ (Kachh, Gujarat), Head Office in Pray§g (D§r§gañj), affiliated to $nanda, contains perhaps 3,000 saÒny§sÊ-s and 500 n§g§-s. Branches in N§sik, OÒk§reávar (Madhya Pradesh), Haridv§r, Ujjain, Udaipur, Jv§l§mukhÊ (Himachal Pradesh), K§áÊ.17 Jån§, 1202 V. S. (Datt§treya [previously Bhairava]), founded at KarÖ Pray§g (Uttaranchal), affiliated to $v§han, Head Office in K§áÊ (Hanum§n Gh§ã), containing perhaps 4,000 to 5,000 saÒny§sÊ-s, mostly n§g§-s. Branches in N§sik, Ujjain, OÒk§reávar, Jån§gaÜh (Gujarat), Haridv§r, R§meávaram, Pray§g, “rÊnagar (Kashmir), Sri Lanka,18 Kathmandu (Nepal). Mah§nirv§ÖÊ,19 805 V. S. [1749 CE] (Kapil Muni), founded at GarhkuÖ·a (Pal§m§u District, Bihar),20 affiliated to Aãal, Head Office in Pray§g (D§r§gañj) $nanda, 912 V. S. (Sårya), founded at Ber§r, Head Office in K§áÊ (MaÖikarÖika Gh§ã),21 contains several hundred saÒny§sÊ-s, with perhaps 500 to 600 n§g§-s. Branches in Tryambakeávar (near N§sik, Maharashtra), PåÖe, S§t§r§ (Maharashtra), BarelÊ (Uttar Pradesh), R§mpur (Uttar Pradesh), Gvalior, Mirzapur (near Banaras), Betul (Madhya Pradesh), BarabaØki (near Lucknow). $v§han, 603 V. S. [1547 CE] (Siddh GaÖeáa),22 Head Office in K§áÊ (Daá§ávamedha Gh§ã), containing several thousand saÒny§sÊ-s, mostly n§g§. Branches in Bhuj (Kacch, Gujarat), Bodh Gay§ (Bihar), Jv§l§mukhÊ, Haridv§r.23 Aãal, 703 V. S. [1646 CE] ($di GaÖeáa), founded at Gondv§n§,
dates from P§van TÊrtha HÜßikeá by Vamáidhar Pokhriyal (Œßikeá: “rÊ Bh§ratmandir Prak§áan 1986:35): Jån§, 1202; $v§han, 1547; Aãal, 1646; Mah§nirv§ÖÊ, 1749; $nanda, 1856; NirañjanÊ, 1904. 17 K§áÊ designates the Old City, around which the larger town of Banaras (Varanasi) has developed. 18 No specific place is mentioned. 19 The akh§Ü§ is usually referred to as the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ to distinguish it from the vaißÖava Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ which is one of the three n§g§ akh§Ü§-s of the R§m§nandÊ order. 20 Other sources give the founding place of the akh§Ü§ as Baijn§th, Bihar. 21 While the K§áÊ branch is officially the headquarters of the $nanda akh§Ü§, the branch at BerelÊ (U.P.) is more frequented and active. At the time of the author’s visit to the K§áÊ branch there was only one resident s§dhu. 22 It is unclear where this akh§Ü§ is supposed to have been founded. 23 Sinha and Saraswati add to this list, “sundry centres in South India”, without being specific.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
59
Head Office in K§áÊ (Katuapura). Branches in Tryambakeávar, BaÜaud§, Ujjain and Haridv§r. Smallest of the akh§Ü§-s with less than 1,000 saÒny§sÊ-s. 7. Agni, 1426 V. S.24 (G§yatrÊ), Head Office in K§áÊ (R§j Gh§ã). Branches in Jån§gaÜh, BarelÊ, Ahmad§b§d, Jh§nsÊ, Haridv§r, SamastÊpur (Bihar), Bhopal, Indore, Ujjain, J§mnagar (Gujarat) and Tryambakeávar, containing 1,000 to 2,000 saÒny§sÊ-s. The n§g§-s of each Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§ revere the bh§l§ (a fifteen to twenty-foot-long javelin), which is engraved with the signs of the respective deities of the akh§Ü§-s and carried at the front of the arrival and bathing processions (sy§hi) at the Kumbh Mel§s by the chief mahant or by n§g§-s. The bh§l§ is usually kept in the headquarters of the akh§Ü§ it represents, but during Mel§s it is planted in the ground near the temporary shrine for the tutelary deity, at the centre of the akh§Ü§-’s camping area.25 During processions, the current chief mahant of the akh§Ü§ is followed by other mahant-s, old n§g§-s26 and recent n§g§ initiates (ã§ng to·e),27 in that order. The Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s have particular ties with each other, though they are not historically invariable.28 The leading akh§Ü§-s, in terms of members and property, are the NirañjanÊ and Jån§, the Jån§ being
24 This date is supplied by Sad§nanda Giri (1976:42) with no reference, and maintained by several saÒny§sÊ-s in the akh§Ü§. 25 Each Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§ has traditionally made use of a ball of ash, known as a gol§. This ball was formerly sent to sent kings or military chiefs as test of political allegiance. If the ashes were smeared on the forehead, in the way that s§dhu-s do, then the recipient was regarded as friendly, but a refusal to do so was a sign of enmity. The shape of a gol§ is round for the NirañjanÊ, liØga-shaped for the Jån§, four-cornered for the Nirv§ÖÊ, and octagonal for the Aãal. Many of the sources, previously referred to for information on the Daáan§mÊs, record this historical tradition. PurÊ (2001:137) provides mantras for the gol§. However, from various inquiries made by this author, it seems that the custom is not current and but vaguely understood by contemporary Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s. 26 N§g§-s initiated at Ujjain are known as khånÊ (‘killer’) n§g§-s, those initiated at Haridv§r as barf§nÊ (‘icy’) n§g§-s, and those initiated at Pray§ga as r§jar§jeávarÊ (‘lord of the king of kings’) n§g§-s. 27 See Ch. 3.3 for an explanation of this term. 28 Sinha and Saraswati (1978:84) note that after the 1954 Kumbh Mel§ the Jån§ and NirañjanÊ came closer together. Relations between the Nirv§ÖÊ and Aãal are said to have become somewhat distant owing to a dispute concerning the selection of a female MaÖ·aleávara. The current ties between akh§Ü§-s are: $v§han and Jån§; $nand and NirañjanÊ; Aãal and (Mah§) Nirv§ÖÊ. The Agni akh§Ü§ always functions independently.
60
chapter two
the oldest and having the largest number of n§g§-s. The other two akh§Ü§-s that have a high percentage of n§g§-s are the NirañjanÊ and the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ. The seventh akh§Ü§, the Agni akh§Ü§, is supposed to have been founded in 1368 CE and has fifteen branches. Like the other akh§Ü§-s, it is nominally áaiva in orientation. All members are life-long celibates and refer to themselves as brahmac§rÊ, distinguishing themselves, by that name, from the other akh§Ü§-s. (DaÖ·Ê-s also refer to themselves as brahmac§rÊ to distinguish themselves from other Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s.) Being known as brahmac§rÊ-s means, also, that members of the Agni akh§Ü§ come, at least theoretically, from a Brahman caste. Unlike the other akh§Ü§-s, which are comprised largely of n§g§-s, none of the members of the Agni akh§Ü§ are n§g§. The Agni akh§Ü§ is not connected to the maÜhÊ29 network of the other akh§Ü§-s and only attained equal status with the other saÒny§sÊ akh§Ü§-s in 1971 when, during the $dh§ Kumbh Mel§ at Pray§g, Brahmac§rÊ Prak§á§nanda was installed as the Mah§maÖ·aleávara of the akh§Ü§. There are currently three Mah§maÖ·aleávaras affiliated to the Agni akh§Ü§, the §c§rya-guru residing in AmarkaÖãak (Madhya Pradesh).30 As previously noted, unlike in the other akh§Ü§-s, a guru will take only one cel§, in the manner common to many other renunciate lineages. SaÒny§sÊ-s of the Agni akh§Ü§ do not take one of the usual Daáan§mÊ ‘ten names’, instead taking one of the names of what they describe as brahmac§rÊ gotra-s, namely $nanda, Caitan, Svaråp or Prak§áa. According to Sarkar (1958:82), the earliest available information concerning the formation of the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s comes from an oral tradition that can be dated to around 1750, and derives from Rajendra Giri who became famous in the affairs of the Delhi Sultanate (see Ch. 7.4). All the akh§Ü§-s have a hereditary bard (bh§ã) who can recite the oral history of the akh§Ü§. Sarkar inspected a manuscript in the possession of the bh§ã of the Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§, detailing the foundation of the akh§Ü§-s, the succession of pontiffs (mahant-s) and the battles that the akh§Ü§-s fought. He estimated that the manuscript could not have been much more than fifty years old, and while admitting that 29
See following section. The Agni akh§Ü§ is nominally under the jurisdiction of the Dv§rak§ pÊãha, and traces its origin to the four sons of Brahm§: Sanaka, Sanatkum§ra, Sanandana and San§tana, dividing its members (theoretically) between three areas: Narmad§khaÖ·Ê (Narmad§), UttarakhaÖ·Ê (northern), and Naißãhika (‘faithful’). Some daÖ·Ê-saÒny§sÊ-s reported to the author that the Agni akh§Ü§ functions as the akh§Ü§ for the daÖ·Ê-s. However, this is denied by the saÒny§sÊ-s of the Agni akh§Ü§. 30
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
61
the information is unreliable, gives the dates for the foundation of the akh§Ü§-s as detailed above. Sarkar (1958:83) further cautions that the record (pothÊ) is from but one akh§Ü§ and that other akh§Ü§-s may possess quite different records. Notwithstanding Sarkar’s caution, his publication (1958:82–85) of the putative dates of the founding of the akh§Ü§-s (as above) has entered many accounts, albeit inaccurately. This is no doubt largely due to the fact that Sarkar’s account stands, still today, as virtually the only published account to be based on any kind of written record.31 While it is probable that ascetic lineages do indeed go back to the seventh century or beyond, firm evidence for the founding of akh§Ü§-s, and their identity with lineages organised by “aØkara, cannot be found before the sixteenth century.32 Concerning the question of when orders of fighting saÒny§sÊ-s may have been organised, it seems most probable that between the late sixteenth and eighteenth centuries, a variety of political factors—that are explored in Chapter 7—led to the formation of various akh§Ü§-s of fighting ascetics, including the Ud§sin, Nirmala, D§då, Bair§gÊ (R§m§nandÊ) and Daáan§mÊ orders, notwithstanding the latter’s claims to greater antiquity. It is suggested that during this period when the akh§Ü§-s formed, the Daáan§mÊs also formed their own distinct (and orthodox) identity, comprising ten lineages from quite disparate backgrounds, one group comprising lineages from the monastic tradition, and the other group comprising lineages with a N§th or ‘heterodox’ background. Beginning in the latter part of the sixteenth century, for the first time there are recorded conflicts between the akh§Ü§-s, most frequently between
31
PurÊ (2001:83–90), a mahant of the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§, also gives the founding dates of the akh§Ü§-s, citing evidence from hand-written pothÊ-s. He claims that the first akh§Ü§ to be founded was the $v§han, in 603 vikram (V. S.), the other akh§Ü§-s subsequently. His information on the dating and some other details concerning places is almost identical to that provided by Sarkar. (PurÊ’s dating reflects his belief that “aØkara was born in 44 BCE.) However, having provided precise dates for the founding of the akh§Ü§-s and a list of the founding saÒny§sÊ-s, he remarks (p. 89) that some people are doubtful about the founding dates. But, he maintains, it is certain that the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ was established by the sixteenth century, even though according to his earlier account it was founded in 805 V. S. by eight mah§purußa-s connected with the Aãal akh§Ü§. In evidence, he cites a battle in Bihar in 1664 CE between Aurangzeb and the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§, who had come from Banaras. 32 Intriguingly, all the akh§Ü§-s possess voluminous written records, mostly concerning financial transactions recorded on parc§ (birch-bark), which are not available for inspection even to relatively high-ranking officials within the akh§Ü§.
62
chapter two
Daáan§mÊ-saÒny§sÊ-s and bair§gÊ-s33 over bathing priorities at mel§-s and rights to collect taxes from pilgrims. Perhaps the earliest record of a fight between identifiable akh§Ü§-s is that of Abu-l-Faíl, who records (1972:422–424) how, on one occasion, during the latter part of the sixteenth century, emperor Akbar was camped at Th§nesar (Sth§ÖvÊávara), near Kurukßetra, at the time of the mel§ there.34 A fight ensued between the PurÊ and Kur (or Gur, Giri?) saÒny§sÊ-s over occupation of an area by the lake, particularly suitable for the collection of alms from pilgrims. The PurÊs, believing that they had been wrongfully usurped by the Kurs, approached Akbar for assistance. Akbar’s solicitations to the parties were to no effect. As the PurÊs were few in number, Akbar enlisted the assistance of some other tribes35 on behalf of the PurÊs who routed the Kurs, slaying their leader (pÊr), $nanda Kur. The combatants numbered around one thousand, and the dead around twenty (Smith 1966:57). Akbar was, apparently, delighted by the sport. In the Dabist§n (Dabist§n 1843, Vol. 2:196–197), a battle that took place at Haridv§r in 1640 between Bair§gÊs (also referred to as ‘MundÊs’) and ‘Sany§sis’ is described. According to the account, the saÒny§sÊ-s were victorious and killed a great number of MundÊs. The MundÊs thew away the rosaries of tulsÊ beads and “hung on their perforated ears the rings of the JogÊs, in order to be taken for these sectaries”. The author of the Dabist§n (Dabist§n 1843, Vol. 2:231) also refers to a battle between ‘Sany§sis’ and ‘SÙfÊs’, the former being victorious.36 33
A conflict between saÒny§sÊ-s and SåfÊs is also recorded (see Dabist§n 1843, Vol. 2:231). 34 The same incident is referred to slightly differently by Al-Bad§oni (1986, Vol. 2:94–95), who describes the two parties of combatants as “JogÊs” and “Sanny§sÊs”, who are said to be “in the habit of fighting there in their bigotry”. At the emperor’s command, a number of soldiers smeared their bodies with ashes and fought on the side of the “Sanny§sÊs” (numbering around 300), against the “JogÊs” (numbering more than 500). Many were slain on both sides, but the saÒny§sÊ-s were victorious. Akbar’s son Jah§ngir is also said to have witnessed a battle between Ud§sin and Vair§gÊ s§dhu-s over bathing at the mel§ (PurÊ 2001:181). 35 These tribes are recorded as the Petamcah§ (unknown to commentators) and the CÊrås, a wild tribe from Mirzapur. 36 The saÒny§sÊ-s had assembled at a Hindu pilgrimage site (unspecified), when an army of naked Jelalis and Mad§ris (sects of SåfÊs) arrived, bringing a cow that they wished to slaughter. To avert the slaughter, the saÒny§sÊ-s bought the cow. However, the SåfÊs brought a second cow, which was also purchased. A third cow was brought, and killed, engendering a battle in which 700 SåfÊs died. The boys
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
63
In 1760 bair§gÊ-s and saÒny§sÊ-s fought pitched battles in Haridv§r over bathing precedence, with 1,800 dead, the saÒny§sÊ-s again being victorious (Russell 1916, Vol. 3:152; Nevill 1909a:254). In that year the British took control of the Haridv§r area, and the Bair§gÊs were then reportedly banned from the Haridv§r mel§ for forty years (Lochtefeld 1994:597). The dominance of the áaiva gosain-s in the area around Haridv§r may have been partly due to the stationing in 1752 of the gosain Rajendra Giri, a powerful miltary commander,37 as commander of forces (faujd§r) at Saharanpur, under the Mughal emperor Ahmad “§h. The dominance of the áaiva gosain-s at Haridv§r, in trade, policing and taxation, appears to have continued largely unchallenged until the end of the eighteenth century. In April 1796 an English officer, Captain Thomas Hardwicke, accompanied by Dr. Hunter, visited the Haridv§r Mel§ on the way to “rÊnagar (Hardwicke 1801:309–347). They attended Makar SaØkr§nti, which fell on April 8th that year. Pilgrims had come from as far as K§bul, Bhut§n and Kashmir. The “Goosseyns” (also referred to as “Mehunts”, “Fakeers” and “Sannyassees”) had set themselves up as the police for the mel§, meeting daily to hear grievances and adjudicate, and collecting levies on cattle, merchandise and pilgrims at the bathing places, taxes that would normally have gone to the Mar§ãhas who were governing the region at that time. Wielding swords, they had effectively silenced all opposition to their regime, including that of the rival bair§gÊ-s. On the last day of the mel§, April 10th, between 12,000 and 14,000 Sikh horsemen arrived and planted their flag near the river. The gosain-s took down the flag and plundered the Sikh party. The Sikhs sent a lawyer to the mahant-s, protesting their right to bathe and seeking the return of their looted property. The property was returned but the Sikhs attacked the ascetics at the bathing places, including the bair§gÊ-s, saÒny§sÊ-s and n§g§-s. Panic ensued, in which several drowned. The Sikhs lost twenty men but killed 500.38 According to a copper-plate inscription in the possession of Mahant
amongst the ‘fanatics’ were taken prisoner and educated “in their own religion” by the saÒny§sÊ-s. 37 See Chapter 7.4. 38 Pinch has commented that at this time the Sikhs were on the verge of statehood in nearby Punjab, under Ranjit Singh. They may well have been exercising territorial muscle at Haridv§r on this occasion.
64
chapter two
R§dh§mohand§sjÊ of N§sik (Ghurye 1964:177), a great massacre of bair§gÊ-s by áaiva saÒny§sÊ-s took place at the SiÒh§ßãa Mel§ at N§sik in 1690. Both sects were bathing at the same place, CakratÊrtha, and subsequently an arrangement was made whereby at the mel§ of 1702, the two orders bathed at different places—the “aÒny§sÊs at Tryambaka Kuáavarta and the bair§gÊ-s at R§makuÖ·a—an arrangement that still continues. This incident, if true, may have been an important impetus for the organisation of the bair§gÊ-s’ akh§Ü§-s. At the SiÒh§ßãa Mel§ at Ujjain in 1789 a dispute between saÒny§sÊ-s and bair§gÊ-s led to intense fighting. The Peáv§ eventually ruled that the two orders should bathe at separate places (Burghart 1983:374). However, at the mel§ in 1826, another battle ensued between the two sects. The bair§gÊ-s, assisted by the Mar§ãhas, slaughtered many of the saÒny§sÊ-s and plundered their temples and monasteries in the vicinity of the city. Mindful of potentially bloody consequences, the British made elaborate arrangements for policing the Ujjain Mel§ of 1850, which included the positioning of heavy guns along the procession route, and the deployment of two companies of the Gwalior Infantry under Captain Macpherson. The more powerful bair§gÊ-s were separated from the saÒny§sÊ-s, who were instructed to bathe earlier than the bair§gÊ-s, and in a separate area. One hundred Brahmans were stationed (as ‘human shields’) between the two parties to assist with the bathing arrangements, which passed off without significant incident. It appears that the order of bathing for the akh§Ü§-s was fixed first in Haridv§r, and then subsequently in Allahabad in 1870 (Maclean 2003:888). Eventually, an agreement was signed with the British in 1906 (Nandan 2002:58), which is still adhered to.39 While there are records—particularly in the eighteenth century—of conflicts at Haridv§r, Ujjain and N§sik, there is no record in any account of any significant confrontation at Allahabad. Given the strategic importance of the Allahabad fort—adjacent to the saØgam—which was first garrisoned by British troops in 1765,40 if there had been
39
See Rai (1993:25–26); Sarkar (1958:99). The fort was built by Akbar in 1584 CE. In 1765 CE, as part of the Treaty of Allahabad (between the East India Company, Shuja-ud-Daula and emperor “§h Al§m), the fort was occupied by British troops to protect the emperor. After its cession by S§dat Ali to the British in February 1798, the fort became, briefly, in 1832, the capital of the North-West Provinces (Maclean 2001:142–144). 40
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
65
any serious conflict there, it would no doubt have been recorded in a British report. Maclean (2003:895–896) suggests that the reason for the absence of conflict at Allahabad may have been that the Haridv§r mel§ was a larger commercial market than Allahabad for trader-s§dhu-s, and that dominance of trade and taxation by one sect or another led to bathing privileges.41 By contrast, Allahabad was a smaller commercial fair, and it was the nav§b-s and then the British, and not s§dhu-s, who taxed pilgrims. In 1938, the Uttar Pradesh State Legislature gave legal sanction for government participation in funding and overseeing the two Kumbh Mel§s in the state, at Pray§g and Haridv§r.42 After Indian Independence, the U.P. government developed more permanent rules for the financial support and administration of both the Kumbh and $dh§ Kumbh Mel§s (Lamb 1999:196). Despite control over bathing priorities, there are still occasions of disturbance. Low (1906:193–210), visiting the Kumbh Mel§ at Pray§ga in 1906, records that the most turbulent of the attending sects and akh§Ü§-s are the Bair§gÊs, who on this occasion caused a riot, to quell which the police called out the army. More recently, at Haridv§r, in 1998, rioting ensued amongst the Daáan§mÊs over bathing priorities. Besides the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s mentioned above, some commentators discuss other akh§Ü§-s, none of which are now recognised 41 Lochtefeld (1994:596–597) suggests that changes in trading routes led to the growing importance of the major annual fair at Haridv§r (which was also the largest horse market in India). The fair coincided with the bathing festival and it seems probable that control over trade and the market-place influenced status and bathing priority. 42 Mela Act 1938; Mela Rules 1940 (Nandan 2002:12). At Kumbh Mel§s, a total of six processions are allowed (two for Daáan§mÊs), the akh§Ü§-s to follow at a hundred yards distance. The order of bathing is currently as follows: At Pray§ga and Ujjain: first, Mah§nirv§ÖÊ with Aãal second, NirañjanÊ with $vahan, Jån§ with $nanda third, Nirmohi, Digambara and Nirv§ÖÊ (the three R§m§nandÊ/Bair§gÊ akh§Ü§-s) fourth, Cho㧠Ud§sin fifth, Baܧ Ud§sin sixth, Nirmala At Haridv§r and N§sik: first, Jån§, NirañjanÊ, $nand and $v§han second, Mah§nirv§ÖÊ and Aãal third, fourth, fifth and sixth, as above
66
chapter two
amongst Daáan§mÊs. These akh§Ü§-s have been either confused with another branch of the Daáan§mÊs, are now defunct, or are what seem to have been branches of N§ths. Ghurye (1964:106–108) states that besides the usual six akh§Ü§-s, there are four other akh§Ü§-s: the Agan, Alakhiya,43 SåkhaÜa and GådaÜa akh§Ü§-s, all of which are said to be attached to the Jån§ akh§Ü§. He also considers it is possible that three ‘akh§Ü§-s’, the SåkhaÜa, —khaÜa and another so-called akh§Ü§-s, the RåkhaÜa, mentioned by Wilson (1861:148–149)—who also mentions the BhukaÜa and KukaÜa akh§Ü§-s but gives no details—are perhaps all to be considered as just one akh§Ü§, the SåkhaÜa, which seems to have been an order of N§ths.44 Sinha and Saraswati (1987:82–83) also include in the list of Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s the GådaÜa akh§Ü§, said to have been founded in K§áÊ in 1617, on the evidence of an inscription. This brings Sinha and Saraswati’s total number of Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s to eight.45 However, the GådaÜa akh§Ü§ also appears to have been a sect of N§ths.46
43 The Agan akh§Ü§ (recognised by Ghurye as a cognate of the Sanskrit term agni ) is said not to be connected with “proper” Daáan§mÊs or n§g§-s. Even though the Agni akh§Ü§ did not gain full status as an akh§Ü§ until 1971, it seems highly unlikely that the Agni sub-branch did not consider themselves as Daáan§mÊs at the time Ghurye was writing, in the early nineteen-fifties. (Sinha and Saraswati (1978:86) note that the Agni akh§Ü§ was built in Banaras in 1957.) Ghurye admits puzzlement over the Alakhiya akh§Ü§, noting that they beg for alms and carry long tongs. By way of clarification: the Alakhiyas may be seen at any large assembly of akh§Ü§-s. They usually wear hats embellished with peacock feathers and have rope coiled around their waist over a tunic. They are often married and might be considered as a sub-sect of the Daáan§mÊs. A particular role they have is to sing and drum at mel§-s, sometimes proceeding from one dhånÊ to the next, collecting flour and money for the akh§Ü§ in skull-shaped coconuts (kapard), singing on such themes as saÒny§sÊ life, God, and the delights of cannabis intoxication. 44 Grierson (1916:866–867) also discusses the RåkhaÜa, SåkhaÜa and —khaÜa divisions, believing them to be branches of the K§nphaãa order of yogÊ-s (N§ths or N§th-Siddhas). 45 They add that the GådaÜa and Agni akh§Ü§-s are not considered as having the same status as the other six akh§Ü§-s, and that they perform “certain functions” for the other akh§Ü§-s. The GådaÜa akh§Ü§ is stated to perform mortuary rites for the other akh§Ü§-s. Enquiries at and near the address supplied by Sinha and Saraswati (1978:248), at Pitambarpura, K§áÊ, failed to establish their previous existence there. 46 Wilson (1861:148–149) and Briggs (1938:10–11) state that the GådaÜas wear the earrings or a piece of wood passed through the lobe of the ear, as worn by the K§nphaãas. Briggs adds that in one ear they may also wear a flat copper plate with the imprint of Gorakhn§th. They carry a small metal pan in which they burn scented wood. This is carried when begging. They are said to belong to the
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
67
Several scholars have suggested that some of the n§g§ lineages of the akh§Ü§-s may have derived from N§th, Siddha or similarly Tantric-influenced orders.47 Sinha and Saraswati (1978:92) discuss the possibility of N§th antecedents,48 and note that at the sam§dhi of BhartÜhari, in the fort at Chunar, N§ths and saÒny§sÊ-s from the Jån§ akh§Ü§ take turns officiating as priests and mahant-s. They mention the common worship of both Bhairava and Datt§treya by the N§ths and the Jån§ akh§Ü§ (who previously worshipped Bhairava, but now Datt§treya), the use of and reverence for the dhånÊ (sacred fire) by both n§g§-s and N§ths, the common but not universal use of earrings, and the fact that many names that occur in the list of maÜhÊ-s contain the ending ‘n§th’ (see Appendix 4). While it seems probable that N§ths and the Daáan§mÊ lineages of the akh§Ü§-s had some kind of common ancestry, it should, however, be cautioned that reverence for the dhånÊ is not exclusive to the two orders. However, it will be argued that the structure of the Daáan§mÊs, in the form into which it evolved in the last few hundred years, is partially a consequence of the integration of quite radical ascetic lineages within the order, many of which could have had common ancestry in N§th or ‘Tantric’ lineages. It could be that the adoption of Datt§treya to supplant the previous tutelary deity, Bhairava,49 represented the integration of radical ascetic lineages within a newly constituted and orthodox Daáan§mÊ order.
Aughar sect of “aivites founded by a Daáan§mÊ named Brahmagiri, through the favour of Gorakhn§th. 47 Dazey (1990:303), for example, comments that the n§g§-s were most likely a separate sect of áaiva ascetics who were converted to advaita philosophy and incorported into the Daáan§mÊ fold early in the mediaeval period. However, he does not expand on this point. 48 See also Dazey (1990:305–306); Rigopoulos (1998:97). Visuvalingam (1989:159, 213 fn. 15) incorrectly attributes the view to Lorenzen (1972:46) that the Daáan§mÊs may have been K§p§likas converted by “aØkara. Lorenzen castes doubt on that claim, first made by Ghurye (1964:104), particularly on the issue of the putative transition from the K§p§lika faith (sic.) to Ved§nta. There are also connections between the Daáan§mÊs and the Ud§sins, the latter also having historical associations with the N§ths. All three sects worship the dhånÊ, and adhere to advaita philosophy. There is also a tradition that a Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ, Bhakta Giri, was the first to take initiation from “rÊ Cand, the founder of the Ud§sin panth (Sinha and Saraswati 1978:138). 49 Most commentators agree on the change of tutelary deity, but I have been unable to establish exactly when that took place.
68
chapter two 2.2 MaÜhÊ-s and d§v§-s
Six of the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s (excluding the Agni akh§Ü§) are essentially the main organisational bodies for the Daáan§mÊ n§g§-s, and comprise a network of a total of fifty-two maÜhÊ-s (a ‘small hut’ or ‘temple’ in Hindi), which function as lineages within the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s. There is some inconsitency in the available literature concerning the identity of individual maÜhÊ-s and their significance.50 DaÖ·Ê-s, being outside the akh§Ü§ system in terms of allegiance and organisation, do not recognise the maÜhÊ classification. As mentioned previously, within the overall Daáan§mÊ structure there are essentially two main lineage traditions which, as we will see, come together during initiation procedures. One set of lineage traditions, comprising the n§g§-s, many of the paramahaÒsa-s and associated saÒny§sÊ-s, is constituted within the maÜhÊ-s of the akh§Ü§. The other set of lineages is represented in the monastic traditions of the daÖ·Ê-s. The lineages of the akh§Ü§-s are also known as n§d vaÒá (‘sound’ lineage), as it is the mantra-guru who initiates the saÒny§sÊ into the akh§Ü§.51 The other lineage is known as the viraj§ vaÒá. The viraj§-homa—which is examined in Chapter 3.3—is an essential feature of Daáan§mÊ initiations, performed by an §c§rya-guru who is a representative of the monastic tradition. The term maÜhÊ may have derived from the term maãha,52 and it has been suggested by some commentators that there were fiftytwo principal maãha-s before the six n§g§ akh§Ü§-s were formed. PurÊ (2001:58) claims that the fifty-two (or fifty-one) maÜhÊ-s are based on fifty-two centres (kendra) that were adjacent to the fifty-two á§ktapÊãha-s,53 but that precise information connecting the pÊãha-s to the maÜhÊ-s is not available. He also comments that in colloquial langage, a á§kta-pÊãha is referred to as devÊ kÊ maÜhÊ (maÜhÊ of the devÊ). While acknowledging the Ved§nta philosophy of “aØkara, PurÊ also maintains that “aØkara worshipped “rÊ-vidy§ (Tantra), and wrote related works. These days also, particular saÒny§sÊ-s are said to “worship
50 51 52
See Appendix 4 for lists of maÜhÊ-s and d§v§-s. See Ch. 3.2. Ghurye (1964:106) maintains that maÜhÊ is a vernacular diminutive of
maãha. 53 For overviews of “akti-pÊãha-s, see Sirkar (1973); Tattv§loka (1994); Kaly§Ö (Tirth§Øk) (1997:515–527).
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
69
the devÊ”, in other words, engage in some kind of Tantric practice.54 The fifty-two maÜhÊ-s are further divided into either four or eight divisions (d§v§),55 each of which has several mahant-s. D§v§ means ‘claim’ and derives from voting procedures within the akh§Ü§ whereby maÜhÊ-s within a d§v§ have equal voting rights during the process of electing officials and mahant-s within the akh§Ü§. This takes place at Kumbh Mel§s, for all akh§Ü§-s, every three or six years, when all official positions within the akh§Ü§ are subject to election. This is the only time when the d§v§-s have a practical significance. N§g§-s and the other saÒny§sÊ-s of the akh§Ü§ trace their lineage through the mahant-s of the d§v§-s, each of whom belongs to a particular maÜhÊ. Unlike the complete account of fifty-two distinct maÜhÊ-s and eight d§v§-s presented by several commentators, not all maÜhÊ-s are currently represented at Kumbh Mel§s. Whereas the maÜhÊ-s represent ‘real’ lineages of gurus and disciples, the d§v§-s are units of administration that function at Kumbh Mel§s for voting purposes. The maÜhÊ-s are lineages of gurus, mahant-s and s§dhu-s who, through association and initiation, transmit doctrines, practices and esoteric knowledge. Lineages of such a kind in the Indian tradition are generally notoriously complex given not only the problems inherent in hagiography but also the manifold tendencies of lineages both to subdivide and also, in some cases, to amalgamate. A guru might have several disciples, one or several of whom may form a sub-lineage, with perhaps the same name, say Giri or PurÊ, and to a greater or lesser extent be affiliated with other sub-branches within the family to which an initiating guru may have belonged. Every non-daÖ·Ê Daáan§mÊ maãha is headed by a mahant whose lineage will be traced, at least theoretically, to a maÜhÊ.56 The maÜhÊ-s are usually referred
54
In a recent personal communication, this was confirmed by a westerner who was initiated into the Jån§ akh§Ü§ in March 2001. His n§g§ guru and associates perform Tantric rites at their Himalayan §árama. 55 See Appendix 4. 56 However, PurÊ (who is affiliated with the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§) also accounts (2001:58–59) for all the ‘ten names’ within the maÜhÊ scheme, despite the fact that the specifically daÖ·Ê lineages, namely TÊrtha, $árama and SarasvatÊ (and half of the Bh§ratÊs) are usually not classified within the maÜhÊ system, as the daÖ·Ê tradition is distinct. According to PurÊ: 1. TÊrthas merged with two maÜhÊ-s of the Giris. 2. $áramas merged with two maÜhÊ-s of the Giris. Thus, the original twenty-three maÜhÊ-s of Giris were augmented by four maÜhÊ-s, comprising TÊrthas and $áramas, giving rise to the twenty-seven maÜhÊ-s of Giris.
70
chapter two
to by number, thus, for example, as the fourth or thirteenth maÜhÊ. Initiates know from the number which maÜhÊ and hence lineage is being referred to.57 It can be seen at a Kumbh Mel§ how the arrangement of the maÜhÊ-s and d§v§-s is represented spatially. (It has been described to the author as representing a yantra.) When camping at the Kumbh Mel§, there are four ropes attached to the roof of the small, temporary temple housing the mårti of the akh§Ü§. The ropes lead in the four cardinal directions, each divided sector (d§v§) representing groupings of the various maÜhÊ-s. Representatives of the maÜhÊ-s are
3. AraÖyas merged with four maÜhÊ-s of the PurÊs. Thus, the original twelve maÜhÊ-s of PurÊs were augmented by four maÜhÊ-s of PurÊs. 4. Parvatas, S§garas and SarasvatÊs have no maÜhÊ-s. 57 The fifty-one (or fifty-two) maÜhÊ-s currently are constituted as follows: Twenty-seven of the maÜhÊ-s are Giri; in one group are thirteen maÜhÊ-s (Meghn§thpanth); and in another group, fourteen maÜhÊ-s ($p§rn§th-panth). One other maÜhÊ attached to the Giris is known as the cho㧠maÜhÊ. (The activities of the members of this maÜhÊ are not regarded entirely favourably by other Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs. Anecdotally described as the n§g§ ‘mafia’, they often reside near railway stations, are said to be armed and to have an extensive information network.) Sixteen of the maÜhÊ-s are PurÊs. Four of the maÜhÊ-s are Bh§ratÊs Four of the maÜhÊ-s are Vanas. One maÜhÊ is L§m§. The L§m§ maÜhÊ mentioned in the lists does not figure in the contemporary constitution of active Daáan§mÊ lineages. However, one explanation (L§l PurÊ 2001:58, 73) is that the L§m§ maÜhÊ was instituted in Tibet by one Ved Giri, whose guru is believed by some saÒny§sÊ-s to have been Padmasambhava (=Kamal Giri: as in Sanskrit, kamala and padma both mean ‘lotus’). According to tradition, Padmasambhava—the famous Tantric yogÊ and siddha—was initiated into Buddhist Cakra-Yoga by a d§kinÊ, came to Tibet in the eighth century at the invitation of King KhriStrong-Ide-brtsan in order to assist the establishment of the first Buddhist monastery and to suppress local deities, and was the putative transmitter of the Bardo Thödol. During the twelfth century there appeared the first signs of an order identifying itself with the first diffusion of Buddhism, calling itself the rNying-ma Order, the ‘old order’, and retrospectively claiming the siddha Padmasambhava as its founder (see Govinda 1960:190; Skilton 1997:188). As a siddha—who have a collective religious heritage spanning N§th, Mah§nubh§va, Buddhist and Tantric traditions—it is not inconceivable that a lineage of ‘N§ths’ deriving from Padmasambhava became the L§m§ maÜhÊ, though Padmasambhava is hagiographically ubiquitous. The division of the maÜhÊ-s (as above) is accepted, with minor differences, by most commentators. However, there is a minor disagreement between PurÊ (2001) and some informants, the latter maintaining that it is the SarasvatÊs who constitute one of the c§r maÜhÊ-s (the other being the Bh§ratÊ), while according to PurÊ, the two c§r maÜhÊ-s constitute the Bh§ratÊs and Vanas.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
71
put forward during election to offices within the akh§Ü§. At Kumbh Mel§s, the dhånÊ-s of the s§dhu-s are arranged in lines, all dhånÊ-s being positioned in one or another of the four (or sometimes eight) sections (d§v§) of camping area of an akh§Ü§. (The dhånÊ-s are also referred to as maÜhÊ-s.) S§dhu-s belonging to a particular maÜhÊ will be camped in an area alongside s§dhu-s from that maÜhÊ or a related maÜhÊ. The related maÜhÊ-s constitute a particular d§v§ or section of the akh§Ü§.58 Initiates in particular maÜhÊ-s may be grouped together as a panthÊ (meaning: ‘follower or master of a particular sect’). Thus, for example, amongst the maÜhÊ-s of the Giris there are two subdivisions, known as the Meghn§th panthÊ and the $p§rn§th panthÊ. Initiates of maÜhÊ number four and maÜhÊ number ten belong to the $p§rn§th panthÊ, whereas the maÜhÊ-s of the Giris, which are grouped under the R§mdattÊ and Œddhin§thÊ d§v§-s, are included within the Meghn§th panthÊ. In essence, the panthÊ-s are simply another indication of historical lineage.59 PurÊ (2001:58–59) maintains that the maÜhÊ-s were instituted “some
58 At Kumbh Mel§s the camping arrangements for the Jån§ akh§Ü§ are as follows: members of the sixteen lineages (solah maÜhÊ) of PurÊs camp to the right of the entrance to the camp, in the north-east quarter; members of fourteen of the lineages of Giris (caudah maÜhÊ) camp in the north-western quarter; members of thirteen lineages (terah maÜhÊ) of the Giris camp in the south-west quarter; members of the four Bh§ratÊ and SarasvatÊ lineages (c§r maÜhÊ) camp to the left of the camp entrance, in the south-east quarter. Camped separately are the cho㧠maÜhÊ. The four mahant-s of the the Jån§ akh§Ü§ camp at the four corners around the centrally located aßãadh§tu-mårti (image made from eight metals) of Datt§treya, the tutelary deity of the akh§Ü§. In the central area around the shrine, the weapons and strong-box of the akh§Ü§ are kept. The four sacred javelins (bh§l§) of the akh§Ü§-s are planted here: the Dattaprak§áa Bh§l§ from Ujjain; Såryaprak§áa Bh§l§ from Pray§g; Candraprak§áa Bh§l§ from N§sik; and the BhairoÒprak§áa Bh§l§ from Haridv§r. According to tradition, there are also four dhånÊ-s: DattamukhÊ, Ujjain; SåryamukhÊ, Pray§g; Gop§l, N§sik; and Ajayanegh, Haridv§r (see Daá N§m VaÒs VÜkß). 59 90% of a settled caste of saÒny§sÊ-s (all Giris) living to the east of Kathmandu, in Kattike (see Bouillier 1976; 1979) belong to what they describe as the “Aparnati thar” (Bouillier 1979:106), which is clearly a legacy of the $p§rn§th panthÊ. In their community thar functions essentially as a marker of exogamous lineage, which is, naturally, particularly important for marriages. While 75% of their marriages are with those from the other thar to be found in Kattike, the AØkh§rÊ, Bouillier (1979:179) remarks that, although her list was not complete, she was informed of five functioning thar-s, the Durg§n§thÊ, Riddhin§thÊ, Aparn§thÊ, AØkh§rÊ and Bodhla. With the exception of the AØkh§rÊ, the other four thar-s feature (see Appendix 4) in the conventional classification of the maÜhÊ-s of the Giris.
72
chapter two
generations” after “aØkara, but observes that there is disagreement about when that was. He believes that maÜhÊ-s were organised by the disciples of the four main disciples of “aØkara, the earliest being the Giri maÜhÊ-s that were instituted in the tenth century CE, followed in the next couple of centuries by the other maÜhÊ-s. According to PurÊ, an important figure in the early organisation of the maÜhÊ-s is VaikuÖãha PurÊ, said to have been alive between 968 and 988 CE. PurÊ’s information derives from two written records, thought to be around four hundred years old. An extensive account is also provided (pp. 61–85) of the dozens of lineages deriving from the four main disciples, who are attached to one of the four §mn§ya-s (connected to the four pÊãha-s). This information is said to be derived from a pothÊ that is 250 to 300 years old, in the possession of the bh§ã of the akh§Ü§. However, despite PurÊ’s claims regarding the antiquity of the maÜhÊ-s and the akh§Ü§-s, there is no real evidence that can be adduced that dates back more than three or four hundred years. The lineages (maÜhÊ-s) of the akh§Ü§-s may in some instances have had a geographical connection—such as, for example Giris, PurÊs, Bh§ratÊs and Bans60 (Vanas)—but these lineages appear to have been subsequently projected back through a paraÒpar§ originating with “aØkara and his four disciples. 2.3 Functionaries within the “rÊ Pañc Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§ organisation Having examined the the overall structure of the akh§Ü§-s and their lineages, in this and the two following sections the general hierarchies and bodies of authority within the Daáan§mÊ order will be considered. The most important body within the organisation of the Daáan§mÊ
60 Sad§nanda Giri (1976:36) notes that the titles ‘Giri’, ‘PurÊ’, ‘Bh§ratÊ’ and ‘Vana’ are found in the modern lists of both the ‘ten names’ and the maÜhÊ-s. From this he infers that these four ‘groups’ of saÒny§sÊ-s helped to create the n§g§ organisations, most probably in the Mughal period, as forces to counter Muslim aggression. Vanas, AraÖyas, Parvatas and S§garas “roamed alone” and did not initiate disciples, and hence these names have become rare, while the Giris, PurÊs and Bh§ratÊs increased their numbers through initiation.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
73
akh§Ü§-s is the “rÊ Pañc61 which consists of a group of n§g§-s and usually four or sometimes eight mahant-s (see below) from the akh§Ü§. ‘“rÊ Pañc’ is also a formal appellation preceding the name of the akh§Ü§ and may be seen on the proscenium-style arch at the entrance to an akh§Ü§. Representatives to the “rÊ Pañc are elected from all the groups of maÜhÊ-s within either four or eight of the d§v§-s, depending on the constitution of the akh§Ü§, and as we have seen, only theoretically represent all fifty-two maÜhÊ-s. Some of the maÜhÊ-s are these days effectively defunct and most akh§Ü§-s are divided into four d§v§-s, the exception being the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ, which is divided into eight d§v§-s. The author’s inquiries during fieldwork indicated that despite the fact that the constitution and decision-making processes within the akh§Ü§-s are somewhat more anarchic than some of the commentaries might indicate, a hierarchy of authority within the akh§Ü§-s is universally recognised. The “rÊ Pañc has been compared to the parliament of the akh§Ü§-s. It gives the orders for initiating n§g§-s at Kumbh Mel§s and settles disputes between maãha-s and individual n§g§-s. During Kumbh Mel§s the assembly of n§g§-s is known as the “ambhu Pañc, which, ultimately, has the highest authority within the akh§Ü§. However, it is only operational (as the “ambhu Pañc) for the duration of the Kumbh Mel§s. During the time between Kumbh Mel§s it is the “rÊ Pañc that has the highest authority regarding administrative affairs, even though the members may be travelling. The “rÊ Pañc has its own flag, deity and insignia but members do not usually own any significant personal property or have any permanent habitation. However, some members of the “rÊ Pañc, particularly mahant-s, may own properties, such as maãha-s or §árama-s, which may be a part of an extensive landholding. In some akh§Ü§-s the “rÊ Pañc may itself, as a body, own land and properties. All seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s have their own “rÊ Pañc, to which officials are usually elected every six years, during either a half or a full Kumbh Mel§. All akh§Ü§-s follow this practice. The election is based on representatives selected from the d§v§-s. The number of posts within each akh§Ü§ varies according to the size of the akh§Ü§, in terms of the number of properties it owns and the number of current initiates, but the positions are hierarchical. The highest position in
61
The akh§Ü§-s spell ‘pañc’ with a short ‘a’.
74
chapter two
an akh§Ü§ is held by a single sabh§pati (the ‘president’ or ‘chairman’), who presides over all the activities of all regional branches of the akh§Ü§. Under him, in order of hierarchical descent, are: árÊ-mahant-s and mahant-s; their assistants (k§rb§rÊ-s or adhik§rÊ-s); th§n§pati-s who manage the akh§Ü§-s properties (the temples and maãha-s); secretaries;62 påj§rÊ-s; koãv§l-s who are armed guards who also circulate information about the election of mahant-s and k§rb§rÊ-s at Kumbh Mel§s, and koãh§rÊ-s (or bhaÖ·§rÊ-s), who manage the daily supplies, such as food items, needed by the akh§Ü§. In the larger akh§Ü§-s, notably the Jån§ and Mah§nirv§ÖÊ, two other officers, known as dhånÊv§l§-s, may be elected to the “rÊ Pañc. The dhånÊv§l§ circulates decisions reached collectively by the “rÊ Pañc to the Jam§t, Jam§t being the name for a group of travelling Daáan§mÊs who do not live in an akh§Ü§.63 In normal circumstances, any maãha is presided over by a mahant, who is the spiritual head of the institution, succession typically passing to a disciple of that guru. While the mahant rules over the maãha by legal right (hak), the árÊ-mahant is elected, and rules by consensus. Mahant-s and árÊ-mahant-s may both sit side by side on the gaddÊ, but it is the mahant of the maãha who usually has a more permanent position. The k§rb§rÊ oversees daily practical affairs of an akh§Ü§ or maãha for the mahant, and will be in charge should the mahant be away. The “rÊ Pañc elects a number of th§n§pati-s (‘landlords’) who man62 All my informants used the English word ‘secretary’ to refer to this post, rather than the Hindi term, saciv, a term common in bureaucratic circles. 63 There are a number of direct parallels between the organisational structures of the Daáan§mÊ and vaißÖava R§m§nandÊ (Bair§gÊ) orders, one being the 52 ma·hÊ-s of the Daáan§mÊs and the 52 dv§ra-s of the R§m§nandÊs. Another is the pañc-saÒsk§r initiation (see Ch. 3.2). There is also a very similar hierarchy of functionaries within both orders (see Burghart 1976:63–72; Sharma 1998:94–95). At the top of the hierarchy of a typical, large R§m§nandÊ ch§vnÊ (‘temporary lodging’ or ‘troop cantonment’, equivalent to an akh§Ü§) is the mahant, followed by two adhik§rÊ-s (who administer the functioning of the organisation); one koãh§rÊ (storekeeper); five påj§rÊ-s; three vy§s-s (specialists in three different R§m§yaÖa-s); one koãv§l; two pras§dÊa-s; three jal-bh§rÊa-s (assistants); and twenty-five bhand§rÊ-s (cooks). The officers of a Bair§gÊ maÖ·al (a regionally organised unit) are: árÊ-mahant, adhik§rÊ, rasoÊy§, jalbh§rÊ and koãv§l. Bair§gÊs are members of a maÖ·al by virtue of their kuãÊ (§árama/sth§n) being in that area. The hierarchical order within the Nirmala akh§Ü§ is also similar (see Oberoi 1997:125, who cites Mahant Dial Singh, Nirmala Panth Daráan, Amritsar, 1952:323–337): “the akhara needs to maintain a touring unit and this shall be always made up of a maximum of 50 and a minimum of 20 Nirmalas. Such a unit will always have the following officiants: a head Mahant [a post below that of the “rÊ Mahant], a Granthi, a Påj§rÊ, a PaÖ·it or GianÊ, a Koãh§rÊ, two K§rb§rÊs, and a “rÊ BhaÖ·arÊ”.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
75
age the akh§Ü§-’s properties. They should be n§g§-s or retired mahant-s and are usually older ascetics. A th§n§pati may be in a position inferior to one he previously occupied. The collective ownership and management of property by up to eight th§n§pati-s, who also have a limited period in that role, is to prevent dissent over the management and ownership of property.64 The “rÊ Pañc, being the highest collective body of authority within the akh§Ü§, has, theoretically, the right to dismiss the th§n§pati managing the affairs of the properties of the akh§Ü§. Depending on the size and occupancy of any of the properties administered by an akh§Ü§, there will be a corresponding number of th§n§pati-s, secretaries and other officials. For example, in 1996 the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ was administering twenty-six properties (PurÊ 2001:151–153),65 the main maãha at Allahabad having eight árÊ-mahant-s, eight k§rb§rÊ-s, three secretaries and three th§n§pati-s. At KaØkhal, Haridv§r, there are two secretaries and five th§n§pati-s. A typical small maãha, such as at Jv§l§mukhÊ, has a single th§n§pati.66 The Jam§t, also referred to as the JhuÖ·Ê (‘small flock or swarm’ in Hindi) or JhuÖ·Ê Pañc, is elected by the “rÊ Pañc and travels for most of the year, except for the four months of the rainy season, carrying its own flag, deity and insignia, which are borrowed from the “rÊ Pañc. The “rÊ Pañc also selects someone from the Jam§t to be a mahant within the Jam§t, the selected mahant being directly under the authority of a árÊ-mahant of the akh§Ü§. The travelling Jam§t may consist of ex-mahant-s, n§g§-s and vastradh§rÊ-s (i.e. paramahaÒsas), all of whom may have joined willingly or been sent travelling by the akh§Ü§. Members of the travelling Jam§t may stay somewhere and establish a new maãha which will recruit new members to the order and send them to the akh§Ü§ for training. Within the akh§Ü§,
64 However, according to Sad§nanda Giri (1976:32) the th§n§pati traditionally occupied his office for life, having received a letter with the seal of the akh§Ü§. 65 At D§r§gañj (Allahabad), Banaras (two properties), KaØkhal (Haridv§r), OÒk§reávar, Ujjain. In Maharashtra: at N§gpur, Akol§, L§Üeg§nv (Vardh§), ParbhanÊ (two properties), and Tryambakeávar (N§sik); and at Jv§l§mukhÊ (H.P.), NÊlkaÖãh, Œßikeá, Karn§lÊ (BaÜaud§), Kurukßetra (five properties), Dehra Dån (U.P.), “rÊn§thjÊ (Baliy§, U.P.), and Udaypur (Rajasthan). 66 At the time of research (2001–2002), the Jån§ akh§Ü§ at Banaras had: 1 sabh§pati; 2 árÊ-mahant-s; 2 k§rb§rÊ-s; 2 secretaries; 4 th§n§pati-s; 4 koãv§l-s; 2 påj§rÊ-s; 1 koãh§rÊ. The Aãal akh§Ü§ at Banaras: 1 sabh§pati, who is also árÊ-mahant as well as secretary; 1 mahant; 1 koãv§l who is also th§n§pati; 1 koãh§rÊ. The $v§han akh§Ü§ at Banaras: 1 sabh§pati; 1 secretary; 1 árÊ-mahant. Agni akh§Ü§ at Banaras; 1 sabh§pati; 1 secretary; 1 th§n§pati, who is also koãv§l; 1 árÊ-mahant; 1 påj§rÊ; 1 koãh§rÊ; 1 bhaÖ·§rÊ.
76
chapter two
the Jam§t is the second highest authority after the “ambhu Pañc.67 It is under the “ambhu Pañc during the Kumbh Mel§, and under the “rÊ Pañc at other times. Overseeing the activities of all thirteen akh§Ü§-s (including the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s) is a body known as the Akhil Bh§ratÊya Akh§Ü§ Parißad,68 based in Haridv§r, which meets to decide various practical and policy issues.69
2.4 Mah§maÖ·aleávaras Affiliated to the akh§Ü§-s are one or several Mah§maÖ·aleávaras (‘Lords of the area’).70 The author was informed by a variety of s§dhu-s, officials and Mah§maÖ·aleávaras, that presently the akh§Ü§-s with the largest number of affiliated Mah§maÖ·aleávaras are the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ and NirañjanÊ, with up to thirty affiliated Mah§maÖ·aleávaras.71 While many Mah§maÖ·aleávaras are affiliated to the various akh§Ü§-s, usually only one—or, occasionally, up to four—is directly involved with an akh§Ü§ in his role as §c§rya-guru (or §c§rya-mah§maÖ·aleávara) for the akh§Ü§, presiding over a part of the saÒny§sa rite. Only the §c§rya-mah§maÖ·aleávara-s may give dÊkߧ, which is the only time when they usually come into contact with the akh§Ü§. Even though Mah§maÖ·aleávaras may indicate an affiliation with a particular
67 Sad§nanda Giri (1976:27) remarks that: “When a disciple first comes into the Akh§Ü§, he is sent out with the ‘Jam§t’ group, to roam about, see the country [and] to gain experience. In this way his good qualities are developed and he becomes fit to lead a life in the community. Eventually such people become the heads of the Akh§Ü§s. Sometimes after training they become head of the $árama of the Siddha-Guru. From many places the Akh§Ü§s recruit wayward boys. In this respect they have reshaped the life of many unruly boys, and saved them from becoming thieves and dacoits. When these boys come into the Akh§Ü§ they are made into good sanny§sins by rigorous training.” 68 Each akh§Ü§ controls an average of a hundred religious bodies, such as maãha-s, temples and §árama-s (Jaffrelot 1996:471). 69 One decision taken quite recently was that the akh§Ü§-s should not become involved in any overt or covert ‘religious’ activity (Dutt 2001). Whether this decision has any binding effect remains, however, to be seen. 70 Mah§maÖ·aleávaras usually have lengthy titles, a typical example being, ‘“rÊmat paramahaÒsa parivr§jak§c§rya brahmanißãa ananta árÊ vibhåßita árÊ annapårna pÊãh§dhÊávara mah§maÖ·aleávara árÊ sv§mÊ viáveávar§nanda giri ji mah§r§ja ved§nt§c§rya’. 71 Sinha and Saraswati (1978:98) list eight MaÖ·aleávaras, including one $c§rya MaÖ·aleávara, for the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§, whereas PurÊ (2001:136–137) lists twentynine Mah§maÖ·aleávaras affiliated to that akh§Ü§.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
77
akh§Ü§, sometimes indicated on the sign over the gateway to the camp or §árama, in most instances the title is essentially honorary, as, at some time in the past, the Mah§maÖ·aleávara’s maãha will have broken away from the akh§Ü§. Mah§maÖ·aleávaras often own large §árama-s and deliver public lectures on Ved§nta and related religious topics to large audiences, particularly in the rainy season. Many of them have the office bestowed upon them during a ceremony at a Kumbh Mel§.72 The Mah§maÖ·aleávaras are the heads of a hierarchy within the monastic tradition, which is essentially independent of the hierarchies that operate within the akh§Ü§-s, except at times of initiation.73 Mah§maÖ·aleávaras have essentially replaced the former preeminence of the §c§rya-s. H. H. Wilson, writing in 1861, makes no mention of them in the Daáan§mÊ order, and Sad§nanda Giri (1976:50–53) concludes that their office has only developed in the last sixty years or so. He remarks that there used to be only three §c§rya-guru-s, of the NirañjanÊ, Jån§ and [Mah§-] Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§-s, and that the §c§rya-guru-s used to accompany the akh§Ü§-s for the baths at the Kumbh Mel§s. (The $nanda, $v§han and Aãal akh§Ü§-s, the three smaller akh§Ü§-s, still accompany the three larger akh§Ü§-s to the baths.) Although these days each akh§Ü§ has its own affiliated §c§rya-guru, this has not always been so. PurÊ (2001:133) remarks that the Aãal and Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ used to share an §c§rya-guru, but that since 1922 the Aãal akh§Ü§ created an independent §c§ryaguru. PurÊ provides a parampar§ for the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ of twelve Mah§maÖ·aleávaras (as §c§rya-guru-s), which, realistically, would perhaps go back around 150 years. Miára (Amiã K§lrekh§ 2001:103) maintains that it was during the period when the Jyotir pÊãha was
72
The §c§rya-guru (who is a Mah§maÖ·aleávara) of each akh§Ü§ is often a resident of a particular maãha. Thus, for example, Sinha and Saraswati (1978:98), discussing the residences of the Mah§maÖ·aleávaras of Banaras, note that the $c§rya-MaÖ·aleávaras of the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ always reside in the Govinda maãha, those of the NirañjanÊ in the Durbeávara maãha, and those of the Jån§ akh§Ü§ in the MÜtyuñj§ya maãha. 73 To give one example, the current $c§rya Mah§maÖ·aleávara of the Jån§ akh§Ü§ is Sv§mÊ Avadheá§nanda Giri, who was elected at the 1998 Haridv§r Kumbh Mel§. Sv§mÊjÊ started and heads an organisation called Prabhu PremÊ SaØgh, the headquarters being in KaØkhal, Haridv§r. It has twenty-eight §árama-s throughout north India, and is dedicated not only to spiritual uplift but also to the education and feeding of the poor and destitute (see www.prabhuprem.org.in). Sv§mÊjÊ has wrtten around a dozen books and lectures frequently.
78
chapter two
moved to Dholka in Gujarat that a decision was made by the Dholka §c§rya that each akh§Ü§ should have its own §c§rya mah§maÖ·aleávara. It is uncertain when the Dholka pÊãha was first established (certainly after 1776), but the Jyotir pÊãha was reestablished in 1941, which means—if Miára is correct—that the arrangement whereby each akh§Ü§ has its own §c§rya-mah§maÖ·aleávara came into existence before 1941.74 The title of ‘Mah§maÖ·aleávara’ clearly derives from the feudal role performed by rulers in the process of state formation during the early mediaeval period.75 The institution of the Vijayanagara Mah§maÖ·aleávara is evident in the parallel role of the Mah§maÖ·aleávaras of the Daáan§mÊ order, whereby these heads of monastic maãha-s are nominally under the instruction and command of the main maãha-s controlled by the reigning “aØkar§c§ryas. It seems that from hundreds of years before the time of “aØkara (eighth century CE), until the last century or so, it was parißad-s of learned Brahmans who adjudicated on doubtful points of religious conduct, and prescribed appropriate penances (Kane HD“, Vol. 2:971–974). Only rarely were heads of maãha-s asked to decide. During the time of Mar§ãh§ domination, the king or minister consulted the Brahmans in holy places such as Paithan, N§sik and Karad on religious matters and only rarely consulted the heads of maãha-s. This arrangement prevailed until the time of the British, and it was 74 Sinha and Saraswati’s account (1978:96) of an anecdote related to them by an informant from the Jån§ akh§Ü§ may throw some light on this issue. According to their informant, around a century ago n§g§-s used to give the highest honour to daÖ·Ê-s, whom they regarded as their gurus. At that time, the daÖ·Ê-s used to initiate the paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s into saÒny§sa. The n§g§-s used to carry the palanquin of the “aØkar§c§rya, who is considered to be the spiritual head of the Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s. However, a dispute arose when the d§Ö·Ê-s, who are Brahman brahmac§rÊ-s, cast doubt on the purity of the paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s. Henceforth, the daÖ·Ê-s refused to initiate the paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s into saÒny§sa. As a consequence, the institution of §c§rya-guru arose, whereby a Mah§maÖ·aleávara from a monastic tradition, and who may also be a daÖ·Ê, will initiate paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s at a Kumbh Mel§. 75 For example, from an inscription of 1356 (Epigraphia Carnatica, vol. X, Kolar, no. 222), we learn that Kum§ra Kampana, one of the early rulers of the Vijayanagara empire, and the first son of Bukka I, was appointed by his father as the Mah§maÖ·aleávara of the Mulb§gal region, entrusted with the task of extending Vijayanagara rule in the Tamil country. Most of the Mah§maÖ·aleávaras were members of the royal family in the early period of Vijayanagara rule. By the time of Harihara II, local tax collection systems of the village assemblies were bypassed and replaced by directly appointed Mah§maÖ·aleávaras and other such officials. See Krishnaswami (1964:7, 103ff.) for further details.
akh§Ü§-s and daáan§mÊ functionaries
79
only at approximately the beginning of the nineteenth century that mahant-s and such authorities as the “aØkar§c§ryas—who occupied, for example, the gaddÊ-s of the “aØkeávara maãha at KaravÊra in Maharashtra76—have claimed almost exclusive jurisdiction in such matters. The adoption of the title of ‘Mah§maÖ·aleávara’ and an extended juridical role of the religious office would seem to indicate a kind of reformation or reorganisation of the order as it currently exists.
2.5 “aØkar§c§ryas While authority is hierarchical within individual maãha-s and akh§Ü§-s, at the apex of the Daáan§mÊ structure are the “aØkar§c§ryas. “aØkar§c§ryas are also referred to as jagadguru (‘world guru’), a title reserved for someone with supreme spiritual authority. They reside at the maãha-s supposedly founded by “aØkar§c§rya.77 The landholdings and estates of the larger maãha-s, particularly those of Dv§rak§, K§ñcÊpuram and “ÜØgerÊ are extensive.78 The estates also include an increasing number of educational institutions and hospitals. Besides their religious and administrative duties—which include participating in initiation rituals at Kumbh Mel§s—the “aØkar§c§ryas also adjudicate on matters of Dharmaá§stra. Besides the government court system, parallel systems of social justice function in many regions of India.79 In south India, the local caste council (kattemane), usually with five members, decides many issues, while others are decided
76
See Ch. 4.4, on Daáan§mÊ pÊãha-s and maãha-s. For a brief biography and an account of the the coronation/consecration (paããabhißeka) of Bh§ratÊtÊrtha, installed as “aØkar§c§rya of “ÜØgerÊ in 1989 (inheriting the gaddÊ from Vidy§tÊrtha, who had occupied it since 1954), see Yocum (1996). 78 See Venkataraman (1959:132–166) for details of the landholdings, shrines, temples and revenue of the “ÜØgerÊ SaÒsth§nam (‘institution’). Revenue derives from around fifty villages in surrounding districts. Net revenue in 1959 was 33,000 Rs. The saÒsth§nam also owns around fifty buildings, temples and shrines throughout India. The j§gÊr (land donated by a ruler) enjoyed by the pÊãha for 600 years was abolished in 1950 by the In§m Abolition Act and became a t§luk§, with a tahsÊld§r as the civil administrator (Gnanambal 1973:8). The wealth of the K§ñcÊpuram maãha, which controls several schools, colleges, hospitals and other organisations, was estimated in 2004 at between Rs. 5,000 and 10,000 crore (1.1–2.2 billion U.S. dollars) (www.hinduismtoday.com/hpi/2004/11/17.shml). 79 See Lariviere (1993). 77
80
chapter two
by “aØkar§c§ryas. Gnanambal (1973) provides extensive documentation of numerous cases decided by the pontiffs of seven south Indian maãha-s, including the Kumbhakonam and “ÜØgerÊ maãha-s (also known as pÊtha-s).80 For settling disputes or grievances the jagadguru is assisted by a number of teachers well-versed in the Dharmaá§stra-s. Cases typically involve marriage, adultery and sexual offences, religious rites and caste practice, anti-social acts, change of occupation, caste pollution, interpreting á§stra-s, caste, initiation and personal affairs. Complaints from individuals are usually first taken to the local pañc§yat, and a report elicited, before the case is presented to a maãha. Branch maãha-s of the “aØkara pÊãha-s have mudr§dhik§rÊ-s who refer cases to the dharm§dhik§rÊ (supervisor), someone who belongs to one of the “aØkarite pÊãha-s and decides on matters of caste, moral conduct and ritual obligation. Many of the cases are also considered by the “aØkar§c§rya. Although complaints are brought to the pÊãha and adjudicated, the pÊãha-s never actively pursue cases in the role of prosecutor. The punishment dispensed in cases which are adjudicated is seldom harsh, typically involving a small fine, forms of social exclusion or purification and expiation ceremonies. Only rarely, usually in cases of sexual misconduct, is someone excluded from the community. The pÊãha-s have considerable authority, particularly among some sections of Brahmans. In this chapter, the structure, organisation and hierarchies within the akh§Ü§-s have been examined. As noted in the previous chapter (1.6), several commentators81 claim that the akh§Ü§-s are in some respects democratic and non-hierarchical. However, it is evident from our consideration of the organisation of the akh§Ü§-s that the akh§Ü§-s are essentially hierarchical in terms of authority and decisionmaking. Conflicts between the akh§Ü§-s were referred to, illustrating the radically different character of the militant wing of the Daáan§mÊs from that of the monastic tradition. Yet it remains to be explained how the “aØkar§c§ryas—the preeminent heads of the Daáan§mÊ monastic tradition—are integrated within a structure that incorporates the militant akh§Ü§-s. This is illustrated in initiation procedures, the main topic of the next chapter.
80
Some Daáan§mÊ maãha-s are also known as pÊãha-s: see Ch. 4.4. See, for example, Sad§nanda Giri (1976:27); Sinha and Saraswati (1978:196); Dazey (1987:557; 1990:309). 81
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
81
CHAPTER THREE
RENUNCIATION, RULES FOR ASCETICS, AND INITIATION In this chapter, the procedures of renunciation are considered. A brief comparison between the earliest texts that provide details of renunciation procedures and a recent account of these rites illustrates the remarkable continuity in saÒny§sa rites for around two millennia. However, several points that are not apparent in the ancient accounts are revealed in the details provided for contemporary procedures. Firstly, at least one officiating guru is required to perform the rite of renunciation for the candidate. In a modern anthropological context, such facilitation not only liberates the renunciate from a prior social identity, but, as indicated in the Introduction to this dissertation, the same saÒny§sa rite also simultaneously initiates the renunciate into the renunciate lineage of the initiating guru: the saÒny§sa rite has two aspects, constituting both a renunciation of one social order, and an initiation into another social order, that of a renunciate sect. Another key component of this chapter is the illustration of how the militant wing of the Daáan§mÊ order is ideologically linked to the monastic wing, via the auspices and participation of a high executive of the monastic wing (frequently a “aØkar§c§rya) in the initiation of paramahaÒsa-s and potential n§g§-s during the saÒny§sa rite.
3.1. Renunciation procedures The earliest extant account of Brahmanical injunctions for the renunciate and renunciation procedures is to be found in the Dharmasåtra of Baudh§yana (2.17–18),1 the earliest portions of which may be dated from around the beginning of the third to the middle of the second century BCE. There seem, however, to have been a significant number of later interpolations in the text, most probably
1
Kane (HD“, Vol. 2: 953).
82
chapter three
including the section on renunciatory rites.2 It is in the Dharmasåtra of Baudh§yana that the term saÒny§sa first appears in dharma literature. Other extant Dharmasåtra texts3 also deal at some length with the life of the renunciate; those of Gautama (3.11–25), $pastamba (2.21.1–17) and Vasißãha (10.1–31).4 These writers frequently quote from unnamed sources (Olivelle 1977:21 fn. 4).5 According to Baudh§yana (2.17.1–7),6 renunciation may be performed by a widower or by someone who has settled his children in their respective duties. It is also prescribed for people over seventy years of age or for a forest hermit who has retired from ritual activities.7 During the procedure,8 the candidate internalises the s§vitrÊ
2
See Olivelle (1999:xxx-xxxiii). Kane (HD“, Vol. 1:52) tentatively dates Baudh§yana to 600–300 BCE. 3 For the translation of the Dharmasåtra-s, see Olivelle (1999). 4 Rules for ‘fourth-§árama’ yati-s (or parivr§jaka-s or saÒny§sÊ-s) also appear in various Pur§Öa-s. See, for example, Kårma Pur§Öa (II.28); N§rada Pur§Öa (I.27.92–106; II.43.123–127). 5 Kane (HD“ Vol.1:989-1158) lists over eighty works dealing exclusively with renunciation. Unfortunately, most still remain in manuscript form and little work has been done on editing the texts. Until Olivelle’s (1977–1978) editing of V§sudev§árama’s Yatidharmaprak§áa, a text dated to between, most probably, 1675 and 1800, the only other mediaeval treatises on renunciation to have been published were ViáveávarasarasvatÊ’s YatidharmasaÒgraha and Vidy§raÖya’s JÊvanmuktiviveka. 6 The candidate first has his head, beard and body shaved and his nails clipped. Then, taking a triple-staff, sling, water-strainer, water-pot and bowl, he goes to the boundary of the village, eats a light meal of ghee, milk and curds, and then fasts. He then recites and internalises the s§vitrÊ mantra several times, in different ways. Before sunset he performs his daily fire sacrifice with offerings of ghee, and spends the night awake. In the last portion of the night he gets up and performs last daily fire sacrifice, making an offering to the Fire common to all men with an oblation prepared in twelve potsherds. He throws into the offertorial fire the vessels used in the daily sacrifice that are not made of of clay or stone (i.e. wood), and into the household fire he throws the two fire-drills. He deposits the sacred fires in himself, breathing in the smell of each fire three times, saying: “With that body of yours worthy of sacrifice, O Fire...” Then, standing within the sacrificial area, he recites, three times softly and three times aloud, the praißa mantra (see below). Filling his cupped hands with water, he pours it out, saying: “I give safety to all creatures!” He takes the staff, sling, water-pot and bowl, reciting appropriate ritual formulae. Taking the aforementioned mendicant’s possessions, he goes to a water place, bathes and sips water, reciting mantras (the SurabhimatÊ, AbliØga, V§ruÖÊ, HiraÖyavarÖa and P§vam§nÊ verses). Entering the water, he controls his breath sixteen times while reciting the AghamarßaÖa hymn; comes out of the water; squeezes the water from his clothes; wears another clean garment; and sips water. Then, taking the water strainer, he recites other mantras: to the elements, the sun, the ancestors and himself; he should then recite the s§vitrÊ mantra, up to an unlimited number of times. 7 Also, it is meant for “§lÊnas and Y§y§varas who are childless. These are people
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
83
mantra,9 deposits the sacred fires in himself,10 and utters the praißa mantra:11 “I have renounced! I have renounced! I have renounced!” A significant omission in Baudh§yana’s account is the absence of reference to anyone who assists, supervises or instigates the saÒny§sa rites: a guru is not mentioned. The candidate of Baudh§yana’s text would need to have knowledge of the procedures of renunciation for it to be performed. This aspect is crucial, as it is initiation by a guru (who has a lineage), through the performance of correct rites, that validates saÒny§sa. The earliest known Brahmanical text devoted specifically to renunciation is the Yatidharmasamuccaya of Y§dava Prak§áa,12 written in
who were originally two types of Vedic sacrificer. The former maintained a stable residence, whereas the latter were given to wandering. Together they constitute a category of Vedic sacrificer who is distinguished from the ordinary householder (see Olivelle 1993:162). 8 A slightly different version of the initiatory rite is given in the Vaikh§nasa Sm§rtasåtra, and reference is made to several of its elements in the Manu SmÜti (6.38), Y§jñavalkya SmÜti (3.56) and VißÖu SmÜti (96.1) (see Olivelle 1977:37). It is also described in most SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s (see Olivelle 1992) and is substantially similar to accounts found in later, mediaeval texts on renunciation. 9 RV III.62.10, also known as ‘entry into s§vitrÊ’ or the g§yatrÊ mantra: “OÒ Earth! I enter S§vitrÊ; that excellent [glory] of S§vitÜ. OÒ Atmosphere! I enter S§vitrÊ; the glory of god we meditate. OÒ Sky! I enter S§vitrÊ; that he may stimulate our prayers” (tr. Olivelle 1999:204). This mantra is the most sacred mantra of the Brahmanical tradition. It is imparted at initiation (upanayana) when the youth becomes a twice-born and a full participant in the religious life of the Brahmanical community. See Sharma (1988) for the religious use and symbolism of the g§yatrÊ mantra in contemporary Hinduism. 10 One of the central motifs within the complex of ideas concerning renunciation in the Brahmanical world is that the external fires become internalised, as the renouncer’s breath. In most sources the internalised fires are identified with the breath or with the five breaths, but in the $ruÖi Upanißad (2) the external fires are deposited in the stomach and the g§yatrÊ mantra in the fire of speech. The internalisation of the fires is accompanied by the relinquishing of ritual paraphernalia into the fire or water. 11 The praißa is the technical term for the mantra, ‘I have renounced’ and constitutes an essential feature of the renunciatory rite. Olivelle translates it as ‘Call’. Praißa is a technical term in Vedic ritual vocabulary, and within that context it refers to the formulae used by Adhvaryu priests to perform specific procedures. It is unclear why this formula was given that technical appellation (Olivelle 1992:95; 1995:67 fn. 26). 12 According to tradition, Y§dava Prak§áa was the advaita-Ved§ntin teacher of R§m§nuja, whom he had plotted to kill after R§m§nuja’s challenge to his own advaita philosophical view. Y§dava Prak§áa subsequently converted to R§m§nuja’s more devotional viáißã§dvaita (qualified non-dualism) philosophy and became his disciple. R§m§nuja was the founder of the first orthodox vaißÖava order of ascetics, known
84
chapter three
the twelfth century.13 While it is evident that Brahmanical texts on renunciation are generally of vaißÖava persuasion, more than other mediaeval works on asceticism, the Yatidharmasamuccaya integrates ascetic life into the ritual life of the Brahmanical vaißÖava tradition (Olivelle 1995:17).14 Y§dava Prak§áa (4.1-49) details the rites of renunciation, primarily according to “aunaka.15 As a preliminary practice before initiation, the so-called kÜcchra16 (arduous) penances are to be performed (4.2), followed by ár§ddha oblations (4.2, 4, 26).17 A crucial feature of saÒny§sa is that, unlike the ordinary people, the dead saÒny§sÊ does not become a ghost but is united immediately with the ancestral spirits. The ár§ddha-s usually performed for a dead person in a ghostly state (ekoddißãaár§ddha), and the customary rite of offering piÖ·a a year after the death of a relative (to six generations
as the “rÊ samprad§ya, one of the four extant vaißÖava samprad§ya-s. It is also believed that R§m§nuja climbed the gopuram of the VißÖu temple in Goßãipåra, and shouted out, for all to hear, including áådra-s, the secret eight-syllable saÒny§sÊ mantra he had just received from Goßãipurna (Ramakrishnanada 1959:151–155). 13 See Olivelle (1995). See Olivelle (1976–1977; 1986–1987) for other mediaeval texts on renunciation, several of which refer to a work called Brahm§nandÊ—a lost work—which seems to have been a basic text (Olivelle 1976:25). 14 There are numerous references throughout the text to VißÖu, his emblem, offerings to him, and to the renouncer as VißÖu: 2.51, 65; 3.6, 10, 53; 4.28, 35; 5.23–24, 32–33, 76-81, 91–142, 260, 293; 6.64, 68, 81, 203–204, 223, 229–314; 7.65–66, 89, 100, 108; 9.25, 45–58; 10.11; 11.28. 15 He also cites eight other authorites: Baudh§yana, Vasißãha, K§ty§yana, Jamadagni, Kapila, J§b§li, AØgiras and Likhita. 16 Four kÜcchra penances constitute what is technically known as a pr§j§patya penance, which consists of taking one meal a day for six days—a morning meal for the first three days and an evening meal the second—eating what is received unasked during the next three days, and fasting during the last three. A single kÜcchra penance—also called p§dakÜcchra (‘quarter penance’) at Y§jñavalkya Dharmaá§stra 3.3.18—is to perform the same four austerities for only one day each (Olivelle 1995:60). In Gautama Dharmasåtra (26) three kinds of kÜcchra penances are described, involving progressive restrictions on eating over twelve days, finally only drinking water. The following chapter (27) describes the c§ndr§yaÖa (‘lunar’) penance, whereby a lunar month of dietary control is observed, progressively decreasing and increasing food intake. The sequential rules of the kÜcchra also apply to this penance. 17 First to the gods, second to the seers, third to the divine beings, fourth to male ancestors, fifth to female ancestors, sixth to human beings, seventh to the elements, and eighth to the self. Kane (HD“ Vol. 2:932), commenting on the NarasiÒha Pur§Öa, remarks that the eight ár§ddha-s are: daiva (to Vasus, Rudras, $dityas); §rßa (to the ten sages, including MarÊci and others); divya (to HiraÖyagarbha and Vair§ja); manußya (to Sanaka, Sanandana and five others); bhautika (to five bhåta-s, pÜthvÊ, etc.); paitÜka (to Kavyav§· fire [?], Soma, Aryaman, pitÜ-s called Agniv§tta etc.); m§tÜár§ddha (to ten m§tÜ-s, such as GaurÊ, Padm§); §tmaár§ddha (to param§tman).
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
85
of ancestors), do not need to be performed for the saÒny§sÊ who has performed his own ár§ddha.18 The s§vitrÊ mantra is then internalised, followed by a night’s vigil. After bathing at first light, the candidate performs the morning fire sacrifice, reciting the Great Utterances19 and the hymn, “Swift runs the river of delight...” (RV IX.58). He should feed some Brahmans and make oblations to the fire, saying: “To the in-breath, sv§h§! To the out-breath, sv§h§! To the diffused breath, sv§h§! To the top-breath, sv§h§! To the middle-breath, sv§h§!” After this he recites the Purußa-såkta (RV X.90), offering a piece of firewood, ghee and porridge to the fire at each verse. He then makes further oblations to Agni SvißãakÜt (the aspect of the fire-god that ‘makes a sacrifice properly offered’), makes presents to his teacher (of a cow, a bowl of ghee or anything else) and recites verses from the TaittirÊya $raÖyaka (II.18.1) and the TaittirÊya Br§hmaÖa (II.5.8.8), depositing the fires in himself. He should then stand before the fire or in water and recite the praißa mantra three times softly, three times in a medium voice, and three times in a loud voice.20 One of the most detailed accounts of initiatory procedures is contained in V§sudev§árama’s Yatidharmaprak§áa,21 a vaißÖava orientated advaita work of the late seventeenth or eighteenth century,22 which 18 Technically, the ár§ddha rites, wherein gods and ancestors are invoked, are essentially a component of, or supplement to, what might be translated as full funeral rites, known as antyeßãi (see Parry 1982:84; Prasad 1995). 19 There are either three or seven Great Utterances (vy§hÜti ), denoting ‘worlds’: bhåÈ, bhuvaÈ, svaÈ, with the addition of mahar, janas, tapas, satya (see Olivelle 1995:63 fn. 13). 20 Y§dava Prak§áa also includes injunctions (4.40-48) for those who wish to renounce in the face of imminent death or mortal danger. If the man is able, he may perform the proper procedure, otherwise he may simply recite orally the praißa mantra. If he is unable to do that he should just mentally abandon attachments. 21 V§sudev§árama was acquainted with fifteen works dealing with dharma, four of them particularly with renunciation: Vidy§raÖya’s JÊvanmuktiviveka, Yatidharmasamuccaya and PraÖavamÊm§Òs§ (c.1360), and ViáveávarasarasvatÊ’s YatidharmasaÒgraha (early sixteenth century), also known as the Yatidharmasamuccaya. Besides the latter works and Vijñ§neávara’s work on dharma, Mit§kßar§ (1100–1120), V§sudev§árama was most influenced by the advatin philosopher MadhusådanasarasvatÊ, the pupil of ViáveávarasarasvatÊ: he cities his Siddh§ntabindu (46.12–14). V§sudev§árama also cites or refers to the works of “aØkara (8th cent.), Sureávara (8th cent.), Prak§á§tman (c. 975), V§caspatimiára (c.980), Sarvajñ§tman (c.1027), Vidy§raÖya (c.1340–1386), MadhusådanasarasvatÊ (1540–1647), NarasiÒh§árama (mid-16th century), R§matÊrtha (mid-16th century) and RaØgojÊ Bhaããa (c.1575) (Olivelle 1977:28). 22 In the final section (73) of his treatise, V§sudev§árama describes himself as a ParamahaÒsa renouncer, the pupil of “rÊ Govind§árama, who was the pupil of “rÊ R§makÜßÖ§árama.
86
chapter three
contains one of the first textual references to the ‘ten names’ (66.14–15) of the Daáan§mÊs. Following Baudh§yana (II.17.11), V§sudev§árama maintains23 (3) that five items are obligatory for the renouncer (8.25): either a single or a triple-staff, a braided string to loop around the mouth of a water pot to carry it, a water strainer, a water-pot and a begging-bowl. The triple staff was usually the kind carried by vaißÖava renunciates, and the single kind by áaiva renunciates. During Daáan§mÊ renunciation procedures the saÒny§sÊ is given a loincloth, and a single staff, which is abandoned shortly if the saÒny§sÊ is affiliated to an akh§Ü§ but is maintained by daÖ·Ê-s. In his commentary on the BÜhad§raÖyaka Upanißad (III.5.1),24 “aØkara maintains that a renouncer should give up all rites and ritual instruments, such as fire, top-knot and sacrificial cord, a position maintained by later advaitin-s. One may easily distinguish Daáan§mÊ from other s§dhu-s (notably vaißÖava) by the absence of the top-knot, which is removed
23 According to V§sudev§árama, renunciation procedures are as follows (see Olivelle (1976; 1977) for the full text; see Olivelle (1977:38) for this resumé). To renounce, he: 1. Performs one penance if he belongs to an §árama and four if he does not (6.1-19; 21.2). 2. Performs eight ár§ddha-s (nine at 21.3) according to the rules of vÜddhiár§ddha (7.1-61; 21.3-35). 3. Gathers the articles needed by a renouncer (8.24-27). 4. Declares his intention to renounce. Three rites follow immediately thereafter: worship of GaÖapati, proclamation of an auspicious day, and worship of the divine mothers (21.37-38). 5. Shaves his beard and head (except the top-knot), pares his nails and bathes (9.10; 21.39-41). 6. Kindles the sacred fires and offers the sacrifice to Brahman (21.41-44). 7. Performs the entry into S§vitrÊ (8.28-29; 9.1-23; 21.49-56). 8. Performs the brahm§nv§dh§na and declares his intention to fast (10.1-4; 21.57-64). 9. Offers the evening sacrifice (11.1; 21.67). 10. Keeps awake and fasts during the night before renunciation (11.1-8). 11. Bathes in the morning, performs the saÒdhy§ worship and offers the fire sacrifice (12.1-5; 21.72-74). 12. Offers a sacrifice to Praj§pati or Agni Vaiáv§nara (12.6-27; 21.76-77). 13. Gives away all his possessions to the priest (12.11-12). 14. Deposits the fires in his self and discards the sacrificial utensils (12.29-35; 13.1-18; 21.72-74). 15. Makes a caru oblation to Purußa (13.27-33; 21.82-86). (A caru oblation is an offering of boiled rice with milk or butter. This is performed by someone with one fire, while someone with three fires offers an ißãi, constituting a burnt offering of rice or barley. It is an oblation customarily associated with the worship of ancestors, frequently mentioned in inscriptions.) 16. Offers the viraj§ oblation (an optional rite, 14.1-47). 17. Proclaims the praißa (16.1-27; 21.91-114) in the following manner: (i) takes leave of his relatives; (ii) leaves home and goes to a lake; (iii) declares his intention to renounce; (iv) makes an offering of water; (v) discards the sacrificial thread; (vi) plucks the hair of the top-knot; (vii) declares the praißa; (viii) gives the gift of safety to all creatures. 18. Either commits suicide (17.1-32; 21.115), or 19. Takes possession of the articles needed by the renouncer (18.1-13; 21.116-128). 20. Places himself under the guidance of a guru (19.1-53; 21.129-160). 24 Trans. by M§dhav§nanda (1965:474–491).
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
87
during initiation. V§sudev§árama makes several references to shaving the head (5), some non-specific (8.3; 9.10), and another (21.39) clearly stating that the top-knot should be retained. However, during the subsequent procedures for renunciation, the renouncer discards one by one the symbols of his ritual life: the s§vitrÊ formula and the sacred fires (which are internalised), sacrificial utensils, sacred thread and top-knot. The abandoning of all emblems and rites became one of the points of contention during the mediaeval period between adherents of the advaita philosophy of “aØkara, and those of the viáißã§dvaita philosophy of R§m§nuja, who believed that, at least, the sacrificial cord should be maintained. One of the issues underpinning this debate is the viáißã§dvaita contention that knowledge alone cannot cause liberation and that action, particularly religious ritual action, should accompany the quest for knowledge. This is in contrast to the advaita position that all action should be abandoned and that knowledge alone brings liberation. Unlike many other commentators on renunciation, the advaitin V§sudev§árama was not biased in a sectarian way.25 He does not adjudicate—as had become customary in advaita orders—over the relative superiority of either advaitin-s (as the carriers of the single staff), or members of one of the vaißÖava ascetic orders (who traditionally carry the triple staff). The type of staff carried had become a self-conscious, emblematic, sectarian distinction.26 The final sacrifice a renunciate will make is performed during the
25
V§sudev§árama states that, according to one opinion (64.5-30), the renouncer worships KÜßÖa, Vy§sa, “aØkara, his gurus, GaÖapati, Kßetrap§la, Durg§, SarasvatÊ, the guardian deities of the quarters, Brahm§ and Rudra. However, others maintain that only VißÖu in the form of the á§lagr§ma is worshipped (64.1-35). 26 Olivelle (1993:172; 1995:132) has remarked on the significance of the types of staffs carried by ascetics in relation to sectarian hierarchies. In a vaißÖava text, the Sanatkum§ra-saÒhit§ (5.34–38), the advaita HaÒsa and ParamahaÒsa ascetics are described as carrying a single staff, whereas the ‘higher’ classes of vaißÖava ascetics, the Bhagav§n and the Prabhu, carry the triple staff. VaißÖava orientated texts make frequent derogatory remarks against the áaiva advaita ascetics who carry the single staff, and not the triple staff (see, for example, Yatidharmasamuccaya 7.71). “rÊ-VaißÖava ascetics, who carried triple staffs, often accused the advaitin-s of being Buddhists pretending to follow the Brahmanical law. However, most SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s and mediaeval legal texts consider the carrying of either the single or the triple staff as a feature of the four-fold classification of renouncers and not as sectarian badges (Olivelle 1986:43). There is an ‘ideal’ classification of four kinds of renouncer (kuãÊcaka, bahådaka, haÒsa, paramahaÒsa) to be found in many texts, which concerns their different emblems and lifestyles. For further details, see Ch. 3.4.
88
chapter three
saÒny§sa rite. V§sudev§árama states (12.6-7; 21.76) that the sacrifice may be to either Agni Vaiáv§nara or Praj§pati, reflecting the divergent views on which deity should be the recipient of the offering.27 During Daáan§mÊ initiation rites, the final sacrifice is to Praj§pati.28 The renouncer should then perform the caru oblation to Purußa (15) and, optionally, a viraj§ oblation (16), and should declare the praißa (17). (All three rites are central to Daáan§mÊ procedures and the performance of the viraj§-homa is crucial.) The renouncer may then commit ritual suicide (18) or exercise the option of not doing so. The renouncer should take a few steps towards the north until called back by his teacher. The journey to ‘the north’ is symbolic of the Great Journey to the Himalayas,29 undertaken without food or water, until the traveller died.30
27 Baudh§yana (II.17.23) states that the sacrifice should be to Agni, but the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s contain contrasting opinions. The J§b§la Upanißad (4) states that though some perform a sacrifice to Praj§pati, one should not do so, rather the sacrifice should be to Agni. However, the N§radaparivr§jaka Upanißad (138) maintains that the sacrifice should be to Praj§pati, and the Kaãhaáruti Upanißad (38) that there should be oblations to Agni Vaiáv§nara, Praj§pati and to VißÖu (see SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s, trans. Olivelle 1992). Both Manu (6.38) and the VißÖu SmÜti (96.1) (see Jolly 1991) state that the final sacrifice should be to Praj§pati. The Kårma Pur§Öa (II.28.4) states that it can be either to Agni or Praj§pati. Y§dava Prak§áa (4.31) cites J§madagnya, who states that the renouncer should perform a sacrifice to Praj§pati at which he gives all his possessions as a sacrificial gift to the priests and deposits the fires in himself. Apart from the inclusion of Praj§pati within a mantra stated by “aunaka, as a feature of the saÒny§sa rite (4.12), Y§dava Prak§áa only once mentions a sacrifice to Praj§pati. 28 Concerning the ambivalence of commentators regarding the deity to be the object of the final oblation, we might consider a feature of the Vedic agnicayana ceremony. Contrasting the generally iconic Hindu religious environment with the generally aniconic Vedic religious environment, Malamoud (1998:212) remarks that the aniconism of the Veda is not absolute. He discusses several instances, one of them during the agnicayana ceremony (the ‘piling of the fire-altar’), when a golden statuette is placed at the base of the brick structure. This statuette is an image of the sacrificer and also of the two divinities Agni and Praj§pati, with whom the sacrificer is secondarily identified. Agni and Praj§pati are furthermore identified with one another within the ceremony itself. The identity of the two deities is frequently alluded to in many Brahmanical texts. In the “atapatha Br§hmaÖa the identity of the two is continually reaffirmed. The traditional, partial identity of the two deities might to some extent explain the ambivalence of commentators on renunciation in respect of the deity to whom the recipient makes the final oblation. 29 As in the final two books of the Mah§bh§rata. 30 On ritual suicide and the rite of renunciation, see Olivelle (1978).
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
89
3.2 Current initiation procedures: pañc-guru-saÒsk§r Among the more comprehensive published accounts of formal Daáan§mÊ initiation procedures are those of Sarkar (1958:63–81), Sad§nanda Giri (1976:26–31) and Tripathi (1978:7–11).31 However, their accounts do not illustrate the two-stage process of initiation.32 All candidates first approach a mahant of an §árama or a maãha, having demonstrated a sincere desire to renounce and honour a guru. The first stage of initiation for entrants into non-daÖ·Ê institutions is known as the pañc-guru-saÒsk§r (‘five guru ceremony’),33 while the first stage in daÖ·Ê initiations is to become a brahmac§rÊ, acquiring one of the four daÖ·Ê surnames,34 $nanda, Caitanya, Prak§áa or Svaråpa, depending on the organisational affiliation of the maãha from which the candidate is taking initiation.35 A brahmac§rÊ generally serves fully initiated saÒny§sÊ-s, as, theoretically, a daÖ·Ê is not supposed to touch fire or metal. The second stage—for all—is the saÒny§sa initiation, known as vidy§-saÒsk§r or viraj§-havan (or homa). During the pañc-guru-saÒsk§r the candidate acquires, besides his main guru, four other gurus, from either the daÖ·Ê maãha, or from
31
See also Ghurye (1964:105); Sinha and Saraswati (1978:65); and earlier ethnographers, such as Rose (1914, Vol. 3:348–355) and Anantakrishna Iyer (1930–1931). Sarkar (1958:66) refers to two texts as sources for his information, the Sannyas-grahanpaddh§ti of ParamahaÒsa Gop§l§nand (Banaras 1941)—which I have been unable to locate—and the YatidharmasaÒgraha of ViáveávarasarasvatÊ (Anand Ashram Press, 1909), who was the teacher of the advaitin MadhusådanasarasvatÊ (1540–1647). The text of the YatidharmasaÒgraha (also known as the Yatidharmasamuccaya) is often in whole or in part contained in manuscripts entitled Viáveávara SmÜti. A work entitled Pañcam§árama-vidh§na is a work based on or contained in the Viáveávara SmÜti, a title of numerous similar but not identical texts (Olivelle 1986:21). 32 Sad§nanda Giri and Tripathi were both initiated into the Daáan§mÊs, as a paramahaÒsa and daÖ·Ê respectively. Tripathi describes most of the procedures outlined in the following section. His top-knot and sacred thread were removed by his preceptor, the top-knot being thrown into the Ganges, and the sacred thread tied to the daÖ·a. The climax of his initiation ceremony was when the preceptor whispered the praißa (or “iva) mantra into his ear. 33 Some daÖ·Ê institutions, such as the MachlÊbandar Maãha (one of the larger daÖ·Ê institutions, with headquarters in Banaras) also perform the preliminary pañcguru-saÒsk§r initiation, some time before the viraj§-homa. 34 Amongst the daÖ·Ê-s, the guru’s name is referred to as prem-path, and the áißya-’s as yog-path. 35 The brahmac§rÊ-s I interviewed from the MachlÊbandar Maãha of Banaras all took the brahmac§rÊ name Svaråpa, owing to the maãha-’s theoretical affiliation to the “§rad§ pÊãha in Dv§rak§.
90
chapter three
the akh§Ü§. The pañc-guru-saÒsk§r may take place at any time, the saÒny§sa rite—freeing the candidate from all previous social ties— being usually performed at the following Kumbh Mel§. Akh§Ü§-s recruit initiates from amongst those who have been accepted by a maãha or recommended by an individual or by the Jam§t. Akh§Ü§-s also admit those who are disciples of others outside their order, and individuals who are not saÒny§sÊ-s but who have served under a n§g§ unconnected with the akh§Ü§. The n§g§ may then send a potential recruit directly to the akh§Ü§. Initiation into the Daáan§mÊs may also, in some rare instances, be directly at one of the main “aØkarite maãha-s,36 for disciples directly under one of the four (or five) reigning “aØkar§c§ryas. Some kind of initiation by a Mah§maÖ·aleávara or Daáan§mÊ s§dhu may also be given quite freely to aspirants such as roving and inquisitive foreigners.37 However, although a new name, mantra and meditation techniques may be given, Daáan§mÊs emphasise the importance of the performance of the viraj§-homa (see below), incumbent on all genuine daÖ·Ê-s, paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s, before one is truly a saÒny§sÊ.38 The following details of current initiation procedures are as performed by candidates taking initiation into the Jån§ akh§Ü§. First, the keeper of the akh§Ü§ records, the k§rb§rÊ, duly records the name of the candidate, whose guru is so and so, and that he has paid his dues (frequently fifty-one rupees) to a particular ma·hi of the “rÊ Pañcn§m Jån§ Akh§Ü§ for the maintenance of the chaÜÊ (‘mobile shrine’) of Guru Datt§treya. The date is recorded according to the
36 Sawai (1992:155) observes that at the time of his research at the “ÜØgerÊ maãha, in 1984: “There are in “ÜØgerÊ currently only three saÒny§sins including the senior Jagadguru (mah§saÒnidh§nam in Sanskrit and Dodda GurugaÏa “old teacher” in Kanna·a). This small number seems to imply that a life of saÒny§sa is perceived by most sm§rtas as too arduous to attempt...[At] “ÜØgerÊ, the Jagadguru is very reticent in permitting aspirants to enter saÒny§sa.” It should be noted that daÖ·Ê-s initiated into saÒny§sa directly by a “aØkar§c§rya at the main “aØkara pÊãha-s constitute a very small percentage of Daáan§mÊs, and that there are many dozens of other daÖ·Ê maãha-s in north India. The vast majority of Daáan§mÊ saÒny§sÊ-s, comprising paramahaÒsa-s, daÖ·Ê-s and n§g§-s, have been initiated at a Kumbh Mel§ via one of the hundreds of maãha-s and §árama-s scattered throughout north India. 37 My wife and I were ‘initiated’ into saÒny§sa by a Mah§maÖ·aleávara at the Kumbh Mel§ around fifteen minutes after meeting him. 38 Sad§nanda Giri (1976:69) mentions a judgment of the Court of the District Judge at Hooghly in West Bengal, in 1937 (Order No. 147, 27: 8), that no person is a saÒny§sÊ unless he has performed the viraj§-homa.
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
91
Hindu calendar. Candidates, usually as a group, present themselves on the appointed day, already shaven, except for the top-knot. A paÖ·it, the guru and the initiate will sit in a triangle in front of the dhånÊ. Uttering “Sv§h§”, oblations of water and flower petals are made, after which the candidate drinks pañcgavya, a mixture of cow’s milk, curd, ghee, urine and faeces. The candidate is then presented with a bundle, containing a coconut, loin-cloth (langoãÊ), sacred thread (janeå) and rudr§kßa necklace, wrapped in an ochre cloth (bhagv§) which he places at the feet of the guru. Technically, the initiating guru is not considered to be the candidate’s ‘real’ guru, as the initiating guru is merely the witness guru, s§kßÊ-guru, to the event of the candidate becoming a disciple of Datt§treya, the Lord of YogÊs. Besides the initiating guru (the mantra-guru), who is effectively the main guru, there are four other gurus from the same akh§Ü§ present, who, with appropriate mantras, will present the candidate with, respectively, holy ash (vibhåti), loin-cloth (langoãÊ), a necklace of beads (rudr§kßa) and sacred thread (janeå).39 These five gurus constitute the so-called pañc-guru-s that the candidates acquire on their first initiation, known as the mantra-guru, rudr§kßa-guru etc. Under the bhagv§, held aloft by other s§dhu-s, the candidate’s top-knot is cut and the guru-mantra is whispered three times into the candidate’s ear by the mantra-guru, ending: “NamaÈ parvatÊ pate, hara hara Mah§deva”. He is given a new name, ending in one of the ten Daáan§mÊ names.40 The candidate then bathes, smears his body with holy ash, and is given a loin-cloth, rudr§kßa and sacred thread. He is finally wrapped in the bhagv§ and places a monetary offering (dakßiÖ§) at the guru’s feet. He then performs what is known as oÒkar-s to the five gurus,
39 PurÊ (2001:160–167) provides the mantras used in the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ for the following: cutting the coãÊ (top-knot); mantra ‘blown’ into the ear; bhagv§; guru; ‘laying’ of the gerå (ochre colour) on cloth; vibhåti; Vedic mantra for wearing bhasm (‘ash’); applying candan (‘sandalwood’) paste; rudr§kßa; langoãÊ; pÜthvÊ (‘earth’); jal (‘water’); G§yatrÊ; going in the direction of ‘the field’; purification of the water vessel (kamaÖ·al ); the tent; tooth-brushing; bringing the dhånÊ to ‘consciousness’; digambar (n§g§) initiation; jaã§; gol§ (‘ball of ash’); sam§dhi. 40 This ceremony is referred to in the Brahmanical texts on renunciation as the yogapaããa, wherein the candidate receives a new name and recites the fifteenth to the thirty-third verses of the eleventh chapter of the BhagavadgÊt§. See Yatidharmaprak§áa 66. 1–24, ‘The Procedure of (Conferring) the Meditation Shawl’, where one of the first textual references to the ‘Ten Names’ occurs.
92
chapter three
a cycle of five rounds of a mantra,41 to each guru, presenting each with dakßiÖ§ of one rupee. The oÒkar is to be subsequently performed twice a day, morning and evening, the recitation accompanied by a rite involving the touching of thumbs and fingers. The coconut is then cracked open, the amount of water inside indicating the capacities of the novice s§dhu. The coconut water is mixed with raw sugar (gu·) and made into cakes. The guru feeds the áißya and the áißya feeds the guru, and the guru asks three times, “Which is sweeter, guru or gu·?”, to which the áißya replies, “Guru”. A metal plate is then lifted over the áißya’s head and the guru announces to the three worlds that the candidate has become a cel§ (áißya). Such kinds of announcement within the akh§Ü§ are known as puk§r (‘call’), a public statement that carries far more weight within what is essentially an oral tradition than in religious culture that is more textually based. Pieces of coconut and gu· are then distributed to all s§dhu-s present, the Brahmans performing the havan, and the fire-places (dhånÊ) of the akh§Ü§. This concludes the first stage of saÒny§sa, during which the saÒny§sÊ acquires five gurus, including the mantra-guru, and is nominally affiliated to the akh§Ü§. He is now called a mah§purußa or a vastradh§rÊ.42 The s§dhu-’s full initiation into the akh§Ü§ takes place in the third and final stage of initiation, when the saÒny§sÊ may become a n§g§.
41 “OÒ Guru-jÊ, OÒ Dev-jÊ, OÒ Datt-jÊ, OÒ Sv§mÊ-jÊ, OÒ $lakh-jÊ, OÒ Namo N§r§yaÖ”. 42 Initiation into the R§m§nandÊ order entails similar procedures (see Sharma 1998:62–68). The vaißÖava pañc-saÒsk§r consists of: 1. tap-saÒsk§r; being adorned by heated brands with the emblems of N§r§yaÖa, the cakra (to the right arm) and áaØkha (to the left arm); 2. puÖ·ra-saÒsk§r; applying a tilak of white clay to the forehead, arm, chest and stomach; 3. m§l§ or kanãhÊ-saÒsk§r; receiving a necklace of tulsÊ beads; 4. n§m-saÒsk§r: receiving the name D§s, together with the name of VißÖu for the current month; 5. mantra-saÒsk§r, receiving the kharaáar mantra from the guru, whispered thrice into his ear, while he is under a cloth. If, after a six-month trial, the disciple’s conduct has been satisfactory, then he is presented with: 1. a cloth to cover his head; 2. two loin-cloths; 3. a cloth (acal ) to cover the loin-cloth; 4. kamaÖ·al. The “rÊ-VaißÖava saÒny§sÊ-s, founded by R§m§nuja, are invariably Brahmans and former householders. SaÒny§sa rites are almost the same as those performed by the Daáan§mÊs (see below). Amongst scriptures recited is the VißÖu-sahasran§ma (see Lester 1992:78). Following the §tma-ár§ddha, §árama-svÊk§ra (the acceptance of the fourth §árama) begins with the praißa mantra.
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
93
3.3 Current procedures: viraj§-havan / -homa (vidy§-saÒsk§r) and n§g§ initiations The second initiation, the viraj§-havan (the ‘rite of the hero’) or vidy§saÒsk§r, is nearly always performed at Kumbh Mel§s. This is the main saÒny§sa rite, which contains most of the features detailed in the texts that were examined in the first part of this chapter concerning ancient renunciation procedures. It is uniquely this rite that authenticates the saÒny§sÊ-’s condition of renunciation (as a ‘genuine’ s§dhu), whether as a daÖ·Ê or a paramahaÒsa. While the major part of this rite is performed by a Brahman paÖ·it, some parts are performed by the §c§rya-guru (a Mah§maÖ·aleávara), who will represent either a daÖ·Ê lineage (initiating daÖ·Ê-s)43 or an akh§Ü§ 44 (being elected by the n§g§-s of the akh§Ü§). For daÖ·Ê-s, the §c§rya-guru may be the same person who performs both the preliminary brahmac§rÊ rite and the final saÒny§sa rite. The §c§rya-guru is also a representative of a reigning “aØkar§c§rya, who also usually presides over major initiation ceremonies at the Kumbh Mel§s. For some days, many hundreds of s§dhu-s will have had a restricted, phal§h§r, diet, which is essentially a diet of milk with some fruit, and will have been repeating the g§yatrÊ mantra. They line up near a river or saØgam at dawn, bringing their parc§, a piece of dried silver-birch bark, on which is written their saÒny§sÊ details and that their dues have been paid to the akh§Ü§. Koãv§l-s police the assembly. The candidates have their head (except for the top-knot), moustache, beard, armpits and pubic region shaved (pañca bhadra), and are given a sacred-thread, a kulhaÜ (a small clay pot representing a kamaÖ·al), and a daÖ·a,45 an
43 Sad§nanda Giri (1976:64–71) remarks that for daÖ·Ê initiations, the number of candidates should equal the number of words in the praißa-mantra, so that during initiation each candidate utters in turn one word of the mantra. 44 To give an example, paramahaÒsa Sv§mÊ Gop§l§nanda of the DakßiÖamårtÊ Maãh of Banaras was initiated by a Mah§maÖ·aleávara from the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§. However, he explained (conversation, on 8 February 2002) that initiations in their order are usually performed by a Mah§maÖ·aleávara from the NirañjanÊ akh§Ü§. 45 DaÖ·a-s may be given to the candidates. Otherwise, two days before the ceremony, they go as a group to the jungle, cut their own daÖ·a-s and collect the firewood (samidh) that will be used in the viraj§-homa. A Brahman should have a daÖ·a of pal§áa wood (flame of the forest, butea frondosa), whereas kßatriya-s and vaiáya-s should have bilva (Bengal quince, aegle marmelos) (Sad§nanda Giri 1976:65).
94
chapter three
ancient symbol of not only asceticism, but also royal power.46 DaÖ·a-s are only used by brahmac§rin-s, so all candidates become nominal brahmac§rin-s before initiation. The §c§rya-guru informs the candidates that this is their last opportunity to return to their homes and families, should they wish to do so. Each candidate briefly discards his cloth and walks naked a few steps to the north before being called back by the §c§rya-guru. (This symbolic walk was discussed previously in the context of the saÒny§sÊ-’s potential suicide.) At sunset the candidates return to the akh§Ü§, which has four funeral fires burning at each corner. Around the fires, the viraj§-havan (or homa)47 will be conducted, for which the candidates are given some of the requisite materials (which include mustard and sesame seeds, the oblation of the viraj§-havan). While a Brahman paÖ·it performs the havan, the §c§rya-guru goes around whispering one of the four mah§v§kya-s (depending on lineage) into the candidates’ ears. Recitation of the Purußa-såkta is also an important element of the ritual.48
46 DaÖ·a also means punishment. For an an analysis of the symbolic value of daÖ·a in both political and religious domains, see Glucklich (1988). 47 Sarkar (1958:67–73) and Kane (HD“ Vol. 2:959-960) describe the lengthy viraj§-homa ceremony, involving a total of forty oblations, of fuel-sticks (the samidh collected by the candidate), boiled rice and ghee. There is a discussion of the viraj§homa in the TaittirÊya-§raÖyaka (1.51-52; 2), wherein the best means to attain selfknowledge is saÒny§sa. (Kane’s account appears to derive from a mediaeval work, Dharmasindhu.) First, the sixteen verses of the Purußa-såkta (RV X.90) are chanted, oblations being performed at the end of each verse. As in many Brahmanical cosmogonic schemes, a classification of 3 + 1 elements is apparent in the Purußa-såkta, whereby three parts of the whole are ‘visible’ and one is ‘invisible’. The visible part of Purußa includes the four varÖa-s produced from the dismembered ‘cosmic man’ (see Malamoud 1998:111). The recitation of the Purußa-såkta is followed by the reciting of the formulae, after oblations, of the viraj§-homa, such as: “May my five pr§Öa-s be purified, may I be light, free from r§jas and from evil, sv§h§. This is for pr§Öa and the rest, it is not mine”. The formulae speak of the purification of all the parts of the body, the five elements and their corresponding guÖa-s, purußa, the five koáa-s (sheaths), the mind, speech and the §tman, and pay homage to the Veda-s. The sacrificer then bows to Agni, Praj§pati, $tma, Param§tma and Jñ§n§tma, after which the Purußa-såkta is again recited. Recitations follow, of various verses and mantras from the Upanißad-s and the first sentences of the four Veda-s. Oblations to Agni SvißãakÜt follow, and the candidate burns his wooden utensils in the household fire, donates his metal vessels to his guru, and deposits the fire in himself, reciting thrice “ayam te yoniÈ” and “ya te agne yajñiy§”, taking in the warmth of the fire. 48 Besides its occurrence in the Atharva Veda (19.6), the Purußa-såkta is also recited for obtaining a son, for purificatory baths, for the purification of sins, and during ár§ddha rites for the deceased (Gonda 1970:27–32). According to some sources, after death the soul assumes what is known as an §tiv§hika áarÊra, which consists of
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
95
With the assistance of the paÖ·it, the candidates perform their own funeral rites (ár§ddha), holding the stem of the sacred dårv§ grass. While chanting the prescribed Vedic mantras the candidates perform the eight kinds of ár§ddha (noted previously) and tarpaÖa, wherein water is released to the ground from cupped hands, as an offering to all the gods. They also offer piÖ·§ to the gods and ancestors, in the form of (usually) forty-eight balls of wheat flour. There is now no responsibility for anyone after the saÒny§sÊ dies. After a night of chanting and initiation, following the performance of the viraj§-havan, the saÒny§sÊ goes to the river with the §c§rya-guru, where he bathes, breaks his daÖ·a, discards his sacred thread, which is thrown into the river, and calls on the Sun and Moon, Wind and Fire, Earth and Sky, Heart and Mind, the morning and evening Twilights, and all the gods to witness his resolution to become a saÒny§sÊ. This is followed by the recitation, usually performed in waist-deep water, of the g§yatrÊ mantra, which is henceforth internalised. The praißa mantra is also recited—modulated in three different pitches—after which the initiate faces the east, performs an oblation to the water and asks that all creatures be free of fear of him. He gives blessings to his sons and relatives, telling them that he belongs to no one and no one belongs to him. He takes vows of ahiÒs§, truthfulness, not stealing, continence, liberality, non-anger, waiting upon the guru, avoidance of carelessness, cleanliness and purity in food habits.49 He then covers his body with ashes and returns to the akh§Ü§. He is instructed on doing good for society and receives a loin-cloth (kaupÊn§)
only three (fire, wind and space) of the five elements. If the appropriate rites are performed, the áarÊra of three elements may pass over the space between death and the formation of a new gross body in the following incarnation. The recitation of the Purußa-såkta enables the reconstitution of a new body. For bathing and deathrites, the Purußa-såkta was used to renew the person concerned, underlined in the case of bathing by an obligatory change of clothes. Gonda (1970:27) remarks that “throughout the ages this text was, in religious practice not only an account of the creation but also an instrument of rising above one’s present state of existence. By identifying oneself with the mythical Purußa and by ritually repeating the mythical event and so reactivating its inherent power for the benefit of oneself and with a view to one’s own reintegration one believed oneself to achieve one’s own ‘rebirth’”. Gonda also notes (1970:32) that the content of the Purußa-såkta became one of the foundations of vaißÖava philosophy, besides often being quoted by the áaiva tradition. 49 See fn. 57 for summaries of rules for saÒny§sÊ-s by Oman (1903:155); Rose (1914, Vol. 3:360); Sad§nanda Giri (1976:25); PurÊ (2001).
96
chapter three
and water pot (kamaÖ·al). The §c§rya-guru then cuts the top-knot (áikh§) on behalf of candidate’s guru, and abhißeka is performed with a conchshell over the initiate’s head. The candidate touches a daÖ·a, which is held by the §c§rya-guru, who pronounces a mantra meaning that the daÖ·a is renounced. Henceforth, the saÒny§sÊ accepts the daÖ·a of knowledge. After this ritual the candidate is instructed in the oÒ, praißa and paramahaÒsa mantras and the significance of the mah§v§kya-s by the §c§rya-guru, to whom presents are given. We have so far been detailing initiation rites of paramahaÒsa-s (and potential n§g§-s), who are initiated by an akh§Ü§ (in this case the Jån§ akh§Ü§), and who only hold a daÖ·a for a portion of the renunciatory rite, after which it is renounced. However, daÖ·Ê-s, who are Brahmans initiated by a representative of a daÖ·Ê maãha, keep the daÖ·a. It is referred to as Brahm-svaråp, and is made from bamboo and not the other kinds of wood, mentioned above, used in the saÒny§sa rite.50 As previously mentioned, a sacred thread and an axe-head are attached to the daÖ·a, which is covered with a cloth. The sacred thread is carried, albeit concealed, as an indication of Brahman status. The receipt of the daÖ·a from the guru is one of the central features of the traditional Brahmanical rites of initiation into the renunciatory state, as described in many mediaeval texts on renunciation. The Brahmanical rite of renunciation consists of two major parts, the first being renunciation proper, in which the candidate abandons family, possessions, fire and other symbols of his former life. The second part is modelled after Vedic initiation (upanayana),51 with some
50 At no time should the daÖ·a come into contact with anything impure. Once initiated into saÒny§sa the daÖ·a should never be further away from its holder than the distance a calf would wander from its mother, who will remain within hearing distance should the calf cry. A typical bamboo stick has knots at regular intervals and daÖ·Ê-s are given one of five sizes of daÖ·a, depending on their height. The tallest saÒny§sÊ-s are given daÖ·a-s with fourteen knots (known as Anant), and successively shorter saÒny§sÊ-s with, respectively, twelve knots (Gop§l), ten knots (V§sudev), eight knots (N§r§yaÖ), and six knots (Sudaráan). (Interviews were conducted with numerous daÖ·Ê-s, mostly of the MachlÊbandar Maãha, at the M§gh Mel§, in January and February, 2002.) 51 Upanayana is the traditional rite of passage for a Brahman or other twice-born male, into the twice-born (dvija) society of those who are entitled to perform sacrifices. Before upanayana, the boy is, technically, a áådra (Vasißãha Dharmasåtra II.6), until he attains twice-born status. The Brahman householder in particular is required to perform sacrifices: nitya (‘permanent’ rites, such as the agnihotra and sandhy§ worship), naimittika (‘occasional’ rites, performed at child-birth, j§takarma, and death, antyeßãi) and k§mya (‘supererogatory’ rites, such as to obtain a male child or at the time of a
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
97
significant differences (Olivelle 1986:37),52 and has the form of an initiatory rite (dÊkߧ) in which the guru plays a central role, ritually handing the new renouncer his staff: the candidate is initiated into a renunciatory tradition.53 Current practice, which clearly reflects ancient tradition, is that during initiations at the Kumbh Mel§ all initiates are furnished with a staff (daÖ·a) and sacred thread, which confers temporary status on them as Brahmans,54 whether or not they actually were previously Brahmans by caste. The daÖ·a also confers the status of brahmac§rin upon the candidate, symbolising his nominal allegiance to the monastic institutions. Gurus from daÖ·Ê institutions present candidates with daÖ·a-s to keep permanently, in continuation of the Brahmanical advaita tradition whereby saÒny§sÊ-s carry a daÖ·a to indicate both their sectarian affiliation and their renunciatory condition. However, at the completion of initiatory rites, non-daÖ·Ê saÒny§sÊ-s (i.e. paramahaÒsa-s) discard the staff and sacred thread—the markers of Brahman status—which they have carried and worn for the period immediately prior to initiation, as a sign that they have entered
pilgrimage to a holy place). Upanayana is traditionally performed in the eighth year for a Brahman, the eleventh year for a kßatriya, and the twelfth year for a vaiáya, though texts vary on the timing. See Prasad (1997) for further details. 52 There are distinct parallels and homologies between the life of the boy brahmac§rin, before upanayana, and the saÒny§sin: the brahmac§rin studies away from the parental home, serving a guru. As a formal preparation for the life of a householder (gÜhastha), the brahmac§rin—like a saÒny§sÊ—remains celibate, undergoes various austerities, begs for food and sleeps on the floor (Dharmasåtra-s of $pastamba 1.2.18–41, 1.31–45; Baudh§yana 1.3.7–47; Vasißãha 11.49–79). During the upanayana the brahmacarin has his head shaved, leaving the topknot (a ceremony variously known as muÖ·ana, cå·§karaÖa or caula), and was traditionally presented with a girdle (mekhal§), sacred thread, deerskin and daÖ·a. The Brahman’s daÖ·a should be of bilva or pal§áa wood, and should be as long as to reach the end of his hair, the kßatriya-’s of vaãa or khadira, to reach the forehead, and a vaiáya-’s of pilu or udumbara, to reach the tip of his nose (Kaelber 1981; Prasad 1997:117). 53 See also Kaelber (1989:121): “Whereas the Sanny§sa Upanißads often state that the sanny§sin gives up his sacrificial cord, girdle, antelope skin, and upper garment, the Vaikh§nasasm§rta Såtra makes it clear that the sanny§sin receives these things anew at his initiation in exactly the way prescribed at the Upanayana. The instructions given for the reception of the initiate by his new teacher (!), including the recitation of the S§vitrÊ (S§vitrÊpraveáana), are virtually identical in each case. As part of the initiation the sanny§sin has his hair, beard, and nails cut, receives a new name, swears obedience to his teacher, and takes a vow of truthfulness and ‘noninjury’ (ahiÒs§), just as the brahmac§rin had done before him, and like the brahmac§rin, the ascetic now begins a long period of training”. 54 See also Crooke (1896, Vol. 2:471).
98
chapter three
the saÒny§sÊ life and permanently renounced caste. The mandatory carrying of a staff for initiation purposes may perhaps indicate that in order to obviate potential complaints from genuine Brahmancaste initiates about the admission of non-Brahmans, all candidates temporarily become Brahmans (holding a staff), but then renounce ‘Brahman’ status during initiation. For those who wish, there is a third stage of initiation to become a n§g§, which may take place at any age. This initiation was traditionally performed several years after saÒny§sa—younger aspirants usually waiting longer for initiation than older men—but these days n§g§ initiation usually takes place a day or two after the vidy§-saÒsk§r initiation. According to my informants n§g§ initiations may, in some rare instances, occur directly, without prior saÒny§sa initiation. A saÒny§sÊ wishing to take n§g§ initiation first approaches a árÊ-mahant (a leading mahant) who will question him as to whether he really wants to become a n§g§. Some days before the bathing procession (sy§hi/ julås) of the Kumbh Mel§, the koãv§l goes to the eight divisions of his akh§Ü§ and announces that each division may send those wishing to become n§g§-s. The names of candidates are then recorded by the k§rb§rÊ. N§g§ Initiations take place at night, at 3.00 a.m. or 4.00 a.m. at Kumbh Mel§s and $dh§ (half) Kumbh Mel§s. At the appointed time the saÒny§sÊ stands next to the kÊrti-stambha, a tall ‘triumphal’ column in the §árama, accompanied by four árÊ-mahant-s and one §c§rya-guru who will give him a mantra. A mahant will then pull the penis thrice, breaking the membrane beneath the skin, an operation known as ãang to·e (literally, ‘broken leg’).55 The saÒny§sÊ is hence fully initiated into the akh§Ü§ as a n§g§, and attached to a n§g§ renunciate lineage.56 Whether initiated as daÖ·Ê, paramahaÒsa or n§g§, the saÒny§sÊ is
55 From different interviews, Sad§nanda Giri (1976:29–30) maintains that the method of initiating new n§g§-s is different in each akh§Ü§. He also observes that formerly ãang to·e was performed but that nowadays there is “only a slight pull of the penis”. It seems that formerly some initiates had the penis broken (ãang to·e) before saÒny§sa, but never performed the viraj§ homa to become n§g§ saÒny§sÊ-s, remaining ‘ãang to·e’ all their lives. 56 According to several n§g§ informants I have interviewed, in the past the process may have involved the guru breaking the muscle of the erect penis with three sharp movements in different directions, rendering the initiate permanently impotent. However, these days the process involves the breaking of the membrane that attaches the foreskin to the penis.
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
99
henceforth a member of a distinct religious community, to a considerable extent bound by often unspoken but mutually recognised rules of behaviour appropriate to their status within their branch of the order,57 a position also often influenced by previous caste. However, in the classical textual tradition may be found injunctions for the ‘ideal’ kinds ascetic. Although the images of the kind of lifestyle presented in these texts have been very influential on general understanding of the renunciate, they seem to bear little correspondence to contemporary or historical reality.
57 Oman (1903:155) cites the ‘rules’, which he had gathered from a member of the order, as follows: (six prohibitions) 1. do not sleep on a couch, under any circumstances; 2. do not wear white clothes; 3. do not speak to or even think about women; 4. do not sleep during the daytime; 5. do not at any time ride on a horse or other animal, or in any vehicle whatsoever. 6. do not allow your mind to be agitated in any way; (six commandments) 1. leave your abode only for the sake of begging necessary food; 2. say your prayers every day; 3. bathe every day; 4. contemplate daily the likeness or image of “iva; 5. practice purity and cleanliness; 6. perform the formal worship of the gods. An account of the rules for saÒny§sÊ-s to obey is cited by Rose (1914:360), from P. Hari Kaul’s Census Report, §148. He should: 1. wear one cloth around his waist and one over his shoulder (he should beg like this); 2. only eat one meal in twenty-four hours; 3. live outside; 4. beg from seven, and not more than seven, houses (except in the case of the kuãÊcaka); 5. not stay in one place more than a few days (except the kuãÊcaka); 6. sleep on the ground; 7. not salute, or speak well or ill of anyone; 8. bow only to saÒny§sÊ-s of higher status or longer standing; 9. only wear the salmon-coloured cloth. Sad§nanda Giri (1976:25) gives ‘six commandments’ to be obeyed by n§g§saÒny§sÊ-s: 1. accept that all property belongs to the community; 2. abstain from all narcotics; 3. do not go to other akh§Ü§-s; 4. do not quarrel with your comrades; 5. obey your superior officer; 6. use whatever belongs to the community, but do not steal or keep anything for yourself. PurÊ (2001:149) provides rules and prohibitions (paraphrased below from the Hindi text) for mahant-s and th§n§pati-s of the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§. They will lose their power and office should they: 1. misuse or destroy any of the moveable or unmoveable property of the akh§Ü§, or use such for the benefit of any other than the akh§Ü§; 2. incur debt for the akh§Ü§ through overspending; 3. keep a wife or woman; 4. have any independent business or occupation; 5. make a disciple (i.e. independently), or introduce anyone as a member of this organisation; 6. become a follower of any other dharma or samprad§ya; 7. bring harm or loss to any main office or branch (of this institution). In a following section, PurÊ states some miscellaneous rules concerning the recording of the names of mahant-s and th§n§pati-s at the headquarters at Allahabad, and their duties in the akh§Ü§.
100
chapter three 3.4 Rules for renunciates
The earliest substantial Brahmanical accounts of rules for the renunciate to obey are to found in the Dharmasåtra-s, rules that are repeated, often in modified form, in many of the Dharmaá§stra-s,58 the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s59 and mediaeval texts on renunciation, which frequently cite the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s as authoritative. According to Baudh§yana (2.17.42—2.18.27),60 the renunciate should only drink water from a well that has been filtered through his water strainer. He should not wear white clothes and should carry the single or triple staff. He should maintain the vows of not injuring living beings, speaking the truth, not stealing, celibacy, and renunciation. The secondary vows are not giving way to anger, obedience to the teacher, not being careless, purification, and purity of food habits. He should beg from “§lÊnas and Y§y§varas, and after returning and washing his hands and feet he should offer his food to the sun, reciting appropriate formulae.61 In the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s the way of life of the wandering ascetic is discussed in many passages. In general the renunciate lives far from his native home, outside the village and its associations with ritual life. Apart from the four months of the rainy season, he wanders without fire or home, living in the wilderness, accepting indiscriminately whatever food is given. The ideal method of begging is to imitate the bee (madhukara), begging
58 See Dutta (1987 [1906]): Y§jñavalkya-saÒhit§ (Vol. 1:56–66); H§rÊta-saÒhit§ (Vol. 1, ch. 6:1–23); Uáan§-saÒhit§ (Vol. 1:1.29–31). The “aØkha-saÒhit§ (Vol. 3:7.1–32) also mentions three of the limbs of classical yoga; dh§raÖ§, praty§h§ra and dhy§na. The overall cosmology centres on VißÖu (or V§sudeva), the all pervading. 59 See Olivelle (1992). Most of the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s date from between the first few centuries CE and around the twelfth century, some from the fourteenth or fifteenth centuries (Olivelle (1993:8–11). 60 Similar prescriptions are given by $pastamba (2.21.7–2.23.2) and Gautama (3.11–3.35). Vasißãha (9.1–10.29) adds that the ascetic should not display the emblems of the renouncer (staff, begging bowl, water strainer etc.). He should not beg through the means of astrology, interpreting omens or the signs of the body, or participate in debates. He may, however, live homeless and resolute in a village. He may also act as if mad. This is also recommended for the P§áupatas (see KauÖ·inya’s comm., tr. Haripada Chakraborty, on P§áupata Såtra 1.8, 2.3, 3.12–14). The renunciate may feign madness and attempt to attract censure, courting dishonour and insult, so that he may not be attached to the pride ensuing from praise (see also Ingalls 1962). 61 For a review of rules and vows for Brahmanical ascetics (based primarily on the Dharmasåtra-s and Manu SmÜti ) see Shiraishi (1996:27–135).
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
101
a little food from many houses. Another method is to undertake the ‘python vow’ (ajagaravrata), waiting for food to come. The highest types of renouncers forego their begging bowls and eat directly from their hands (p§Öip§trin), or the ground (udarap§trin) as would an animal. Four kinds of ascetics (kuãÊcaka/kuãicara, bahådaka, haÒsa, paramahaÒsa) are explained in many texts, arranged—with minor modifications and inconsistencies—in a hierarchy of ‘detachment’.62 They are to be found in the Mah§bh§rata (XIII.129.29),63 VißÖu SmÜti (4.11),64 Skanda Pur§Öa, SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s65 and many of the mediaeval texts on renunciation.66 This four-fold classification is also referred to by
62 1. KuãÊcaka: lives in a hut (kuãÊ), wears saffron-coloured clothes, has a triple staff (tridaÖ·a) and wears the sacred thread. He should stay with his son and depend on him for his living. 2. Bahådaka: should renounce his relatives, have a tridaÖ·a, wear the sacred thread, recite the g§yatrÊ mantra, wear saffron-coloured clothes, and beg for food at seven houses of sage-like Brahmans (or other well conducted men), avoiding flesh, salt and stale food. 3. HaÒsa: should be versed in Ved§nta and have the pursuit of knowledge as his aim. He should stay in one place and live on charity. He may carry a single staff and a water-pot and wear the sacred thread. He should stay not more than one night in a village and not more than five nights in a town when begging for alms, otherwise he should subsist on cow-urine and cow-dung, or fast for a month. 4. ParamahaÒsa: has attained knowledge and regards all as the Self. He either wears one piece of cloth or goes naked, and begs and eats with his hands only. He lives in an uninhabited house, a burial ground or under a tree. He may carry a single staff but abandons the top-knot, sacred thread and permanent rites. 63 Kuãicara, kÜtodaka, haÒsa, paramahaÒsa. 64 See Jolly (1991). 65 See $árama Upanißad (the earliest of the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s, dated to around the third century CE) and Bhikßuka Upanißad. In the N§radaparivr§jaka Upanißad (vv. 174-175) several classificatory schemes are provided, including a six-fold scheme that includes the turÊy§tÊta and avadhåta, which, as Olivelle notes (1992:99), cannot be easily distinguished from one another. Both these kinds of renouncers are considered to be liberated beings and not subject to any kind of rule or prohibition. The other four classes of ascetics are also distinguished by the goals to which they aspire: kuãÊcaka-s to the atmospheric world; bahådaka-s to the heavenly world; haÒsa-s to the Penance-world; and paramahaÒsa-s to the Truth-world. There is also a discussion (vv. 204–205) of the relative frequency of shaving, eating and bathing, and the application of renunciatory marks of ash and sandal paste, according to the relative grade of the six kinds of renunciates. Lower kinds, the kuãÊcaka and bahådaka, shave, bathe and eat more frequently than the higher kinds. The highest kind, the avadhåta, obtains his food “like a python”, does not shave nor does he apply any sign or mark. 66 See the twelfth-century Yatidharmasamuccaya (5.7); the P§r§áaram§dhavÊya and JÊvanmuktiviveka attributed to Vidy§raÖya; and the seventeenth-century Yatidharmaprak§áa
102
chapter three
modern commentators on the Daáan§mÊ tradition.67 The four kinds of renouncer are graded in respect of the degree of their renunciation, the ParamahaÒsa-s being the highest,68 a distinctive feature of many classifications of ascetics being the importance attached to eating habits. The paramahaÒsa stage is sometimes referred to as the fifth §árama or as beyond the §árama-s. As a classificatory term for renunciates, it was frequently used by “aØkara, who did not use the other terms for ascetics just referred to. In his commentary on the BÜhad§raÖyaka Upanißad (III.5.1.49) he distinguishes the renunciation associated with the classical fourth §árama from the higher type of renunciation wherein all emblems of the renouncer are abandoned, a condition he associates with the paramahaÒsa (as explained, a term that has a specific sense in the Daáan§mÊ social context). “aØkara was also referred to as a paramahaÒsa by his hagiographers, as a sign of respect for the highest type of renouncer. Within the four-fold classification given above, it may be seen that the two lower classes of ascetics carry the triple staff, whereas the higher classes carry either a single staff or none at all. (This is according to the advaita tradition, whereby the ‘lower’ viáißã§dvaita adherents carry the triple staff.) The paramahaÒsa discards the top-knot and the sacrificial string, the preeminent marks or signs of Brahman status. Even though, theoretically, renunciation should be of the former life, including caste, in some passages in the advaita-orientated SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s it is explained that the top-knot and sacrificial thread were in fact retained despite renunciation, albeit symbolically.69
(4.1–113) by V§sudev§árama. V§sudev§árama cites several sources on classes of renouncers, including Vidy§raÖya’s JÊanmuktiviveka, the Skanda Pur§Öa and the Yatidharmasamuccaya. Kane (HD“ Vol. 2:939) notes that the four kinds of ascetics to be found in the Mah§bh§rata, Såta-saÒhit§ (M§nayogakhaÖ·a ch. 6), Bhikßuka Upanißad and Vaikh§nasa-dharmasåtra (8.9) are not consistently categorised, and that the categorisation in the latter text is probably the oldest. 67 See, for example, PurÊ (2001:32–33). 68 The ParamahaÒsa Upanißad describes (vv. 1–4) the way of the paramahaÒsa yogins, the highest class of ascetics, as extremely rare. “If there is one such person, he alone abides in the eternally pure Being, and he alone is a man of the Veda-s”. He has renounced not only family, topknot and sacred string, but all rites and possessions: he goes entirely naked. “He is not attached anywhere either to the pleasant or the unpleasant”. The J§b§la Upanißad (v. 6) adds that they “keep their conduct concealed, and... although they are sane, behave like madmen”. 69 Thus, for example, in the N§radaparivr§jaka Upanißad (vv. 152–153), in response to the question as to how a man can be a Brahman when he has no sacrificial
renunciation, rules for ascetics, and initiation
103
Commenting on the different and conflicting classifications of renouncers to be found in the SaÒny§sa Upanißad-s, Olivelle (1992:100) remarks that, “[they] point to the original variety of ascetic lifestyles that...were conflated into the single institution of saÒny§sa by Br§hmaÖic theology”. However, the Brahmanical concept of saÒny§sa—to enter a non-ritual state—is evidently but an ideal abstracted from a society with not only many kinds of ascetics, but also, as noted in the Introduction, many kinds of sects of ascetic renunciates that have existed at least since the time of the production of Brahmanical texts which detail the saÒny§sa rite. The rites of renunciation, detailed above, clearly indicate the process whereby the lineages of the daÖ·Ê maãha-s and the akh§Ü§-s are integrated. The saÒny§sÊ has theoretically severed all ties to his previous social world, is nominally—but only nominally—beyond caste, and has become affiliated either to a daÖ·Ê lineage, or to a Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§ (through his five gurus), in either case affiliated to the monastic tradition represented by the §c§rya-s and the “aØkar§c§ryas. The substance of the saÒny§sÊ-’s new identity is embodied in both the legend of “aØkara and what he represents, and in the structure of the Daáan§mÊ order as presented in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, short texts that are analysed in the next chapter.
string, it is explained that the sacrificial (or triple) string resides in the heart; that the renouncer’s string is worn as the supreme and imperishable Brahman; that knowledge is their top-knot; that the top-knot and sacrificial string consist of knowledge; and so forth.
104
chapter four
CHAPTER FOUR
THE INTEGRATION OF VARIOUS LINEAGES: THE MA•H$MN$YA-S In the previous chapters the structure of the Daáan§mÊ organisation was examined largely from an anthropological perspective, in terms of branches, divisions, initiations and hierarchies. It was also shown in the previous chapter how the two main wings of the order are integrated at times of the saÒny§sa rite. In this chapter, we will be examining the Daáan§mÊs from a different persective of integration; from that of the normative account of the tradition, in terms of its own history, which is predominantly constituted in terms of lineages. The central focus will be on the Maãh§mn§ya-s, texts that contain the details of Daáan§mÊ lineages and of the pÊãha-s supposedly founded by “aØkara. The information in these texts provides an overview of the Daáan§mÊ order, integrating the diverse lineages and providing all Daáan§mÊs with a commonly understood identity and a concise framework for their traditional religious history. The disparities between the sect’s own traditional history, particularly regarding the pÊãha-s, and historical evidence in the form of texts and inscriptions, will also be assessed. A brief, preliminary discussion of “aØkara’s authentic works and his probable date will be undertaken in the following section, as both issues bear directly on the history of the Daáan§mÊs.
4.1 “aØkara’s authorship of texts, and his date “aØkara is supposed to have organised the Daáan§mÊs, and is sometimes attributed with the authorship of one or another of the Maãh§mn§ya-s, short Sanskrit texts that present an overview of the order, its ten lineages and its pÊãha-s. These texts will be analysed in the following section. The issue of the genuine works of “aØkara has attracted considerable scholarly inquiry. The longest list I have so far seen of works attributed to “aØkara is that contained in the Appendix of Piantelli (1974:i–xiii), which lists 433 works, 187 of which, it is indicated, are accepted as genuine by the tradition, including the
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 105 Maãh§mn§y§divic§ra/Saptamaãh§mn§y§divic§ra.1 The Maãh§mn§yasetu is included in the list as a text not accepted as genuine by the tradition, and the Mah§nuá§sanam is not mentioned. The sheer volume of texts produced in a short life (of thirty-two years, according to tradition), the poor or different style of writing in some texts, philosophical inconsistencies in others, references to doctrines or schools that may be dated post-“aØkara, and devotional hymns, are amongst the considerations leading most scholars who have looked into the issue to doubt “aØkara’s authorship of a large number of texts attributed to him.2 There remains considerable doubt, however, about some of the criteria, however good,3 used to establish the validity of works, the genies of interpolation and alteration hovering ever close to many conclusions. Nevertheless, evidence derived from “aØkara’s hagiographies, examined in the following chapter, makes it highly improbable that “aØkara wrote the Maãh§mn§ya-s. The issue is further complicated by the fact that numerous §c§rya-s of both the official (four or five) and other advaita maãha-s have been called “aØkara, as have other writers who have no connection to the advaita tradition at all. Rukmani (1998:264) points out that “aØkara is a very common name in Kerala, and that “aØkara (the author of the Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya) had contemporaries named “aØkara, one being the author of the play, $ácaryacå·§maÖi, another being the “aØkara (or “aØkaran§r§yaÖa) who wrote the “aØkaran§r§yaÖam. Another “aØkar§c§rya was the author of the T§r§hasyavivÜttik§ (Hacker 1995:43), and Rukmani notes yet another, “aØkarapåjyap§dayati, who was the author of the Bhaããikavyavy§khya. However, terms such as påjyap§da and bhagavatp§da are often used as terms of respect for a guru; they are not exclusively reserved for the author of the Brahmasåtra-bh§ßya. To “aØkar§c§rya is also attributed the Prapañcas§ra, an early digest (10th–11th century?) of Tantric texts (Pal 1981:2). What may indisputably count as “aØkara’s genuine works4 are those
1
I have not seen this text, or seen any other reference to it. See, for example, Potter (1981:14–15). 3 See Pande (1994:99–129). 4 First published in 1947, Paul Hacker’s criteria (1995:41–56) towards establishing the genuine works of “aØkara have been influential on subsequent discussion. Mayeda (1992), who is influenced by Hacker in many respects, is another commentator frequently cited by others. Belvalkar (1929:209–240) also made a systematic 2
106
chapter four
commented on by “aØkara’s direct disciples,5 namely the Brahmasåtra-bh§ßya (BSB)—universally recognised as “aØkara’s quintessential work—on which Padmap§da wrote the Pañcap§dik§, and “aØkara’s bh§ßya-s on two Upanißad-s, the BÜhad§raÖyaka and theTaittirÊya, on both of which Sureávara wrote v§rttika-s. Sureávara also quotes the Upadeáas§hasrÊ in his Naißkarmyasiddhi. Beyond these four works, many have given rise to discussions of authenticity. Belvalkar (1929:215–231) comments on a total of fifty-seven texts, noting the existence of around 400 works attributed to “aØkara.6 Using several criteria, he concludes that eleven commentaries (including those on the BhagavadgÊt§, Brahmasåtra-s and nine Upanißad-s), eight stotra-s, and three prakaraÖagrantha-s can confidently be ascribed to “aØkara. A few other works may be those of “aØkara, while 358 other works must be considered as non-genuine. One of Hacker’s criteria (1995:41–56) for attempting to establish authenticity is the name attributed to the author of the texts. Twenty-one texts examined are attributed to “aØkar§c§rya, “aØkaraBhagavatp§da or “aØkara-Bhagavatpåjyap§da; fifteen are texts men-
and influential study of the issue. His conclusions, and those of Hacker, Mayeda and others, are further analysed by Pande (1994:100–130), who is more open to the inclusion of a greater number of works. 5 For the authentic works of the disciples, see Potter (1981, Vol. 3:18–19); Mayeda (1992:5); Hacker (1995:58). Padmap§da’s Pañcap§dik§ is probably his only genuine work, commented on by Prak§á§tman (mid tenth century) in the Pañcap§dik§vivaraÖa. Two works are attributed to Toãaka, the “rutis§rasamuddharaÖa and a short text, Toã§ßãaka (see S. Rajagopala Sastri 1968:63). Hirst (2005:11) mentions the striking similarities between the thought of Toãaka and his teacher, “aØkara. To Hast§malaka is attributed the short work Hast§malakaálok§È (probably spurious). Also attributed to Sureávara (besides Naißkarmyasiddhi) is the M§nasoll§sa, a commentary on the DakßiÖ§mårti-stotra attributed to “aØkara. The authenticity of both these works has been questioned (Potter 1981, Vol. 3:550–551). Alston (1980a, Vol. 1:13) notes that the M§nasoll§sa contains no eulogy to “aØkara, which would render the work unique, should it be included alongside the genuine works of Sureávara. While the influence of Toãaka and Hast§malaka on Advaita Ved§nta has been negligible, Padmap§da founded one of the two main post-“aØkara schools of Advaita Ved§nta, the VivaraÖa (‘uncovering’) school. This was later overshadowed by the Bh§matÊ school. The main point of difference between the two schools is that according to the VivaraÖa view, the jÊva is a nescient reflection of Brahman, whereas according to the Bh§matÊ view the jÊva is Brahman, as defined or limited by nescience (avidy§). 6 Included in Aufrecht’s Catalogus Catalogorum; the Triennial Reports and the Descriptive Catalogues of the Government Oriental Library, Madras, and the collected editions of the §c§rya-’s major, minor and miscellaneous works, published in Mysore, “rÊraØgam, PåÖe and elsewhere.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 107 tioned more than once as the work of “aØkara; and eight are attributed to “aØkar§c§rya and “aØkarabhagavat. Of the texts examined, only the bh§ßya-s of three prasth§na-s (the early Upanißad-s, BhagavadgÊt§ and Brahmasåtra-s), as well as the Gau·ap§dÊya-bh§ßya, are attributed to “aØkara-Bhagavat in the utilized material, as are the Upadeáas§hasrÊ and Vivekacå·§maÖi. The other texts have the other names in the colophon and make virtually no reference to Govinda (“aØkara’s teacher), who is always mentioned as a teacher in the texts attributed to the Bhagavat. Such was the extent of the identification of “aØkara with the name ‘Bhagavat’, that Appaya DÊkßit§, commenting on the commentaries of four prominent philosophers in the latter half of the sixteenth century in his Catur-mata-leáa-saÒgraha, refers to $nandatÊrtha (Madhva), R§m§nuja, “rÊkaÖãha and Bhagavatp§da (Suryanarayana Sastri 1930:28), it being commonly understood that the last name refers to “aØkara. Hacker also considers the terminology used in the various texts. Having surveyed other scholarly arguments concerning authorship, he concludes that, while there may be other genuine works of “aØkara, those mentioned above are provisionally entitled to be called genuine, while, above all, the bh§ßya-s on the prasth§natrayÊ can claim to be “aØkara’s genuine productions. While this restricted list is accepted by most scholars, Ingalls (1952:7) and Comans (1996:xv–xvi) have argued against “aØkara’s authorship of the Vivekacå·§maÖi.7 Using the Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya as a yardstick for genuine works, Mayeda (1992:6) believes “aØkara’s commentaries on the BhagavadgÊt§ and the BÜhad§raÖyaka, Ch§ndogya, Aitareya, TaittirÊya, ^á§, Kaãha, MuÖ·aka, Praána and M§Ö·åkya Upanißad-s are most probably genuine, as are the commentaries on the Gau·ap§da-k§rik§, and the Adhy§tmapaãala of the $pastamba-dharmasåtra.8 While the Upadeáas§hasrÊ is certainly genu-
7 Alston (2000:108) also does not accept “aØkara’s authorship of either the Vivekacå·§mani or $tmabodha. 8 “aØkara is also attributed with the authorship of a number of independent texts (prakaraÖa grantha-s); Sundaresan (2002) has argued that, besides the Upadeáas§hasrÊ, at least one of these texts, the PañcÊkaraÖa, is most probably genuine, as is a commentary on it, the PraÖav§rttika by Sureávara. Belvalkar also believes the PañcÊkaraÖa should also be attributed to “aØkara, although he acknowledges that there is nothing in the text to warrant its ascription to him. The v§rttika on the text, supposedly by Sureávara, is redolent of Tantra and, according to Potter (1981:318), is extremely suspect.
108
chapter four
ine, the commentary on the “vet§ávatara Upanißad may be spurious.9 Although Hacker,10 Nakamura and Mayeda believe the Yogasåtrabh§ßya-vivaraÖa may be genuine,11 Rukmani’s (1998) examination of the work leads one to conclude that this is highly improbable.12 “aØkara’s date has been the subject of numerous discussions and monographs, and is significant in the context of the hagiographies and the history of the maãha-s and their guru-parampar§-s, which will be examined in following sections. Currently, the most commonly accepted date for “aØkara is 788 to 820 CE, first (?) proposed by C. P. Tiele in 1877.13 However, the date of the fifth century BCE proposed by Narayana Sastry in his Age of “aØkara—first published in 1916—received widespread endorsement by the monastic tradition, represented by the pÊãha-s, most of which currently have guru-parampar§s which go back to the earlier date. However, we will see that some guru-parampar§-s appear to have been altered in the twentieth century to accord with a later date. Some of the more useful evidence concerning “aØkara’s date may be summarised. Throughout the discussion it needs to be borne in mind that a disciple is not necessarily younger than a teacher, nor
9
Mayeda’s detailed and subsequently influential analyses of texts, which owes much to Hacker’s previous work (see Hacker 1995), particularly concerning “aØkara’s use of specific terms—such as avidy§, m§y§, n§maråpa and Êávara—concluded that several of the important works attributed to “aØkara are genuine: BhagavadgÊt§-bh§ßya (1965a); Upadeßas§hasrÊ (1965b); Kena Upanißad-bh§ßya—there are two commentaries on the Kena Upanißad, the Padabh§ßya and V§kya-bh§ßya, both of which Mayeda believes to be genuine—(1967–1968a); and M§Ö·åkya Upanißad and Gau·ap§dÊya-bh§ßya, which are related texts (1967–1968b). Hirst (2005:21) also maintains the authenticity of the Gau·ap§da-k§rik§ and the Upadeáas§hasrÊ. Wilke (1995:328–330) provides an overview of the conclusions of Hacker, Mayeda and others on this topic. 10 On the basis of the signature ‘Bhagavadp§da’. 11 Leggett, who translates and comments on this work, also accepts it as genuine (1992:1–6). The text certainly existed in the fourteenth century. See also Halbfass (1983:Appendix), whose analysis renders “aØkara’s authorship improbable though not impossible. 12 The position of the current “aØkar§c§ryas on “aØkara’s genuine works is that a wider body of texts should be included, including the Tantric SaundaryalaharÊ (see Candraáekarendra SarasvatÊ 2001). 13 Outlines of the History of Ancient Religions (see Kunjunni Raja 1960:129). This was on the basis of Yajñeávara’s $ryavidy§-sudh§kara and Bhaããa NÊlakaÖãha’s “aØkara-mand§rasaurabha, which refer to “aØkara being born in the village of K§laãi in Kerala in the year 3889 of the K§lÊ period (=845 Vikram, =788 CE). However, these texts cannot be dated earlier than the sixteenth century (Pande 1994:45). Pathak (1882:174–175) also argues for this date, but also based on a dubious manuscript.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 109 does a disciple nessarily write after the death of a teacher. “aØkara could have had disciples who were older than him, or disciples could have written works prior to further literary activity of their teacher. However, given the textual evidence for the provision of a rough chronology, we may be reasonably sure of “aØkara’s date within certain parameters. According to tradition, “aØkara’s paramaguru (preceptor’s preceptor) was Gau·ap§da, who may be dated to not later than 500–570 CE.14 “aØkara quotes from the Gau·ap§da/Gau·ap§dÊya (M§Ö·åkya)k§rik§15 (III.2; III.38) in his Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya (2.15), but does not give a name here or in any other of his works (Lindtner 1985:275; Kunjunni Raja 1991:108). “aØkara’s bh§ßya on the Gau·ap§da-k§rik§ (GK) is accepted by most scholars as one of “aØkara’s genuine works, but Lindtner (1985) has argued that the author of this work fails to comprehend an important philosophical point made by Gau·ap§da.16 “aØkara’s understanding of Gau·ap§da is so widely off the mark in several places that Lindtner believes (p. 277) that “apart from other considerations, [it is] almost inconceivable that the author of the Bh§ßya, as tradition would have us believe, should have been a direct pupil of a direct pupil of the author of the GK.”17 The evidence indicates that “aØkara post-dates BhartÜhari (c.425– 450),18 Dign§ga (c.480–540)19 and DharmakÊrti (c.530–60020 or 634–
Three Buddhist scholars (Bhavya, “§ntarakßita and his disciple KamalaáÊla) quote from Gau·ap§da’s M§Ö·åkya-k§rik§ (Kunjunni Raja 1960:131; 1991:107). Bhavya quotes him in his Madhyamaka-hÜd§ya-k§rik§ (8.13), but Lindtner (1992:61) believes it probable that Bhavya knew but sections 1–3 of Gau·ap§dÊya-k§rik§. A date for Bhavya of approximately 500 to 570 is generally accepted (Nakamura 1983:81–85; Kunjunni Raja 1991:107; Qvarnström 1999:176). Nakamura’s dates for “§ntarakßita (680 to 740) and KamalaáÊla (700 to 750) have been challenged (Thrasher 1979:138). Kunjunni Raja (1960:139; 1991:113) dates both “§ntarakßita and KamalaáÊla forty-five years later: “§ntarakßita wrote his Tattva-saÒgraha before he left for Tibet (around 763), and KamalaáÊla arrived in Tibet in 792, and died there shortly after 794. See also Ruegg (2000:12). 15 Also known as $gama-á§stra. 16 This concerns Gau·ap§da’s use of the term aj§ti-samat§—one of Gau·ap§da’s ‘fingerprint’ terms—which “aØkara understood differently to the sense intended by Gau·ap§da. 17 Hirst (2005:198, fn. 28) also comments that Gau·ap§da and “aØkara may have lived several generations apart. 18 See Aklujkar (1994:21): “aØkara criticises BhartÜhari’s sphoãa doctrine. It is known from PuÖyar§ja’s commentary on the V§kyapadÊya (II.486) that one of BhartÜhari’s teachers was Vasur§ta, who was a younger contemporary of Vasu14
110
chapter four
67321). In his Upadeáas§hasrÊ (18.141–142), “aØkara quotes two verses22 from DharmakÊrti’s Pram§Öav§rttika (2.354).23 Sureávara, “aØkara’s main pupil, also cites one of these same verses from DharmakÊrti in his magnum opus, the BÜhad§raÖyaka-bh§ßya-v§rttika (4.3.476),24 and also names him (4.3.753).25 According to “aØkara’s hagiographical tradition, the philosophers Kum§rila and MaÖ·anamiára (“aØkara’s chief adversary) were “aØkara’s contemporaries. However, it seems probable that “aØkara slightly post-dates Kum§rila,26 who may
bandhu, who was a teacher of Dign§ga. Vasubandhu lived in the first half of the fifth century (Kunjunni Raja 1960:133). 19 See Qvarnström (1999:178). Dign§ga, in his Pram§Öasamuccaya (V), quotes two verses from BhartÜhari’s Vy§khy§dÊya (II.155, 158) (Lindtner 1994:200). “aØkara (BSB 2.2.28) quotes from Dign§ga ($lambanaparÊkߧ, v. 6). This verse is also quoted by Kamalaáila in his Pañjika, as that of Dign§ga (Kunjunni Raja (1991:106). 20 See Lindtner (1992:56–59): Bhavya (c.500–570) and Dharmap§la (c.530–561)— who Bhavya knew—quote DharmakÊrti. See also Qvarnström (1999:178). 21 T§r§n§tha, in his History of Buddhism, states that DharmakÊrti was alive during the period of King SroØ-btsan-sgam-po (617–651). The Chinese pilgrim I-tsing (634–713) also mentions DharmakÊrti as Kum§rila’s contemporary (Pathak 1892a, Art. VIII:90; Belvalkar 1929:211). This evidence has been cited to date DharmakÊrti to 634–673 (Nakamura 1983:76–77). Kunjunni Raja (1960:135) dates him to the early seventh century. 22 Dign§ga’s main work, the Pram§Öasamuccaya, was reworked by DharmakÊrti in his Pram§Öav§rttika. When, in the BSB, “aØkara is attacking Vijñ§nav§da Buddhists, the ideas attacked—if terminology is taken into consideration—appear almost certainly to be those of DharmakÊrti (Nakamura 1983:76). There has been an attempt made by Sankaranarayanan (1995b) to suggest that some of the quotations of Dign§ga and DharmakÊrti used by “aØkara—which have been cited above as evidence for “aØkara’s date—are in fact from an earlier period. This would permit an earlier date for “aØkara, of earlier than 500 CE. However, as Kunjunni Raja (1995) observes, the arguments are weak. 23 A third verse (18.143), often cited in philosophical works, also appears to be a quotation of DharmakÊrti (Nakamura 1983:76). 24 This particular verse, beginning abhinno ’pi hi buddhy§tma..., is particularly famous and is quoted in numerous philosophical works, including Kum§rila’s “lokav§rttika and M§dhava’s Sarva-daráana-saÒgraha (2.206–207). 25 See Pathak (1892a, Art. VIII); Belvalkar (1929:211); Umesh (1981:100); Nakamura (1983:76). 26 Kum§rila refers several times to Dign§ga (Umesh 1981:35). Kum§rila and DharmakÊrti were probably contemporaries (Lindtner 1992:56–57), as maintained by the Buddhist tradition. DharmakÊrti appears to criticise Kum§rila’s “loka-v§rttika, while Kum§rila, in his BÜhaããÊk§, seems to be objecting to statements in DharmakÊrti’s Pram§Öav§rttika (Kunjunni Raja 1991:109; Taber 1992:180). At the beginning of his TaittirÊya-Upanißad-bh§ßya, “aØkara appears to be attacking the views expressed in Kum§rila’s “loka-v§rttika. This is corroborated by a remark by Sureávara in his V§rttika on “aØkara’s commentary (Belvalkar 1929:209; Kunjunni Raja 1960:137; Halbfass 1983:iv). In the “loka-v§rttika Kum§rila frequently criticises the Jaina phi-
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 111 have written his BÜhaããÊk§ between 630 and 640, in his old age,27 but “aØkara may have been a contemporary of MaÖ·anamiára,28 whose literary activity was probably in the second half of the seventh century (Thrasher 1979:137–139).29 In conclusion, while “aØkara’s floruit may have been around 700 CE30 —around a century before the widely accepted date of 788–820—he cannot have lived much later than the beginning of the ninth century.31
losopher AkalaØka, who most probably lived after the seventh century (Pathak 1892b, Art. XVI:221–223). According to one tradition, AkalaØka was contemporary of the R§ßãrakåta emperor, S§hasatuØga Dantidurga, who is mentioned in a grant dated 753 CE (áaka 675) (Belvalkar 1929:210). If the tradition were true, then the date of Kum§rila would have to be moved to the first half of the eighth century. However, AkalaØka’s dates are controversial. 27 Concerning an upper limit for Kum§rila: firstly, his “loka-v§rttika is quoted in the Tattva-saÒgraha of “§ntarakßita (c.680–740) (Nakamura 1983:84–85). Secondly, Maheávara, in his commentary on the Nirukta, quotes from the “loka-v§rttika. Maheávara was a contemporary of Harisv§min, who wrote a commentary on the “atapatha-br§hmaÖa in 638 CE (Kunjunni Raja 1991:110). So Kum§rila’s date cannot be much later than middle of the seventh century. (See also Halbfass 1988:183.) It also seems that “aØkara (in his TaittirÊya-bh§ßya) was attacking the views of Kum§rila (Pathak 1892b, Art. XVI:217). 28 In his Sphoãa-siddhi, MaÖ·anamiára quotes from DharmakÊrti’s Pram§Öa-v§rttika. He also quotes fifteen times from Kum§rila’s “loka-v§rttika, and once from his Tantrav§rttika. However, neither MaÖ·anamiára nor “aØkara refer to one another, even though both held remarkably similar philosophical positions (Thrasher 1979:118– 120). MaÖ·ana almost certainly makes references to “aØkara’s BSB, and appears to have had the text before him when he wrote the Brahma-siddhi, one of his later works (Kuppuswami Sastri 1937:xlv–xlvii, lviii; Kunjunni Raja 1960:143; Thrasher 1979:122–129). Sureávara, “aØkara’s chief disciple, also knew MaÖ·anamiára’s work, criticising him and reproducing his material with only slight rewording. MaÖ·anamiára is not named by Sureávara, but his opponent is almost certainly MaÖ·anamiára, as Sureávara in his Naißk§rmya-siddhi paraphrases or quotes from MaÖ·anamiára’s Brahma-siddhi. It is possible that MaÖ·aÖamiára read “aØkara (who died aged 32 according to tradition), but that a response to their differences was made by Sureávara (Thrasher 1979:131–137). It is suggested (see Ch. 5.3) that the extreme rivalry between “aØkara and MaÖ·anamiára, as depicted in the hagiographies of “aØkara, may have been primarily due to their different religious persuasions rather than philosophical views. 29 Umbeka is not mentioned in the Tattva-saÒgraha of “§ntarakßita (680–740 or 725–785), but is mentioned by his disciple KamalaáÊla (700–750 or 745–795) in his Pañjik§. Umbeka, whose literary activity may have been between 760 and 790, comments on the MaÖ·anamiára’s Bh§van§-viveka (Thrasher 1979:138–139). 30 This date was argued for by Nakamura (1983:57–89). 31 Jinasena quotes Vidy§nanda—another Jaina—in his $dipur§Öa, his final work, which was written around 838. Vidy§nanda, in his AßãaáatÊ, quotes from Sureávara’s BÜhad§raØyaka-bh§ßya-v§rttika (Pathak 1892b, Art. XVI:224–229; Belvalkar 1929:214). At the end of V§caspatimiára’s Ny§ya-såcinibandha, it is stated that it was written in
112
chapter four
At first glance, there would seem to be some slight evidence for the currently accepted date for “aØkara (788–820 CE), in that when “§ntarakßita and KamalaáÊla are discussing Upanißada-v§da, in the eighth century, they make no reference to “aØkara (Qvarnström 1999:176). Further, the great “vet§mbara Jaina scholar and doxographer Haribhadrasåri (c.730–770 CE),32 although quoting BhartÜhari, Dign§ga and DharmakÊrti, also makes no reference to “aØkara (Umesh 1981:ii).33 Nakamura (1962:187ff.) comments that although, beginning around 600, advaita/ved§nta is recognised as a distinct doctrine by Jaina philosophers,34 who attacked particular advaita-related theories, Ved§nta as a school of philosophy was not significant. He notes that Haribhadrasåri, in his ‘a·daráanasamuccaya, refers to the teachings of the ‘six schools’ (Buddhism, Ny§ya, S§Òkhya, Jainism, Vaiáeßika and MÊm§Òs§) and also Lok§yata in an appendix, but does not refer to Ved§nta at all.35 Nakamura (1992:192) maintains that from the tenth century onwards, however, Ved§nta began to become increasingly significant as a system, and that the philosophy recognised by Jaina philosophers was that of “aØkara.36 However, although “aØkara later came to be considered as not only the pre-eminent advaitin, but as perhaps the pre-eminent philosopher of India, it seems that for several centuries post-“aØkara, it was MaÖ·anamiára—who knew the philosophy of “aØkara, and who was 841 CE (saÒvat 898), which is quite reliable (Nakamura 1983:65–66). Kunjunni Raja (1960:143–144) notes Hacker’s suggestion that the date should be taken as áaka 898 (equivalent to 976 CE), but disagrees with the later date. In the Bh§matÊ (1.3.17), a commentary on the BSB, V§caspatimiára criticises the views of Padmap§da, referring several times to his Pañcap§dik§ (Belvalkar 1929:214; Kunjunni Raja 1960:145). 32 See Chapple (1993:1–2) for Haribhadra’s date. 33 Vetter (1979:11), following Kunjunni Raja (1960), also remarks that “aØkara was not referred to by “§ntarakßita, KamalaáÊla or Haribhadrasåri. 34 By, for example, Samantabhadra (c.600) and his commentator AkalaØka (c.700–770), Mallav§din (8th century), and “Êl§Øka (latter half of 9th century). See also Ghokale (1958; 1961–1962; 1972), who discusses and translates chapters III and VIII of Bhavya’s MadhyamakahÜdaya, which deal with Ved§nta as known to Bhavya in the sixth century. 35 Nakamura (1962:192) also notes that Siddharßi, in a work composed in 906, refers to a total of twelve systems, but not Ved§nta. 36 Nakamura (1992:192–193) cites the Yaáastilaka of the Digambara scholar Somadeva, composed in 959, which refers to Ved§nta and the doctrine of the Brahman-advaitin-s. Nakamura maintains that “This is conspicuously the Advaita theory of the “aØkara school”. However, “aØkara is not referred to explicitly. Unfortunately, I have not been able to see this text in order to ascertain what I suspect: that “aØkara may not have been known by Somadeva.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 113 roughly his contemporary—who was considered the main exponent of advaita by later advaitin-s, and not “aØkara (Vetter 1979:11; Wilke 1995:336). V§caspatimiára (9th century), author of the influential Bh§matÊ, a commentary on “aØkara’s Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya, relies for his interpretation of “aØkara on the doctrines in the Brahmasiddhi of MaÖ·anamiára (Subramanya Sastri 1937:vi).37 MaÖ·anamiára was also accepted as an authority by other important later advaitin-s such as Prak§á§tman (10th century), $nandabodha (c.12th century), and Citsukha (c.13th century) (Isayeva 1993:66–67). Nor does any Ny§ya-Vaiáeßika philosopher of the ninth and tenth centuries refer to “aØkara, 38 even though they make occasional references to MaÖ·anamiára. Qvarnström (1999:176) also remarks that it was not until the tenth century that Ved§nta gained general recognition in Jaina and Buddhist literature as a distinct philosophical system, and suggests that this is possibly on account of “aØkara being from the south and not the north where Jaina and Buddhist systems were flourishing. However, although Jainism and Buddhism were in decline in the south by the time of “aØkara, in some centres,39 particularly K§ñcÊpuram—which had previously been a stronghold of both religions—Jainism40 and Buddhism were still influential for several hundred years after the time of “aØkara.41 Yet there seems to have been little contemporary
37 Subramahmanya Sastri (1935:vi) also asserts that R§m§nuja (1017–1137), in his quintessential work, “rÊ Bh§ßya, only quotes MaÖ·anamiára as the advaita prototype. However, it is evident that R§m§nuja also refers to “aØkara and his arguments: as dravi·a bh§ßyak§ra (p. 119); as bh§ßyak§ra (p. 120, p. 144); and as the incarnation, “aØkara (p. 111). (References are to the Karmarkar edition, 1959–1964.) 38 See Potter (1981, Vol. 3:23 fn. 25; 1977, Vol. 1:15, 485, 604). For example, the Ny§ya-Vaiáeßikas “rÊdhara (fl. 991) and Apar§kadeva (fl. 1125) notice MaÖ·ana’s arguments but not “aØkara’s. 39 Such as KoØkanapura. 40 According to one tradition, it was the famous Jaina, AkalaØka—and not “aØkara—who defeated Buddhists in K§ñcÊpuram. A village in the suburbs of K§ñcÊ(puram) is still known by the name ‘Jaina K§ñcÊ’. Many Jaina centres (that appear to have been weaving centres) were subsequently converted into K§l§mukha áaiva centres. Jainism began to acquire more influence than Buddhism in K§ñcÊpuram around the seventh century, and in other parts of Tamil Nadu during the latter part of the first millennium (Desai 1957:25–96; Champakalakshmi 1996:397–398). 41 Buddhaghoßa (fifth century) and other Buddhists propagated their doctrine from the vih§ra-s of K§ñcÊ. Dign§ga (c.480–540) was born in a suburb of K§ñcÊ (later going north to study logic under Vasubandhu in Nalanda). Dharmap§la (530–561) was also a native of K§ñcÊ. Bhavya (500–570) also lived in south India,
114
chapter four
awareness of him by any philosophical tradition. If the earlier date proposed for “aØkara is accepted (flourishing around the beginning of the eighth century), then the only conclusion to be drawn is that “aØkara must have remained relatively unknown for several centuries after his demise, perhaps until his promotion by advaita maãha-s, which were first founded in the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries.
4.2 Organisational structure of the Daáan§mÊs, according to the Maãh§mn§yastotra, “rÊ Maãh§mn§yasetu and other texts The normative account of the Daáan§mÊs is embedded in a few short Sanskrit texts, known variously as (“rÊ ) Maãh§mn§ya, Maãh§mn§yastotra, Maãh§mn§yasetu and MaãhetivÜtta, which detail the four §mn§ya-s, all supposedly but improbably written by “aØkar§c§rya. The Maãh§mn§yaá§sanam (or Mah§nuá§sanam), frequently appended to the Maãh§mn§ya-s, is a text primarily explaining the dharma and entitlement of the four designated §c§rya-s to individual jurisdiction in their four respective regions: the gaddÊ is to be passed on only to the virtuous and learned saÒny§sÊ. One aspect of this text is as a legitimation of the four pÊãha-s, to the exclusion of other claims. $mn§ya means: a sacred tradition; that which is to be remembered or studied or learnt by heart; a Veda (or Veda-s in the aggregate); or received doctrine. The term also has a particular significance in the context of the dissemination of Tantric texts during the early mediaeval period. Similar to the Tantric tradition, which has western, eastern, northern and southern §mn§ya-s,42 pertaining to the four Daáan§mÊ pÊãha-s—supposedly founded by “aØkar§c§rya—are four §mn§ya-s, at the western, eastern, northern, and southern borders of India. The four §mn§ya-s of the maãha-s are said to be “revealed” (in all texts) in a sequence, such that the first is the western §mn§ya, as did DharmakÊrti who lived in the kingdom of Cå·§maÖi. Around 640, Hüang Tsang reports more than a hundred Buddhist monasteries in K§ñcÊ, with more than 10,000 SthavÊra monks (Watters, 1905, Vol. 2: 226). Buddhism was still a living religion in K§ñcÊpuram in the twelfth century, surviving there into the sixteenth century (Mahalingam 1969:125; Chaudhury 1969:234–235; Subramanyam 1975:23–24). 42 For a survey of the four main Tantric pÊãha-s, see Sircar (1973:11–24). For a resumé of the Tantric §mn§ya-s, see Goudriaan (1979: 41–46; 1981:17–20); Sanderson (1988:149–158). For an overview of “akti-pÊãha-s, see Tattv§loka (1994); Kaly§Ö (TÊrth§Øk) (1997:515–527).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 115 the “§rad§ maãha (at Dv§rak§); the second is the eastern §mn§ya, the Govardhan maãha (at PurÊ); the third is the northern §mn§ya, the Jyotir maãha (at Jyoáimaãh); and the fourth is the southern §mn§ya, the “ÜØgerÊ maãha.43 It can be seen from the scheme below that each of the ‘ten names’ of the Daáan§mÊs are nominally affiliated to one or another of the four main maãha-s, also known as pÊãha-s. There is, however, an ongoing dispute concerning the location of the ‘genuine’ southern pÊãha: whether it should be located at “ÜØgerÊ or at K§ñcÊpuram. The information in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, presented below, is known quite well by most initiates, and is repeated, with some minor differences, in virtually every commentary on the Daáan§mÊs that has been published in the previous 150 years.44 I will be suggesting that this account is probably fictitious in several respects. However, regardless of the authenticity of the Maãh§mn§ya-s, the importance of these texts may be gauged not only from the intrinsic value of constituting a formal identity for various lineages of ascetics as an organised sect with a founder, but also from the fact that they have on several occasions been used as formal evidence in Court cases concerning property, trusteeship and succession.45
43 There has been some discussion in orthodox Hindu circles concerning why the southern pÊãha is located inland, and not at a costal extremity, such as R§meávaram. See, for example, Ramesan (1968). 44 There are differences to be found in some of the earlier ethnographies. Crooke’s account (1896 Vol. 4:273) relies on the Panj§b Census Report (3) of Maclagan, who remarked (1891:112) that he had before him eight lists of the “ten names”, from different parts of the Province (Punjab). Only Giri, PurÊ, AraÖya and Bh§ratÊ were common to all lists. The names are associated with one or another of “aØkara’s four disciples, namely Tarnaka, Prithodar (or Prithivi), Saråpa and Padman. (These names of §c§rya-s are not exactly those of the disciples of “aØkara in the standard hagiographies.) Maclagan reports that according to some accounts the distribution of saÒny§sÊ-s per maãha is as follows: Jyotir (Giri, PurÊ, Bh§ratÊ); “ÜØgerÊ (Vana, AraÖya, TÊrtha); Narar§ginÊ (Parvata, $árama); Brahmac§rÊ (SarasvatÊ, DaÖ·Ê). Rose’s account (1914:353) presents four different lists, one of which (‘List A’) distributes the names as below, with the exception of the absence of the SarasvatÊ p§da. Rose’s ‘List B’ distributes the p§da-s quite differently. Rose’s two other lists of ‘ten names’ both list eleven names. Included in those lists are the JattÊ, Sukar, Rukar, DaÖ·Ê and SurastÊ, names which do not appear in ‘modern standard lists’. It is just possible that Maclagan and Rose’s ethnographies reveal that the standard account of the ten names as found in the Maãh§mn§ya-s (see below) had not yet become universally standard; or they could have been badly informed. 45 See Mishra (2001:vii–xiv) for some of the legal judgments that have derived from the Maãh§mn§ya-s.
116
chapter four
During the first initiation into the Daáan§mÊs, the pañc-guru-saÒsk§r, the initiate is instructed on his lineage, lifestyle, gotra, pÊãha and so on, according to which of the ten names he receives. This information—in particular, the initiate’s own maãh§mn§ya—is to be remembered as a form of formal identification, and is circulated among Daáan§mÊ initiates in the form of Hindi texts, including the Daá n§m vaÒá vÜkß and Stotra-pußpañjalÊ (see Haridv§r Giri, n.d.). In contrast, the contemporary structure of the Daáan§mÊs, in terms of its various branches and sub-branches, is ill understood by most initiated saÒny§sÊ-s, who rarely have any knowledge of any branch of the order other than their own. The understanding of what Daáan§mÊ means lies, for all practical purposes, in a body of texts that has become a vital means for presenting an overview of the order, both from emic and etic perspectives. The Daá n§m vaÒá vÜkß describes the cosmic evolution from “the void”, through various gods and Üßi-s, to “aØkara and his four disciples, who head the four Maãh§mn§ya-s. Additional information in this text includes the constitution of the maÜhÊ-s, the four §c§rya-s of the four yuga-s,46 the four cermonial javelins (bh§l§-s),47 and the four dhånÊ-s.48 The ten names49 are assigned to one of four strings (tanÊ-s): Uttar (north), of the Giris; Purv (east), of the Vanas and AraÖyas; DakßiÖ (south), of the PurÊs; Paácim (west), of the TÊrthas and $áramas.50 The texts of the various Maãh§mn§ya-s are available in Sanskrit catalogues, in several Hindi publications, and in three English publications.51 Apart from minor differences, the only essential disSatyug, Brahm§, VißÖu, “iva; Dv§paryug, Vy§sa, “ukdeva; Tret§yug, “iva, “akti, Par§áara; K§lyug, Gau·a, Govind§c§rya. 47 Dattaprak§áa (at Ujjain); Såryaprak§áa (at Pray§g); Candraprak§áa (at N§sik); and the Bhairavaprak§áa (at Haridv§r). 48 DattamukhÊ (at Ujjain); SåryamukhÊ (at Pray§g); Ajayamedha (at Haridv§r); and the Gop§la (at N§sik). 49 According to another undated Hindi paper circulated amongst some Daáan§mÊs: PurÊ represents the top of the head; Bh§ratÊ, the forehead; SarasvatÊ, the tongue; Vana and AraÖya, the back; S§gara, the stomach; Giri, the arms; Parvata, the legs; TÊrtha and $árama, the feet. 50 I cannot be sure, but I believe these are the strings that divide the area containing the ceremonial dhånÊ-s at mel§-s, such that the different lineages are stationed in their respective quarters. 51 Maãh§mn§ya-s, or substantial extracts from them, are contained in the following Hindi publications: “arma (1963:642–652); Up§dhy§y (1967:601–617); Vidy§nand Giri (1993:60–65); Miára (1996:33–57); Sad§nand Brahmac§rÊ (2001:24–26); PurÊ (2001:44–48); Haridv§r Giri (n.d.:66–69). The Maãh§mn§yopanißad is published in 46
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 117 parity between the different versions of the texts concerns a few of the deities, and the appointment of “aØkara’s disciples to the respective gaddÊ-s: It will be suggested that it is most probable that normative texts, in the form of Maãh§mn§ya-s (or something with a similar name) which continue to be disseminated by the main “aØkara pÊãha-s, are most probably not more than about four or five hundred years old. The scheme below is based on the Maãh§mn§ya-setu, published by Parameshwar Nath Mishra (2001:1–57),52 and some details that conflict with this text are indicated.53
Un-Published Upanißads (ed. Kunhan Raja 1933:48–49). Antarkar (2001:72) refers to versions I have not seen: Maãh§mn§ya-stotram and Maãh§mn§ya-setu (ed. Bodas), “ÜÊraØgam: V§Öi Vil§s Press (1954–1958; 1975). Three English publications contain Maãh§mn§ya-s: Aiyer and Sastri (1962:49–57, 102, 110), Chakraborty (1973:180–181), which contains short sections; and Mishra (2001:1–52), which contains an appendix (Appendix 2:59–61) that compares the verses of three published versions of Maãh§mn§ya-s, those of “arma (1963), Up§dhy§y (1967), and K§meávar N§th Miára (1996). See the Bibliography for further details of these publications. 52 This text, together with the Mah§nuá§sanam and “eߧmn§ya (and translations) are contained in Appendix 2. Mishra’s text is almost identical to that published by K§meávar N§th Miára (1996), and very similar to other versions of this text, including the Maãh§mn§ya-setu published by “arma (1963:642–652), but for a different verse order in some passages. “arma’s text of the Maãh§mn§ya-stotra (another text containing virtually the same information) is from the “ÜØgerÊ pÊãha, obtained in the form of a very old handwritten copy from the “rÊ K§maråpa maãha of Banaras. “arma (1963:647) states that the Maãh§mn§ya-stotra-s he had collected from other maãha-s, at NavadvÊpa, K§áÊ, K§maråpa, Lahore, PåÖe and Mirzapur, are similar. The texts of the Maãh§mn§ya-setu and the Mah§nuá§sanam are differently ordered in some passages in some versions of the texts, different versions also omitting or adding the occasional verse. 53 Entries with a single asterisk (*) indicate differences contained in the versions of the (“rÊ ) Maãhamn§ya-setu and Maãh§mn§ya-stotra published by “arma (1963:642–652). Brahm§carÊ (2001:22–24) provides the “§rad§ pÊãha §mn§ya, which is identical to Miára (1996). At variance with Mishra (2001): Vidy§nand Giri **(1993:63–66); Up§dhy§y ***(1967:601–617); PurÊ ****(2001:44–48); Kunhan Raja *****(1933:48–49). The information in the Daá n§m vaÒá vÜkß is almost identical to the Maãh§mn§yasetu of Mishra, with the exception that the deities of the Jyotir maãha are called Sårya-N§r§yaÖa and PuÖyagiri; and both Hast§malaka and PÜthvÊdhar§c§rya are assigned to “ÜØgerÊ. The sth§n of Jyotir is called Œddhin§th, and the ißãdev of Jyotir is Datt§treya (no other §mn§ya in this text has an ißãdev). The “ÜØgerÊ maãha has (inexplicably) the gaddÊ of AnusuÊy§ (sic.).
118
chapter four
“§rad§-pÊãha (also named K§lik§) Maãha (Western kßetra) Dv§rak§ (Arabian Coast, Gujarat) Jurisdiction (maÖ·ala) Sindhu, SauvÊra,54 Saur§ßãra,55 Mah§r§ßãra Orders (pad§ni) TÊrtha, $árama Deities (m) Siddeávara (f) Bhadrak§lÊ TÊrtha / Kßetra (r)56 GomatÊ, Dv§rak§ (GaØg§-GomatÊ)***** Veda Mah§v§kya57 Gotra Brahmac§rÊ name Samprad§ya Appointed pontiff
S§ma tat tvam asi58 (you are that) Avigata Svaråpa KÊãav§ra Viávaråpa (Padmap§da)* **** (Hast§malaka)***
Maãha Govardhan-pÊãha (Eastern kßetra) Jagann§th (PurÊ, East Coast, Orissa) Jurisdiction (maÖ·ala) AØga,59 VaØga,60 KaliØga,61 Magadha,62 Utkala,63 Barbar§ (?)64 Orders (pad§ni) AraÖya, Vana Deities (m) Jagann§th (f) Vimal§ (VÜßal§)* TÊrtha / Kßetra Mahodadhi (sea)/Purußottama. Veda Œg Mah§v§kha prajñ§naÒ brahma65 (knowledge is brahma) Gotra Kaáyapa Brahmac§rÊ name Prak§áa Samprad§ya Bhogav§ra Appointed pontiff Padmap§da (Hast§malaka) **** Maãha
54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65
Jyotir-pÊãha (also named BadarÊk§, or “rÊ)
The area adjacent to the Indus river. The area around Sur§t. (r) = river. An aphorism (great saying) from the Upanißads. Ch§ndogya Upanißad (6.8.7); attached to S§ma Veda. The country around Bhagalpur, in Bihar. West Bengal. Orissa. West-central Bihar Orissa. The barbarian region (?). Aitareya Upanißad (3.5.3); attached to Œg Veda.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 119 (Northern kßetra)
BadarÊk§árama (Jyoáimaãh, Uttaranchal, Himalayas) Jurisdiction (maÖ·ala) Kuru-p§ñc§la,66 KaámÊra, Kamboja67 Orders (pad§ni) Giri, Parvata, S§gara Deities (m) BadarÊk§ (N§r§yaÖa)* **** (f) PårÖagirÊ (PuÖyagiri) **** TÊrtha / Kßetra (r) Alakanand§ / BadarÊk§árama Veda Atharva Mah§v§kya ayam§tm§ brahma68 (the self is brahma) Gotra BhÜgu Brahmac§rÊ name $nanda Samprad§ya $nandav§ra Appointed pontiff Toãaka (Troãaka) Maãha “ÜØgerÊ-pÊãha (also named “§rad§) (Southern kßetra) “ÜØgerÊ (Western Gh§ãs, Karnataka) Jurisdiction (maÖ·ala) $ndhra, Dravi·a,69 KarÖata,70 Kerala Orders (pad§ni ) SarasvatÊ, Bh§ratÊ, PurÊ Deities (m) $di Var§ha (f) K§m§kßÊ (“§rad§)* **** TÊrtha / Kßetra (r) TuØgabhadra, R§meávaram Veda Yajur Mah§v§kya ahaÒ brahm§smi71 (I am brahma) Gotra Bhårbhuva Brahmac§rÊ name Caitanya Samprad§ya Bhåriv§ra Appointed pontiff Hast§malaka (Sureávara)* *** **** (PÜthvÊdhara)72 ** *****
4.3 Gotra, samprad§ya, Brahmac§rÊ name, Veda and mah§v§kya In the Maãh§mn§ya-s we find an assignment of the four disciples of “aØkara to the four pÊãha-s, each with its own Vedic school; and the ten names distributed in four groups, each with its own Brahmani66
Western Gangetic plain. Eastern Afghanistan. 68 M§Ö·åkya Upanißad (4.2); attached to Atharva Veda. 69 Tamil Nadu. 70 Karnataka. 71 BÜhad§raÖyaka Upanißad (1.4.10); attached to “ukla (white) Yajur Veda. 72 PÜthvÊdhara is identified with Sureávara by PurÊ (and some other commentators), while “arma identifies PÜthvÊdhara with Hast§malaka. 67
120
chapter four
cal gotra, samprad§ya and Brahmac§rÊ name. As can be seen, the two points of disagreement between the Maãh§mn§ya-s concern the deities (at three of the pÊãha-s) and the appointment of “aØkara’s disciples. The Maãh§mn§ya-s only agree on the appointment of Toãaka to the Jyotir pÊãha. Gotra denotes an ancient Vedic clan or lineage, the gotra-s supposedly originating with the seven mythological Üßi-s.73 The gotra-s were most probably distinguished originally on the basis of different Vedic rites performed.74 There are scores of Brahmanical gotra-s, pertaining to the ten major divisions (and their sub-divisions) of Brahmans. There are also twenty-five other Brahmanical clans, including the Kashmiri, Nepali and M§lv§ Brahmans, and other groups, all with various gotra-s. Four groups of gotra-s are traditionally assigned to one or another of the four Veda-s,75 this arrangement also being reflected in the correspondence (albeit inaccurate) in the Maãh§mn§ya-s of four gotra-s to fourVeda-s. Mediaeval §gama texts of “aiva-Siddh§nta reveal that traditional initiation into “aivism also entails the acquisition of the gotra/gocara of the initiating guru (Brunner 1964:458). As can be seen from the table giving the structure of the Daáan§mÊs, the four pÊãha-s are represented by four Brahmanical gotra-s (lineages); Avigata, Kaáyapa, BhÜgu and Bhårbhava. Kaáyapa appears in the first fully formulated lists of the seven Üßi-s, in the Dharmasåtra-s (Mitchener 1982:30),76 while the Kaáyapa gotra is traditionally in the group of
73 In Mah§y§na Buddhism, the term gotra—as with so many other terms originally employed in a Vedic context—has, besides its sense as a spiritual lineage, a technical philosophical meaning, designating both a soteriological principle and an aspect of awakening. For further details, see Ruegg (1969). 74 One of the original senses of gotra, as used in the Œg Veda, was of a ‘cowstall’ (Kane 1935:10). For Jainas, gotra had the sense of ‘family’, while in some Mah§y§na texts gotra meant ‘spiritual class’. By the early centuries BCE, gotra had come to designate not only descendants of a common ancestor, but sometimes a family, an exogamous unit or social status generally. The so-called pravara recitation by Brahmans, which accompanies daily sandhy§ worship, is a recitation of a list of usually three ancestors, who were among the seven primordial Üßi-s, and whose names constitute gotra-s. A gotra is the lineage of the family, thus confirming from which families a potential wife would be acceptable, as marriage cannot be made with a partner from within the same gotra. A man is in one of eighteen gotra-s, and must marry into one of the other seventeen, a system which has survived to the present day (Brough 1953:2–10; Kane HD“ Vol. 2:479–497). 75 See Sherring (Vol.1, 1872:6–113) for a detailed account of the gotra-s, and (p. 8) their affiliation to the Veda. See also Kamath (1986:83) on particular gotra-s. 76 Agastya is to be found occasionally in the Dharmasåtra-s as an eighth Üßi.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 121 gotra-s that follow the S§ma Veda (Sherring 1872:8). This is inconsistent with the scheme of the Maãh§mn§ya-s, whereby the Kaáyapa gotra is assigned to the Govardhan pÊãha, which follows the Œg Veda. BhÜgu appears as an eighth Üßi in a second list of Üßi-s, which came to take textual preference over the first list, notably in most of the lists to be found in the Pur§Öa-s (Mitchener 1982:30). In the Brahmanical tradition the BhÜgu gotra is amongst the gotra-s that follow the Œg Veda. Again, this is inconsistent with the Maãh§mn§ya-s, wherein the BhÜgu gotra is affiliated to the Jyotir pÊãha, which follows the Atharva Veda. The other two gotra-s, Bhårbhava and Avigata, do not appear in known list of gotra-s,77 but no one has so far been able to provide a satisfactory explanation for them. Gotra and the other elements of the Maãh§mn§ya-s, which initiates are supposed to learn, are essentially esoteric verbal markers of the initiate’s identity and lineage within the Daáan§mÊs, used for mutual identity and detecting imposters: a kind of saÒny§sÊ pravara. The origin of the four samprad§ya names, $nandavara, Bhåriv§ra, Bhogavara and KÊãavara, that are given in the texts cited, similarly defies adequate explanation. Most commentators follow Ghurye (1964:86) in explaining, somewhat vaguely, the samprad§ya in terms of life-style.78 However, in Daáan§mÊ practice, the samprad§ya names, as wth the gotra-s, simply confirm to which of the four groups of lineages the initiate belongs, and do not signify a different life-style. The samprad§ya names are used by Daáan§mÊs as an identificatory title, such as, for example, Mahant L§l PurÊ, Bhåriv§ra.79 (It can be seen, according to the Maãh§mn§ya-s, that Bhåriv§ra indicates
77
See Ghurye (1964:85–87); Dazey (1990:288). This author has also failed to find any references to these gotra-s in published works. 78 Thus, according to Ghurye, the $nandav§ra is happy (§nanda) with whatever food he gets without begging, or because his happiness is not derived from worldly pleasures. The Bhåriv§ra (bhårÊ meaning ‘very much’) is explained as renouncing wealth and living on vegetation in the jungles. The Bhogavara (bhoga meaning ‘enjoyment’ or ‘pleasure’) are supposedly indifferent to worldly pleasures. Lastly, the KÊãavara (kÊãa meaning ‘insect’ or ‘worm’) is supposed either to eat as little as an insect, or to have developed a high level of compassion, not even troubling insects. See also Rose (1914:357): 1. Bhog-b§r, who are indifferent to all earthly things, save those necessary to sustain life; 2. Khet-b§r, who attempt to eat only a small quantity of food; 3. $nand-b§r, who are averse to begging and live on spontaneous alms; 4. Bhår-b§r, who live on forest products and pounded grasses and ashes. 5. Kanái-b§r, who have no desire and live on air and water, in continual beatitude. 79 Of the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§ at KaØkhal (see Bibliography).
122
chapter four
a PurÊ, Bh§ratÊ or SarasvatÊ; $nandav§r indicates a Giri, Parvata or S§gara; etc.) When a candidate is initiated into saÒny§sa by the §c§rya-guru, a mah§v§kya from one of four Upanißad-s—attached to its respective Veda—is given, the mah§v§kya being the liberating mantra of the lineage. However, the distribution in the Maãh§mn§ya-s of the fourVeda-s to the four cardinal directions is not corroborated in other Brahmanical sources.80 The four Brahmac§rÊ names given, $nanda, Caitanya, Prak§áa and Svaråpa, are the names given to brahmac§rÊ-s who have passed their first stage of initiation to become daÖ·Ê-s. They will subsequently undergo the viraj§-homa to become daÖ·Ê-saÒny§sÊ-s. The four Brahmac§rÊ names theoretically correspond to their affiliation to a particular pÊãha. As previously noted, this is determined by the affiliation of the particular maãha via which the candidate is initiated, to either the western, eastern northern or southern pÊãha.
4.4 The pÊãha-s and guru-parampar§-s In this and the following sections, the claims by various maãha-s to have been founded by “aØkara will be surveyed, and it will become apparent that there is no substantive evidence to connect “aØkara with the early history of any of the maãha-s supposedly founded by him. Even in the nineeenth century the claims of the ‘official’ four maãha-s to be the only legitimate ones were far from universally established. Over the previous few hundred years, several other advaita maãha-s have also claimed legitimacy, many of the disputes being settled by royal decree or by a court case. The ‘legitimacy’ issue stems primarily from the claims of various “aØkar§c§ryas to be the sole representative in their area for the title of jagadguru, entitled to travel in palanquin (a··§-p§lakÊ)81 and be accorded due
80 However, Mishra (2001:2) cites the Bh§gavata Pur§Öa (3.12.37), stating that the Œg, S§ma, Atharva and Yajur Veda-s are “expressed” from, respectively, the eastern, western, northern and southern mouths of Brahm§. However, this verse from the text of the Bh§gavata Pur§Öa states that: “Beginning from the front face of Brahm§, gradually the four Vedas—Œg, Yajur, S§ma and Atharva—became manifest” (trans. Prabhupada): Üg-yajuÈ-s§m§tharv§khy§n ved§n pårv§dibhir mukhaiÈ (á§stram ijy§m stuti. stomam pr§yaácittam) vyadh§t kram§t. There is no mention of directions. 81 This mode of transport, usually reserved for kings, may involve the palanquin being carried ‘sideways’ to hold up (a··§) other traffic.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 123 honours, and to have the ‘foremost’ right to collect tithes or donations (agrasaÒbh§van§) from adherents or disciples in the kßetra supposedly under their jurisdiction. Evidence from the Maãh§mn§ya-s have been central to several court cases, as have passages in the hagiographies of “aØkara, particularly those referring to his last days and final sam§dhi.82 Claims and counter-claims by rival maãha-s also frequently involve the assertion by one of the parties that parts of a particular text not agreeing with their claim have been tampered with. It can be seen from the variant schemes of the Maãh§mn§ya-s (as shown above) that there is inconsistency concerning the appointments to the four pÊãha-s, depending on which text is referred to.83 The identity of Sureávara, who is claimed by the “ÜØgerÊ, Dv§rak§ and K§ñcÊ maãha-s (see below), is also disputed.84 Most of the maãha-s that will be
82 Amongst the hagiographies, the K§ñcÊ maãha relies most on the evidence of the A“V (see Ch. 5.1), where “aØkara is said to have passed away at K§ñcÊ. (This text is rejected as inauthentic by “ÜØgerÊ.) In their support, the K§ñcÊ maãha also cite evidence for this from the “ivarahasya and the M§rkaÖ·eya-saÒhit§, the authority of which is disputed by “ÜØgerÊ. 83 Rose (1914:353) records two (variant) versions of the appointments to the maãha-s. Chakraborti (1973:181) also remarks on the disagreement amongst scholars over the appointments to the maãha-s, one issue being whether it was Hast§malaka or Padmap§da who was the first appointed pontiff of the PurÊ maãha. The “ÜØgerÊ tradition, according with the Maãh§mn§ya-stotra, maintains that the first pontiff of Dv§rak§ was Padmap§da. 84 Sureávara is identified by the monastic tradition as MaÖ·anamiára (see Pande 1994:281–283). Relatively large parts of all the hagiographies of “aØkara are dedicated to the debate between “aØkara and either MaÖ·anamiára—the famous MÊm§Òsaka and author of the Brahmasiddhi, who is portrayed as a disciple of another great MÊm§Òsaka, Kum§rila—or Viávaråpa. In the “aØkara-dig-vijaya (10.103–107) (see Ch. 5.1), after his conversion by “aØkara, MaÖ·anamiára (a gÜhastha) acquired the name Sureávara (as a saÒny§sin). The “DV also refers to MaÖ·anamiára as Viávaråpa. The identification of MaÖ·anamiára and Sureávara is also made by Anant§nandagiri, in the “aØkaravijaya (sec. 55), and by Cidvil§sa in the “aØkaravijaya (18.44–45). However, in other hagiographies of “aØkara (Vy§s§c§la’s “aØkaravijaya (6.5.36); Govindan§tha’s “aØkar§c§ryacarita (6.1); LakßmaÖa “§strÊ’s GuruvaÒáa-k§vya (2.143), “aØkara’s opponent is identified as a disciple of Kum§rila called Viávarupa; and MaÖ·anamiára is a different person. Many scholars have argued, on philosophical grounds, against the possibility of MaÖ·anamiára being Sureávara: see Dasgupta (Vol. 2, 1975:82– 87); Hiriyanna (1923; 1924); Bhattacharyya (1931:301–308); Kuppuswami Sastri (1981:27–50); Alston (1980a, Vol.1:50–51). Sastri (1961:281–291) believes that the two could be the same: MaÖ·ana could have changed his views. However, in perhaps the most extensive and detailed treatment of the topic, Kuppuswami Sastri (1937: xxiv–lvii) not only illustrates the philosophical differences between the two authors, but points to a long line of Ved§ntins—including V§caspatimiára, Vimukt§tman, Prak§á§tman, $nandabodha, Prakaã§rthak§ra, Citsukha, Amal§nanda, $nandagiri,
124
chapter four
referred to in this section claim to have been founded by “aØkara, and have parampar§-s of §c§rya-s going back to between the eight century CE and the sixth century BCE. However, 44 BCE is taken as the date of the birth of “aØkara by several authorities, including, until recently, the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. The later date of “aØkara (788 to 720 CE) accepted by many contemporary scholars was challenged by Narayana Sastry (1971 [1916]), who proposed an earlier date of 509 BCE for the birth of “aØkara. This proposal for an earlier date was accepted by many Indian scholars, some of whom85 still maintain it, despite many objections raised by various scholars. I suspect that the views of Narayana Sastry (and hence later scholars) may have been substantially impelled by the considerable space devoted to the date of “aØkara in The Theosophist during the 1890s. Articles on the date of “aØkar§c§rya appeared in Volumes I, IV, XI, XIV and XVI of The Theosophist,86 volumes XIV and XVI containing the guru-parampar§-s of the “ÜØgerÊ and Dv§rak§ maãha-s respectively, the “ÜØgerÊ list recording the birth of “aØkara in 43 BCE, the Dv§rak§ list giving the birth-date of “aØkara in 2631 yudhißãhira áaka (509 BCE). Scholarly opinions on the date of “aØkara seem to have influenced the construction of guru-parampar§-s, and some of them, such as that of “ÜØgerÊ, appear to have been altered during the previous century to accord with the later date (788–820 CE) for “aØkara (Antarkar 2001:45), as previously the “ÜØgerÊ maãha had had a guru-parampar§ that accorded 800 years for the life of Sureávara.
Vidy§raÖya, MadhusådanasarasvatÊ, and Brahm§nandasarasvatÊ—and philosophers of other schools, whose works illustrate their understanding that MaÖ·anamiára and Sureávara were different people, with different views on particular philosophical points. Indeed, Sureávara, in his V§rttika and Naißk§rmyasiddhi, sneers at some of the views of MaÖ·ana (p. xxx). The main division in advaita, between the Bh§matÊ and VivaraÖa schools (concerning whether the locus of nescience resides in jÊva or brahman) goes back to MaÖ·anamiára and Sureávara. However, in some works (see p. xxv), for example Vidy§raÖya’s VivaraÖa-prameya-saÒgraha (p. 92), a passage from Sureávara’s V§rttika (4.8) is attributed to Viávaråp§c§rya (Dasgupta, p. 83), lending some credence to their identification in the Maãh§mn§ya-s. Also, in none of MaÖ·anamiára’s works, or in the philosophical works of other authors, is MaÖ·anamiára mentioned as a disciple of either Kum§rila or SaØkara. 85 See, for example, Aiyer and Sastri (1962) and Kuppuswami (2001), who argue for a birth-date of 509 BCE. 86 The dates argued for the time of “aØkara were: 8th cent. CE (K. T. Telang, Vol. I:71, 89, 203); 510 BCE (Subha Rao, Vol. IV:295, 304–310); 5th cent CE (Bh§shy§ch§rya, Vol. XI:98, 182, 263–271); 43 BCE (Gopalacharlu, Vol. XIV: 253–256); 509 BCE (Govind-d§sa, Vol. XVI:163–168).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 125 Perhaps the earliest list of §c§rya-s for the “ÜØgerÊ pÊãha is that contained in the “rÊ-purußottama-bh§ratÊ-carita, composed by VißÖu in the late fifteenth century (Shastry 1982:7).87 It provides a brief account of the §c§rya-s from Vidy§áaØkara (on the gaddÊ from 1228–1333) to Candraáekharabh§ratÊ II (1454–1464). In one of the hagiographies of “aØkara, LakßmaÖa-“§strÊ’s GuruvaÒáa-k§vya, written in 1740, is also to be found a list of §c§rya-s for the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. Antarkar (2001:40) believes that this is possibly the earliest full list of §c§rya-s of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. This work was instigated by the then reigning §c§rya, Saccid§nandabh§ratÊ II (1705–1741). Probably the earliest widely disseminated list of the “ÜØgerÊ §c§rya-s was that published by Gopalacharlu in The Theosophist in 1893, which was based on a text published twenty years previously by KÜßÖar§ja Wodeyar of Mysore. This guru-parampar§ gives the date of “aØkara’s birth as 43 BCE, his accession to the “ÜØgerÊ gaddÊ as 34 BCE, and his death as 11 BCE. He is followed by Viávaråp§c§rya and thirty-one other gurus, up to Saccid§nanda “iv§bhinava NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ, who acceded in 1817. A similar but not identical list was subsequently published as an appendix to the Tamil translation of the “DV, under the order of NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ VIII, after his demise in 1879.88 Up to 1989 there were 34 or 35 §c§rya-s in the six lists that Antarkar (2001) inspected.89 However, it seems that “aØkara could not have lived earlier than the seventh century CE,90 rendering spurious all of the guru-parampar§-s that go back to BCE.91
87
I am doubtful about this early date, as it is based on the report of Venkataraman (1959:ix), some of whose proposed dates for the §c§rya-s of “ÜØgerÊ lack sufficient historical support. 88 It was also published in Telugå, by Vavilla R§masv§mÊ in 1885 CE. 89 Many of the pontiffs of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha have been from the MålakaÖadu branch of Telugå-speaking Brahmans of Tamil Nadu (Gnanambal 1973:5). 90 As discussed in Section 1 of this chapter. 91 Sastry and Kumaraswami (1971:201–206), supporters of the K§ñcÊ maãha, comment that lists of “ÜØgerÊ §c§rya-s are not consistent. A list of thirty §c§rya-s was published in 1854 by His Highness “rÊ KÜßÖar§ja Wodeyar, in which PÜthvÊdh§ra is “aØkara’s immediate successor at “ÜØgerÊ. In some later manuscripts Viávaråpa is introduced in place of PÜthvÊdh§ra, but none of them mention the name of Sureávara, as found in the list prepared by NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ VIII. In the list of “ÜØgerÊ §c§rya-s published by Aiyer and Sastri (1962:164), “aØkara is recorded as ascending the gaddÊ in 18 BCE, and passing away in 12 BCE. Sureávara follows him, ascending the gaddÊ in 12 BCE, and passing away in 773 CE; a ‘miraculous’ reign of 785 years. Sastry and Kumaraswamy maintain that Sureávara was not introduced to the “ÜØgerÊ guru-parampar§ until after 1856. They believe (1971:194–201) that
126
chapter four
The other three maãha-s (of the ‘official’ four) have a list of between 60 to 144 §c§rya-s in their guru-parampar§-s,92 widely disparate numbers of §c§rya-s for institutions that were supposed to have been founded within a few years of each other. To date, the Dv§rak§ maãha has a list of 77 names, going back to “aØkara, born in 491 BCE, the seventy-seventh §c§rya being Abhinava Saccid§nanda, installed in 1960 (Miára, Maãh§mn§ya Setu 2001:26). This guru-parampar§, minus the §c§rya-s of the twentieth century, is given in the Vimaráa93 (pp. 25–28) said to have been written by the §c§rya “rÊ R§jar§jeávara “aØkar§árama Sv§mÊ, the seventy-third pontiff of Dv§rak§, in 1896 (Miára, Maãh§mn§ya Setu 2001:35; Umesh 1981:169), and published in 1955 (Antarkar 2001:40).94 In several sources, the so-called copper-plate of King Sudhanv§ is mentioned.95 The inscription (last line) is dated asvin áukla 15, yudhißãhira áaka 2663—corresponding to 476 BCE—and has been cited
“aØkara was born in 509 BCE, and was the first “aØkar§c§rya of K§ñcÊ, passing away in 477 BCE. The second §c§rya to occupy the gaddÊ was Sureávara (477–407 BCE), followed by sixty-five other §c§rya-s (eight of whom were called “aØkara), up to CandraáekharendrasarasvatÊ, who ascended the gaddÊ in 1907 CE. The thirty-seventh was Abhinava “aØkara, born in Cidambaram, who was on the K§ñcÊ gaddÊ from 801 to 839 CE. The proponents of the earlier date for “aØkara maintain that it is this Abhinava “aØkara who is being confused with $di “aØkara, the bh§ßyak§ra. 92 See Aiyer and Sastri (1962:167–181) for the §c§rya-s in the guru-parampar§-s of four maãha-s: 35 for (TuØga) “ÜØgerÊ; 68 for Ku·alÊ; 79 for Dv§rak§; 144 for Jagann§th. These lists seem to be based on a Mar§ãhÊ work by Mahadev Rajaram Bodas, “aØkar§c§rya va ty§nc§ samprad§ya, PåÖe, 1923 (Lütt 1978:412 fn. 2). See also Shastry (1982: Appendix III) for the (36) pÊãh§dhipati-s of “ÜØgerÊ jagadguru-s who go back to $di “aØkara (788–820 CE), who is followed by Sureávara. Dates only start with Vidy§áaØkaratÊrtha (on the gaddÊ from 1228–1333 CE); see Sad§nand Brahmac§rÊ (2000:29–34) for the (78) jagadguru-s of Dv§rak§, also going back to “ureávara, who supposedly occupied the gaddÊ from 447 BCE. According to this guru-parampar§, Sureávara is followed by Citsukh§c§rya (from 423 BCE). However, Citsukha may be dated to the latter half of the twelfth century, as he comments on the Ny§ya-makaranda of $nandabodha Bhaãã§rak§c§rya, who appears to have lived in the latter half of the eleventh and first half of the twelfth century (see Dasgupta 1975, Vol. 2:49; Satchidanandendra Sarasvati 1989:908–943). However, it was long ago suggested (Govinda-D§sa 1894:166) that the Citsukh§c§rya of the Dv§rak§ guru-parampar§ is different from the more recent Citsuka. 93 I have not seen this work. 94 The Dv§rak§ guru-parampar§ is also published in Govinda-D§sa (Theosophist, Vol. XVI, 1894:164–168); B§ldev Up§dhy§y (1967); Yatisandhy§samuccaya (pub. by Dv§rak§-pÊãha, 1967). 95 For the Sanskrit text and translation, see Mishra (Math§mn§ya Setu 2001:62– 65).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 127 on several occasions96 in support of the claims to antiquity of both the Dv§rak§ pÊãha and “aØkara (who is supposed to have been a contemporary of Sudhanv§), and to authenticate the claim that “aØkara founded four maãha-s in the four quarters of India.97 Sudhanv§ (as a king of Kerala) also appears (four times) in the “aØkara-dig-vijaya (“DV)98 and the Maãh§mn§ya-s.99 Umesh (1981:176–177) is, in my view, rightly suspicious of the authenticity of this inscription: the copper-plate was not available from the Dv§rak§ pÊãha for his inspection, despite his numerous requests; the Sanskrit is not ancient, as would have been used in the fifth century BCE; and the signature of Sudhanv§ as sarvabhauma (‘Lord of the entire earth’)100 is odd,
96
Vimaráa p. 2 (see Umesh 1981:169); Mishra (Math§mn§ya Setu 2001:xvii). Installing: (l.1) Padmap§da (alias Sanandana) at Bhogvardhana (Jagann§th); (l.17) Toãaka (alias PratardaÖa) at Jyotir (BadarÊ); (l.23–27) Viávaråpa (alias Sureávara) at “§rad§ (Dv§rak§); and (l.18–19) PÜthvÊdh§ra (alias Hast§malaka) at “ÜØg-ÜßÊ (“ÜØgerÊ). Sureávara is deputed by “aØkara to be the arbiter of important decisions (l.32–33). “aØkara is also said to have installed “rÊ KÜßÖa in the renovated temple of Trailokya Sundar in Dv§rak§, which is particularly renowned for heresies (l.23–26). 98 See M§hava-Vidy§raÖya (1986). The first appearance (1.60–98) is when Sudhanv§ (an incarnation of Indra) is saved from the perils of Buddhism by the miracles of Kum§rila-Bhaããa (an incarnation of Skanda): he accepts the Veda and expels the Sugata Buddhists. This incident seems to be partly based on an account found in the Keralopathi (the earliest traditional account of Kerala), according to which two of the twenty-five Perumals who administered Kerala (Palli Bana Perumal and Cheraman Perumal) embraced Buddhism, Palli Bana Perumal (c.305–317 CE) ordering the Brahmans throughout Malan§·u to also embrace Buddhism. The Brahmans, with the help of a saint named JaØgaman and six á§strÊ-s defeated the Buddhists in debate, resulting in their expulsion by the king, who then abdicated in great remorse. Cheraman may have been born, and died, a áaiva, though supporting Palli Bana Perumal’s conversion to Buddhism (Chaudhury 1969:233). In the second incident (5.10–30), Sudhanv§’s attempts to entice “aØkara to his palace are rebuffed. He is finally granted the boon of a son after reciting three self-penned dramas. Sudhanv§ appears (14.166–175) when “aØkara visits Kerala; and when “aØkara commences his digvijaya, he is accompanied by many disciples and Sudhanv§, who here makes his fourth appearance (15.1–29). During his encounter with Krakaca and his ferocious K§p§lika entourage, the king fought with bow and arrow on behalf of “aØkara, who reduced them to ashes with a mystic syllable. 99 Discussing the various characteristics (lakßaÖa) needed by a wandering mendicant (parivr§jaka) to assume authority at either of the four separate pÊãha-s (Dv§rak§, Jyotira, “ÜØgerÊ and Govardhana), the Mah§nuá§sanam, v. 53 (Mishra, vv. 53 and 55 [=“arma 1963:649, Maãh§mn§yasetu, vv. 32 and 33; see Appendix 2]) states that he should have the capacity for exertion of Sudhanv§ for dharma, serving gods and kings. The tradition of dharma (v. 55) should be protected eternally by Sudhanv§ and other rulers. 100 See also Miára ($miã K§lrekh§ 2001:21–23) for a discussion of the term sarvabhauma. 97
128
chapter four
as it is to “aØkara that the plate is addressed as a eulogy. Sanskrit first came to be used in inscriptions only in the first century BCE (Salomon 1998:86), the earliest extant examples of copper plate inscriptions—used primarily to record land grants—dating to around the middle of the fourth century CE (the earliest examples being in Prakrit, issued by the Pallava and “§laØk§yana dynasties in south India), though they appear to have been manufactured from the first or second century CE (Salomon 1998:114). Further, the form of copper plate inscriptions is fairly standardised, and in no respect similar to the copper plate inscription of Sudhanv§. The historical existence of Sudhanv§ as a king of Kerala seems doubtful as I have been unable to find any reference to him in other sources,101 and the copper-plate inscription seems to be entirely spurious, manufactured to add credence to the legitimacy of Dv§rak§ and the other three pÊãha-s.102 4.4.1 K§ñcÊpuram There is an ongoing dispute concerning whether “aØkara founded either four maãha-s, as per the Maãh§mn§ya-s, or five maãha-s, including K§ñcÊpuram (known as the K§makoãÊ pÊãha). This maãha is nevertheless fully recognised in most orthodox circles.103 Both “ÜØgerÊ and
101 Intriguingly, R§ja Sudhanv§ also features in the semi-mythological history of Nepal (see Wright 1877:83, who edited a translation of the Buddhist recension of the VaÒá§valÊ, ‘The Genealogical History of Nepal’): the Tret§ Yuga is said to have ended in Sudhanv§’s reign; he built a new palace in a town called S§nk§syanagarÊ that he founded; and was put to death, for reasons unknown, at Janakpur by R§ja Janaka, the father of SÊt§. 102 Sureávara’s reputation amongst “aØkara’s hagiographers is such that his appropriation to a particular place seems to be a probable (though admittedly unreliable) indicator of the source of a hagiographic or eulogistic text. The Dv§rak§ guru-parampar§ begins in 509 BCE, and the copper-plate also records dates in the fifth century BCE. I would even hazard a guess that the inscription may have been fabricated around the time of the previously mentioned disputes over the legitimacy of pÊãha-s in Gujarat during the latter part of the nineteenth century. Curiously, the inscription does not mention Kerala, where, according to the “DV, Sudhanv§ was a king. 103 Published in Kaly§Ö (TÊrth§Øk) (1997:547–548), a conservative publication, is a list of twenty jagadguru áaØkar§c§rya pÊãha-s and upapÊãha-s, which states that the five main pÊãha-s “established by “aØkara” are: Jyotir pÊãha, Govardhan pÊãha, “§rad§ pÊãha, “ÜØgerÊ pÊãha, K§makoãi pÊãha. There are seven “branches or upamaãha of the “ÜØgerÊ pÊãha”: KuÖ·i (=Ku·alÊ), “ivagaØg§, $vanÊ, Viråp§kßa, Pußpagiri, SaØkeáva/ KaravÊr, R§mcandr§pur (Hosangar t§luk§, Mysore District); and eight maãha-s in
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 129 K§ñcÊpåram claim legitimacy as the authentic southern pÊãha, and a substantial volume of polemical publications from both sides have issued in the last century, the foremost contributors being, on the “ÜØgerÊ side, “arma (1963); and on the K§ñcÊ side, Kuppuswami (1972; 2001)104 and Narayana Sastry (1971 [1916]), who published the first work in English in support of the K§ñcÊ claim. Recently, Antarkar (2001) has responded to numerous points raised by “arma, Aiyer and Sastri, and Venkataraman, objecting to the legitimacy of the K§ñcÊ maãha. “arma claims, contrary to significant epigraphic evidence, that the K§ñcÊ maãha only came into existence in the early nineteenth century. The PuÖyaálokamañjarÊ (P“M), one of the three hagiographies of “aØkara accepted as genuine by the K§ñcÊ maãha,105 contains a guru-parampar§ for the K§ñcÊ pÊãha, going back to “aØkara’s founding of the maãha and ascension of the gaddÊ in 480 BCE;106 he is followed by Sureávara who was on the gaddÊ from
the Karnataka area: Hariharpur (near “ÜØgerÊ), Bhandige·i (U·upi t§luk§), Ya·nÊrå (K§sargo·u t§luk§), KodaÖ·§áram (Tumkår t§luk§, Mysore District), SvarÖvallÊ (“irsÊ t§luk§), Nelam§vu (Uttar Kan§Ü§ t§luk§), YoganarsiÒh Sv§mi (HolenarasÊpur, Mysore District), B§lakuduru (U·upÊ t§luk§). Another list of twenty maãha-s is cited by Anantanandendra Sarasvati (1968:388) from a work that I have not seen, by Mah§vidv§n Venkaã§cala “arma. These maãha-s are described as “aØkar§c§ry§dividy§-dharma-pÊãh§dhipa-parampar§gata-maãhaÈ: Sumeru, Param§tma, Sumeru (at K§áÊ), Hayvaka, Koppala, “rÊ-Sailam, R§meávaram, Ghanagiri, Honnahalli, Kaivalyapura, Målabagalu, Sirali, GÜdhrapura, NarasiÒhav§di, Molavana, Paitana, K§áÊ, TÊrthar§japura, GaØgotrÊ, TÊrthahalli. There is also a reference to a “aØkara maãha at GaØgotrÊ in The Light of Asia (1894:331). My suspicion is that this may be to a now practically derelict maãha at Ukhimaãha (near GaØgotrÊ), which I visited in 1985. This appears also be the maãha referred to by Ghosh (1930:12)—who cites Sister Nivedita’s Northern Tirthas—which was originally granted to the “Kedarn§th order of “ankar§c§rya” for (presumably) miltary gosain-s in the service of the kings of GaÜhv§l. The mahant was said to be the 125th in succession. 104 Kuppuswami responds, in large measure, to the arguments presented by R. Krishnaswamy Aiyer and K. R. Venkataraman in The Truth about the Kumbhakonam mutt, [Publisher and place not identified]:1965. (I have not been able to see this work.) Bader (2000:291) lists thirteen polemical works arising from disputes between the matÈa-s, including those by “arma (1963), and Aiyar and Venkataraman (1965). 105 The others are Anant§nandagiri’s “aØkaravijaya (see following section) and the Guru-ratna-m§l§. 106 Antarkar (2001:38) and Veezhinathan (see Sarvajñ§tman 1972:1) also refer to the Jagadguru-ratna-m§lastava (Guru-ratna-m§l§/m§lik§ [GRM]), which contains a list of 57 §c§rya-s for the K§makoãi pÊãha. The work is attributed by the K§ñcÊ maãha to Sad§áivabrahmendra, who was co-student with $tmabodhendra (1586–1638), both being disciples of ParamahaÒsa “ivendra (1539–1586), §c§rya no. 57. It appears that
130
chapter four
477 to 407 BCE.107 The guru-parampar§ is said by the K§ñcÊ to have been prepared by Sarvajñasad§bodha, the fifty-sixth §c§rya, on the gaddÊ from 1512 to 1539. Later additions to the parampar§ were added by several subsequent §c§rya-s, the current reigning §c§rya being JayendrasarasvatÊ, the sixty-ninth. However, the credibility of the guru-parampar§ pertaining to the period prior to the sixteenth century is doubtful. The earliest record of an advaita maãha at K§ñcÊ is a copper-plate epigraph, dated to 1291/2 CE,108 that records the grant of a village called Ambik§puram (near K§ñcÊ) to “rÊ “aØkar§rya (also referred to as “aØkara-yogin), by VijayagaÖ·agop§la, a Telugå Coϧ ruler. The inscription mentions påj§ to CandramaulÊávara and advaita upadeáa. It has been claimed, by some K§ñcÊ supporters, that the inscription is referring to a “aØkar§c§rya, and provides evidence of a maãha founded by him.109 However, firstly, it is clear that the reference cannot be to $di “aØkara, as no one suggests that “aØkara lived at such a late date. Secondly, the name in the inscription is “aØkar§ya and not “aØkar§c§rya. A Tamil inscription in the “iva temple at Ambik§puram, dated 1516 CE (áaka 1436), is signed by CandraáekharasarasvatÊ of the K§ñcÊ maãha, and refers to a village granted to the maãha, confirming the aforementioned grant of 1291/2 CE by VijayagaÖ·agop§la (Mahalingam 1940:324; Antarkar 2001:112-115). The next record providing information about the pontiffs of K§ñcÊ is a grant of a village named KÜßÖar§yapuram, made in 1521 CE (áaka 1444) by KÜßÖadevar§ya of Vijayanagara, to Candracå·asarasvatÊ, disciple of Mah§devasarasvatÊ.110 In 1527 CE (áaka 1450) KÜßÖadevar§ya made a further grant, of the village named Udayamb§kam, to Sad§ái-
a commentary on the GRM, the Sußam§, and the P“M (part 1)—part 2 was written at a later date—were both written by $tmabodha. The Sußam§ contains references to the BÜhat-“aØkaravijaya of Citsukha, and the Pr§cÊna-“aØkaravijaya (Pande 1994:21), the two lost hagiographies of “aØkara discussed by Bader (see Ch. 5). 107 See Sastry and Kumaraswamy (1971:194–197) for the guru-parampar§. 108 Epigraphia Indica (EI) XIII, pp. 122–132; 194–198. 109 See, for example, Kuppuswami (1991:xxix–xxxi), who assigns this inscription, contra EI, to 1111 CE. 110 In another grant, of 1506 CE (áaka 1429), Mah§devasarasvatÊ is mentioned as a disciple of Sad§áivasarasvatÊ (EI XIII, p. 122), while Sad§áivasarasvatÊ is a disciple of CandraáekharasarasvatÊ, ‘Candraáekhara’ and ‘Candracå·§’ being homonyms (EI XIV, p. 169).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 131 vasarasvatÊ, disciple of CandraáekharasarasvatÊ, wherein Sad§áiva is described as “iva incarnate, besmeared with holy ash, and wearing rudr§kßa m§l§ (EI XIV:168–175).111 While there are several consistent records concerning the names of the early pontiffs of the K§ñcÊ maãha, the name “aØkar§c§rya first appears in epigraphs at K§ñcÊ in 1686 CE. The four other maãha-s consistently deny the authenticity of the K§ñcÊ maãha, yet the maãha currently enjoys equal status with the maãha-s at Dv§rak§ and “ÜØgerÊ, the three maãha-s being singled out by the Hindu Religious Endowments Commission in 1960–1962 as being among the few Hindu institutions which have remained true to the aims with which they were established (Bader 2000:304). Several of the “aØkar§c§ryas of those institutions have been, and continue to be, held in very high regard. Regarding the polemical arguments against K§ñcÊ, one strand of “arma’s multi-faceted argument is the absence of any reference to K§ñcÊ in the Maãh§mn§ya-s. However, the K§ñcÊ maãha currently denies the authenticity of the Maãh§mn§ya-s, believing that they post-date Vidy§raÖya and were not written by “aØkara.112 This is the view of most scholars who have examined the Maãh§mn§ya-s. However, at the end of the nineteenth century,113 in response to objections by critics that K§ñcÊ was not mentioned in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, some supporters of K§ñcÊ either found or produced a Maãh§mn§ya-setu that included K§ñcÊ, as the madhy§mn§ya or mål§mn§ya, and constituting the fifth §mn§ya.114 However, the production of this §mn§ya appears to have detracted from the K§ñcÊ claim, rather than substantiating it as intended. Critics of the K§ñcÊ claim, notably “arma (1963:312 ff.),
111
See also EI XIII, p. 122. The official position of the K§ñcÊpuram pÊãha is that the Maãh§mn§yas are historically unreliable, were not written by “aØkara, and came into existence after the time of Vidy§raÖya. However a Maãh§mn§ya-setu that records five maãha-s exists (see below), K§ñcÊ being the mål§mn§ya, presided over by “aØkara himself, the others by his disciples. (I have not been able to see this text.) 113 “arma (1963:316–336) refers to a maãh§mn§ya published by the Kumbhakonam maãha in 1894. 114 Details from this §mn§ya are to be found in “arma (1963:‘kha’), who refers to this §mn§ya also as the mål§mn§ya, årdv§mn§ya and mukhy§mn§ya: Maãha, “§rad§; $árama, IndrasarasvatÊ; PÊãha, K§makoãi; Brahmac§rya, Satyabrahmac§rÊ; Veda, Œg; Mah§v§kya, AuÒ Tatsat; Samprad§ya, Mithy§v§ra; $c§rya, “rÊ “aØkar§c§rya. Details provided by Aiyer and Sastri (1962:98) are as per “arma, but also included are: Kßetra, Satyavrata K§ñcÊ; Devat§, Ekamran§tha/K§makoãi or K§m§kßÊ; TÊrtha, Kampa Saras. 112
132
chapter four
have devoted a substantial effort to pointing out the inconsistencies contained in the K§ñcÊ Maãh§mn§ya. For around 120 years, since the controversy first began to generate considerable heat,115 the claim of the K§ñcÊ maãha is that “aØkara founded five maãha-s, with himself as the first §c§rya at K§ñcÊ, and his four disciples at the other places recorded in the Maãh§mn§ya-s. The main substance of the “ÜØgerÊ claim is that the K§ñcÊ maãha is a branch maãha—of which there are several—of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. One of the issues that has complicated the argument is the shifting of the K§ñcÊ maãha to Kumbhakonam, which took place certainly prior to 1763 (Antarkar 2001:139), most probably in 1743 (Srinivasan 1979:246).116 From epigraphic evidence, it appears that the K§makoãÊ pÊãha was located in the VißÖuk§ñcÊ part of K§ñcÊpuram at least until 1686.117 Owing to Muslim raids, the maãha was then temporarily shifted to Tanjore, at the invitation of the r§ja, Pratapa SiÒha, who built a new maãha and had a golden image of K§m§kßÊ devÊ installed. The maãha was then shifted to Kumbhakonam (Gnanambal 1973:10),118 which may have been the site of a “aØkara maãha since the thirteenth century (Champalakshmi 1996:344).119 Endowments
115
In 1886, a forum of scholars and pandits met at a vyavasth§ (‘organisation/ ruling’) held at Banaras and decided that only four maãha-s were legitimate. Their decision was based primarily on the “DV and Maãh§mn§ya-s (Antarkar 2001:135–137). Ironically, it coincided with a tour of the north by Mah§devasarasvatÊ, the 63rd §c§rya Kumbhakonam maãha. However, the purpose of the vyavasth§ was to discredit the claim of one Sad§nandatÊrtha Sv§mÊ that “aØkara founded a fifth maãha at Målab§gala in Dv§rak§ (see below). 116 “astry and Kumaraswamy (1971:202) believe the maãha moved to Kumbhakonam in the latter part of the eighteenth century. Srinivasan (1979:273 fn. 160) refers to a [unidentifiable] copper-plate inscription from the K§m§kßÊ temple at K§ñcÊ that refers to Mah§devendrasarasvatÊ (1703–1746), a pupil of CandraáekharasarasvatÊ of the “aØkar§c§rya maãha at K§ñcÊ. The inscription mentions the renovation of the temple by CandraáekharendrasarasvatÊ, the pontiff of K§m§koãipÊãham, who came to K§ñcÊ from Kumbhakonam for that purpose in 1840. 117 The vaißÖava “§raØgap§Öi temple of Kumbhakonam was renovated in the early Vijayanagara period, beginning in 1385, when the name Kumbhakonam was first used. A vaißÖava maãha was first attached to the temple in the period of Raghun§tha N§yaka, in the seventeenth century, since when it has served as an important pontifical seat of south Indian VaißÖavism (Champakalakshmi 1996:344). 118 Gnanambal cites T. A. Gopinath Rao, Copper Plate Inscriptions Belonging to the Sankaracharya of the Kamakoti Pith (Madras: Law Printing Press, 1916:2–3). 119 A Telugå CÙ·a Copper plate grant of the period of VijayagaÖ·agop§la (thirteenth century) records provisions made for its maintenance (Epigraphia Indica, XIII, A-62:194ff).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 133 were made to the Kumbhakonam maãha by the provision of the late Vijayanagara ruler VeØkaãa V in áaka 1632 (1710 CE). The main maãha returned to the “ivak§ñcÊ part of K§ñcÊpuram in the early nineteenth century, the Kumbhakonam maãha now being a branch maãha of K§ñcÊpuram.120 4.4.2 “ÜØgerÊ and other southern maãha-s While there is an on-going dispute between the “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊpåram pÊãha-s as to which pÊãha was founded by “aØkara as the southern pÊãha,121 at least six other maãha-s have claimed legitimacy in the south (see Antarkar 2001:51–69): the maãha-s at $vaÖi, Pußpagiri, Viråp§kßa,122 “aØkeávara, TuØga “ÜØgerÊ and Ku·alÊ (or
120
Both the Kumbhakonam (‘junior’) and K§ñcÊ (‘senior’) maãha-s have a traditional entitlement (known as merai) to 1/96th part of the land-tax payable to Government, a tradition ratified in the High Court of Madras in 1917 by Sir John Wallis and Justice Mr. Ayling (Antarkar 2001:121). In 1894 the Collector of Tanjore recommended that 6743 Rs. be paid as merai to the K§ñcÊ maãha (Anantanandendra Sarasvati 1968:379). 121 A dispute between the K§ñcÊ K§makoãi and “ÜØgerÊ maãha-s led to two court cases, in 1844 and 1848. This concerned the authority to carry out the repair of the ear-ornaments (taãaØka-pratißãh§) of the Goddess Akhil§Ö·eávarÊ in the Tiruvanaikoil temple at Jambukeávaram, and the entitlement to exclusive jurisdiction over certain spiritual affairs of the area, in this case in district of Tirichinopoly. (Incidentally, the maãha attached to this temple also claims to be the first and foremost of the maãha-s established by “aØkara; see Antarkar 2001:95). The cases were decided in favour of the K§ñcÊ maãha, and the “ÜØgerÊ maãha failed to prove its case for its jurisdiction over religious matters in the south. A similar dispute over the consecration of the earrings again took place in 1908, with the same outcome, the K§ñcÊ maãha finally performing the consecration. There were several other disputes between the two maãha-s (Bader 2000:290–291 fn 138; Antarkar 2001:94–101). More recently, in 1984, one K. Rajendran brought a case at the High Court of Madras (Bader 2000:303), claiming that the incumbents of the K§ñcÊpuram maãha are not Jagadguru-“aØkar§c§ryas. Rajendran cited the Maãh§mn§ya-s, and called attention to the three branches of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha in Tamil Nadu. He objected to the control of the K§ñcÊ maãha over the K§m§kßÊ-amman temple, and to the participation of the Chief Minister and the Minister for Religious and Charitable Endowments in a conference partly organised by the K§ñcÊ maãha. The court rejected the suit, and, similar to the ruling in the case brought before the Bombay High Court in 1908, maintained that it was not the duty of the government to declare who is or who is not a “aØkar§c§rya. 122 Both the Pußpagiri maãha (Cuddapah t§luk§, Cuddapah District, Karnataka) and Viråp§kßa maãha (Hospet t§luk§, Bellary District, Karnataka) have their own Maãh§mn§ya-s (Antarkar 2001:80). For the Maãh§mn§ya-stotra of the Pußpagiri maãha, see Anantandendra Sarasvati (1968:386–387). It seems possible that the Pußpagiri maãha was originally one of four “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha-s known to have been very
134
chapter four
Kå·alÊ). While the Ku·alÊ maãha (at the confluence of the TuØg§ and Bhadr§ rivers in Shimoga District, Karnataka) may date from the twelfth century, and TuØga “ÜØgerÊ (in Chikkamagalur District, Karnataka) from the fourteenth century,123 the others date from a later period. The TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha and Ku·alÊ maãha (whose current jurisdiction is in north-west Karnataka and southern Maharashtra; see Anantanandendra Sarasvati 1968:363 fn. 11) have both made competing claims for legitimacy, arguing that the other maãha is a subsidiary.124 Of the two, the currently recognised “aØkar§c§rya occupies the gaddÊ of TuØga “ÜØgerÊ.125 However, it seems that previously the Ku·alÊ maãha enjoyed supremacy.126 In 1580, during the reign of KÜßÖappa N§yaka of Keladi (1520–1609), an order was passed prohibiting the §c§rya of the TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha from going out on digvijaya. During the reign of the 52nd §c§rya of Ku·alÊ, around 1723, the §c§rya-s of Ku·alÊ, “aØkeávara and TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha-s met at S§t§r§ (Maharashtra) during the reign of Sahu—the successor of “iv§jÊ—to decide which of the §c§rya-s should be entitled to agra-påj§ (‘first/ foremost’ påj§). It was decided in favour of the §c§rya of the Ku·alÊ maãha. Under the order of Basavappa N§yaka II—during the reign NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ, the 53rd §c§rya of Ku·alÊ (1727–1751)—the §c§rya of TuØga “ÜØgerÊ was restrained from going on digvijaya; and again in 1806, this time under the order of PurÖayya, the famous minister of Hyder $lÊ and Tippu Sultan. Another restraining order was was also issued in 1820. In 1811, KÜßÖar§jendra III of Mysore permit-
influential in the development of temple culture in the CÙÏa period (c.1000–1200) (see Ch. 6.2), given that another maãha, at Tiruv§naikk§val, seems to have once been a “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha that was converted at an indeterminable time, after 1200, to an advaita “aØkara maãha (see Annual Reports on Indian Epigraphy 1986:103, no. 538, para. 53, 28th July 1909). 123 From inscriptional evidence, it appears that the Ku·alÊ maãha received grants from 1155, while the TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha received grants only after 1345 or 1350 (Antarkar 2001:55–67). 124 There is a story to be found in several sources that while the §c§rya of the Ku·alÊ maãha, NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ, was away on an extended tour, around 1570, the gaddÊ was usurped by the TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha. This, however, contradicts the account (and the guru-parampar§ of TuØga “ÜØgerÊ), that NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ was initially the incumbent of TuØga “ÜØgerÊ (see Antarkar 2001:57–59). 125 The founding of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha, and its association with “aØkara, are discussed in the following chapter. 126 Ayer and Sastri (1962:88–92); Anantanandendra Sarasvati (1968:383); Antarkar (2001:59–61).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 135 ted NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ127 (1820–1856) of Ku·alÊ to go on digvijaya in palanquin and with full honours, having recognised him as jagadguru. When, in 1836, the incumbent of Ku·alÊ, the 59th §c§rya, also wanted to go on digvijaya, the TuØga “ÜØgerÊ §c§rya objected and took the Ku·alÊ §c§rya to court in Mysore to prevent it; the resultant ruling was in favour of TuØga “ÜØgerÊ, but on Appeal (no. 22 of 1847) the ruling was overturned, in favour of the Ku·alÊ §c§rya, ratified by Sir Mark Cubbon in 1849. Up until the middle the nineteenth century, all of the several court rulings in disputes between the Ku·alÊ and “ÜØgerÊ maãha-s issued in favour of the Ku·alÊ maãha. Although currently the “aØkar§c§rya of the TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha is recognised as the ‘legitimate’ “aØkar§c§rya, and not that of Ku·alÊ, it seems that it was only in the middle of the twentieth century that the TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha started pushing the claim that theirs was the DakßiÖ§mn§ya maãha, or one founded by “aØkara for the southern region. Records appear to have been altered to this effect (Antarkar 2001:81). It is not only the K§ñcÊ, Ku·alÊ and “ÜØgerÊ maãha-s that have enjoyed dominance as the southern maãha. The “ivagaØg§ maãha was established at the request of R§ja Wodeyar, the then ruler of Mysore, in 1615 at “ivagaØg§128 by an ascetic, “aØkarabh§ratÊ,129 who was ordained by Abhinava NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ V of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha (Row 1914:57ff.). The spiritual jurisdiction of the maãha has periodically extended over most of the territory of modern Karnataka. Between 1727 and 1846 the maãha rose to prominence, so much so that the “ÜØgerÊ maãha was overshadowed by the influence of the “ivagaØg§ maãha. During this period, r§hdarÊ-s (‘passports’) were issued by several local rulers and officials, permitting the jagadguru-s of “ivagaØg§ to travel in the region and collect religious donations, and a number of villages were granted to the maãha. However, NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ VIII, who was on the gaddÊ as the pÊãh§dhipati of (TuØga) “ÜØgerÊ
127
Another §c§rya of the same name. According to Row (1914:24) the two main temples at the site (SvarÖadevÊ/ HonnadevÊ and GaØg§dharasv§mÊ) were first established in the reign of VißÖuvardhana (1104–1141). The site, which is thirty-four miles north-west of Bangalore, features a prominent hill where pilgrims assemble at MakarasaØkr§nti to witness several pot-loads of ‘GaØg§-water’ issuing from the earth. 129 For a list of the “aØkar§c§ryas on the gaddÊ at “ivagaØg§ from 1615 to 1914, see Row (1914:Appendix 1). 128
136
chapter four
from 1817 to 1879, revived the fortunes of “ÜØgerÊ (Venkataraman 1959:84–95; Antarkar 2001:85–92), ‘rediscovering’ K§laãi (“aØkara’s birthplace), instituting “aØkara jayantÊ celebrations all over India, and arranging for the publication of a comprehensive collection of “aØkara’s works. He also instituted meetings of various ‘legitimate’ “aØkar§c§ryas and objected to travel on palanquin (a··§-p§lakÊ) and the receiving of presents by the ‘illegitimate’ §c§rya-s of the “ivagaØg§ maãha. To settle the dispute, the Mah§r§ja of Mysore passed an order (10th June 1831) that both maãha-s should enjoy equal privileges (Row 1914:69). However, the aim of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha—which was ultimately successful—was to absorb the “ivagaØg§ maãha-’s jurisdiction into its own and to treat the “ivagaØg§ sv§mÊ as a ‘disciple’, giving him a small allowance (Row 1914:75). At times, the “ivagaØg§, $vaÖi and (TuØga) “ÜØgerÊ maãha-s have sent payments to the Ku·alÊ maãha, which is evidence of their status as subsidiary maãha-s in previous centuries. However, as observed previously, it was the (TuØga) “ÜØgerÊ maãha that subsequently gained preeminence, gaining control of the “ivagaØg§ maãha, and persuading the government to deny it certain privileges, such as the suspension of r§hdarÊ-s.130 The $vaÖi maãha was founded by Abhinava NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ V, of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha, who, according to the “ÜØgerÊ guru-parampar§, ascended the “ÜØgerÊ gaddÊ in 1576, his demise being in 1599 (Aiyer and Sastri 1962:165). The earliest record for the $vaÖi maãha is a grant by “rÊ RaØga III, dated 1645 (Venkataraman 1959:60),131 subsequent grants being made by the Mughal administrators of Bijapur (Karnataka). According to the occupants of the $vaÖi maãha (Anantanandendra Sarasvati 1968:384–385), the maãha was established
130 The vigorous assertion of power and privileges for the “ÜØgerÊ maãha by NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ VIII also led to several court cases against the Kumbhakonam maãha, where the K§ñcÊ maãha was stationed during most of the nineteenth century (see Antarkarv 2001:88ff.). In 1829, two hundred residents of Madurai had an order (nibandhanapatrik§) issued, stating their allegiance to the Kumbhakonam maãha. The “ÜØgerÊ §c§rya got a similar order issued in his favour. However, in 1837, when NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ wished to attend the Mah§m§gham festival in Kumbhakonam, he was prevented by a government order from going by palanquin through the street of Kumbhakonam housing the Kumbhakonam and other maãha-s; he was obliged to pass via another route. The §c§rya went to Trichiripalli in 1838 and attempted to get donations (agrasaÒbh§navan§) from the residents of some villages in the district. Upset, the villagers approached the District Collector, who passed an order preventing the “ÜØgerÊ §c§rya from doing so. 131 Epigraphia Carnataka, X, Mulbagal, 60.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 137 after NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ returned to “ÜØgerÊ from a long tour in the north, to find that someone else had been installed on the “ÜØgerÊ gaddÊ. Rather than dispute, he set up at the Ku·alÊ maãha. When NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ went on tour again, he left a disciple on the Ku·alÊ gaddÊ, to avoid being usurped again. On this tour he established a maãha in Kolar district that was subsequently moved to Avanti (also in the Kolar district), and which became known as the $vaÖi maãha. Although the $vaÖi maãha is currently recognised as a branch of the TuØga “ÜØgerÊ maãha,132 in the eighteenth century the agrasaÒbh§van§ collected by the §c§rya, who was on tour in the K§veri area, went to the K§ñcÊ maãha, as the K§veri area lay within the K§ñcÊ jurisdiction. However, correspondence from the early eighteenth century133 reveals that at that time both the $vaÖi and “ivagaØg§ (see below) maãha-s were paying tribute annually to the Ku·alÊ maãha (Anantanandendra Sarasvati 1968:384–385), indicating that it was either Ku·alÊ or K§ñcÊ that was then considered the preeminent maãha. The Viråp§kßa maãha is another advaita maãha that has been involved in legal disputes concerning its right to exert spiritual sovereignty over the area under its jurisdiction, and to collect donations. According to local tradition it was founded by the legendary Vidy§raÖya,134 its first §c§rya being appointed in 1382. However, the earliest available inscription is of KÜßÖadevar§ya, of 1515 (Verghese 1995:116).135 In 1863, the “ÜØgerÊ maãha filed a suit in the Nizam’s High Court, attempting to prevent the Viråp§kßa maãha—which had representatives stationed in Hyderabad and other places—from touring and collecting yearly payments. The court decided against the plaintiff, noting that people were familiar with the Viråp§kßa maãha, and that the “ÜØgerÊ saÒsth§na (‘institution’) had not toured for many years. The court ruled that the “ÜØgerÊ maãha should give up its claim to regular payments for spiritual authority; and that the Viråp§kßa maãha should continue to impart religious instruction to its disciples and tour the country, and that no one should interfere with that organisation.136 132 The §c§rya-s of the $vaÖi maãha call themselves $vaÖi “ÜØgerÊ sv§mÊ-s (Venkataraman 1959:60). 133 Letters written in 1711, 1713, 1714 and 1715. 134 See the following chapter. 135 Another sm§rta advaita maãha is located nearby, the Cint§maÖi maãha at $negondi. It is believed that this maãha was founded in the early fourteenth century, and continued to function in post-Vijayanagara times. 136 The K§ñcÊ maãha, and the Viråp§kßa, $vaÖi, “ivagaØg§, HaÒpe and KaravÊra
138
chapter four
In Maharashtra, in the village of KaravÊra, is the KaravÊra maãha, also known as the “aØkeávara pÊãha. The maãha appears first to have been affiliated to “ÜØgerÊ, and then to have seceded in the sixteenth century (Lütt 1978:416). It has four branches, at “aØkeávara/KaravÊra, PåÖe, Kolhapur and S§t§r§ (Anantanandendra Sarasvati 1968:367). In 1925/26 both the “aØkar§c§rya of PurÊ (Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha) and the “aØkar§c§rya of “aØkeávara (Dr. Kurkoti) were actively engaged in the politics of the recently reformed Hindu Mah§sabh§, and both were vigorously defending their claim to be “aØkar§c§ryas, through public exposure and political activity. Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha was attempting to become pontiff of Dv§rak§, but did not succeed, instead becoming “aØkar§c§rya of PurÊ in 1925, at the request of the dying “aØkar§c§rya of PurÊ, MadhusådanatÊrtha (Lütt 1978:415).137 According to tradition, “aØkara was of the Nambådiri (Nambåthiri) caste of Kerala. Their manners and customs are recorded in the “aØkara-smÜti and the “aØkar§caryar, works reputedly but almost certainly not written by “aØkara. According with some of the hagiographic accounts of “aØkara’s travels (see below), the Nambådiris claim that “aØkara left Ked§rn§th, where he had set up a áivaliØgam, and returned to “rÊsailam via Ayodhya, Gay§ and PurÊ. When “aØkara reached the south he is said to have established four maãha-s in Trichur (Kerala). Two of these, the Thekk¿ maãham (Tirukkekkat) and the Natuvil maãham (N§·uvile) were functioning at the beginning of the twentieth century, presided over by Nambådiri saÒny§sÊ-s, who have, according to them, descended in a regular line of succession from the original heads of the maãha-s (Ananthakrishna Iyer 1912:259).138
maãha-s—the latter now all being branches of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha—are all known as “§rad§ maãha-s. While there is a reference in some of the vijaya-s of “aØkara (see below) to “aØkara’s inauguration of the worship of “§rad§ devÊ at “ÜØgerÊ, according to the Maãh§mn§ya-s it is Dv§rak§ that is the “§rad§ pÊãha. 137 The “aØkar§c§rya of “aØkeávara/KaravÊra, together with the “aØkar§c§ryas of PurÊ and Dv§rak§, attended the Allahabad Kumbh Mel§ of 1918 to preside over sessions of the All-India Hindu Sabh§ (later to become the Hindu Mah§sabh§) and the All-India San§tana Dharma Mah§sammelan. The “aØkar§c§rya of KaravÊra was subsequently enrolled into the Hindu Mah§sabh§ (Jaffrelot 1996:198). 138 These maãha-s are said to have been originally situated at Trichur, but subsequently relocated outside town. One of the four maãha-s (I have not been able to determine which) was transformed into a Vedic college for Nambådiri Brahmans (Anantanandendra SarasvatÊ 1968:378).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 139 4.4.3 Disputes concerning the western pÊãha The Målab§gala maãha (in Karnataka) and the Durv§spur maãha (in the vicinity of Dv§rak§) have both claimed legitimacy, in opposition to the Dv§rak§ maãha. The claim of the former led to a convocation of pandits at the aforementioned vyavastha in Banaras in 1886, which decided against the Målab§gala maãha, in favour of Dv§rak§. In 1945 Sv§mÊ “rÊ Abhinava Saccid§nandatÊrtha was consecrated as head of the Dv§rak§ maãha. Prior to this he had been head of the Målab§gala maãha, but upon his appointment to Dv§rak§ the lineage of the Målab§gala maãha was merged with that of Dv§rak§ (Daáan§mÊ Samprad§ya—The Monastic Tradition 1999:4). Bader (2000:299) discusses what he describes as undoubtedly the most significant legal case involving the jurisdiction of the “aØkara maãha-s, which came before the High Court of Bombay in 1908.139 The “aØkar§c§rya of Dv§rak§ succeeded, under a first court ruling, in preventing his rival at Dholka in Gujarat from calling himself “aØkar§c§rya, and from soliciting money under that name. In defence, the Dholka §c§rya had claimed that the “aØkar§c§rya at BadarÊn§th had long ago set up maãha-s in Gujarat and elsewhere, having been obliged to quit BadarÊn§th owing to disputes there; and that the Dholka maãha is a branch of the Jyotir maãha. An appeal was brought by the “aØkar§c§rya of Dholka, who denied the authenticity of “aØkara’s authorship of Maãh§mn§ya-s, which the Dv§rak§ maãha had cited in evidence, reiterating that Dholka was a branch of the Jyotir maãha. The British Judge, Chief Justice Scott, accepted the claim that “aØkara established four maãha-s, but observed that maãha-s may decline in prestige, and that new maãha-s are established. He noted that the jurisdiction of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha was reported to have been divided into five or six branches in 1835.140 Justice Scott accepted the defendant’s evidence that the “aØkar§c§ryas of “ÜØgerÊ, Dv§rak§ and PurÊ had received offerings when they were on tour in districts outside their alleged jurisdiction, but allowed the appeal, setting aside the ruling of the lower court. The Dv§rak§ pÊãha was again involved
139 Madhusudan Parvat v. Shree Madhav Teerth, in the Indian Law Reports, Bombay Series, 33 (1909), pp. 278–293; The Bombay Law Reporter, 11 (1909), pp. 48–68; see Bader (2000:299 fn. 155). 140 This was on the basis of Sri Sunkur Swami v. Sidha Lingayah Charanti; see Bader (2000:301 fn. 159).
140
chapter four
in a dispute in 1982, after the demise of the then pontiff Abhinava Saccid§nandatÊrtha, who had appointed Svaråp§nandasarasvatÊ as his successor. However, at that time Svaråp§nanda was “aØkar§c§rya of the Jyotir maãha, where he had been installed since 1973 (Jaffrelot 1996:356). This resulted in Svaråp§nanda becoming the “aØkar§c§rya of two maãha-s, which was challenged by M§dhav§árama who wished to occupy the Jyotir maãha gaddÊ (Sundaresan 2000:4). 4.4.4 The eastern pÊãha Regarding the history of the eastern pÊãha in Orissa, little if anything is known of the historical origins. It seems that the oldest maãha-s in the area were K§p§lika and P§áupata.141 The Govardhana maãha at PurÊ has a list of 144 (or 142) §c§rya-s contained in its Maãh§mn§ya, published in PurÊ as the “aØkar§c§rya-jagadguru-maãh§mn§ya by Yogendra Asthav§dana “arma in 1930 (Pande 1994:29). The Govardhan maãha has four other branches in PurÊ: the “aØkar§nanda, “ivatÊrtha, Gop§latÊrtha and Mahiprak§áa maãha-s. The first three maãha-s are presided over by saÒny§sÊ-s, while the last is a brahmac§rÊ maãha.142 The only dates known for the pontiffs of the Govardhan maãha are for the last five pontiffs, the first of whom became Head in 1849. In the bald list many names are repeated. One significant difference between appointments at PurÊ and other pÊãha-s is that at PurÊ the “aØkar§c§ryas are traditionally first householders before assuming office. At the other pÊãha-s the “aØkar§c§ryas are generally appointed much younger, from brahmac§rya. As a consequence, pontiffs at PurÊ tend to reign for shorter periods, which could account for its longer list of pontiffs (Lütt 1978:412). However, there seems to have been some kind of lapse of authority at PurÊ, as suggested by a letter from the “aØkar§c§rya of “ÜØgerÊ to his colleague at PurÊ, dated
141 In Bhubaneávara, the oldest maãha is the Sadavrata maãha, dating from (tentatively) the seventh century. It was originally in the hands of the P§áupata order, but in 1964 it was administered by Bh§ratÊs of the Daáan§mÊ order (Miller and Wertz 1976:13). The second oldest monastery is the K§p§li maãha, dating (tentatively) from the eighth to sixteenth centuries. This maãha is associated with the K§p§likas, a sect closely associated with the P§áupatas. 142 The “aØkar§nanda maãha is the more important of the affiliated maãha-s, supplying the vice-president to an organisation of Brahmans (the Mukti-MaÖ·apa) which oversees sixteen in§m villages in the PurÊ pargana. The Govardhan maãha supplies the president to this organisation (Anantanandendra Sarasvati 1968:399).
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 141 1862.143 The “aØkar§c§rya states that “the Acharyas of the Govardhana and Jyotir Maths degraded themselves to the position of Gosains [presumably married saÒny§sÊ-s] and thus these two Maths remained without any Acharya although the Govardhana Math was subsequently revived by a Sanyasi from Gougak Nakhal.” Beyond this not much is known, but it appears from East India Company documents that the PurÊ maãha was (still or again?) in the hands of saÒny§sÊ-s around 1800 (Lütt 1978:413 fn. 6). At one time there seems to have been a close association between the Govardhana maãha and the Jagann§tha temple, in that the priests of the Jagann§tha temple used to receive training in ceremonies and rituals in the Govardhana maãha. A certificate was then issued, which, following the confirmation of the king, permitted the priests to carry out their services. Owing to a dispute arising from the removal and destruction of the idols of $di-“aØkara and “iva (or Padmap§da?)144 from Jagann§tha, around 1800, the relationship between the two institutions ended.145 Prior to 1900 the “aØkar§c§rya of “ÜØgerÊ was regarded as the preeminent authority regarding the running of the other maãha-s, and the “aØkar§c§rya of PurÊ did not play an important role in the religious life of India. This changed in the twentieth century, since when the “aØkar§c§ryas of PurÊ have played a more prominent role in Hindu religious affairs, notably under Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha, who was very active during his period on the gaddÊ, from 1925 to 1960 (Lütt 1978:414–415).146 Prior to becoming
143
Madhusudan Parvat v. Shri Shankaracarya, The Indian Law Reports, Bombay Series, 33, p. 289 (see Lütt 1978:412). 144 During his reign, Gajpati DibyasiÒha Deva II (1793–1798) renovated the Jagann§tha temple, temporarily removing the mårti-s of Padmap§da and “aØkar§c§rya. They were returned but subsequently destroyed by vaißÖava-s (Das 1997:109). 145 PurÊ has witnessed periodic contests between vaißÖava and áaiva religious and political authorities since the twelfth century, until which time Orissa was áaiva, with few vaißÖava temples. “§kta images appear from the eighth century onwards. The rise of vaißÖava influence began around the time of the construction of the Jagann§tha temple, begun in 1136, attributed to the GaØga king Anantavarman Co·agaØga, who was most probably áaiva. The cult of Purußottama (later known as Jagann§tha) was raised to the status of an imperial cult. Jagann§tha at PurÊ is mentioned by S§yana (c.1370), indicating its importance. See Dimock (1963:107); Dash (1978); Panigraha (1981:335–352); Upinder Singh (1993:249–259). 146 In January 1906, at the Allahabad Kumbh Mel§, the “aØkar§c§rya of PurÊ presided over the orthodox organisation, San§tana Dharma Mah§sabh§; at the inauguration of the All-India Hindu Sabh§ at Haridv§r, in 1915, the “aØkar§c§rya of PurÊ acted as one of the three “aØkar§c§rya vice-presidents; three “aØkar§c§ryas—of
142
chapter four
“aØkar§c§rya, he was involved in the Hindu Mah§sabh§, after 1923, and ran for presidentship in 1925/26. At the invitation of the Self Realisation Fellowship of Los Angeles, he toured the USA in 1958, becoming the first “aØkar§c§rya to tour outside India. Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha died in 1960, having not appointed a successor. The gaddÊ was vacant for four years, eventually being occupied by NirañjanadevatÊrtha, who became infamous as one of the instigators of the agitation against the government’s failure to implement a panIndian ban on cow-slaughter.147 Since the early twentieth century, the “aØkar§c§ryas of PurÊ, Dv§rak§ and Jyoáimaãh have been mutually supportive during various religious and political protests, their orthodox stance being supported by Hindu organisations such as the Hindu Mah§sabh§ and the Jan SaØgh (Lütt 1978:416–417).148
PurÊ, Dv§rak§ and “aØkeávara/KaravÊra—presided, at the Allahabad Kumbh Mel§ of 1918, over sessions of the All-India Hindu Sabh§ (later to become the Hindu Mah§sabh§) and the All-India San§tana Dharma Mah§sammelan; Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha was involved in the nationalist movement, having contacts with Aurobindo and Gokhale. He was arrested but acquitted in 1921 after involvement in the famous ‘Karachi case’, a consequence of the All-India Khilafat Conference held in Karachi in July 1921, when Maulana Muhammed Ali declared it unlawful for any faithful Muslim to serve in, or conscript for, the British army. As “aØkar§c§rya, he was extensively involved, between 1931 and 1933, in opposition to the Untouchability Abolition and Temple Entry Bills. After 1952, Bh§ratÊkÜßÖa spent more time in N§gpur, founding the Viáva Punarnirm§Öa SaØgha (World Reconstruction Association) there in 1953, and eventually settling there. 147 On November 6th, 1966, 200,000 people tried to storm parliament, resulting in eight deaths and many injuries. 750 people (including 500 saÒny§sÊ-s) were arrested. NirañjanadevatÊrtha undertook a 73-day fast in an unsuccessful attempt to change the decision of the government. In 1972, he formed an organisation against family planning, concerned that the proportion of Hindus in the population was decreasing. 148 In July 2000 a dispute erupted over the gaddÊ of PurÊ (Banerjee 2000:34). Sv§mÊ Adhokßaj§nanda, from Banaras, arrived in PurÊ, claiming that he was the real “aØkar§c§rya, having been ordained by the previous §c§rya of PurÊ, Sv§mÊ NirañjanadevatÊrtha. However, he was arrested and expelled from the town, with widespread support from local dignitaries for the incumbent, Sv§mÊ Niácal§nandasarasvatÊ. The case is not straightforward, as the incumbent’s appointment—finally in 1995—had been surrounded by controversy and had taken several years, an appointment to the gaddÊ needing the recognition of the state’s endowment commissioner. One of the objections raised against Niácal§nandasarasvatÊ’s appointment was that a “aØkar§c§rya of PurÊ should be a TÊrtha, and not a SarasvatÊ. In the context of this particular dispute, it is perhaps interesting to note that according to the Maãh§mn§ya-s— used many times in court in legal and jurisdiction disputes by “aØkar§c§ryas of the four main maãha-s—TÊrthas should belong to the Dv§rak§ pÊãha, and SarasvatÊs to the “ÜØgerÊ pÊãha.
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 143 4.4.5 The northern pÊãha Little information is available about the Jyotir maãha in the north, for which Antarkar was supplied with a list of 82 §c§rya-s in 1987 by the then §c§rya.149 Miára (Amiã K§lrekh§, 2001:102–106), an affiliate of the Dv§rak§ pÊãha, maintains that the Jyotir pÊãha was vacant from 1776 to 1941 (165 years),150 during which time the gaddÊ was removed to Dholka, where it was occupied by a continuous line of “aØkar§c§ryas during the interval. (It will be recalled that the Dholka gaddÊ was the object of a considerable legal dispute.) Pande (1994:29) observes that the tradition of the Jyotir maãha is incomplete and shows interruption in the succession. Of the earliest period, twenty-one names are recounted in verses contained in an Appendix to a manuscript of the Mantra-rahasya.151 There is also a list of twenty-one names for the period between 1479 and 1776,152 then there is a gap until the twentieth century. In 1851/2 there was an earthquake in the area which destroyed the maãha (Mason 1994:17). During the early part of the twentieth century there were several court cases when various people laid claim to be the “aØkar§c§rya of the Jyotir maãha (Sundaresan 2000:1). However, on May 11th 1941, Brahm§nandasarasvatÊ was installed as pontiff, with the approval of the “aØkar§c§ryas of “ÜØgerÊ and PurÊ, and support from Karpatri of Banaras and the Mah§r§ja of Darbh§Øga. 153 His appointment was, however, surrounded by controversy, as was the appointment—after his demise in 1953—of his successor, “§nt§nandasarasvatÊ, who had a rival, KÜßÖabodh§árama. Both were appointed “aØkar§c§rya by the rival factions, resulting in court proceedings, decided in favour of “§nt§nanda, who was subsequently succeeded by VißÖudev§nandasarasvatÊ in 1981. However, the contro-
149 The current §c§rya frequently resides in Allahabad, where the Jyotir maãha has a p§ãhaá§l§. 150 According to some records, the Jyotir maãha ceased to function for nearly three centuries, but the current authorities of that institution admit a break of only 165 years (Cenkner 1983:111). 151 M§y§datt§ “§stri, JyotiápÊãha-paricaya, p. 16 (cited by Pande). 152 HarÊ KÜßÖa Ratåri, GaÜhv§l ka Itih§s, p. 55 (cited by Pande). 153 Brahm§nandasarasvatÊ’s reputation was enhanced through the influence of his former secretary and disciple, Mah§Üßi Maheá YogÊ, who, famously, became a guru to the Beatles, Marianne Faithful, Donovan, and other pop-stars from the nineteen-sixties. (For further details of the relationship between the Maharishi—as he became known—and Brahm§nanda, see Mason 1994:12–23.)
144
chapter four
versy lingered on concerning the rightful successor to the Jyotir pÊãha. In 1979 a meeting of the “aØkar§c§ryas of the four §mn§ya maãha-s took place at “ÜØgerÊ, the first ever such meeting. It was convened by the then “aØkar§c§rya of “ÜØgerÊ, “rÊ Abhinava Vidy§tÊrtha, but neither “§nt§nanda nor VißÖudev§nanda were invited. Another court case which began in 1999, at Allahabad, concerning the succession to the Jyotir maãha, was still running in 2000.154 4.4.6 The Sumeru pÊãha The Sumeru pÊãha of Banaras also has a claim to have been founded by “aØkara, as the northern pÊãha. Several of the publications of the Maãh§mn§ya-s155 include another (or extra) text (together with the other four §mn§ya-s and the Mah§nuá§sanam) that presents—with some minor differences—three more maãha-s and §mn§ya-s (see Appendix 2),156 the Sumeru being the fifth.157 The Sumeru §mn§ya is as follows (Mishra 2001:48–52, vv. 66–68):158 Maãha (Kail§sa kßetra) Orders (pad§ni) Deities
Sumeru-pÊãha Kail§sa Satya (Truth), Jñ§na (Knowledge) (m) Nirañjana (f) M§y§
154 For further details of the dispute concerning the gaddÊ, the claim exerted by sv§mÊ-s of three separate lineages, political influence, and the subsequent succession, see Daáan§mÊ Samprad§ya (1999); Sundaresan (2000); P. N. Miára [Amiã K§lrekh§] (2001). 155 Kunhan Raja (1933:49); “arma (1963:650–651); Up§dhy§y (1967:610–612); Miára (1996:48–49; 2001:16–52). (Miára’s text is currently being disseminated by the Dv§rak§ pÊãha.) 156 The “eߧmn§ya-s; called the “Residuary-Shruti Receptacles” (Mishra), and part of the Maãh§mn§yasetu (“arma). 157 The sixth §mn§ya (Mishra vv. 69–72) is said to be the Self (§tm§mn§ya), and param§tm§ is the ‘great’ maãha. The samprad§ya is sattvatoáa (‘goodness-pleasure’), and the pada (‘title’, ‘office’) is yoga. The kßetra is the ocean; the deites are (m) ParamahaÒsa and (f) M§nasÊ M§y§; the tÊrtha is TripuãÊ (?); the sentences of Ved§nta are the instruction; and the §c§rya is Cetan§hÜdaya (‘consciousness-heart’). The seventh §mn§ya is Nißkala. The maãha is Sahasr§rkadyuti (‘brilliance of a thousand suns’). The samprad§ya is sacchißya (‘the good student’) and the pada-s are “rÊ-guru and p§duk§-s (a mendicant’s ‘holy’ sandals). The kßetra is §nubhåti (‘realisation’), the deities are (m) Viávaråpa (‘multiform/universal/VißÖu’) and (f) Citáakti, and the §c§rya is Sadguru. The tÊrtha is hearing the true scriptures. 158 Further details are included in the text provided by Kunhan Raja (1933: 49)
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 145 TÊrtha Samprad§ya $c§rya
M§nasa (rovaraÒ) K§áÊ ^ávara
In a previous publication Miára (1996:12) claims that, although it is said that there are seven maãha-s, in fact “aØkara founded four of them. The existence of the Sumeru matÈa is explained as being an allegorical ‘heavenly’ maãha.159 Up§dhy§y (1967:610) similarly explains the fifth §mn§ya, Sumeru maãha, as an årdhv§mn§ya, stating that the last three §mn§ya-s have a corporeal form only as knowledge.160 However, the Sumeru maãha of Banaras still functions—claiming to have been founded by “aØkara in 827 CE—and maintains a list (up to 1958) of sixty mahant-s who have occupied the gaddÊ, the first being Mah§dev§nandatÊrtha.161 (Curiously, all the mahant-s but the last, from 1958, are named ‘TÊrtha’.) The maãha is in a district of Banaras named ‘Sumeru’, possibly indicating the antiquity of the maãha, and preserves a pair of wooden sandals (p§duk§), believed to have been used by “aØkara, hence its other name, the ‘P§duk§ Maãha’. It admits only daÖ·Ê-s of the SarasvatÊ order, and used to be patronised by the Mah§r§ja of Banaras.162 In the GuruvaÒáa-k§vya,
159
jaise ‘Sumeru maãh’ ko årdhv§mn§y kah§ gay§ hai (Miára 1996:12). unka áarÊr keval vijñ§n hÊ hai (Miára 1996:12). 161 Sinha and Saraswati (1978:261–262) relate that the maãha was supposedly founded as a branch of the “§rad§ pÊãha by Mah§dev§nandatÊrtha, who was a disciple of Padmap§d§c§rya, the latter being one of “aØkara’s four chief disciples. The fifty-eighth mahant, Nity§nandatÊrtha, although himself a vegetarian, apparently introduced left-handed Tantric practices, including goat sacrifice to K§lÊ, when he was on the gaddÊ between 1945 and 1950. $nandabodh§árama, who occupied the gaddÊ in 1958, banned women from residence in the maãha. From 1758, when the gaddÊ was occupied by Mah§dev§nandatÊrtha VI, all mahant-s have been of Bengali descent. Several buildings attached to the maãha were sold off by a drunkard, Viáeßvar§nandatÊrtha, the fifty-third mahant, and several bullock-cart loads of manuscripts were sold to Annie Besant. At the time of Sawyer’s (1993) research in Banaras, in 1988, the “aØkar§c§rya of the Sumeru maãha was Sv§mÊ “aØkar§nanda. This author visited the Sumeru maãha in February 2002. It was in a run-down condition with no resident s§dhu-s. I was informed by several of the caretakers that the current mahant was away somewhere. 162 There is a copper-plate inscription on the wall of the maãha, written in both Bengali and Devan§garÊ Sanskrit. It is dated 1290 áaka, and purports to record an in§m, on behalf of the local r§ja, for sustaining a temple there, said to have been founded by $di “aØkar§c§rya in the eighth century, and inaugurated to “rÊ Bhadrak§lÊ. The plate does not appear significantly weathered. A learned colleague of mine, a Bengali Sanskritist, was kind enough to inspect an imprint of the text 160
146
chapter four
written in 1740 (see below), it is stated (3.25) that “aØkara established five maãha-s, including one for himself at Banaras. At the Brahmendra maãha, at the “iv§laya gh§ã in Banaras, there is an inscription dated 1884 CE (V. S. 1941) revealing a guru-parampar§ of “aØkara (Anantanandendra Sarasvati 1968:379–380). This would seem to indicate that the Banaras maãha was of some considerable importance in the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries. Sinha and Saraswati (1978:60) relate that “some years ago”, Sv§mÊ Maheávar§nanda was designated “aØkar§c§rya of K§áÊ by the then “aØkar§c§rya of Jyoáimaãh at a ceremony at the $dh§-Kumbh at Pray§g. However, Sv§mÊ $nandabodh§árama, the mahant of the Sumeru maãha at the time of Sinha and Saraswati’s study (1967), did not recognise Sv§mÊ Maheávar§nanda as the “aØkar§c§rya, nor did Maheávar§nanda live at the Sumeru maãha. One of the most important recent pontiffs of the Sumeru maãha was Sv§mÊ Harihar§nandasarasvatÊ (commonly known as ‘Karpatri’), who died in 1982. He has been described as the most influential daÖ·Ê not only of Banaras but of all India (Sawyer 1993:170), directing the affairs of the Jyotir pÊãha even though he was not a “aØkar§c§rya. Our relatively brief excursion into the histories of various advaita maãha-s has shown that very little reliance, if any, can be placed on the parampar§-s of the maãha-s,163 or the information in the Maãh§mn§ya-s that “aØkara founded four maãha-s in four specific places, each pÊãha being associated with either two or three of the ten lineages: the status of various pÊãha-s was still being contested in the nineteenth century.
and concluded that the language and characters used in the inscription would most probably indicate a date of around the seventeenth century at the earliest for the composition of the text, which appears to have been falsely dated. 163 According to the guru-parampar§ of (TuØga) “ÜØgerÊ (see Aiyer and Sastri 1962:164–181), none of the first four §c§rya-s of the “ÜØgerÊ after “aØkara are named SarasvatÊ, Bh§ratÊ or PurÊ, as they should be according to the Maãh§mn§ya; §c§rya-s nos. 8 to 11, and nos. 35 and 36 are named TÊrtha (located at Dv§rak§ in the Maãh§mn§ya); and §c§rya-s nos. 5, 6 and 7 are Giris (located at Jyotir maãha in the Maãh§mn§ya). There are no PurÊs or SarasvatÊs in the list at all. In the Ku·alÊ list all the §c§rya-s are Bh§ratÊs. Of the seventy-nine §c§rya-s of Dv§rak§ (TÊrtha and $árama according to the Maãh§mn§ya), only six are TÊrtha, one is a SarasvatÊ (acc. “ÜØgerÊ), thirty-six are $árama, while the rest have other names. The 144 §c§rya-s of the Jagann§tha maãha should be called either Vana or AraÖya, according to the Maãh§mn§ya, yet none of them have that name. After the eighteenth, all but two are TÊrtha (located at Dv§rak§ in the Maãh§mn§ya) and the first seventeen have other names. (No guru-parampar§ is provided by Aiyer and Sastri for the Jyotir maãha.)
integration of various lineages: the maãh§mn§ya-s 147 The epigraphic evidence that has been examined indicates there that were advaita maãha-s in south India dating from the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries, notably TuØga-“ÜØgerÊ, Ku·alÊ-“ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊpuram. While the specific sectarian identity of the K§ñcÊ maãha referred to in early inscriptions is hard to determine, we will see in Chapter 6.5 that a “ÜØgerÊ maãha was not associated with the name of “aØkara at the time of its founding in the fourteenth century. Regarding the current main maãha-s in the north, at Dv§rak§, PurÊ and Jyoáimaãh, there appears to be no reliable epigraphic or other evidence that is much more than than a couple of hundred years old referring to these institutions.
148
chapter five
CHAPTER FIVE
“A‡KARA’S HAGIOGRAPHIES AND HIS RELIGIOUS ORIENTATION It was suggested in the previous chapter that the popular notion that “aØkara founded four maãha-s is highly improbable. In this chapter, the hagiographies of “aØkara will be surveyed for what they reveal concerning the founding of maãha-s and other legends central to the traditional life of “aØkara. “aØkara’s religious orientation will also be analysed, and it will be seen that “aØkara, despite being projected as an incarnation of “iva in the hagiographies, was almost certainly a vaißÖava, as were his immediate disciples. In the final section, the hagiographies of “aØkara will be returned to again. They provide further evidence of the improbability that “aØkara founded either maãha-s or an order of ascetics.
5.1 The hagiographies of “aØkara Two scholars in particular have made detailed studies of the hagiographies of “aØkara, namely Antarkar1 and Bader (2000).2 Around twenty Sanskrit hagiographies of “aØkara have so far been uncovered.3 Several hagiographical works have been composed since the late eighteenth century, on the basis of earlier works or tradition,4 but vernacular texts do not start appearing until the end
1
1960; 1961; 1972; 1997. See also Kuppuswami (1972:7–20); Pande (1994:1–39). 3 A few brief references and details of “aØkara’s life may also be found in the “iva-rahasya (9.16); Patañjali-carita (8), composed by R§mabhadra-DÊkßita, c.1700; M§rkaÖ·eya SaÒhit§ (72.7.10,11–18; 73.7.1–2); LiØga Pur§Öa (1.40.20–22); Kårma Pur§Öa (28.32.35); Saura Pur§Öa; and Padma Pur§Öa. Texts of these passages (the last two without references) are included in Pande (1994:36–38). Details of “aØkara’s life may be found in several other Pur§Öa-s (see Sankaranarayanan 1995a:5–14, who lists a total of 33 sources, including the hagiographies). 4 One of the better known of these is the “aØkara-digvijaya-s§ra of Sad§nanda, composed in the late eighteenth century. His son-in-law Dhanapatisåri composed the 4iÖ·ima, dated to 1824, a well-known commentary on the “DV. Another such work is the nineteenth-century “aØkara-mand§ra-saurabha, written by NÊlakaÖãha, for 2
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 149 of the nineteenth century. Bader examines eight of the hagiographies (some other texts, not examined, being largely derivative of one of the eight works considered):5 M§dhava’s “aØkara-dig-vijaya (“DV), Anant§nandagiri’s “aØkaravijaya (A“V),6 Cidvil§sa’s “aØkaravijayavil§sa (C“V), Vy§s§cala’s “aØkaravijaya (V“V), R§jacå·§maÖi-DÊkßita’s “aØkar§bhyudaya (R“A), Govindan§tha’s “aØkar§c§ryacarita (G“C), Tirumala-DÊkßita’s “aØkar§bhyudaya (T“A), and LakßmaÖa-“§strÊ’s GuruvaÒáa-k§vya (GVK).7 All texts are tentatively dated post-fourteenth century, the earliest being the A“V and the V“V,8 most probably followed by the C“V and T“A.9 Antarkar (1973:2) places the C“V
which Ungemach (1992) provides the text and (German) translation. 5 Bader (2000:342–350) also discusses two so-called ‘lost’ hagiographies of “aØkara, the Pr§cÊna-“aØkaravijaya (Pr“V)—attributed by some (see Pande 1994:7) to $nandagiri (or $nandajñ§nam)—and the BÜhat-SaØkaravijaya (BÜ“V) attributed to Citsukha. (According to one tradition, Citsukha—also called VißÖuáarman—was a direct disciple of “aØkara.) T. S. Narayana Sastry (1971 [1916]) was one of the first scholars to call attention to the ‘lost’ texts. Antarkar (1960; 2001:26) believes in the existence of the BÜ“V, yet has not succeded in seeing it, despite efforts over the last 35 years; nor has Pande (1994:9). According to two commentaries on the “DV—Acyåta’s Advaitar§jya-LakßmÊ (17.16.103), dated to 1798, and the 4iÖ·ima—the Pr“V was a source for the “DV. However, Bader (2000:342–350) believes the Pr“V to be a summary of the contents of A“V. $tmabodha ($tmabodhendra)’s Sußam§ (a commentary to the Guru-ratna-m§lik§ attributed to Sad§áivabrahmendra) also cites the Pr“V and the BÜ“V. According to the concluding stanzas, it was written in 1720 (Pande 1994:7; Antarkar 2001:38). However, it may be older still, as $tmabodha is dated from 1586 to 1638. No text of the BÜ“V is available, but for a single chapter published by Sastry and Kumaraswamy (1971:272–281). It contains astrological information and faulty Sanskrit that lead both Bader (2000:347 ff.) and Umesh (1981:179–182) to doubt its authenticity. Ungemach (1992:4) notes that material from the Pr“V and BÜ“V is cited in later texts, but also doubts that these two texts existed. 6 Antarkar (1961) demonstrates that this Anant§nandagiri cannot be identified as $nandagiri, the Ved§ntin, with whom he is sometimes identified. 7 There is a complex relationship between the texts: see the table comparing contents (Bader 2000:74–76). The texts fall essentially into two groups, comprising slightly different traditions (Bader 2000:242), Group A comprising the A“V, C“V and the GVK, and the other, Group B, comprising the V“V, R“A, G“C and “DV. The T“A stands somewhat alone. 8 Some believe the V“V to have been written by Mah§deva IV (Mah§devendrasarasvatÊ, also known as Vy§s§c§la), the 52nd §c§rya of K§ñcÊ, from 1498–1507 (Ungemach 1992:4; Pande 1994:20). 9 In the colophons of the T“A, Tirumala-DÊkßita says that he is devoted to Paramaáivendra. According to the guru-parampar§ of the K§ñcÊ maãha, the fifty-seventh §c§rya was Paramaáiva II (ParamaáivendrasarasvatÊ), who reigned from 1539 to 1586, and who was the guru of Sad§áivabrahmendra (Aiyer and Sastri 1962:131). If we accept the admittedly unreliable chronology of the guru-paraÒpar§-s, and if
150
chapter five
perhaps before the R“A (c.1630), and possibly before the T“A (16th cent.). Bader (2000:24) believes the R“A and G“C to have been written around 1650, while the GVK may be dated to 1740, and the “DV to between 1650 and 1798 (Sawai 1985; Bader 2000:53–62). The “aØkara-dig-vijaya (“DV/Madh§vÊya)10 of M§dhava11 is by far the most widely distributed of the hagiographies of “aØkara, the incumbent “aØkar§c§ryas of the “ÜØgerÊ and Dv§rak§/Jyotir maãha-s maintaining that this text is the most authoritative account of the §c§rya-’s life. Since the establishment of its widespread reputation, towards the end of the eighteenth century, subsequent writers largely restate its contents.12 According to the “DV, “aØkara had four direct disciples, whom he converted to his philosophy.13 There is a reference (10.71) to “aØkara’s setting up a temple at “ÜØgerÊ and initiating the worship of the devÊ “§rad§, and to his installing certain of his disciples in §árama-s, such as the one at ŒßyaáÜØga14 (“ÜØgerÊ) for ensuring the greatness of his creed (16.93). He also built a temple to devÊ at K§ñcÊpuram, inaugurating worship according to Vedic tradition (15.1–20).15 However, no mention is made anywhere in the text of their appointments to head the four maãha-s, nor is there
the Paramaáivendras are identical, then the T“A may be placed in the latter part of the sixteenth century. 10 For references in this section, see Vidy§raÖya (1915) for the Sanskrit text, and M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya (1986) for the English translation. 11 Even though the colophons at the conclusion of each of the sixteen chapters state that the text was written by M§dhava, the editor of the widely circulated Anand§árama edition of the “DV has changed not only the title of the work (to SaÒkßepa-“aØkara-jaya) but also the author’s name, to M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya. Besides Bader, several other scholars have presented evidence against the possibility of Vidy§raÖya’s authorship: see Sastry and Kumaraswamy (1971:229); Antarkar (1972:1–23); Sawai (1985:454–459). 12 There are two exceptions (Bader 2000:23): the $c§rya-digvijaya-campu, by VallÊsah§ya, and the BÜhat-“aØkaravijaya by Brahm§nandasarasvatÊ. The former text may be dated to the end of the nineteenth century, while the latter idiosyncratically diverges significantly from the other hagiographic works. 13 “aØkara’s first disciple was Padmap§da (Sanandana), whom he met in Banaras; followed by Hast§malaka, who became his disciple in MåkaÒbik§ (Kollår, Karnataka); Toãaka (Giri) became his next disciple, in SÜØgerÊ; lastly, Sureávara, who became his main disciple. 14 In Hindu mythology, ŒßyaáÜØga is (in most texts) a single-horned ascetic who is seduced by an enchantress on behalf of Indra, who fears the ascetic’s tapas (see Doniger O’Flaherty 1981a:42–54). 15 This was towards the beginning of his digvijaya according to the “DV, and at the end of the digvijaya according to the A“V (see below).
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 151 any mention of the founding of an order of ascetics, nor the term ‘Daáan§mÊ’. Given the relative lateness of this text, the absence of any reference to the founding of an order of ascetics or four maãha-s is indeed intriguing.
5.2 “aØkara’s life in the hagiographies “aØkara’s own works, previously discussed, provide very little information on the life of the §c§rya. We know from these that “aØkara became a saÒny§sÊ and that his guru was Govinda, but not much more. According to tradition, “aØkara was of the Nambådiri caste, an orthodox Brahman caste who are the only original Brahmans of Kerala, renowned for their maintenance of Vedic rites which are extinct elsewhere.16 Sureávara, in his V§rttika (6.22–23) on “aØkara’s Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya, tells us that his teacher was a “lordly ascetic who walked with a bamboo staff ” and that he was descended from the Üßi Atri, indicating that “aØkara was a Brahman (Alston 1980a, Vol. 1:44). In the Naißk§rmyasiddhi (4.44)17 Sureávara refers to “aØkara as a dravi·a, indicating “aØkara’s southern origins.18 However, it is interesting to note that in the works considered genuine, all “aØkara’s references to places are to those in the north, in the Ganges delta (Alston 1980a, Vol. 1:44). “aØkara also refers to the Himalayas,19 lending some support to the supposition that “aØkara wrote and taught in north India. Our only other source of information for the life of “aØkara is the hagiographies, which Bader (2000:72) considers it more appropriate to take as the creation of hagiographers rather than as any kind of historical record.
16 Mayeda (1992:7 fn. 7) notes that insofar as the Nambådiris adhered to any philosophical system at all, it was to the (Kum§rila) Bh§ããa school of Pårva MÊm§Òs§, which “aØkara attacked in his works (see below). It is suggested that advaita philosophy was adopted by the Nambådiris only after it had become popular in other parts of India. 17 See Grimes (1992). 18 This is also indicated by “aØkara’s practice of writing as performed through incisions into palm-leaf that were later filled with ink. This is the method utilised in south India, whereas in north India, ink was applied at the time of writing, often on birch-bark. 19 In the BSB (II.3.14; III.1.8. See “aØkar§c§rya 1993:468, 567) “aØkara refers to the melting of snow and hail. He refers to a blind man dreaming he has seen a Himalayan peak (BÜhad§raÖyaka Upanißad-bh§ßya IV.3.6. See “aØkar§c§rya 1965:605).
152
chapter five
Amongst the numerous incidents recorded in the various hagiographies, particular stories are common to all.20 However, since the “DV has become the most well-known of the hagiographies, particular incidents contained therein have become standard to the contemporary understanding of “aØkara’s life, even though they do not occur in the other hagiographies.21 All of “aØkara’s hagiographies agree in describing the tapas undertaken in order to have a child by a pious but childless Brahman couple, “ivaguru and his wife, usually referred to by the respectful epithet $rya or $ry§mb§. In all texts but one, “aØkara is born in K§laãi,22 a village in the Ernakulam district of Kerala.23 “aØkara is initiated into an advaita lineage by his guru, Govinda, that goes back, ultimately, to Vy§sa and “iva.24 His mission is to restore the true teachings of Ved§nta, to 20 See Bader (2000:77–99). Ungemach (1992:11–24) also discusses several of the motifs, similarities, and parallels between events in hagiographies of “aØkara and events in: the R§m§yaÖa; legends of the Buddha (in the Buddhacarita, J§taka tales, and other sources); the Basava Pur§Öa (containing stories of Basava, the twelfthcentury founder of the LiØgayat/VÊraáaiva sect); the Kalpasåtra (containing stories of Mah§vÊra); the LÊϧcaritra (an anecdotal biography of Cakradhar, founder of the Maharashtran Mah§nubh§va sect, written between 1272 and 1278); and stories—particularly relating to “aØkara’s entry into the body of king Amaruka—pertaining to the semi-legendary founders of the N§th order, Matysendran§th and Gorakhn§th (c.12th/13th century), found in, for example, the Gorakßa-siddh§nta-saÒgraha. One of the hagiographies of Madhva (see below), the 13th century MaÖimañjarÊ, describes several specific events found in the hagiographies of “aØkara, such as “aØkara’s meeting with MaÖ·anamiára, and “aØkara’s burning of his mother’s body after her death. 21 One prominent example is when “aØkara avoids an outcaste in Banaras who is “iva in disguise, an incident which only occurs in the “DV and the T“A. 22 In the Calcutta edition of the A“V “aØkara is born in Chidambaram, Tamil Nadu, a place more commonly associated with the birth of Patañjali, the author of the Yogasåtra, who is an embodiment of the primal serpent, $diáeßa (see DÊkßhitar 1965:5.2–5.8). 23 The description of “aØkara’s birth uses stock images of k§vya literature, as found in Aávaghoßa’s Buddhacarita and K§lid§sa’s RaghuvaÒáa (Bader 2000:80). When “aØkara was five, “ivaguru was about to perform “aØkara’s upanayana, but died; his mother perfomed the rite. Against the wishes of his mother, “aØkara wanted to leave home and renounce. While bathing in the river, “aØkara is seized by a crocodile. Brahmanical tradition permits renunciation in the event of a life-threatening calamity (§pat-saÒny§sa), and “aØkara, in the jaws of death, asks his mother permission to renounce, which she, of course, grants, miraculously saving him. 24 Govinda’s teacher is Gau·ap§da, the author of the earliest specifically advaita commentary available, the Gau·ap§dÊya-k§rik§ (King 1995:15). In the hagiographies, Gau·ap§da is also linked with another lineage, descending from Patañjali. Although current tradition, taken from the “DV, locates Govinda by the Narmad§ river, only three texts agree on this, and do not specify the place.
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 153 which end he is to write his commentary on the Brahmasåtra, which is approved by Vy§sa, who grants him an extension of sixteen years on his life, which was originally destined to finish when he was but sixteen years old.25 Perhaps the most fundamental theme of “aØkara’s life story is that he is an avat§ra of “iva,26 the concept of avat§ra being common in the traditional biographies of both kings and saints in India. The avat§ra, Buddha or TÊrthaØkara is the divine descendant, sent to earth to rescue people from heresy, encroaching decadence and chaos, and to reestablish cosmic order.27 “aØkara moves freely from the human to the divine plane, experiencing human suffering—notably as a child—and is involved in numerous rational debates, yet he is divinely incarnated and can perform miracles in time and space. The incarnations of “iva generally reflect the ambivalent and often frightening qualities of “iva, in contrast to some of the more benign incarnations of VißÖu. One important exception is the incarnation of “iva as L§kulÊáa, the preceptor of the P§áupata order who probably lived in the second century (Chakraborty 1970:8–12),28 and who may possibly have partially inspired “aØkara’s hagiographers: like “aØkara, L§kulÊáa also had four pupils, named Kuáika, Garga, Mitra and Kauruáya. The concept of divine presence—and also, by
“aØkara’s life-span is omitted in the C“V (Bader 2000:85 fn. 25). Sawai (1987) also summarises “aØkara’s purpose of incarnation, as told in the “DV: to halt the conduct of “evil” people, establish Vedic dharma, and to guide people to salvation. The áaiva mythological frame of the hagiographies of “aØkara draws on themes found in the Pur§Öa-s. In the A“V, C“V and GVK, it is N§rada who is alarmed by the Brahmans’ neglect of their duties, their rampant heresies, and the decline of Vedic sects. To save the world from chaos, “iva agrees to incarnate as “aØkara, the son of a pious Brahman woman. In the T“A, “DV and GVK, the story begins with “iva himself, who is approached for help by the deva-s. In the T“A and “DV, not only “iva incarnates (as “aØkara), but Brahm§ becomes MaÖ·anamiára, SarasvatÊ his wife, Kum§ra is born as Kum§rila-Bhaããa (§c§rya), N§r§yaÖa as Padmap§da, and V§yu as both Hast§malaka and Toãaka. 27 See Granoff (1984; 1988a; 1988b) and Snell (1994) for excellent studies of the transmission and common motifs in Indian hagiographies. See Schober (1997) for articles on the importance of the hagiography of Buddha for the Buddhist tradition. Even in the earliest stratum of Buddhist texts, the biography of the Buddha is inherent in the teachings transmitted (Reynolds 1997:19–39). 28 The Mathur§ pillar inscription of Candragupta II (of Gupta year 61, regnal year 5, =380 CE) mentions a áaiva guru who was tenth in succession from Kuáika. This provides an approximate date for L§kulÊáa, who is identified with “iva in the inscription, an identification probably made not much earlier (Stietencron 2001:34 fn. 21). 25
26
154
chapter five
implication, divine grace—being inherent in outstanding religious leaders was first articulated in the Gupta period. The first historical evidence for an identification of a historical person with a deity—even though such an identification may have been made previously—was that made (posthumously) between L§kulÊáa and “iva29 (Stietencron 2001:22). It is evident that many of the motifs central to Indian hagiography may also be found in other religious contexts. Heffernan’s remarks concerning Christian saints and their biographies in the Middle Ages are appropriate—in a parallel way—to saintly saÒny§sÊ-s: that paradigmatic action dominates narrative structure; and that for actions narrated in the lives of the saints to be binding for the community, they had to be imitatio Christi. Gregory of Tours (538/9–593/4), one of the most influential early mediaeval sacred hagiographers, believed that the saint, unlike the rest of mankind, lived simultaneously in two worlds, the heavenly and the earthly (Heffernan 1988:6–10). “Sacred biography, although it exalts the individual, does so only having made perfectly clear that the exaltation is the result of Providence. There are no genuinely autonomous acts of heroism in this genre; all actions, whether good or evil, are contingent acts” (Heffernan 1988:64). Such remarks are quite apposite to the saÒny§sÊ-s being discussed. A central motif of the hagiographies is “aØkara’s all-India tour of victory, his digvijaya establishing his supremacy over all rival views.30 Throughout his journey he is victorious over all rival sects
29 Lorenzen (1983), focusing primarily on the “DV, has indicated several parallels between the lives of “aØkara and KÜßÖa, the earliest Indian god to be given a real hagiology. Details of KÜßÖa’s life, particularly the birth and infancy, amply fit the ‘standard saga’ of the hero as elaborated by the psychoanalyst Otto Rank in 1914. Two significant differences between the life-story of “aØkara and KÜßÖa are the lack of conflict with a father figure, such as KaÒsa, and the absence of abandonment and adoption by other, more humble parents, such as Nanda and Yaáod§. Lorenzen has pointed to the tension in the hagiographies between “aØkara, the lone áaiva saÒny§sÊ renunciate, and the householder vaißÖava tradition represented by his mother, a staunch vaißÖava, a tension most famously explored in Dumont’s (1960) structural analysis of Indian society, referred to in the Introduction. Bader (2000:128) acknowledges the tension in the hagiographies between householder and saÒny§sÊ but disagrees with Lorenzen’s (1983:164) supposition of a vaißÖava component in the narrative, implied in a comparison of the childhoods of “aØkara and KÜßÖa; the hagiographies of “aØkara are distinctly áaiva in orientation. 30 This features in five of the hagiographies (Bader 2000:141–182), the most
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 155 and views—the very existence of which indicates the decline of the Vedic tradition—and reestablishes the correct understanding of the sacred texts. Although the hagiographies differ considerably over the places visited,31 the end of the debates, and the final event of significance before he dies,32 signals “aØkara’s ascension to the Throne of Omniscience.33 “aØkar§c§rya also features in the partly mythological—and not
extensive account being contained in the A“V, which is associated with the K§ñcÊ maãha, and is particularly áaiva in orientation. The A“V provides the largest number of identifiable places that “aØkara visited, including many pilgrimage places, thirteen places being identified as venues for debates with sectarian foes. However, the “DV provides the largest number of places visited, being complied from several sources. “aØkara visits a total of twenty-eight places, scattered throughout India. 31 In all seven sources: BadarÊ, Pray§ga, K§ñcÊ, R§meávaram. In six: Maghada, GokarÖa, K§laãi. In five: K§ámÊra, K§áÊ, Cidambara, “rÊvali/“ivavih§ra. In four: “rÊáaila, “ÜØgerÊ, Tirupati, Anantaáayana (Bader 2000:143). 32 The place of “aØkara’s final disappearance, as recorded in the vijaya-s, has been examined by Antarkar (1997), who inspected seventeen works. Amongst the hagiographies that state the place of “aØkara’s demise (not all do so), the locations are: 1) VÜߧcala (Trichår) in Kerala (two works, G“C, and Kåßm§Ö·a “aØkara-vijaya of Purußottamabh§ratÊ); 2) K§ñcÊ (four works: A“V, BÜ“V, R“A, (and presumably) $c§rya-digvijaya-campå of VallÊ-Sah§ya; and also in the Sußam§); 3) Himalayas, in either Ked§ran§tha or Kail§sa—and in two accounts via a cave/hermitage of Datt§treya, which could be at M§hårÊ in Maharashtra (see Bader 2000:158)—(seven works: “DV, C“V, GVK, “aØkara-digvijaya-sara of Sad§nanda, Bhagavat-p§d§bhyudaya of Kavi LakßmaÖa Såri, and “aØkara-mand§ra-saurabha and “aØkara-daya, both by NÊlakaÖãha). Kedarn§th has become the most widely accepted of the places mentioned, owing to the popularity of the “DV. However, Antarkar favours K§ñcÊ, though this is rejected by those who deny the authenticity of the K§ñcÊ pÊãha. The iconographic evidence from K§ñcÊ (statues of saÒny§sÊ-s) is relatively modern, and really provides no substantive evidence at all on this issue. Local traditions locate the place of “aØkara’s death at K§ñcÊ, Ked§rn§th, “rÊnagar (Kashmir), VÜߧcala and Nirm§l§ (near Bassein, close to Bombay), all of which contain either shrines or sam§dhi-s for $di-“aØkara. Gadgil (1895:295) visited the sam§dhi of “aØkara at Nirm§l§ but concludes that the festival there, celebrated around the 13th of the bright half of K§rtika, is for a ‘second’ “aØkara. In our current state of knowledge, the question of where “aØkara may have died is still open. 33 Six of the hagiographies describe “aØkara’s final ascension to the seat of omniscience (sarvajña-pÊãha), while in four of the hagiographies his enthronement is the climax of the narrative: see Bader (2000:96, 177–179). There are various challenges before he ascends, the final one being from SarasvatÊ (MaÖ·anamiára’s wife), who (in some versions) questions him as to whether he can be pure, having enjoyed women. In all the hagiographies “aØkara takes the body of king Amaruka to make love, to gain knowledge of all á§stra-s, including k§ma-á§stra: see Bader (2000:169–182). “aØkara passes the test, and disappears to his abode on mount Kail§sa. This episode may be modelled on a similar story pertaining to Gorakhn§th and Matsyendran§th (see Ungemach 1992:22).
156
chapter five
always entirely consistent—Chronicles (VaÒá§valÊ ) of Nepal, according to which34 he was born to an immaculate Brahman woman in the Deccan during the time of the Nepalese SåryabaÒáÊ dynasty. Having been defeated by Bauddham§rgÊs in religious debate in six former incarnations, “aØkara went to Nepal to pursue the sixteen remaining learned Bodhisattvas who had fled there in fear of him.35 In Nepal, “aØkar§c§rya found that the four Hindu castes were all Buddhists of one kind or another. The only clever Buddhists he could find invoked SarasvatÊ to help them in debate, but “aØkara dismissed the goddess and defeated them. “aØkara forced some bhikßu-s to marry, prohibited many Buddhist ceremonies, cut the Buddhists’ Brahmanical thread, made them shave their top-knots and perform animal sacrifices—contrary to their religion—in order to drive them out of the region. Some Buddhists who refused to accept defeat were put to death, all 84,000 of the extant Buddhist religious texts in Nepal were destroyed, and áaiva religion was introduced. Although “aØkara had vanquished the Buddhist religion in Nepal, but for a few remaining Bauddham§rgÊs, he was obliged to leave some Buddhist priests in temples, as no one else was competent to propitiate the gods. “aØkara then returned to the seaside in the south. In the hagiographies, the digvijaya-s depict “aØkara as a universal conquerer, frequently referring to him as “the king of ascetics”.36 His quasi-military conquest of the four quarters, and subsequent ascent to the Throne of Omniscience, are evidently modelled on the royal digvijaya (‘conquest of the quarters’) undertaken by kings of the early mediaeval period,37 the philosophical and sometimes dangerous battles with sectarian opponents mirroring the earlier royal submission of feudatory regents. This is a theme also to be found in epic/historic
34
See Wright (1877:118–123); Hasrat (1970:38–40). In these accounts, “aØkara is also said to have brought the Pañca-Gau·a and Pañca-Dravi·a Brahmans to Nepal and to have divided the Nepalese people into sixty-four castes (Wright 1877:185–186; Petech 1958:181–183). 36 The role of the ‘big-man’ (periyar, periyavatar) in south Indian culture has been examined by Mines and Gourishankar (1990), who illustrate the several parallels between kings, sect-leading renunciates (notably the “aØkar§c§rya of K§ñcÊ), and other community leaders who act as sponsors for worship (as yajam§na-s) and exhibit altruistic behaviour in the giving of charity. 37 See Inden (1990:240–260) for a study of the R§ßãrakåãas’ performance of the digvijaya. 35
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 157 (itih§sapur§Öa), literature.38 It has been suggested (Sax 2000) that the demise of the royal digvijaya—due in large part to the dominance of northern Islamic regimes—led to the production of religious digvijaya-s, modelled on the royal performance. It is also possible that the early digvijaya-s of “aØkara were modelled on the already extant digvijaya-s of the vaißÖava dualist, Madhva (1238–1317)39 from U·upi, as it is probable that one of the earliest hagiographies of “aØkara, $nantagiri’s “aØkaravijaya, post-dates Madhva.40 In Madhva’s hagiographies, during his digvijaya (similarly to “aØkara), Madhva goes first to “ÜØgerÊ, and also goes to BadarÊkar§árama, establishing holy places and fending off threats from Muslims (Sax 2000:48). “aØkara’s final ascent of the Throne of Omniscience has a direct parallel in the ancient r§jasåya rite, the royal consecration cere-
38 In this category of literature, Bader (2000:170) notes Ratn§kara’s (9th cent.) Haravijaya, the story of “iva’s defeat of the demon Andhaka; V§sudeva’s (9th cent.) Yudhißãhiravijaya, a retelling of the main events of the Mah§bh§rata; and the (12th. cent.) PÜthvÊr§javijaya, dealing with the war and triumph of PÜthvÊr§ja III (which may have directly influenced the V“V, G“C, GVK and “DV). A digvijaya also features prominently in K§lid§sa’s RaghuvaÒáa. 39 MaÖimañjarÊ and Sumadhvavijaya, both by N§r§yaÖapaÖ·ita, the son of TrivikramapaÖ·ita, who was a direct disciple of Madhva. 40 Besides the hagiographies of “aØkara and Madhva, Sax (2000) also discusses the digvijaya-s of Vallabha (1479–1531) and Caitanya (1486–1533). Madhva took saÒny§sa from Acyutaprekßa, either at the age of nine or eleven/twelve (see Glasenapp 1992:4), and wrote a treatise on renunciation (see Olivelle 1982). “rÊ Caitanya KÜßÖa was given his name by Keáva Bh§ratÊ, a Daáan§mÊ, from whom he took saÒny§sa in 1510. The initiation seems to have been largely a formality (he did not add Bh§ratÊ to his name); Caitanya was far more influenced by ^ávara PurÊ of the Madhva sect, whom he had met previously in Gay§ in 1508, and who initiated him into the Daá§kßara KÜßÖa mantra, after which he became an ecstatic devotee of KÜßÖa (Kapoor 1994:20–25). Vallabha, besides his other works, wrote a treatise on renunciation, the SaÒny§sanirÖaya, which, according to tradition, was written in BadarÊn§th. He took saÒny§sa one month before his death, aged fifty-one. However, his doctrine of renunciation “is tinged by a palpable disinclination for the subject” (Smith 1993:136–137), his view being that the lÊl§-s of the world can be known without it; bhakti is contrasted with saÒny§sa (see Horstmann 1997:229–231; Bhatt 1980). Sax states that “It is possible—perhaps even likely—that “aØkara’s hagiographers, all of whom wrote after the time of Madhva, were in fact emulating historical accounts of actual journeys by the [other] VaißÖavas”. Madhva attacks “aØkara’s reputation, portraying him as an incarnation of the demon MaÖimat, born to a widow (Bader 2000:37), and the digvijaya-s of “aØkara may, in part, have been responding to those accounts. However, Vallabha and Caitanya both lived after the time the time of the production of the earlier hagiographies of “aØkara. Rather, it seems more probable that later vaißÖava hagiographies were based on the earlier hagiographies of “aØkara and Madhva.
158
chapter five
mony for a kßatriya king, which is one of the three large-scale árauta rites, the others being the aávamedha and the v§japeya. Heesterman’s (1957:222–224) study of the r§jasåya illustrated that it was not a ceremony performed once and for all, but is of the character of a yearly festival (utsava), whereby the powers active in the universe are regenerated. The king’s unction is preceded by a year long dÊkߧ, and dÊkߧ-like observances. Technically, the consecration rite is reserved for kßatriya-s; and “aØkara is a Brahman, who, having renounced, is beyond ritual action. Yet four specific elements of the r§jasåya are reflected in the narrative: the preparatory initiation (dÊkߧ, received from Govinda); the establishment/conquest of the four quarters (digvy§sth§pana);41 the chariot drive42 (also performed by the “aØkar§c§ryas); and the enthronement.43 In the r§jasåya the king has a particular association with the tiger, upon whose skin he receives the unction,44 prior to the dÊkߧ. Similarly, the gaddÊ-s of the “aØkar§c§rya-s are covered with a tiger skin. It is during the chariot drive that the king engages in a ritual battle with another kßatriya, at whom he shoots his arrows, declaring, “the purpose has been fulfilled”.45 The parallel in the hagiographies is the verbal battle with the wealthy ritualist MaÖ·anamiára,46 who is presented to “aØkara by his uncle and teacher, Kum§rila-Bhaããa (the foremost authority of his time—seventh century—in the Vedic MÊm§Òs§ tradition), who self-immolated after meeting “aØkara.47 41 See Heesterman (1957:103–105) for how the royal sacrificer mounts the “quarters of space”, taking one step in each of the four directions, and a fifth towards the centre, which is above. 42 Ibid. (pp. 127–139). 43 Ibid. (pp. 140–142). 44 Ibid. (p. 106). 45 Ibid. (p. 129). 46 Identified in four of the hagiographies as Viávaråpa. See Ch. 4.4, fn. 84 of this book for the identity of Viávaråpa/Sureávara/MaÖ·anamiára. 47 Kum§rila, the ritualist, is portrayed as the man responsible for the defeat of Buddhism and the restablishment of the Vedic path. To gain inside knowledge of Buddhism, and to defeat them in subsequent debate, he disguised himself as a Buddhist. Realising that he has committed a sin, Kum§rila immolates himself on a fire; when “aØkara arrives, the fire is already alight. (This incident is depicted on a plaque near the saØgam at Pray§g.) “aØkara does not debate with Kum§rila, who expresses admiration for “aØkara’s commentary on the Brahmasåtra but declines to write a sub-commentary on it, assigning the task to a disciple. Both “aØkara and Kum§rila are projected as saviours of orthodoxy in popular tradition; to wit the customary definition of sm§rta: vyavah§re bh§ããaÈ param§rthe áaØkaraÈ (Halbfass 1983:101 fn. 21).
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 159 The fulfilment of the r§jasåya is the enthronement of the king, which is accompanied by a game of dice. The king ascends the throne, which is considered to be his birthplace, and is proclaimed brahman by each of the four priests who sit around him at the four quarters.48 In the “DV, the most widely known hagiography, those defeated in debates during the digvijaya are described in the fifteenth chapter.49 A substantial part of the digvijaya is devoted to the conquest of áaivas of various types, the K§p§likas being the most horrendous, while the only vaißÖava opponents are described as wearing the emblems of VißÖu, and as recognising five differences.50 The philosophical doctrine (p§ñc-bheda) appears to be that of Madhva.51 The vaißÖava-s are dealt with in but three verses, which is significant. “aØkara’s lack of engagement with any vaißÖava opponents, of which there were many in “aØkara’s time, and throughout the period of the composition of the hagiographies, is curious indeed. A possible explanation is that “aØkara’s hagiographers wished to project him as a áaiva (for reasons that will become apparent in the following chapter) who defeated only radical áaiva-s and tantrika-s, yet did not want to offend vaißÖava-s, who underpinned the early Ved§nta tradition.
5.3 “aØkara’s religious orientation Having considered “aØkara’s life in the hagiographies as an incarnation of “iva, in this section “aØkara’s religious orientation will 48
Heesterman (1957:140–160). First, the liquor drinking “§ktas, in R§meávaram (vv. 1–3). He then worships Lord R§ma (R§man§tha) and proceeds to K§ñcÊ where he builds a temple to DevÊ, inaugurating Vedic worship and eradicating every trace of Tantric worship (vv. 4–5). He continues to Andhra, where he worships VeØkaãan§tha (VißÖu), followed by a battle with the áaiva K§p§lika, Krakaca, and his followers in KarÖata (vv. 8–12). He then defeats the áaiva dualist, NÊlakaÖãha, and his disciple, Haradatta, in GokarÖa (vv. 29–72); vaißÖava-s in Dv§rak§ (vv. 73–75); the bhed§bheda ved§ntin, Bhaããa Bh§skara, in Ujjain (vv. 76–140); some Jainas among the Bahlikas or Bactrians (vv. 141–155); a “§kta named Abhinavagupta, in K§maråpa (most probably confused with the famous Kashmiri Tantric); and finally some unidentifiable philosophers in Bengal (vv. 161–162). 50 Between God and jÊva, between jÊva and jÊva, between jÊva and insentient objects, between God and sentient objects, and between insentient objects themselves 51 Lorenzen (1983:163) identifies these opponents as P§ñcar§trins. However, this is not stated in the “DV. Moreover, while the P§ñcar§trins maintain a five-fold manifestation of N§r§yaÖa—in his para, vyåha, vibhava, ant§ryamin and arca forms—(see Bhatt 1968:3), they do not adhere to the doctrine described in the “DV. 49
160
chapter five
be analysed, particularly considering the evidence from “aØkara’s own works. The indications are that he was a vaißÖava with a religious background that was most probably P§ñcar§tra,52 a ritual and philosophical system that also significantly informed the religious background of both R§m§nuja and Madhva, two other important early Ved§ntins. It is known that the P§ñcar§trins produced a vast number of texts, their Tantra-s (or $gama-s) dating from the fifth century.53 Their influence on some aspects of the Brahmanical tradition has perhaps been heretofore somewhat underestimated.54 The attitude of both “aØkara and the “rÊ-VaißÖavas to the P§ñcar§trins is ambivalent. On the one hand, a long array of “rÊvaißÖavas and later P§ñcar§trins have attempted to disprove the charge of heterodoxy made against the P§ñcar§trins. On the other hand, while most of the P§nc§r§trin authors regard P§ñcar§tra as being in conformity with the Veda, they also regard the Veda as either the shoots or the roots of P§ñcar§tra (Bhatt 1968:12). “aØkara’s opposition to the vaißÖava Bh§gavatas (P§ñcar§trins) is known from his remarks in the Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya (2.2.42). As P§ñcar§tra claims to be based on an independent, extra-Vedic revelation, it would have been illegitimate and unacceptable from “aØkara’s perspective. However, P§ñcar§tra gets off lightly. His principal objection to P§ñcar§tra does not concern their shared common Ultimate, N§r§yaÖa, but concerns an aspect of P§ñcar§tra metaphysical doctrine;55 the contention being that an individual soul (called SaÒkarßana) said to be created from the supreme Self (called V§sudeva) will be impermanent, as it is created. “aØkara does not accept this, a component of the P§ñcar§tra doctrine of vyåha-s (emanations). However, he agrees with the P§ñcar§trins that N§r§yaÖa
52
While several scholars have concluded that the origin of the term p§ñcar§tra (lit. ‘night of the five’) is obscure, Neevel (1977:10) believes that the term probably refers to the dissolution of the five elements in mokßa. For P§ñcar§tra doctrine, see Schrader (1916). 53 Schrader (1916:14) estimates that the saÒhit§ literature of the P§ñcar§tras amounted to at least 1.5 million áloka-s. 54 See Inden (2000:29–98) for a penetrating analysis of the influence of P§ñcar§tra on ritual and royal polity in Kashmir in the 7th and 8th centuries. 55 “aØkara appears to have lived between the times of the composition of the earlier northern P§ñcar§tra saÒhit§-s and the later southern saÒhit§-s: see Schrader (1916:16–17).
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 161 is superior to Nature, and is well known to be the supreme Self and the Self of all, dividing Himself into many forms. “aØkara also endorses the Bh§gavatas’ ‘single-pointed’ (ek§ntin) devotion and temple visiting. “aØkara (BSB 2.2.42) gives five methods of worshipping the supreme lord, Bhagavat V§sudeva: (i) abhigamana, ritually going to the temple of the deity, with speech, body and mind centred on him; (ii) up§d§na, collecting materials needed for worship; (iii) ijy§, worship; (iv) sv§dhy§ya, the muttering of mantra; (v) yoga, meaning meditation. By worshipping the lord in these ways for a hundred years, the devotee reaches Bhagavat. Alston (1980a, Vol. 1:10–14) comments on “aØkara’s connection to the early P§ñcar§trins, pointing out “aØkara’s reference in the introduction to his GÊt§ commentary to two separate groups of mind-born “sons of Brahm§”,56 who were projected at the beginning of the world-period (kalpa). To them, the Lord, called N§r§yaÖa, communicated a practical knowledge of the two-fold Vedic wisdom. “aØkara also quotes frequently from the N§r§yaÖÊya section of the “§nti parvan of the Mah§bh§rata, which contains (XII.321.27–326.97) the earliest known account of the doctrines of the P§ñcar§trins (Neevel 1977:10); it is of a secret dialogue between N§r§yaÖa and N§rada. In the next section (XII.327ff.), Dvaip§yana praises P§ñcar§tra as the greatest Upanißad. “aØkara could have objected to the P§ñcar§trins on several grounds: the secondary status of the Veda in respect of their own texts; the predominance of Tantric elements and associated anti-Brahmanical rites and practices; image worship and the paramouncy of bhakti over mokßa; and the admission of women, áådra-s and foreigners within the Bh§gavata fold (see Batt 1963). However, “aØkara equates the Supreme of the Upanißad-s with N§r§yaÖa (BSB 2.2.42), which is the Supreme for the P§ñcar§tras. “aØkara only rejects one aspect of the vyåha doctrine of the P§ñcar§tras, and expressly approves a considerable part of their system, which is said to agree with his Ved§nta. According to Neevel’s analysis (1977:20), “aØkara’s rejection of P§ñcar§tra doctrine is only partial. “aØkara admits, in a general sense, that param§tma exists in a manifold way as vyåha-s (‘extensions’ of Himself), and that this concept has a Vedic basis (quoting Ch§ndogya Upanißad 7.26.2). “aØkara also says (BSB 2.2.42–44) that the entire
56
Also described in the N§r§yaÖÊya section of the MBh (XII.327).
162
chapter five
universe is a vyåha of the Lord, twice referring to a specific aspect of the P§ñcar§tra vyåha theory, the ßa·-guÖa-s.57 In his introduction to the BhagavadgÊt§, “aØkara refers to the ßa·-guÖa-s—in the same sequence used by P§ñcar§tra—in explaining how N§r§yaÖa has become the avat§ra KÜßÖa (Neevel 1977:20–23). These qualities are said to co-exist in equal fullness in V§sudeva (or N§r§yaÖa), the highest Godhead and vyåha (paravyåha). “aØkara does not object to the vyåha theory as such, but only the way that the theory is developed by the P§ñcar§trins. “aØkara is far more critical of the áaiva Maheávaras, K§p§likas and P§áupatas—and also of Ny§ya-Vaiáeßika, S§Òkhya, Yoga, Jainism and Buddhism,58 all of which he explicitly describes as heretical (veda-b§hya). Neevel argues that “aØkara placed P§ñcar§tra on a higher level than other systems, closest to Ved§nta. Objections to P§ñcar§tra did come from Pårva-MÊm§Òs§kas, who maintained that P§ñcar§tra was in conflict with the Veda-s, but not from the commentatorial tradition of Ved§nta, of which all known sources reveal a more or less positive attitude to P§ñcar§tra. An important exception is B§dar§yaÖa, who, in the Ved§ntasåtra-s (2.2.42–45, the so-called p§ñcar§tra section of the tarka-pada), raises objections to what the commentatorial tradition assumes to be P§ñcar§tra doctrines, even though P§ñcar§tra is not named. However, Neevel (1977:18–22) notes that “aØkara and Bh§skara (the earliest two commentators on the Ved§ntasåtra/Brahmasåtra) treat this såtra in only a cursory way; they could have levelled many objections to P§ñcar§tra, but refrain. Both Ved§nta and P§ñcar§tra emphasised knowledge over action, and laid stress on a continuity with the Upanißad-s, but P§ñcar§tra had developed an alternative and increasingly popular ritual tradition, which Neevel suggests may have threatened the livelihood and authority of sm§rta Brahmans, hence their opposition. If “aØkara really was a áaiva, as depicted in the hagiographies, then his attitude towards the vaißÖava Bh§gavatas and his recognition
57
The ‘six-qualities’ of P§ñcar§tra are: jñ§na, aiávarya, áakti, bala, vÊrya and
tejas. 58 (BSB 2.1.1–3; 2.2.4–6.) “SmÜtis are the scriptural texts called Tantra, written by the great seer (Kapila)”. It is not possible for Kapila and others to have attained perfection in their practice: “It is a false claim that liberation can be obtained through S§Òkhya knowledge or the path of Yoga independently of the Vedas”...Yoga “leads to the acquisition of extraordinary powers”, but not liberation (BSB 2.1.1).
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 163 of N§r§yaÖa as the highest Self in his main work, the Brahma-såtrabh§ßya, is indeed remarkable.59 Alston (1980a, Vol.1:10–14) observes that there is very little in “aØkara’s commentaries to connect him with “iva worship. He invokes N§r§yaÖa at the beginning of his GÊt§ commentary, who is said by $nandagiri—his sub-commentator—to be his chosen deity (ißãa-devat§), and in the commentary he refers several times to KÜßÖa as N§r§yaÖa, even though the name N§r§yaÖa does not appear in the text of the GÊt§. Hacker (1995:33–39) has also considered the issue of “aØkara’s religious orientation. Lorenzen (1983:160) believes Hacker’s arguments that “aØkara was most probably a vaißÖava to be not altogether convincing, but Hacker’s conclusions have yet to be refuted. Hacker observes that in the Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya (BSB), “aØkara’s definitive work, “iva is not mentioned. There is one passing mention (3.3.32), in a mythological reference, to Rudra, who generated Skanda. But this is no evidence for áaiva predilection;60 on the contrary, as áaiva-s prefer to refer to their ißãa-devat§ as “iva, and not Rudra, a name usually used by opponents. Earlier in the BSB (2.2.36–41), “aØkara refutes the doctrines of the áaiva-s (Maheávara-s), whose God is Paáupati. ‘“aØkara’ is a well-known name of “iva since ancient times, but concerning the notion that “aØkar§c§rya was a áaiva, or indeed an incarnation of “iva as projected in the hagiographies, in the Pañcap§dik§ (v. 3) Padmap§da61 bows to his teacher who had merely the name of “aØkara, whom he contrasts with the real “iva (whom he does not bow to). He states that “aØkara (his teacher) did not wear ashes smeared over his body like “iva and his ascetic devotees, nor does the “new “aØkara” have any of the marks or emblems of “iva. “aØkara’s use of imagery is also vaißÖava in style, and not áaiva. Three times in the BSB (1.2.7; 1.2.14; 1.3.14) the á§lagr§ma is referred to in the context of a metaphysical analogy. Four times (3.3.9; 4.1.3 twice; 4.1.5) an image is used of the superimposition of the spiritual vision
59
See also Hirst (1993:131–139), who presents a broad clutch of references from “aØkara’s own works, indicating both his vaißÖava orientation and his conception of the Lord and ‘Inner Controller’ as N§r§yaÖa. In the Gau·apak§rik§-bh§ßya (1.6–7), “aØkara seems to imply that that the founder of the advaita tradition is N§r§yaÖa, who is his non-dual self (see Hirst 1993:138). 60 The DakßiÖ§mårti-stotra (attributed to “aØkara), on which Sureávara wrote a V§rttika, the M§nasoll§sa, is áaiva in orientation, but both are of doubtful authenticity (see Potter 1981, Vol. 3:550–551). 61 See Padmap§da (1989:6).
164
chapter five
of VißÖu on idols (pratim§), as an instance of the superimposition of religious ideas on things. Hacker maintains that if “aØkara really was a áaiva, then the imagery would have more naturally employed the liØga instead. Similar vaißÖava imagery occurs throughout the commentaries on the Upanißad-s.62 Imaginary persons used by “aØkara in explanations are also frequently vaißÖava characters, with names such as Devadatta, Yajñadatta, VißÖumitra and KÜßÖagupta. In his commentary on Gau·ap§da’s M§Ö·åkya-k§rik§ (4.1), “aØkara equates Gau·ap§da’s SaÒbuddha (“§kyamuni, the Buddha) with N§r§yaÖa (the Purußottama), once again indicating “aØkara’s vaißÖava orientation. Also, In the BSB (3.4.20) “aØkara equates (third §árama) vanaprastha-s with vaikh§nasa-s, the latter being orthodox vaißÖava-s who have practically no associations with renunciation (see Colas 1992). Hacker (1995:36) observes that “aØkara deviates from custom, in that he does not—with the exception of the GÊt§ commentary—include the invocation to a deity (maØgal§carana or namask§ra) at the beginning and/or end of his works. Where he does include a maØgala, as for the M§Ö·åkya-bh§ßya and TaittirÊya Upanißad-bh§ßya, he invokes the neutral Brahman or $tman. This “aØkara explains in his commentary on the Kena Upanißad, where he says that “he who, having been led to Brahman, is consecrated to sovereignty, does not wish to bow to anyone”. The evidence discussed does not necessarily indicate that “aØkara was specifically vaißÖava, as his realisation took him beyond religious identification. It merely points to “aØkara’s probable religious background, which was evidently not áaiva. A further clue as to “aØkara’s religious orientation is provided by his attitude to Vin§yaka (GaÖapati/GaÖeáa). Commenting on a passage in the GÊt§ (9.25), “aØkara remarks there are four kinds of worshippers (each attaining their own respective goal): Devavrata-s (who attain the deva-s), PitÜvrata-s (who reach the realm of ancestors), Bhåtavrata-s (who attain the bhåta-s, ‘malevolent spirits’), and VißÖuvrata-s (the vaißÖava-s who worship ‘Me’, and reach ‘Me’).63 “aØkara mentions three sects of Bhåtavrata-s by name: the Vin§yaka, the M§tÜgaÖa and the CaturbhaginÊs (Nagaswamy 1996:237–238). GaÖeáa makes his first appearance in the Hindu pantheon around
62 TaittirÊya (1.6.1; 1.8.1); MuÖ·aka (2.1.4); Praána (5.2); BÜhad§raÖyaka (1.1.1; 5.1.1); Ch§ndogya (6.16.3; 7.1.4; 8.1.1). 63 See BhagavadgÊt§ (tr. van Buitenen 1981:107).
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 165 the fifth century (Courtright 2001:7), and by the sixth century Vin§yaka is well established as a classical deity within the Hindu pantheon in both north and south Indian temple worship (Nagaswamy 1996:239). He is also established mythologically, certainly by the seventh century, as the T¿v§ram hymns of Appar and Campantar refer to GaÖapati as the son of the God “iva (Peterson 1991:101), and a number of hymns were composed to him. Yet it is apparent that “aØkara regarded the worship of GaÖeáa as the lowest form of worship, that of malevolent spirits (bhåta). The horrifying nature of GaÖeáa, leader of the attendants (bhåta-s) of “iva, is described in a chapter of the Y§jñavalkya SmÜti entitled Mah§gaÖapatikalpa. “iva is said to have created him for the specific purpose of impeding those performing ritual sacrifices (Nagaswamy 1996:239). Within the development of áaiva worship, GaÖeáa had became integrated within the orthodox áaiva tradition by the time of “aØkara, so his attitude to those who worship Ganeáa as bhåtavrata-s seems to be yet another clear indication of his non-áaiva religious inheritance. The second group of bhåta worshippers that “aØkara mentions are those who worship the M§tÜgaÖa (which represents the Saptam§tÜs),64 while the third group of bhåta worshippers mentioned by “aØkara are those who worship the ‘four sisters’ (caturbhaginÊ-s).65 It is evident from “aØkara’s commentaries that the worship of Durg§, Bhadrak§lÊ, Vin§yaka, the Saptam§tÜs, r§kßasa-s, piá§ca-s and the sixty-four yoginÊ-s is considered the lowest grade of worship. “aØkara’s classification of the catuÈßaßãiyoginÊ worship with the lowest form of worship of bhåta-s, preta-s and piá§ca-s, would provide further evidence against “aØkara’s authorship of the Tantric stotra-s and commentaries attributed to him.
64 These are usually Br§hmÊ, MaheávarÊ, KaumarÊ, V§r§hÊ, Indr§ÖÊ and C§muÖ·a. This gaÖa also includes GaÖeáa at the beginning and VÊrabhadra (or VÊn§dhara “iva) at the end. The worship of the seven women is ancient, possibly being represented on Mohenjo-d§ro seals (Ramachandra Rao 1992, Pratima-Kosha, Vol. 6:246), and certainly found from the first century CE onwards. It is known that from the seventh century their worship in Tamil Nadu involved the sacrifice of goats or fowl, and was performed by non-Brahman priests. 65 In an intriguing analysis of the term caturbhaginÊ used in the GÊt§-bh§ßya, Nagaswami (1996:242–244) argues, from the evidence of commentators on the passage containing the term, that the original term used was catuÈßaßãiyoginÊ, referring to sixty-four yoginÊ-s (associated primarily with Tantric worship), and not caturbhaginÊ. There was a close relationship between the sixty-four yoginÊ-s, Tantric Kaulas, and the P§áupatas.
166
chapter five
“aØkara’s two most important meetings, in the context of the hagiographies, are with MaÖ·anamiára and Kum§rila, the great debate (lasting between six and a hundred days) being between “aØkara and MaÖ·anamiára.66 The winner must convert to the lifestyle of the other. The arbiter is MaÖ·anamiára’s wife (Sarasav§ÖÊ/ Bh§ratÊ/Ubhaya-Bh§ratÊ/SarasvatÊ), who decides that “aØkara has won. MaÖ·anamiára is then initiated as a saÒny§sÊ and becomes a disciple of “aØkara. Hacker (1995:38–39) suggests that the reason behind the traditional emphasis on the rivalry between “aØkara and MaÖ·anamiára—two great orthodox Brahman monists, between whom there were only minor philosophical differences—was that “aØkara was most probably a vaißÖava, while MaÖ·anamiára seems to have been a áaiva, as at the end of his Brahmasiddhi he calls the state of liberation paramaáivabh§va.67 Hacker surmises that a few centuries later, when concrete differences between the two schools had been forgotten, V§caspatimiára successfully meged the two systems into one. From then on, MaÖ·ana’s doctrines survived as the so-called V§caspati (bh§matÊ ) sub-school of advaita-Ved§nta. However, it is apparent that Kum§rila was also a áaiva, as the maØgal§caraÖa at the beginning of his “lokav§rttika is an explicit eulogy to “iva.68 The evidence fits a hypothesis being presented that the hagiographers could not have sucessfully presented “aØkara as an orthodox Brahman áaiva monist, engaged in an intense rivalry with other orthodox Brahman áaiva-s. MaÖ·anamiára’s and Kum§rila’s áaiva orientation had to be omitted, as in the hagiographies “aØkara is also a áaiva. Although “aØkara’s religious background is not entirely certain, his advaita philosophical position, entailing a doctrine of m§y§, would not be inconsistent with a vaißÖava heritage. The Param§rtha-s§ra (ascribed to $diáeßa) and the VißÖu Pur§Öa are vaißÖava devotional works that espouse both a form of advaita and a doctrine of illusion, m§y§ (Alston 1980a, Vol. 1:36–37). Both texts slightly predate69 “aØkara, and
66
Portrayed as cordial and respectful in one set of texts, while in the other set there is an antagonism with the shaven-headed saÒny§sÊ (Bader 2000:88–89, 185). 67 See Kuppuswami Sastri (1937:300, section P.159.9). 68 See Kum§rila (1993:3, l. 1), who bows to “he whose body is pure consciousness, whose divine eyes are the three Vedas, who causes attainment of the highest, and who wears the cresent moon”; viáuddhajñ§nadeh§ya trivedÊdivyacakßuße áreyaÈpr§ptinimitt§ya namaÈ som§rdhadh§riÖe. 69 Hacker (1995:39) dates the Param§rtha-s§ra to before the sixth century, while Hazra (1940:22) dates the VißÖu Pur§Öa to not later than the seventh century.
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 167 although he does not comment on these texts directly, there is no reason to suppose, as some of his critics have, that because “aØkara on occasion employed Buddhist concepts, his philosophical doctrines were necessarily or substantially inherited from a Buddhist milieu,70 such as that of Gau·ap§da. If there is any conclusion to be drawn concerning “aØkara’s religious background, it may be that he is best described as a refomed P§ñcar§trin or Bh§gavata, “aØkara-Bhagavat or “aØkara-Bhagavatp§da indeed being one of the names he uses to describe himself. This is but a surmise. However, a P§ñcar§tra (and orthodox Vedic) background is also evident in the two other important Brahmanical renunciate orders that developed in south India around the beginning of the second millennium: the “rÊ-VaißÖava order of R§m§nuja, and the order of Madhva. Nevertheless, these Ved§ntins’ specific relationship to P§ñcar§tra remains uncertain, as a fundamental principle of P§ñcar§tra is that, for participation in the cult, an initiation ceremony is required, to be performed by an §c§rya, a maãh§dhipati or a guru (Gnanambal 1977:108).71 We will first address R§m§nuja’s connection to P§ñcar§tra. According to the KoÊl Ol..ugu (the somewhat historically unreliable “rÊraØgam temple chronicle), it is said that N§thamuni, Y§munamuni and R§m§nuja (the three most important §c§rya-s in the early development of “rÊ-VaißÖavism)72 took saÒny§sa from the householder state, but by the consent of Lord Varadar§ja of K§ñcÊpuram, rather than at the feet of another saÒny§sÊ, as was traditional (Lester 1992:91–92). Neevel (1977:37) believes that Y§muna’s family, and that of his grandfather N§thamuni, were of a class of Bh§gavatas, known as áißãa Bh§gavatas, who performed both Vedic and P§ñcar§tra prac-
70 For a useful summary of “aØkara’s relationship to Buddhist philosophy, see Mayeda (2000). 71 This initiation is based on five sacraments, known as pañc-saÒsk§r (or cakraØkana), the pañc-saÒsk§r initiation also being fundamental to the first stage of initiation into the Daáan§mÊs. For details of the pañc-saÒsk§r initiation into “rÊ-VaißÖavism, see Gnanambal (1977:183–186). A yellow string is tied around the wrist, the body is branded with symbols, and the candidate receives a new name and mantra. 72 N§thamuni was born shortly after 907; Y§muna (his grandson, the fourth §c§rya) most probably flourished between 1022–1038; R§m§nuja’s dates were probably moved back by several decades, to 1017–1137, to enable R§m§nuja (the sixth §c§rya) to receive Y§muna’s blessings (see Neevel 1977:14–16). According to tradition, Y§muna is R§m§nuja’s teacher’s teacher (param§c§rya).
168
chapter five
tices, installing images, prostrating and circumambulating temples.73 Y§muna makes every effort to distinguish P§ñcar§tra from other non-Vedic traditions, defending it from attacks from the two major schools of Pårva MÊm§Òs§, the Bhaããa (Kum§rila), and Prabh§kara. Halbfass (1983:92) comments that Y§muna’s $gamapr§m§Öya (c.1000) is an exemplary statement concerning the authority of the so-called P§ñcar§tra. Y§muna also presents a long and elaborate refutation of the charge that B§dar§yaÖa rejected P§ñcar§tra. (It was previously mentioned that “aØkara was also uncomfortable with B§dar§yaÖa’s apparent rejection of P§ñcar§tra.) One of Y§muna’s distinctive contributions was to deny that there were any general conflicts between Veda (or áruti) and P§ñcar§tra (Neevel 1977:24). Y§muna’s works reveal many influences, including, directly, the bhakti of the $l..v§rs, tangentially Islam, but more importantly, P§ñcar§tra. Neevel (1977:193) contends that by the time of R§m§nuja, a division of labour had taken place, in which “rÊ-VaißÖava viáißã§dvaita philosophy had hived off the philosophical activity of the P§ñcar§tras, leaving their ritual activity to take a separate course.74 However, according to tradition (the KoÊl Ol..ugu) R§m§nuja was also a P§ñcar§trin ritually, opening the temple to full participation by áådra-s, called s§ttada VaißÖavas (‘those with no thread’) (Stein 1999:233; Hopkins 2002:34).75 73 For details of P§ñcar§tra eight-fold daily observances, see Czerniak-Droídíowicz (2002); for the worshipper’s visualisation and installation of the deity, see Rastelli (2002). 74 Lipner (1986:5) refers to Neevel’s study, but contends that R§m§nuja, while recognising the authority of P§ñcar§tra, does not explicitly identify his position with their views. However, according to tradition, after fleeing from “rÊraØgam to avoid persecution, R§m§nuja settled at MeÏkote, directed the restoration of the Tirun§r§yaÖa-sv§mÊ temple, and renewed his saÒny§sa on the stone marking the renunciation of the great sage Datt§treya (also the tutelary deity of the Jån§ akh§Ü§) who is listed as the twenty-fifth pr§durbhava (or vibhava) within a list of thirty-eight descents contained in the S§ttvata SaÒhit§ (9.77–84)—copied almost verbatim in the Ahirbudhnya SaÒhit§ (5.50ff.), an important P§ñcar§tra text—one of the earliest sources within the P§ñcar§tra tradition (Rigopoulos 1998:43). A continuity within the “rÊ-VaißÖava tradition with respect to Datt§treya is still evident. On January 31st 1971, the dying pontiff of the Yadugiri Yatir§ja Maãha at MeÏkote officially bestowed the title to the gaddÊ of the maãha to a successor, in a ceremony performed at the Datt§treya temple. On the initiation day for the successor, the tridaÖ·a was handed over, and the kaá§ya (ochre-coloured) robe was placed at the feet of Datt§treya (Gnanambal 1977:140). 75 In two of his hagiographies, the R§m§nuja-divya-carit§i and the Prapann§mÜta of Anant§c§rya, it is said that R§m§nuja visited Jagann§tha at PurÊ and attempted, with the support of the king, to reform the worship in the temple and the lives of the priests, by introducing P§ñcar§tra rites. The incumbent (‘degraded’) priests resisted,
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 169 Lester (1992:95) maintains that although guru-parampar§ texts and temple chronicles place the “rÊ-VaißÖava practice of renunciation on a Vedic foundation, inscriptions and other evidence suggest otherwise, that saÒny§sÊ-s and JÊyar maãha-s, at least to begin with, were mostly inspired by non-Vedic traditions of renunciation, those of the S§ttada/S§ttvata ek§Øgin/ek§ntin Bh§gavatas, in other words, P§ñcar§tra.76 Madhva (1238–1317), a sm§rta vaißÖava, was another important figure in the early development of Ved§nta. He also fully accepted the P§ñcar§tra (Zydenbos 2001:113, 116), and wrote a short text, SaÒny§sa-paddhati, on rules for renunciates.77 It is apparent that “aØkara was a vaißÖava who seems to have been significantly informed by P§ñcar§tra—as were R§m§nuja and Madhva—yet “aØkara’s hagiographers project him as an ‘orthodox’ (Vedic) áaiva. In the following chapter, it is proposed that “aØkara’s early hagiographies projected him as a áaiva in the image of their Vijayanagara patrons who, beginning in the mid-fourteenth century, patronised what was essentially a ‘reformed’, ‘orthodox’ áaiva tradition that included advaita áaiva maãha-s and Vedic scholarship. In the following section we will see that the writers of the earlier hagiographies do not clearly mention either “aØkara’s founding of a renunciate order
and R§m§nuja was magically removed by Lord Jagann§tha to “rÊ Kårmam, a áaiva temple in Andhra Pradesh. The incident is also briefly mentioned in the temple chronicle, M§daϧ PañjÊ (Dash 1978:159–160). Lord Jagann§tha and Balabhadra wear the “rÊ-VaißÖava tilak on their foreheads. 76 By title, there are three types of renunciates in contemporary “rÊ-VaißÖavism: jÊyar, §Ö·avan and ek§Øgin. The jÊyar-s and §Ö·avan-s are former Brahman householders who have become saÒny§sÊ-s; ek§Øgin-s are important in the historical development of “rÊ-VaißÖavism, but are unrecognised these days in works on or of “rÊ-VaißÖavas. With the exception of the ek§Øgin Brahmans at Tirupati, ek§Øgin-s came to be regarded generally as low-caste, even though they at one time enjoyed great power and prestige in vaißÖava temples. Ek§Ögin may be equated with the ek§ntin Bh§gavatas, and while “rÊraØgam Brahman authorities state that ek§Øgin designates a non-twiceborn renunciate, it is unclear from the “rÊraØgam chronicles whether the ek§Ögin is Brahman or non-Brahman. However, a mid-fifteenth century inscription in the Tirumalai-Tirupati temple contains the earliest reference to S§ttada “rÊ-VaißÖavas, who are identified as persons living a life of renunciation (either as ek§kin or ek§Øgin), and as disciples of Kand§·ai R§m§nuja Ayyangar, who refers to himself as parama ek§Øgin, a title suspiciously close to that used by the P§ñcar§tra VaißÖavas. Kand§·ai R§m§nuja Ayyangar’s teacher was Kand§·a AÖÖan of “rÊraØgam, who was known as s§ttada parama ekaØgin, s§ttada most probably being a corruption of s§ttvata, designating the Bh§gavata/P§ñcar§tra vaißÖava tradition, reflected in the title of its earliest text (Lester 1992:85–86). 77 See Olivelle (1982) for a translation and commentary.
170
chapter five
or the institution of maãha-s, traditions which seem to have arisen well after the founding of the first advaita maãha-s. Most of “aØkara’s hagiographies include the inauguration of a devÊ shrine at “ÜØgerÊ,78 and non-Tantric devÊ worship at K§ñcÊ. DevÊ worship is apparent in the hagiographies of “aØkara, but in a non-Tantric, Vedic (sm§rta) form: radical áaiva opponents are defeated. The hagiographical tradition of devÊ worship is embodied in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, but we also find there deities such as Bhadrak§lÊ (=Durg§), the tutelary deity of the “§rad§ pÊãha. However, we have seen that worship of deities such as Bhadrak§lÊ seems to have been considered by “aØkara as of the lowest order of worship. It is proposed that the Maãh§mn§ya-s represent the final stage of a process whereby radical ‘Tantric’ n§g§ áaiva ascetics were integrated with a monastic order of ‘reformed’ áaiva-s, into the Daáan§mÊs. 5.4 PÊãha-s, maãha-s, and the installation of disciples in the hagiographies The paucity of references in the hagiographies to the founding of maãha-s and the establishing of an ascetic order is striking,79 the most obvious explanation being that, during the period that they were composed, the “aØkara maãha-s did not have the prominence they now enjoy. There also appears to be no inscriptional evidence connecting “aØkara with any maãha-s prior to 1652, indicating that the idea of his founding monastic centres was not widespread before that time.80 The hagiographies indicate that the notion that “aØkara founded a sect may not have been prevalent for another century. The earliest hagiography to mention the founding of a maãha is
78 SarasvatÊ is installed at “ÜØgerÊ in five of the hagiographies: A“V, C“V, T“A, “DV, GVK (Bader 2000:75). 79 The “DV has already been discussed, while the V“V, G“C, R“A (Group B) and T“A make no mention of succession, nor of the founding of monastic centres. Ungemach (1992:27) also remarks that the legend of “aØkara founding four maãha-s under four disciples is not stated in any hagiography. 80 The first inscription that specifically identifies “aØkara as the founder of a maãha appears to be one dated 1652. It records a grant to the “ÜØgerÊ “dharma-pÊãha” established by “aØkar§c§rya, for the worship of the gods Mallik§rjuna, Vidy§áaØkarasv§mÊ and “§rada-amma; Epigraphia Carnatica, Vol. VI, “ÜØgerÊ J§gÊr, no. 11 (see Kane HD“, Vol. 2, part 2:907; Bader 2000:241 fn. 28).
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 171 the “aØkaravijaya of Anant§nandagiri (sec. 61–62).81 After installing the devÊ SarasvatÊ in “ÜØgerÊ, “aØkara is said to have founded a maãha there and established the Bh§ratÊ samprad§ya. He placed Padmap§da82 in charge. “aØkara then proceeds to K§ñcÊpuram (sec. 63), instigates the construction of two towns in the vicinity, consecrates a temple to the devÊ K§m§kßÊ, and installs a árÊ-cakra. He establishes a lineage of disciples, which would last until the end of the eon, in various cities, the first of which was the seat of learning (vidy§pÊãha) at K§ñcÊ (sec. 67). No other maãha is specifically mentioned in this text, which is the one recognised by the proponents of the K§ñcÊ maãha as the most authoritative biography of “aØkara. Besides the A“V, which only mentions maãha-s and worship at K§ñcÊ and “ÜØgerÊ, only two hagiographers, Cidvil§sa (C“V) and LakßmaÖa-“§strÊ (GVK), mention the founding of four maãha-s.83
81 References are to the Madras edition of the A“V, edited by Veezhinathan (see Anant§nanda Giri 1971). 82 Sureávara, according to the Calcutta edition of this text, which also only mentions the establishing of a lineage of disciples in “ÜØgerÊ, and does not mention any maãha founded at any other place (Bader 2000:235). This discrepancy between the two editions of the A“V has been one of the contentious points fuelling the ongoing controversy concerning the legitimacy of the K§ñcÊ pÊãha, discussed previously. Another point of contention is that the Madras—but not the Calcutta—edition of the A“V also mentions “aØkara’s receipt from “iva of five crystal liØga-s (A“V sec. 55, 66, 74), three of which were established by himself at Ked§ra (mukti-liØga), NÊlakaÖãha (near Kathmandu) (vara-liØga), and “ÜØgerÊ (bhoga-liØga). The fourth (yogaliØga) and fifth (mokßa-liØga) were given to Sureávara, the former to be worshipped by him, and the latter to be sent to Cidambaram. 83 See also Ungemach (1992:27). However, despite the fact that there is no mention at all in the “DV of the founding of four maãha-s, the tradition of “aØkara founding four maãha-s (in the four quarters of India) is so prevalent that one may even find this myth perpetuated in recent scholarship. Malinar (2001:93) states that “The philosopher “aØkara is claimed as the founder of the monastic institutions (maãha) of the Daáan§mÊ orders and of the Advaita samprad§ya. This position is elaborated and continuously re-created in numerous hagiographies.” This assertion is apparently incorrect. Further, Malinar focuses almost solely on the “DV, which contains no mention of the founding of either Daáan§mÊ orders or four (or any) maãha-s. Similarly, Isayeva (1993:81) maintains, incorrectly, that “Most of the biographers are of the opinion that the main monasteries, which were founded by “aØkara...were established in the following order: Dv§rak§, BadarÊn§tha, PurÊ, “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊ”, and that (p. 88) “The hagiographies enumerate ten Hindu monasteries founded by “aØkara, as well as ten monastic orders of sanny§sins”. Isayeva (1993:82, fn.10) also maintains, but with no supporting evidence, that each of the ‘ten names’ corresponds to one particular monastery, and that “to five other monasteries were assigned the monastic orders of TÊrtha, PurÊ, VaÖa, Parvata and S§gara”.
172
chapter five
Jagann§th and Dv§rak§ figure in the digvijaya of “aØkara in only three hagiographies, and the popular tradition of dispatching disciples to the four quarters appears also in only the C“V and GVK (Bader 2000:160–161). We have noted that Antarkar tentatively fixes the date of the C“V around the sixteenth century, though acknowledging that fixing a date for this text is difficult.84 The GVK is known to have been composed at the behest of an incumbent of the “aØkara maãha at “ÜØgerÊ, Sv§mÊ Saccid§nandabh§ratÊ (on the gaddÊ from 1705–1741),85 and records the traditions of the time (c.1735–1740).86 The founding of the monastic centres follows the account of Cidvil§sa (C“V), who appears to have been the first hagiographer to mention four maãha-s. Cidvil§sa extols “ÜØgerÊ (C“V 24.31–33a),87 where the first maãha (called “rÊ maãha) is established by “aØkara, who installs Sureávara in that seat of learning. “aØkara is then said to establish other maãha-s: near the Jagann§tha temple in the east (presided over by Padmap§da); in the “western quarter” (where he installed Hast§malaka); and “in the northern quarter he had a heavenly maãha built” (where he installed Toãaka) (C“V 30.10–31.29). While there are specific references in the text to “ÜØgerÊ and Jagann§th, and though the GomatÊ (river) is mentioned by name as a tÊrtha (C“V 30.4) in connection with the western quarter, there is no mention in the text of either Dv§rak§ or BadarÊ(n§tha) as the place of the founding of a maãha. In the GVK, besides the specific references to the “ÜØgerÊ and Jagann§tha maãha-s—also found in C“V—there are specific references (3.59–62) to the maãha-s at Dv§rak§ and BadarÊ.88 The appointment of dis-
84 Antarkar (1973:2) supplies several references—five to kings—from the C“V that may at some time help to establish more precisely its date. Antarkar has not been able to deduce any dates from these references: 1. Bhadrasena of Rudr§khyanagar, near Pray§g (ch. 16); 2. VÊrasena, near the bank of the TuØgabhadr§ river, “ÜØgerÊ maãha (ch. 24); 3. R§jasena, king of of K§ñcÊ (ch. 25); 4. Bhojasingh, king of Cidambar (chs. 26 and 27); 5. Ratnasingh, king of BadarÊ (ch. 31); 6. R§mar§ja of Anantaáayana (ch. 28). Bader (2000:38–40) largely corroborates Antarkar’s findings, but concerning an earliest date for the C“V, he notes (p. 197) that some sections of the C“V featuring debates between MaÖ·anamiára and “aØkara appear to have been lifted from the P§r§áara-m§dhavÊya (1340–1360). 85 Miára ($miã K§lrekh§ 2001:25). 86 This is the first text giving a guru-paraÒpar§ for the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. 87 All references to the C“V are to the text edited by Antarkar (1973). See also Bader (2000:237–238). 88 Antarkar (2001:22) observes that another vijaya of “aØkara, the Bhagavat-
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 173 ciples also follows the C“V.89 However, there is no unanimity in the hagiographies as a whole concerning the identity of “aØkara’s leading disciples.90 The only hagiographies to mention the founding of maãha-s, the A“V, C“V and GVK, mention “ÜØgerÊ as the place of the founding of the first maãha. However, according to all the Maãh§mn§ya-s, Dv§rak§ is the first of the four maãha-s to have been founded,91 a tradition that is clearly different from that embodied in the hagiographies. Given that the GVK is relatively late (c.1740), the only other source of the tradition of the founding of four maãha-s amongst any of the earlier hagiographies of “aØkara is the C“V, which, as we have seen, is partially incomplete, and which may be assigned to the sixteenth century.
5.5 The first references to the ‘ten names’ Amongst the eight hagiographies of “aØkara scrutinised by Bader, the only one to mention the establishing of ten lineages is the C“V (24.36–37a).92 This is said to occur while “aØkara is residing at “ÜØgerÊ, but no more information is supplied. The only other hagi-
p§d§bhyudaya, mentions, besides the four places in connection with the founding of maãha-s, also K§ñcÊ, but that this text post-dates the GVK. 89 Regarding our previous discussion of the Sumeru maãha at Banaras: the GVK (3.23) also refers to “aØkara contemplating five maãha-s when he was in Banaras, four for his disciples and one for himself. However, after this fleeting reference, no more is said of the fifth maãha (Antarkar 2001:23). 90 See Bader (2000:98). The A“V does not mention Toãaka, who is usually counted, along with Sureávara, Padmap§da and Hast§malaka, as one of the four chief disciples. In five of the hagiographies, “aØkara’s first disciple is Sad§nanda, who gains another name, Padmap§da, from walking across water, lotus blossoms appearing under his feet from his intense devotion. In the T“A, however, the two are treated as two separate individuals. In the A“V, Padmap§da occupies a prominent place, but Sad§nanda walking on water is not mentioned, nor is there any other story about the disciples. 91 The Maãh§mn§ya-setu states that the “§rad§ pÊãha (at Dv§rak§) is the “first §mn§ya maãha”: prathamaÈ paácim§mn§yaÈ á§rad§maãha ucyate (Maãh§mn§ya-setu line 1): Miára (1996:33); Mishra (2001:1); Up§dhyay (1967:601); “arma (1963:648). The Maãh§mn§ya-stotra (of “ÜØgerÊ) simply mentions Dv§rak§ first in the §mn§ya-s of the maãha-s: “In the western quarter the kßetra is Dv§rak§ (and) the maãha is K§lik§” (digbh§ge paácime kßetraÒ dv§rak§ k§lik§ maãhaÈ). 92 samprad§y§n daáaivait§n áißyeßv§racaya svataÈ / tÊrth§árama-van§raÖya-giri-parvatas§gar§È // sarasvatÊ bh§ratÊ ca purÊtyete daáaiva hi / (Antarkar edition, 1973:73).
174
chapter five
ography to refer to a lineage is the A“V, which (we have already noted) refers to the establishing of but one samprad§ya, the Bh§ratÊ (A“V sec. 62). Curiously, the GVK, which follows the C“V on the establishing of maãha-s, like all the other hagiographies makes no mention of the ten names.93 There is nothing in any of the hagiographies to connect maãha-s with the Daáan§mÊ lineages, such as we find in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, nor do the published guru-parampar§-s accord with what little information is supplied by the hagiographies. It is apparent that the traditions of the guru-parampar§-s for the maãha-s were independent from the sources for the traditions that are constituted in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, and from the sources that led to the hagiographies of “aØkara. I have so far found no reference in any text to the ten names before the sixteenth century, excluding the possibility that the C“V may possibly be earlier than that. The only early texts that I have been able to discover that refer to the ten names both utilise the same phrase utilised by Cidvil§sa, and were written between the sixteenth and eighteenth centuries. A reference to the ten names may be found in the Yatidharmaprak§áa of V§sudev§árama (66.14–15),94 dated to between 1675 and 1800 (Olivelle 1976:18). In this passage V§sudev§árama is citing an earlier work, the YatidharmasaÒgraha of ViáveávarasarasvatÊ (pp. 102–103).95 ViáveávarasarasvatÊ was the teacher of the illustrious advaita philosopher, MadhusådanasarasvatÊ (1540–1647), who is the person believed by some to have authorised the acceptance of n§g§ lineages within the Daáan§mÊ order.96 Given Viáveávara’s relationship 93 Michaels (2004:126) also notes that a connection between “aØkara and the Daáan§mÊs appears to have been made after the 15th/16th centuries, as there is no mention of this in the earlier hagiographies. 94 Discussing the procedure of conferring the meditation shawl (yogapaããa)—which means initiation into saÒny§sa—V§sudev§árama explains (66.3–4) that the the cloth is held over the pupil, who, with the guru, other pupils and relatives, recites the chapter of the BhagavadgÊt§ called Viávaråpa, up to the words “...enjoy a prosperous kingdom”. (Note that here also a vaißÖava text is recited.) “Then the guru should give him a name that is approved by all. TÊrtha, $árama, Vana, AraÖya, Giri, Parvata, S§gara, SarasvatÊ and PurÊ are the ten names (given to) renouncers. His name should be uttered appropriately with the titles árÊ and p§da. From today onward you should always perform the initiation, the explanation (of texts) and the like, and also confer the meditation shawl on one who has been examined well” (66.13–18); ed. and trans. by Olivelle [1976, Part 1:99; 1977, Part 2:187]). 95 =Viáveávarapaddhati, published by the $nand§árama of PåÖe in 1909; see Olivelle (1977, Part 2:25) 96 See Chapter 7.1.
áaØkara’s hagiographies and his religious orientation 175 to Madhusådana, we may assign the YatidharmasaÒgraha of Viáveávara to around the end of the sixteenth century. Another early reference to the ten names occurs in the V§r§Ö of Bh§Ê Gurd§s (1551–1637), a disciple of the fourth Sikh guru, Guru R§m D§s, and scribe of the Guru Granth Sahib in the period of the fifth guru, Guru Arjun Dev. The V§r§Ö may be dated to the first quarter of the seventeenth century (Jodh Singh 1998, Vol.1:1–5). It states (V§r 8, pau·Ê 13 [varÖa]): “Many are yogeávars (great yogis) and many are sannyasis. Sannyasis are of ten names97 and yogis have been divided into twelve sects”.98 It seems that Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs were also established in Nepal by the middle of the seventeenth century. A copper-plate inscription of 1635/6 from the Jagann§th temple in Hanum§n 4hoka palace square in Kathmandu99 employs the phrase daáan§ma sany§sÊ referring to several individuals with the surnames ‘Giri’, ‘PurÊ’ and ‘Bh§ratÊ’.100 That the notion of saÒny§sÊ-s with ten names was established by the seventeenth century101 may be gleaned from a report in the Dabist§n, composed in 1645, where it is reported (Dabist§n, 1843, Vol. 2:139) that the saÒny§sÊ-s are of ten names.102 Our chronicler accurately describes, perhaps for the first time, the division of the saÒny§sÊ-s into the two main branches of the Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs, the monastic and n§g§. It is suggested that perhaps a century or so before this report, the ten names—comprising two branches—became established: to my knowledge, there is no earlier reference.103 In the
97
SaÖni§sÊ das n§m dhari. Trans Jodh Singh (1998, Vol. 1:214). 99 See Vajr§c§rya (1976:198, no. 10). 100 Day§la Bh§ratÊ, Renuk§ BharatÊ, R§ma Giri, Nirañjana PurÊ, B§la Giri, “aØkaran§th Gad§dhara Giri, Bhagav§n Bh§ratÊ, Purna Giri, Ayodhy§ Giri, Kula Giri, Purußottama Giri. 101 Kane (HD“, Vol. 1, part 2:815) notes a reference to the ten names in the SmÜtimukt§phala of Vaidyan§tha-DÊkßita, a text he dates to c.1700. 102 “...Ban, A’ran, TÊrthah, A’shram, Kar (Giri?), Parbatah, S§kar, Bh§rthy, PerÊ and SarsatÊ. They are said to follow the dictates of Dat§teri [Datt§treya], and to be of two classes: “Dandaheri”, who do not have long hair and are attached to the precepts and regulations of the smriti; and the “Avadhåtas” who drink ashes, wear the “zunar” and “juta” [jaãa, ‘dreadlocks’]. Other sany§sis rubbing bhabåt [vibhåti] into the body remain twelve years standing up on one leg... Some of this class of men (are) of consideration and opulence and are escorted by files of elephants; they have carriages, fine apparel, courtiers, servants on foot and horseback.” 103 It is claimed (see Michaels 1994:117ff.) that an (unnamed) saÒny§sÊ follower of a “aØkar§c§rya came from the $maradaka Agnimaãha at K§áÊ and Pray§ga to 98
176
chapter five
next chapter the establishing of orthodox áaiva advaita maãha-s will be discussed, and how “aØkara may have been projected onto the monastic tradition. Nepal twice in the twelfth century, taught yoga and tantra vidy§ there, founded two temples, initiated $nandadeva (son of king “ivadevamalla) and others, and had the Paáupatin§th temple renovated. This claim is based primarily on a Sanskrit inscription, said to be dated to 1142 (V.S. 1199, Nev§rÊ SaÒvat 262), which is on a slab of stone now lying in the grounds of the Government Museum in Kathmandu. The text of the inscription is reprinted by both Regmi (1966:13–16) and •aÖ·an (1986:27–29), though the renderings of many of the lines and phrases of the inscription are substantially different in the two versions. I have some doubts about both the dating of the inscription and its supposed provenance. Firstly, although Regmi (1966:13) states that the date figures of the inscription are lost, •aÖ·an (1986:27), in his preamble to the inscription, states that the date of the inscription is N.S. 262. I have been unable to ascertain how this was established, given that the date of the inscription is apparently unreadable. Secondly, given the discussion earlier in this chapter of “aØkara’s religious orientation, it would seem improbable that one of his followers would be teaching yoga and Tantra, rather than advaita-Ved§nta. However, the Amaradaki [=$maradaka?] maãha, a “aiva-Siddh§ntin institution that was particularly influential in south India during the twelfth century (see Ch. 6, fn. 39, 40) contributed to the development of the temple movement, was associated with Tantra, and supplied áaiva-§c§rya-s who inititiated many regents from the eleventh to thirteenth centuries. It seems possible that if the inscription does indeed date from the twelfth century, as maintained by •aÖ·an (1986:27) and Vajr§c§rya (1980:209ff.), then it may perhaps relate to a “aiva-Siddh§ntin rather than a saÒny§sÊ. In support of this suggestion, firstly, it may be noted that in an incomplete sentence in v. 6 of the inscription Durv§sa is mentioned (though in which capacity it is difficult to discern accurately from the fragment). According to several Tantra-s, Durv§sa is the preceptor of the Amaradaki maãha (ARE 1917, part II, para. 37 [1986:124]). Secondly, although •aÖ·an (1986) and Michaels (1994:117ff.) believe that this inscription signals the arrival of saÒny§sÊ-s in the Kathmandu valley, I have been unable to see how such a conclusion could be derived from it. Although (possibly) a teacher named “aØkara— approached by pupils—is referred to in v. 9, no reference is made to either a saÒny§sÊ, a daáan§mÊ or a “aØkar§c§rya. Also, in Ch. 4.1 it was pointed out that “aØkara was a relatively common name in the mediaeval period, and that the mention of someone named “aØkara does not necessarily refer to the author of the Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya or a “aØkar§c§rya. That the Amaradaki maãha was in south India, yet supplied a preceptor to a Nepalese king would not be improbable: there was considerable religious and cultural contact between the two regions from the twelfth century onwards, and since either the twelfth or the fifteenth century the priests (and their assistants) of the Paáupatin§th temple at Kathmandu have come from south India (Michaels 1994:116–132). Also, the Amaradaki maãha was connected to the GÙÏakÊ maãha, which had a significant institutional presence in K§áÊ. Notwithstanding a tradition amongst the so-called Bhaããa-priests of Kathmandu that the worship of Paáupati and their priesthood were instigated by “aØkar§c§ry§, it has been suggested that if there were áaiva ascetics in the Kathmandu valley during the twelfth to fifteenth centuries, then they were most probably “aiva-Siddh§ntins rather than saÒny§sÊ-s (i.e. followers of “aØkar§c§rya).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
177
CHAPTER SIX
THE RISE AND INFLUENCE OF ADVAITA MA•HA-S In order to consider the relative importance and influence of advaita maãha-s within the context of religious developments in India from the early to the late mediaeval period, a brief survey of the development of early “aivism will first be presented. The processes will then be considered whereby several forms of “aivism gradually came to replace Buddhism and Jainism as the dominant forms of religion in the south. This was primarily due to state patronage. The religious orientation of various rulers and prominent Ved§ntins is discussed, and the initiation of kings by r§ja-guru-s. A more detailed analysis of the institution and funding of áaiva maãha-s up to the Vijayanagara period follows. The central thrust of this chapter is to illustrate how a new monastic tradition was founded by the early founders of the Vijayanagara empire, a tradition which also represented a ‘new’ orthodox sm§rta form of advaita “aivism, primarily represented in Ved§nta tradition and philosophy. It was only much later that “aØkara—ideally situated as an orthodox advaita-ved§ntin—was projected onto that new monastic project, which originally seems to have had nothing to do with the §c§rya. Although the work of many scholars of the period has been utilised in this chapter, the argument that a ‘new’ orthodox áaiva tradition was established is essentially novel.
6.1 The P§áupatas We will first consider the earliest known sect of áaiva-s in India, the P§áupatas. In what many scholars believe to be one of the later additions to the Mah§bh§rata (XII, 349.64), there are references to different doctrines (jñ§na) and sects (mata) prevalent at the time (c.300–500): the P§áupata-s, S§Òkhya, Yoga, P§ñcar§tra and Vaidika. In the Pur§Öa-s, the vaißÖava P§ñcar§tras are sometimes condemned, but it is the P§áupatas who are considered to be the most subversive. The P§áupatas can be regarded as the prototypes of “aivite ascetics, covering their body with ashes and sectarian markings, emphasising
178
chapter six
yoga, and often criticised for anti-social behaviour. “aivite sects, which seem to have developed in the early centuries BCE, all attribute their origin to the P§áupatas—the oldest recognisable “aivite sect—who worshipped Bhairava, the fierce form of “iva (Maheávara). The first textual references to “aivism are found in Patañjali’s Mah§bh§ßya on P§Öini’s grammar, probably written in the second century BCE (Dyczkowski 1989:4). Patañjali (5.2.76)1 refers to “ivabhagat-s, whom he describes as itinerant ascetics wearing animal skins and carrying an iron lance. The P§áupata doctrine2 is attributed to L§kulÊáa (or N§kulÊáa), ‘The Lord of the Staff ’, who was considered to be an incarnation of “iva. His teachings, according to tradition, had been revealed by “rÊkaÖãha, the consort of Um§ (Chakraborti 1970:8; Pathak 1960:4–8). He is believed to have come from Baroda (Gujarat) and to have lived in the early centuries. However, it is far from certain that P§áupata “aivism began with him, as there is a tradition which admits the existence of P§áupata teachers prior to L§kulÊáa (Dyczkowski 1989:20). There were other groups of ascetics also known as P§áupatas, and it is probable that P§áupata became a general name for a number of sects. The earliest surviving texts of the sect are the P§áupatasåtra, with the Pañc§rtha-bh§ßya of KauÖ·inya, which may be dated to around the fourth to the sixth centuries (Dyczkowski 1989:21).3 P§áupata texts inform us that the P§áupata ascetic should be a Brahman, and it was prohibited for him to address women or áådra-s except under special circumstances.4 However, no Brahmanical rite is recommended, and many of its rituals seem to have been entirely non-Vedic (Dasgupta 1975, Vol. 5:142).5 P§áupata philosophy appears to have been a
1
Ed. Kielhorn (1906, Vol. 2:387). P§áupata doctrine and the yoga doctrine of PatañjalÊ bear distinct affinities (see Hara 1999). 3 For the chronology of the P§áupatasåtra and its commentaries, see Hara (1994). 4 Ingalls (1962:291–297) believes that P§áupata actions were far more lecherous than KauÖ·inya’s gloss suggests. 5 Dasgupta (1975, Vol. 5:130) remarks that the texts do not give us any philosophy of “aivism but rather deal almost wholly with rituals, or rather modes of life. It is quite possible that áaiva philosophy was added to extant ascetic practices, as in the Sarva-daráana-saÒgraha of M§dhava the P§áupata system is not identified with any form of philosophy, but with different kinds of ascetic practices. 2
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
179
relatively late accretion to a radically antinomian lifestyle, which included: wearing filthy garments; use of violent and indecent language; imitation of animals; feigning madness; spitting; defecation; and public sex acts. The P§áupatas specified five levels of attainment,6 the second level being distinctively P§áupata, whereby the initiate behaves in a manner (such as being mad, or like a dog) likely to cause censure and reprimand, courting disfavour, thereby relieving the initiate’s previously accumulated bad karma. The P§áupata goal was mokßa, but also to be free to act at will. The P§áupatas are thought to have survived in two major factions, the K§p§likas7 and the K§l§mukhas. The K§p§likas were a radical and itinerant “aivite sect famed for their carrying of a human skull, their immoral behaviour and their reputation for practising human sacrifice. They are believed to have been the instigators of Tantric ritual (White 1998), and are referred to in early (fifth or sixth cent.) Tantric literature (Lorenzen 1972:52). While the K§p§likas represented the most heterodox aspects of “aivism, the K§l§mukhas represented the more orthodox aspects, inaugurating temples and colleges in south India. Despite differences in practice, the K§l§mukhas maintained a doctrine very similar to that of the P§áupatas. We will be returning to these áaiva sects, after first examining the causes of the rise of various forms of “aivism in the south. 6.2 Maãha-s and competing religious traditions in south India, 600–1500 CE After the seventh century, there was a general decline in the influence of both Jainism and Buddhism in south India, with relatively few references to Buddhism in literature and inscriptions, although, as previously noted, Buddhism survived in some centres up until the thirteenth century. Jainism nevertheless still maintained some influ-
6 See Ingalls (1962); Davidson (2002:183–184). There are distinct parallels between the P§áupatas and the Greek Cynics, both of which Ingalls believes had shamanic roots. The Cynics first appeared in the fourth century BCE and exerted considerable influence until the fifth century. 7 In Hala’s Prakrit poem, the G§th§saptaáati (third to fifth century) there is one of the earliest references to the K§p§likas (Dyczkowski 1989:26).
180
chapter six
ence in the south for several centuries, and between the eighth and tenth centuries several new monastic orders were established in the Bangalore and Mysore districts. Royal and private charters registering land grants, and control over local tolls, raised the position of the Jaina pontiff almost to the position of a landlord, giving the maãha considerable status in the local area. The adoration of the preceptor of Jaina maãha-s developed into a cult during this period, numerous burial stones being erected by lay and monastic disciples, to which ritual worship was offered (Nandi 1973:108–113, 170; Champakalakshmi 1996:345; Davidson 2002:90). Buddhism and Jainism were being challenged by the growing popularity of vaißÖava bhakti (centred on the $l..v§rs) and, more importantly, áaiva bhakti 8 (centred on the N§yaÖ§rs).9 Both Jainism and Buddhism had previously been patronised by the non-Tamil C§Ïukyas, but the adoption of “aivism by the succeeding Tamil P§Ö·ya and Pallava dynasties entailed a loss of patronage for those religions, and the active promotion of “aivism by the ruling elites of the Deccan and south India.10 The expansion of the powerful Tamil kingdom of the Pallavas under Mahendravarman I (580–630)11 and his son NarasiÒhavarman I (630–668) coincided with the anti-Buddhist and anti-Jaina bhakti movement and the rise of a strong sense of Tamil
8 One of the most important centres of the early south Indian bhakta saints was K§ñcÊpuram, a place also associated with the early career of R§m§nuja (13th century). 9 In the Tamil region, three áaiva poet-saints, Tirun§Öacampantar, Tirun§vukkaracar and Cuntaramårti, popularly known as Campantar (or N§Öacampantar), Appar and Cuntarar (sixth to eighth centuries), are recognised as the principal ‘leaders’ (n§yaÖar), or the ‘First Three Saints’, of the sixty-three N§yaÖ§rs. In a later classification, M§Öikkav§cakar (ninth century?), the author of the Tiruv§cakam (‘Sacred Utterances’) is included with the other three poets, as ‘Preceptors of the Faith’ (camayakuravar) or ‘The Four’ (n§lvar). Their vernacular poems were incorporated into the T¿v§ram, also known as ‘The Complete Canon’ (aãaØkaÖmuÜai) which comprises seven books and forms the bulk of the primary sacred texts of Tamil “aivism. In the eleventh century the works of the ‘First Three Saints’ were compiled into the seven-volume TirumuÜai (‘Sacred Utterances’), which served as primary scripture for this branch of “aivism. It seems that the entire canon (which, amongst other works, also includes the Tirumantiram as Book X; see below) was not completed until the thirteenth century (Peterson 1991:12–15). 10 Buddhism survived for longer in the outlying regions of the east and north (Davidson 2002:90). 11 According to tradition, Mahendravarman was converted from Jainism to “aivism by the poet-saint Appar (Peterson 1991:9). For a brief resumé of the king’s literary activity, see Unni (1998:1–7).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
181
identity.12 While all the Pallavas worshipped the trimårti (Brahm§, VißÖu and “iva), it was “aivism that witnessed a remarkable growth, particularly during the reign of NarasiÒhavarman II (or R§jasiÒha, c.690/91–c.728/29) (Mahalingam 1969:123–124).13 The anti-social practices integral to both Jaina and Buddhist ideologies (such as their prohibitions on contact with women, and their generally negative attitude to art, literature and music), and the alien and artificial literary style of Jaina Tamil may also have been significant contributory factors in the decline of Jainism and Buddhism after the seventh century (Zvelebil 1973:192–197). In the early bhakti hymns of theT¿v§ram (the collective title for the N§yaÖ§rs’ hymns)14 particular emphasis is given to the temple15 and ritual worship.16 However, it is apparent that the so-called bhakti movement of south India was mainly represented by Brahman and kßatriya poets, and was not in any way a low-caste phenomenon articulating class-struggle or social protest, even though the ethos of the bhakta-s could be described as social negativism (Zvelebil 1973:192–197).17
12 It may also be noted that the bhakti movements contributed significantly to the cult of the book—notably Pur§Öa-s—in distinction to earlier oral traditions: texts came to be considered as protecting forces for domiciles, and particular merit could be accrued from copying a text (Brown 1986:76–78). 13 R§jasiÒha also seems to have continued supporting some Buddhist institutions. He is credited with the construction of a Buddhist vih§ra at Nagapaããinam. 14 The collective title T¿v§ram (‘a text related to ritual worship’) was only given to the N§yaÖ§rs’ hymns in, perhaps, the sixteenth century. 15 The three poets sang hymns to “iva as the god of shrines situated in 274 sacred places (five belonging to the Himalayas, the abode of “iva), the Tamil places creating a “aivite sacred geography (see Spencer 1970). 16 Besides the bhakti movement, more radical forms of “aivism were also prevalent in the south. In the Tirumantiram, Tirumålar (eighth/ninth century), the great Tamil siddha and Tantric, describes four paths of “aivism, also called áuddha-siddh§nta and ved§nta (Thirumular 1999:vv. 1419–1501). In desending order of accomplishment, from jñ§na to bhakti, are: jñ§nÊ-s, merging the “I in the you”; yogÊ-s, raising kuÖ·alinÊ through the six centres, attaining siddhi and sam§dhi; those in kriy§, not missing daily worship; those in cary§ (performance of rites and cermonies), who perform many pilgrimages. Those on the paths of kriy§ and cary§ wear earrings, rudr§kßa around the neck, and (presumably) the vÜßabha (bull) and trident mådra-s (seals). There is also a reference (v. 1449) to six schools of ved§nta-siddh§nta. This four-fold hierarchical scheme is the same as the four-fold division into ‘quarters’ (p§da) of both the “aiva $gama and the P§ñcar§tra SaÒhit§, and probably does not accurately reflect real socio-religious divisions. 17 An examination of the caste-origin of the bhakti poets reveals that around 75% of the poet-saints were either of Brahman or kßatriya origin. A further 20% (including Appar and Namm§l..v§r) are veÏϧÏa-s, technically a áådra caste, but in
182
chapter six
In the tenth and eleventh centuries the CÙÏas actively promoted the devotional “aivism of the N§yaÖ§rs, enlarging and rebuilding extant “iva shrines visited by the N§yaÖ§rs, who were installed as a feature of the iconography and ritual complex of the temple. They also perpetuated the institution, begun by the Pallava kings before them, of employing singers of the hymns of the N§yaÖ§rs in ritual worship in the temples (Peterson 1991:14).18 Although developments in the dominance and decline of various religious movements are being discussed, particularly concerning the rise of VaißÖavism and “aivism, it is important to consider the frequently syncretic nature of religion at a popular level. To give but one example for the period under discussion: in Bengal in the eleventh and twelfth centuries, it is apparent that, in the eyes of the laity, there was practically no distinction between ‘Pur§Öic’ Hinduism and Buddhism; people may have had ten Brahmanical saÒsk§ra-s performed by Brahmans, yet paid homage to the Buddha (Chakrabarty 2001:145).19 However, notwithstanding religious syncretism, sectarian conflicts nevertheless took place. The twelfth-century work of C¿kkiϧr, the Periya Pur§Öam (a hagiography of the sixtythree N§yaÖ§rs), contains a description of a major conflict between Jainas and “aivas, which occurred at Va·aãali, near Kumbhakonam, wherein the Jainas are accused of hiding a liØga and are forced to leave by the local CÙÏa ruler. The Jainas appear to have suffered considerably at the hands of zealous áaiva-s.20 The period following
practice members of a community of middle-class landlords. The remaining 10% are either low-caste or of unknown caste. 18 Although they promoted “aivism, the CÙÏas, and the Pallavas before them, were also supporters of Jainism. An inscription dated to 945, in the reign of the CÙÏa king MadiraikoÖ·a Parakesarivarman, records a gift of gold to a devotee at a (most probably) Jaina monastery, JinagiripaÏÏi. Other inscriptions during the reigns of the CÙÏas record various grants and land gifts. These include an inscription of c.1116 (from the reign of KulÙttuØga CÙÏa I), another, a few years later, from the reign of Vikrama CÙÏa, and an inscription dated 1199 records a gift of land to a Jaina temple (Desai 1957:34–35). 19 It is apparent that in mediaeval contexts, while texts may have been sectarian, ritual was frequently fluid, crossing Jaina, Buddhist, Muslim, Tantric, and sectarian ‘Hindu’ boundaries, creating shared patterns of worship. For evidence from the ninth to fourteenth centuries; see Granoff (2000:418–420); Orr (2000:24–25; 204, fn. 45). 20 One indication of this is an epigraph at “rÊáailam, Andhra Pradesh, dated to 1512, recounting the pious achievements of a VÊraáaiva chief, named LiØga, who took pride in cutting off the heads of “vet§mbara Jainas (Desai 1957:23). There
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
183
the Periya Pur§Öam witnessed a significant growth of maãam-s (maãha/ guhai/§tÊÖam), which functioned not only as centres of sectarian learning but also of administration. Inscriptional evidence for the Deccan and south India between 600 and 1000 reveals that the overwhelming majority of maãha-s were in the central/western part of what is now Karnataka State (see Nandi 1973:205). This area, to the east of Goa, is known to have been home to around fifty Jaina, áaiva and Buddhist monasteries during that period.21 Although, as explained, áaiva-orientated sects are known to have existed since at least the early centuries BCE, áaiva monasteries22 were unknown before the eighth century (Nandi 1973:70–90; Swaminathan 1990:117).23 Between the eighth and tenth centuries, there are around thirty-five inscriptions for áaiva maãha-s, the earliest being for the “aiva-Siddh§ntins (see below), P§áupatas,24 K§p§likas,25 and the K§l§mukhas26 of Mysore,27 all of
is also a persistent tradition that Cuntarar was reponsible for the annihilation of 8,000 Jainas in Madurai (Nampi $Öã§r Nampi, $Ïuãaiya PiÏÏaiy§r Tiruvul§m§lai, 59 and 74; see Zvelebil 1973:106). During the reign of the KaÏacårya king Bijjala (12th century), the K§l§mukha Ek§natada R§mayya exterminated many Jainas at Ablår. K§l§mukhas desecrated dozens of Jaina basadi-s during that period, many of which can be identified, after defeating the Jainas ‘in debate’ (Settar 1999:77–79). 21 In Karnataka, nine other maãha-s were situated in the Bangalore area, while two Jaina maãha-s were in south Karnataka, one dating from the sixth century, the other from the tenth century. Four maãha-s (two áaiva and two Jaina) were situated in Tamil Nadu, and seven in Andhra Pradesh. Four maãha-s (Buddhist, áaiva and Jaina) were functioning in Orissa, around Bhubaneávara, while two áaiva maãha-s were situated on the coast of Maharashtra, south of Mumbai. Four áaiva maãha-s are recorded in Madhya Pradesh. 22 There appear to have been few vaißÖava maãha-s before the rise of the “rÊVaißÖava movement under R§m§nuja in twelfth and thirteenth centuries. See Gurumurthy (1979:17, 73), who lists four, the earliest being the Govindapadi maãha founded in North Arcot in 969. 23 One of the earliest references to a maãha in inscriptions is in the Tirum¿ÜÜali inscription (of uncertain date) of Dantivarman Pallava (r.796–847) (Swaminathan 1990:117). 24 The earliest inscription referring to P§áupatas is dated 943, found at Hem§vati, Sira T§luk§, Mysore. Another important inscription, referring to “iva becoming incarnate as L§kulÊáa, is found at EkliØgji, near Udaipur, Rajasthan, dated 1028 (Bhandarkar 1995:166). There was also an important P§áupata centre in U·upi, on the Kanataka coast in South Kanara district, supported by the $Ïupa chiefs. The P§áupatas were also influential in the area around Pal..aiy§r..ai (south Tamil Nadu) during the CÙÏa period. R§jendra I built a temple there for one of his queens that was used by P§áupatas. The D§r§suram temple in the same town contains 108 sculptured figures of P§áupata áaiv§c§rya-s (Champakalakshmi 1996:346). 25 The earliest occurence of the word kap§lin (one who bears a skull) is probably
184
chapter six
whom had established maãha-s in the south by around the middle of the tenth century. The influence of the P§áupatas appears to have been extensive. Davidson (2002:184–186, 341–343) has identified over one hundred P§áupata sites, all over India, dating from the fifth to the twelfth century, and remarks that no comprehensive study has yet been undertaken, which would doubtless reveal more sites.28 It appears (Davidson 2002:85) that Buddhist missionary activity was effectively supplanted by the P§áupatas.29 The P§áupatas and K§l§mukhas, besides promoting their §gama-s, were both associated with Ny§yaVaiáeßika philosophy.30 By the tenth century there were áaiva maãha-s all over the Deccan,
that in the Y§jñavalkya SmÜti III.243 (c.100–300). Further references to K§p§likas occur in the Maitr§yaÖÊya Upanißad, and various literary texts from the third to the fifth centuries onwards. The earliest inscriptional evidence is provided by Jaina inscriptions, one at “ravaÖa BeÏgoÏa (dated 960–974), and the other from Tirumakå·al-Narsipur Taluk in Mysore District (Lorenzen 1991:12–24). There is a copper-plate charter dated to 639, granting a village near Igatpuri, Maharashtra, for the worship of the god K§p§leávara (Bhandarkar 1995:168), though this does not indicate a maãha. 26 The earliest mention of the K§l§mukha sect is in a R§ßãrakåãa grant of 807 (Nandi 1973:85). By the mid-tenth century the eastern Deccan (Telugu speaking) had become a stronghold of the K§l§mukhas. They rose to prominence during the 11th, 12th and early 13th centuries (see Lorenzen 1991:97–172). 27 The K§l§mukha maãha-s at Mayil§ppår and TiruvoÜÜiyår (in the Chennai area) and Tiruv§ãutuÜai appear to have an ancient history, and may date from the ninth or tenth centuries (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:117–118; Champakalakshmi 1996:385 fn. 65). 28 By the seventh century P§áupatas were associated, as teachers, with the court of Bhavavarma II, and during the eighth and ninth centuries P§áupata “aivism was well established in Cambodia. 29 As late as 900, even Buddhist monarchs respected P§áupata missionaries. In art, L§kulÊáa is usually depicted in the image of the Buddha. 30 Haribhadra (eighth century), in his ‘a··aráanasamuccaya (vv. 13, 59), mentions that naiy§yika-s and vaiáeßika-s are áaiva-s, while GuÖaratna (late fourteenth century; one of Haribhadra’s commentators) states that the naiy§yika-s are áaiva-s, and the vaiáeßika-s are p§áupata-s (Nandi 1973:84). Bhandarkar (1995:167) comments that the identification of naiy§yika-s with áaiva-s must be a mistake, as Bharadv§ja of the Ny§ya school is specifically referred to as a p§áupat§c§rya. Uddyotakara (c.500), an important Ny§ya philosopher, worshipped the Supreme Lord as “iva, in accordance with the practice of the P§áupatas, while Praáastap§da (c.500), an influential Vaiáeßika philosopher, was a Maheávara áaiva (Hirst 1993:121). There are indications that both naiy§yika-s and vaiáeßika-s were associated with the P§áupatas, but the precise reference that several mediaeval commentators (including Haribhadra) make in regard to áaiva-s and p§áupata-s is often hard to determine.
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
185
the greatest concentration being around DharvaÜ (central Karnataka). By the end of the CÙÏa period (early thirteenth century), nearly every temple in south India in the region governed by them had one or more maãha-s functioning in close proximity to it (Nilakanta Sastri 1955:650; Suthanthiran 1986:192). From the early thirteenth century, numerous áaiva maãha-s were established by devotees of what had become a canon of áaiva saints.31 Besides being educational institutions which were frequently in receipt of grants and donations (vidy§d§na) to further educational activities,32 the maãha-s were also often involved in charitable activities, including feeding arrangements for pilgrims and the poor, and in some cases setting up hospitals and maternity centres.33 The early maãha-s were but a few rooms attached to temples, but by the tenth century there were separate buildings for the residents. During the latter half of the first millennium, it became common practice for regents to take initiation (dÊkߧ) from áaiva gurus, whose general influence was similtaneously enhanced by the growing popularity of devotional “aivism amongst the population in some parts of India. In the south many kings, from the C§Ïukya, Hoysala, CÙÏa, GaØga, CedÊ, Y§dava, and subsequently the Vijayanagara dynasties, were initiated by áaiva preceptors—effectively undergoing a spiritual rebirth—usually in return for which substantial properties were donated, with revenue to be derived from the holdings.34 Kings
31
See Rajamanickam (1964:231–250). Amongst subjects studied were Veda, Mah§bh§rata, R§m§yaÖa, the eighteen Pur§Öa-s, yogaá§stra, systems of philosophy, logic (tarka), grammar (vy§karaÖa), poetry (k§vya), dramaturgy (n§ãaka), and sciences connected with literature (s§hitya) (Gurumurthy 1979:14; Swaminathan 1990:118). For educational subjects and salaries in maãha-s during the CÙÏa period, see Nilakanta Sastri (1955:628–634). 33 Gurumurthy (1979:14); Suthanthiran (1986:192); Swaminathan (1990:117). 34 Vikram§ditya I of the C§Ïukya dynasty of B§d§mÊ had as many as three áaiva preceptors, the first, “rÊ Sudaráan§c§rya, performing the áiva maÖ·ala dÊkߧ, for which he was granted a village in 660. Another of his gurus, “rÊ Megh§c§rya, also received a village in the same year. An inscription of 1039 reveals that the K§l§mukha, Kriy§áakti PaÖ·ita Deva, was r§ja-guru of the Western C§Ïukya, (Jaya) SiÒha Deva. Sarveávaraáakti Deva—an §c§rya of seventy-seven temples—was r§ja-guru of another C§Ïukyan monarch, Someávara Deva, in 1070. In 1129 Someávara Deva Bhålokamalla made a grant to the r§ja-guru, Vamaáakti PaÖ·ita, the greatest of the K§l§mukha gurus, who also received a grant, in 1156, from BijjaÖa Devarasa of the Kal..acuriyas, over whom the guru had considerable influence. Vamaáakti was also most probably the r§ja-guru of the Hoysala king, VÊra, receiving a village from a grant made in 1193. It appears from another inscription, in 32
186
chapter six
were consecrated and installed as royal protectors of the realm at the centre of a áaiva maÖ·ala.35 Davidson comments (2002:89) that “áaiva royal inscriptions are collectively the most extraordinary documents for the combination of religious fervour, erotic sentiment and graphically violent images”.36 Records indicate that the áaiva preceptors, known as r§ja-guru-s, were almost exclusively from the “aivaSiddh§nta, K§l§mukha, and Mattamayåra orders (the latter also being a “aiva-Siddh§nta sect), though the lineage in a few inscriptions is hard to determine. We will now consider the available evidence on this influential role of the “aiva-Siddh§nta and K§l§mukha sects. It is apparent that the CÙÏa r§ja-guru-s (§c§rya) were held in enormous
1191, that Kriyaáakti Deva was also the r§ja-guru of the Hoysala ruler NarasiÒha Deva. The r§ja-guru-s of the Hoysalas seem to have come from $sandi-n§·, where there were five maãha-s, the priests from there being known as KampaÖ§c§ryas. As recorded in 1245, the Y§dava (or SeuÖa) rulers had Rudraáakti Deva, from the Koteávara (or Koãin§tha) temple of Kuppaãår, as their K§l§mukha r§ja-guru (Saletore 1935; Nandi 1973:101–102; Settar 1999). CÙÏa regents, from R§jar§ja to KulottuØga (c.1000–1200), were initiated by a long line of “aiva-Siddh§ntin §c§rya-s, many of whom came from north or central India (Laãa, Gau·a and Madhya regions). Their ‘surnames’ were all -áiva (and often -áiva-paÖ·ita) and they were authors of a number of texts (Rajamanickam 1964:228–231; Nagaswamy 1998). King Devendravarman of the eastern GaØga dynasty was initiated into “aivism by PataØgaáiv§c§rya, who received a village as dakßiÖ§. The K§l§mukha, Vidyeávara, was acknowledged as the preceptor of the eastern C§Ïukya, Amma II (Vijay§ditya VI), who donated four villages to his sect. Kum§ra Sv§mÊ was the preceptor of another regent of the eastern C§Ïukyas, Yuddhamalla II, who built a monastery for the exclusive use of áaiva monks and preceptors. The preceptor of the CedÊ king, Yuvar§jadeva, was Sadbh§va “ambhu, who received a large province as bhikߧ (‘charitable donation’). King GaÖapatideva of the K§katÊya dynasty was ordained by his preceptor, Viáveávara “ambhå (Saletore 1935; Nandi 1973:101–102; Settar 1999). The eastern C§Ïukyas were also, from the beginning and throughout their rule, active patrons of Jainism. The early K§katÊyas, based in Warangal, supported Jainism at the beginning of their reign (Desai 1957:19–22). 35 The r§ja-guru should perform a special abhißeka ritual, marking the king’s spiritual enthronement (see Nagaswamy 1998:26). 36 Davidson (2002:129–130) believes that the term devar§ja, which appears in many inscriptions, refers to the king identified with “iva. This seems incorrect (see Kulke 1978b; Chandra 1992). Devar§ja refers to the icon of power (a palladium, typically a liØga) that is at the centre of a royal consecration ritual based on the aindra abhißeka, whereby the king is consecrated with the power of either Indra or “iva. The ancient Vedic rite was augmented by $gamic rites, and by the ninth century it had become established as the preeminent rite of royal consecration in many parts of Asia.
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
187
respect, and considered as the spiritual guardians of the country.37 They came from “aiva-Siddh§nta lineages (sant§na), and their functions included the supervision of the construction of temples,38 and the keeping of documents and records of temple endowments. R§ja-guru-s could be householders or bachelors (most were householders) but not saÒny§sin-s. They were sometimes hailed as siddha-s who could cure disease, and were meant to be able to predict impending disasters. They also used to perform various rituals to protect the king, including the annual r§ja-rakߧ, during which the king was annointed with sacred ashes mixed with saffron powder (Nagaswamy 1998:24–26). By the thirteenth century, numerous “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha-s had been established, which exerted a considerable influence in most parts of the Tamil region.39 One of the maãha-s most influential in supplying r§ja-guru-s was the GÙÏakÊ maãha.40
37 R§jar§ja refers to his guru as “my Lord” (sv§mÊ/u·aiy§r), whom he adores as “iva himself. According to the K§mik§gama (one of the principal texts in mediaeval “aiva-Siddh§nta), in temples the foremost place is offered to the r§ja-guru, followed by the king and then the queen. It seems that the R§jendra CÙÏa brought áaiva-§c§rya-s south, from Banaras and the God§vari region (Nagaswamy 1998:20–28). 38 Three people were responsible for temple construction: the yajam§na (patronbuilder); the architect-sculptor; and the §c§rya, who was the most important. He should know v§stu-á§stra, and supervise all procedures (Nagaswamy 1998:24–26). 39 According to the tradition pertaining to the CÙÏa r§ja-guru-s, five Üßi-s (Kauáika, Kaáyapa, Bharadv§ja, Gautama and Agastya [or $treya]) were initiated by “iva. (This group of Üßi-s is often to be found in “aiva-Siddh§nta $gama texts; see Brunner 1964:457.) The Üßi-s produced five lineages (p§ñca-sant§na-s: Durv§sa, DadÊci, Ruru, “veta, and Upamanyu), which resulted in the establishing of five maãha-s in the south: Mant§na-K§lÊávaram (at the centre), surrounded by Amardaki, GÙÏakÊ, Pußpagiri, and RaÖabhadra. Mant§na-K§lÊávaram was most probably in the God§vari region, while the latter four maãha-s (particularly Amardaki) played a central role in the development of the temple movement in south India. According to several Tantra-s, Durv§sa is the preceptor of the Amardaki maãha (ARE 1917, part II, para. 37 [1986:124]). Aghora “iva came from the Amardaki maãha and was a resident of K§ñcÊ. Though not a r§ja-guru (Nagaswamy 1998:28ff.), he was an influential and prolific systematiser of a dualist form of “aiva Siddh§nta. His Kriy§-krama-dyotika (Aghora-áiv§c§rya-paddhati), written in 1158, is still one of the most important texts in the south (Davis 1991:17). 40 The GÙÏakÊ maãha also traces its lineage to Durv§sa, and was probably established in south India by Yuvar§jadeva I (r.915–945?), a king of the Kalacuri dynasty. The maãha had several lineages (sant§na), and by the fourteenth century had numerous branches all over the south (Mahalingam 1962; Rajamanickam 1964:225; Dehejia 1986:89), employing many musicians and craftsmen. The pontiffs (who all have the surnames ‘“iva’ or ‘“ambhu’) came from the same lineage (i.e. “aiva-Siddh§ntin) as those of the Mattamayåra sect, though there is also evidence that the maãha may have had P§áupata adherents and related Tantric associations at the time of
188
chapter six
A considerable number of the “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha-s were named after either the famous Brahman áaiva saint, Tirujñ§naáambandar, or the non-Brahman áaiva saint, Tirun§vukkaraáar.41 With regard to VaißÖavism, non-Brahman participation became significant only after the time of R§m§nuja, in the thirteenth century. In the case of “aivism, it is apparent that beginning in the twelfth and thirteenth centuries many new maãha-s42 were established that were headed by lineages (sant§na) of non-Brahman teachers, called mudaliy§r.43 It seems
its founding. The name ‘GÙÏakÊ’ may indeed derive from ‘Gola-giri’, indicating a circular Tantric yoginÊ temple, such as that at Bhe·agh§ã, near Jabbalpur (Mahalingam 1962:447; Swaminathan 1990:119–121; Nilakanta Sastri 1992:118; Misra 1997:78). The Goll§/GÙÏakÊ or Lakߧdh§yi lineages (of the twelfth to fourteenth centuries) trace themselves from the Goll§ maãha of Banaras (which may be connected to the Bhikߧ maãha of Banaras; see Rajaminickam 1964:227). The GÙÏakÊ maãha supplied r§ja-guru-s to the Kalacuri, K§katiya, M§lva, and Telugu CÙÏa dynasties. One of the maãha’-s most influential preceptors, who founded several branch maãha-s, was Viáveávara “iva (fl. mid-thirteenth century). While it is possible that the GÙÏakÊ maãha-s also supplied the r§ja-guru-s for the Tamil CÙÏas (Rajamanickam 1964:229), evidence indicates that it was the Amardaki maãha which supplied most of their áaiva-§c§rya-s (Nagaswamy 1998:30–33). Nothing is heard of the GÙÏakÊ maãha after the sixteenth century, most probably because the maãha was overshadowed by the growing influence of the sm§rta maãha-s following the tradition of “aØkara (Mahalingam 1962:450). (For details of the maãha-s’ activities, acquisitions, branches, lineages, and preceptors, see ARE 1917, part II, para. 33–38 [1986:121–125]; ARE 1936–7, para. 19 [1986:67].) 41 See Annual Reports on Indian Epigraphy (1986:102–104 [no. 538, para. 53, 28th July 1909]); Rajamikkam (1962) supplies a comprehensive list of maãha-s. 42 See Gurumurthy (1979:70–73) for a list of sixty maãha-s established between the tenth and fourteenth centuries. 43 Rajamanikkam (1962; 1964:214–250); Champakalakshmi (1981:421). There are some indications that the flourishing non-Brahman maãha-s were opposed by Brahmans, though attempts to take them over were generally unsuccessful (Stein 1999:236–237). $gama texts, in general, permit the initiation up to the second level (of three levels of initiation: samayadÊkߧ, viáeßadÊkߧ, nirv§ÖadÊkߧ) of both áådra-s and women, though some texts dispute áådra-s’ rights to be initiated to the third (‘highest’) level (nirv§ÖadÊkߧ), and become §c§rya-s. In some instances, to obviate restrictions, ‘sat’ (‘pure’) áådra-s are created. Considerations of caste seem to be behind the scheme of four kinds of áaiva-s (variously named and categorised) to be found in many texts (Brunner-Lachaux 1963, Vol. 1:xxiii–xxiv; Brunner 1964:460ff.). According to the VarÖ§macandrika, a seventeenth century text produced by the (“aiva-Siddh§nta) Dharmapuram maãha (long after the maãha had been founded) to legitimise non-sm§rta worship, áådra-s have the right to take all levels of áaiva initiation, and to become preceptors (Koppedrayer 1991:201). It is evident that many áaiva maãha-s were significantly supported by members of the v¿Ï§Ïa caste (originally low-caste, but subsequently comprising many middle-class landlords). For studies of other non-Brahman “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha-s, see: Oddie (1984) for an account
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
189
probable that from the middle of the thirteenth century, many of the maãha-s were founded by disciples of MeykaÖã§r44 (Rajamanikkam 1962:222–223). The ascetic frequenters of “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha-s were generally known as áivayogin-s or maheávara-s, who are recorded in a large number of epigraphs.45 According to the $gama-s counted as authoritative for the southern “aiva-Siddh§ntins of the period under consideration (c.1000–1300), although authority lay ultimately in a mastery of the rites and texts of the $gama, adherents also had the right to study the four Veda-s (Nagaswamy 1998:27). “aiva-Siddh§nta, in general, accepts the authority of the Veda, but considers the $gama also to be both Veda and áruti (‘revelation’), the $gama in effect being a ‘higher’, more subtle revelation than the traditional Veda, which is regarded as a secondary revelation. A crucial distinction between the Vedic and $gamic traditions is that whereas the Veda is only open to the ‘twice-born’, the $gamic revelation is for all four varÖa-s, including áådra-s, who seem to have been quite powerful within the general expansion of “aiva-Siddh§nta (Brunner 1964:451ff.). The K§l§mukhas were divided into at at least two major orders, the “akti-parißad, which had four separate subdivisions, and the SiÒhaparißad. The SiÒha-parißad seems to have been distributed over a large area, including parts of Andhra Pradesh and Mysore, though the “akti-parißad was probably the more important order. The main centres of activity of the “akti-parißad were the DharvaÜ and Shimoga districts of Karnataka (Lorenzen 1991:97). Between the middle of the eleventh and the end of the thirteenth century, the K§l§mukha r§ja-guru-s of south India came from either BaÏÏig§ve (BaÏÏig§me/ Belag§ve),46 Kuppaãår, $sandi-n§· or “rÊparvata (“rÊsailam), the first two places being most important, particularly BaÏÏig§ve (in the “ik§ripura t§luk§ of Shimoga district, in Karnataka), which from of the Dharmapuram and Tiruv§vaãutuÜai maãha-s; Arooran (1984) for the maãha-s at Tiruv§vaãutuÜai, Tarumapuram and TiruppaÖant§Ï; Yocum (1990) for the Tiruv§vaãutuÜai AdhÊnam (founded in the seventeenth century). 44 MeykaÖã§r is one of the most important figures in the development of “aivaSiddh§nta in the south. His Civañ§napÙtam, written around 1221, was a Tamil text that laid the basis for a shift in “aiva-Siddh§nta theology from Sanskrit to Tamil (see Davis 1991:17–18). 45 See Annual Reports on Indian Epigraphy (1986:102–104), no. 538, para. 53, 28th July 1909. 46 Before approximately 1100, the place was called VaÏÏig§me, and then Balipura (Settar 1999:56).
190
chapter six
the eleventh to the thirteenth centuries was hardly matched by any mediaeval Deccan city: with over fifty temples, it was famous for its splendours and seats of learning. The earliest record of the presence of K§l§mukhas at BaÏÏig§ve is from 1019 (Settar 1999:70), while it is recorded in 1036 that BaÏÏig§ve had five K§l§mukha maãha-s (Saletore 1935:34–38; Settar 1999:68). From 1036 to 1139 BaÏÏig§ve was home to at least thirteen monastic orders, including one Buddhist, two VaißÖava, three Jaina, one Advaita, one “rotiya and six K§l§mukha, the K§l§mukhas being the most important and influential of the orders (Settar 1999:65–66).47 The K§l§mukha influence spread all over Karnataka under Hoysala and C§Ïukya patronage (Venkatarman 1950:74), the most prominent division of the K§l§mukhas being centred in the Ko·iya maãha, at the Ked§reávara temple48 in BaÏÏig§ve, from where many of the K§l§mukha r§ja-guru-s came.The Ko·iya maãha first appears in records in 1139, from when it appears in records alongside the original five maãha-s.49 It received substantial patronage from the KaÏacårya king, Bijjala, who was closely involved with Basava, the key figure in the development of the VÊraáaiva order.50 The short-lived prominence of the Ko·iya maãha was overshadowed by another “akti-parißad branch, the MåvarukoÖeyasantani of Parvat§vaÏi (Settar 1999:69, 77). By the end of the twelfth century the K§l§mukha order had begun to decline in power and influence. Besides providing preceptors to kings, the K§l§mukha pañcamaãha-s, as an institution, patronised vaißÖava-s51 and supervised the transac-
47 Although L§kulÊáa is hagiographically connected to the founding of the P§áupata order, the BaÏÏig§ve records frequently refer to L§kulÊáa-K§l§mukha in the same phrase, but no reference ever occurs in records to either P§áupatas or K§p§likas (Settar 1999:69). 48 The full name of “iva who presided over this temple was DakßiÖa-Ked§reávara (‘Lord of the Southern Ked§ra’). 49 Interestingly, the oldest of the original five K§l§mukha maãha-s that can be dated is the P§ñcaliØga maãha (Settar 1999:67). It will be recalled that in “aØkara’s hagiographies the K§ñcÊ stream of texts (the A“V and its derivatives) devote considerable emphasis to “aØkara’s establishing five liØga-s. Could this story perhaps be an echo of the importance given to the establishing of a five-liØga maãha within the K§l§mukha tradition? 50 The VÊraáaivas Prabhudeva and Akkam§h§devÊ were also connected with BaÏÏig§ve. VÊraáaivas took over maãha-s of the K§l§mukhas after the latter declined (Settar 1999:78). 51 Epigraphia Carnatica VII (Shikapura), 131, 132.
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
191
tions of other áaiva institutions in 1104 and 1113.52 However, as noted above, K§l§mukhas appear to have had serious conflicts with Jainas. The K§l§mukhas worshipped not only “iva, but also VißÖu and Brahm§, and accepted not only the $gama-s, but also the Veda-s, varÖa-s and §árama-s. Nevertheless, vaißÖava critics such as R§m§nuja and Y§mun§c§rya represented the K§l§mukhas as anti-Vedic (Settar 1999:68–69). As revealed in inscriptions, not only were kings being initiated and making substantial donations to K§l§mukha gurus, but so were their viceroys and provincial officials, who were often entitled Mah§maÖ·aleávara (Narasimham 1929:116).53 Prior to the ninth century, inscriptions hardly mention any lineage of teachers, but from the ninth century onwards a preceptor is rarely mentioned without his lineage. The role of the royal preceptor was clearly becoming institutionalised, resulting in the enhanced role and influence of the institution to which a line of preceptors was attached. The áaiva gurus were, like their Jaina counterparts, becoming deified as cult objects. Archeological evidence indicates that already by the seventh century (and perhaps earlier) P§áupata teachers were thought to become identical with “iva at the moment of death, and temples were erected with a liØga installed bearing their name (Stietencron 2001:24). The enhanced status of many pontiffs of áaiva maãha-s was partly in view of the irrevocable nature of royal grants (á§sana-s) and partly owing to the absolute rights of the pontiff over the temple or monastery. In a record of around 900 is to be found one of the first references to a mahant, whose rights in this instance are absolute.54 However, in many instances local bodies or assemblies had the right to remove the pontiff, should he have committed moral offences or be deemed to have brought the maãha into disrepute. Nandi (1973:99–101) comments that absolute control over the properties of the temple or monastery led to a kind of feudal organisation in important monasteries, some of which organised mass áaiva initiation (dÊkߧ) rituals, thus furthering their sphere of influence. The maãha-s
52
EC VII (Shikapura), 131, 99. The Mah§maÖ·aleávara, Kundamarasa, made grants in 1019 after washing the feet of his guru, Måliga “ivaáakti PaÖ·ita of BaÏÏig§ma. Govinda R§ja, the younger brother of KÜßÖa R§ja, made endowments to Someávara PaÖ·ita Deva. See Saletore (1935:38) for other instances. 54 EC X, Srinivaspur t§luk§, 29. The grant, by Kunnayya, was also made to the servants of five (presumably resident) mahant-s. 53
192
chapter six
also attracted itinerant trade on account of their organisational network, contributing significantly to urban growth (Champakalakshmi 1996:210).55 Itinerant traders were also significant donors to maãha-s, some of which were named after them. Misra (1997) discusses the power of maãha-s and their pontiffs in central India in the ninth and tenth centuries, based on records of nine “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha-s. The initiates promoted vaiáeßika philosophy and $gamic “aivism, from “fortress-like structures”. The movement was rooted in the GuÖa-“ivpuri region, but spread over central India, and on to Gujarat, Rajasthan, Andhra, Karnataka and Tamil Nadu. The network of “aiva-Siddh§nta maãha-s traced their lineages back to the Mattamayåra (‘drunken peacock’) sect at Kadvaha.56 From the seventh to the thirteenth centuries, these monasteries supplied many of the r§ja-guru-s to regents of several of the dynasties previously referred to. Some of the pontiffs were low-caste, but regardless of caste—which had theoretically been eliminated after initiation—received land-grants from the state. Nominally celibate,57 several of the pontiffs wrote religio-philosophical texts that became relatively widely known.58 It has been estimated (Misra 1997:74; Dehejia 1986:89) that the dispensation in grants and land to the pontiffs of these áaiva maãha -s amounted to one third of the revenue of the entire Kalacuri state, indicating the importance of áaiva maãha -s to Kalacuri polity. The maãha-s employed not only artisans and tenant farmers, but also a contingent of law-enforcement officers (vÊrabhadra -s and vajramußãi-s) -
-
-
55 Champakalakshmi (1996:385) draws attention to the close relationship indicated between the increase in trade activities, craft production—especially oil and textiles—and the institution of áaiva maãha-s. The K§l§mukha (P§áupata) maãha-s of the ninth and tenth centuries (in centres such as Mayil§ppår and Tiruvor...r.iyår), the bhakti maãha-s named after áaiva saints (of the eleventh and twelfth centuries), and the well organised maãha-s of the Goll§/GÙÏakÊ or Lakߧdh§yi lineages (of the twelfth to fourteenth centuries, which trace their lineage from the Goll§ maãha of Banaras), were all invariably located in trade and craft centres. 56 See Davis (2000) for further details of the Mattamayåra sect. 57 It is apparent from records of various kinds that celibate orders were not always so. Derrett (1974) analyses a legal ruling from the sixteenth century—during the reign of VeØkata I—at Jambukeávara, whereby it is ordered that the pontiff of a P§áupata maãha should be a gÜhastha. It is apparent that the maãha had been occupied by various non-celibate P§áupatas, nominally a strictly celibate order. 58 These include the VyomatÊ-ãik§ of Vyomaáiva, the Pr§yascitta-samuccaya, Naimittika-kriy§-anusandhana and Soma-áambhu-paddhati (Misra 1997:76).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
193
whose powers of enforcement included mutilation and castration. In terms of the powers and privileges enjoyed within the hierarchy of the state, the pontiffs of the maãha-s appear to have been ranked higher than Brahmans and the chief priest, in other words, second only to the regent himself.59 The pontiffs also held more land than the kßatriya-s, who were subservient to them. The maãha-s rendered services to the state in various ways, including the garrisoning of war-forces, the provision of elephants, horses and perhaps wealth, the manufacture of armaments for battle, the maintainance of arsenals, training in warfare, and even participation in battle. Several pontiffs are praised in inscriptions not only for their knowledge of religious texts, but also for their political wisdom, their power against enemies, and their knowledge of weaponry. They also participated in civil administration, one pontiff (Vimalaáiva) being praised for his ability to make even distant people pay taxes.60 Taxes were also levied by the maãha-s themselves on many items, including a wide range of animals and farm produce, taxes being another source of the maãha-s’ considerable wealth. The titles of the pontiffs, such as n§tha, adhipati and p§la were those usually reserved for royalty, and such was the importance of the pontiffs to the state that, time and again, their “venerable feet were revered by the lustre of the crest jewels of the princes” (Misra 1997:77). The relationship of maãha-s to the empires of south India in the first centuries of the second millennium is particularly relevant in the context of understanding the traditions associated with development of advaita maãha-s, particularly those of “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊpuram, which are connected by hagiographers with the activities of “aØkar§c§rya. In this regard we now turn to the founding of the Vijayanagara empire, considering the religious orientation and initiation of its regents, and their patronage of various religious institutions.
6.3 Religious initiation and orientation of the Vijayanagara rulers After the collapse of the CÙÏa and later C§Ïukya empires, four dynasties arose in south India; the Y§davas of Devagiri, the K§kaãÊyas 59 See Corpus Inscriptionum Indicarum, Vol. 4, part 1, nos. 63, 64, 70; Misra (1997:75). 60 Corpus Inscriptionum Indicarum, Vol. 4, part 1, no. 64, v. 44.
194
chapter six
of Warangal, the Hoysalas of Dv§rasamudra and the P§Ö·yas of Madurai, who dominated the south in the thirteenth century. By 1328 these kingdoms had come under the control of the Delhi sultanate, but subsequent revolts against Delhi resulted in the establishing of the independent sultanate of Ma’bar at Madurai (which lasted from 1335 to 1378), the BahmanÊ sultanate (in 1347 at Bijapur, Karnataka), and the kingdom of Vijayanagara, whose capital was modern-day HaÒpe (Hampi), Karnataka.61 Up to 1565, three dynasties ruled Vijayanagara; the SaØgama (1336–1485), S§Ïuva (1485–1505), and the TuÏuva (1505–1570). Harihara (R§ya)62 I, the eldest of the five sons63 of the chieftain SaØgama, was the first king of Vijayanagara (1336–1356). Within a few years, with the assistance of his brothers—primarily Bukka but also M§rappa—Harihara built up an extensive empire stretching from coast to coast, an empire that was constantly at war with the BahmanÊ sultanate. Bukka I (1356–1377) succeeded his brother Harihara I, Bukka’s son, Kum§ra Kampana, being famed for the conquest of ToÖ·aimaÖ·alam, defeating the Muslim governor of KaÖÖanår (six miles north of “rÊraØgam), and the destruction of the Ma’bar sultanate (1334–1371).64 The traditional date of the founding of Vijayanagara is 1336. 1346 has also been suggested, the date of the famous ‘festival of victory’ at “ÜØgerÊ, to which we shall return. These dates have been questioned by Kulke (1985:126), who maintains that Vijayanagara probably only emerged under Bukka I as a capital, in the area of the old Hoysala capital, previously called Viråp§kßapaããaÖa, HosapaããaÖa
61 For the history of this period, see Saletore (1934); Mahalingam (1940); Venkataraman (1950); Majumdar (1960, Vol. 6); Krishnaswami (1964); Dallapiccola (1985); Verghese (1995); Aiyangar (2000). 62 The SaØgamas are frequently referred to in inscriptions as r§ya (‘king’). 63 The other four brothers were Kampa, Bukka, M§rappa and Muddappa. Curiously, the name Muddappa does not appear in some inscriptions as one of the brothers, another brother being named as either SaØgama or SaØkara (Filliozat 1973:135). 64 The event is celebrated by Kampana’s wife, GaØg§ DevÊ, in her epic, Madhur§vijayam. After the victories, Kampana’s commandant, Goppana, brought back and facilitated the reinstallation of the two main idols of “rÊraØgam that had been secreted at “iØgavaram (Gingee) and the foot of the Tirupati hill. “rÊraØgam had twice been sacked, once by Malik Kufår in 1310–1311, and during the Tughluq incursions in 1327–1328 (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:126).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
195
or Vijayaviråp§kßapura.65 The first inscription mentioning the name Vijayanagara is from 1357, the year after Harihara I died and Bukka I took the throne. Bukka gave himself the regal title Mah§r§j§dhir§ja parameávara, but only in 1368, shortly before his death. Initially, all brothers had the title Mah§maÖ·aleávara. Bukka I was followed by Harihara II (1377–1404), under whom the Vijayanagara empire expanded all over south India up to the KÜßÖa river. Harihara II’s three sons, Viråp§kßa I, Bukka II and Devar§ya I, all vied for the throne after Harihara’s death, Devar§ya succeeding and ruling from 1406 to 1422. Devar§ya’s two sons, R§macandra and VÊra Vijaya, both ruled for brief periods, followed by VÊra Vijaya’s son, Devar§ya II (1424–1446), the greatest of the SaØgama rulers. After Devar§ya II, the reigns of Mallik§rjuna (1446–1465) and Viråp§kßa II (1466–1485) were weak, resulting in S§Ïuva NarasiÒha (1485–1491), governor of Candragiri, usurping the throne in 1485. S§Ïuva NarasiÒha was succeeded by his minor sons, Timma (1491) and Imma·i NarasiÒha (1491–1505), the latter being assassinated by his TuÏuva minister, VÊra NarasiÒha, whose reign (1505–1509) was followed by that of his half-brother, KÜßÖadevar§ya (1509–1529), the greatest king of Vijayanagara. Acyutar§ya, a half-brother of KÜßÖadevar§ya, then ruled from 1529–1542. Following his death, a faction led by R§mar§ya, KÜßÖadevar§ya’s son-in-law, installed Sad§áiva (the nephew of Acyutar§ya) on the throne, though R§mar§ya remained the de facto ruler. Under R§mar§ya, the Vijayanagara empire regained some territory lost under KÜßÖadevar§ya but the combined forces of the Delhi sultanate finally defeated R§mar§ya, who died in January 1565 at the decisive battle of Rakkasa-TaØga·i, also known as the battle of T§ÏikÙta. The Vijayanagara capital was sacked and temporarily occupied by the Muslim armies, thenceforth ceasing to be an imperial capital. Northern Karnataka came under
65 Venkataranayya (1974:34) maintains that there is inscriptional evidence (of 1323) that Harihara I was first a king in Gutti (Jaggat§pi-Gutti), in the present Anantapur district of Andhra Pradesh. However, an inscription from 1347 states that Harihara was reigning in the ‘Gutti-r§jya’, and governing from Vijayanagara (Sewell and Aiyangar 1932:191 [Epigraphical Annual Reports made to the Archaelogical Survey of Madras, 1921, App. A, C-P. 9]). Filliozat (1973:xvii) suggests that there may have been two Hariharas, as a solution to this and other conflicting inscriptional evidence.
196
chapter six
Muslim control, and as the empire disintegrated, independent feudatories arose. Tirumula, R§mar§ya’s brother, moved to PenugoÖ·a66 in the Anantapur district, founding the $ravi·u dynasty (1570–1646) there with the puppet ruler, Sad§áiva. The capital of the vestiges of the empire subsequently moved twice, to Candragiri in North Arcot district, in 1592, and then to Vellore in 1606 (Verghese 1995:2). Many historians have presented the glorious history of the Vijayanagara empire in terms of a Hindu empire established in the face of Muslim aggession and persecution.67 The Vijayanagara rulers have been presented as Hindus whose patronage of and association with Hindu institutions, particularly the advaita maãha at “ÜØgerÊ, and whose defeat of the Muslims, notably at Madurai, saved and revived Hindu dharma from impending destruction. However,although wars with the BahmanÊ sultans were frequent, their cause was more political and economic than religious. There were also numerous military expeditions against less powerful Hindu rulers, such as the “ambuvar§yas, the Re··is of KoÖ·avÊ·u, the Velamas and the Gajapatis (Verghese 1995:3). Muslim soldiers also fought in the armies of the Vijayanagara regents, undermining the notion that the protagonists were fighting essentially religious wars. Kulke (1985:120–125) also questions the traditional account, presented by several prominent historians,68 of the origins of the SaØgama brothers. According to this account, the brothers were serving in Warangal in the Eastern Deccan, which was overrun by Sultan Muhammad Tughluq in 1323. They fled to Kampili, which was also subsequently captured in 1327 by the Muslims, who had them taken to Delhi as prisoners and converted to Islam. The Sultan of Delhi then sent Harihara I and Bukka to take over the administration of Malik Muhammad in Kampili, and put down a revolt by Hindu subjects. They are then said to have been converted back to Hinduism by the sage, Vidy§raÖya, and to have built a Hindu
66
PenugoÖ·a, Delhi, Kolhapur and Jina K§ñcÊ are counted as the four Vidy§sth§nas of the Jainas (Desai 1957:161). 67 See, for example Saletore (1934, Vol. 1:1): “south of the Vindhyas...after eight and sixty years of humiliation...the smouldering forces of Hinduism suddenly swept away the growing menace...The terror which shook the country to its foundation was entirely foreign; the measures adopted to meet and rout it were purely indigenous”. 68 Sewell (1900); Nilakanta Sastri (1958); Venkataramanayya (ed. Majumdar) (1960, Vol. 6:271–325).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
197
empire. However, the evidence indicates that the SaØgamas began their career under the Hoysala king, Ballala III, and were never converted to Islam.69 We shall also see that the Vijayanagara rulers were indeed initiated into “aivism, but not by Vidy§raÖya. The religious culture of the Vijayanagaras and previous kingdoms was generally cosmopolitan. Inscriptions of the later C§Ïukyas and Hoysalas exhibit an almost uniform pattern, beginning with an invocatory verse in praise of “iva, VißÖu, Jina or “akti. However, this is not a characteristic of Vijayanagara inscriptions, most of which begin with a short obeisance:70 “Salutation to Viråp§kßa”, “Salutation to GaÖapati”, or “Salutation to VÊrabhadra”, all of which are áaiva deities.71 In general, the inscriptions mention a variety of both vaißÖava and áaiva deities, goddesses such as SarasvatÊ, and also refer to various characters from the Mah§bh§rata. The Vijayanagara rulers extensively promoted important Hindu institutions, in endowments to “aiva and VaißÖava temples and advaita maãha-s, and in the patronage of commentary on the Veda. But the earlier Vijayanagara rulers were essentially áaiva, and like many of the other kings and regents of previous times, were initiated by áaiva gurus. K§áÊvil§sa Kriy§áakti $c§rya, almost certainly a K§l§mukha, is known from several inscriptions to have been the r§ja-guru of the first two SaØgama rulers, Harihara I and Bukka I, the founders of the Vijayanagara empire, and perhaps also of Harihara II and Devar§ya I.72 The precise lineage of this particular Kriy§áakti is difficult to 69 Wagoner (2000) has shown how the account of the founding of Vijayanagara and the ‘conversion’ and ‘apostasy’ of the brothers was derived from a melding together—first by N. Venkataramanayya in 1929, then elaborated by Nilakanta Sastri in 1946, and then repeated by subsequent historians—of ‘histories’ contained in two sets of texts: (i) ‘IߧmÊ’s FutåÈ al-Sal§ãÊn, written in Gulbarga between 1347 and 1350; BaranÊ’s Ta’rÊkh-i Firåz-Sh§hÊ, written at the Sultanate court of Delhi; RiÈlah or The Travels of Ibn-Baããåãa, written in 1354; (ii) R§jak§la-nirÖaya, Vidy§raÖya-k§lajñ§na, Vidy§raÖya-vÜtt§nta, and Vidy§raÖya-áaka, written in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries. The latter set of texts is particularly unreliable historically. The Vidy§raÖyak§lajñ§na contains distinct motifs in common with other texts, notably the Prat§parudra Caritramu and KoÊl Ol..ugu, indicating a common source for the accounts. 70 See UVAT 1985. 71 In two records, obeisance to “rÊ R§m§nuja is found, and in some other records only the name of the deity is mentioned, such as “rÊ Viããhala and “rÊ TiruveØgaÏan§tha. Only thirteen inscriptions contain an invocatory verse, two invoking Jina, nine invoking “iva, one praising VißÖu, and one invoking both “iva and M§dhava (Rajasekhara 1985:104). 72 Only one inscription contradicts this: in 1396 KhaÖ·eya R§ya Khaleávara Devayya is called r§ja-guru (Saletore 1935:39 fn. 29).
198
chapter six
determine. He is also referred to as R§yar§jaguru-maÖ·al§c§rya (Rama Rao 2000:44). There were two other K§l§mukha gurus, Kriy§áakti Deva and Kriy§áakti PaÖ·ita, who headed two of the five K§l§mukha maãha-s in BaÏÏig§me in 1113 (Saletore 1935:39).73 Although Kriy§áakti is also a common name for P§áupatas (Lorenzen 1991:161–164), it seems that this Kriy§áakti (K§áÊvil§sa) was a K§l§mukha of the “aktiparißad branch of that order, kriy§áakti referring to an office rather than a personal name. As revealed in a stone inscription to Bukka, dated 1368, and two other inscriptions of 1347 (Verghese 1995:8), K§áÊvil§sa Kriy§áakti was also the guru of one M§dhavamantrin,74 who was the great minister of M§rappa, one of the five SaØgama brothers (Saletore 1935:33 fn. 2). Between 1347 and 1442 at least three different K§l§mukha Kriy§áakti gurus are mentioned in Vijayanagara literary and epigraphic sources, namely K§áÊvil§sa, V§ÖÊvil§sa and CandrabhåßaÖa.75 After the reign of Devar§ya II (1424–1446) there are no further references to K§l§mukha gurus. The tutelary deity of both the K§l§mukhas and the earlier Vijayanagara rulers was Viråp§kßa, who was housed in the K§l§mukha Ko·iya (or KÙãi) maãha at BaÏÏig§ve, and not in the royal temple of Vijayanagara at Pamp§-kßetra (Saletore 1935:38–39), which housed Pamp§devÊ, originally a local goddess, who had become the consort of Viråp§kßa. The Prak§áik§ of Cannibhaããa,76 who was at the Vijayanagara court, refers to VijayanagarÊ and Viråp§kßa as different places, Viråp§kßa having probably been derived from the name of the deity (Thakur 1961:527). All the copper-plate records from
73
See Epigraphia Carnatica VII (Shikapura), 99, p. 67. There are several M§dhavas (who are not to be confused with the vaißÖava dualist Madhva), whose identities are examined below 75 Kriy§áakti is mentioned as the kula-guru of Harihara II in a copper-plate grant of 1378. R§ja-guru V§ÖÊvil§sa Kriy§áakti is referred to in a record of 1379. In two copper-plate grants (of 1398 and 1399) Harihara II is praised as the worshipper of the feet of r§ja-r§ja-guru-pit§maha Kriy§áaktideva. Devar§ya I is referred to in an inscription of 1410 as having received supreme knowledge by the favour of r§ja-guru Kriy§áakti, who is also mentioned in a grant made in the same year by Vijaya Bhåpati, Devar§ya’s son. In 1429, Harihara II made a grant to Brahmans, with Kriy§áakti at their head. Kriy§áaktideva is mentioned in a record of 1431, the last inscription referring to a ‘Kriy§áakti’ being in 1442, when r§ja-guru Kriy§áakti O·eya is referred to. CandrabhåßaÖa Kriy§áakti appears in the court of Devar§ya II, in a work of “rÊn§tha, a Telugu poet (Verghese 1995:8, 112). 76 Most probably the author of the Sarva-daráana-saÒgraha (see below). 74
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
199
Vijayanagara end with the honorific ‘signature’ ‘“rÊ Viråp§kßa’,77 at least until 1570 (Rajasekhara 1985:103). However, after the decisive defeat of the Vijayanagaras at the battle of T§ÏikÙta in 1565, the $ravÊ·u king, VeØkaãa II, who was established in PenugoÖ·a, replaced ‘“rÊ Viråp§kßa’ with ‘“rÊ VeØkateáa’ (the vaißÖava deity of Tirupati) as the official signature. The later Vijayanagara regents were primarily vaißÖava.78 Whatever their personal initiation or religious inclination, like many successful politicians the Vijayanagara rulers patronised a variety of religious institutions, including VÊraáaivas,79 followers of Madhva,80
77 In one example the honorific signature names both Viråp§kßa and “rÊkaÖãhan§tha (“iva) (UVAT 1985:83). 78 The Vijayanagara rulers remained áaiva up until Viråp§kßa II (1466–1485), the first Vijayanagara ruler to convert to “rÊ-VaißÖavism being S§Ïuva NarasiÒha, who usurped the throne in 1485. He was a devotee of VeØkaãeávara of Tirupati (Tirumalai) and NarasiÒha of Ahobalam. Under the later TuÏuvas the VeØkaãeávara temple was built up to become the most splendid temple of the realm (Michell 1995:276). KÜßÖadevar§ya (1509–1529) is known to have venerated “rÊ-VaißÖava ascetics such as Govindar§ja—who is called his guru—and VeØkaãa T§t§c§rya. The Telugu vaißÖava tradition maintains that T§t§c§rya was the guru of KÜßÖadevar§ya. There is also a story that Vy§sar§ya temporarily occupied KÜßÖadevar§ya’s throne during an inauspicious conjunction of planets (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:128). KÜßÖadevar§ya’s favourite deity was VeØkaãeávara of Tirupati, one of the main centres of “rÊ-VaißÖavism. The last TuÏuva emperor, Sad§áiva, and his regent, R§mar§ya—whose guru was Pañcamatabhañjanam T§t§c§rya—also owed their primary allegiance to “rÊ-VaißÖavism. Patronage for áaiva institutions seems to have more or less ceased under Sad§áiva and R§mar§ya, the last of the Vijayanagara rulers (Verghese 1995:9; Champakalakshmi 1996:343). 79 The VÊraáaivas, also called LiØg§yats, were widely active in the Vijayanagara period, particularly in Karnataka and Andhra Pradesh. The most important figure in the development of VÊraáaivism was Basava, who was minister to the Kalacåri king Bijjala from 1162–1167. The most important VÊraáaiva maãha-s were at “rÊsailam, SaØgameávaram and Ummattår (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:129). It is known that Devar§ya II patronised LiØg§yat gurus, and some LiØg§yats, such as the Generals LakkaÖÖa and Camarasa, rose high in state service. Grants were made to various jaØgama-s (wandering VÊraáaiva priests), and it is assumed that there were many VÊraáaiva maãha-s, though there are but a few records. There is no evidence, however, to support the claim that Devar§ya and his immediate successors were VÊraáaivas (Verghese 1995:8, 112, 117). For an account of contemporary VÊraáaiva renouncers (virakta), see Bradford (1985). 80 Little is known about the presence of VaißÖavism in Karnataka before the time of the dualist Madhva (1237–1317). (For Madhva’s dates, see Glasenapp 1992:9–11.) Madhva ($nandatÊrtha) was born in a vaißÖava sm§rta family, and besides accepting the VedasaÒhit§-s as authoritative, also accepted Mah§bh§rata, V§lmÊki’s R§m§yaÖa, Pur§Öa-s agreeing with these, and the entire P§ñcar§tra (Zydenbos 2001:113, 116). The temple of KÜßÖa at U·upi, which is the centre of the Madhva school, is first
200
chapter six
and Jainas.81 Devar§ya II, although initiated into “aivism, endowed the “rÊ-VaißÖava temples at “rÊraØgam and Tirumalai, and also sponsored Jaina institutions82 in the imperial capital and elsewhere (Verghese 1995:9).83 Besides the sects previously mentioned, there was also a significant presence of N§ths in south India during this period. Some records also seem to mention a Christian dÊv§n (chief minister) to Devar§ya II in 1445 (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:127). Up to 10,000 Muslim horsemen were employed in Devar§ya’s army, and Harihara II had a mosque built in 1439 in the Muslim quarter of Vijayanagara at the behest of a Muslim patron, the warrior Ahmad Kh§n
mentioned in an epigraph of 1366–1367 (Ramesh 1970:300). According to tradition, Madhva appointed eight disciples to conduct worship of KÜßÖa at the maãha founded by him at U·upi. This led to the founding of eight maãha-s in U·upi, which currently function as branch maãha-s of the main maãha, known as the KÜßÖa maãha (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:121–122). However, the tradition was primarily established by another group of four of his disciples: Padman§bha, Narahari, M§dhava and AkßobhyatÊrtha. These disciples were succeeded by JayatÊrtha and his successors, who were the most influential group of Madhva’s adherents. This lineage bifurcated around 1412, the younger division further bifurcating around 1435, resulting in three branches, known as the Vy§sar§ya, R§ghavendra-sv§mÊ and Uttar§di maãha-s (Verghese 1995:113). The Madhva sect is currently the largest vaißÖava sect in Karnataka State (Siauve 1957:iv). 81 Bukka I was behind the Jaina-VaißÖava accord of 1368, which specifically mentions, along with others, the Jainas of the PenugoÖ·a N§·u. It seems that this charter was necessary as the Jainas appear to have been subject to considerable harassment in the latter half of the fourteenth century (Desai 1957:161, 402). There are very few records of the SaØgamas that mention new constructions, the earliest of them dating to 1385 and recording the construction of a caity§laya for the Jina, Kuntu N§tha, the seventeenth TÊrthaØkara (Archaeological Survey of India: South Indian Inscriptions [ASI], Vol. 1, no. 152, pp. 153–160). This was on behalf of a general of Harihara II, Irugappa DaÖ·an§yaka—perhaps the greatest patron of the Jainas amongst Vijayanagara officials—who was a pupil of Pußpasena, and is also associated with other Jaina centres, such as “ravaÖa BeÏgoÏa (‘white tank of the Jainas’) and TiruparuttikunÜu (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:129). 82 A record of 1426, issued on the order of Devar§ya II for the erection of a caity§laya to P§rávan§tha (ASI, Vol. 1, No. 153), reveals that state aid was being given to Jainas, who nevertheless were on the decline both politically and numerically (Rajasekhara 1985:106). Nevertheless, during the fourteenth and fifteenth centuries Jainism was adhered to by large sections of the population, and all over the south Karnataka region many Jaina basti-s were restored (Ramesh 1970:300). During this period the main Jaina strongholds were K§ñcÊ, “ravaÖa BeÏgoÏa and the TuÏuva area (south-west Karnataka) (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:129). 83 During this period, although little is heard of Buddhism, there is a reference by a Javanese poet in 1362 to Buddhist monks “living at six monasteries in K§ñcÊpuram”, indicating that Buddhism continued to be practised (Sewell and Aiyangar 1932:195 [Memoirs of the Batavian Society of Arts LIV, 1902]).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
201
(Rajasekhara 1985:107; Wagoner 1999:250). KÜßÖadevar§ya and his successor, Acyutar§ya, although converted to “rÊ-VaißÖavism,84 gave significant gifts and endowments to both vaißÖava and áaiva temples,85 including some in Kumbhakonam, notably the vaißÖava “§raØgap§Öi, R§masv§mÊ and Cakrap§Öi temples, and the áaiva $di Kumbheávara temple.86 The political adaptation of Vijayanagara rulers to religious situations is well illustrated by the policy of R§mar§ya, the last of the Vijayanagaras, who allowed mosques to be built, and refused to heed the advice of his brother, Tirumala R§mar§ya, and other Hindu subjects, who wished to prevent cow-slaughter in the Muslim quarter (Turukav§·a). Further, he had the Koran placed before himself in the Audience Hall, so that Muslim soldiers would feel more comfortable making obeisance before him. The Vijayanagaras and the N§yakas also made substantial endowments to the darga-s (tombs) of Muslim saints, where miracles were believed to be performed (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:127). Having considered the Vijayanagaras’ general religious orientation, the áaiva initiation of the early rulers by K§l§mukha r§ja-guru-s, and the patronage they extended to various traditions, we now turn
84 There is a claim that a sage of the Madhva sect, Vy§sar§ya (Vy§satÊrtha), was the r§ja-guru of S§Ïuva NarasiÒha and of the TuÏuvas, VÊra NarasiÒha, KÜßÖadevar§ya and Acyutar§ya. Eleven sam§dhi-s (known as bÜnd§vana-s) of Madhva saints are to be found at Vijayanagara, indicating their influence there between around 1324 to 1623. Vy§sar§ya was a significant presence in the courts of S§Ïuva NarasiÒha and the TuÏuva rulers—down to Acyutar§ya—from around 1499 until his death in 1539. Although KÜßÖadevar§ya and Acytar§ya are known to have venerated Vy§sar§ya, there is little supporting evidence for the claim that Vy§sar§ya was a r§ja-guru. There is another claim that Viråp§kßa II was a “rÊ-VaißÖava. However, both of these suppositions are principally based on accounts to be found in sectarian hagiographic works (Verghese 1995:8–9, 113–114). 85 KÜßÖadevar§ya repaired the Viråp§kßa temple at HaÒpe soon after his succession, and made gifts to the áaiva temples at TiruvaÖÖ§malai, Cidambaram, K§lahasti, “rÊsailam and Amar§vatÊ. Gifts were also given to the vaißÖava temples at K§ñcÊ, Tirupati, SiÒh§calam and AhÙbalam. Amongst those in his service were sm§rta-s, Jainas and vaißÖava-s (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:126). Acyutar§ya, on the occasion of his coronation, gave an equal number of villages to the temples of Ek§mbaran§tha and Varadar§ja at K§ñcÊ. 86 This temple was built during the Vijayanagara period and hosts a twelveyearly Mah§m§gham festival, when bathing in the temple tank during the month of M§gha is equivalent to a bath in all the holy rivers of India, mirroring the annual bath at the M§gh Mel§ at Pray§ga. A vaißÖava maãha, first attached to the “§raØgap§Öi temple in the seventeenth century, has become an important vaißÖava pontifical seat in south India.
202
chapter six
specifically to their founding and patronage of a new orthodox áaiva institution at “ÜØgerÊ. 6.4 The SaØgamas’ patronage of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha and its pontiffs Crucial to our inquiry into the history of the Daáan§mÊ order is the origin of the monastic tradition at “ÜØgerÊ. In this section, an attempt will be made to disentangle epigraphic evidence from tradition, in order to establish the identity of the most important figures in the earliest decades of the maãha, namely its first three pontiffs (Vidy§tÊrtha, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and Vidy§raÖya), S§yaÖa (the commentator on the Veda-s), and at least two individuals named M§dhava (one of whom is often mistakenly identified with Vidy§raÖya). We have surveyed the importance and influence of various “aiva-Siddh§ntin maãha-s and lineages, and how the Veda was studied, but with foremost authority bestowed upon the $gama-s. In this and the following section, it will be seen how the the pontiffs patronised by the early Vijayanagaras at “ÜØgerÊ were essentially representatives of a new, orthodox, áaiva, Brahmanical, advaita-Ved§nta monastic tradition, ‘orthodox’ in respect of primarily representing Ved§nta, and constituting a tradition that acknowledged its ultimate authority as deriving from the Veda. We will first consider the founding of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha and its first pontiffs. It is well known that the SaØgamas extended significant patronage to the maãha at “ÜØgerÊ. In 1346 Harihara I led his four brothers on a pilgrimage there, where they celebrated the ‘festival of victory’ (vijayotsava), the conquest of the earth from the eastern to the western shore. The inscription records grants to forty Brahmans “well-versed in the Veda”,87 and praise is bestowed on Vidy§tÊrtha guru, “whose friendship gained is never lost” (UVAT88 1985:71–73).89 Saletore believes (1935:39–40) that Vidy§tÊrtha was the pontiff of
87 The wife of the late Hoysala king Ballala III, Kikk§yitai, also participated in this ceremony and donated land. This and other evidence undermines the contention made by several historians that the Vijayanagaras conquered the Hoysalas (Kulke 1985:122). 88 This work, on Vijayanagara inscriptions, hence referred to as UVAT, contains the text and translation of many of the inscriptions referred to in this section. 89 See also EC VI (“n 1), p. 92.
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
203
“ÜØgerÊ at the time, and together with the famous Vidy§raÖya, to whom we shall return, was responsible for considerable financial aid90 to the rulers in their military campaign, which brought on them the envy of their contemporaries, and which caused a pledge of eternal friendship to be made to the head of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. Although the traditional guru-parampar§ of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha records the death of Vidy§tÊrtha in 1333,91 several epigraphic records, from “ÜØgerÊ and other places, clearly indicate that Vidy§tÊrtha continued to be alive at least until June 14th 1375.92 Saletore (1935:40) believes that Vidy§tÊrtha remained guru of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha until this date. However, in 1356 Bukka paid homage to Vidy§tÊrtha, and also made land grants to Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and his disciples “to live and carry on their religious observances in sacred “ÜØgerÊ” (UVAT 1985:70, v. 1; 72, v. 3). According to tradition, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha (=Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha) followed Vidy§tÊrtha (=Vidy§áaØkara) as pontiff of “ÜØgerÊ,93 and it seems probable that Bh§ratÊtÊrtha was, for some time, head of “ÜØgerÊ, but perhaps under Vidy§tÊrtha (Rama Rao 2000:42). Bh§ratÊtÊrtha is indeed described in one inscription, in so many words (UVAT 1985:116, v. 10), as the disciple of Vidy§tÊrtha.94 While Vidy§tÊrtha appears not have left any written works, both Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and Vidy§raÖya wrote several advaita-Ved§nta texts which are considered to be important works within the Ved§nta tradition.95
90 There is a legend (Saletore 1934, Vol. 1:142) of Vidy§raÖya bringing down a shower of gold for three and three-quarter hours. 91 See Aiyer and Sastri (1962:164). Venkataraman (1959:28) refers to Vidy§tÊrtha as also Vidy§áaØkaratÊrtha. 92 On this date (áaka 1298, r§kßasa, §ß§·ha, áukla, 15) a gift of land was made by PaÖ·arideva O·eya (viceroy over the MaØgal..åru-r§jya) to Vidy§tÊrtha for conducting worship in the “iva temple at UÏayibeããu in the Mangalore t§luk§. In an inscription dated 1377, VÊra Bukka O·eya (Bukka I) is spoken of as having become “very great” with the assistance of Vidy§tÊrtha. A stone record at “ÜØgerÊ of 1365 restates the founders’ friendship with Vidy§tÊrtha. See Saletore (1935:40) for further details of the relevant inscriptions. The evidence does not seem to exclude the possibility that Bh§ratÊtÊrtha took over the gaddÊ at “ÜØgerÊ after 1356, yet Vidy§tÊrtha continued to perform functions and receive grants. 93 See Venkataraman (1959) for the details of the lives of all the pontiffs of “ÜØgerÊ. 94 According to tradition, Vidy§tÊrtha founded eight maãha-s and installed therein eight of his disciples: “aØkar§nanda, Saccid§nanda, S§ndranda, Advait§nanda “evadhi, Mah§deva “iva, Advaita Sukh§nanda, “ivayogÊ and PratyagjyotÊ. Vidy§raÖya and Bh§ratÊtÊrtha (Advaita Brahm§nanda) remained at “ÜØgerÊ (Shastry 1982:18). 95 Bh§ratÊtÊrtha wrote a commentary on the Brahmasåtra-s, the AdhikaraÖam§la (or
204
chapter six
At “ÜØgerÊ there is the splendid temple of Vidy§áaØkara. It is the main temple of the tÊrtha, and tradition associates it with the founding of a maãha in “ÜØgerÊ by “aØkara. Although this temple may have been erected in memory of Vidy§tÊrtha, the notion that the temple was either consecrated in 1356, under the supervision of Bh§ratÊtÊrtha—who granted 120 vÜtti -s (stipends) to various Brahmans on the occasion (ARMAD96 [“ÜØgerÊ] 1916:15)—or constructed as late as 1380 (ARMAD [“ÜØgerÊ] 1933:226), has been challenged by Michell (1995). A careful consideration of both epigraphic evidence and architectural style leads Michell to the conclusion that the Vidy§áaØkara temple, which has a liØga representing “aØkara, was constructed in the mid-sixteenth century.97 Inscriptions of 1390, 1430 and of the TuÏuva period (1515–1545) refer to the deity Vidy§áaØkara, but not to any temple. Given the abundance of inscriptions in Vijayanagara, Michell comments (1995:276) that it is indeed strange that the largest and most finely appointed temple of the area is utterly devoid of any foundational inscription. He believes that the probable reason is that the temple was sponsored and built by the pontiffs of the “ÜØgerÊ advaita maãha itself, in an attempt to gain prestige for their áaiva institution. As we have seen, from the late fifteenth century onwards the Vijayanagara regents switched their primary religious allegiance from “aivism to VaißÖavism, an allegiance also followed by family members, ministers and military commanders. This is reflected in the changed honorific signature and the erection of important new vaißÖava temple complexes in the sixteenth century (Michell 1995:276). It is suggested that, in this context, the Vidy§áaØkara temple was built to enhance the prestige of the site. It also seems probable, given the other evidence presented so far in this book, that around the time of the construction of the temple in the mid-sixteenth century, the legend of “aØkara founding pÊãha-s may first have been disseminated. -
Vaiy§sikaratnam§la). The Pañcadaái is attributed to both Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and Vidy§raÖya, and the JÊvanmuktiviveka is attributed to Vidy§raÖya (Venkataraman 1959:37–38), though the authorship of many of the texts attributed to Vidy§raÖya is problematic (see fn.126). 96 Annual Report of the Mysore Archaeological Department. 97 Epigraphs of 1346 and 1356 make no reference to any temple, and Michell doubts that a record of 1375 (ARSIE 1929, no. 460) from Ku·upu (near Mangalore), which refers to offerings to be made to the “aØkaradeva temple at “ÜØgerÊ, refers to the Vidy§áaØkara temple.
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
205
According to tradition, Vidy§raÖya is connected with both the founding and the success of the Vijayanagara project (UVAT1985:25). There are four early inscriptional references to Vidy§raÖya: in a copper-plate grant of 18th April 1336, the village of Y§ragu·i is renamed Vidy§raÖyapura (UVAT 1985:46, vv. 1–38),98 while in a grant made shortly afterwards,99 Harihara I is described (UVAT 1985:57, vv. 22–25)100 prostrating himself at the feet of the holy ascetic Vidy§raÖya, “comparable to Lord “iva Himself, the one of supreme austerity and devotion...”. In these inscriptions Vidy§raÖya is credited with assisting the SaØgamas in founding Vijayanagara in 1336. However, it is almost certain that these two copper-plate grants are spurious, being backdated (ARMAD 1934:139–142; Filliozat 1973:xiv–xv; Kulke 1985:123), as are two others, one dated 1370 (?), and another dated March 23rd 1344—twelve years before Bukka became king—in which king Bukka is exalted: seated on a bejewelled throne, he shines “in Vidy§, the city established by [the sage] Vidy§raÖya” (UVAT 1985:66, vv. 14–16). The first genuine epigraphic mention of Vidy§raÖya is dated October 25th 1375 (ARMAD “g. 1933:226; Filliozat 1973:xxx, fn. 1). On this date a grant was made by Bukka—during the incumbency of the governance of Mangalore by PaÖ·arideva—[to] “the holy feet of Vidy§raÖya of “ÜØgerÊ” (UVAT 1985:60, v. 1), who had by now, it is assumed, become pontiff of the maãha.101 This would agree with a ka·ita102 of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha that states that Bh§ratÊtÊrtha died in 1374 (ARMAD “g. 1933:226–227). The land-grant was for the feeding of Brahmans and daily offerings to Lord Vidy§áaØkara, the deity later housed in the temple built in honour of Vidy§tÊrtha. Saletore (1935:41) believes inscriptions indicate that it was to Vidy§tÊrtha, and not to Vidy§raÖya, that the SaØgamas credited their success,103 even though
98 According to this copper-plate inscription (vv. 27–28)—the ‘Bestarahalli’ grant—this was the date of Harihara’s coronation, in the presence of the god Viråp§kßa and his consort Pamp§. 99 The ‘K§paluru’ grant. 100 See also EC (X, no. 70:241). 101 Other grants were made: in 1377, in the presence of Vidy§raÖya of “ÜØgerÊ; in 1378, under the orders of Vidy§raÖya (UVAT 1985:89, 93). 102 A ka·ita is a long piece of cloth covered with paste, and used for records (see Shastry 1982:9–12). 103 A copper-plate grant dated 1377 states that Bukka O·eya was born to free the land of mleccha-s, and became the sole lord of the earth by the grace of Vidy§tÊrthas-
206
chapter six
in later tradition the honour goes to ParamahaÒsa Parivr§jak§c§rya Vidy§raÖya “rÊp§da. Vidy§raÖya is also credited with the authorship of numerous works, but we shall see that, besides his genuine works, others are not of his authorship, but credited to him in the mistaken belief that he was named M§dhava before he took saÒny§sa. The evidence indicates that it was the triumvirate of Vidy§tÊrtha (Vidy§áaØkara), Bh§ratÊtÊrtha (Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha) and Vidy§raÖya who are intimately connected with the politics of the early Vijayanagaras, Vidy§raÖya perhaps awarded the gaddÊ of “ÜØgerÊ as a reward for his manifestation of showers of gold, if the legend has some historical basis. This seems not improbable, given the evidence, previously reviewed, of the considerable wealth of the áaiva maãha-s in previous centuries. In the aforementioned inscription of May 26th 1386 (UVAT 1985:116, vv. 10–11) the three sages are mentioned together, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha, as the disciple of Vidy§tÊrtha, “coming to full bloom in the rays of the sun that is sage Vidy§raÖya”. While there is inscriptional evidence for the association of the triumvirate with the (TuØga) “ÜØgerÊ maãha, they are also all claimed by the Ku·ali maãha at “ÜØgerÊ (Antarkar 2001:61–62). Vidy§tÊrtha is also claimed by the tradition of the K§ñcÊ maãha. The guru-parampar§ of the PuÖyaálokamañjarÊ , by Sarvajñasad§áivabodha (56th pontiff from 1524 to 1539), the earliest account of the pontiffs of the maãha, states that Vidy§tÊrtha, a disciple of Candracå·a,104 ruled there for seventythree years (from 1297 to 1370) as the fifty-first preceptor, retiring with his disciple, “aØkar§nanda, to the Himalayas, where he died (Rama Rao 1931:83).105 The fifty-second pontiff, according to the traditional account, was Vy§s§cala Mah§devendrasarasvatÊ, who may have been the author of one of the early hagiographies of “aØkara, the Vy§s§cala-“aØkaravijaya (see Ch. 5.1 fn. 8). As previously noted, the first mention of Vidy§raÖya in connection with “ÜØgerÊ is in an inscription of 1375; no earlier inscriptions at ,
v§mÊ. Another grant of 1380—which gives details of previous grants—relates that, in 1346 the five brothers (and Bukka O·eya in 1356) had gone to the senior “rÊp§da (Vidy§tÊrtha). Saletore (1935:41) believes this inscription and the other evidence referred to “demolishes the contention of all those who have erroneously maintained that Vidy§raÖya “rÊp§da was instrumental in the founding of the Empire of Vijayanagara”. 104 Vidy§tÊrtha was called SarvajñavißÖu, son of “araØgap§Öi of Biv§raÖya, before saÒny§sa. Also, Candracå·a was previously GaØgeáa according to this account. 105 See also Mallappa (1974:20); Kuppuswami and Seshadri (2001b:6).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
207
“ÜØgerÊ mention Vidy§raÖya, but only Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and Vidy§tÊrtha, who are mentioned in inscriptions, respectively, nearly thirty and nearly twenty years previously (Kulke 1985:130). In a copper-plate grant of 1380 (ARMAD 1916:57) it is recorded that Bukka had written a letter to Vidy§raÖya “rÊp§da, who was then in Banaras, requesting him to return to Viråp§kßa (HaÒpe). Vidy§raÖya returned to HaÒpe, from where he was taken to “ÜØgerÊ and granted land for his maintenance, in Kikunda-n§·u.106 Cikka, the son of Harihara (Harihara II), also granted land to Vidy§raÖya, as did Harihara II, who, in 1380, confirmed all previous grants that had been made (Saletore 1935:41; Kulke 1985:133). In an inscription dated November 25th 1384, Harihara II is described as having “acquired the empire of knowledge unattained by other kings ... by the grace of Vidy§raÖya muni” (UVAT 1985:108). Harihara II is also recorded in this inscription as having made a donation to two disciples of Vidy§raÖya: Sårappa and KÜßÖadeva. It was during the last two years of the reign of Bukka I, and then in the reign of Harihara II that Vidy§raÖya, most probably, was pontiff of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha, from October 1375 to his death on May 26th 1386.107 In 1386, before he died, Vidy§raÖya was present when Harihara II made a grant, recorded on copper-plate, to N§r§yaÖa V§japeya-yati, Narahari Somay§ji and PaÖ·ari DÊkßita, who are acknowledged as “Promoters of the Commentary on the Four Vedas”. On January 29th 1386, Vidy§raÖya made a land-grant to a lay attendant for the purposes of food offerings at the temple of GopÊn§tha (ARMAD 1934:139–141; UVAT 1985:111).108 Shortly after Vidy§raÖya’s death, 106 This particular account of Vidy§raÖya’s return from Banaras is repeated in the Guru-vaÒáa-k§vya and in a ka·ita at “ÜØgerÊ (ARMAD 1933:226–227). 107 The putative date of Vidy§raÖya’s succession is supported by a ka·ita at the “ÜØgerÊ maãha, which states that Bh§ratÊtÊrtha died in 1374 (ARMAD 1933:266ff.). However, the ka·ita records are not entirely reliable. The situation is further complicated by the existence of several other Vidy§raÖyas. One of them is mentioned at “ÜØgerÊ in 1515 (ARMAD 1916:18); another is the guru of a sv§mÊ at the Ku·ali maãha in 1591; Vidy§raÖya is claimed by some as the founder of the Ku·ali maãha; another Vidy§raÖya may have been a pontiff of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha at the time of KÜßÖadevar§ya (ARMAD 1933:146). Vidy§raÖya is also claimed as the founder of the Viråp§kßa maãha, as described in the Pußpagiri Maãh§mn§ya (see Anantendra Sarasvati 1968:386–387); also, several gurus of the $vaÖi maãha are called Vidy§raÖya (Rama Rao 1931:91). 108 A disciple of Vidy§raÖya named “aØkar§raÖya-“rÊp§da made an endowment to a temple at Chant§ru in the U·upi t§luk§ in 1402 (Annual Report on South-Indian Epigraphy 1928:81).
208
chapter six
Harihara II made further grants, in 1386, of land in KikuÖ·a-n§·u, which was named Vidy§raÖyapura in his honour (ARMAD 1933:134– 146). Significantly, in an inscription dated May 3rd 1384 (UVAT 1985:102) Vidy§raÖya is referred to as KrÊy§áakti-Vidy§raÖya,109 indicating the probability that Vidy§raÖya was a K§l§mukha before his accession to the “ÜØgerÊ gaddÊ, a ga··Ê that had already been occupied by Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and Vidy§tÊrtha, Ved§ntins who represented a new orthodox tradition. While Bh§ratÊtÊrtha’s religious background is uncertain, Vidy§tÊrtha was almost certainly a maheávara (see below). We have seen that Vidy§tÊrtha and Bh§ratÊtÊrtha are mentioned in a number of inscriptions dating from 1346. However, as Vidy§raÖya is first mentioned in 1375, it seems highly improbable that he was associated with the founding of Vijayanagara or a maãha. It seems that his active role in the 1330s and 1340s was projected back from a later age (Kulke 1985:128). Also central to this period of early Vijayanagara religious history are S§yaÖa and M§dhava, the latter often being identified erroneously with Vidy§raÖya. M§dhava’s identity is further complicated by the existence of at least one other contemporary with the same name. Concerning the identities of M§dhava and S§yaÖa, there is an inscription (UVAT 1985:34), unfortunately undated, at the AruϧÏaPerum§Ï temple at K§ñcÊpuram. This record is dedicated to S§yaÖa, of the Bh§radv§ja gotra, S§yaÖa being the famous commentator on the Veda-s. His mother “rÊm§yÊ is named; as are his father, MayaÖa; his younger brother, Bhogan§tha; and his elder brother, M§dhava. This M§dhava, of the Bh§radv§ja gotra, and the brother of S§yaÖa, is one of the great mediaeval commentators on dharmaá§stra, whose fame in the south stands second only to “aØkar§c§rya (Kane HD“, Vol.1, part 2:779). For the purposes of explication, this M§dhava will be henceforth referred to as M§dhava [B]. (Futher on in this section we will consider the identity of another M§dhava, who will be referred to as M§dhava [A].)110
109 This has been interpreted by some as referring to two individuals, but the text (UVAT 1985:98, l.1–7) seems to indicate one person, as the relevant case endings are in the singular. 110 The distinction between M§dhava [A] and M§dhava [B] was first clearly analysed and demonstrated by Narasimhachar (1916a; 1916b; 1917). It was further commented on by Rama Rao (1930; 1931; 1934), and subsequently endorsed by Kulke (1985).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
209
During the middle of the fourteenth century, M§dhava [B]—sometimes referred to as M§dhava-§c§rya—served as a minister and advisor to Bukka I.111 According to Rama Rao (1930:703), there are five works that may be attributed with some certainty to this M§dhava, who was philosophically orientated to advaita.112 This M§dhava [B] has also been identified with the author of the “aØkara-dig-vijaya, the most well-known of the hagiographies of “aØkara. In the opening verse of the “DV, the author pays obeisance to his guru, Vidy§tÊrtha. This work was originally entitled SaÒkßepa-“aØkara-jaya, and in some current printed editions113 is attributed to M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya. The colophons at the conclusion of each of the sixteen chapters of the “DV state that the work was written by M§dhava (not M§dhavaVidy§raÖya). But this author could not have written the text before 1650 (Sawai 1985; Bader 2000:54–55), several centuries after the time of both M§dhava [B] and Vidy§raÖya. The identification of M§dhava [B] with Vidy§raÖya has led to numerous works being wrongly attributed to M§dhava [B] (Rama Rao 1930:705–706).114
111 Due to the erroneous identification of M§dhava with Vidy§raÖya (see below), it has sometimes been assumed that M§dhava/Vidy§raÖya was also a minister to Harihara I, Bukka I and Harihara II (see, for example, Venkataramanayya [Majumdar] 1990, 4th edn., Vol. 6:323) 112 P§r§áarasmÜti-vy§khy§ (P§r§áaram§dhavÊya), Vyavah§ra-m§dhava, K§lam§dhavÊya (K§lanirÖaya), JÊvanmuktiviveka, and JaiminÊyany§m§l§vistara (which examines the såtras of Jaimini). The P§r§áaram§dhavÊya and Vyavah§ra-m§dhava provide rules on dharma, while the K§lam§dhavÊya is concerned with the requisite timing for dharmic acts. The P§r§áaram§dhavÊya considers renunciate life, but primarily for the three lower classes of renouncers. The JÊvanmuktiviveka focusses on the life of the paramahaÒsa, the highest type of renouncer, and is also attributed to Vidy§raÖya (see Olivelle 1977, part II:25; Vidy§raÖya 1996: Translator’s Preface), owing to the frequent but problematic identification of M§dhava with Vidy§raÖya (see below). Vidy§raÖya salutes Vidy§tÊrtha, one of the first pontiffs of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha, in the opening stanza of this work. 113 The $nand§árama edition. 114 Such as Vidy§m§dhavÊya, M§dhavanid§na and Sarva-daráana-saÒgraha. Some scholars, such as Lorenzen (1983), have revised their former opinion (also held by Hacker 1995:ch. 1) that the author of the Sarva-daráana-saÒgraha and the “aØkara-digvijaya were one and the same person, namely M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya. The evidence indicates that M§dhava [B] was certainly not the author of the “DV, and probably not the author of the Sarva-daráana-saÒgraha, an account of the sixteen systems of philosophy that espouses advaita as the ‘highest’ philosophy. In this work it is stated both that the author is S§yaÖa-M§dhava, and also M§dhava, “the Kaustubhajewel of the milk-ocean of the fortunate S§yaÖa” (M§dhava-$ch§rya 1882:1.3–4). It has been suggested that this work may have been by M§dhava [C], also known as M§yaÖa, one of the two sons of S§yaÖa, who was neither M§dhava [A] (see
210
chapter six
In his seven known works,115 which include his Vedic commentaries, S§yaÖa also provides corroborating information concerning his family, mentioning his parents, his younger brother Bhogan§tha, and his elder brother, M§dhava [B]. S§yaÖa116 first lived at the court of Prince Kampa (a younger brother of Harihara I), in the east of Vijayanagara, and then, following KaÒpa’s death, served as advisor and minister to his young son, SaØgama II, who became ruler of the eastern province. M§dhava [B] became the mah§-mantrin (Kane Vol.1, pt.2:789), and Bhogan§tha a minister-chamberlain for SaØgama II (UVAT 1985:80–83).117 This latter inscription, of 1356, was composed by Bhogan§tha, who states his veneration for the preceptor “rÊkaÖãhan§tha,118 a áaiva advaitin who lived in the early twelfth century (Suryanarayana Sastri 1930:1–35; Nagaswamy 1982:97). This “rÊkaÖãha, who is also referered to in an inscription as a K§l§mukha,119 was most probably the r§ja-guru of Vikrama CÙÏa (c.1121) (Rajamanickam 1964:229; Nagaswamy 1998:35).120
below), governor of Banavase (and minister to Harihara I, Bukka I and Harihara II), nor M§dhava [B], minister to Bukka I (Rama Rao 1930:714; Venkataraman 1959:34). The author of the SDS (1.2) states that he daily follows his guru SarvajñaVißÖu, son of “§raØgap§Öi, who knows all the $gama-s, thus ruling out M§dhavas [A] and [B]. However, a most insightful analysis by Thakur (1961) indicates that the author of the SDS was Cannibhaããa (Cinna or Cennu), son of Sahajasarvajña VißÖu Bhaããop§dhyaya, who was also a preceptor to S§yaÖa and M§dhava [B]. Cannibhaããa was a younger contemporary of S§yaÖa and M§dhava, author of a sub-commentary on the Pañcap§dik§vivaraÖa, and worked in the Vijayanagara court under the patronage of Harihara Mah§r§ja The SDS shares many passages and quotations from Cannibhaããa’s other works. Thakur suggests that the plan of the work may have originated with M§dhava, and been written by Cannibhaããa, with the help of S§yaÖa and M§dhava. 115 Subh§ßita-sudh§nidhi, Pr§yaácitta-sudh§nidhi (Karmavip§ka), AlaØkara-sudh§nidhi, Dh§tuvÜtti, Puruߧrtha-sudh§nidhi, Yajñatantra-sudh§nidhi. 116 ‘S§yaÖa’ also was not an uncommon name during the period under consideration. Filliozat (1973:xxxi) records six different S§yaÖas from inscriptions, son of Harihara I, son of Kampa I, son of Bukka I, son of M§rappa, son of Kampa II, and minister of Kampana I. 117 Rama Rao (1930:711), however, doubts that M§dhava served SaØgama II, believing that, at Vijayanagara, M§dhava was only ever a minister of Bukka I. 118 This “rÊkaÖãha (n§tha) is not to be confused with the “rÊkaÖãha who was the preceptor of the P§áupatas. 119 Epigraphia Carnatica VII (Shikapur), 99 (1113 CE). 120 “rÊkaÖãha, like “aØkara, R§m§nuja and Madhva ($nandatÊrtha), commented on the Brahmasåtra of B§dar§yaÖa, and spearheaded the non-dualist “iv§dvaita school, which is particularly important in the south, and is based on his commentary, the “rÊkaÖãha-bh§ßya. These four philosophers could be considered as the most influential
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
211
Having served mah§maÖ·aleávara-s in the eastern provinces, S§yaÖa and M§dhava then appear to have moved to Vijayanagara and both became ministers to Bukka I, but in different capacities. S§yaÖa lived to see Bukka II’s son, Harihara II, enthroned as king of Vijayanagara, in 1377, and died during the latter’s reign. S§yaÖa’s guru was Vidy§tÊrtha. In S§yaÖa’s Vedic commentaries and some other later works, the term “M§dhavÊya” occurs in the colophon. However, it is clear from the introductory verses of the Puruߧrthasudh§nidhi and theYajurveda-bh§ßya that M§dhava was approached by Bukka I to write the texts, but M§dhava entrusted their composition to his younger brother, S§yaÖa (Rama Rao 1930:709). There is also no evidence, apart from a copper-plate in§m of dubious authenticity,121 that different sections of the Veda-bh§ßya were written by a team of Brahmans under the guidance of S§yaÖa. A reference was made previously to three Brahmans who received grants at “ÜØgerÊ in 1386 for their commentaries on the four Veda-s. However, S§yaÖa does not acknowledge anyone’s assistance in his works (Kulke 1985:131), and this gift to Brahmans does not necessarily indicate that S§yaÖa was assisted in his commentaries. The works of S§yaÖa and M§dhava [B] also indicate that M§dhava [B] was also a minister to Bukka II (one of the three sons of Harihara II), who asked both S§yaÖa and M§dhava to compose treatises on the Veda-s, Pur§Öa-s and SmÜti-s. Besides M§dhava [B], it is also apparent that there was another M§dhava, [A], who was governor of Banavasi (Goa), and the author of T§tparyadÊpik§, a commentary on the SåtasaÒhit§. On his instruction, Brahmans were brought from Andhra Pradesh and Kashmir, and settled with land in Karnataka (Rama Rao 1930:709 fn. 1). From several inscriptions, including one from Goa, dated 1391, it
philosophers up until the fourteenth century, their systems being the subject of a commentary, Catur-mata-leáa-saÒgraha, by Appaya DÊkßit§, who flourished in the latter half of the sixteenth century. “rÊkaÖãha was a contemporary, or near contemporary, of R§m§nuja, with whom he had many philosophical similarities, both of their systems being variants of viáißã§dvaita. But for minor details, the philosophy of “rÊkaÖãha is essentially advaita. “rÊkaÖãha is associated with Cidambaram, though may have come from the north (Suryanarayana Sastri 1930:16, 28, 73, 285). He may have come from the GÙÏakÊ maãha (ARE 1936, para. 19 [1986:67]). The significance of support by the Vijayanagara rulers for particular advaita traditions is discussed below. 121 The authenticity of this copper-plate, of 1386, is doubted as it refers to Vidy§raÖya as living some months after his death (Rama Rao 1930:711).
212
chapter six
is known that his parents were M§c§mbik§ and CauÖ·abhaããa; that he served as minister to Harihara I, Bukka I and Harihara II, from 1347 to 1391; and that his guru was K§áÊvil§sa Kriy§áakti (Filliozat 1973:136).122 M§dhava [A] was also minister to prince M§rappa, the younger brother of Harihara I. In 1368, this M§dhava mantrin is twice described in inscriptions as “depending on king Bukka’s lotus feet”, something that a saÒny§sÊ would never state. This M§dhava [A] also clearly never became Vidy§raÖya (Kulke 1985:128). According to tradition at “ÜØgerÊ (Venkataraman 1959:28–39; Sawai 1985), S§yaÖa is the elder brother of Vidy§raÖya, and this and other references are explained by claiming that Vidy§raÖya was called M§dhava before his taking saÒny§sa from Vidy§áaØkaratÊrtha (=Vidy§tÊrtha), the tenth jagadguru of “ÜØgerÊ, Vidy§raÖya becoming the twelfth jagadguru, after Bh§ratÊtÊrtha. The editors of UVAT (1985:33), in accord with the “ÜØgerÊ tradition,123 also maintain that S§yaÖa was named Bh§ratÊtÊrtha after saÒny§sa and that the M§dhava §c§rya [B] who became Vidy§raÖya was different from the M§dhava mantrin [A] of the $Øgirasa gotra who was Provincial Governor of the area that is now Goa. However, the claim of tradition that M§dhava [B] became Vidy§raÖya is impossible, not least because M§dhava [B] praises, as his guru, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha, who, according to tradition, would have been his brother with a new name. While there seems to be no doubt that there were at least two M§dhavas (one of the $Øgirasa gotra [M§dhava A], and the other of the Bh§radv§ja gotra [M§dhava B]), both of whom were closely involved with the Vijayanagara rulers, it is apparent from a careful consideration of both the literary and the epigraphic evidence that neither of the M§dhavas changed their name to become Vidy§raÖya, the saÒny§sÊ (Rama Rao 1930:712–717; Filliozat 1973:135; Kulke 1985:129–132).124 In the five authentic works of M§dhava [B], partic-
122
Inscription no.146. See Venkataraman (1959:29). 124 One of the most useful studies of the M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya identity issue is presented by Rama Rao (1930; 1931; 1934; 2000). See also Raghavan (1976). Besides M§dhava [A] and [B], Vidy§raÖya has also been identified with Vidy§m§dhava—son of N§r§yaÖapåjyap§da of the Vasißãha gotra, author of Vidy§m§dhavÊya, an astronomical work—and with M§dhava, son of Indukara, author of the medical work of the sixteenth century, M§dhava-vid§na (Rama Rao 1931:82). Another M§dhava, VeØkaãa M§dhava, wrote a commentary on the Œg Veda, the Œgartha-dÊpik§, a work composed on the banks of the K§verÊ river at the time of the inauguration of the 123
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
213
ular features are common: invocatory verses addressed to Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and Vidy§tÊrtha, and references to his first work, P§r§áarasmÜtivy§khya, in which full details of his parentage are given. He also calls himself a minister (am§tya), and the bearer of the burden of sovereignty of Bukka (Kulke 1985:128). It is also apparent that M§dhava [B] was a married householder and a performer of Vedic sacrifices. In one inscription of 1377 (Mysore Archaeological Report 1915:42), M§yaÖÖa the son of M§dhava is mentioned, while the “ivatattva-ratn§kara (dated to 1709) describes M§dhava as having sons and grandsons (Rama Rao 1931:82). Throughout the works of M§dhava [B], it is Bukka I who is mentioned as his patron; no mention is made of either Harihara I or Harihara II. The inscriptions mentioning Vidy§raÖya, however, are all of the reign of Harihara II. Moreover, the tradition relating to Vidy§raÖya, including the narratives of Nuniz and Ferishta, depicts Vidy§raÖya as having taken saÒny§sa before Bukka I came to the throne, and as having gained the throne for Harihara I by dint of his spiritual power. Also, according to the literary tradition of the maãha-s, Vidy§raÖya was a poor Brahman, unable to marry.125 The Vidy§raÖya-k§lajñ§, “ivatattva-ratn§kara and Guru-vaÒáa-k§vya also speak of Vidy§raÖya setting Harihara on the throne, yet M§dhava makes no mention of either Harihara I or Harihara II. The married M§dhava (who performs Vedic sacrifice, necessarily with his wife) and the saÒny§sÊ Vidy§raÖya cannot be the same person in the same period of time, in the reign of Bukka I, or later. Further, M§dhava [B] refers to himself as M§dhava in all his works. If he had become Vidy§raÖya at any time, he would have been prohibited, according to the rules of saÒny§sa, from referring to himself by his pre-saÒny§sa name. Yet M§dhava never refers to himself anywhere, even by allusion, as Vidy§raÖya. Nor is an identity made between M§dhava and Vidy§raÖya in the works by the other M§dhavas previously referred to, nor in several other works from the next couple of centuries that refer to either M§dhava or Vidy§raÖya. As already observed, S§yaÖa lived into the reign of Harihara II, yet
CÙÏa empire in the tenth century under Par§ntaka I (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:124); and yet another M§dhava, M§dhavatÊrtha, a disciple of $nandatÊrtha, became a vaißÖava pontiff around 1333 (Sewell and Aiyangar 1932:184 [EI, vi, 260]). 125 According to the MaÖimañjarÊbhedinÊ and Guru-vaÒáa-k§vya (Rama Rao 1934:804).
214
chapter six
S§yaÖa refers to his brother as a performer of Vedic sacrifices, and not as a saÒny§sÊ, nor as Vidy§raÖya. Also, as previously observed, M§dhava invokes Bh§ratÊtÊrtha as his guru, yet Vidy§raÖya does not once refer to Bh§ratÊtÊrtha. Vidy§raÖya, in his works,126 instead acknowledges Vidy§tÊrtha and his guru “aØkar§nanda.127 Despite the fact that Vidy§raÖya’s importance and role in the affairs of Vijayanagara was most probably projected back from a later time, it is clear from inscriptional and other evidence that Vidy§tÊrtha, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha, Vidy§raÖya, S§yaÖa and M§dhava [B] played a highly significant role in the Hindu religious revival under the Vijayanagaras, primarily represented in the advaita-Ved§nta tradition established at “ÜØgerÊ. We now turn to the issue of “aØkara’s putative involvement with that tradition.
6.5 “aØkara and the founding of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha Tradition associates the founding of “ÜØgerÊ and the other main maãha-s with “aØkara. However, an examination of “aØkara’s hagiographies, undertaken in the previous chapter, revealed that there is no evidence for this in the earlier hagiographies. We will see that inscriptional evidence also reveals no connection between “aØkara
126 Anubhåti-prak§ßa,VivaraÖa-prameya-saÒgraha and Pañcadaái. The authorship of the Pañcadaái is slighly problematic, as the author first pays salutations to the lotus feet of his guru, “rÊ “aØkar§nanda (Vidy§raÖya 1975:1.1). According to tradition (Venkatraman 1959:52), “aØkar§nandabh§ratÊ was the sixteenth pontiff of “ÜØgerÊ, taking saÒny§sa in 1428, and occupying the gaddÊ from 1448 to 1454. We have seen that Vidy§raÖya died in 1386, so for his guru to have been “aØkar§nanda would have been impossible. Numerous other works are attributed to Vidy§raÖya (see UVAT 1985:23–24). Vidy§raÖya’s literary activity was exaggerated in later times, first occuring in the Vidy§raÖya-k§lajñ§na, a work of semi-prophesy, composed between around 1664—after the collapse of the Vijayanagara empire—and 1709. In this work Vidy§raÖya is credited with initially composing numerous works that were then written by S§yaÖa and M§dhava, including the Veda-bh§ßya. This attribution to Vidy§raÖya is repeated in the eighteenth century Guru-vaÒáa-k§vya. Vidy§raÖya’s hagiography is contained in the MaÖi-mañjari-bhedinÊ, where he is identified with M§dhava and credited with the authorship of many works. M§dhava’s identity with Vidy§raÖya is propounded in several other works emanating from the “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊ maãha-s (Rama Rao 1931:80). 127 There is one tradition that links Vidy§raÖya with Tantra, indicated in a list of the heads of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha, in the Gady§vali, a work on Tantric ritual by Nij§tmaprak§áayogÊndra (Antarkar 2001:48).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
215
and either the founding or early history of any maãha. We have seen that the early pontiffs of “ÜØgerÊ were áaiva, and we will also see that the K§ñcÊpuram maãha appears to have been consistently áaiva. “rÊkaÖãha(n§tha), a r§ja-guru and an important advaita “aiva-Siddh§nta philosopher in the twelfth century, will be again mentioned in this section. It will be suggested that he can be seen as a transitional figure in the shift from $gamic “aivism—represented by the previously powerful K§l§mukhas, Mattamayåras and “aiva-Siddh§ntins—to a new Brahmanical advaita institution that was established at “ÜØgerÊ. “aØkara has been shown to be vaißÖava, and it will become evident that his immediate disciples were also vaißÖava. It will also be argued that it is improbable that “aØkara inaugurated either devÊ worship or the sm§rta tradition at “ÜØgerÊ, with which tradition credits him. Finally, it will be suggested that “aØkara’s projection onto the “ÜØgerÊ project, and the attachment of specific legends to his name concerning the founding of maãha-s and the instigation of an order of ascetics, developed in a three-stage process. We will first consider the earliest evidence of any maãha at “ÜØgerÊ. The two oldest inscriptions at “ÜØgerÊ, found in the P§rávan§tha basti, date from 1150 and 1160. The first praises the Jina-á§sana, and the second contains information about a donation from Jaina merchants, indicating that Jainism was established in “ÜØgerÊ in the twelfth century (Kulke 1985:132). It is known that the South Kanara district of Karnataka was long a stronghold of Jainism, which received considerable patronage after the advent of Hoysala power (Ramesh 1970:298). A Hoysala feudatory, Lokan§thadevarasa, was a Jaina, and an inscription from 1334 records land-grants to the basti of “§ntin§tha, built at K§rakaÏa by the disciples of the Jaina preceptor Kumudacandra-bhaãã§rakadeva. The $Ïupa ruler, Kulaáekhara III, was also an active supporter of Jainism, as shown by inscriptions dated 1384 at Må·abidure, when he made grants to the Jaina tÊrthaØkara P§rávan§tha, and worshipped at the feet of the Jaina preceptor C§rukÊrti. However, the $Ïupas were predominantly áaiva, as were the early Vijayanagara rulers. The first record of any kind concerning an advaita presence at “ÜØgerÊ dates to 1346 (UVAT 1985:71–73), an inscription in which obeisance to “ambhu (“iva) and Vidy§tÊrtha is stated. It records the visit of the five brothers—on the occasion of the vijayotsava—and the donation of land for the maintenance of Bh§ratÊtÊrtha (who, as we have seen, is an advaita-ved§ntin), his disciples and forty Brahmans.
216
chapter six
But this inscription only refers to “ÜØgerÊ as a tÊrtha, and not as a having a maãha. The first mention of a maãha at “ÜØgerÊ is in 1356, when Bukka I donated villages for the maintenance of those at the “ÜØgerÊ maãha (Kulke 1985:132).128 While we cannot be certain that there was no advaita maãha at “ÜØgerÊ much before 1356, some circumstantial evidence may indicate the former presence of Jainas, as Bh§ratÊtÊrtha is praised as having demolished the teachings of the Jainas and Buddhists.129 An outstanding puzzle is the precise sectarian situation at “ÜØgerÊ just before the founding of a maãha. As mentioned previously, Vidy§tÊrtha left no written works. But in both texts and inscriptions, Vidy§tÊrtha is referred to as a Maheávara,130 which may possibly indicate a “aiva-Siddh§ntin. However, as noted at the beginning of this section, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha did leave a text, which is advaita-ved§ntin in perspective. The exact processes which led to the establishing of an advaita-ved§nta monastic tradition are hard to determine. From the time of the first recorded Vijayanagara grant to “ÜØgerÊ, in 1346, until Vidy§raÖya’s death in 1386, donations to the advaita maãha increased enormously, multiplying approximately five-fold in that period, indicating the importance of “ÜØgerÊ to the Vijayanagara rulers.131 However, neither the grant of 1380, previously referred to, confirming all previous grants, nor any other inscription, give any indication that there was any kind of institution at the site receiving any kind of income prior to the first grants in 1346. The “ÜØgerÊ
128
Tradition credits Vidy§raÖya with establishing eight advaita maãha-s, but this remains uncorroborated. Besides “ÜØgerÊ two other advaita maãha-s are known from records, one being the Vidy§raÖya-sv§mÊ maãha, centred on a well, and located to the west of the Viråp§kßa temple at Vijayanagara. This maãha was associated with the “ÜØgerÊ maãha and is referred to in an inscription of KÜßÖadevar§ya from 1515, but the date of the foundation of themaãha is uncertain and disputed. The head of the maãha in the 1990s, NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ, traces his lineage from Vidy§raÖya. The other advaita maãha is the Cint§maÖi maãha in $negondi, believed to have been established in the early fourteenth century (Verghese 1995:116). 129 Kulke (1985:133); ARMAD (1933:211–218, l.66ff.). 130 See Mallappa (1974:28): Vidy§tÊrtha is referred to as a Maheávara in EC VI, “g 2, 5, 12, 14, 24, 28; in the works of S§yaÖa; at the end of every chapter of Anubhuti Prak§áa; the beginning and end of every part of the Veda-bh§ßya; at the beginning and end of JÊvanmuktiviveka; and in “aØkar§nanda’s BÜhad§raÖya-dÊpik§. 131 In the first ten years, from 1346 to 1356, the income from the villages at “ÜØgerÊ amounted to between 250 and 360 gady§Öa-s (=610 g.). During Vidy§raÖya’s stay at “ÜØgerÊ, income was between 1419 and 1871 gady§Öa-s (Kulke 1985:133).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
217
maãha continued to be endowed with grants by the later SaØgamas, Bukka II giving an endowment for the maintenance of the library there in 1406. More land was given by Devar§ya II in 1431, and by Mallik§rjuna in 1451. The N§yakas of KeÏadi (Shimoga district) established an independent state from 1499 to 1763, and continued the support of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha originally instituted by the Vijayanagaras (Shastry 1987). As we have seen, the Vijayanagara inscriptions bestow praise on various deities, including “iva, GaÖeáa, Viråp§kßa and R§macandra; and the §c§rya-s “rÊkaÖãhan§tha, Vidy§tÊrtha, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha and Vidy§raÖya. Given that the eulogies in many of the inscriptions are quite lengthy, and considering that “aØkara is so intimately connected to “ÜØgerÊ in later tradition, it is remarkable that “aØkar§c§rya is not mentioned in any inscription. In an inscription of 1346 praise is bestowed on Vidy§tÊrtha, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha, and on Vidy§raÖya’s knowledge of advaya (advaita) (UVAT 1985:116, v. 10), yet “aØkara, later so particularly associated with advaita, is not mentioned. In a ka·ita copy of Harihara’s inscription of 1380, Bh§ratÊtÊrtha is praised for defeating Bhaããa (Kum§rila), but here also no mention is made of “aØkara (Kulke 1985:134), who, as recalled, defeated Kum§rila in debate in the hagiographies. Shastry (1982:7) also comments on the “rÊ-purußottama-bh§ratÊ-carita, the manuscript of which is to be found in the archives of “ÜØgerÊ. Composed by “VißÖu”, and belonging to the fifteenth century, the first three chapters give an account of the §c§rya-s of “ÜØgerÊ, from Vidy§áaØkara to Candraáekharabh§ratÊ II, and the other nine chapters deal with Purußottamabh§ratÊ, until his assumption of the pontificate at HaÒpe, and his taking over the administration of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. Here also, remarkably, no mention is made of “aØkara. It was suggested in Chapter 5 that “aØkara was relatively unknown during his life-time, and probably for several centuries after, as there is no mention of him in Buddhist or Jaina sources for some centuries; nor is he mentioned by other important philosophers of the ninth and tenth centuries, notably the Ny§ya-Vaiáeßikas, áaiva adherents of a philosophy favoured, as we have seen, by the K§l§mukha r§ja-guru-s. Potter (1977, Vol. 1:15) remarks that even the advaita system scarcely receives any mention by Ny§ya-Vaiáeßikas until the time of “rÊharßa (c.1075–1125), who critiques Ny§ya and espouses Ved§nta. Our brief survey of the inscriptional evidence from “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊ also reveals no trace of the name of “aØkara, even in the four-
218
chapter six
teenth century, after the founding of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. It has been argued that “aØkara’s religious orientation was distinctly vaißÖava. However, the prime religious orientation of the early SaØgamas, their r§ja-guru-s, and the early advaita pontiffs, was distinctly áaiva. We have seen that Vidy§tÊrtha, the first pontiff claimed by “ÜØgerÊ to have any genuine inscriptional reference, is also referred to as a Maheávara, a sect which, as we have seen, was commented on by “aØkara with particular condemnation. If we examine the works of “aØkara’s immediate disciples it is also apparent, as first observed by Hacker (1995:38), that they and nearly all the early advaita philosophers up to the tenth century were vaißÖava, “in a restricted sense of the word”. This is apparent from the introductory invocations (maØgal§caraÖa) to the available works of “aØkara’s disciples. Toãaka begins his “rutis§ra-samuddh§raÖam with an invocation to Hari; Vy§sa is also mentioned.132 The other references in the text that might provide a specific clue to Toãaka’s religious orientation are in verse 85, where he refers to “rÊ R§ma; verse 148, where he refers to Hari (of the BhagavadgÊt§) as the teacher of all teachers; and the final verse, v. 179, where he bows down to Lord VißÖu. Toãaka makes no reference anywhere to “iva, and is particularly critical of the S§Òkhya, Ny§ya and Vaiáeßika systems.133 Sureávara also offers obeisance to VißÖu in the first verse of his Naißkarmyasiddhi,134 and refers to omniscient Hari at IV.64; at IV.76 he states that ““aØkara obtained through the power of his yoga the knowledge which reveals the abode of VißÖu and which destroys the entire world of bondage”. The Pañcap§dik§ , the work of Padmap§da135—another of “aØkara’s disciples—begins with three invocations.136 The first is to the eternal brahman; the second is to B§dar§yaÖa (author of the Ved§ntasåtra/ Brahmasåtra); the third is to his teacher “aØkara, who is described as being without the “enjoyment” of a family, or Um§, without vibhåti ,
132 See Comans (trans., 1996). The only other work attributed to Toãaka is the Toãak§ßãaka (Rajagopala Sastri 1968:63). 133 See, for example, vv. 140–141. 134 See Balasubramanian (trans., 1988). 135 This is his only known authentic work (Potter 1981, Vol. 3:563). 136 See Padmap§da (1948; 1989), Pañcap§dik§ (text in edition of Vedakavivamsam T. R. Srinivasan; trans. in edition by Venkataramiah).
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
219
(the sacred ashes worn by áaiva-s), of mild nature (unlike the ugra, ‘fierce’ form of “iva), and without Vin§yaka (i.e. GaÖapati). This description of “aØkara by one of his chief disciples seems to be overtly distinguishing the venerable teacher from any explicit connection with “iva or áaiva-s. This might be contrasted with a description of, for example, Sad§áivasarasvatÊ, pontiff of the K§ñcÊ maãha, who was referred to in an inscription of 1527 as an incarnation of “iva, wearing holy ash and rudr§kßa-m§l§. There is little in the Pañcap§dik§ to indicate Padmap§da’s religious orientation. However, at one point, when discussing Brahman (I.3.49)137 Padmap§da refers to the (transient) bliss of HiraÖyagarbhaloka (the abode of KÜßÖa), and then quotes from the BhagavadgÊt§. At Pañcap§dik§ II.5.12, Padmap§da refers to the sentient HiraÖyagarbha (the ‘Lord’ who is also subject to transmigration), beyond whom lies Brahman. No genuine works are available for Hast§malaka, “aØkara’s fourth disciple.138 Sarvajñ§tman, author of the SaØkßepaá§rÊraka, was a pupil of Sureávara. In the introductory invocation he invokes VißÖu,139 and then, having saluted Vy§sa, “rÊ “aØkara and “rÊ Sureávara (vv. 6–8), states that the obstacles [to writing the treatise] have been removed by “my preceptor’s contemplation on Lord N§r§yaÖa” (v. 10). Interestingly, as noted by Veezhinathan in his introduction to the text, Sarvajñ§tman140 is associated with the K§makoãi pÊãha at K§ñcÊ. According to tradition he took saÒny§sa directly from “aØkara, and was nominated successor to the maãha, with Sureávara, his preceptor, as his protector. However, is apparent that there is something odd about aspects of the traditional account here. As discussed in the previous chapter, in the “aØkarite tradition the K§makoãi pÊãha at K§ñcÊ is particularly associated with “aivism. This is substantiated in other sources also. Appar (seventh century), one of the sixty-three N§yaÖ§rs, refers to áaiva maãha-s at K§ñcÊ (Balambal 1999:32), and makes one of the earli-
137
Venkataramiah’s edition, p. 209. To Hast§malaka is attributed the Hast§malakaálok§È, but this is probably spurious (Potter 1981, Vol. 3:19). Amongst other important Ved§ntins, $nandabodha invokes VißÖu, while Vimukt§tman bows to his own self (Hacker 1995:38). 139 See Sarvajñ§tman (Veezhinathan trans., 1972). 140 Traditional dates for Sarvajñ§tman place him in the fourth century BCE, but if he was a disciple of Sureávara, he must be placed around the eighth or ninth century. 138
220
chapter six
est known references to K§m§kßÊ, the presiding deity of the K§makoãi pÊãha. Campantar, Appar’s contemporary, refers to “iva in union with K§makoãi of “Kacci”, which refers to K§m§kßÊ of K§ñcÊ. The áaiva bhakta Cuntarar, who lived in the eighth century, also refers to the k§makkoããam of K§ñcÊ (Nagaswamy 1982:204–207). The term k§makoãi was used, from the eleventh century onwards, to refer to ammaÖ shrines,141 but crucially, from the time of Appar, k§makoãi referred to the consort of “iva. The K§makoãi pÊãha, as currently constituted, was built during the reign of “rÊraØgar§ya in the late sixteenth century (Balambal 1999:39),142 though the present K§m§kßÊ temple may well be at the same site visited by Cuntarar (Nagaswamy 1982:207). As observed in the previous chapter, it was only in 1686 that the name “aØkar§c§rya first appears in inscriptions of the maãha. The earliest inscriptional records of the pontiffs of the K§ñcÊ maãha, dating from 1290, also clearly show that the pontiffs of the maãha were áaiva. Yet the first three advaita saÒny§sÊ-s claimed by the K§ñcÊ tradition, namely “aØkara, Sureávara and Sarvajñ§tman, are evidently vaißÖava. In the previous chapter, Hacker’s (1995:38–39) suggestion was considered, that the reason behind the rivalry between “aØkara and MaÖ·anamiára, as portrayed in the hagiographies of “aØkara, was most probably that MaÖ·anamiára was a áaiva, which would have been in distinction from almost all other advaita ved§ntin-s of the time (when, it should be added, religious affiliation was not a trivial affair). This is not to say that political or hagiographical expedience may not transcend religious sensibilities.
141 From the thirteenth century onwards, devÊ shrines, known as ammaÖ shrines, became a prominent feature of temple worship in Tamil Nadu. Although from at least the eighth century devÊ images in the temple were common, separate shrines for the devÊ as part of the temple complex were rare until the thirteenth century. Among the most important devÊ-s were Durg§, Jyeßãh§ (the fearsome sister of LakßmÊ), and the Sapta-M§tÜk§s. From the eleventh century onwards, the ammaÖ shrines were invariably called k§makoããam or tiruk§makoããam in all temples, whence the name of the K§makoãi pÊãha at K§ñcÊ. Folk goddeses, worshipped most probably since very ancient times at the village level, first started gaining prestige in south India in the CÙÏa period (985–1050). Absorbed into the religious practice of temple culture, devÊs were associated with both “aivism and VaißÖavism. After the eleventh century, ammaÖ shrines, those devoted to P§rvatÊ or Um§, gradually replaced other, older devÊ shrines. By the fourteenth century, most “iva temples had such a shrine, known as a k§makoããam. DevÊ, with many names, also appeared as the consort of VißÖu in the main vaißÖava centres of south India, enjoying a universalisation in the company of Pur§Öic deities (Stein 1973:77–80; Nagaswamy 1982:204–206; Stein 1999:238). 142 ARE 1954–1959:no. 349.
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
221
Regarding the various traditions that were to become subsumed under the umbrella of ‘Hindu’—a process that properly began in the early sixteenth century—pre-Muslim religious orientation in India was distinctly sectarian and non-universalist. The significance of this, in the context of religious identity, will be explored in the following chapter. An analysis of a manual on påj§ for priests (Påj§pad-paddhati), the eleventh-century Somaáambhu-paddhati of Somaáambhu (probably south Indian), is pertinent in this respect. The removal of liØga (internal ‘marks’ of a previous religion) was a fundamental process in initiation into “aivism; there was no question of ‘equality of faiths’, as the removal of the liØga removed all the merit that may have been acquired while following the previous creed (Stietencron 1995:56–63). As there is considerable evidence that “aØkara and his immediate disciples were vaißÖava, there is all the more reason to doubt their connection with the early monastic tradition of either “ÜØgerÊ or K§ñcÊpuram. The monastic traditions that developed at “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊpuram, as represented in the works that we have at our disposal from the hand of the early known (as opposed to hagiographically presented) pontiffs, were essentially and distinctly orthodox. As has been indicated, they were essentially áaiva, yet, in accord with Brahmanical tradition, sm§rta orthodoxy was demonstrated by their acknowledgement of the Veda as the ultimate source of knowledge. In this, the advaita pontiffs and their strictly Brahmanical cohorts were somewhat distinct from the K§l§mukhas, Mattamayåras and “aivaSiddh§ntins who had been so influential and powerful in previous centuries.143 These sects, while accepting the Veda, as we have seen, laid prime emphasis on the $gama. They did not deny the authority of other texts to other traditions: simply, religious traditions were hierarchised, and within their own orders, $gamic “aivism was at the apex. After the fourteenth century the influence and estates of the K§l§mukha and Mattamayåra orders significantly declined, their role to a significant extent being eclipsed by the new and heavily patronised sm§rta advaita maãha-s. The sm§rta tradition, centred on “ÜØgerÊ, may have also been competing with “rÊ-VaißÖavism. Suryanaran Sastri (1930:42, 74) remarks
143 It may be noted that the áaiva sects under discussion were also significantly inflenced by Tantra (see Lorenzen 1991:3–7).
222
chapter six
that under the CÙÏas VaißÖavism had found little favour, but that there is evidence that the influence of R§m§nuja’s movement, open to all castes,144 engendered a new aggression by vaißÖava-s against áaiva-s.145 Haradatta (d.1119), for example, was forced to defend his áaiva teachings in public, seated on a red-hot tripod, and wrote the Hari-hara-t§ratamya, which Sastri (1930:74) describes as “a monument of sectarianism, such as could have been called forth only by the intolerant spirit of a religion on the upward and onward march”. It was previously noted that one of the most important philosophers of the early mediaeval period was the áaiva advaitin “rÊkaÖãha, a K§l§mukha (also referred to as a “aiva-Siddh§ntin) who most probably lived in the early twelfth century. He is mentioned in a Vijayanagara inscription (UVAT 1985:80–83) as a teacher of Bhogan§tha (minister to SaØgama II), and as a form of Paáupati who expounds a new Maheávara doctrine (vv. 12–13). “rÊkaÖãha argued for the authority both of the Veda (including the Upanißad-s) and the áaiva $gama-s, and his role in attempting to harmonise the two traditions has been compared with a parallel task undertaken by R§m§nuja—around the same time as “rÊkaÖãha—to harmonise P§ñcar§tra $gama with the Veda (Suryanarayana Sastri 1930:11). A crucial difference, of course, is that while the six-fold path of the áaiva $gama-s is open to all varÖa-s, the Veda is only for the ears of the twice-born. The áaiva-orientated advaita of “rÊkaÖãha may be understood as the bridge between the more Tantric K§l§mukhas and the orthodox sm§rta áaiva tradition that developed at the advaita maãha-s sponsored by the Vijayanagaras. It is perhaps partly in response to the situation outlined above that the early hagiographers found “aØkara’s orthodox Vedic position146 and philosophical erudition so suitable for elaboration into a digvijaya. “aØkara’s orthodox position would, of course, have been fully acceptable to Brahmans. We now turn, finally, to the tradition that “aØkara inaugurated both sm§rta and devÊ worship at “ÜØgerÊ. The predominant practice
For the role, status and social mobility of áådra-s in the early “rÊ-VaißÖava movement, see Stein (1968). 145 The reformist zeal of R§m§nuja may have contributed to the rivalry there between áaiva-s and vaißÖava-s for royal patronage (Champakalakshmi 1996:397– 398). 146 For “aØkara’s relationship to Vedic orthodoxy, see Rambachan (1991). 144
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
223
of the “ÜØgerÊ maãha is sm§rta,147 being the Brahman tradition of the worship of five deities, pañcayatana-påj§, namely $ditya (Sårya), Ambik§ (DevÊ), VißÖu, GaÖeáa and “iva. At “ÜØgerÊ a sixth deity, Kum§ra (Skanda, SubrahmaÖya, MurugaÖ), is also worshipped. Sm§rta adherents have as ißãa-devat§ either “iva or VißÖu.148 “aØkara is credited by tradition with the initiation of sm§rta worship149 at “ÜØgerÊ (Sawai 1992:23), yet our previous analysis of his religious orientation revealed his ranking of devÊ and GaÖapati worship as of the lowest order (alongside bhåta-s), and his distaste for “iva, making it highly improbable that he initiated this form of áakti worship at “ÜØgerÊ—as projected by his hagiographers—or instituted sm§rta worship. It seems that his association with devÊ worship was a result of his projection by his hagiographers as a áaiva, with the complementary áakti worship inherent to áaiva traditions, particular in such sects as the K§l§mukhas. The advaita maãha-s of “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊ have presiding devÊ-s: “§rad§ and K§m§kßÊ, respectively. DevÊ worship has been, and continues to be, an integral feature of the worship of the maãha-s since the latter part of the fourteenth century, when the maãha-s began to receive Vijayanagara patronage. According to tradition, “aØkara installed “rÊ “§rad§ devÊ at “ÜØgerÊ, and a great festival in her name is performed in January to celebrate the anniversary of “aØkara’s inauguration of her worship at the “ÜØgerÊ maãha (also known as “rÊ “§rad§ pÊãha). “§rad§ is worshipped daily and also during the festival of Navar§tri (Sawai 1992:73). However, although “§rad§ is associated with both Dv§rak§ and “ÜØgerÊ, and while there is evidence of the
147
See Venkataraman (1959:136–165) for details of temples, shrines and worship at “ÜØgerÊ. See Dazey (1993:158–160) for the daily routine of the “aØkar§c§rya, and the festivals celebrated. 148 The two sectarian traditions are outwardly distinguished by, usually, either three horizontal lines of vibhåti on the forehead (tripuÖ·ra), for áaiva-s; or by three vertical marks (årdhvapuÖ·ra), usually of sandal-paste (candan), for vaißÖava-s. In south India, sm§rta-s generally follow the advaita tradition represented at “ÜØgerÊ, or the dvaita tradition represented by Madhva. There are at least twelve divisions amongst sm§rta-s, four of them being Va·agalai, and six of them being TeØgalai, the two main divisions of “rÊ-VaißÖavism (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:113). Sm§rta practice in Karnataka, in general, has long been to apply the tripuÖ·ra, but the followers of Madhva apply a distinguishing single vertical line (Zydenbos 2001:120). Most varieties of sectarian marking usually also include a red round dot (akßata) between the eyebrows, which represents áakti. 149 For details of sm§rta worship, see Bühnemann (1988).
224
chapter six
worship of Durg§ and LakßmÊ in Vijayanagara (Filliozat 1985:313), there is no mention of “§rad§ devÊ in any Vijayanagara inscription, the main devÊ found in records being Pamp§ (consort of Viråp§kßa). The most important festival for the Vijayanagara rulers was mah§navamÊ, celebrated in honour of Durg§, and also LakßmÊ and SarasvatÊ; on the ninth and final day, several thousands of buffaloes, sheep and goats were sacrificed before the r§ya-s and nobles (Nilakanta Sastri 1992:131). Considering the evidence presented above, it seems that the devÊ-s became incorporated into the temple rites of the maãha-s during the early period of Vijayanagara involvement with the advaita maãha-s—several centuries after the time of “aØkara—but that the devÊ at “ÜØgerÊ was not “§rad§ at that time. As we have seen, the earliest of “aØkara’s hagiographies was most probably written during the Vijayanagara period. The connection of “aØkara to either K§ñcÊ or “ÜØgerÊ in the earlier of the hagiographies precisely fits the region where the Vijayanagaras were operating, endowments being made to both maãha-s, particularly “ÜØgerÊ. Vijayanagara being the centre of what might be called ‘Hindu India’ at the time, the earlier hagiographers would have had no reason to write of advaita maãha-s in places still occupied by Muslim regimes to the north. It was previously explained that the legend of the four maãha-s was a feature only of the later hagiographies. The Cidvil§sa“aØkaravijaya-vil§sa was probably written in the sixteenth century, and here for the first time are disciples dispached to the four quarters of India. The names of all four maãha-s do not appear until later still (perhaps around 1650), after the fall of the Vijayanagara empire and the conversion of the later rulers to VaißÖavism. It appears that hagiographers in the service of the Vijayanagara rulers wrote the earliest hagiographies of “aØkara, projecting him in the image of their sponsors as an incarnation of “iva150 (who also performs devÊ worship). The two southern maãha-s were written into the hagiographies to enhance their status as resorts of “aØkara, the saviour of the Vedic tradition. This has created the legacy of a continuing dispute, resting on the irony that “aØkara probably founded neither maãha. Hacker (1995:29) also believes that “aØkara was transformed into a áaiva folk-hero in a reconstruction of Hinduism—in the face of Muslim aggression—by his hagiographers, but wrongly attributes the project to Vidy§raÖya (assisted by S§yaÖa). 150
the rise and influence of advaita maãha-s
225
Several conclusions may be drawn concerning the development of the hagiography of “aØkara, and the final attribution to him of the founding of an order of renunciates and four maãha-s. 1) “aØkara’s connection with “ÜØgerÊ and K§ñcÊ was established some time after the founding of any advaita maãha in either of those places; this connection was perhaps first made in the fourteenth or fifteenth century in the earlier hagiographies which, as we have seen, contain no reference to his establishing any maãha. The “aØkaravijaya of Anant§nandagiri, perhaps the earliest of the hagiographies, dated perhaps to post-fourteenth century (Bader 2000:24), and associated with K§ñcÊ, is unique amongst the hagiographies in that it contains no reference to the four disciples of “aØkara, instead providing an account of twelve disciples who accompanied “aØkara when he went to see his guru (Bader 2000:258–259). 2) The next stage in the elaboration of “aØkara’s hagiography was to attribute to him four main disciples and the founding of a maãha in either K§ñcÊ or “ÜØgerÊ (depending which stream of hagiography is referred to). 3) The third stage of hagiographic projection is to attribute to “aØkara the founding of four maãha-s in the four quarters of India under four disciples. This stage, I believe, most probably coincides with the production of the Maãh§mn§ya-s, which both affirmed “aØkara’s conquest of the four quarters, and also integrated into that picture “aØkara’s founding of an order of ascetics, many lineages of which, up until the time of the dissemination of the integrated picture, had no connection to the orthodox traditions represented by the advaita maãha-s. Many prominent Ved§ntins bear one or another of the ten names of the Daáan§mÊ family. There are the first preceptors of “ÜØgerÊ: Bh§ratÊtÊrtha, Vidy§tÊrtha, and Vidy§raÖya.151 Madhva (the dualist) was initiated under the name PårÖaprajña, was named $nandatÊrtha when he was an §c§rya, and was only later called Madhva. The three important scholars (munitrayam) within the early
151 The name AraÖya is currently an unusual Daáan§mÊ name. As has been observed by Gerald Larson, although S§Òkhya doctrine permeates Indian philosophy generally, followers of S§Òkhya are practically non-existent. Larson found but one S§Òkhya maãha, near Banaras. However, there is a lineage of S§Òkhyans—named AraÖya—at the Kapil maãha at Madhupur in Bihar, which was founded in 1938 by Sv§mÊ Harihar§nand§raÖya, who is said to have revived S§Òkhya (see Dharmamegha AraÖya 1989).
226
chapter six
Madhva Ved§nta tradition were Madhva, JayatÊrtha (1365–1388) (who codified Madhva’s doctrines), and Vy§satÊrtha (1460–1539) (Sarma (2003:17). Several of the prominent Ved§ntins of the fifteenth and sixteenth centuries bore the name SarasvatÊ, including Sad§nanda YogendrasarasvatÊ (Sad§nanda),152 who wrote the Ved§ntas§ra, on which a commentary, the SubodhinÊ, was written by his grand-disciple, NarasiÒhasarasvatÊ of Banaras, in 1588 (Nikhilananda 1978:xii).153 Other important Ved§ntins of this period were Brahm§nandasarasvatÊ, author of the Brahm§nandÊyam, and MadhusådanasarasvatÊ—the author of the Advaitasiddhi—an advaitin but also a devotee of KÜßÖa (see Nelson 1998).154 Jagann§th§árama was a great teacher of south India, living in the latter half of the fifteenth century. His pupil, NarasiÒh§árama, became one of the most reputed teachers of Ved§nta in the early half of the sixteenth century (Dasgupta 1975, Vol. II:53–55).155 Unravelling lineages in terms of orders is inherently complex, given that orders may flourish or decline, that many people of historical importance bear the same name, and that lineages may bifurcate into orders with different religious or philosophical positions. While these advaita Ved§ntin-s are unquestionably in what might be called the philosophical parampar§ of “aØkara, citing his arguments and works, this, I would suggest, is quite different from maintaining that these authors believed—whether they did or not—that they were of a saÒny§sÊ order begun by “aØkara, moreover a family also comprising militant Giris, PurÊs and Bh§ratÊs. The social, religious and political processes that may have been behind the integration of diverse lineages into an orthodox order is the central issue addressed in the following chapter. 152 His guru was Advay§nandasarasvatÊ. There appear to have been two individuals named Sad§nanda who are occasionally confused (Ramachandran 1968:206), one being the author of the Ved§ntas§ra, the other being the author of the Advaitabrahmasiddhi. 153 See also Hiriyanna (1929:17); Haramohan Mishra (1983:v). 154 Madhusådana was a pupil of Viáveávar(§nanda)sarasvatÊ (pupil of Sarvajñaviáeßa, and pupil’s pupil of GovindasarasvatÊ) (Dasgupta 1975, Vol. II:55). Besides the Advaitasiddhi, to Madhusådana are attributed the Siddh§ntabindu, Ved§ntakalpala-tik§ and Advaita-ratna-rakßana (Rajagopalan 1968:255). 155 Some of the foremost Ved§nta writers of the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries flourished in a Ved§ntic circle, directly or indirectly under the influence of NarasiÒh§árama and Appaya DÊkßita.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
227
CHAPTER SEVEN
N$G$-S, S—F^S AND PARALLEL RELIGIOUS IDENTITIES Examined in the previous chapter was the claim that “aØkara founded maãha-s, in particular the K§ñcÊpuram and “ÜØgerÊ maãha-s. There appears to be no evidence to substantiate this claim, or the tradition that he founded an order of ascetics. It was also shown that the guru-parampar§-s of the maãha-s are quite unreliable, and that the earliest an advaita tradition can be discerned at the maãha-s is 1155 at Kå·ali, 1290 at K§ñcÊpuram, and 1346 at (TuØga) “ÜØgerÊ. Evidence for the foundation of the other maãha-s, namely at Dv§rak§, PurÊ, and Jyoáimaãh, is even more elusive, and firm records do not go back more than a few hundred years. If “aØkara did not found the Daáan§mÊs, then what is needed is some kind of explanation of when and why the order might have come into existence as a recognisable entity. In this chapter, the context for the formation of the Daáan§mÊs as a distinct order will be explored, the central hypothesis being that the Daáan§mÊ order formed in response to religious and political developments, some time in the late sixteenth and seventeenth centuries. The formation of an order essentially integrated two sets of disparate and previously unconnected lineages pertaining to the n§g§ and monastic traditions. It is suggested that around the time of the formation of the akh§Ü§-s of the Daáan§mÊs, a Daáan§mÊ identity was created—encapsulated in the all-India purview of the Maãh§mn§ya-s— integrating monastic and military saÒny§sÊ-s, and enhancing the legitimacy of both sets of lineages, the instigation of which was attributed to “aØkara. As indicated in Chapter 2, of the thirteen militant akh§Ü§-s currently functioning in India, the six non-Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s1 are believed to have formed in this period, and it seems most probable that the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s also formed around the same time, notwithstanding claims to greater antiquity.
1 The three Bair§gÊ (R§m§nandÊ) akh§Ü§-s, and the three Sikh-affiliated akh§Ü§-s (the Nirmala and the two Ud§sin akh§Ü§-s).
228
chapter seven 7.1 The formation of militant ascetic orders
As early as the eighth century, P§áupata ascetics were armed by guilds to protect trade (Davidson 2002:80).2 Lorenzen (1978) provides other examples of Indian fighting ascetics in the early mediaeval period. In a frequently cited reference to fighting ascetics in the KabÊra Bijaka (Abhilash Das 1997:56–57 [RamainÊ 69]), most probably written in the mid-sixteenth century, scorn is poured on yogÊ-s, siddha-s, mahant-s and ascetics who resort to arms, keep women and collect property and ‘taxes’.3 Besides the Mad§ri fakÊr-s (see below), the first groups of mercenary ascetics to be in any way organised appear to have been the N§ths4 (Orr 1940:6) and the SaÒny§sÊs. Perhaps the earliest recorded confrontation between ascetic fighters is that recorded in Abu-l-Faíl’s Akbar-n§ma (1972:422–424)5 when rival groups of SaÒny§sÊs and ‘JogÊs’ (N§ths) clashed, watched by Akbar, in the late sixteenth century.6 Other organised militant orders, such as the early Sikh kh§ls§,7 the Ud§sin and Nirmala orders,8 D§dåpanthÊ,9
2 In the eleventh century, King Harßa (Harßadeva) (r.1089–1101), short of funds, raided temples for icons he could melt down. He employed groups of naked ascetics, who defiled the temples with spittle and excrement. Basham (1951:206) believes they may have been $jÊvikas. 3 This particular section of the Bijaka appears to have been written not only after the time of KabÊr, but also some time after the battle of Panipat in 1526, as firearms are referred to; firearms were used for the first time on a large scale on Indian soil during this battle (Lorenzen 1978:61). Lorenzen (1992:9–12) dates KabÊr to between the mid-fifteenth century and c.1525. 4 N§th-YogÊs maintained a stronghold at the gorge at Galt§ (near Jaipur) until usurped by militant vaißÖava-s in the sixteenth century (Orr 1940:8). The state of Jodhpur (and the wider area of Marw§r) was heavily influenced by the N§ths in the first half of the nineteenth century, particularly in relation to the rise to power of M§n Singh, whose guru was Ayas Dev N§th (assassinated in 1815). N§ths were also an element in the Jodhpur army (see Gold 1996; White 2001:9–19). In royal chronicles of Rajasthan, Kumaun and Nepal may be found accounts of how particular N§th-Siddhas use yogic powers and intrigue to install patrons favourable to them on the throne (White 2001:5–6). ‘Siddhas’ were not only heterdox power brokers: the famous eleventh-century writer and Tantric, Abhinavagupta, was also a siddha (see Muller-Ortega 1989:60–61). 5 Referred to in Ch. 2.1. 6 In his Memoirs, Jah§ngir (r.1605–1628) reports not less than two or three thousand people attending contests at arenas for athletes or pugilists, at places such as Agra and Lahore. However, it is not known what proportion of them were in the hands of sects like the D§dåpanthÊs or Gosains (Kolff 1990:28). 7 According to the Sikh tradition, the kh§ls§ (‘brotherhood’) was founded in 1699 by Guru Gobind Singh, the tenth guru in descent from N§nak, the founder of the
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
229
R§m§nandÊ (Bair§gÊ),10 NimbarkÊ and R§dh§vallabhÊ n§g§-s,11 all formed between the time of Akbar and the eighteenth century, with a substantial recruitment of low-caste áådra-s into Sikh, R§m§nandÊ and Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s (Pinch 1996:26–27). Even though there had been sporadic attacks on saÒny§sÊ-s by
order. However, it appears that the kh§ls§ formed gradually from bands of roving warriors, during most of the eighteenth century, as an element in the expansion of Punjabi J§ãs, and the consequent reaction of the Mughals (McLeod 1976:1–19, 51). The NihaØgs, soldier ascetics (also referred to as Ak§lis), a subdivision within the kh§ls§, were formed, according to tradition, in 1690, by M§n Singh (see Farquhar 1925a:340). 8 The Ud§sin order was founded, according to tradition, by “rÊ Cand, during the seventeenth century, as was the other Sikh-related akh§Ü§, the Nirmala (see Singh 1951:64; Ahuja 1994; Oberoi 1997:124–127). However, the Sikh orders are more accurately understood as a continuation, within a new community, of an already extant ascetic tradition with significant correspondences with the N§ths, including particular respect for haãha-yoga practices, and a reverence for the dhå§n (=dhånÊ ) (McLeod 1980:35 fn. 2, 103, 203). The three militant, ascetic, Sikh-related orders are the NihaØg, Ud§sin and Nirmala. 9 Towards the end of Akbar’s reign, D§då (d.1604), a cotton-cleaner from Ahmadabad, organised a new sect of R§ma devotees, the D§då panth, which comprises virakta-s (ascetics), vastradh§rin-s (householders), and n§g§-s (kh§kÊ [ash-clad]virakta-s). The D§då panth n§g§-s had a prominent role in the armies of some princes, notably in Jodhpur, and still retain a small akh§Ü§ that bathes with the Nirmohi anÊ at Kumbh Mel§s. The D§dåpanthÊs claim that their n§g§-s are descended from Sundard§s, a disciple of D§då, and thus from the late sixteenth or early seventeenth century. Although the genealogy of the D§dåpanthÊ n§g§-s may possibly have begun around the mid-seventeenth century at the earliest, firm records are only available from the second half of the eighteenth century; they were officially constituted in 1756 (Thiel-Horstmann 1991:257, 268–269). According to Orr (1940:15) the D§dåpanthÊs first fought alongside the R§m§nandÊs, and then set up their own akh§Ü§. 10 The vaißÖava R§m§nandÊs appear to have constituted their military branches between approximately 1650 and 1720 (Ghurye 1964:177; [Thiel-] Horstmann 2001). According to R§m§nandÊ tradition, the decision to arm vaißÖava ascetics was taken at the meeting of the catuÈ samprad§ya at Galta (near Jaipur), in 1713 (Burghart 1978b). However, R§m§nandÊs were already armed and organised by 1693 (see below). 11 According to Orr (1940:10–17), the R§dh§vallabhÊs joined ranks with the NimbarkÊs, while armed VißÖusv§mÊ militants entered the service of R§ja Bijay Singh of Jodhpur as mercenaries in 1779, as one of sixteen fighting akh§Ü§-s (seven akh§Ü§-s were R§m§nandÊ; seven NimbarkÊ; one Madhva; one VißÖusv§mÊ). SaÒny§sÊs and VißÖusv§mÊs continued to serve the Jodhpur state for nearly a century, until they were finally disbanded by Mah§r§ja Jasvant Singh in 1875. Up to the early twentieth century, the Jaipur state maintained a force of 5,500 n§g§-s, comprising mostly D§dåpanthÊs, but also NÊm§vats (NimbarkÊs) and R§dh§vallabhÊs. SaÒny§sÊs, D§dåpanthÊs and VißÖusv§mÊs were still employed in the Bundi and Koãa states until 1915.
230
chapter seven
Muslims—such as the massacre of a large number of devotees at Haridv§r by Timur in 1398 (Nevill 1909a:254)—it seems that the formation of the saÒny§sÊ akh§Ü§-s was not primarily in response to Muslim harassment. Many follow Farquhar (1925b:483), who believes that MadhusådanasarasvatÊ (1540–1647), the well-known Ved§ntin philosopher, approached Emperor Akbar (1542–1605) to seek advice on the protection of the order to which he belonged from harassment by armed Muslim fakÊr-s. He was advised by his trusted R§ja Birbal, who was present, to initiate a large number of non-Brahmans. Thus were many kßatriya-s and vaiáya-s—and, says Farquhar, “multitudes of áådra-s at a later date”—admitted into the order. It is said that half the Bh§ratÊs refused to accept this and went to “ÜØgerÊ to remain ‘pure’, thus making three-and-one-half lineages ‘pure’. The recruitment of n§g§-s into fighting units appears to have taken place around the time of Akbar’s reign, although it is unlikely to have been a specific response to harassment by militant SåfÊs.12 Farquhar’s conclusion was based on anecdotal evidence, and the historical evidence (see Ch. 2.1) indicates that the main conflicts of the period were between sects of Hindu renunciates—more specifically between vaißÖava Bhair§gÊs and áaiva SaÒny§sÊs13 (also known as gosain-s)—rather than between saÒny§sÊ-s and militant SåfÊ orders (Sikand 1998). A further problem with Farquhar’s thesis is that Akbar is recorded witnessing a fight between saÒny§sÊ-s and yogÊ-s (see Al-Bad§oni 1986 Vol. 2:94–95; Abu-l-Faíl 1972:422–424), illustrating that militant Hindu orders were already in existence in some form during his reign, but perhaps organised only within the previous few decades.14 R§m§nandÊ and
12 Although the story of the founding of the akh§Ü§-s cannot be confirmed, it seems that MadhusådanasarasvatÊ may have had a connection with Akbar’s court (Halbfass 1983:88). 13 Although a distinct ‘Hindu’ identity seems to have formed in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries (see below), significant disputes concerning sectarian Hindu identity persisted well into the nineteenth century. In the Kachava kingdom of Amber-Jaipur a major dispute finally erupted in 1864 concerning vaißÖava and áaiva affiliation. Under Mah§r§ja R§msingh II, zealous áaiva-s had chased vaißÖava-s from the capital of the kingdom, Jaipur. For many months the wearing of the vertical vaißÖava tilak had been effectively banned, and only those wearing the horizontal three-line tilak were to be seen in the streets (Clémentin-Ojha 1999:349). 14 Lorenzen (1978:62–64) believes that the various fighting orders that emerged in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries—in response to social, economic and political change—may be divided into two broad groups: those movements concerned with the protection of specific, local, economic and social interests; and
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
231
D§dåpanthÊ traditions maintain that their military organisation was in response to the aggressive activities of the saÒny§sÊ-s. However, the evidence indicates that n§g§ military activity flourished under direct state patronage,15 and was not primarily religiously sectarian, even though inter-sectarian battles did take place at Hindu mel§-s. The organisation of saÒny§sÊ-s and other ascetics into military akh§Ü§-s can be understood as a relatively seamless transition between the two lifestyles of n§g§ and soldier: both require rigorous self-discipline, and an adaptability to harsh conditions. The travelling jam§t is perfectly adaptable to a military unit, with its command structure, information network, and proficiency in practical camping and cooking arrangements over wide areas of India. Soldiers, naked and theoretically beyond identifiable caste, are cel§-s of a commander, who performs the religious rituals of his sect, thus increasing the bond of the unit. In mediaeval India, asceticism, trade and war were by no means incompatible (see Kolff 1990:77). Some western commentators have been challenged to reconcile the idealised ascetic striving for mokßa—referred to in the Introduction—with militant saÒny§sÊ-s (see Lochtefeld 1994). However, if the practice of tapas (‘asceticism’) is considered in its Indian context, epic and Pur§Öic material illustrates how tapas almost invariably leads to boons and the acquisition of material powers, and also frequently of magical weaponry with which to overcome and kill adversaries.16 The powers of militant, ash-covered gosain-s are quite reconcilable with their
those involved in popular, sometimes regional, rebellion against central authority. However, the categories are not entirely distinct, as different groups operate in both domains. Lorenzen categorises the Sikhs, broadly, in the second group, while the Daáan§mÊ n§g§-s, he maintains, formed for the protection of non-n§g§ land and monastic property. Though the Daáan§mÊ n§g§-s may have protected monastic property, there are no available historical records of this. 15 For example, in the reign of Aurangzeb (1658–1707), under an imperial decree of 1692–1693, five R§m§nandÊ commanders were authorised to move freely about the whole empire, with standards and kettledrums, and without hindrance, in charge of foot and horse-mounted soldiers (Orr 1940:9). 16 Pinch (1997:12–15) comments on the historical change in attitude towards tapas, comparing V§lmÊki’s R§m§yaÖa (usually dated to around the first century) wth the R§mcaritm§nas of TulsÊd§s (c.1543–1623), particularly in the B§lak§Ö·a. In short: V§lmÊki elevates it, in the traditional way, as leading to power; but TulsÊd§s pours scorn on tapas, prefering bhakti. Pinch suggests that this shift in attitude is a reflection of the change in the social attitude of the times towards religious ascetics, evinced by the activities at the time of armed, marauding gosain-s and fakÊr-s. Disdain for this kind of lifestyle was also shared by the nirguÖÊ bhakta KabÊr.
232
chapter seven
mythological counterparts. In the construction of an identity for the Daáan§mÊs, the lifestyles and activities of both monastic monks and armed, ash-covered gosain-s are equally valid within the framework of traditional Hinduism.
7.2 The development of SåfÊ institutions in India If we consider SåfÊ institutions in India, many aspects of their development seem to provide a plausible rationale for a parallel institutionalisation of the Daáan§mÊ order. The first SåfÊ settlements in India17 date from the eighth century (Siddiqi 1989:14).18 Another wave of SåfÊ Shaikhs, who migrated from Khurasan (western Afghanistan/ Iran) to Delhi during the time of the Delhi sultanate, were distinctly militant, and did not always exhibit the pietistic attitude that some writers have extolled, their wrath leading to “the discomfiture, misery and often death of those who presumed to oppose [them]” (Digby 1986:60). Between the thirteenth and eighteenth centuries, Bijapur (also known as the BahmanÊ state) was a SåfÊ stronghold in India. The BahmanÊ state was a region contiguous and frequently at war with Vijayanagara, with which it had considerable structural similarities (Eaton 2002:160–166). At its height in the mid-seventeenth century, the Bijapur sultanate was one of the largest and most powerful states in the subcontinent, second only to the Mughal empire. The first SåfÊs to enter the Bijapur plateau arrived in the late thirteenth century (Eaton 1997:36–48), and were what might be called ‘warrior SåfÊs’, who are virtually indistinguishable in many respects from Daáan§mÊ n§g§-s. The first of these warrior SåfÊs to gain renown was Shaikh SåfÊ Sarmast (d.1281),19 who, with his army of seven hundred gh§zÊ-s (‘religious soldiers’)—according to his hagiography—killed
17 The first Muslim conquest in the subcontinent was of the Sindh region, in 711/712, by Ibn al-Qasim (see Schimmel 1980:3–4). 18 The first major SåfÊ to settle in the subcontinent was al-HujwÊrÊ (c.1009–1071). Called D§t§ Ganj Bakhsh by his followers, he is the author of the first major treatise on Såfism in Persian, the Kashf al-maÈjåb. His tomb (in Lahore) subsequently became a ‘gateway’, visited by all SåfÊs who migrated to the subcontinent (Rizvi 1978:112–113; Schimmel 1982:3). 19 All dates in this and the following sections are given as CE. For the conversion of dates—given in many sources according to the Muslim calendar (A.H.)—to other calendars, see Sewell and DÊkshit (1896:105ff.).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
233
many Hindus and engaged in battle with a Hindu king.20 During a crucial fifty-year period, from 1296 to 1347, militant SåfÊs seem to have been extensively involved with Muslim military expansionism in the Deccan. In this period, the SåfÊs, besides providing the Muslim armies with an element of religious legitimacy, may have represented the only element of Islamic organisation at the frontiers of expansion, most probably centred on kh§nq§h-s (simple monastic dwellings) (Eaton 1997:46).21 SåfÊ Sarmast belonged to no institutional order as such, as he predated any such organisation in south Asia, yet, as a SåfÊ, he had been initiated by a pÊr (a Muslim religious preceptor), enabling him to initiate others. Within the SåfÊ world this system of initiation (baiy’a)22 and authorative transmission is known as khil§fat, and is a direct parallel with the guru-parampar§ arrangement that operates within the Hindu domain. Integration through the khil§fat system is the single most important criterion for being a SåfÊ.23 From the fourteenth century onwards, an institutional network of kh§nq§h-s became established, based on a silsil§ (‘chain’) from a founding pÊr (or shaikh). By the mid-fourteenth century, warrior SåfÊs—who had not been affiliated to any order—had more or less disappeared from the Bijapur area. They were replaced by SåfÊs who were affiliated to
20 Another warrior SåfÊ, PÊr Ma’bari Khandyat, who died in the early fourteenth century, accompanied one of the sultan of Delhi’s campaigns in the struggle to gain control of Bijapur. According to Ma’bari’s hagiography, he slaughtered many idolatrous local r§ja-s. He appears also to have accompanied Malik Kufår—whom we encountered in the previous chapter (fn. 64)—in 1311, during his military campaigns in the south. While Sarmast and Ma’bari are known to have been involved with armies, other SåfÊs appear in Bijapur in the late thirteenth century who are remembered for their military prowess, martyrdom, and attacks on Hindus and idolatry. Amongst them are $li Pahlavan (a companion of SåfÊ Sarmast), Shaikh Shahid, PÊr Jumna, and Tigh Brahna. 21 In the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries, kh§nq§h-s also functioned as travellers’ rest houses (sarai), thus facilitating the spread of the fame of saints. There were up to 120 kh§nq§h-s in Delhi, where three nights’ stay was possible (Digby 1976). 22 The initiation ritual involves the teacher grasping the pupil’s hand (or touching his head), and investing the best disciples with a khirqa (a garment of, usually, patched wool). Some were also given a licence or diploma (called ijaza or khil§fatn§ma), authorising them to act as deputies (khalÊfa), and disseminate the principles and practices of their respective orders (see Rizvi 1978:102). 23 For an analysis of the pÊr-murÊd (teacher-disciple) relationship, one of the basic pillars of SåfÊ organisation, see Islam (2002:385–396).
234
chapter seven
one or another of the SåfÊ orders that had developed in the MiddleEast, notably the Chishti, Q§diri and Shatt§ri orders.24 One of the first SåfÊs to become closely associated with the BahmanÊ court at Bijapur was Shaikh Siraj-uddÊn Junaidi (d.1380), who assisted with the coronation of the new king, Ala-uddÊn Hasan, in 1347, and received what was perhaps the first land-grant to a Deccani SåfÊ, the village of Korchi, which has since remained in the hands of his descendants. Shortly after his coronation the new sultan distributed four hundred pounds of gold and a thousand pounds of silver in the name of Nií§m ud-DÊn (-al DÊn) Aulia, the great Chishti of Delhi. As a consequence, his successor Muhammad “§h BahmanÊ, was able to obtain a declaration of allegiance from virtually all the SåfÊs of his kingdom (Eaton 1997:60–61). It will be recalled that the first land-grants to “ÜØgerÊ were just a year earlier, in 1346, in somewhat parallel circumstances; namely, patronage of a saÒny§sÊ institution in return for favours presumably rendered. In another parallel with Daáan§mÊ institutions, the Indian SåfÊ Shaikhs of the fourteenth century and later—following a tradition of some of their predecessors in the eleventh and twelfth centuries in Khurasan—were considered to have a divinely sanctioned jurisdiction over a specific territory (wil§yat).25 There were frequent challenges to various claims of jurisdiction and ‘protection’, both from within the
24 Their occupation of the Deccan was in part as a consequence of Muhammad bin Tughluq’s order of 1327 that the kh§nq§h-s of Delhi be vacated. Resident SåfÊ-s were ordered to migrate to the Deccan to inhabit the new capital at Daulatabad, as part of a general policy of resettlement. In 1347 many Deccanis revolted against the rule of Delhi, and the BahmanÊ kingdom was established at Gulbarga. 25 Heads of sisil§-s dispatched their khalÊfa-s to various provinces, called wil§yat. KhalÊfa-s, in their turn, appointed subordinate khalÊfa-s for various cities and settlements. Thus a hierarchy of saints came to be established in northern India, with the chief saint established at the centre, controlling a network of kh§nq§h-s spread over the country. Mediaeval records show numerous instances of such territorial distribution (Nizami 1961:175–177). At the beginning of the fourteenth century, Shaikh Nií§m al-DÊn of the Chishti silsil§ was identified with the well-being and fortune of the city of Delhi, over which the Shaikh exercised his ‘governance’. In an account of the late fourteenth century, AmÊr Khwurd describes how Mu’Ên al-DÊn’s wil§yat extended all over India (Digby 1986:72). The notion of ‘divine jurisdiction’ is perhaps most amply exemplified in the person of Mu’Ên al-DÊn Chishti (d.1236), who founded the Chishti lineage in India. His tomb in Ajmer became a major centre of pilgrimage, notably after Akbar’s pilgrimages on foot there between 1562 and 1575. Today, the festival for the anniversary of the saint is the greatest pilgrimage festival of Muslims in the Indian subcontinent.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
235
order and from rival orders (Digby 1986:63–72), one example being the cult of Datt§treya,26 one of several Hindu devotional cults that arose in Maharashtra in this period.27 Tulpule believes (1979:352) that the Datt§treya cult probably arose as a reaction against the activity of SåfÊs, who were exerting a significant influence on the traditional religion of Maharashtra.
7.3 Religious identity in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries In this section, we turn to the issue of religious identity in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries, and how there was an ample context in this period for the development of a distinct Hindu sectarian identity for the Daáan§mÊs. It was observed in Chapter 5.6 that the first references to Daáan§mÊ appear around the middle of the sixteenth century. Around the same time, we find the first references to the term ‘Hindu’, as used self-reflexively to distinguish ‘Hindu’ from other religious traditions, specifically Islam. As noted in the previous chapter, in the earlier part of the first millennium, áaiva and vaißÖava were considered as distinct religious traditions, and the term ‘Hindu’ was not used by the traditions themselves. The first use of the term ‘Hindu’ by Hindus was by Vijayanagara regents in 1352. This appears to be the first use of the term term ‘Hindu’ in any Indian language source (Talbot 2003:90). Devar§ya II is described as “the sultan among Hindu kings (hindur§ya-suratr§Öa)” in inscriptions of 142428 and 1428.29 The term was previously only used by Muslims, and it was not until the late thirteenth century that Persian literature written in India uses the term ‘Hindu’ as a religious designation. The Vijayanagara use of the term appears to have been an appropriation in order to distinguish Indic from Turkish polities, and, according to Talbot (2003:90–91), was not used to
26 NarasiÒhasarasvatÊ (1378–1458) is regarded as the second avat§ra of Datt§treya (a deity comprising the trimårti Brahm§, VißÖu and “iva). He is the central figure in the history of the cult, and most probably its founder (Rigopoulos 1998:111–112). 27 Another example is the Mah§nubhava sect, founded by Cakradhar (d.1273), who was the last of a series of five human incarnations, called the ‘Five KÜßÖas’ (see Feldhaus and Tulpule 1992). 28 EI, Vol. III, no. 5, vv. 19–20, p. 40. 29 EI, Vol. XIII, no. 1, vv. 10–13, p. 10.
236
chapter seven
represent a distinction between those of the ‘Hindu religion’ from those of the ‘Islamic religion’.30 The term ‘Hindu’ was first used self-reflexively in a religious sense in Bengal during the early part of the sixteenth century by VallabhÊya and Gau·Êya vaißÖava-s, who actively proselytized, converting not only among Hindu groups, but also occasionally Muslims. “The Hindus now start using this foreign term as a device of asserting and defining their identity against the foreigners; the fact that they are named, excluded and defined as “others” by these foreigners provides them with a new sense of their own identity, as well as a new perspective on the otherness of others” (Halbfass 1988:192). In the seventeenth century the term ‘Hindu’ is also used in Maharashtra where “iv§jÊ (1627–1680) led successful campaigns against the Mughal rulers. However, the projection in hagiography31 of “iv§jÊ as an entirely ‘Hindu’ ruler, a protector of gods, Brahmans and cows, fighting demonic ‘Muslim’ adversaries—such as the Mughal captain Udebh§n, who sacrificed a pregnant cow before battle and killed his eighteen mistresses—is misleading. Indeed, in the army of Afíal Kh§n (“iv§jÊ’s chief adversary) there were many Hindus; and in “iv§jÊ’s own army there were many Muslims (Laine 1999:307). Nevertheless, it is during this period that ‘new’ and distinct religious identities emerge. Discussing this issue in the age of “iv§jÊ, Laine (1999:315) concludes: “In short, the complex diversity of religious belief and practice, which early Muslim arrivals to India saw as a multitude of sects and communities, was now a unity, a religion, a dÊn.” In the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries, on the one hand there appears to have been a tendency towards the establishing of a distinct ‘Hindu’ identity, while on the other there was also an apparent tendency—in the consciousness of difference—towards religious universalisation, a process that came to successful fruition during the following two centuries. The tendency towards religious universalisation is readily apparent in the PraÖ§mÊ sect, which was founded in the same period in the Jamnagar district of Gujarat. Its
30 However, in the latter inscription (vv. 10–13) Devar§ya is compared in numerous virtues with R§ma, son of Daáaratha. 31 Notably, the “ivabh§rata, commissioned at the time of “iv§jÊ’s coronation in 1647. The writing of historical biographies (carita-bakhar) began in Maharashtra with the advent of Mar§ãha rule under “iv§jÊ (see Wagle 1997:135).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
237
first preceptors were Devcand (b.1581) and Pr§Ön§th (1618–1694).32 Pr§Ön§th believed in the unity of religions, reflected in the teachings of the Bible, Veda, Koran, Jaina scriptures and other holy works, and spent sixteen months in Delhi unsuccessfully attempting to dissuade Aurangzeb from what is generally perceived as his anti-Hindu policy (Mukharya 1989:113; 1999:122). During the late sixteenth and seventeenth centuries religious identity became a significant political issue with new dimensions in many parts of India. Although there had been earlier attacks on Hindu temples by Islamic regimes—primarily as demonstrations of power at the frontiers of campaigns, rather than being specifically antireligious (Eaton 2000)—there was a period of cessation of hostilities from around 1420 onwards. However, in the late sixteenth century attacks on Hindu temples recommenced (Talbot 2003:104–107). By the middle of the seventeenth century, communal relationships between landed SåfÊs and Hindus became increasingly violent in the Deccan, with many SåfÊs participating in various conflicts in the region. Under a farm§n (‘royal decree’) of 1679, Hindu temples were destroyed, and a tax (jaziy§)33 on Hindus, that had been rescinded by Akbar (r.1556–1605)34 in 1564/5, was reinstated in 1679 by Aurangzeb (r.1658–1707), who at first desisted from imposing it, partly owing to his allegiance to the R§jpåts. His reimposition of the tax appears not to have been specifically anti-Hindu, but was part of an attempt to rally support from an increasingly orthodox clergy (ulam§)35 (Chandra 2003:141–142).36 Nevertheless, there is
32 Pr§Ön§th’s mother tongue was Gujarati, but he was well acquainted with Persian, Arabic, Sanskrit, Sindhi, Rajasthani and Hindi. He twice made tours of Muslim Arabia, and had an extensive knowledge of Islam. All PraÖ§mÊ literature is in Hindi, written in the devanag§rÊ script, and Pr§Ön§th was the first Hindi poet to use the word hindavi (Hindustani), considering it as the ‘national’ as well as a link language. 33 The tax has been calculated as amounting to a month’s wages from a tradesman’s income for a year (Chandra 2003:142). It was in force until 1713; it was again imposed between 1717 and 1720 ([Thiel-] Horstmann 1991:268). 34 Akbar’s son and successor, Jah§ngÊr (r.1605–1628), generally continued—but with important exceptions—the liberal policy of his father, permitting Hindu pilgrimage to such places as Haridv§r, preventing forcible conversion to Islam, and even paying daily allowances to extra-faith converts. Many Hindus also held high public office (Sharma 1937–1938:307–315). 35 Bayly (1985:191) believes Aurangzeb’s ‘tilt’ towards Islam may have been to build up local support against the power of Hindu zamÊnd§r-s. 36 During periods of conflict between Mughal and Hindu rulers, up until the
238
chapter seven
also some evidence that Aurangzeb, after his conquest of Bijapur in 1686, contributed to the widening divisions between the Muslim and Hindu communities, purging non-orthodox and ‘eclectic’ SåfÊs (Eaton 1997:244–246). Regarding Hindu/Muslim relations, changes in government perceptions and policy can be seen in developments within the sultanate of Bijapur. Eaton (1997:99–114) discusses the cultural syncretism of the sultanate under Sultan Ibrahim II (1580–1627). The Sultan, a Sunni Muslim and a Deccani, was a noted scholar, with a considerable knowledge of Sanskrit.37 He is hailed as one of the great poets of the age, and actively supported various Hindu religious and cultural institutions,38 one of his popular epithets being jagadguru.39 The religious eclecticism of Ibrahim II was not shared by his successor, Sultan Muhammad $dil “§h (1627–1656), under whom an orthodox Muslim religious establishment came to play a heightened religio-political role in Bijapur. Up to a fifth of the wealth derived from military conquests went to support Muslim organs of state (Eaton 1997:115). Muhammad styled himself a mujahid (‘wager of
eighteenth century, it is important to recognise that the political battles were not in any way similar to, for example, the religious wars waged in Europe between Protestant and Catholic regimes. By contrast, in India, no Muslim enclaves were siezed; populations were not expelled on the basis of religion; there were no forced conversions; banks maintained branches in both Hindu and Muslim regions, extending credit regardless of religion; and Hindus and Muslims served in respective governments and armies on both sides. (For further details, see Gordon 1999.) 37 His dominance in the region can be traced from 1583, when the Shi’a khuãba (the Friday sermon, in which the secular ruler’s name was revered and prayed for) was replaced by that of orthodox Sunnism (Eaton 1997:100). 38 He composed one of the landmarks of Dakani literature, the Kitab-i Nauras, a treatise on the nine sentiments (rasa) of Sanskrit literature, which also discusses the subject of Indian musical r§ga-s. Instead of the usual Muslim invocation, bism-ullah, the book opens with a prayer to GaÖapati. “iva, ParvatÊ and Bhairava also feature prominently in the work. It is reported that Ibrahim even had an image of SarasvatÊ brought into the palace for his personal worship. Being infatuated with music, Ibrahim also instituted a national music-holiday, ^d-i Nauras, in which thousands of Hindu musicians participated. He issued orders ensuring the rights of pilgrims to perform rituals to the Hindu deity Khanderao (Mallari), and supported the upkeep of a Hindu temple at Chinchvad, near Pune (Eaton 1997:111). 39 Besides support for Hindu institutions, Ibrahim tolerated Shi’a Muslims—though not in his employment—and was the first sovereign to allow Jesuits to establish mission churches in the kingdom. He nevertheless wished to be remembered above all as a good Muslim; on his tomb are Arabic couplets from the Koran, extolling the piety of Abraham (father of Isaac), who is described as not a Jew, nor a Christian, but a Muslim.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
239
jihad’) and gh§zÊ (‘religious fighter’) in his campaigns, from 1638 to 1649. Government regulations (Dastur al-$mal ) issued under Muhammad specifically separated the Hindus and Muslims as distinct and unequal communities for the first time in the history of Bijapur.40 Reaction to the religious eclecticism came not only from government but also from the SåfÊ orders of Bijapur, primarily from the newlyarrived Q§diri and Shatt§ri orders. The reformist SåfÊs of Bijapur were often hostile to Brahmans, Hindu ascetics and yogÊ-s. There are several semi-hagiographic accounts of the time that describe various spiritual battles between SåfÊs and Hindu yogÊ-s and gosain-s; the SåfÊs, of course, emerging victorious. Even though warrior SåfÊs had been active in India since the thirteenth century, it was only in the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries that the image of the Islamic holy warrior (gh§zÊ) appears in Indo-Muslim writing, an image that was then retroactively attributed to numerous individuals of previous centuries (Talbot 2003:107). During the period under consideration SåfÊs began to exert considerable influence on the administration in Delhi, some gaining very prominent status. Amongst Chishtis, Khw§ja Muinud Chishti and Shaikh Salim Chishti were virtually made patron saints of the Mughals (Chandra 1996:145). The status of Shaikhs was such that they were considered to be above some aspects of law (Shackle 1976:162). Already by the sixteenth century the Mughal emperors had established extensive bureaucratic hierarchies that dispensed royal funds and land to SåfÊ shrines, frequently regulated by appointed trustees (Ernst and Lawrence 2002:21). Also, contrary to certain preconceptions concerning the nature of Islam, some SåfÊs of the mediaeval period in the subcontinent enjoyed a particular kind of prestige, as they acted as priests at darg§h-s (‘tombs of departed pÊr-s’), and also performed rituals as intermediaries between God and supernatural forces (Gaborieau 1989).41 Besides the more orthodox SåfÊs of the darg§h-s there were also
40
The Muslim population were obliged to attend the Friday prayers, and preachers were instructed not to allow any Hindu influences on Islam. Muslims were instructed not to attend festivals such as Holi, Div§li and Dassera, when taxes on sheep, ghÊ, and rice were imposed for those attending (Eaton 1997:117–118). 41 Gaborieau’s study is limited to Nepal, but it seems probable that the situation was similar in north India.
240
chapter seven
many majzåb (‘dervish’/Mad§ri)42 SåfÊs wandering around. In the Dabist§n (p. 223)—written in the mid-seventeenth century—they are compared with SaÒny§sÊ-Avadhåts, rubbing themselves with ashes, the most “perfect” of them going naked—even in the severe cold of Kashmir and Kabul—with black turbans and tangled hair, sometimes clad with iron chains, and drinking large quantities of bh§Øg. In terms of life-style and appearance there is little to distinguish them from N§ths and Daáan§mÊ n§g§-s.43 During the late sixteenth and early seventeenth centuries arose what has been called the ‘the Nakshbandi reaction’, an orthodox SåfÊ movement against religious eclecticism in Mughal India, represented by Akbar, and against ‘unorthodox’ SåfÊ orders and practices. This movement roughly parallels events during this phase of Bijapur’s history (Eaton 1997:124). The reformist Nakshbandis had spread widely throughout Muslim-dominated north India, many obtaining high posts in the civil and military administration.44 Many men, not only those with a high degree of traditional Islamic learning, but also military adventurers and soldiers, abandoned their previous occupations and joined the Nakshbandis during the time of Aurangzeb’s rule. Some recent immigrants from Central Asia who were military commanders holding high office in the late seventeenth and early eighteenth centuries became clients of Nakshbandi b§b§-s, though there seems to be no evidence of proseytizing or conversion of nonMuslims (Digby 2001:7–8). The influence of the Nakshbandis may 42 An order founded by “§h Madar (=Shaikh Badi’u’d-DÊn, b.1315) (Rizvi 1993:318). 43 These kinds of SåfÊs were known by various names in different regions of India, including: Mad§ris, Haydaris, Malamatis, Torlaks, Babs, Abdals, Jamis, Malangs, Jalalis, and Qalandars. This radical form of Såfism is also known as qalandar. The early Qalandari branches were founded in the Middle-East, Turkey, Egypt and Sindh in the thirteenth century (Schimmel 1983:335; Rizvi 1993:301–321; Ernst and Lawrence 2002:21–22). Radical SåfÊs were noted for being quarrelsome and sometimes violent, giving rise to anxiety when they stayed in kh§nq§h-s in India. Yet their spiritual powers were feared and respected (Digby 1976:172). For a graphic account of some of the radical practices of a sect of fakÊr-s in Hyderabad, the Rufayis, descended from Sayed Ahmad KabÊr RafaÊ (d.1160), see Hunt (1934). 44 The Nakshbandi order derives its name from Bah§’uddÊn Naqshband (d.1390), who came from central Asia. His most successful successor was ‘Abdu’l-Kh§liq Ghijduw§nÊ, who taught ‘the way of the Khojas (teachers)’, ãarÊqa-yi Khw§jag§n, and established connections with trade guilds and merchants. Under Khw§ja Ahr§r, Nakshbandis came to dominate central Asia, establishing a firm footing in India at the end of Akbar’s reign, shortly before 1600 (Schimmel 1983:364–367).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
241
also be seen in the pattern of marriages between Nakshbandis and the royal house (Damrel 2000:180–187). One of the most famous of the orthodox reformers was a Sunni Muslim, Shaikh Ahmad Faruki of SirhindÊ (1563–1624),45 who was a Nakshbandi. He disliked Shi’a Islam, and attempted to reform all orders.46 SirhindÊ rose to become governor of the province of Bihar, and oversaw a network of up to 1,600 khulafa/khalÊfa-s (Rizvi 1993:226, 293) that, according to Jah§ngir, was active in every town of the empire.47 Both the more conservative SirhindÊ, a Nakshbandi, and his more eclectic and ‘N§th yogic’ Chishti predecessor, Abd alQuddås GangohÊ (d.1537), agreed on the principle of prohibiting kafÊr-s from government service, except in minor posts. SirhindÊ went further, however, wishing to reimpose a tax on non-Muslims, and attempting to prohibit Muslim dress for non-Muslims.48 The assertion of a distinct Muslim identity on the part of the political elite also roughly coincided with the heightened importance of the institutions of SåfÊ pÊr-s. From around the mid-seventeenth century, the kh§nq§h-s of the Bijapur region, which were previously occupied by the early migrant pÊr-s, were replaced by darg§h-s, which sometimes included a courtyard, a small mosque and the graveyard of the pÊr-s descendants. Spiritual power ceased being transmitted from one pÊr to another, and began to be transmitted from the pÊr to the darg§h where he was buried (Eaton 1997:210–213; Lapidus 1988:460). Also, whereas previously the pÊr holding the office of kalÊf§ (or sajj§da-niáÊn ‘one who sits on the prayer carpet’) had been
45 SirhindÊ—also known as ‘Mujaddid’ (‘saviour’) Alf i-Sani—traced his descent from Caliph ‘Umar, and believed that he and three of his successors (beginning with his son, Muhammad Ma’ßum) were the highest representatives of God (qayyåm), directly elected to reform Islam (Schimmel 1983:369; Rizvi 1993:202ff.). 46 The nature of the ‘Nakshbandi reaction’ has been questioned by Damrel (2000), who argues that SirhindÊ’s reform programme was essentially his own personal agenda, rather than being rooted, as many scholars have maintained, in Nakshbandi tradition. SirhindÊ was imprisoned but was eventually released, after which he inititated “§h Jah§n (Haq 1935:17ff.). Although primarily a Chishti, SirhindÊ was also initiated into the Q§diri (and maybe also the Suhrawardi) order, and then, finally, into the Nakshbandi order. SirhindÊ traced his line of allegiance to the Prophet through twenty-one Nakshbandis, twenty-five Q§diris and twentyseven Chishtis. He maintained Chishti ties even after he became a Nakshbandi (Damrel 2000:182). 47 On the relationship between SirhindÊ and Jah§ngir, see also Sharma (1937– 1938:312–313). 48 See Rizvi (1993:215–329) for a comprehensive account of SirhindÊ.
242
chapter seven
succeeded by initiated disciples (murÊd-s), the criterion for succession changed, and it passed to a hereditary heir and his family, pÊrzada-s (‘sons of the pÊr’), who enjoyed—and still enjoy—the social prestige inherent in being descendants of an illustrious predecessor. The darg§h-s became dynamic social institutions centred on the personality cult of the departed pÊr and his descendants. Although for many centuries the devotion of a pÊr to his deceased teacher (Shaikh) had been frequently expressed by pilgrimage to his tomb—a local pilgrimage that in some instances was considered a Great hajj (Shackle 1976:162–163)—Såfism changed from being a discipline for a small elite, to becoming a movement of popular devotionalism, many darg§h-s becoming general places of pilgrimage. Although the pÊr-s of some kh§nq§h-s had acted as spiritual preceptors to Sultans, ties between pÊr-s and Sultans remained largely informal. However, a significant development in the late seventeenth century was that many pÊrzada-s entered into formal association with the state, and permanent land-grants (in§m) were issued, which were substantially augmented up to the beginning of the eighteenth century by subsequent Sultans, including Aurangzeb. The land-grants, enshrined within the Dastur-al-$mal, established a new relationship between the state and SåfÊ institutions, which began enjoying power and prestige within the state in a new and significant way, as the “Brahmans of Islam” (Eaton 1997:212–221, 247). The influence of SåfÊs may be gauged from the fact that there was more Persian SåfÊ hagiographical literature produced in India than in all of Persia and Central Asia combined (Ernst and Lawrence 2002:48).49 SåfÊ institutions were clearly very influential on the Muslim state during the period under consideration, and it is interesting to consider a parallel in the structures of the SåfÊ and Daáan§mÊ schemes of their respective orders. During the middle ages it was very common for SåfÊs to trace their lineage to the four Caliphs, and thence to the Prophet Muhammad. Hagiographers also retrospectively assigned such lineages to famous SåfÊs, such as J§l§l al-DÊn RåmÊ (1207–1273), author of the MathnavÊ. In the Al-Jawahir-ul Mudiyya of Shaikh Muhyiddin Abdul Kadir (d.1373), and other works, RåmÊ was attached to
49 One of the earliest works of SåfÊ hagiography was Muhammad Ja’far alKhuldÊ’s Hikay§t al-Awliy§ (late ninth or early tenth century), a work no longer extant (Islam 2002:3).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
243
the lineage from Abu Bakr’s family. However, this is contradicted by epigraphic and other evidence (Güven 1991:24–27). The Maulawi sect of SåfÊs, who descend from RåmÊ, thus trace the lineage of their sect back through RåmÊ to Abu Bakr, the first Caliph.50 It was during the twelfth and thirteenth centuries that the organisation of SåfÊ orders as teaching lineages first crystalised (Rizvi 1978:83),51 a link to the lineage of the Prophet Muhammad being crucial.52 During initiation the lineage of the chain of masters is recited, a practice subsequently supplemented by the writing out of the names of the masters of the order, resulting in a filial tree (shajara). Knowing the names of previous masters conferred special religious merit (Ernst and Lawrence 2002:19–23). In this context it is interesting to note the observations of the author of the Dabist§n, written in 1645, comparing the Hindus and the (celibate) Muslim SåfÊs: [The SåfÊs], as they have heard that there ten classes of sany§sÊs, and twelve of yogÊs,53 they also pretend to be divided into fourteen classes; when they meet together, the questions which they ask are: who are the four sages, and which are the fourteen noble families? And they impose upon their disciples many years of service, before they reveal to them the four sages and fourteen families; they say: the sage of sages is the [1] illustrious Muhammed (may the peace of God be upon him!), and after him, devoted to godliness, [2] Ali (may the blessings of God be upon him!); from him the Khalifat devolved upon [3] Imam
50 The four Caliphs reigned as follows: Abu Bakr (632–634); ‘Umar (634–644); ‘Uthm§n/‘Usman (644–656); ‘Ali [bin Abi Talib] (656–661). 51 An example is the Indian Chishti order, which has a tradition of twenty-two masters. Many Chishtis trace their lineage to the archangel Gabriel, and reckon the 21st successor as Shaikh Nií§m ud-DÊn Aulia (d.1325), and the 22nd as Shaikh Nasir ud-DÊn Mahmud Chiragh-i Dihli (d.1356). However, the branch of the Chishti order that predominates in the Deccan starts with the Prophet Muhammad, and counts Shaikh Nií§m ud-DÊn’s successor, Burhan ud-DÊn Gharib (d.1337) as the 21st successor, and Zayn ud-DÊn Shirazi (d.1369), as the 22nd (Ernst and Lawrence 2002:23). 52 Most SåfÊ orders regard ‘Ali as their Shaikh, and trace their descent from either ‘Ali, or from Hasan al-Basri (656–661), who was born in Medina and settled in Basra. According to SåfÊ tradition, Hasan became ‘Ali’s disciple, though this is doubted by mediaeval and modern scholars (Rizvi 1978:27, 83). 53 This is a reference to the twelve panth-s (baropanthÊ ) of N§th-yogÊs/siddha-s, which are: Satyan§th, Dharma, R§m, Nateávar, Kanthar, Kapil, Vair§gya (BhartÜhari), Mann§th (Gopicand), Ayae, Pagal (associated with CauraØgin§th or Puran Bhagat), Dhavja (associated with Hanum§n or Mah§vÊr), GaØg§n§th (associated with BhÊßma, son of GaØg§) (see Banerjea 1988:13–14). For the complete guru-parampar§ of the N§ths, descending from the ‘nine N§ths’, see Vil§sn§th (1998:61–81).
244
chapter seven Hossain;54 then [4] Khaja Hossen of Basora,55 also was his disciple and a khalif; these four personages are the four sages (Dabist§n pp. 220–221).
The text continues with a list of fourteen families,56 which are said to descend from two Caliphs.57 Similarities between the SåfÊ and SaÒny§sÊ overviews of their respective orders is evident.58 54
Husain (624/5–669/70) was the son of ‘Ali. His assasination—while opposing the Umayyads—was a decisive moment in the separation of the supporters of ‘Ali (Shi’a) from the Sunni community. 55 Hasan al-Basri (642–728); most SåfÊ lineages claim to pass through him. 56 In the eleventh century, the Persian SåfÊ, Shaikh al-HujwÊrÊ classified twelve SåfÊ orders, linking each to a famous SåfÊ master, despite the fact that there was seldom a correspondence between these early ascetics and the well-known SåfÊ orders of later times. Sultanate and Mughal tazkira (‘hagiographical family-tree’) writers added two more SåfÊ orders—to make fourteen—but the lists are not consistent (Ernst and Lawrence 2002:24). 57 The text continues: “They say besides, from Khaja Hossen, of Basora, sprang two branches: the first was that of the Khalif Hossen BasorÊ HabÊb AjemÊ, from whom nine families proceeded, named as follows: JÊbʧn, T§ikerʧn, Kherkʧn, Sikatʧn, JenÊdʧn, Gazrånʧn, Tåsʧn, Ferdusʧn, and Soherwardʧn. From the second Khalifat of Hossen Basori, which was that of Shaikh Abdul Wahid Zaid, came forth five families with the following titles: the ZebÊrʧn, Ai§sʧn, Adhamʧn, HabÊrʧn and Cheshtʧn, and these are the fourteen noble families.” The $-Ên-i AkbarÊ of Abu-l-Faíl (1972, Vol. 2:393–420) provides a somewhat different list of the fourteen SåfÊ orders that existed in India at the time of Akbar (r.1556–1605): Habibi, Tayfuri, Karkhi, Saqati, Junaydi, K§zruni, Tusi, Firdaus, Suhrawardi, Zaydi, I’y§zi, Adhami, Hubayri, and Chishti. The lives of the fourteen founding saints are also sketched. “It is said Ali, the Prince of the Faithful, had four viceregents, viz., Hasan, Husayn, Kamil, and Hasan Basri. The source of these orders they believe to be Hasan Basri who had two representatives, Habbib-i-Ajami, from whom the first nine obtain their spiritual fervour, and the other Abdu’l W§had-bZayd, from whom the last five are filled with consolation” (p. 394). Five SåfÊ sects played an important role in India from the fourteenth century onwards: Shatt§ri, Q§diri, Qalandari, Nakshbandi, and Uwaysi (Siddiqi 1989:35). The earliest silsil§ was the Q§diri, founded by Shaikh Abdul Q§dÊr Jil§ni (d.1166) (Rizvi 1993:6 fn. 1). From the beginning of the thirteenth century, the most important of the organised SåfÊ orders in India were the Chishti and Suhrawardi, the former order being more ascetic, independent from state patronage, and also open to outsiders. Suhrawardis were more closed to outsiders, accepted government service, and became wealthy. From the fourteenth century, SåfÊs were often initiated into both orders (Rizvi 1993:13, 217, 272). The Q§diri and Shatt§ri orders became influential in India in the fifteenth century. The Shatt§ri order became closely identified with the state elite (dressing like kings, with followers in military uniform), but lost favour with Akbar, and declined in influence (Lapidus 1988:448). For the founding and resumé of the history of the Q§diri, Suhrawardi, Kubrawi (which has two Indian branches, the Firdawsi and Hamadani), Nakshbandi (Khw§jagan), and Chishti orders, see Rizvi (1978:84–120). For the Shatt§ri order, see Rizvi (1993:62–64). 58 SåfÊ and Daáan§mÊ traditions have parallels even today. During initiation,
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
245
It is not only SåfÊ orders that trace their descent from four preceptors. Also, as previously noted, the áaiva P§áupata order traces its origin to the four disciples of L§kulÊáa. The vaißÖava Vaikh§nasa tradition also traces its origins to four Vedic schools, represented, according to the $nanda-saÒhit§ (XVII. 38–39),59 by four Vedic Üßi-s who were disciples of Vikh§nasa: MarÊci, Atri, Kaáyapa and BhÜgu (Colas 1996:14, 20).60 Within the Indian epic tradition, Vy§sa, the reputed author of the Mah§bh§rata, is said to have had four disciples: Sumanta, Jaimini, Paila, and VaiáaÒp§yana (see Kramisch 1924:2). According to the Jaina “vet§mbara tradition, four pupils of Vajrasv§min (fifth–sixth cent.?) founded four kula-s (‘clans’) for the mendicant community: the Candra (sometimes -kula), the NirvÜtti (sometimes -kula), the Vidy§dhara gaccha (‘those who travel together’) and the N§gendra gaccha. In the mid-thirteenth century, referring to “the four kula-s” was a way of referring to the totality of the “vet§mbara mendicant community (Dundas 1993:251–252; Cort 2001:42).61 The Sikh-related Baܧ (‘large’) Ud§sin akh§Ü§ was founded, according to tradition, by “rÊ Cand, the eldest of the two sons of Guru N§nak (1469–1539). The akh§Ü§ is divided into four divisions, namely: Balu Hasna; Phul Sahib (or Mʧn Sahib); Almast; and Bhagat Bhagv§n (or Gonda). These four dhånÊ-s (dhå§n)62 are said to have been instituted in 1636 by the four disciples of B§b§ Gurdita, who followed “rÊ Cand on the gaddÊ.63 According to the Bhaktam§la (v. 32) of N§bhad§sa64
Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs receive instruction on their Maãh§mn§ya, and usually receive a paper, such as the Daán§m-kalp-vÜkß, providing the four maãha scheme. A largely parallel procedure still operates at the Amin ud-DÊn darg§h on “§hpur Hill, near Bijapur (Eaton 1997:304). On induction to the order, murÊd-s are issued with printed certificates linking them, through Amin ud-DÊn, to the Chishti SåfÊs of Delhi, and ultimately to the Prophet. 59 The earliest part of the Vaikh§nasa corpus dates from the ninth century, while the bulk was composed in the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries. 60 See also Caland (1941:i–xxxvi). 61 There is some evidence that all of these four gaccha-s were extant in the late fourteenth century, but by the sixteenth century only the Candra gaccha was still flourishing. The gaccha-s, as organisational units, gradually replaced ‘the four kula-s’ during this period. 62 Besides the four dhånÊ-s, seven bhakáiá-s were founded, that is, centres of Sikhism in different parts of India, but mostly in Punjab (Singh 1951:64–66). There is here also some kind of a parallel with the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s. 63 See Ch. 3.1. 64 See Pollet (1963:76, 171).
246
chapter seven
(c.1600), R§m§nuja had four disciples;65 and it seems the organisation of the four vaißÖava samprad§ya-s may have first formally arisen in the sixteenth century.66 This is not to suggest that the SaÒny§sÊs necessarily borrowed the idea of four ‘disciples’ from the SåfÊ or any other tradition, as “aØkara may possibly have had four disciples, though it is perhaps significant that the chief mahant-s of the akh§Ü§-s are sometimes called pÊr, a Muslim honorific term. However, some evidence has been presented to show that there was a very fertile context for the development of an identity for an orthodox Hindu order. By the middle of the seventeenth century in north and south-central India, there was harassment of Hindu saÒny§sÊ-s and yogÊ-s; the heightened power and prestige of pÊr-s and darg§h-s with their proud and remunerative lineages; a more orthodox regime at Delhi perceived by many as essentially hostile towards Hindus; and, importantly, large roving bands of militant n§g§-saÒny§sÊ-s with what seems to have been a non-orthodox Tantric background. The notion of ten names seems first to be attested around the end of the sixteenth century, around the time of the formation of the first militant akh§Ü§-s. It is suggested that it was in this context that the Maãh§mn§ya-s emerged as an ideological response to the saÒny§sÊ-s’ social and political situation. The Maãh§mn§ya-s built on to the notion of “aØkara as a áaiva who conquered the four corners of India with Ved§nta, with the claim that “aØkara also founded of an order of ascetics, who consequently became united under an orthodox Hindu umbrella. The Daáan§mÊ order amalgamated lineages of militant Giris, PurÊs and Bh§ratÊs, with other monastic lineages, producing the compound order of ‘TÊrtha, $árama, Vana, AraÖya, Giri, Parvata, S§gara, SarasvatÊ, Bh§ratÊ and PurÊ’. Some of the activities of the n§g§-s and akh§Ü§-s will now be discussed to illustrate the diversity of Daáan§mÊ activities, by this time with some kind of orthodox identity.
65 66
“rutiprajña, “rutideva, “rutidh§m§, and “rutidadhi. See Ch. 2.1, fn. 7.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
247
7.4 Mercenary and military activities of n§g§-s and gosain-s Sarkar (1958:262–286) records the service to various regents in north India by n§g§ armies of up to many thousands of Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊ gosain-s, Bair§gÊ and other fighting orders, who fought in numerous battles, both defensive and aggressive. During the early eighteenth century the city of Jhansi was the capital of a small state ruled over by Daáan§mÊ gosain-s (see below). During the latter half of the eighteenth and the early nineteenth centuries they were employed, in many instances as a regularly paid standing army, in service to Mah§r§jas of Jodhpur, Jaipur, Jaisalmer, Bikaner, Udaipur, BaÜaud§, Marv§r (western Madhya Pradesh), and Bhuj (capital town of Kacch). In an official bond-letter dating from the 1730s, addressed to the Mah§r§ja Jaisingh II (r.1700–1743),67 the R§m§nandÊ, Vrij§nand, abjures the carrying of arms and allowing armed monks to attend R§m§nandÊ communal feasts. This indicates their conspicuous presence.68 It is further stated that those R§m§nandÊs who do so will be expelled from the seven-branched “rÊ R§m§nandÊ samprad§ya (the seven-branched samprad§ya being perhaps modelled on the seven akh§Ü§-s of the Daáan§mÊs). The Daáan§mÊs, along with Sant and other vaißÖava orders, were similarly requested to sign such bonds ([Thiel]-Horstman 2001:3–4). However, this did not prevent their extensive military campaigns.69
67 Jaisingh II was a king of the Kachav§h§ dynasty of eastern Rajasthan. The kings of this dynasty operated as semi-autonomous regents under the Mughals. Their capital moved from Ajmer to Jaipur in 1739. 68 They were permanently established at a small fort at the base of Nahargarh hill (Orr 1940:11). 69 R§m§nandÊ warriors under Vrij§nand subsequently engaged in battle in 1744 in the neighbouring states of Ko㧠and BåndÊ with forces that were threatening ^ávarsingh, Jaisingh II’s successor. Although the R§m§nandÊs fought on behalf of the Mah§r§ja of Jaipur, they were not on his regular payroll. Vrij§nand died in 1752, and was succeded by B§l§nand, whom R§m§nandÊ tradition credits with giving definitive shape to the military organisation of the R§m§nandÊs, in 1734. Although B§l§nand is cast as a R§m§nandÊ, R§m§nanda is nowhere mentioned in the relevant documents of the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries. Rather, it is R§m§nuja who figures as the spiritual fountainhead of the order ([Thiel-] Horstmann 2001:8). B§l§nand’s forces fought against the J§ãs who were seeking to expand. Outside Rajasthan, B§l§nand had strongholds in the entire Braj-Bh§ratpur region, and as far away as Jagann§th PurÊ. B§l§nand died in 1795, his funeral being attended by numerous dignitaries, testifying to his power and influence. He had
248
chapter seven
The militant D§dåpanthÊs were supported by the Mah§r§ja of Jaipur, M§dhav Singh, who reigned from 1750 to 1767. Court records reveal that, beginning in 1768, the n§g§-s began to receive ever more lucrative land-grants and payments. By 1803, eight years after they had officially joined state forces, 4,000 n§g§-s were a part of the 13,000-strong state army of Jaipur.70 There are other documented instances of large bands of gosain n§g§-s being hired for specific military offensives. In 1763, PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ “§h, king of Gorkha, and the founder of modern Nepal,71 was engaged in a campaign to extend his empire into the Kathmandu valley (Baral 1964:231–234). His chief adviser and strategist was the ascetic N§th-siddha, Bhagavantn§th, who used his influence to negotiate various matrimonial and military alliances between Gorkha and some of the other forty-five kingdoms of western Nepal. During PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ’s attack on the village of S§g§, his Ghorkalese troops were confronted by five hundred n§g§-s who were fighting on behalf of one of his opponents, Jayaprak§á Malla, king of Kathmandu. The leader of the n§g§-s, Gul§bram, had given a sword to PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ “§h when the latter visited him in Banaras twenty years previously. Gul§bram, believing the sword to be responsible for the king’s success in battle, had returned for recompense, which was denied. Gul§bram and his forces then took up arms with Jayaprak§á, but with disastrous consequences; all the n§g§-s were slaughtered by the Ghorkalese army. Gul§bram, however, escaped. During the 1780s, some seven hundred n§g§-s died in battle in another Himalayan province, Kumaon. 1,400 n§g§-s had been enlisted, with the promise of substantial financial rewards, by king Mohan Cand in his unsuccessful attempt to recapture his seat at Almora, from which he had been deposed by his rival, Harßdeo Joái, king of the neighbouring province, GaÜhv§l (Agrawal 1993:325). been an §c§rya for forty-three years and had accumulated much wealth and several important temples; he was succeeeded by Govind§nand. 70 Crooke (1896, Vol. 4:238) reports that the D§dåpanthÊ n§g§-s live in seven camps or villages in the neighbourhood of Jaipur. They are occasionally sent out to coerce revenue defaulters. Their pay is one anna per day in peacetime, and two per day during active service. All are never on duty at the same time; those left at home cultivate land, breed camels or lend money. As late as 1914, a group of D§dåpanthÊs offered military service to the Government of India for the First World War. However, they refused to enlist in the regular army, and their offer was not accepted (Orr 1940:12 fn. 4). 71 See Burghart (1995) for the king’s attempt to found a “Hindu” kingdom.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
249
The careers of three prominent Daáan§mÊ gosain n§g§-s, namely Rajendra Giri Gosain (d.1753), and his cel§-s, the brothers Anåp Giri Gosain (Himmat Bah§dur) (1730–1804) and Umrao Giri Gosain (b.1734), have been documented by Sarkar (1958:123–261) and Bhalla (1944).72 Their studies reveal the extent of some gosain-s’ power, wealth, influence and duplicity. At the height of their careers the gosain-s commanded a force of up to forty thousand horse and foot soldiers. The movement and recruitment of troops was greatly facilitated by a network of weapon-stocks and grain-stores in the countryside. Gosain-s also looked after food-producing small holdings at different times of the year. When on campaigns, most of which were executed in the Gangetic region, they carried equipment—including materials for mounting fortified locations—on elephants and other pack animals, and had camel-mounted guns. The army was equipped with excellent horses and state-of-the-art weapons, including musketry and artillery.73 They were highly regarded by the British as a fighting force, ranked alongside the Afghans, J§ãs and Sikhs, and particularly renowned for their night-time guerilla operations: naked, slippery with oil, and deadly with the dagger. The gosain-s Rajendra Giri, Anåp Giri, Umrao Giri, and their n§g§ saÒny§sÊ armies, fought on behalf of several rulers and regents, their mercenary approach to war resulting on some occasions in their changing sides to fight on behalf of former adversaries. Their patrons in the mid-eighteenth century included the Safdar Jang,74 vazÊr
72
See also Kolff (1971) and Barnett (1987) for further details of their activities and political developments. 73 Military equipment also included bows and arrows, shields, spears, discuses (worn around the neck), the ‘rocket’ (a metal cylinder with knives), and the ‘umbrella’ (a mechanism of revolving iron balls) (Orr 1940:16). 74 The Mughals also supported R§m§nandÊ n§g§-s at Ayodhya. Safdar Jang granted seven bÊgh§-s of land at Hanum§n hill to Abhay R§m D§s, the abbott of the Nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§. During the reign of Shuja’s successor, Asaf ud-Daulah (r.1775–1793), funds were raised to construct part of the fortess-like building to be found at this site. It seems that originally the N§ths and then the Daáan§mÊs were the former occupants of the hill. The Daáan§mÊs also used to dominate Ayodhya, but were evicted from Ayodhya (except for the Siddhigiri maãha) and the hill then occupied by the Jån§ akh§Ü§. R§m§nandÊ forces were led by Abhay R§m D§s (van der Veer 1988:143–147). All Mughal emperors, from Akbar to “§h $lam II (the last Mughal emperor, r.1759–1806) also supported N§th institutions and individuals, as has the royal house of Nepal since the mid-eighteenth century. “§h $lam II was highly influenced by the charisma and yogic powers of Mastn§th (White 2001:8, 15).
250
chapter seven
(‘chancellor’) to the Mughal Emperor (Ahmad “§h) and ruler of the province of Avadh, and his successor Shuja-ud-Daulah.75 Campaigns were launched against the encroaching Afghans,76 and an unsuccessful attempt to capture Delhi was also pursued in 1753, resulting in the death of Rajendra Giri. In league with the Afghans, the n§g§-s also fought the Mar§ãhas. Before the battle of Panipat in 1761, an assembly of the Afghans were most upset at the sight the naked army of Shuja, “with their things and buttocks exposed” (Sarkar 1958:158). A combined army of Mughals, Path§ns, Ruhel§s, R§jpåts, n§g§-s and others fought the British in battles at Patna and Buxar in 1764. However, the British repelled the attackers with superior fire-power (Sarkar 1958:163–166). Anåp Giri and Umrao Giri continued their mercenary activites under other patrons, including the J§ãs under JavahÊr Singh, in their unsuccessful campaign to capture Delhi from the Ruhel§s in 1764 and 1765 (Sarkar 1958:170–172). However, in 1767 the two gosain-s again changed sides, serving under the Mar§ãha, Ragun§th Rao (Sarkar 1958:178). During Rao’s absence in the Deccan, the gosain-s lived by plundering BundelkhaÖ·, to be subsequently re-employed by the nav§b of Avadh, Shuja-ud-Daulah, between 1767 and 1775. They were paid the colossal sum of 48,000 rupees per year (Bhalla 1944:129). Together with the Mar§ãha, Gop§l Rao, the two gosain-s were employed as high commanders who held the power of dastkhat (‘signature’), entitling them enlist troops without reference to Shuja (Barnett 1987:79).77 For the next fifteen years the gosain-s served a series of regimes78 in Delhi, interspersed with periods of sanctioned plunder. Anåp Giri’s last patron, from 1789 and 1802, was the Mar§ãha, Ali Bah§dur, who eventually conquered 75 Politically expedient ‘religious syncretism’ on the part of regents and powerbrokers during this period was not uncommon (see Bayly 1985:177–191). 76 In one campaign the Afghans, under Ahmad “§h Abdali, attacked the holy shrine of Gokul, near Mathur§. Four thousand n§g§ saÒny§sÊ-s and bair§gÊ-s defended the shrine, but two thousand of them were slain (Sarkar 1958:154). 77 In battle against the Mar§ãhas in 1787, áaiva n§g§ gosain-s under Anåp Giri fought alongside another army of n§g§-s, including five thousand musketeers, under the vaißÖava bair§gÊ commander, B§lan§nand, who was in service to the Mah§r§ja of Jaipur, who had up to 10,000 n§g§-s in his army (Bhalla 1944:130–134; Sarkar 1958:226–252; Chandra 1977:21). 78 These were Mirza Najaf Kh§n (who seized Delhi in 1773); the Mar§ãha, M§dhav Rao Scindia (from 1784); and “§h $lam II. Anåp was in charge of the defence of the city during the two latter regimes.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
251
BundelkhaÖ· with the assistance of Anåp Giri’s forces, for which he was rewarded with 1,300,000 rupees (Bhalla 1944:133).79 The Treaty of Bassein, signed in 1802, ceded large parts of BundelkhaÖ· from the Mar§ãhas to the British. In 1803 Anåp Giri and his forces at first united with the Mar§ãhas to repel the British, who were threatening Anåp’s territory. However, through the British Collector, Mr. Mercer, and Colonel Mieselbach, Anåp sold himself and his 4,000 cavalry and 8,000 foot-soldiers to the British. When his forces arrived they received a thirteen-gun-salute (Bhalla 1944:134). Alongside the British under Colonel Powell, they conquered Bundelkhan·, defeating the Mar§ãha chief, “amáer Bah§dur (son and succesor of Ali Bah§dur), other warlords and BuÖ·ela chieftans (Pinch 1997:10). Anåp concluded a treaty with the British on September 4th, yielding a j§gÊr of 2,200,000 rupees, the right to maintain a force of 10,000 cavalry, and a swathe of land between Kalpi (near Mathur§) and Allahabad. Anåp’s brother Umrao Giri had been imprisoned on account of a conspiracy, but his release and a pension were negotiated. Anåp Giri died in 1804 at the age of seventy, shortly after the conclusion of the war.80 Anåp Giri had a son, Narender Giri, but he did not inherit his father’s estate (Bhalla 1944:135).81
7.5 SaÒny§sÊ-s, fakÊr-s and rebellion in east India After the defeat of the nav§b Siraj-ud-Daulah at the battle of Plassey in 1757, the British had gained control of revenue collection in Bengal, Bihar and Orissa by 1767. In the general breakdown of law and order during the disintegration of Mughal authority—after the death of Aurangzeb in 1707—many saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s had become organised in roving bandit/dacoit groups, sometimes known
79 In 1791 Anåp Giri placed local R§jpåts and others under the command of a Dutch colonel, John Mieselbach (Sarkar 1958:256). 80 Anåp established a small town in BundelkhaÖ·, named Gosainpur (Hunter 1885, Vol. 5:173). His earthly remains were deposited in a tomb two miles north of Banda. 81 According to Sarkar (1958:205), Anåp Giri’s son was Kum§r GaØg§ Giri, and another adopted son was Kum§r Kañcangir. Umrao Giri had two sons, namely Kum§r Jagat Giri and Uttam Giri, who were also involved in courtly life and mercenary activity (Sarkar 1958:245).
252
chapter seven
as PiÖ·arÊs.82 Company records contain numerous reports of incursions by these ‘marauding’ and frequently armed groups, the first of which took place in 1743 (Ghosh 1930:36). Although often naked, leading gosain-s frequently wore gold and silver bangles and necklaces, sometimes studded with pearls and diamonds (Ghosh 1930:19). British forces were subsequently engaged in numerous skirmishes and battles with bands of saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s in Bihar and Bengal (Ghosh 1930; Chandra 1977).83 The British version of events is, by and large, endorsed by Ghosh, whereby the ash-clad, bh§Øg-drinking saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s are presented as marauder-bandits, masquerading as pilgrims, but extracting money and goods from local landlords and peasants on false pretences. However, this view has been challenged (Chandra 1977; Chatterjee 1984): if the socio-economic situation of the region at the time is considered, then the disturbances can be seen as part of a larger movement of peasant unrest and rebellion against colonial repression and excessive taxation, sometimes leading to starvation; saÒny§sÊ and fakÊr n§g§-s were frequently at the spearhead of the movement.84
82
After the battle of Panipat in 1761, the Mar§ãhas were forced to rely on mercenaries, some of whom received the name ‘PiÖ·arÊ’ (Gordon 1969:426). 83 From 1757 there are reports of battles between up to 5,000 saÒny§sÊ-s and British sepoys, forced seizure of money from zamÊnd§r-s’ kacaharÊ-s (‘revenue offices’) and Collectors, and raids on villages and factories at Dacca and other places by groups of armed saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s. The first raid on a British factory was at Rampur Boalia, in Dacca, in 1763, by saÒny§sÊ-s assisted by unemployed cotton workers. In some raids British agents were killed, and army captains were regularly dispatched to disperse the raiders, not always successfully; both sides frequently sufferered extensive casualties. The raids were frequently successful as the robbers could flee from the British-held territories of Bengal, Bihar and Orissa. In a series of succesful raids on zamÊnd§r-s in 1773, the saÒny§sÊ-s were led by Motit Giri and Dharma Giri (Chatterjee 1984:8). In the latter decades of the eighteenth century the fakÊr-s were under the leadership of the Mad§ri SåfÊ, Mañju “§h (d.1787), whose first raid in Bengal was conducted in 1771 (Chandra 1977:49–68). By 1774 he had established a cantonment in Dinajpur district of well-armed R§jpåts, with whom he had formed an alliance. A series of raids were conduced in 1786 by Musa “§h (d.1792), a relative of Manju, who retreated to a headquarters he had established in Gorkha, Nepal. Various groups of saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s operated out of Myemsingh (in what is now northern Bangladesh), an area over which ruling authorities, including Garos, Koches, Afghans, north-Indian Brahmans and breakaway Mughals, had only ever been able to exert minimal control (van Schendel 1985:140–144). 84 The situation was significantly exacerbated by the great famine of 1770/1771, when around one third of the population of Bengal, some fifteen million people, died. However, Warren Hastings was able to write to the Board of Directors that, despite the decrease in population, revenue had increased in 1771, in comparison
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
253
Groups of saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s—who ocasionally fought each other (Chandra 1977:29)—together with other pilgrims had for many centuries enjoyed annual pilgrimages to holy places in Bihar, Bengal and Assam.85 Some fakÊr-s had enjoyed extraordinary privileges under various patrons in the seventeenth and the early part of the eighteenth century. Prior to full British control over revenue, Muslim authorities occasionally issued sanad-s (‘deeds/grants’) to ensure the rights of the fakÊr-s to collect alms and acquire property,86 a demand on meagre peasant resources also regarded as legitimately collectable by the British in the form of tax. Some groups of saÒny§sÊ-s were also employed simply as mercenaries in the service of political rivals to the British.87 British forces, under orders from Warren Hastings, made strenuous to 1768, owing to his diligent efforts: taxes were collected with the help of troops. Price-fixing, monopoly purchase, enforced monoculture, and control over trade in many goods, such as grain, salt, cotton and opium were amongst the economic tactics used by the British, leading to deprivation and workers’ anger. The price of rice increased enormously. Exorbitant demands for payment led to ryots being evicted from their land, many of them swelling the ranks of the roving saÒny§sÊ and fakÊr bands, perhaps to up to 20,000 strong. Farmers enlisted the help of n§g§-s to resist new taxes introduced in 1770 (Chandra 1977:149, 166; Chatterjee 1984:6). 85 Visited by saÒny§sÊ-s and other Hindus in this part of India were places such as Janakpur (in the Terai), Mah§sthangarh (near Bogra), places along the Brahmapåtra river, GaØg§ S§gar (on the bay of Bengal, about fifty miles east of Calcutta), Jagann§th Påri and K§m§kßÊ (near Guahati). Many saÒny§sÊ-s began their annual pilgrmage cycle from the M§gh Mel§ at Allahabad in January/February. The fakÊr-s and other Muslim pilgrims, who entered Bengal by the same route as that followed by the saÒny§sÊ-s—and who were generally better received in Muslimdominated Bengal—went to darg§h-s, several of which are located in Dinajpur and Malda districts, and to the famous AdÊna mosque, near Pandua, also in the Malda district. Some pilgrimage sites were common to both fakÊr-s and saÒny§sÊ-s, one being a bath in the river Karotoya at Mah§sthangarh, where there is the darg§h of PÊr “§h Sultan (Ghosh 1930:24–29). Another was at Makhanpur, in the district of Cawnpore, 140 miles from Agra, where the headquarters of the Mard§ri fakÊr-s and the tomb of “§h Mad§r are situated. Hindus also frequented the place, believing the saint to be an incarnation of Lakhan (Ghosh 1930:27). 86 In 1659 Shuja-ud-Daulah issued a sanad to the fakÊr Janab “§h Sultan Has§n Måri§ (of the Burhana sect, which is the same as the Mad§ris, who, of all SåfÊ sects, most closely resemble saÒny§sÊ n§g§-s) whereby within the countries of Bengal, Bihar and Orissa he was free to roam with all the paraphernalia of the julås (‘procession’), and confiscate properties with no heir, or which are rent-free. Although no contributions were to be levied, the fakÊr “will be supplied with provisions”, according to the sanad (Ghosh 1930:22). 87 Five or six thousand armed saÒny§sÊ-s undertook raids in 1773, in the pay of Darpa Deo, r§ja of Baikantapur. In the same year another large raiding group was reportedly in the pay of the Bhutanese (Chandra 1977:72–73).
254
chapter seven
efforts to prohibit, rout and dispel the raiders entering Bengal. No less than four battalions of the army were actively engaged against the saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s (Chandra 1977:84, 101–114), and attempts were also made to remove settled saÒny§sÊ-s—many of them being landless peasants—of which there were several thousand in some districts.88 The British negotiated with the Nepalese, and signed a treaty with the Tashu L§m§ of Bhutan, to prevent saÒny§sÊ-s from being resident in their territory, and by 1800 the rebellion that had continued for thirty-five years was finally suppressed. Raids on Company-owned finance and property in east India ceased (Chandra 1977:131–137), and the few military n§g§-s who remained in south Bihar in 1809/1810 were reported to have abandoned arms (Pinch 1996:31).89 Nevertheless, it seems that some saÒny§sÊ-s (or those pretending to be saÒny§sÊ-s) were still involved in criminal activities in the nineteenth century. Their activities were were virtually indistinguishable from, and carried out in broadly the same region (central India) as those of maruding bands of PiÖ·arÊ highway robbers (van Woerkens 2002:26ff.). These bandits were also called Thag (Thug/Thugi/Thagi) by the British, a term that had already been used in South Asia to refer to criminal assassins for about a thousand years.90 In 1830, a government ‘Department of Thagis and Dacoits’ was set up by the
88 A law was passed in 1773 to prohibit the carrying of arms by saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s, and certain sects of saÒny§sÊ-s, bair§gÊ-s and fakÊr-s were expelled from Bengal and Bihar, becoming ‘prohibited sects’. Farmers found to be harbouring members of prohibited sects were to be severely punished (Chandra 1977:60). 89 After a series of land-reforms had been implemented by Warren Hastings, by 1790 revenue collection for the British was undertaken by a new class of landlords, who frequently employed saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s for that purpose. Under the Permanent Settlement of Bengal Act of 1793, responsibility for law and order then passed from the zamÊnd§r-s to a newly created police force (Chandra 1977:165). Some zamÊnd§r-s granted land, in a religious donation (sibbotar), rent-free, to ascetics. Landlords thereby enhanced their own status in the area, and gained a protection force of armed saÒny§sÊ-s to guard their estates. SaÒny§sÊ-s were also given land after they had assisted landlords’ own forces in repelling aggressors (Chatterjee 1984:3). In north and east Bengal, some saÒny§sÊ-s still live on the produce of endowed lands (Ghosh 1930:160). 90 Bh§sarvajña (ninth century) makes perhaps the first known reference: he refers to the ãhakaá§stra in connection with the killing of Brahmans. Several writers use the term in the following centuries; and a fourteenth century Muslim report mentions thag-s. The term ãhaka/ãhaga may be derived from the Sanskrit root sthag (‘cover/ conceal’). See Halbfass (1983:13, 24 fn. 61) for further details and references.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
255
Governor General, Lord William Bentick. It was to oversee the activities of Thugs, and was run by William Sleeman, a British official who is responsible for the stereotyping of the term ‘Thug’. Sleeman had read an article by Dr. Sherwood (a surgeon in Madras), published in 1816, entitled ‘Of The Murderers Called Phansigars [‘stranglers’]’, which so concerned him that he transfered to the Civil Service in 1918 (Annan 1967:64ff.).91 Sleeman, the initiator and architect of the anti-Thug campaign, came to believe that three-quarters of Hindu and Muslim mendicants were criminals (van Woerkens 2002:102ff.), and that the Thugs—who worshipped K§lÊ, and either strangled or poisoned their victims—constituted an organised criminal sect.92 Such was the British suspicion of ascetics that a police handbook (s§dhu-i-kitab, written in Urdu) was issued in 1913 to enable officers to identify s§dhu-s by their appearance and sectarian markings (Pinch 1996:8). However, within the socio-political context of the time, it is apparent that the Thugs were not an organised religious sect or a caste; that their activities were entirely mercenary; and that the notion of a Thug ‘conspiracy’ was unfounded, but nevertheless helped to finance Sleeman’s department,93 which was quite successful in catching and punishing several thousand criminals. Marauding PiÖ·arÊ groups that had previously been employed, on an occasional basis, as mercenaries by various powers such as the Mar§ãhas, in many instances simply continued their ‘criminal’ marauding activities when states had insufficient funds to pay them (see Gordon 1969). There is also a widely-held nationalist notion, still prevalent, of a specifically Hindu militant saÒny§sÊ rebellion against British rule in the eighteenth century, famously taken up as the main theme of a novel by Bankim Chandra Chatterji94 (1838–1894), $nandamaãh. The influence of this image is apparent in that Bande Mataram, the saÒny§sÊ song from the novel—which was set to music by Rabindranath Tagore—became the unofficial anthem of the Independence
91 According to van Woerkens (2002:44ff.), who provides a comprehensive account of the Thugs, Sleeman first heard of specific crimes of the Thugs sometime between 1822 and 1824; an anti-Thug law was passed in 1836 (p.100). 92 See Sleeman (1903, Vol. 1:96–111) for his account of the iniquity of the Thugs. 93 The idea of a criminal religious cult also proved popular with the Victorian press and as a theme for novelists (see Rushby 2002:8–15). 94 For Chatterji’s role in the formation of Neo-Hinduism, see Halbfass (1988:243– 246, 334–341).
256
chapter seven
movement.95 However, we have seen that the situation regarding s§dhu-s in the eighteenth century cannot simply be characterised as a Hindu saÒny§sÊ uprising against British rule: SåfÊ fakÊr-s were involved with saÒny§sÊ-s in the Bengal rebellion, and the gosain fighters formed substantial alliances with not only the Mughals but also the British. SaÒny§sÊ-s performed various roles in the period under discussion, both in support and against the rule of various powers. Nor can saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s be characterised, as they were by the British, as simply ‘Thugs’. This is to ignore the complex, various and shifting roles of many saÒny§sÊ-s in this period: as ascetics (some of whom would not so much as touch a coin), and as pilgrims, traders, money-lenders, mercenaries, protection guards, bandits, and on occasion even diplomats.96
7.6 Gosain traders and bankers Many of the political conflicts previously discussed had ceased by the beginning of the nineteenth century, by which time many thousands of gosain-s97 had settled in Bengal and other parts of India, many of them being ex-soldiers from disbanded armies of various regents. These settled gosain-s, some of them rich from war, engaged 95 M. K. Gandhi also took up the song as a constituent of his nationalist ideology. When V. D. Savarkar, the famous Indian freedom-fighter, was at high school in N§sik, he belonged to and recruited members to a secret society of revolutionaries, aiming to liberate their motherland from British rule. Members greeted each other with Bande Mataram, and in a pamphlet with that name Savarkar asserted that the assassination of British officials is the first stage of the revolution. In his monumental work, Indian War of Independence, 1857, Savarkar refutes British accounts of the Mutiny of 1857 as failed. The work, which describes how s§dhu-s, saÒny§sÊ-s and fakÊr-s can become revolutionaries, was banned but achieved wide circulation, becoming, for half a century, the Indian revolutionaries’ gospel and handbook. Savarkar was imprisoned for terrorist activities from 1910 to 1937. He then became president of the Hindu Mah§sabh§ from 1937 to 1944 (McKean 1996:73–77). See Savarkar (1989) for his conception of Hindutva. 96 In the 1770s, PuraÖ Gir mediated between the Panchen L§m§ and the British, serving both sides in their negotiation of a trade treaty between Bengal and Tibet. After the death of the L§m§, Puran Gir (and his successor, Daljit Gir) continued his negotiating role with the L§m§’s successor. In 1779 Puran Gir travelled with the Panchen L§m§ to Peking to visit the Chinese emperor (Clarke 1998:66). 97 The number of áaiva and vaißÖava ascetics in north India in the last decades of the eighteenth century was considerable, around 500,000, comprising around five percent of the population (Bayly 1992:126, 183).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
257
in money-lending, banking and trading, involving significant amounts of money overall. Evidence of saÒny§sÊ-s’ involvement in trade may be seen in Banaras, where in 1787 they were the dominant merchant class, having a substantial trade in cloth, raw silk, gold and silver, in a network extending to the Deccan, Bengal and Nepal. In Banaras alone they owned forty of the leading business houses, representing a significant sector of the economy.98 Established also in Mirzapur, the gosain-s, who were mostly Giris, were described by G. H. Barlow, sub-secretary to the Bengal government, as being “a religious sect remarkable for their wealth, and for their integrity in all commercial transactions” (K. P. Mishra 1975:95–96). In Mirzapur, the gosain-s were the accepted leaders of the merchant community (Bayly 1992:143), one Giri mahant being notorious amongst merchants (Crooke 1896, Vol. 2:471). In 1911, the Giris of the Mirzapur area were reported to have land-holdings amounting to 44,784 acres, income deriving also from rent and money-lending (Chatterjee 1984:3–4). By the 1780s gosain-s had become the dominant money-lending—frequently at exorbitant rates of interest99—and property-owning group in Allahabad, Banaras, Mirzapur, Ujjain and N§gpur (Bayly 1992:126, 143; Kolff 1971), and were major brokers in Rajasthan and the Deccan, at places such as Hyderabad and PåÖe (Clarke 1998:58).100 There was, however, often a very thin line indeed between tax-collection, dacoity and money-lending.101
98 In 1786/1787 the total value of the saÒny§sÊ-s’ imports and exports which passed through the customs houses of Banaras and Mirzapur was 1,614,759 Rs.. Around 40% of the trade was in raw silk, most of which was brought from Bengal and traded in Mirzapur and Banaras for bullion or other commodities (K. P. Mishra 1975:96). The figure given above only records the declared goods, and does not account for what appears to have been a substantial non-declared trade. In 1809/1810, one gosain merchant alone sent silk worth 650,000 Rs. to the United Provinces (Cohn 1964:177). 99 Aware of the saÒny§sÊ-s’ profitable money-lending business, the British government enacted various measures in 1772 to cap loan rates (at 2%) and restrict the saÒny§sÊ-s’ business. 100 Chatterjee suggests that the increase in money-lending activities of the saÒny§sÊ-s was partly a consequence of a decline in their previously profitable silk-smuggling business. This decline was an effect of superior British production techniques, extra levies and custom posts. The saÒny§sÊ-s complained to the British administration of being taxed in both Banaras and Mirzapur, and for a while tried to smuggle goods through Bihar. The British nevertheless recognised the value of the saÒny§sÊ-s’ trade (Cohn 1964:177). 101 Mar§ãha tax records of the mid-eighteenth century illustrate the nexus between
258
chapter seven
In the 1780s, European banking houses were also established to finance trade, with the resultant consequence that samÖy§sÊ-s’ profit able loan businesses were effectively squeezed (Chatterjee 1984:7). The extent of the saÒny§sÊ-s’ money-lending business may be gauged from their involvement in the financing of the war between PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ “§h, Jayaprak§á Malla and others, in their struggle for control of the Kathmandu valley in the mid-eighteenth century, referred to in the previous section. It is evident that PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ “§h helped finance his campaign with cash loans from saÒny§sÊ traders, who had trade agencies in several cities in the valley.102 The gosain-s were repaid, and as a reward they were awarded charters to trade freely in his domain. The gosain-s profited handsomely from both sides throughout the duration of the conflict, in terms of both financial interest earned and trading rights.103 However, it appears that some gosain-s and Kashmiris were expelled from Nepal by PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ “§h owing to their allegiance to the Malla dynasty (Regmi 1975, Vol. 1:117–121, 201).104 During the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries it is apparent that some saÒny§sÊ maãha-s—which were occasionally fortified (Ghosh
money-lending, dacoity and mercenary activity. The gosain (or any) money-lender would typically loan money against the purchase of goods, and also arrange transport and guards. Default on repayment could result in land and its derivative revenue being acquired by the lender, an arrangement that was legally binding. Transfer of ownership of land and its revenue meant that the new ‘owner’ could demand money from tenants. Rulers also used their military forces to collect taxes, and the military were often gosain-s (Gordon 1971). 102 The first request for a loan was made in 1745, addressed to Mahant Kamala Bana, Mahant Lakßman PurÊ, and D§yal PurÊ. This was in a period when Jayaprak§á Malla was in exile—but not abdication—from his throne in Kathmandu. In 1748, Jayaprak§á Malla, alarmed at the threat to his realm, then borrowed 20,000 Rs., after extensive bargaining, from Kamala Bana Gosain and Rakham PurÊ Gosain to help finance his bid to reclaim the throne, which was successful. 103 In 1764 Jayaprak§á issued a charter requesting that the gosain-s—Durbasa Bana, Lakßman Bana, Jageávara Bana, BhagavatÊ Bana (disciple of Kamala Bana), Bhor Bana, Naval Bana and Catår Bana—reside in Kathmandu with him, enjoying royal favour. After the eventual fall of Kathmandu, the new ruler PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ “§h continued to support gosain-s. In 1786 he issued another charter, addressed to the first four of the above-named gosain-s, permitting them to conduct trade to Tibet, subject to statutory checking and taxes. It is curious that this lineage of Daáan§mÊs, the Bana (Van), although so prominent in Nepal in the eighteenth century, is very meagrely represented these days. 104 Sometime after 1792 the gosain-s were also expelled from Tashilumpo in Tibet, owing to the suspicion by the Chinese authorities that they were acting as spies for their enemies (Clarke 1998:56, 67).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
259
1930:20)—became, effectively, storehouses for the trade in goods (including raw silk, shawls, opium, gold, silver, copper and spices) which was carried out by cel§-s of various mahant-s over wide areas of north India. SaÒny§sÊ traders who profited were able to buy land, sometimes acquired from both peasants and landlords suffering insuperable debt. Individuals and groups of pilgrims traded in precious and semi-precious gems, notably coral and pearl from the Coromandel coast and Sri Lanka. They also traded in diamonds, brocade, broadcloth, tobacco, indigo and conch shells. Coral and pearl were two of the principal exports from Bengal to Tibet, while musk, golddust and yaktails were brought from there (Clarke 1998). A network of maãha-s and pilgrimage routes throughout India greatly facilitied contacts, trade, resting places and loan facilities. Armed n§g§-s were available to protect the transportation of goods and bullion traded from as far afield as Ahmadabad, BaÜaud§, PåÖe, N§gpur, Bengal, Kashmir, Nepal and Tibet. The n§g§-s’ religious status and their fearsome reputation also made them virtually immune from prosecution or police harrassment (Bayly 1992:184). In 1792, the r§ja of Nepal complained that “although the fakÊr105 is full of faults and deserving death”, he could only expell them from his territory and could not confine or kill them, as that would be contrary to religious law (Ghosh 1930:9).106 The gosain-s were all members of a religious fraternity107 whose
105
In Nepalese records of this period, the term fakÊr is used also for saÒny§sÊ. The different status of ascetics regarding the law may be seen also in ancient India, in Dharmaá§stra. Olivelle (1987:48), reviewing injunctions found in several works, notes that ascetics, when found guilty of a crime, were not subject to the corresponding punishment (instead they were required to perform religious works for the king); they were not to be tortured during interrogations; judges were expected to show leniency towards them; and wandering asectics could obtain a pass from the Controller of Shipping that allowed them to cross rivers without paying the usual fee. Amongst the privileges for Brahmanical ascetics were land-grants that were made to them in newly-settled countyside; they were exempted from the salt tax; and the property of an ascetic could not be taken as booty when an enemy’s land was conquered. 107 Clarke (1998:53) suggests that the gosain-s may have been either vaißÖava or áaiva. However, gosv§min (gosain) followers of Caitanya and Vallabh§c§rya are not, to my knowledge, ever mentioned in ethnographic reports of the period. The information supplied concerning gosain-s indicates that they were followers of “aØkara (i.e. Daáan§mÊs), most of them having one of the ‘ten names’. However, vaißÖava Bair§gÊs are mentioned as traders at Chhartarpur, in Madhya Pradesh (Kolff 1971:215). Pinch (1996:43) remarks that the term gosain began to lose its specific áaiva and 106
260
chapter seven
rules and codes of practice were recognised by initiates, further facilitating trading arrangements. They were also favoured as religious mendicants who, in some kingdoms, were exempt from full taxation on their goods. In Banaras, for example, gosain-s paid special rates on their transit goods (Bayly 1992:143, 165). Maãha-s also received religious donations, particularly at mel§-s when pilgrims frequently donated handsomely to a mahant, and generally used rent-free land. The passing of wealth from a desceased mahant to, frequently, a sole cel§ or a closed group of cel§-s, ensured that institutional wealth, which was sometimes considerable, remained ‘in house’.108 This arrangement had distinct financial advantages over the traditional family arrangement, whereby a father’s wealth and property was often dispersed to many relatives, sometimes geographically distant, upon his death. Even in the mid-nineteenth century the gosain-s were still an important element in north Indian trade and commerce.109 They owned fleets of boats and controlled a major share of the trade along the Ganges, transporting goods from the United Provinces to Bengal— some of which went on to Europe—and brought Bengali and British goods to Mirzapur and Banares for trade (Cohn 1964:180). Until the 1840s gosain-s remained the key inland merchants in the growing colonial trade in cotton. The British were significantly irritated by the success, authority and general popularity of the gosain-s—a popularity the colonial masters did not enjoy—and attempted to blacken their name. The gosain-s, however, were no economic partisans: in 1857 the gosain maãha-s of the United Provinces had at least 200,000 Rs. invested in government paper currency (Bayly 1992:241–242). In north India, there was a decline of the trading activities of the
Daáan§mÊ connotations only in the nineteenth century in Bihar and eastern Uttar Pradesh where it generally referred to n§g§-s. By the end of the century gosain had become a general term for both áaiva and vaißÖava s§dhu-s. 108 In a case that reached court in Calcutta, the disputed wealth of one maãha— not considering immovable property—amounted to 242,000 Rs. (A. K. Mishra 1975:99). 109 During the late eighteenth century, corporate religious institutions had invested in a substantial building programme. In Banaras, by 1816, there was said to be one pilgrim rest house for every ten houses. The use of dressed stone in the construction of religious buildings was a major influence on the stone-cutting business, which was controlled by the ascetic orders (Bayly 1992:127).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
261
gosain-s in the nineteenth century, which may have been a consequence of agricultural development in the Punjab and the change from river to railway transport (Cohn 1964:181). The increase in British hold over trade and exports is also evident, in that between 1814 and 1854 British exports in commodities tripled (Rothermund 1993:23). However, the gosain akh§Ü§-s adapted astutely to changing economic patterns, diversifying rapidly into urban property ownership after 1802.110 Following the construction of the railways, the gosain-s also capitalised on the rapidly rising value of urban properties. Although the gosain-s’ involvement in trade and banking declined in the nineteenth century, they still enjoyed considerable income from rent,111 and maintained their position as a major money-lending
110 It has been estimated that around 250,000 acres of land are still owned by the Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s, about half being the property of the Jån§ akh§Ü§. Until recently, the entire Girnar hills area in Gujarat was under the control of a n§g§ from the Jån§ akh§Ü§ (Gross 1992:163). 111 In Banaras district in 1909, the gosain-s owned 10,304 acres of land (Nevill 1909b:114). Sinha and Saraswati (1978:262) provide a list of nine paramahaÒsa-s of Banaras who, between 1926 and 1931, had substantial bank deposits at the koãhÊ (‘banking house’) of the JaØgambari maãha before the koãhÊ went into legal liquidation. Their deposits were mostly of around 2,000 Rs. to 3,000 Rs., but one, that of Sv§mÊ Svaråp§nanda MaÖ·aleávara, was of over 20,000 Rs. Joint families of ‘respectable’ city bankers could earn around 20,000 to 80,000 Rs. per annum towards the end of the nineteenth century (Bayly 1973:41). It seems that up until around 1925 there were a few wealthy maãha-s in Banaras that were also known as koãhÊ-s. The koãhÊ-s used to feed the general public and ascetics on certain occasions but were guarded and only inhabited by the mahant and his servants who entertained wealthy people and high officials. It seems that some of the paramahaÒsa maãha-s of Banaras were once affluent, namely the Bih§rÊ PurÊ, Bodh Gay§, Param§rtha Giri, DakßiÖamårti, Dhurbeávara, Jageávara, Haãhiy§ R§ma, NarsiÒh Cauk, Annapårna, Hari GÊrÊka, and Prak§á§nanda maãha-s. SaÒny§sÊ estates also occasionally have an ambiguous position in regards to religious status and the law. Sinha and Saraswati (1978:80) cite a legal case (Judgement of the High Court of Allahabad, Case No. 21 [1928], Appeal No. 584 [1934]) involving one Sv§mÊ R§mcaran PurÊ, who describes himself as a landlord (zamÊnd§r) and a banker, and not a paramahaÒsa. He states that he is the Municipal Commissioner of Banaras, paying a substantial amount of money in taxes and rent money to the government and the Mah§r§ja of Banaras. (Per year, he paid 2,000 Rs. to the government, 35,000 Rs. to the Mah§r§ja, 200 Rs. in municipal taxes, 208 Rs. in income tax and “some anna-s” on banking business.) He had inherited the property, the maãha, from his ancestors and also purchased further property himself. There were three temples on his property, of LakßmÊ, Mah§deva and Bh§gavatÊ, and he would feed and distribute alms to visiting Brahmans, áådra-s and fakÊr-s. He argued that his property was not an endowment, that he was the sole owner, and that he had the right to sell or mortgage it should he so choose. He claimed to have been given the property without any conditions attached, and to be performing
262
chapter seven
group, not only in the cities, but also in the small towns and villages along pilgrimage routes (Bayly 1992:452).112 Even in the early twentieth century the Mah§r§ja of Jaipur employed a group of n§g§-s as tax collectors (Farquhar 1925c:452). The influence of the gosain-s on the economy of north India had been such that Bayly (1992:242) comments: “As some of the largest urban property owners in the Gangetic and central Indian towns, and as important lower-level money-lenders, ironically it was [gosain-s] who became the nearest of any Indian business community to the emerging bourgeoisie that European theorists, from Sleeman to Marx, wished to see”.
7.7 SaÒny§sÊ-s and the modern political world The wealth of merchants and bankers appears to have played a significant role in the establishment of the nascent Congress Party. Although some members of the Viceroy’s executive council assumed that the Congress was supported by journalists, lawyers and other professionals, it is apparent that between 1885 and 1901, very many of the elected members were from the trading and banking classes, such as the Naupati bankers, the commercial aristocracy of Banaras. These bankers (mah§jan) financed pilgrim centres and trade in sugar, indigo, opium, g§ñj§ and bh§Øg. A high percentage of the assets of the major bankers, who had a close connection with the functions of local government, was also absorbed in the foundation of temples, bathing gh§ã-s, community shrines and religious trusts (Bayly 1973:29–43). In terms of life-style, there was little difference between bankers and saÒny§sÊ-s.113 On another front, in Calcutta, it was believed in 1912 that an akh§Ü§ was being used as a cover for the Midnapore revolutionary
charitable activities only, without the constraints that would be incumbent upon an endowed property. 112 Nevill (1909a:256) remarks that the UdasÊs [of Uttar Pradesh]: “Besides their religious duties carry on a considerable trade in money-lending”. The Daáan§mÊ áaiva akh§Ü§-s of the n§g§ gosain-s (the [Mah§]-Nirv§ÖÊ, NirañjanÊ and Jån§) are said by Nevill (1911:71) to be “equally wealthy and carry on extensive banking business”. 113 Until the 1880s, the major bankers of Allahabad lived as joint families in several small mud houses in the central market area. In a typical mah§janÊ family, food remained strictly vegetarian and servants were few (Bayly 1973:41–42).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
263
society, plotting aginst British rule (Taylor 2001:52). At the meeting of the National Congress in N§gpur in 1920, over a hundred n§g§-s attended. It was decided that they could carry the message of Independence and non-cooperation around India, as the masses of the towns and villages had high regard for them. Gandhi urged the n§g§-s to visit military camps and advise the soldiers to give up their employment (Pinch 1996:5). S§dhu-s were regarded by the British authorities as a serious threat in their involvement with the non-cooperation movement, as already in the mutiny/rebellion of 1857 n§g§ s§dhu-s had been involved, even though not militarily to any large extent. It is apparent that during the twentieth century, and particularly since Independence, the Daáan§mÊs have turned towards other activities, establishing colleges and §árama-s, many paramahaÒsa-s preaching as a means of livelihood in big cities such as Delhi, Bombay and Calcutta, their chief patrons being big businessmen and important officials in the government. However, as has been explored by McKean (1996), there is a considerable connection between several important saÒny§sÊ institutions and right-wing organisations such as the RSS, BJP,114 VHS115 and VHP.116 The VHP—which has recruited many s§dhu-s to its ranks117 (Jaffrelot 1996:355)—supported the claim of
114
By 1991, the BJP had six saffron-clad MPs (Jaffrelot 1996:479). The closing ceremony of a meeting of the Viá§l Hindu Sammelan, held in Kerala in April 1982, was presided over by the “aØkar§c§rya of K§ñcÊpuram (Chiriyankandnath 1998:212). 116 One prominent example is the relationship between the VHP (Viáva Hindu Parißad) and the Divine Life Society (DLS). The DLS was founded in 1936 by Sv§mÊ “iv§nanda, its headquarters being in Haridv§r. “iv§nanda (SarasvatÊ) took saÒny§sa in 1924 from the Daáan§mÊ, Sv§mÊ Viáv§nandasarasvatÊ, though he subsequently makes virtually no reference to his guru. One of “iv§nanda’s early disciples was Sv§mÊ Cinm§y§nanda (d.1993), who founded the VHP in 1964, which the DLS carefully avoid mentioning. “iv§nanda’s successor, Sv§mÊ Cid§nanda, maintains ties with the VHP. Significant events in the expansion of the DLS were “iv§nanda’s founding of the All World Religions’ Federation in 1945, and the All World Sadhus’ Federation in 1947 (McKean 1996:164–179). At the inaugural meeting of the VHP in August 1964, it was decided to organise a world Hindu sammelan during the Allahabad Kumbh Mel§, on 22–24 January 1966. Among the 25,000 attending delegates were two “aØkar§c§ryas, from Dv§rak§ and PurÊ (Jaffrelot 1996:198; Bhatt 2001:180–185). For the involvement of JayendrasarasvatÊ (“aØkar§c§rya of the K§ñcÊ pÊãha) with the VHP in the 1980s, see Jaffrelot (1996:357). 117 Jaffrelot (1996:357) maintains that the Hindu nationalist movement made major advances in the early 1980s by mobilising Hindu leaders who could be seen as ‘ecclesiastical’ authorities. 115
264
chapter seven
Sv§mÊ V§sudev§nanda to the succession to the Jyotir pÊãha in 1998, his rival being beaten up at the Kumbh Mel§ (Krishnan 2002:28). While attempting, to some extent, to remain outside political involvement, the Daáan§mÊ “aØkar§c§ryas have inevitably been drawn into the R§m Janm BhåmÊ dispute at Ayodhya, given their status as religious authorities.118 As of 2002, four of the “aØkar§c§ryas (of the four §mn§ya maãha-s) were opposed to the VHP’s temple construction plan, while JayendrasarasvatÊ (of the K§ñcÊ pÊãha) has been asked by the government to help negotiate the issue. The VHP are very keen for the other “aØkar§c§ryas to throw their weight behind temple construction, even though they are reluctant to do so (Krishnan 2002). The proximity of JayendrasarasvatÊ119 to the government was evident when he sent Brahman representatives to Delhi to perform rituals on the morning of R. Venkataraman’s inauguration, on the 25th July 1987, as the eighth President of India. Adding to the long list of the President’s degrees and awards, the “aØkar§c§rya bestowed on Venkataraman the title ‘Sat seva ratna’.120 Perhaps one of the most illustrative links between the Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs and the modern political world is the case of Um§ Bh§ratÊ, a saÒny§sin who became a politician, and who was subsequently sworn in, on 8th December 2003, as the first woman chief minister of the state of Madhya Pradesh. Although the “aØkar§c§rya of the K§ñcÊ maãha, JayendrasarasvatÊ, has been involved in political life at the highest levels, that did not prevent his arrest at Mehboobnagar in Andhra Pradesh on 11th November 2004 for conspiracy to murder A. “aØkarar§man, a manager of the Var§daperumal temple at K§ñcÊpuram, who died in the temple office on 3rd September 2004.121 The murder was committed
118 For further details of the “aØkar§c§ryas’ involvement with ‘Ayodhya’, see Jaffrelot (1996:413 fn. 3, 470–471) 119 For brief biographies of CandraáekharendrasarasvatÊ and his disciple JayendrasarasvatÊ, see Cenkner (1996:55–57). 120 ‘The Jewel of True Service’. See www.parliamentofindia.nic.in/rs/ whoswho/vp/rvenkatraman.htm; www.indiademocracy.com/resources/presidents/ rvenkataraman.jsp 121 For further details of the case, see (for all biblographical entries, see under www.): www.industelegraph.com/story/2004/11/12/01357/717; www.outlookindia. com/ptinews.asp?id=318369; www.hinduismtoday.com/hpi/2004/11/17.shtml; http://in.rediff.com/news/2004/nov/17agnl.htm; www.mytamil.com/n/a/arc0-
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
265
by a gang of five, including Kadiravan and Rajini, who were allegedly hired by Appu and Ravi Subramanian (a building contractor) at the behest of the “aØkar§c§rya. The “aØkar§c§rya’s arrest was authorised by the Chief Minister of Tamil Nadu, J. Jayalalit§. The seventy-yearold “aØkar§c§rya was also accused of involvement in an assault on R§dh§kÜßÖan (an auditor and associate of the maãha), his wife and an associate that took place on 20th September 2002. JayendrasarasvatÊ’s appointed successor, the ‘junior’ §c§rya VijayendrasarasvatÊ,122 was also arrested for conspiracy to murder, together with twenty-two others, including the K§ñcÊ maãha manager, Sundaresa Iyer, and VijayendrasarasvatÊ’s younger brother Raghu in connection with the two cases. It has been alleged123 that between May and July 2004 “aØkarar§man wrote a number of letters complaining of the misappropriation of temple-related funds by the two “aØkar§c§ryas, his final letter of 30th August containing a threat to take the maãha to court. Perhaps in a moment of weakness, JayendrasarasvatÊ authorised the silencing of his critic. JayendrasarasvatÊ and VijayendrasarasvatÊ were originally remanded in custody until 26th November 2004, a stay which was extended until 10th December. (It should be emphasised that at the time of going to press none of the allegations against any of the parties have so far been proven.) Within a week of the arrest of the “aØkar§c§rya, there were protests, hunger strikes and the closure of temples in cities such as Lucknow, Banaras S§t§r§ and Haridv§r. Even Muslim leaders in Ayodhy§ and S§t§r§ came out in his support. There has been some comment in the press that the “aØkar§c§rya’s influence in the AIDMK (All India Dravida Munnetra Kazhagam) party, and the considerable wealth of the K§ñcÊ maãha, a privately run body that—as noted in Chapter 2—has assets estimated at between 1.1 and 2.2 billion U.S. dollars, over which the Tamil Nadu Endowments Department has no control,124 may be behind the charges.
2005.shtml; http://onlypunjab.com/fullstory2k5-insight-news-status-24-newsID-6387. html; http://www.countercurrents.org/comm-anand031204.htm; http://newsinfo. com/2003/01/22/2201seercase.html; http://www.iacfpa.org/p_news/nit/iacpaarchieve/2004/12/03/diary1-03122004.html; http://www.countercurrents.org/ comm-anand231104.htm 122 VijayendrasarasvatÊ was officially appointed as successor to the gaddÊ of the K§ñcÊ maãha in 1987. 123 http://www.countercurrents.org/comm-anand231104.htm, p. 2 124 www.hinduismtoday.com/hpi/2004/11/17.shtml, p. 2. Particularly in the
266
chapter seven
However, many prominent people, including Jayalalit§, have denied these allegations. JayendrasarasvatÊ and VijayendrasarasvatÊ were granted bail on 10th December, when they returned to a significant welcome in K§ñcÊpuram. A court hearing is scheduled in the Chengalpatta Sessions Court for January 2006 for the charges of murder and those related to the assault on R§dh§kÜßÖan.
7.8 Concluding remarks In the Introduction to this book, one of the hypotheses proposed was that the projection by the Brahmanical tradition of the image of the ‘lone male saÒny§sÊ’ (beyond caste, ritual and social engagement), though influential even today, is misleading. Firstly, although the saÒny§sÊ is projected as being ‘beyond caste’ both in Brahmani-cal texts and in many contemporary anthropological and Hindu studies reviews, it is evident from our survey of Daáan§mÊ institutions in the first three chapters of this book that caste has an important influence on the life of the saÒny§sÊ. Secondly, even though most Brahmanical texts proscribe saÒny§sa for women, references in the Introduction and Chapter 1 illustrate both the historical and the current existence of numerous women saÒny§sin-s. Noted in the Introduction were the studies of Dumont (1960; 1998) and Burghart (1978; 1983a; 1983b; 1996). It was observed that Dumont’s seminal article of 1960, which apprehended the image presented in Brahmanical texts of the ‘lone’ saÒny§sÊ who lives independently of the conventional social world, ignored the renunciate’s necessary initiation into a new social order, namely a renunciate institution. Burghart’s more sophisticated model, which was refined in his later publications, of parallel social orders whereby the political realm and renunciate institutions are juxtaposed, while improving on Dumont’s analysis, was also found to be inadequate—even if initially useful for understanding a complex range of phenomena—for encapsulating the complex roles that renunciates have played and
1990s under the stewardship of JayendrasarasvatÊ, the K§ñcÊ maãha significantly expanded its investments in hospitals, schools and colleges (http://www. countercurrents.org/comm-anand231104.htm, p. 3).
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
267
continue to play. In the previous section, the influences of some saÒny§sÊ-s on the political world at the highest level were presented. Such involvement undermines the neat distinctions between social worlds that Burghart articulated. I would contend that the roles of saÒny§sÊ-s and other renunciates are historically too complex to be captured in any kind of binary model, even though such models may serve as useful navigatory schemes. Several ethnographies were cited in the Introduction to illustrate how saÒny§sÊ-s are not only lone mendicants, but are settled as castes in various regions of India, performing a variety of roles, as priests, farmers and traders. Many of these settlements seem to have been established by ex-mercenaries after the demise of the saÒny§sÊ n§g§ armies during the nineteenth century, whose activities have been reviewed in this chapter. Amassed wealth was most probably, in some instances, also channelled into land and property now at the disposal of the akh§Ü§-s and paramahaÒsa maãha-s. The role of saÒny§sÊ-s in the history of India since the sixteenth century is evidently complex, whether viewed from religious, economic or political perspectives; and the material presented in this book illustrates this. Historically, there may well have been some old, male, Brahman ritualists who renounced ritual life and wandered alone. However, these Brahman saÒny§sÊ-s would have been already initiated into the Brahmanical world through upanayana. An important consideration is whether the many kinds of ascetics—who were not old Brahmans—mentioned by commentators during the first millennium could have adopted that way of life without being formally initiated by a guru. In the modern context, the saÒny§sa rite, which has remained substantially stable in form since the earliest textual records (from around the third century BCE), simultaneously constitutes both a renunciation of a former social life, and an initiation into a spiritual lineage via a guru. The saÒny§sÊ is not a ‘real’ and recognised saÒny§sÊ unless he or she has passed through the viraj§-homa under a guru. This is true today, and I have argued that it is highly improbable—but for some exceptions—that it was otherwise in the past, though this is difficult to substantiate. In general, lineages—inherent in guruparampar§-s—transmit religious teachings, a sectarian mythology and a sectarian identity, and engender institutions over time. It is this package that essentially constitutes a sect, whether in the context of settled saÒny§sÊ communities, or amongst wandering s§dhu-s. The analysis of the saÒny§sa rite in a modern context (presented
268
chapter seven
in Chapter 3) illustrates how the two main wings of the Daáan§mÊs come together on the occasions of its performance, when representatives from the monastic tradition also provide preceptors for the militant wing of the akh§Ü§-s. The ten lineages of the Daáan§mÊs, spread between the daÖ·Ê-s, paramahaÒsa-s and n§g§-s, are brought together not only through initiation rites, but through the adoption of an identificatory structure, encapsulated in the information contained in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, texts which were analysed in Chapter 4. When the saÒny§sÊ is initiated, the guru imparts to the candidate the relevant details regarding how his or her new name fits into the scheme of the Maãh§mn§ya-s, with its associated identificatory markers (brahmac§rÊ name, gotra name, and samprad§ya name) and association of the name with one of the four pÊãha-s, which has its jurisdiction and founding §c§rya. “aØkara’s fame as an advaita philosopher, and his well-established reputation for performing a digvijaya and founding four maãha-s and an order of Brahmanical ascetics, provide the specific substance that bonds the identity of the Daáan§mÊs as a sect of saÒny§sÊ-s. One of the central issues of this study was to investigate how this identity came to be forged, in the light of historical information which undermines the veracity of the Maãh§mn§ya-s’ presentation of the founding of the sect. In the latter part of Chapter 4, it was shown how numerous maãha-s have claimed to be founded by “aØkara, and that claims were being contested by several of them in the nineteenth century. Still today, the K§ñcÊpuram and the “ÜØgerÊ maãha are in dispute as to which one is the genuine southern pÊãha. Guru-parampar§-s were shown to be unreliable, and with the exception of the southern pÊãha-s, some of which appear to date from the thirteenth century, records of the other maãha-s cannot be traced back further than about 250 years. In attempting to understand how the name of “aØkara came to be associated with the founding of a monastic tradition, the contents of his hagiographies were examined in Chapter 5. It was shown how the early hagiographies make no mention of the founding of maãha-s, and that the four maãha-s first appear in hagiographic work in an ‘incomplete’ form in the late sixteenth century at the earliest. Regarding the founding of a renunciate order, amongst the twenty extant hagiographies, only in one of the later texts (Cidvil§sa’s “aØkaravijaya-vil§sa) are the ‘ten names’ briefly enumerated. This text may be dated to the late sixteenth century (or slightly later), a period when, for the first time, the ‘ten names’ phrase also appears in other texts.
n§g§-s, såfÊs and parallel religious identities
269
It is apparent from “aØkara’s own works (which were examined in Chapter 5) and the works of his immediate disciples (analysed in Chapter 6) that “aØkara and most of his disciples (Toãaka, Sureávara and Padmap§da) were not áaiva, yet “aØkara is projected as a áaiva in hagiographic works, which began to be produced around the fourteenth century. In Chapter 6 it was proposed that “aØkara, who was relatively unknown during his lifetime and for several centuries thereafter, was projected as an incarnation of “iva by hagiographers in the image of their Vijayanagara patrons, who—in common with many other regents of the Deccan between the eighth and fifteenth centuries—were initiated into “aivism by áaiva r§ja-guru-s. This established “aØkara’s reputation as a áaiva, yet, as mentioned, the hagiographies generally fail to provide the key features central to Daáan§mÊ identity, namely that “aØkara founded four maãha-s and an order of ascetics. In Chapter 6 it was also shown how the early Vijayanagara regents patronised “ÜØgerÊ from the mid-fourteenth century, effectively establishing a lineage and a maãha that represented a ‘new’, orthodox form of advaita “aivism. However, it was evinced that there is no historical evidence to associate “aØkara with the founding of a maãha at any of the places now recognised as “aØkarite pÊãha-s, including “ÜØgerÊ. In this chapter (Chapter 7) political developments during the sixteenth and seventeenth centuries have been analysed, and it has been proposed that these developments provide an entirely adequate context for understanding the formation of an identity for a Hindu sect such as the Daáan§mÊs. It was during this period that militant akh§Ü§-s of all the sects appear to have formed, and it was proposed that the structure of Daáan§mÊ identity may have been influenced by the model of sectarian identity that had been developed by SåfÊ orders, who during this period exercised significant influence within the dominant Islamicate polities of north India. Through the creation of an orthodox Daáan§mÊ identity, with parampar§-s receding to “aØkara, lineages of both militant n§g§ saÒny§sÊ-s and those pertaining to the monastic tradition were forged into a sect with an identity, gaining added prestige from being founded by someone who was, by then, a famous Brahman saÒny§sÊ. It has been proposed that the tradition embodied in the Maãh§mn§ya-s is possibly of much more recent origin than is generally believed. It should be emphasised that the conclusions derived from this study of religious developments in South Asia from the early to late mediaeval period are but a ‘thesis in process’: further information
270
chapter seven
may come to light that could undermine any aspect of this study; and constructive criticism is invited. From the outset, no disrespect was intended to any individual or organisation, and it should be cautioned that this is a study of religious institutions that may have little to do with anyone’s spiritual experience. As noted in the Introduction, those saÒny§sÊ-s who find their way into history and books such as this do so because their engagement with ‘the world’ has in some capacity rendered them historically visible. Those saÒny§sÊ-s who live according to the ideals of saÒny§sa, engaged in quiet contemplation of the divinity, detached from the world, and shunning the glare of any kind of publicity, will remain forever unnoticed, yet vital to the spiritual inheritance of South Asia.
appendix 1
271
APPENDIX 1
NUMBERS AND PERCENTAGES OF ORTHODOX, REFORMIST AND RADICAL S$DHU-S 1.1 The chart below constitutes an overview of Tripathi’s (1978:156, 242–249) research regarding s§dhu sects active in the state of Uttar Pradesh during the time of his sociological investigation. The survey covers a total of 500 s§dhu-s in various sects. [(V): vaißÖava. (S): áaiva. (N): nirguÖÊ] Orthodox sects 1. “rÊ Samprad§ya (V) 2. Nimb§rkÊ (V) 3. Brahma Samprad§ya (V) 4. Madhva Gau·Êya (V) 5. R§m§nandÊ (V) 6. Vallabhac§rÊ (V) 7. SakhÊ (V) 8. Ud§sin (V) 9. Sv§mÊ N§r§yaÖ (V) 10. Dh§mÊ (V) 11. DharnÊávarÊ (V) 12. Mah§nubh§va (V) 13. HarÊác§ndÊ (V) 14. Malåkd§sÊ (V) 15. Parin§mÊ (V) 16. R§sik (V) 17. Par§ár§mÊ (V) 18. R§dh§ VallabhÊ (V) 19. R§dh§ R§mnÊ (V) 20. Daáan§mÊ (S) 21. K§nphaãa (S) 22. AghorÊ (S) 23. LiØg§yat (S) 24. KÊn§r§mÊ (S) 25. KaraliØgÊ (S) 26. GaÖpatya (S)
No. % 25 5.0 21 4.2 20 4.0 24 4.8 33 6.6 27 5.4 3 0.6 5 1.0 5 1.0 3 0.6 1 0.2 2 0.4 3 0.6 1 0.2 4 0.8 2 0.4 1 0.2 6 1.2 4 0.8 60 12.0 60 12.0 10 2.0 10 2.0 10 2.0 5 1.0 4 0.8
Orthodox sects No. % 27. K§p§lika (S) 1 0.2 28. “§kta (S) 4 0.8 Total: 354 70.8
272
appendix 1
Reformist sects No. % 1. Br§hma Kum§rÊ (N) 5 1.9 2. KabÊr (N) 5 1.0 3. D§då (N) 5 1.0 4. Nirmala (N) 5 1.0 5. Bhagat (N) 1 0.2 6. B§b§ L§lÊ (N/V) 3 0.6 7. Caran D§sÊ (V) 3 0.6 8. Dariyad§sÊ (N) 1 0.2 9. NiraØk§rÊ (N/V) 4 0.8 10. K§yam (N) 1 0.2 11. R§dha SoamÊ (N) 5 1.0 12. Dariya (N) 5 1.0 13. GhÊsa (N) 4 0.8 14. GarÊbd§sÊ (N) 5 1.0 15. Gulabd§sÊ (N) 4 0.8 16. L§l (N/V) 3 0.6 17. NaØgÊ (N/V) 2 0.4 18. NirañjanÊ (N/S) 5 1.0 19. N§mdh§rÊ (N) 5 1.0 20. NiraØk§rÊ (N) 4 0.8 21. Paltu SahabÊ (N) 1 0.2 22. Prem Prak§áÊ (N) 4 0.8 23. Panap (N/V) 3 0.6 24. Raid§sÊ (V) 1 0.2 25. R§m SanehÊ (N/V) 4 0.8 26. “iva N§r§yaÖÊ (N/S) 5 1.0 27. Satta N§mÊ (N) 1 0.2 28. SÊt§ R§mÊ (N/V) 4 0.8 29. S§dh (N) 1 0.2 30. Saheb (N) 4 0.8 31. Suthar§ (N) 3 0.6 32. Seva (N) 2 0.4 Radical Sects 1. $nanda MargÊ (N) 2. Muni Sam§jÊ (N) 3. KumbhÊ Patia (S) Total:
No. 2 2 2 6
% 0.4 0.4 0.4 1.2
Grand total:
500 100
Reformist sects 33. Bavari (N) 34. “ivoham (S) 35. Sat Sain (S) Total:
No. % 2 0.4 20 4.0 10 2.0 140 28
appendix 1
273
1.2 The chart below comprises the various sects who were resident in the ascetic maãha-s of Benares in 1968, as published by Sinha and Saraswati (1978:51). [(S) = áaiva. (V) = vaißÖava. (SK) = sikh] Male 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20.
DaÖ·Ê (S) (Daáan§mÊ) 237 N§g§ (S) (Daáan§mÊ) 85 ParamahaÒsa (S) (Daáan§mÊ) 288 R§m§nandÊ (V) 253 R§m§nujÊ (V) 75 Nimbarka (V) 10 Madhva (V) 1 Gau·Êya (V) 3 VißÖusv§mÊ (V) 30 KabÊrpanthÊ (V) 35 GarÊbd§sÊ (V) 5 D§dåpanthÊ (V) 2 GhÊsa (V) 3 Sv§mÊn§r§yaÖ (V) 15 GorakhpanthÊ (S) 3 Nirmala (SK) 15 Ud§sin (SK) 79 NihaØg Sikh (SK) 10 Bauddha 5 (Others) 35
Female 2 6 8 5 5 28 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 41
Total 239 91 296 258 80 38 1 3 30 34 6 2 3 15 3 15 79 10 5 76
274
appendix 2
APPENDIX 2
“R^ MA•H$MN$YASETU, MAH$NU“$SANAM, “E‘$MN$YA1 “rÊ Maãh§mn§yasetu “§rad§ Maãh§mn§yaÈ prathamaÈ paácim§mn§yaÈ á§rad§maãha ucyate | kÊtav§raÈ samprad§yas tasya tÊrth§áramau pade || dv§rak§khyaÒ hi kßetraÒ sy§d devaÈ siddheávaraÈ | bhadrak§lÊ tu devÊ sy§d §c§ryo viávaråpakaÈ2 || gomatÊtÊrtham amalaÒ brahmac§rÊ svaråpak§È | s§mavedasya vakt§ ca tatra dharmaÒ sam§caret || jÊv§tmaparam§tmaikya bodho yatra bhaviáyati | tattvam asi mah§v§kyaÒ gotro ’vigata ucyate || sindhusauvÊrasaur§ßãramah§r§ßãr§s tath§ntar§È | deá§È paácimadiksth§ ye á§rad§maãhabh§ginaÈ ||
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
1
The Sanskrit texts (including verse numbers) presented below are as contained in Mishra (2001:1–52). Several typographical errors have been corrected, and variant readings of words and phrases are occasionally substituted from other versions of Maãh§mn§ya-s, notably “arma’s (1963:642–652), where Mishra’s text is unclear. For the translation, Mishra’s (2001:1–52) English translation was consulted, as was that of Dazey (1987:577–602), and the Hindi translations of Up§dhy§y (1967:601–617) and Miára (1996:33–57). In the various published versions of the Maãh§mn§y§-s the order of some of the verses is different, even though the content is substantially similar; this has been indicated in the footnotes. The published versions of the Maãh§mn§ya-s (given below) generally follow the verse order of either “arma (1963) or Mishra (2001). [‘l’ =line; ‘v’ =verse.] Maãh§mn§ya-s, or extracts from them, are contained in the following Hindi publications: “arma (1963:642–652); Up§dhy§y (1967:601–617); Vidy§nand Giri (1993:60–65); Miára (1996:33–57); Sad§nand Brahmac§rÊ (2001:24–26); PurÊ (2001:44–48); Haridv§r Giri (n.d.:66–69). The Maãh§mn§yopanißad (a short version of the Maãh§mn§ya-setu) is published in Un-Published Upanißads (Kunhan Raja 1933:48– 49). Antarkar (2001:72) refers to versions I have not seen: Maãh§mn§ya-stotram and Maãh§mn§ya-setu (ed. Bodas), “rÊraØgam: V§Öi Vil§s Press (1954; 1958; 1975). Three English publications contain Maãh§mn§ya-s: Aiyer and Sastri (1962:49–57, 102, 110); Chakraborty (1973:180–181), which contains two short sections; and Mishra (2001:1–52), which contains an appendix (Appendix 2:59–61) that compares the verses of three published versions of Maãh§mn§ya-s, those of “arma (1963), Up§dhy§y (1967), and Kameßvar N§th Miára (1996). See Bibliography for further details. 2 Hast§malaka (Up§dhy§y, v. 2)
appendix 2
275
triveÖÊsaØgame tÊrthe tattvamasy§di lakßaÖe |3 sn§y§ttattv§rtha bh§vena tÊrthan§mn§ sa ucyate || §árama-grahaÖe prau·ha §á§p§áa vivarjitaÈ | y§t§y§ta vinirmukta ev§árama ucyate4 || kÊã§dayo viáeßeÖa v§ryante yatra jantavaÈ | bhåt§nukampay§ nityaÒ kÊãav§raÈ sa ucyate || sva svaråpaÒ vij§n§ti svadharma parip§lakaÈ | sv§nande krÊ·ate nityaÒ svaråpo baãur ucyate ||
6. 7. 8. 9.
Govardhana Maãh§mn§yaÈ pårv§mn§yo dvitÊyaÈ sy§d govardhanamaãhaÈ smÜtaÈ |5 bhogav§raÈ samprad§yo van§raÖye pade smÜte || purußottamaÒ tu kßetraÒ sy§j jagann§tho ’sya devat§ | vimal§khy§ hi devÊ sy§d §c§ryaÈ padmap§dakaÈ || tÊrthaÒ mahodadhiÈ proktaÒ brahmac§rÊ prak§áakaÈ | mah§v§kyaÒ ca tatra sy§t pr§jñ§naÒ brahma cocyate || ÜgvedapaãhanaÒ caiva k§áyapo gotram ucyate | aØgavaØgakaliØgaá ca magadhotkalabarbar§È | govardhanamaãh§dhÊn§ deá§È pr§cÊ vyavasthit§È || suramye nirjane sth§ne vane v§saÒ karoti yaÈ |6 §á§bandhavinirmukto vanan§m§ sa ucyate ||7 araÖye saÒsthito nityam §nande nandane vane | tyaktv§ sarvam idaÒ viávam §raÖyaÒ parikÊrtyate || bhogo vißaya ityukto v§ryate yena jÊvin§m | samprad§yo yatÊn§ñ ca bhogav§raÈ sa ucyate || svayaÒ jyotir vij§n§ti yogayuktiviá§radaÈ | tattvajñ§naprak§áena tena proktaÈ prak§áakaÈ ||
10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17.
Jyotir Maãh§mn§yaÈ tÜtÊyas tåttar§mn§yo jyotir n§ma maãho bhavet | árÊmaãhaá ceti v§ tasya n§m§ntaram udÊritam ||8
18.
3
vv. 6–8 =l. 1–4 in Chakraborty (1973:180). “eßa” (Up§dhy§y, v. 7); “etad §árama lakßaÖaÒ” (Chakraborty, l. 4). 5 A few lines of a Maãh§mn§ya pertaining to the Govardhan maãha that are not to be found in other texts, even though the information contained therein is substantially similar, are included by Chakraborty (1973:181): “govardhana maãhe ramye vimal§pÊãha saØgake | pårv§mn§ye bhogav§re árÊmat k§áyapa gotrajaÈ || m§dhyavasya sutaÈ árÊm§n sanandana iti árutaÈ | prak§áa brahmac§ri ca ÜgvedÊ sarvaá§stra vit | árÊpadm§daÈ pratham§c§ryatven§bhyaßicyata || ” 6 “suramya nirjane deáe v§saÒ nityaÒ karoti yaÈ” (Chakraborty, l. 5). 7 “§á§p§áavinirmukto vanan§m§ sa ucyate” (Chakraborty, l. 6). 8 “§nandav§ro vijñeyaÈ sampradad§yo ’sya siddhikÜt” (“arma, p. 649, v. 7). 4
276
appendix 2
19.
§nandav§ro vijñeyaÈ saÒprad§yo ’sya siddhidaÈ | pad§ni tasya khy§t§ni giriparvatas§gar§È || badarÊk§áramaÈ kßetraÒ devo n§r§yaÖaÈ smÜtaÈ | pårÖ§giriá ca devÊ sy§d §c§ryas toãakaÈ smÜtaÈ || tÊrthaÒ ca §lakanand§khyaÒ9 §nando brahmac§ry abhåt | ayam §tm§ brahma ceti mah§v§kyam ud§hÜtam || atharvavedavakt§ ca bhÜgv§khyaÒ gotram ucyate | kurukaámÊrak§mbojap§ñc§l§divibh§gataÈ | jyotirmaãhava᧠de᧠udÊcÊdigavasthit§È || v§so girivane nityaÒ gÊt§dhyayanatatparaÈ |10 gambhÊr§calabuddhiá ca11 girin§m§ sa ucyate || vasan parvatamåleßu prau·haÒ jñ§naÒ vibharti yaÈ |12 s§r§s§raÒ vij§n§ti parvataÈ parikÊrtyate || tattvas§gara gambhÊra jñ§naratnaparigraÈ |13 mary§d§Ò vai na laØghyeta s§garaÈ parikÊrtyate ||14 §nando hi vil§saá ca v§ryate yena jÊvin§m | samprad§yo yatÊn§Ò ca §nandav§raÈ sa ucyate || satyaÒ jñ§namanantaÒ yo nityaÒ dhy§yet tattvavit | sv§nande ramate caiva §nandaÈ parikÊrtyate ||
20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27.
“ÜØgerÊ Maãh§mn§yaÈ cathurtho dakßiÖ§mn§yaÈ áÜØgerÊ tu maãho bhavet | samprad§yo bhåriv§ro bhårbhuvo gotramucyate || pad§ni trÊÖi khy§t§ni sarasvatÊ bh§ratÊ purÊ | r§meávar§hvayaÒ kßetram §div§r§hadevat§ || k§m§kßÊ tasya devÊ sy§t sarvak§maphala prad§ | hast§malaka15 §c§ryas tuØgabhadreti tÊrthakam || caitany§khyo brahmac§rÊ yajurvedasya p§ãhakaÈ | ahaÒ brahm§smi tatraiva mah§v§kyaÒ samÊritam || §ndhradravi·akarÖ§ãakeral§diprabhedataÈ | áÜØgeryadhÊn§ deá§s te hy av§cÊdigavasthit§È || svarajñ§narato16 nityaÒ svarav§dÊ kavÊávaraÈ | saÒs§ras§gar§s§r§ hant§ ’sau hi sarasvatÊ ||17
28. 29. 30. 31. 32. 33.
9
“tÊrthaÒtvalakanand§khyaÒ nand§khyo...” (“arma, p. 649, v. 9). “v§so girivare(?) nityaÒ gÊt§bhy§se hi tatparaÈ” (Chakraborty, l. 9). 11 “... vuddhiáca ...” (Chakraborty, l. 10). 12 “vaset parvatamåleßu prau·ho yo dhy§na tatparaÈ” (Chakraborty, l. 11). 13 “vaset s§garagambhÊre dhanaratna parigrahaÈ” (Chakraborty, l. 13). 14 “mary§daách§nalaØghyena s§garaÈ parikÊrtitaÈ” (Chakraborty, l. 14). 15 Sureávara (Up§dhy§y, p. 608, v. 3); PÜthvÊdhara (“arma, p. 649, v. 13). “arma identifies PÜthvÊdhara as Hast§malaka. 16 “svarajñ§navaáo ...” (Chakraborty, l. 15). 17 “saÒs§ra-s§gare ߧr§bhijño ya sa sarasvatÊ” (Chakraborty, l. 16). 10
appendix 2 34. 35. 36. 37.
277
vidyabh§reÖa saÒpårÖaÈ sarvabh§raÒ parityajan |18 duÈkhabh§raÒ na j§n§ti bh§ratÊ parikÊrtyate19|| jñ§natattvena saÒpårÖaÈ pårÖatattvapade20sthitaÈ | parabrahmarato nityaÒ purÊn§m§ sa ucyate ||21 bhåriáabdena sauvarÖyaÒ v§ryate yena jÊvin§m | samprad§yo yatÊn§Ò ca bhåriv§raÈ sa ucyate || cinm§traÒ caityarahitam anantam ajaraÒ áivam | yo j§n§ti sa vai vidv§n caitanyaÒ tad vidhÊyate ||
Mah§nuá§sanam22 38. 39. 40. 41. 42. 43.
mary§daiߧ suvijÕey§ caturmaãhavidh§yinÊ | t§m et§Ò samup§áritya §c§ry§È sth§pit§È kram§t ||23 §mn§y§È kathit§ hy ete yatÊn§Ò ca påthak påthak |24 taiÈ sarvaiá catur§c§ryairniyogena25 yath§kramam ||26 prayoktavy§È svadharmeßu á§sanÊy§s tato ’nyath§ | kurvantu eva satatam aãanaÒ dharaÖÊtale ||27 viruddh§caraÖapr§pt§v §c§ry§Ö§Ò sam§jÕay§ | lok§n saÒáÊlayanty eva svadharm§pratirodhataÈ || sva-svar§ßãrapratißãhityai saÕc§raÈ suvidhÊyat§m | maãhe tu niyato28 v§sa §c§ryasya na yujyate ||29 varÖ§árama sad§c§r§ asm§bhir ye pras§dhit§È | rakßaÖÊy§È sadaivaite sva sva bh§ge 30 yath§vidhi ||
18 Mishra’s alternative rendering of terms are utilised in this line, which corresponds to Chakraborty, l. 17. 19 “parikÊrtitaÈ” (Chakraborty, l. 18). 20 “tattve” (Chakraborty, l. 19). 21 =Chakraborty, l. 20. 22 “arma’s version of the Mah§nuá§sanam omits vv. 38 and 65. Most of the verses of this text also appear in “arma’s Maãh§mn§yasetu (pp. 649–650, vv. 21–48), which has several verses (14, 15, 16, 44) not contained in Mishra’s version of that text. Up§dhy§y (pp. 609–612) includes v. 38 (of the text above) as the last verse of the “ÜØgerÊ Maãh§mn§ya, and begins the Mah§nuá§sanam at v. 39. Miára (1996:49–57) includes most of the verses of the Mah§nuá§sanam in the latter part of the “eߧmn§ya (subsequent to v. 10). 23 v. 38 =“arma, p. 649, Maãh§mn§yasetu, v. 21. 24 “ukt§ácatv§ra §mn§ya yatÊn§Ò hi pÜthak pÜthak | te sarve catur§c§ryaniyogena yath§vidhi ||” (“arma, Maãh§mn§yasetu, v. 14. 25 “sarve” (Mishra). 26 “te sarve catur§c§ry§ niyogena yath§kramam” (Up§dhy§y, pp. 612, v. 1). vv. 39–64 (above) =Miára, “eߧmn§ya, vv. 48–73. 27 vv. 40–41 =“arma, vv. 15–16. 28 “nityaÒ” (“arma, v. 22). 29 vv. 42–49 =“arma, Maãh§mn§yasetu, vv. 22–29. 30 “rakßaÖÊy§sta evaite sva sve...” (“arma, v. 23; Up§dhy§y, p. 613, Mah§nuá§sanam, v. 5).
278
appendix 2
44.
yato vin§ßãir mahatÊ dharmasy§sya31 praj§yate | m§ndyaÒ santy§jyam ev§tra d§kßyam eva sam§árayet || parasparavibh§ge tu na praveáaÈ kad§cana | paraspareÖa kartavy§ hy §c§ryeÖa vyavasthitiÈ || mary§d§y§ vin§áena lupyeran niyam§È áubh§È | kalah§Øg§rasampattir atast§Ò32 parivarjayet || parivr§· §ryamary§do m§makÊn§Ò yath§vidhi | catußpÊãh§dhig§Ò satt§Ò prayuÕjy§c ca påthak påthak || áucir jitendriyo veda ved§Øg§di viá§radaÈ v yogajÕaÈ sarvaá§str§Ö§Ò sa mad§sth§nam §pnuy§t ||33 uktalakßaÖa sampannaÈ sy§c cen matpÊãhabh§g bhavet | anyath§rå·hapÊãho ’pi nigrah§rho manÊßiÖ§m || na j§tu maãham ucchindy§d adhik§riÖy upasthite | vighn§n§m api b§huly§d eßa dharmaÈ san§tanaÈ || asmatpÊãhe34 sam§rådhaÈ parivr§· uktalakßaÖaÈ | aham eveti vijÕeyo yasya deva iti áruteÈ ||35 eka ev§bhißecyaÈ36 sy§d ante lakßaÖa-sammataÈ | tattatpÊãhe krameÖaiva na bahu yujyate kvacit ||37 sudhanvanaÈ samautsukyanivåttyai dharmahetave | devar§jopac§r§Òá ca yath§vad anup§layet ||38 kevalaÒ dharmam uddiáya vibhavo brahmacetas§m | vihitaá copak§r§ya padmapatranayaÒ vrajet || sudhanv§ hi mah§r§jas tath§nye ca nareávar§È | dharmap§raÒparÊmet§Ò p§layantu nirantaram || c§turvarÖyaÒ yath§yogyaÒ v§ÖmanaÈ k§yakarmabhiÈ |39 guroÈ pÊãhaÒ samarceta vibh§g§nukrameÖa vai || dhar§m §lambya r§j§naÈ praj§bhyaÈ karabh§ginaÈ | kåt§dhik§r§ §c§ry§ dharmatas tadvad eva hi || dharmo målaÒ manußy§Ö§Ò sa ca §c§ry§valambanaÈ | tasm§d §c§ryasumaÖeÈ á§sanaÒ sarvato (a)dhikam || tasm§t sarvaprayatnena á§sanaÒ sarva-sammatam |40 §c§ryasya viáeßeÖa hy aud§ryabharabh§ginaÈ ||
45. 46. 47. 48. 49. 50. 51. 52. 53. 54. 55. 56. 57. 58. 59.
31
“...dharmasyatra...” (“arma, v. 24). subs., from “arma, v. 26. 33 ‘“...tantr§Ö§Ò” (“arma, Maãhamn§yasetu, v. 28); “...á§str§Ö§Ò sa mad§sth§nam §pnuy§t” (?) (Mishra). 34 “...pÊãhe...” (“arma, v. 31). 35 v. 51 =“arma, Maãh§mn§yasetu, v. 31; Up§dhy§y, p. 614, Mah§nuá§sanam, v. 13. 36 “...ev§vißecyaÈ” (?) (Mishra). 37 v. 52 =“arma, Maãh§mn§yasetu, v. 52; Up§dhy§y, v. 14. 38 vv. 53–55 =“arma, Maãh§mn§yasetu, vv. 32–34; Up§dhy§y, vv. 14–17. 39 vv. 56–58 =“arma, Maãh§mn§yasetu, vv. 40–42; Up§dhy§y, vv. 18–20. (References to “arma below are to the Maãh§mn§yasetu.) 40 v. 59 =“arma, v. 46; Up§dhy§y, v. 21. 32
appendix 2
279
§c§ry§kßipta daÖ·§s tu kåtv§ p§p§ni m§nav§È | nirmal§È svargam§y§nti santaÈ sukåtino yath§ ||41 ity evaÒ manur apy §ha gautamo ’pi viáeßataÈ |42 viáißãa áißã§c§ro ’pi mål§d eva prasiddhyati || t§n §c§ryopadeáaá ca r§jadaÖ·aá ca p§layet | tasm§d §c§rya r§j§n§vanavadyau na nindayet ||43 dharmasya44 paddhatir hy eߧ jagataÈ sthitihetave | sarvavarÖ§áramaÖ§Ò hi yath§á§straÒ vidhÊyate ||45 kåte viávagurur brahm§ tret§y§m åßisattamaÈ | dv§pare vy§sa eva sy§t kal§v atra bhav§my aham || maãh§á catv§ra §c§ry§ catv§raá ca dhurandhar§È | samprad§yaá ca catv§ra eߧ dharmavyavasthitiÈ ||46
60. 61. 62. 63. 64. 65.
“eߧmn§ya47 athordhvaÒ áeߧ §mn§y§s te vijÕanauka vigrah§È | paÕcamas tårdhva §mn§yaÈ sumerumaãha ucyate | samprad§yo ’sya k§áÊ sy§t satyajÕ§n§bhide pade || kail§saÈ kßetramity uktaÒ devat§ ’sya niraÕjanaÈ | devÊ m§y§ tath§c§rya Êávaro ’sya prakÊrtitaÈ || tÊrthaÒ tu m§nasaÒ proktaÒ brahmatattv§vag§hi tat | tatra saÒyogam§treÖa saÒny§saÒ samup§árayet || sukßmavedasya vaktv§ ca tatra dharma sam§caret | ßaßãhaÈ sv§tm§khya §mn§yaÈ param§tm§ maãho mah§n || sattvatoßaÈ samprad§yaÈ padaÒ yogam anusmaret | nabhaÈ sarovaraÒ kßetraÒ48 parahaÒsa ’sya devat§ || devÊ sy§n m§nasÊ m§y§ §c§ryaá cetan§hvayaÈ | tripuãÊtÊrtham utkåßãaÒ49 sarvapuÖyaprad§yakam || bhava p§áavin§á§ya saÒny§saÒ tatra ca §árayet | ved§ntav§kyavakt§ ca tatra sam§caret ||
66. 67. 68. 69. 70. 71. 72.
41
v. 60 =“arma, v. 43; Up§dhy§y, v. 22. v. 61 =“arma, v. 45; Up§dhy§y, v. 23. 43 v. 62 =“arma, v. 44; Up§dhy§y, v. 24. 44 “dharmapaddhatireߧ...” (“arma, v. 47). 45 v. 63 =“arma, v. 47; Up§dhy§y, v. 25). 46 v. 65 =“arma, v. 39. “arma’s text concludes: “iti árÊmatparamahaÒsaparivr§jak§c§rya árÊmacchaØkara bhagavatkÜtau maãh§mn§y§ácatvaraÈ sam§pt§È”. [Thus are the four-fold maãh§mn§ya-s, written by the honourable paramahaÒsa ascetic, “rÊ “aØkara Bagavat, completed.] 47 This section of text is referred to as ‘Maãh§mn§yasetu’ by “arma; as ‘“eߧmn§ya’ by Up§dhy§y (pp. 310–311). Miára appends this text to the previous section. 48 “nabhikuÖ·ali” (the centre of the coil) is given as the kßetra by Kunhan Raja (1933:49). 49 The tÊrtha is given as Trikuãi by Kunhan Raja. 42
280 73. 74. 75.
appendix 2 saptamo niákal§mny§yaÈ sahasr§rkadyutir maãhaÈ | sampradayo (a)sya sacchißyaÈ árÊguroÈ p§duke pade || tatr§nubhåtiÈ kßetraÒ sy§d viávaråpo (a)sya devat§ | devÊ cicchaktin§mnÊ hi §c§ryaÈ sadguruÈ småtaÈ || sacch§straáravaÖaÒ tÊrthaÒ jar§måtyuvin§áakam | purÖ§nandapras§dena saÒny§saÒ tatra c§árayet ||50
50 Kunhan Raja’s text (Maãh§mn§yopanißat) also details seven §mn§ya-s (the four standard §mn§ya-s, and three other áeߧmn§ya-s). The main details of all seven §mn§ya-s are similar to those presented above.
appendix 2
281
TRANSLATION “rÊ Maãh§mn§yasetu [The division of the revered traditions] “§rad§ Maãh§mn§ya 1.
The first is the western tradition (§mn§ya). The monastery (maãha) is called “§rad§. Its samprad§ya51 is kÊãav§ra. The [saÒny§sin] names [‘titles’, pada] are TÊrtha [holy ford] and $árama [hermitage]. The kßetra is Dv§rak§. The male deity is prescribed as Siddheávara. The female deity is Bhadrak§lÊ. The [first] §c§rya is Viávaråpaka.52 The tÊrtha is the pure GomatÊ [river], the brahmac§rÊ [name] is Svaråpaka; and he is a reciter of the S§maveda; he should observe the dharma therein. There will be known the unity of jÊv§tman and param§tman. “Tattvamasi” 53 is the mah§v§kya. The gotra is called Avigat. Sindhu, SauvÊra, Saur§ßãra, Mah§r§ßãra and other places also are the territories in the western direction apportioned to the “§rad§ maãha. “Tattvamasi ” is the figurative meaning of the tÊrtha at the confluence of the three rivers. He who bathes there, in the essence of that saying, is called TÊrtha. He who is mature, who has shunned the noose of desire, is seized of [the condition of] $árama. Free from coming and going, only he is called ‘$árama’. Through [the distinction of] compassion for insects [kÊãa], he shoos away [living] beings [from] there. From [his] compassion for living beings, he is always called KÊãav§ra. He who knows himself is surrounded and protected by his own dharma. He always amuses himself in his own bliss. A young lad [a Brahman brahmac§rÊ ] is called Svaråpa.
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.
Govardhana Maãh§mn§ya 10.
The second tradition is the eastern, prescribed as the Govardhana maãha. The samprad§ya is Bhogav§ra. The [saÒny§sÊ] titles prescribed are Vana [forest] and AraÖya [jungle]. 51 52 53
For the sense of specific terms used in the Maãh§mn§ya-s, see ch. 4.2–4.3. Hast§malaka (Up§dhy§y, v. 2). “You are that”.
282 11.
appendix 2 The kßetra is Purußottama [and] its male deity is Jagann§th. The female deity is Vimal§. The [first] §c§rya is Padmap§daka. The tÊrtha is proclaimed as the ocean. The brahmac§rÊ [name] is Prak§áaka. And the mah§v§kya there is “prajÕ§naÒ brahma”.54 The Œgveda is studied, [and] the gotra is that of K§áyapa. AØga, VaØga, KaliØga, Magadha, Uãkala and Barbar§ are the territories situated in the east, presided over by the Govardhan maãha. He who makes [his] dwelling a place in a uninhabited forest is free from the ties of hope, [and] is called Vana. Situated in the jungle, he dwells in eternal bliss in a sylvan paradise. Having renounced this whole world, he is called AraÖya [jungle].55 He keeps a distance from peoples’ so-called pleasures and sensual enjoyments. And the samprad§ya of the ascetics (yati-s) is called Bhogavara. He who is proficient in the practice of yoga, producing light within himself, in the manifestation of knowledge of reality, is called Prak§áa.
12. 13.
14. 15. 16. 17.
Jyotir Maãh§mn§ya 18.
The third tradition is the northern tradition of the maãha called Jyotir. It is also [called] “rÊ-Maãha, which is its other name. The samprad§ya is known as $nandavara, which confers perfection. Its titles (pada-s) are called Giri, Parvata and S§gara. The kßetra is BadrÊk§árama; the male deity is [to be remembered as] N§r§yaÖa, and the female deity is PårÖ§giri. Its [first] §c§rya is [to be remembered as] Toãaka.56 The tÊrtha is the Alaknanda [river]. $nanda is the brahmac§rÊ [name]. “Ayam§tm§ Brahma”57 is the mah§v§kya. The Atharvaveda is spoken, [and] the gotra is said to be BhÜgu. The [territory] apportioned is Kuru, K§ámÊr, K§mboja, P§Õc§la, et cetera. Other terrritories situated in the north are also included under the authority of the Jyotir maãha. Living in the forests and hills, he is eternally engaged in the study of the GÊt§.
19. 20. 21. 22.
23.
54 55 56 57
“Knowledge is Brahman”. “lakßaÖaÒ kila” (Chakraborty, l. 8, instead of “parikÊryate”). “Troãaka” (“arma, p. 649, v. 9). “The self is Brahman”.
appendix 2
283
[He is] thoughtful, steadfast, wise, and is called Giri. He who lives in the mountain valley, his knowledge is mature. He knows the quintessence of everything [and] is called Parvata [mountain]. He grasps the gem of knowledge [in] the deep ocean [s§gara]. He who verily never exceeds his [moral or juridical] limits is called S§gara. He distances himself from the pleasures and enjoyments of the world [living beings]. The samprad§ya of the ascetics [here] is called $nandavara. [The ascetic] knows the truth [which is] the culmination of knowledge [and] always thinks about truth. He enjoys the delight in himself and is called $nanda.
24. 25. 26. 27.
“ÜØgerÊ Maãh§mn§ya The fourth tradition, then, is [that of] the “ÜØgerÊ maãha. The samprad§ya is Bhuriv§ra [and] the gotra is Bhårbhuva. The three titles [pada] are named SarasvatÊ, Bh§ratÊ and PurÊ. The kßetra is called R§meávara [and] the male deity is $di V§r§ha. Its female deity is K§m§kßÊ, who bestows the fruits of all desire. Hast§malaka58 is the [first] §c§rya [and] the TuØgabhadra [river] is the tÊrtha. The brahmac§rÊ name is Caitanya; he recites the Yajurveda. The mah§v§kya to be uttered there is “AhaÒ Brahm§smi”.59 $ndhra, Dravi·a, KarÖ§ãaka, Kerala, et cetera, are the apportioned territories which are included as being subject to [the authority] of “ÜØgerÊ. Always intent upon self-control, uttering [the mantra] svar, a lord amongst poets, the defeater of the entire ocean of worldly existence, he is called SarasvatÊ. He who is full of the weight of knowledge, he relinquishes the burden of everything. He does not know the burden of suffering, and is called Bh§ratÊ. [He] filled with true knowledge, established in a condition filled with truth, [and] always gratified in the highest Brahman, is called PurÊ [town]. He who utters correct sounds [speaks truly], through many words, keeps a distance from the [beings of] the world. The samprad§ya of the ascetics [here] is called Båriv§ra. Consciousness, freed from mental fluctuations, is infinite, undecaying, [and] auspicious. He who knows this is verily wise, [and] he is called Caitanya.
28. 29. 30. 31. 32. 33. 34. 35. 36. 37.
58 59
See fn.15. “I am Brahman”.
284
appendix 2 Mah§nuá§sanam [The great instruction]
38.
This rule giving the instruction for the four maãha-s is to be well discerned. The §c§rya-s [who are] established in succession, are to be supported by this rule. The traditions (§mn§ya) of the ascetics, which are declared, are [to be] separately distinguished. All of these four §c§rya-s, through [this] injunction, [are to be appointed] in succession. [People], engaged otherwise, should be made to perform their own dharma-s, under this order. They [the §c§rya-s] should constantly wander on the surface of the earth. If people engage in forbidden conduct, they should be guided in [the non-obstruction of] good conduct of their own dharma, by the the §c§rya-s. Each one properly abiding in his own territory, wandering around is to be practised. The §c§rya should not make a permanent residence in a maãha. We have clearly presented the [rules for] the virtuous conduct of varÖa and §árama. According to [this] injunction, the rules should be preserved by each [§c§rya] in his own area. Since the great destruction of dharma is produced by this [failure to uphold dharma], indolence should be renounced, [and] one should just rely on skill [and ability]. There should be no intrusion into one another’s territory at any time. [This] should be mutually observed, arranged by [each] §c§rya. If, through the destruction of the boundaries, these auspicious injunctions are violated, [then] then the embers of strife [will] be fanned [aggravated], [which] should be avoided. The wandering ascetic, according to [this] injunction, [should observe] the boundary [established by me], [and] the separate existence [i.e. non-interference] enjoined upon the four pÊãha-s. He who is pure, a master of his senses, [and] proficient in the Veda and Ved§Øga, et cetera, [and] is a knower of yoga [and] all á§stra-s, he should obtain our rank and position. A perfected person, who has the aforementioned qualities, should be entitled to my pÊãha. Otherwise, even one who has ascended the pÊãha [who does not have the requisite qualities] may be restrained by the wise. A qualified person who is installed at the maãha should never be uprooted [from there], even should many difficulties arise. This is the eternal dharma. The wandering ascetic, who has the aforementioned qualities, [and] who ascends our pÊãha, he should be known by [his saying] “It is I”, as one hears it said “yasya deva” (lord of whom).60
39. 40. 41. 42. 43. 44. 45. 46. 47. 48. 49.
50. 51.
60
A famous scriptural saying from “vet§ávatara Upanißad 6.23: yasya deva par§bhaktiryath§deve tath§ gurau...
appendix 2 52.
285
In the end, only one [§c§rya] who has the [agreed upon] characteristic is [to be] anointed [as §c§rya]. [This is to be done] at each pÊãha, [and] only in succession; [and] there should not be more [than one §c§rya] anywhere. [Like] [king] Sudhanv§,61 possessed of the enthusiasm for the cause of dharma in creation, so he should protect the reverence to gods and kings. Having explained the dharma of isolation,62 he is [shown to be] powerful among those whose minds are directed to Brahman. Let him wander; and help [will be] bestowed [on him] [through his] acting like a lotus petal.63 The great king Sudhanv§ and other rulers of men should should continuously protect the dharma that is traditionally handed down. The pÊãha of the guru should be honoured with speech, mind, body and actions, according with the propriety of the four varÖa-s, [and] verily, [it should be occupied] in due succession, [and] according to the [established territorial] divisions. Kings, depending on support, are entitled to taxes from their subjects. $c§rya-s, [on whom] power is conferred, are [similarly] entitled to authority with respect to dharma. Dharma is the root of humanity, and an §c§rya is its support. Therefore, the instruction of a well-adorned §c§rya is greater than everything. Therefore, the instruction [of the §c§rya], through all [his] continuous endeavour, is assented to by all people; the §c§rya’s discrimination is [held] as a responsibility in his heart. Men who have commitited sins, but who are struck by the §c§rya-’s stick [i.e. punished], will enter heaven pure, like people who do good. Thus, in this way, also Manu and also Gautama particularly declared. Even the conduct of the most learned of the learned [§c§rya-s] becomes [is made] well known, from the root [as it were]. The instruction of the §c§rya and the punishment of the king are for the welfare of the people. Therefore, the §c§rya and the king should not be criticised, and should be properly respected. This manual on dharma is for the maintenance of the world; it is indeed enjoined as a á§stra [scripture] upon people of all castes and stages of life. In the KÜta age Brahm§ is the world-guru; in the Tret§ age it is the most virtuous Üßi-s [wise seers]; in the Dv§para age it is indeed Vy§sa; now, in the K§lÊ age, it is “I [am]”.
53. 54.
55. 56.
57. 58. 59. 60. 61. 62. 63. 64.
61 62 63
A king from Kerala whom “aØkara meets in the “aØkara-dig-vijaya. KevalaÒ, pertaining to a meditative ascetic, kevalin. Undisturbed by the muddy waters beneath.
286 65.
appendix 2 Dharma is maintained by these [things]: the four maãha-s, the four §c§rya-s (who bear the burden [of responsibility]), and the four samprad§ya-s.
“eߧmn§ya [The remaining doctrine] 66.
Next, there are the [other] remaining ‘heavenly’ [årdhva] §mn§ya-s, [which are] distributed in the form of knowledge. The fifth §mn§ya is the ‘heavenly’ maãha, called the Sumeru maãha. Its samprad§ya is K§áÊ [Banaras]; its titles [pada] are distinguished as truth and knowledge. The kßetra is said to be [mount] Kail§s. Its male deity is Nirañjana, [and] its female deity is M§y§. And its §c§rya is worshipped as the Lord [Êávara]. The tÊrtha is proclaimed as the mental one64 [m§nasa], which is absorbed in the essence of Brahman. There, through union [with Brahman], refuge should be taken in renunciation[saÒny§sa]. The sixth §mn§ya is one’s own self. The ‘subtle’ Veda is spoken, and there dharma should be observed. The great maãha is the the great Self [param§tman]. The samprad§ya is the joy of reality; the title [pada] is to be remembered as yoga. The ocean of the sky is the kßetra, [and] the male deity is parahaÒsa 65 [the highest kind of ascetic]. The female deity is M§nasÊ M§y§, and the §c§rya is said to be Cetan [self/intelligence]. The tÊrtha is TripuãÊ which brings forth the bestowal of all merit. There, one should resort to saÒny§sa for the destruction of wordly bonds, and the sentences of Ved§nta are uttered. There, dharma is to be practised. The seventh §mn§ya is the Nißkala [stainless?];66 the maãha is Sahasr§rkadhuti [the splendour of a thousand suns]. Its samprad§ya is Sacchißya [the good student]; the holy footprints [or wooden sandals, p§duk§] of the guru are the title [pada]. The kßetra there is realisation [anubhåti]; the male deity is Viávaråpa [the form of the universe]; the female deity is verily named Cit-áakti; the §c§rya is declared as Sadguru. The tÊrtha is the hearing of sacred scripture, which is the destroyer of old-age and death. Through the grace of total bliss, there saÒny§sa is resorted to.
67. 68. 69. 70.
71. 72. 73.
74. 75.
64
The notion of mental tÊrtha-s is also recognised in classical sources. For example, BhÊßma extolls their virtues to Yudhißãhira (MBh XIII.111). 65 =paramahaÒsa 66 Perhaps from nißkalaØka, or from nißkala (to drive away).
appendix 3
287
APPENDIX 3
THE HISTORY AND MYTHOLOGY OF THE KUMBH MEL$ Whether Daáan§mÊs reside almost permanently in a maãha or §árama, or travel, the vast majority will attend the Kumbh Mel§ (or Kumbh Parv),1 particularly a Mah§ (‘great’) Kumbh Mel§ at Pray§g. It is the largest festival on earth, when, in recent years, up to an estimated fifteen million people will pass through or reside permanently during the six weeks of the festival.2 The main purpose is to bathe at particularly auspicious times, of which there are usually five during each Mel§.3 Bathing at auspicious times4 is believed to eradicate accumulated sin and, for the more mythologically minded, to confer
1
The terms mel§ and parv both mean ‘festival’ or ‘occasion for religious observance’, parv being the term generally preferred by saÒny§sÊ-s. The term kumbha means ‘pot’, and also indicates the astrological sign of Aquarius. 2 Bedi and Bedi (1991:114) provide the following statistics for the attendance (in millions) at the Pray§ga Kumbh for MaunÊ Am§vasy§: 1906, (2.5); 1918, (3); 1930, (4); 1942, (1.2); 1954, (6); 1966, (7); 1977, (10); 1989, (15). MaunÊ Am§vasy§ is the most important bath of the Mel§, and also a time most auspicious in the Hindu calendar for offering piÖ·§ for ancestor (pitÜ) worship. 3 The main baths for the Kumbh Mel§ are as follows (the dates are for the 2001 Pray§g Kumbh; saØkr§nti is the term used for when the sun or a planet enters a new astrological sign; * indicates the most important baths for saÒny§sÊ-s). At Pray§g: Paußa PårÖim§ (full-moon, plus eclipse, 9th Jan.); Makar SaØkr§nti* (14th Jan.); MaunÊ Am§vasy§* (24th Jan.); Basant PañcmÊ* (29th Jan.); M§ghÊ PårÖim§ (8th Feb.); Mah§-“ivar§tri (12th Feb.). The akh§Ü§-s perform the ‘royal procession’ (á§hÊ julås) three times: Makar SaØkr§nti, MaunÊ Am§vasy§, and Basant PañcmÊ. At Haridv§r, the three most important baths are on: Mah§-“ivar§tri*; the new moon day (kÜßÖaam§vasy§) of Aries* (Caitra); the first day (saØkr§nti ) of Taurus* (Vaiá§kha). At N§sik: when Jupiter, Sun and Mars enter Leo (“r§vaÖa/SiÒha saØkr§nti )*; Leo (“r§vaÖa) kÜßÖa-am§vasy§*; “r§vaÖa full-moon*; am§vasy§ of Virgo* (Bh§drapada); Ek§daáÊ (the eleventh day of either fortnight of the lunar month) of Scorpio (K§rtika). At Ujjain the most important baths are on; Meßa (Aries) saØkr§nti *; Vaiá§kha (Taurus) kÜßÖa am§vasy§; the full-moon of Vaiá§kha. In 1921 plague broke out at Ujjain, since when there has only been one ‘royal bath’ (PurÊ 2001:173). The baths for the 1980 Ujjain Mel§ were: 31st March (Caitra PårÖim§); 14th April (Meßa saØkr§nti);15th April (Vaiá§kha am§vasy§); 17th April (Akßaya TÜtÊy§); 19th April (“aØkar§c§rya JayantÊ); 30th April (Vaiߧkha PårÖim§) (“arma 1980:11). 4 See Stanley (1977:27–31) for an explanation of the significance of particular astronomical events, such as am§vasy§.
288
appendix 3
some drops of the Nectar of Immortality (amÜta) on the bather. The Kumbh Mel§ not only attracts pilgrims from throughout India and Nepal but is also a gathering of all major Hindu religious and ascetic organisations.5 For sects such as the Daáan§mÊs, it is a unique occasion for a gathering of their order from far and wide, when important issues are discussed and decided. “aØkar§c§ryas and all branches of the order attend, elections within the n§g§ akh§Ü§-s take place, and saÒny§sa and n§g§ initiations are performed.6 The pageants of the akh§Ü§-s arrive at the site, making their ‘entry procession’ (peáv§Ê julås), with mahant-s and sv§mÊ-s on decorated daises atop elephants (these days mostly on tractor trailers), who are garlanded by officials. They are accompanied by naked, sword-yielding, ash-covered n§g§-s blowing n§gph§ni (a serpent-shaped horn), some on horseback. At the camps of the akh§Ü§-s, bhåmÊ-påj§ will be performed, and the akh§Ü§ flag (dhvaj) will be raised fifty feet high. On the occasions of the main baths, the akh§Ü§ will make a ‘royal procession’ (á§hÊ julås) to the saØgam. The Mel§, crowded with multitudes of men and women such as you may not meet twice in a lifetime, has made an impression on all who have ever visited. Two of the sites, Haridv§r and Pr§yag, are the location of the headquarters of six of the seven Daáan§mÊ akh§Ü§-s (see Ch. 2.1), the military wing of the Daáan§mÊs. The Kumbh Mel§ usually takes place every three years, rotating around four sites: at Pray§g (the ‘tÊrãh-r§j ’), at the saØgam of the 5 There is scant evidence in the Veda for institutionalised pilgrimage (y§tr§); Y§ska’s Nirukta does not list pilgrimage among the meanings of y§tr§ (Sanskrit for ‘travel’), although this term became the most common one for pilgrimage in the Pur§Öic period (c.200–1000). Bhaããa LakßmÊdhara’s KÜty§kalpataru (‘the wish-fulfilling tree of general duties’; c.late 11th–early 12th cent.) was a work that exercised a great influence in Mithil§, Bengal, and northern and western India. Discussed in the text is how to properly discharge the traditional triple-debt (ÜÖatraya) to the seers, ancestors and gods: pilgrimage is stated to be one of the incumbent duties (Bharati 1963:147). On the significance of tÊrtha (‘ford’)-y§tr§, Salomon (1979) translates and discusses a mediaeval text, TÊrtha-praty§mn§y§È, the earliest extant version of which appears in the SmÜtyarthas§ra of “rÊdhara, dating to c.1150–1200. In this text, around one hundred pilgrimage sites throughout India are ranked according to the amount of merit obtained by visiting them, the merit being evaluated in terms of both the distance to be travelled, and a correspondence with regimes of purification penances (kÜcchra or pr§j§patya-kÜcchra) (see Ch. 3.1). The fundamental feature of the system of the TÊrtha-praty§mn§y§È is its emphasis on rivers, the text being organised around the main rivers of India. 6 The second most important mel§ for the akh§Ü§-s is that at GaØg§ S§gar, near Calcutta, held every year during Makar SaØkr§nti.
appendix 3
289
GaØg§ and Yamun§ rivers;7 Haridv§r, on the banks of the GaØg§; Ujjain, on the banks of the “ipr§; and Tryambakeáwar (near N§sik), on the banks of the God§varÊ. “aiva n§g§ initiations take place in Pray§g, Haridv§r and Ujjain, whereas vaißÖava n§g§ initiations take place at N§sik.8 There is a tradition that “aØkar§c§rya organised the Kumbh Mel§, or that he organised attending groups of ascetics (Krasa 1965:181). However, there appears to be no evidence to support this belief. We will see that both the astrological determinants of the festival and also the notion that the Kumbh Mel§ occurs at one of four sites—which has an explanatory myth—were most probably invented in the mid-nineteenth century. One of the widely known mythological stories in the Hindu tradition is that of the ‘Churning of the Ocean of Milk’ (kßÊr§bdhi-manthana) and the production of the Nectar of Immortality (amÜta).9 The story appears in both the R§m§yaÖa10 and the Mah§bh§rata,11 and later in more or less embellished variants in the Agni, VißÖu, Brahm§Ö·a, V§yu, Kårma, Padma, Skanda, Matsya and Bh§gavata Pur§Öa-s.12 It is famously represented in architecture—dating from the twelfth century—at Ankor Wat in Cambodia. The deva-s (gods), defeated by asura-s (demons) and ashamed of their weakness, approached VißÖu, seeking rejuvenation and immortality. VißÖu directed them to the primeval ocean that contained the secrets of life and death. The gods enlisted the help of the demons to churn the cosmic milk-ocean, so as to extract various boons, especially the amÜta, contained in its depths. Mount Mandara—said in some accounts to be near Mount Kail§sa—was used as the churning stick. This ‘stick’ was supported on the back of the Tortoise King
7 The extinct SarasvatÊ river is also said to emerge from underground at the saØgam of the GaØg§ and Yamun§ rivers. 8 The three vaißÖava n§g§ akh§Ü§-s belong to the R§m§nandÊ order (see Ch. 2.1). 9 The popular legend appeares in numerous Hindi publications; see, for example, Up§dhy§y (n.d.). See Long (1976) for a discussion of the various versions of the myth and references. 10 B§la-k§Ö·a 45.14–31. For a not entirely accurate translation of the V§lmÊki text, see Sen (1988:71–73). 11 II.15–17. For a translation of the text as contained in the Critical Edition, see van Buitenen (1973). 12 For Pur§Öic references, see Mani (1975:31–32). The “rÊmad Bh§gavatam [Bh§gavata Pur§Öa] (8.6–10) (for a translation, see Prabhup§da 1976) contains the most elaborate form of the myth (Long 1976:178).
290
appendix 3
(kårmar§ja), and around it was curled V§suki (the king of snakes) as a rope, whose head and tail was pulled by, respectively, the asuras and deva-s, to churn the ocean. After many years of churning, fumes, gases and, finally, deadly poison was produced. To save the situation, “iva drank the poison. ParvatÊ (or VißÖu) prevented him from swallowing it, and his throat turned blue,13 hence one of his epithets, NÊlakaÖãha (blue-throat). Thereafter, fourteen extraordinary treasures were produced, including14 an aerial car (vim§na pußpaka), Air§vata (the elephant), the P§rij§ta tree (erythrina indica), a flying horse, a priceless jewel (kaustubha), the waxing Moon, Rambh§ (one of the celestial dancers at Indra’s court), five auspicious cows (LakßmÊ, Suråpa, Yamun§, SuáÊl§ and Saurabhi), Viávakarma (the cosmic architect), and, lastly, Dhanvantari (the divine healer),15 holding a pot (kumbha) of amÜta, which was handed to Indra. The deva-s and asura-s had previously agreed to share the amÜta, but the deva-s reneged at this point and kept the whole pot for themselves, fearing the invincibility of the asura-s should they drink the amÜta. The asura-s then snatched away the kumbha of amÜta from the deva-s. N§r§yaÖa, concerned about the consequences of this, assumed the form of an enchanting female, MohinÊ, whose charms caused the asura-s to loosen their grip on the pot. The deva-s snatched back the pot and started drinking the amÜta. R§hu (the ascending node of the moon), one of the asura-s, disguised himself as a deva in order to get a drink of the nectar. However, just as he began to sip the nectar, he was noticed by the Sun and the Moon who warned N§r§yaÖa. N§r§yaÖa cut R§hu’s throat with his discus, but R§hu’s head and throat became immortal and ascended to heaven, remaining the eternal enemy of the Sun and Moon. Meanwhile, “ukr§c§rya (Venus), the preceptor of the asura-s, alerted the asura-s to MohinÊ’s enchantment. The asura-s attacked the deva-s and a battle ensued. There are several different accounts of what followed. Pertinent to the mythology of the Kumbh Mel§ is the story whereby BÜhaspati ( Jupiter), the preceptor of the deva-s, assisted. This particular version of the conclusion of the fight between the deva-s and asura-s
13 This part of the account, wherein gases and poison were produced, and “iva drank the poison, is not in the Mah§bh§rata. (Simon Brodbeck kindly pointed this out.) 14 Accounts vary slightly on what was produced. 15 The ‘patron saint’ of the Indian medical profession.
appendix 3
291
underpins the mythology of the sacredness and linkage between the four sites. In this story, BÜhaspati told Jayanta, the son of Indra, to flee with the amÜta and hide it from the asura-s. Jayanta took the form of a rook and, assisted by the Sun and the Moon, fled with the kumbha, pursued by the asura-s. A fight between the deva-s and asura-s took place for twelve days, and depending on the account: either the kumbha fell to earth at the four sites, Pray§g, Haridv§r, Ujjain and N§sik; or the sites were where Jayanta rested; or the kumbha was hidden at the four earthly sites and eight heavenly sites for twelve divine days (equalling twelve human years), when a few drops spilled en route, sanctifying the places. During the battle, the gods sent the Moon to prevent the pot from overflowing; the Sun to protect it from bursting; Saturn to prevent the contents being devoured by Jayanta; and BÜhaspati to protect Jayanta from the demons, during which twelve-year period he was staying in the signs (r§ái) of Aquarius (Kumbha), Taurus (VÜßa), Leo (SiÒha) and Scorpio (VÜácika), hence the origin of the twelve-year cycle of the Kumbh Mel§ and the determination of the timing of the Mel§ according to the position of Jupiter.16 Whereas the story of the ‘Churning of the Ocean’ and the fight between the deva-s and asura-s is told in a number of texts, including the epics and Pur§Öa-s, the story of Jayanta and the spilling of the nectar at four places does not appear therein,notwithstanding current claims for the antiquity of the mel§.17 The myth of the spilling of the 16 There are also other legends of the spilling of the nectar (Dubey 1987:121; Rai 1993b:43–44; Nandan 2002:3–4). In one, it is Garu·a who, winning the pot after a battle with the demons, is carrying it to devaloka when the nectar drops at the sites. In another, Garu·a brought the nectar from devaloka to release his mother, Vinat§, from Kadrå, the mother of the serpents (n§ga-s). Vinat§ was released but Indra stole the pot, and when fleeing the pursuing serpents spilt drops at the four sites. While the dropping of nectar is not found in the epic-Pur§Öic tradition, Garu·a’s bringing nectar to free his mother from the snakes is well known (MBh I.25ff.; R§m III.35.27; Garu·a Pur§Öa 1.240.26–28; Skanda Pur§Öa 4.1.55–125). 17 Evidence occasionally cited in support of an ancient Kumbh Mel§ includes a reference in the V§yu Pur§Öa (2.15.47) to “kumbha” as a holy place suitable for performing ár§ddha rites. Dubey (1987:120) believes that this reference does not refer to a Kumbh Mel§ but to a tÊrtha named “rÊ Kumbha on the SarasvatÊ river. Bonazzoli (1977:107) observes that a verse from the Atharva Veda (4.34.7) that states, “I give four pitchers (kumbha), in four (several) places” (caturaÈ kumbh§Òáacaturdh§ dad§mi) has been taken out of context by some commentators who believe this verse indicates the antiquity of the Kumbh Mel§. S§yaÖa (fourteenth century) commented on this verse, but made no connection with either Pray§g or the Kumbh as a Mel§, even though in his time tÊrtha-y§tr§-s were common. It seems that the
292
appendix 3
four drops of nectar, and astrological prerequisites,18 appear in two short texts—one referring to Haridv§r and the other to Pray§g—both of which are attributed to the Skanda Pur§Öa.19 The earliest publications of these ‘Pur§Öic’ texts are by Giri (1909) and Gau·a (1947).20 However, they are not traceable in any other printed editions of the Skanda Pur§Öa (Bonazzoli 1977:115), and appear almost certainly to have been interpolated, most probably around 1860, if Maclean is correct about the origins of the Kumbh Mel§ (see below). According to these texts the location for the occurrence of the Kumbh Mel§ is determined primarily according to the position of Jupiter (BÜhaspati), in its (almost) twelve-year cycle. Every twelve years the Mah§ (‘great’) Kumbh Mel§ takes place at Pray§g. This is when Jupiter is in Aqarius (Kumbha) on both the M§gh (Capricorn)21 and Meßa (Aries) saØkr§nti-s. Some Mah§ Kumbh Mel§s are hailed as particularly auspicious, such as the 2001 Pray§g Kumbh, during which was an astrological alignment that had not occurred for 144 years. Periodically, the $dh§/Ardh (half) Kumbh Mel§ occurs at either Haridv§r or Pray§g, in six-yearly cycles, while every year the M§gh Mel§ is held at Pray§g. The M§gh Mel§ begins at Makar SaØkr§nti (on January 16th) and finishes on “ivar§tri, ‘“iva’s night’, the main festival for “iva, held on the 14th day of the dark half of the month of Ph§lgån (Pisces). The full Pray§g Kumbh Mel§ takes place when Jupiter (BÜhaspati) enters Aries (Meßa; Hindi Cait) and both the Sun and the Moon are in Capricorn (M§gha).22
tradition of four Kumbh Mel§ sites was not current in S§yaÖa’s time. For other spurious Vedic references, see Bhattacharya (1977:4). 18 There is, however, no clear reference to the astrology of the Kumbh Mel§ in any astronomical work (Bhattacharya 1977:2). See Roebuck (1992) for an introduction to Indian astrology. 19 It has also been claimed that the Kumbh Mel§ is referred to in the VißÖu Pur§Öa, but there is no reference in any printed edition. The astrological prerequisites have also been erroneously attributed to the “ivasaÒhit§ (Bhattacharya 1977:3–4). 20 VeÖÊr§ma “arma Gau·a, Kumbha parva mah§tmya (KM), K§áÊ: Vy§sa Pustak§laya, SaÒvat 2004 (=1947 CE), pp. 16–17. This same text appears in Swami Shriramakrishnananda Giri’s KumbhaparvanirÖayaÈ (KN) (ed. Sitarama Sharma), Allahabad: B§ghambarÊ GaddÊ, SaÒvat 1965 (=1909 CE), which is translated and discussed by Bonazolli (1977:111–115) and commented on by Dubey (1987:123–126) and Rai (1993b:44). 21 Also Makar in Hindi. 22 For further details (not always consistent), see Sarkar (1958:97–98); Sinha and Saraswati (1978:149–151); Dubey (1987:123–128); Rai (1993b:47–57); ‘Kumbh’-parv (viáeߧØk) (2001:17–18); PurÊ (2001:167–178).
appendix 3
293
According to current mythology, the Mel§s are held when Jupiter is in one of four astrological houses: Aquarius, Taurus, Leo or Scorpio. However, as may be seen from the scheme below, this does not exactly correspond to practice (one of the mel§-s at Pr§yag takes place when Jupiter is in Aries). The timing of the baths is also determined by how long Jupiter remains in each sign. The Mel§ at Pray§g is known as the Kumbh Mel§, at Haridv§r as the Meß Kumbh (as the festival coincides with the large bath for the saØkr§nti of Meßa), and at Ujjain and N§sik as the SiÒh§ßãa (‘eight lion’) Mel§.23 Year
Place
0
Haridv§r Cait(ra) (Aries) Jupiter in Aquarius (Kumbha), Sun and Moon in Aries. Pray§g M§gha Jupiter in Aries (Meßa) [or (Capricorn) Taurus (VÜßa)] Sun and Moon in Capricorn on the new moon day in Capricorn. N§sik “ravaÖa Jupiter in Leo, Sun and Moon (Leo) in Leo (SiÒha). Haridv§r Caitra Jupiter in Leo, Sun in Aries. (Aries) Ujjain Vaiá§kha Jupiter in Leo, Sun in Aries (Taurus) [or Taurus], Moon in Virgo (Tul§). Pray§g M§gha Jupiter in Scorpio (VÜácika), Sun in Capricorn. Haridv§r Caitra Jupiter in Aquarius, Sun and Moon in Aries.
3
6(a) (b) (c) 9 12
Month
Astrology
Mela Kumbh
Kumbh Kumbh 1/2 Kumbh Kumbh 1/2 Kumbh Kumbh24
Sinha and Saraswati (1978:149–151) and Rai (1993b:47–57) note that, historically, the Kumbh Mel§ fell strictly according to the cycle of Jupiter, which is 11.86 years, the retrograde movement taking
23 The scheme for the timing of the mel§-s is primarily based on the astrological configurations found in the dubious text of the Skanda Pur§Öa, cited by Gau·a (op. cit., KM 8–21) and Giri (op. cit., KN 7–9). Interpretations are not entirely consistent. See Bonazzoli (1977); Bhattacharya (1977:2); Sinha and Saraswati (1978:149). 24 According to Gau·a (op. cit.) there are alternative astrological determinants: Pray§ga M§gha (Capricorn) Jupiter enters Taurus on the new moon day in the month of M§gha, Sun in Capricorn; N§sik $ߧ·ha (Cancer) Jupiter, Sun and Moon in Cancer (Karka), on the new moon day (am§vasy§); Ujjain Vaiá§kha (Taurus) Saturn in Libra (Tul§), Sun and Moon in Taurus on the new moon day.
294
appendix 3
it one house further every eighty-four years. Thus, the Haridv§r, Pray§g, Ujjain and N§sik Kumbh Mel§s take place sometimes eleven, twelve or thirteen years after a previous mel§ at one or another of the sites.25 The pattern of the dates (CE) of the mel§-s during the twentieth century is irregular (Dubey 1987:127),26 usually following a twelve year cycle, but with eleven and thirteen year intervals, in consort with the cycle of Jupiter. However, the N§sik and Ujjain mel§-s are either in the same year or a year apart. Although it has been suggested that the mythology and astrology linking the four sites of the Kumbh Mel§ seems to be of relatively recent origin, there are a number of references to each site in the Pur§Öa-s. The N§rada Pur§Öa ([Part 5] Uttarabh§ga 66.44) states that it is auspicious to bathe [every twelve years] in the GaØg§ at Haridv§r when Jupiter is in Aquarius (Kumbha) and the Sun is in Aries.27 Hazra
25
There was a dispute over this in 1956/7 and again in 1968/9 at the SiÒh§ßãa Mel§ at Ujjain (“arma 1980:10). On both occasions, the daÖ·Ê-s, “aØkar§c§ryas and others attended, but the mel§ was boycotted by the n§g§ akh§Ü§-s, who attended a mel§ held a year later, claiming that the mel§ should be held strictly every twelve years. There was also a dispute over when one of the Pray§g Kumbh Mel§s should be held, the SaÒny§sÊ astrologers believing it should be in 1965, while the Vair§gÊs (R§m§nandÊs) believed it should be in 1966 (Lamb 1999:198). The solution and consequence was the enhanced funding by the government of the annual, month-long M§gh Mel§, held at the same site, the two sects of s§dhu-s attending in different years. On both occasions many millions of pilgrims attended. In order to show their gratitude to the goverment for funding both mel§-s, the R§m§nandÊs attended the following year, in 1967, a festival attended by over two million people. The M§gh Mel§ continues to be attended by the R§m§nandÊs and their akh§Ü§-s, but is not attended by the Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊ akh§Ü§-s. 26 Haridv§r Pray§g Ujjain N§sik 1915 1906 1945 1932 1927 1918 1957 1944 1938 1929 1968 1956 1950 1941 1980 1968 1962 1954 1992 1980 1974 1965 2004 1992 1986 1977 2003 1998 1989 2001 27 It may be noted that the twelve-year cycle of Jupiter also determines the date of several other religious baths in India, the largest besides the four northern mel§-s being the twelve-yearly Mah§maham Mel§ at Kumbhakonam, by the K§verÊ river. This single-day festival is referred to as the Mah§ Mel§ of the south, the last having been held on the full-moon of March 1st 1980 when around two million people attended. It is celebrated when Jupiter is in transit across Leo, and the moon is conjunct with the constellation Maham, when the sun is in Aquarius (Kumbha).
appendix 3
295
(1940:132) believes that this section of the Pur§Öa is “comparatively late” (post-1000). The Khul§ßt-ut-Taw§rikh (34b), a description of India under Aurangzeb, written between 1693 and 1695, informs us that every twelfth year, when Jupiter enters the sign of Aquarius and the Sun is in Aries, a large number of people come from far and wide to bathe at Haridv§r (Rai 1993b:64). The text also mentions a yearly mel§ at Allahabad (Pray§g). Although a yearly festival at Haridv§r,28 which draws exceptional crowds every twelve years, is historically quite well attested, its origins are obscure. Several of the Pur§Öa-s recommend bathing at the saØgam of the GaØg§ and Yamun§ in the month of M§gha, particularly on am§v§sy§,29 the fifteenth day of the dark half of the month. The Anuá§sanaparvan of the Mah§bh§rata30 states that whoever bathes with a restrained mind, observing strict vows, at Pray§g in the month M§gha is cleansed of all sins and attains heaven. Perhaps the earliest unequivocal reference to a congregation of people at Pray§ga during M§gha occurs in the NarasiÒha Pur§Öa (1.1.24), a text dated by Hazra (1958:242) between 400 and 500. Another early historical record of a large gathering of ascetics at any of the sites may be found in the account by Hüang Tsang31 of his travels in India, between 629 and 645. From his account32 and from epigraphic evidence (Devahuti 1983:60, 176–181, 250), we have information of the presence of half a million people, from court officials to beggars, many thousands of áramaÖa-s, and a whole township of temporary structures at the saØgam near Pray§ga in 644, a gathering that lasted a month, which Hüang Tsang says is “age-old”. Bathing in the river washes away The mythology surrounding the festival involves nectar oozing from a pot into a liØga of sand made by “iva (see Subramanyan, 1980). 28 According to the $-Ên-i-AkbarÊ (3.9), at Haridv§r (M§y§) large numbers of pilgrims assemble on the 10th of the month of Caitra (March/April). (See Abul-Fazl 1972.) 29 The Pray§ga-mah§tmya-áat§dhy§yi recommends bathing there, and describes the benefits thereof. The Matsya Pur§Öa is the earliest Pur§Öa containing this M§h§tmya, which appears subsequently in the Padma and other Pur§Öa-s. Besides the Matsya (106.8; 107.7) and Padma (3.44.1), other Pur§Öa-s also recommend thrice-daily bathing during M§gha at Pray§ga: N§radÊya (2.63), Kårma (1.36.2; 1.38.2), Agni (3.10b–11a), and Skanda (4.1.7.62). See Bonazzoli (1977:84–101); Bhattacharya (1977:6); Dubey (1988:63). 30 MBh XIII:26.36. 31 Or Hiuen Tsiang/Hwen-Thsang/Yuan Chwang. 32 See Beal (1884:230–234); Watters (1904;361–365); Cunningham (1963:327– 329).
296
appendix 3
sins, and many visitors fast. Some ascetics are said to try to attain liberation by climbing a pole erected in the middle of the river, and staring at the sun. There also used to be a tradition of ritual suicide at Pray§ga.33 Since olden times, kings and noble families had come to the place to distribute gifts and goods in charity, hence the name of the area to the east of the river, d§n kßetra.34 Hüang Tsang was in the company of King Harßa Vardhana, the ruler of Kanauj, who was attending the sixth five-yearly assembly of the Buddhist saØgha. Harßa attended every five years, holding council, adorning a statue of the Buddha in a sumptuous way, performing religious rites and distributing alms to priests, men of standing, heretics, widows, orphans, the poor and mendicants. In one day, he is said to have distributed wealth accumulated over five years, much of it replenished subsequently by gifts from visiting nobles. Niccolau Manucci, who was in India from 1656 to 1717, also mentions (1990, Vol. II:76) a quinquennial festival at Allahabad. He observes that those who die from stifling by the crowd are not afforded the usual lamentions, as they die in a condition of grace and holiness, effected by the tÊrtha. Manucci also mentions that those who bathe must each pay six and a quarter rupees35 to the Mughal king, who derives a handsome income. It is also reported (De 1986:99) that Caitanya (1485–1533) visited the Pray§ga Mel§ around 1515. Pray§ga (Illah§b§s) is also referred to by Abu-l-Faíl in his $-Ên-l-AkbarÊ (3.9)36 (16th cent.); he observes that suicide is respected here—but regarded as a sin elsewhere—and that although holy throughout the year, Pray§ga is especially so during the month of M§gha. Thevenot, a European traveller, described the congregation at Pray§g in 1666–1667 of “troops” of fakÊr-s—some good men, and some rogues—performing ablutions and various penances, including fasting, continuously standing, holding their arms above their heads and being buried alive (Dubey 1988:67). Mediaeval commentators such as LakßmÊdh§ra (late 11th–12th cent.)
33 See Kane (HD“, Vol. 2:925; Vol. 3:939; Vol. 4:603–614). Before it was ordered to be cut down by Akbar, around 1584, jumping from a banyan tree near the saØgam was a popular means of suicide (Bonazzoli 1977:144). 34 The area is still so called, and pilgrims still receive alms there during mel§-s. 35 A small fortune at the time. 36 Reference to the Blochmann (1997) translation.
appendix 3
297
and V§caspatimiára (c. 9th–10th cent.), refer to the efficacy of m§ghasn§na at Pray§ga, as does TulsÊd§s (1532–1623) in the R§mcaritm§nas (Dey 1998:66). Regarding Ujjain,37 the Skanda Pur§Öa (5.1.1.48.51, 5.1.2.61.39, 5.1.2.82.15–17) recommends bathing there, in the “ipr§, on the fullmoon day of Taurus (Vaiá§kha). The “iva Pur§Öa (1.12.22–23) and V§r§ha Pur§Öa (1.71.47–48) extoll the virtues of bathing at N§sik, in the God§varÊ—also referred to as GomatÊ-tÊrtha—when the Sun and Jupiter are in Leo (SiÒha). The Brahm§ Pur§Öa (152.38–39; 175.83–84) refers to this event as the SiÒh§ßãa Mel§. There is a temple at R§mgh§t, on the God§varÊ at N§sik, that is opened every twelfth year, when Jupiter is in Leo. According to Ghurye (1964:178), the earliest mention of the N§sik mel§ occurs in the Guru-carita, a text from the end of the fifteenth century. Although it can also be seen that these Pur§Öic injunctions coincide with the timings of the mel§-s at the respective sites, as previously noted, the linkage between the sites is not evident in the epics or Pur§Öa-s.38 Bonazzoli (1997:117)39 believes that the Kumbh Mel§ (or Kumbh Parv) gets its name from a large gathering that used to take place at Haridv§r every twelve years on the occasion of a particular conjunction of planets, one of which was Kumbha r§ái, and that the traditional bath at Pray§ga for Makar saØkr§nti may have developed into the ‘Pray§ga Kumbha Parva’. The name was applied to the other large festivals, even though no celestial body was in the Kumbha r§ái (‘sign of the zodiac’) at the time of their occurrence. It is apparent that the current Kumbh Mel§ at Pray§g and the other three sites is a continuation of an ancient gathering of ascetics in those places,40 but Maclean’s (2001; 2003) studies of the origins of the Kumbh Mel§ provide substantive evidence that the legend of 37 Samanta (1997:17) states that there were three-yearly gatherings of Buddhists at Ujjain during the reign of Aáoka in the third century BCE, but gives no reference for the information. 38 See also Ali (1983). 39 See also Bhattacharya (1977:7); Rai (1993b:53–56). 40 The festival of “ivar§tri, celebrated all over India and Hindu Nepal, is another festival attended by many áaiva s§dhu-s at áaiva holy places, such as P§ápatin§th in Kathmandu. Although there are references to the mythology of the ‘Night of “iva’ in several Pur§Öa-s (dating from the eighth to twelfth century), the origins of the festival are obscure (Long 1982:192). One of the earliest references to the festival in India is from 1141. However, one of the first references to “ivar§tri in Nepal dates to 1773 (Michaels 1996:326).
298
appendix 3
the four sites and the astrological determinants may have been instituted around the middle of the nineteenth century. From Maclean’s (2003:884–888) inspection of numerous historical documents, including government archives, tax legislation, Indian and British travel accounts, and newspaper reports, it is evident that before 1868 there is no mention of the word ‘Kumbha’, in any of its variant spellings, in connection with the annual mel§ at Pray§g, nor is there any indication that every six or twelve years the mel§ had a particular significance, either as an ardh or ‘full’ Kumbh Mel§.41 The main agents behind the transformation of the site of the M§gh Mel§ into a site for one of the Kumbh Mel§s seem to have been the paÖ·§-s42 of Pray§g, the Pragv§ls (pray§g-v§l§-s) (Maclean 2003:879–884), who claim that their exclusive right to serve pilgrims at the saØgam was established by Akbar, in a farm§n (‘charter’) dated 1593. Their service to pilgrims for many generations had built up a network of contacts all over India, particular villages being the domain of particular Pragv§ls. They had enjoyed some freedom from intrusion during Nav§bÊ rule, prior to the secession of Allahabad to the British in 1801. The British inherited the right to collect tax from visiting pilgrims—and their vehicles—which was implemented in 1806. The exhorbitant tax (one rupee per pilgrim) levied by the British antagonised the Pragv§ls, as impoverished pilgrims would have less money to give to them (Maclean 2003:881). By 1815 the Pragv§ls threatened to cease officiating, causing concern amongst the British, who recognised the Pragv§ls’ substantial influence over the arrangements for the mel§ and their role in attracting taxable pilgrims. Although the Pilgrim Tax was abolished by 1840 (Maclean 2001:147), leading to increasing attendance, the British continued
41 During the early part of the nineteenth century there are references by British observers to the Kumbha Mel§ (with variant spellings) at Haridv§r, which drew exceptional crowds every twelve years, but the M§gh Mel§ at Pray§g is referred to as a yearly event. The first mention that Maclean (2003:884–888) has been able to find in any document of a Kumbh Mel§ at Allahabad is in 1868, by the Magistrate of Allahabad, who reports that a “Coomb fair” will be held in January 1870, and that four years previously (in 1866) there had been an “Ad Coomb when the concourse was immense”. Maclean believes that 1870 was the first time the mel§ at Allahabad was referred to as the Kumbh Mel§. 42 PaÖ·§-s are Brahman priests who may be found in all major Hindu pilgrimage centres. They keep family records and, for a fee, guide pilgrims through religious rituals, including the ministering of rites for the dead. They are generally regarded as low-caste Brahmans.
appendix 3
299
to profit from the mel§, taxing traders, barbers and others providing services. This was a source of increasing tension between the British and the Pragv§ls. In June 1857, after the mutiny of the 6th Native Infantry, the Pragv§ls joined the rebellion against the British, which was crushed. After their failed attempt at insurrection, the Pragv§ls exerted every effort to rebuild their business. Due to the general turmoil in India, there was no mel§ in 1858, but in 1859 there was a small M§gh Mel§ (Maclean 2001:153). The M§gh Mel§ of 1860 was exceptionally well attended, the flags of the Pragv§ls (used for the the purposes of identification by their clients) bearing anti-British symbols. That same year the Pragv§l Sabh§ was formed and registered with the government. Its aims were to protect and preserve the rights of its members to conduct rituals and accept donations at the saØgam. Although the origins of the legend of the four sites, the twelve-year cycle and the related astrology are obscure, Maclean’s analysis tends to the conclusion that the package of ideas was at the least actively disseminated, or most probably fabricated, around the middle of the nineteeth century, in an environment inhabited by several important groups of actors: anti-British Pragv§ls, with an economic agenda to expand the fame of their tÊrtha; and various mahant-s, saÒny§sÊ-s and pilgrims, some of whom, in the context of the general uprising against the British and general issues of geographical and religious identity, may have been active disseminators of some of the legend currently pertaining to the Kumbh Mel§. The mel§ became a symbol of religious identity, and the legacy of a decision by the British not to interfere with religious affairs. The institution of British rule in India at the end of the eighteenth century had effectively eroded the power and economic activities of the akh§Ü§-s. The only great arenas remaining for displays of the power and religious prestige of saÒny§sÊs and akh§Ü§-s, and for the collection of alms and donations, were the Kumbh Mel§s, which remained relatively free from government interference; s§dhu-s were allowed to go naked and display arms. The dissemination of legends highlighting both the antiquity and auspiciousness of the mel§-s could not have but furthered saÒny§sÊ-s’ economic and religious agendas.
300
appendix 4
APPENDIX 4
SUBDIVISIONS WITHIN THE DA“AN$M^ AKH$4$-S: MAŒH^-S AND D$V$-S 1. In the Maãheávar Dharma Paddhati, an oral tradition has been recorded (Sad§nanda Giri, 1976:19), in which there is a list of 53 maãha-s, which are as follows: 1. “ÜØgerÊ. 2. “§rad§. 3. Govardhana. 4. Jyotir. 5. Sumeru. 6. Param§tm§. 7. Ku·ali. 8. “aØkheávara. 9. K§áyapa. 10. Kumbhon. 11. Pußpagiri. 12. Viråp§kßa. 13. Habyaka. 14. “ivagaØg§. 15. Koppala. 16. “rÊ Saila. 17. R§meávara. 18. R§macandrapura. 19. Avanti. 20. H§li. 21. Bh§Ö·§giri. 22. Dhanagiri. 23. Kevalyapura. 24. Måla BeØgal. 25. “rÊ Saila.1 26. Khidr§påra. 27. NarasiÒhadeva. 28. Maulavan. 29. Peãhna. 30. Bh§Ö·§giri. 31. K§áÊ. 32. TÊrthar§jpura. 33. TÊrthahale. 34. Hariharpura. 35. GaØgÙttarÊ. 36. Buddhag§ya. 37. T§rakeávara. 38. Dhumeávara. 39. Goleávar. 40. Kudapal. 41. Kairua. 42. Gohanda. 43. Anauvar. 44. BhÊmeávara. 45. OÒk§reávara. 46. Mandh§ta. 47. GaØgeávarÊ. 48. Siddhan§tha. 49. Cidambaram. 50. Siddheávara. 51. Vimaleávara. 52. Amarn§tha. 53. Cinaur. 2. Sad§nanda Giri (1976:21), Sinha and Saraswati (1978:263), and PurÊ (2001:53–76) present somewhat inconsistent accounts of the formation of the eight d§v§-s, comprising the maÜhÊ-s. According to Sad§nanda Giri, they are: A. R§mdattÊ D§v§ 1. R§mdatta. 2. Durg§n§thÊ. 3. Balabhadran§thÊ. 4. Jagjivan§thÊ. 5. SaÒjñan§thÊ. B. Œddhin§thÊ D§v§ 1. Œddhin§thÊ. 2. Brahman§thÊ (Younger). 3. Pit§mbarin§thÊ. 4. Jñ§nan§thÊ (Younger). 5. Jñ§nan§thÊ (Elder). 6. Aghorn§thÊ. 7. Bh§van§thÊ. 8. Brahman§thÊ (Elder). C. D§v§ of 4 maÜhÊs 1. OÒk§rÊ. 2. Yati. 3. Param§nandÊ. 4. Ch§nd§bodhl§. D. D§v§ of 10 maÜhÊs 1. Sahajn§thÊ. 2. Kusumn§thÊ. 3. S§garn§thÊ. 4. P§raán§thÊ. 5. Bh§van§thÊ. 6. S§gar Bodhla. 7. Nagendran§thÊ. 8. Viávambharn§thÊ. 9. Rudran§thÊ. 10. Ratann§thÊ. E. VaikuÖãhÊ D§v§ 1. VaikuÖãhÊ. 2. Mult§nÊ (Keáo PurÊ). 3. Mathur§ PurÊ. 4. Keval PurÊ. 5. Daáan§mÊ. 6. Tilak PurÊ (Meghn§th PurÊ). 7. “yamsundar Ban. 8. Balabhadra Ban. 9. R§mchandra Ban. 10. “akhad§r§ Ban. F. Sahaj§vat D§v§ 1. Sahaj PurÊ.
1
This name inexplicably appears twice, also occurring as entry no. 16.
appendix 4
301
G. Dariy§v D§v§ 1. GaØg§ Dariy§v. 2. Bhagav§n PurÊ. 3. Bhagav§nta PurÊ. 4. Puran PurÊ. 5. Hanum§nta PurÊ. 6. NÊlkaÖãha PurÊ. 7. Jñ§nan§th PurÊ. 8. Manomeghn§th PurÊ. 9. Bodh Ayodhya PurÊ. 10. Arjun PurÊ. H. Bh§ratÊ D§v§ 1. Narsingh Bh§ratÊ. 2. Manmukund Bh§ratÊ. 3. Viáambhar Bh§ratÊ. 4. Padman§th Bh§ratÊ. In this scheme, the PurÊ, Bh§ratÊ, SarasvatÊ, TÊrtha, $árama, Vana and AraÖya saÒny§sÊ-s belong to D§v§ groups E, F, G and H. 3. According to the Daá n§m vaÒß vÜkß, a short text Hindi circulated amongst Daáan§mÊ initiates, the maÜhÊ-s are constituted as follows (see also PurÊ 2001:57–85): 4 maÜhÊ-s of Bh§ratÊs: Viáva Bh§ratÊ, NarsiÒh Bh§ratÊ, B§l Viávan§tha Man Maheáa Bh§ratÊ, Manmukunda Bh§ratÊ. 4 maÜhÊ-s of Van(a)s: SiÒhasan Van, BhaÖ·§rÊ Van, S§rop§r§ Van, Tot§r§ Van. 16 maÜhÊ-s of PurÊs: BaikuÖãhpurÊ, KevalpurÊ, KeáavpurÊ, Mult§nÊ, ManpurÊ, R§mcandrapurÊ, R§dh§purÊ, GurudevpurÊ, PunampurÊ, GaØg§dariy§vpurÊ, Durg§purÊ, K§mn§thpurÊ, Daáan§m TilakpurÊ, SahajpurÊ, Bhagav§npurÊ, R§mpurÊ, Pray§gpurÊ (?). 13 maÜhÊ-s of Giris: Meghn§thÊ, BaikuÖãhn§thÊ, Bh§vn§thÊ, Jñ§nn§thÊ, “Êtaln§thÊ, Viávan§thÊ, R§j§n§thÊ, Hariv§n§thÊ, Durg§n§thÊ, Pramathn§thÊ, Bhol§n§thÊ, Saheávarn§thÊ, Œddhn§thÊ. 14 maÜhÊ-s of Giris: $p§rn§thÊ, Prabh§n§thÊ, B§daln§thÊ, AuÒk§rÊn§thÊ, Rudran§thÊ, S§garn§thÊ, N§mendran§thÊ, Bodhn§thÊ, Kumustn§thÊ, Ratann§thÊ, Mol§n§thÊ, Maheávan§thÊ, Modun§thÊ, R§man§thÊ. 4. In the sources of the Mah§nirv§ÖÊ akh§Ü§, used by Sarkar (1958:58–59), 52 maÜhÊ-s are listed in the six groups, with the following divisions: A. Giri ($nandbar section, Megn§th-panthÊ). 1. R§mdattÊ. 2. Durg§panthÊ. 3. Œddhin§thÊ. 4. Brahman§thÊ (Lesser). 5. Patambaran§thÊ. 6. Balbhadran§thÊ. 7. Jñ§nn§thÊ (Lesser). 8. Jñ§nn§thÊ (Greater). 9. Aghorn§thÊ. 10. Sañjn§thÊ. 11. Bhavan§thÊ. 12. JagjÊvan§thÊ. 13. Brahman§thÊ (Greater). B. Giri (Ap§rn§th-panthÊ). 1. OÒkarÊ. 2. ParamanadÊ. 3. Bodhla. 4. Yati. 5. Nagendran§thÊ. 6. S§garn§thÊ. 7. Bodhn§thÊ. 8. Kumasn§thÊ. 9. Sahajn§thÊ. 10. Paráan§thÊ. 11. Marn§thÊ. 12. Viávambharn§thÊ. 13. T§r§n§thÊ. 14. Rudran§thÊ. C. PurÊ (Bhurbar section). 1. Bhagv§n PurÊ. 2. Bhabvant PurÊ. 3. GaØg§ Daryab. 4. Lahar Daryab. 5. Puran PurÊ. 6. Jarbh§rat PurÊ. 7. Sahaj PurÊ. 8. Mani Meghnad PurÊ. 9. Bodha Ayodhya PurÊ. 10. Jñ§n§th PurÊ. 11. Arjun PurÊ. 12. NÊlkaÖãh PurÊ. 13. Hameman PurÊ. 14. VaikuÖãhÊ. 15. Mult§nÊ. 16. Mathur§ PurÊ. 17. Keval PurÊ. 18. Daáan§mÊ Tilak PurÊ. (The PurÊs are usually only attributed with 16 maÜhÊ-s according to all sources but Sarkar.)
302
appendix 4
D. Ban 1. “yamsudar Ban. 2. R§mcandra Ban. 3. “aØkhadh§rÊ 4. Balabhadra Ban. E. Bh§ratÊ 1. Narsingh Bh§ratÊ. 2. Man Mukund Bh§ratÊ. 3. Viáv§m Bh§ratÊ. 4. Padmanav Bh§ratÊ. F. L§m§. The L§m§ maÜhÊ/akh§Ü§ has an uncertain status. According to Sad§nanda Giri (1976:19), n§g§-s believe that the L§m§ maÜhÊ, which in some lists is the fifty-third maÜhÊ, is included in the Giri d§v§.
bibliography
303
BIBLIOGRAPHY Abhilash Das (comm.) (1997). Kabir Bijak, trans. Prem Prakash. Allahabad: Parakh Prakashak Kabir Sansthan. Abu-l-Fazl (1972) The Akbar-n§ma, trans. from Persian by H. Beveridge. (Bibliotheca Indica: a Collection of Oriental Works published by the Asiatic Society of Bengal.) Delhi: Rare Books. ––––––[-Allami] (1997). The $-Ên-i-AkbarÊ (being the third volume of the Akbar-n§ma), trans. H. Blochmann, ed. D. C. Phillott. Delhi: Low Price Publications (first pub. 1927). Agrawal, C. M. (1993). History of Kumaun [Kumaun ka Itih§s], Vol. 1, trans. Badri Datt Pande. Almora (U.P.): Shree Almora Book Depot. Ahuja, Jasbir Kaur (1994). ‘Udasi Sampardaya: Torch-Bearers of Sikhism’. The Sikh Review, Vol. 42.10, no. 490, October, pp. 13–18. Aiyer, A. Nataraja, and S. Lakshminarasimha Sastri (1962). The Traditional Age of Sri Sankaracharya and the Maths. Madras: Rajan & Co. Aklujkar, Ashok (1994). ‘An Introduction to the Study of BhartÜ-hari’. In Saoja Bhate and Johannes Bronkhorst (eds), BhartÜhari, Philosopher and Grammarian: Proceedings of the First International Conference on BhartÜhari, pp. 7–36. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Al-Badauni [Abdu-l-Q§dir Ibn-i-Mulåk Sh§h] (1986). Muntakhabu-t-Taw§rÊkh, Vols. 1–3, trans. from Persian and ed. George S. A. Ranking (Vol. 1), W. H. Lowe (Vol. 2), and Wolseley Haig (Vol. 3). Delhi: Renaissance Publishing House. Ali, S. M. (1983). The Geography of the Puranas. New Delhi: People’s Publishing House, 3rd. edn. (first pub. 1966). Alston, A. J. A “aÒkara Source-Book, Vols. 1–6. London: Shanti Sadan. (1980a, Vol. 1, “aØkara on The Absolute; 1980b, Vol. 2, “aØkara on Creation; 1981, Vol. 3, “aØkara on the Soul; 1989, Vol. 4, “aØkara on Rival Views; 1989, Vol. 5, “aØkara on Discipleship; 1989, Vol. 6, “aØkara on Enlightenment.) –––––– (1980c). The Devotional Poems of MÊr§b§Ê (Translated with Introduction and Notes). Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. –––––– (2000). ‘“aÒkara in East and West Today’. In Bradley J. Malkovsky (ed.), New Perspectives on Advaita Ved§nta: Essays in Commemoration of Professor Richard de Smet, S. J., pp. 84–108. Leiden/Boston/Köln: Brill. Alter, Joseph S. (1992). The Wrestler’s Body: Identity and Ideology in North India. Oxford/ Berkeley, Los Angeles: University of California Press. Anant§nanda Giri (1971). “rÊ “aØkara-vijaya, ed. N. Veezhinathan. Madras: Centre of Advanced Study, University of Madras. Anantanandendra Sarasvati, Swami (1968). ‘Sri Sankara and Sankarite Institutions’. In T. M. P. Mahadevan (ed.), Preceptors of Advaita, pp. 367–401. Secunderabad: Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Sankara Mandir. Ananthakrishna Iyer, L. K. (1912). The Cochin Tribes and Castes, Vol. 2. Madras and London: Higginbotham & Co. –––––– (1930). ‘Sanny§sÊ’. In Ananthakrishna Iyer, Rao Bahadur, and H. V. Nanjundayya (complilers), The Mysore Tribes and Castes, Vols. 3–4. Bangalore: Mysore University, 1930–1931. Annan, David (1967). ‘Thuggee’. In Norman Mackensie (ed.), Secret Societies, pp. 64–83. London: Aldus Books.
304
bibliography
Annual Reports on Indian Epigraphy, 1887–1910. New Delhi: Archaeological Survey of India, 1986. Annual Reports on Indian Epigraphy, 1915–1921. New Delhi: Archaeological Survey of India, 1986. Annual Reports on Indian Epigraphy, 1936–1937. New Delhi: Archaeological Survey of India, 1986. Annual Report of the Mysore Archaeological Department, for the year 1933. Bangalore: University of Mysore, 1936. Annual Report of the Mysore Archaeological Department, for the year 1934. Bangalore: University of Mysore, 1936. Annual Report on South-Indian Epigraphy, for the year ending 31st March, 1928. Madras: Government of India, 1930. Antarkar, W. R. (1960). ‘BÜhat-“aØkara-Vijaya of Citsukh§c§rya and Pr§cÊna“aØkara-Vijaya of $nandagiri a/s $nanda-Jñ§na’. Journal of the University of Bombay, Vol. XXIX, part 2, September, pp. 113–121. –––––– (1961). ‘“aØkara-Vijaya of Anant§nandagiri’. Journal of the University of Bombay, Vol. XXX, part 2, September, pp. 73–80. –––––– (1972). ‘SaØkßepa “aØkara Jaya of M§dhv§c§rya or “aØkara Digvijaya of “rÊ Vidy§raÖyamuni’. Journal of the University of Bombay (n.s.), Vol. XLI, no. 77, pp. 1–23. –––––– (ed.) (1973). ‘“rÊcidvil§samuniviracitaÈ “aØkaravijayavil§saÈ’. Bh§ratÊya Vidy§, 33, pp. 1–92. –––––– (1997). ‘The Place of “aØkara’s Final Disappearance’. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bombay, Vol. 71 of 1996, pp. 1–22. –––––– (2001). K§ñcÊ K§makoãi Mutt: A Myth Or Reality? (Post-Graduate and Research Department Series, no. 44). Pune: Bhandarkar Oriental Research Institute. Archaeological Survey of India: South Indian Inscriptions (Tamil and Sanskrit), Vol. 1, ed. E. Hultzch. London: Trübner & Co./W. H. Allen & Co, 1890. Arooran, K. Nambi (1984). ‘The Changing Role of Three Saiva Maths in Tanjore District from the Beginning of the Twentieth Century’. In Kenneth Ballhatchet and David Taylor (eds), Changing South Asia: Religion and Society, pp. 51–58. Hong Kong: Centre of South Asian Studies, SOAS, University of London. Babb, Lawrence A (1975). The Divine Hierarchy: Popular Hinduism in Central India. New York: Columbia University Press. –––––– (1984). ‘Indigenous Feminism in a Modern Hindu Sect’. Signs (Journal of Women and Culture), Vol. 9, no. 3, Spring, pp. 399–416. –––––– (1996). Absent Lord: Ascetics and Kings in a Jain Ritual Culture. Berkeley: University of California Press. Bader, Jonathan (2000). Conquest of the Four Quarters: Traditional Accounts of the Life of “aØkara. New Delhi: Aditya Prakashan. Balambal, K. (1999). ‘K§ñci Through the Ages’. In S. Settar and P. K. V. Kaimal (eds), We Lived Here, pp. 32–53. Delhi: Pragati Publications/The Indian Council of Historical Research. Balasubramanian, R. (trans. and comm.) (1988). The Naißkarmyasiddhi of Sureávara. Madras: Radhakrishnan Institute for Advanced Study in Philosophy, University of Madras. Balbir, Nalini (2002). ‘Women and Jainism in India’. In Arvind Sharma (ed.), Women in Indian Religions, pp. 70–107. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Banerjea, Akshaya Kumar (1983). Philosophy of Gorakhnath (with Goraksha-VacanaSangraha). Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub. 1962). –––––– (1988). The Nath-Yogi Sampradaya and the Gorakhnath Temple. Gorakhpur: Digvijayanath Trust.
bibliography
305
–––––– (n.d.). Natha Yoga. Gorakhpur: Digvijayanath Trust. Banerjee, Ruben (2000). ‘Seer Pressure: A claimant to the exalted position is branded an imposter and ordered out of the temple town’. India Today International, 31st July, p. 34. Banerji, Sures Chandra (1998). A Companion to Dharmaá§stra. New Delhi: D. K. Printworld. Baral, Leelanateshwar Sharma (1964). Life and Writings of PÜthvÊn§r§yaÖa “§h. Unpublished Ph.D. Thesis, School of Oriental and African Studies, University of London. Barnett, Richard B. (1987). North India Between Empires: Awadh, the Mughals, and the British. New Delhi: Manohar. Basham, A. L. (1951). History and Doctrines of the $jÊvikas: A Vanished Indian Religion. London: Luzac & Company Ltd. –––––– (1981). The Wonder that was India. New Delhi: Rupa, 3rd. edn. (first pub. 1954). Basilov, V. N. (1999). ‘Cosmos as Everyday Reality in Shamanism: An Attempt to Formulate a More Precise Definition of Shamanism’. In Romano Mastromattei and Antonio Rigopoulos (eds), Shamanic Cosmos: From India to the North Pole Star (Venetian Academy of Indian Studies, no. 1), pp. 17–40. New Delhi: D. K. Printworld (P) Ltd. Bayly, C. A. (1973). ‘Politics and Patrons in North India’. In John Gallagher, Gordon Johnson, and Anil Seal (eds), Locality, Province and Nation: Essays on Indian Politics 1870-1940, pp. 29–68. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. –––––– (1985). ‘The Pre-history of “Communalism”? Religious Conflict in India, 1700–1860’. Modern Asian Studies, 19.2, pp. 177–203. –––––– (1992). Rulers, Townsmen and Bazaars: North Indian Society in the Age of British Expansion, 1770–1870. New Delhi: Cambridge University Press (first pub. 1983). Beal, Samuel (trans.) (1884). Si-Yu-Ki: Buddhist Records of the Western World, Translated from the Chinese of Hiuen Tsiang (A.D. 629). London: Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co. Ltd. Bedi, Rajesh, and Ramesh Bedi (1991). Sadhus: The Holy Men of India. New Delhi: Brijbasi Printers Private Limited. Belvalkar, S. K. (1929). (Shree Gopal Basu) Lectures on Ved§nta Philosophy (Part 1: Lectures 1–6). Poona: Bilvakuñja Publishing House. Bennett, J. G. (1965). The Long Pilgrimage: The Life and Teachings of Sri Govindananda Bharati, known as the Shivapuri Baba. London: Hodder and Stoughton. Bhagat, M. G. (1976). Ancient Indian Asceticism. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. (The) BhagavadgÊt§ in the Mah§bh§rata: A Bilingual Edition, trans. and ed. J. A. B. van Buitenen. London: University of Chicago Press, 1981. Bhalla, P. N. (1944). ‘The Gosain Brothers’. Journal of Indian History, Vol. XXIII, part. 2, serial no. 68, August, pp. 128–136. Bhandarkar, Ramkrishna Gopal (1995). Vaisnavism, Saivism and Minor Religious Systems. New Delhi: Asian Educational Services (first pub. 1913). Bharati, Agehananda (1963). ‘Pilgrimage in the Indian Tradition’. History of Religions, Vol. 3, no. 1, Summer, pp. 135–167. –––––– (1965). The Tantric Tradition. London: Rider and Company. Bhardwaj, Surinder Mohan (1987). ‘Single Religion Shrines, Multireligion Pilgrimages’. In R. L. Singh and Rana P. B. Singh (eds), Trends in the Geography of Pilgrimages: Homage to David E. Sopher, pp. 105–116. Varanasi: The National Geographical Society of India/ Banaras Hindu University. Also printed in
306
bibliography
The National Geographical Journal of India, Vol. 33, part. 4, December 1987, pp. 457–468. –––––– (1999). Hindu Places of Pilgrimage in India: A Study in Cultural Geography. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal (first pub. University of California Press, 1973). Bhatt, Chetan (2001). Hindu Nationalism: Origins, Ideologies and Modern Myths. Oxford: Berg. Bhatt, G. R. (1980). “ri Vallabh§ch§rya and His Doctrines. Delhi: Butala & Co. Bhatt, S. R. (1963). ‘Why Pañcar§tra was Condemned as Non-Brahmanic’. Indian Historical Quarterly, Vol. XXXIX, nos. 1 & 2, March and June, pp. 21–26. –––––– (1968). The Philosophy of Pancharatra (Advaitic Approach). Madras: Ganesh & Co. Private Ltd. Bhattacharji, Sukumari (1970). The Indian Theogony: Brahm§, VißÖu and “iva. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Bhattacharya, Jogendra Nath (1973). Hindu Castes and Sects. Calcutta: Editions Indian (first pub. 1896). Bhattacharya, Ram Shankar (1977). ‘The Kumbhaparvan’. Hindutva, Vol. VII, no. 8, December 1976–January 1977, pp. 1–9. Bhattacharyya, Dinesh Chandra (1931). ‘MaÖ·ana, Sureávara and Bhavabhåti: the Problem of their Identity’. The Indian Historical Quarterly, Vol. VII, pp. 301–308. Bishnudevnand Saraswat, Swami (1977). Yogiraj Handiya Baba, trans. Henry Mitchell. Daraganj, Allahabad: Handiya Baba Yogalaya (first Hindi edn. 1954). Blacker, Carmen (1999). The Catalpa Bow: A Study in Shamanistic Practices in Japan. Richmond, UK: Japan Library (Curzon Press) (first pub. George Allen & Unwin, 1975). Blunt, E. A. H. (1931). The Caste System of Northern India (With special reference to the United Provinces of Agra and Oudh). London: Humphrey Milford/Oxford University Press. Bodewitz, H. W. (1973). JaiminÊya Br§hmaÖa I, 1–65 (Translation and Commentary, with a Study: Agnihotra and Pr§Ö§gnihotra). Leiden: E. J. Brill. Bollée, Willem B (1981). ‘The Indo-European Sodalities in Ancient India’. Zeitschrift der Deutsches Morgenländischen Gesellschaft, Band 131, pp. 172–191. Bonazzoli, Georgio (1997). ‘Pray§ga and it’s Kumbha Mel§’. Pur§Öa, Vol. XIX, no. 1, January, pp. 81–159. Bouillier, Véronique (1976). ‘Funeral observances of a group of non-ascetic Sunyasi in central Nepal’, trans. Kathryn S. March. Contributions to Nepalese Studies, Vol. 3, no. 2, September, pp. 35–45. –––––– (1978). ‘L’ascétisme dans le Code Népalais’. Journal Asiatique, Vol. CCLXVI, parts 1 & 2, pp. 133–152. –––––– (1979). Naître Renonçant: une caste de Sanny§si villageois au Népal Central. Nanterre: Laboratoire d’Ethnologie. –––––– (1997). ‘Conflits autour d’un monastère Sanny§sÊ: documents du Kw§ãhan·o maãh à Bhatgaon (Népal)’. In Les Habitants du Toit du Monde (Études Recueillies en Homage à Alexander W. Macdonald par les Soins de Samten Karmay et Philippe Sagant), pp. 723–735. Nanterre: Société d’Ethnologie. Bradford, N. J. (1985). ‘The Indian Renouncer: Structure and Transformation in the Lingayat Community’. In Richard Burghart and Audrey Cantlie (eds), Indian Religion (Collected Papers on South Asia, no. 7), pp. 79–101. London: Curzon Press. Briggs, George Weston (1982). Gorakhn§th and the K§nphaãa YogÊs. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub. 1938).
bibliography
307
Brockington, J. L. (1996). The Sacred Thread. Edinburgh: Edinburgh University Press, 2nd. edn. (first pub. 1981). Bronkhorst, Johannes (1986). The Two Traditions of Meditation in Ancient India. Stuttgart: Steiner-Verlag-Wiesbaden-GmbH. –––––– (1998).The Two Sources of Indian Asceticism. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, revised Indian edn. (first pub. Bern: Peter Lang, 1993). Brough, John (1953). The Early Brahmanical System of Gotra and Pravara: A Translation of the Gotra-Pravara-MañjarÊ of Purußottama-PaÖdita, with an Introduction. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Brown, C. Mackenzie (1986). ‘Pur§Öa as Scripture: From Sound to Image of the Holy Word in the Hindu Tradition’. History of Religions, Vol. 26, no. 1, August, pp. 68–86. Brunner, Hélène (1964). ‘Les Catégories Sociales Védiques dans le “ivaÊsm du Sud’. Journal Asiatique, no. 252, pp. 451–472. Brunner-Lachaux, Hélène (trans. and intro.) (1963). Somaáambhupaddhati (Le rituel quotidien dans la tradition áiva’ite de l’Inde du Sud selon Somaáambhu), Vols. 1–4 (Publications de l’Institut Français d’Indologie no. 25). Pondichéry: Institut Français d’Indologie. Bühnemann, Gudrun (1988). Påj§: A Study in Sm§rta Ritual (Publications of the De Nobili Research Institute, Vol. XV). Vienna: Gerold & Co. Burghart, Richard (1976). ‘Bairagi Mandals’. Contributions to Nepalese Studies, Vol. 3, no. 1, January, pp. 63–104. –––––– (1978a). ‘Hierarchical models of the Hindu social system’. Man (n.s.), 13, pp. 519-536. –––––– (1978b). ‘The Founding of the Ramanandi Sect’. Ethnohistory 25, no. 2, Spring, pp. 129–131. –––––– (1983a). ‘Renunciation in the religious traditions of South Asia’. Man (n.s.), 18, pp. 635–653. –––––– (1983b). ‘Wandering ascetics of the R§m§nandi sect’. History of Religions, 22.4, pp. 361–390. –––––– (1984). ‘Regional Circles and the Central Overseer of the Vaishnavite Sects in the Kingdom of Nepal’. In Kenneth Ballhatchet and David Taylor (eds), Changing South Asia: Religion and Society, pp. 165–179. Hong Kong: Centre of South Asian Studies, SOAS, University of London. –––––– (1995). ‘The Category ‘Hindu’ in the Political Discourse of Nepal’. In Vasudha Dalmia and Heinrich von Stietencron (eds), Representing Hinduism: The Construction of Religious Traditions and National Identity, pp. 129–141. London: Sage Publications. –––––– (1996).The Conditions of Listening: Essays on Religion, History and Politics in South Asia. Delhi: Oxford University Press. Caland, Willem (ed. and intro.) (1941). Vaikh§nasa-“rautasåtram: The Description of Vedic Rites according to the Vaikh§nasa School belonging to the Black Yajur Veda (Bibliotheca Indica, work no. 265). Calcutta: Royal Asiatic Society of Bengal. Candraáekharendra SarasvatÊ Sv§mÊ, Jagadguru “rÊ (“rÊ “aØkar§c§rya of K§ñcÊ K§makoãi PÊãha) (1976). Hindu Dharma. Kumbakonam: Sri Kamakoti Research Centre. –––––– (1995). Hindu Dharma: The Universal Way of Life. Mumbai: Bharatiya Vidya Bhavan. –––––– (2001). “rÊ “aØkara Bhagavatp§d§c§rya’s SaundaryalaharÊ (An Exposition by PåkaárÊ Candraáekharendra SarasvatÊ Sv§mÊ, 68th “aØkar§c§rya of K§ñcÊ K§makoãÊ PÊãha). Mumbai: Bharatiya Vidya Bhavan. Cantlie, Audrey (1977). ‘Aspects of Hindu Asceticism’. In Ioan Lewis (ed.), Sym-
308
bibliography
bols and Sentiments: Cross-cultural Studies in Symbolism, pp. 247–267. London: Academic Press. Caplan, Patricia (1973). ‘Ascetics in Western Nepal’. Eastern Anthropologist, Vol. 26, no. 2, April–June, pp. 173–183. CaturvedÊ, Ac§rya Paraáur§m (1964). UttarÊ Bh§rat kÊ Sant-Parampar§ (sanáodhit tath§ parivardhit). Allahabad: Bh§ratÊ Bhan·§r LÊ·ar Press (2nd. edn.). Cenkner, William (1983). A Tradition of Teachers: “aØkara and the Jagatgurus Today. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. –––––– (1996). ‘The Sankaracarya of Kanchi and the Kamaksi Temple as Ritual Centre’. In Raymond Brady Williams (ed.), A Sacred Thread: Modern Transmissions of Hindu Traditions in India and Abroad, pp. 52–67. New York: Columbia University Press. Chakrabarti, Kunal (2001). Religious Process: The Pur§Öas and the Making of a Regional Tradition. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Chakraborti, Haripada (1970). P§áupata Såtram: with Pañch§rtha-Bh§ßya of KauÖ·inya. Calcutta: Academic Publishers. –––––– (1973). Asceticism in Ancient India: In Brahmanical, Buddhist, Jaina and $jÊvaka Societies—from the earliest times to the period of “aØkar§ch§rya. Calcutta: Punthi Pustak. Champakalakshmi, R. (1981). ‘Peasant State and Society in Medieval South India: A Review Article’ [of Stein 1980]. The Indian Economic and Social History Review, Vol. XVIII, nos. 3 & 4, July–December, pp. 411–426. –––––– (1989). ‘Religion and Social Change in Tamil Nadu’. In N. N. Bhattacharya (ed.), Medieval Bhakti Movements in India, pp. 162–173. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. –––––– (1996a). ‘From Devotion and Dissent to Dominance: The Bhakti of the Tamil $l..v§rs and N§yaÖ§rs’. In R. Champakalakshmi and S. Gopal (eds), Tradition, Dissent and Ideology: Essays in Honour of Romila Thapar, pp. 135–163. Delhi: Oxford University Press. –––––– (1996b).Trade, Ideology and Urbanization: South India 300 BC to AD 1300. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Chandra, A. N. (1977). The Sannyasi Rebellion. Calcutta: Ratna Prakashan. Chandra, Lokesh (1992). ‘Devar§ja in Cambodian History’. Indologica Taurinensia, Vol. XVII–XVIII, 1991–1992, pp. 103–122. Chandra, Satish (1996). Historiography, Religion & State in Medieval India. New Delhi: Har-Anand Publications. –––––– (2003). ‘Jizya and the State in India during the Seventeenth Century’. In Richard M. Eaton (ed.), India’s Islamic Traditions, 711–1750, pp. 133–149. New Delhi: Oxford University Press, Chapple, Christopher Key (2003). Reconciling Yogas: Haribhadra’s Collection of Views on Yoga. Albany: State University of New York Press. Chatterjee, Suranjan (1984). ‘New Reflections on the Sannyasi, Fakir and Peasant War’. Economic and Political Weekly, Vol. XIX, no. 4, January 28, pp. PE2–PE-13. Chattopadhyaya, Sudhakar (1970). Evolution of Hindu Sects up to the Time of “aÒkar§c§rya. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. Chaudhury, Binayendra Nath (1969). Buddhist Centres in Ancient India. Calcutta: Sanskrit College. Chiriyankandnath, James (1998). ‘Bounded Nationalism: Kerala and the Social and Regional Limits of Hindutva’. In Thomas Blom Hansen and Christophe Jaffrelot (eds),The BJP and the Compulsions of Politics in India, pp. 202–227. New Delhi: Oxford University Press, 2nd. edn. Chowdhury-Sengupta, Indira (1996). ‘Reconstructing Spiritual Heroism: The
bibliography
309
Evolution of the Swadeshi Sannyasi in Bengal’. In Julia Leslie (ed.), Myth and Mythmaking: Continuous Evolution in Indian Tradition, pp. 124–143. London: Curzon Press, 1996. Cidvil§sa-muni (1973). ‘“rÊ Cidvil§samuniviracitaÈ “aØkaravijayavil§saÈ’, ed. W. R. Antarkar. Bh§ratÊya Vidy§, 33, pp. 1–92. [See also Antarkar, 1973.] Clarke, John (1998). ‘Hindu Trading Pilgrims’. In Alex McKay, Pilgrimage in Tibet, pp. 52–70. Richmond, UK: Curzon. Clémentin-Ojha [Ojha], Catherine (1981). ‘Female Asceticism in Hinduism: Its Tradition and Present Condition’. Man in India, Vol. 61, no. 3, pp. 254–285. –––––– (1984). ‘Condition féminine et renoncement au monde dans l’Hindouism: Les communautés monastiques de femmes à Benares’. Bulletin de l’École Française d’Extrême-Orient, 73, pp. 199–122. Clémentin-Ojha, Catherine (1985). ‘The Tradition of Female Gurus’. Manushi, 31, Vol. 6, no. 1, November–December, pp. 2–8. –––––– (1988). ‘Outside the Norms: Women Ascetics in Hindu Society’. Economic and Political Weekly, Vol. XXIII, no. 18, April 30, pp. WS-34–WS-36. –––––– (1992). ‘Qu’est-ce qu’être orthodoxe? Le cas des ascètes vishnouïtes du catuÈ-samprad§ya. In Serge Bouez (ed.), Ascèse et renoncement en Inde, ou la solitude bien ordonnée, pp. 71–85. Paris: Éditions L’Harmattan. –––––– (1999). Le Trident sur le Palais: Une cabale anti-vishnuite dans un royaume hindou à l’époque coloniale. Paris: Presses de l’École Française d’Extrême-Orient. Cohn, Bernard S. (1964). ‘The Role of the Gosains in the Economy of Eighteenth and Nineteenth Century Upper India’. Indian Economic and Social History Review, 1, no. 4, pp. 175–182. Colas, Gérard (1992). ‘Le renoncement dans la tradition vishnouite vaikh§nasa’. In Serge Bouez (ed.), Ascèse et renoncement en Inde, ou la solitude bien ordonnée, pp. 41–56. Paris: Éditions L’Harmattan. –––––– (1996). VißÖu, ses images et ses feux: Les métamorphoses du dieu chez les vaikh§nasa. Paris: Presses de l’École Française d’Extrême-Orient. Comans, Michael (trans. and comm.) (1996). Extracting the Essence of the “ruti: The “rutis§rasamuddharaÖam of Toãak§c§rya. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Corpus Inscriptionum Indicarum: Inscriptions of the Kalachuri-Chedi Era (ed. Vasudev Vishnu Mirashi), Vol. IV, part 1. Ootacamund: Government Epigraphist for India, 1955. Cort, John E. (2001). Jains in the World: Religious Values and Ideology in India. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Courtright, Paul B. (2001). GaÖeáa: Lord of Obstacles, Lord of Beginnings. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub.1985). Crooke, W. (1896). The Tribes and Castes of the North-Western Provinces and Oudh, Vols. 1–4. Calcutta: Office of the Superintendent of Government Printing. –––––– (1918). ‘Sanny§sÊ’. In James Hastings (ed.), Encyclopaedia of Religion and Ethics, Vol. X, pp. 192–193. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark. Cunningham, Alexander (1963). The Ancient Geography of India, Vol. 1 (The Buddhist Period, including the Campaigns of Alexander, and the Travels of Hwen-Thsang). Varanasi: Indological Book House (first pub. 1871). Czerniak-Droídíowicz, Marzenna (2002). ‘Aßãadh§vidhi: The Eight-Fold Division of the Daily Religious Obligations according to the ParamasaÒhit§’. In Gerhard Oberhammer and Marion Rastelli (eds), Studies in Hinduism III: P§ñcar§tra and Viáißã§dvaitaved§nta, pp. 33–59. Wien: Der Östereichischen Akademie der Wissenschaften. Dabist§n (or School of Manners) [attributed to Moául F§nÊ], Vols. 1–3, composed
310
bibliography
in 1645, trans. from Persian by David Shea and Anthony Troyer. London: Allen & Co., 1843. Dainik J§graÖ [Hindi newspaper]. ‘Akhan· akh§Ü§ astitva meÖ §y§’. Il§h§b§d, 12 January, 2001, p. 3. Dallapiccola, Anna Libera, and Stephanie Zingel-Avé Lallemant (eds) (1985). Vijayanagara – City and Empire: New Currents of Research. Stuttgart: Steiner Verlag Wiesbaden GMBH. Damrel, David D. (2000). ‘The “NaqshbandÊ Reaction” Reconsidered’. In David Gilmartin and Bruce B. Lawrence (eds), Beyond Turk and Hindu: Rethinking Religious Identities in Islamicate South Asia, pp. 176–198. Gainesville: University Press of Florida. Daá N§m VaÒá VÜkß. (A Hindi text distributed under the authority of Kanvar Giri, Gop§l Giri, Mahant Mah§vÊr Giri, and Sundar Giri.), n.d. Daáan§mÊ Samprad§ya - The Monastic Tradition. www.advaita-vedanta.org/avhp/adtoday.html, 5th May 1999. Das, Bikram (1997). Domain of Lord Jagannath: A Historical Study. Delhi: B. R. Publishing Corporation. Das, Jagadish Chandra, and Jitendra Singh (1991). ‘The Tradition of Kumbh: A Study in Continuity and Change’. In Makhan Jha (ed.), Social Anthropology of Pilgrimage, pp. 237–246. New Delhi: Inter-India Publications. Dasgupta, Shashibusan (1962). Obscure Religious Cults. Calcutta: Firma K. L. Mukhopadhay (first pub. 1946). Dasgupta, Surendranath (1975). A History of Indian Philosophy, Vols. 1–5. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub. Cambridge 1922). Dash, G. N. (1978). ‘The Evolution of the Priestly Power’. In Anncharlott Eschmann, Herman Kulke, and Gaya Charan Tripathi (eds), The Cult of Jagannath and the Regional Tradition of Orissa, pp. 155–168. Delhi: Manohar. Davidson, Ronald M. (2002). Indian Esoteric Buddhism: A Social History of the Tantric Movement. New York: Columbia University Press. Davis, Richard H. (1991) Ritual in an Oscillating Universe: Worshipping “iva in Medieval India. Princeton: Princeton University Press. –––––– (1995). ‘The Origin of LiØga Worship’. In Donald S. Lopez (ed.), Religions of India in Practice, pp. 637–648. Princeton: Princeton University Press. –––––– (2000). ‘Praises of the Drunken Peacocks’. In David Gordon White (ed.),Tantra in Practice, pp. 131–145. Princeton: Princeton University Press. Dazey, Wade Hampton (1987). The Daáan§mÊ Order and Monastic Life. Unpublished Ph.D. thesis, University of California, Santa Barbara. –––––– (1990). ‘Tradition and Modernization in the Organization of the Daáan§mÊ SaÒny§sÊns’. In Austin B. Creel and Vasudha Narayanam (eds), Monastic Life in the Christian and Hindu Traditions: A Comparative Study, pp. 281–321. Lewiston/Queenston/Lampeter: The Edwin Mellen Press. –––––– (1993). ‘The Role of Bhakti in the Daáan§mÊ Order’. In Karel Werner (ed.), Love Divine: Studies in Bhakti and Devotional Mysticism, pp. 147–172. Richmond, UK: Curzon Press. De, Sushil Kumar (1986). Early History of the Vaisnava Faith and Movement in Bengal (from Sanskrit and Bengali Sources). Calcutta: Firma KLM Private Limited. Dehejia, Vidya (1986). YoginÊ Cults and Temples: A Tantric Tradition. New Delhi: National Museum. Denton, L. T. (1991). ‘Varieties of Female Asceticism’. In Julia Leslie (ed.), Roles and Rituals for Hindu Women, pp. 211–230. London: Pinter Publishers. Derrett, J. Duncan M. (1974). ‘Modes of Sanny§sÊs and the Reform of a South
bibliography
311
Indian Maãha carried out in 1584’. Journal of the American Oriental Society, 94.1, pp. 65–72. –––––– (1976). ‘R§jadharma’. Journal of Asian Studies, Vol. XXXV, no. 4, August, pp. 597–610. Desai, P. B. (1957). Jainism in South India (and some Jaina Epigraphs) (Jivar§ja Jaina Grantham§l§, no. 6). Sholapur: Gulabchand Hirachand Doshi. Devahuti, D. (1983). Harsha: A Political Study. Delhi: Oxford University Press. Dey, Nundo Lal (1971). The Geographical Dictionary of Ancient and Mediaeval India. New Delhi: Oriental Books, Reprint Corporation (Munshiram Manoharlal), 3rd. edn. (first pub. 1927). . Dharmamegha AraÖya, Sw§mÊ (1989). Epistles of a S§m khya-yogin. Madhupur, Bihar: Kapil Maãh. Digby, Simon (1976). ‘Sufis and Travellers in the Early Delhi Sultanate: The Evidence of Fawa’id Al-F’wad’. In Attar Singh (ed.), Socio-Cultural Impact of Islam on India, pp. 171–178. Chandigarh: Publication Bureau, Panjab University. –––––– (1986). ‘The Sufi Shaikh as a Source of Authority in Mediaeval India’. In Marc Gaborieau (ed.), Islam et Société en Asie du Sud (Éditions de l’École des Hautes Études en Sciences Sociales, Puruߧrtha 9), pp. 57–78. Paris: Centre d’Études de l’Inde et de l’Asie du Sud. –––––– (2001). Sufis and Soldiers in Awrangzeb’s Deccan: Malfúzát-i Naqshbandiyya (Translated from the Persian and with an Introduction). New Delhi: Oxford University Press. DÊkßhitar, T. R§maliØga (1965). A Study of Chidambaram and its Shrine: as recorded in Sanskrit Literature. Chidambaram: T. R§maliØga DÊkßhitar. Dimock, Edward C. (1963). ‘Doctrine and Practice among the VaißÖavas of Bengal’. Jounal of Asian Studies, Vol. 3, no. 1, Summer, pp. 106–127. Doniger O’Flaherty, Wendy (trans. and ed.) (1981). The Rig Veda: An Anthology. London: Penguin Books. Doniger, Wendy, and Brian. K. Smith (trans. and eds) (1991). The Laws of Manu. London: Penguin Books. Dubey, D. P. (1987). ‘Kumbha Mela: Origin and Historicity of India’s Greatest Pilgrimage Fair’. In R. L. Singh and Rana P. B. Singh (eds),Trends in the Geography of Pigrimages: Homage to David E. Sopher, pp. 117–140. Varanasi: The National Geographical Society of India, Banaras Hindu University. Also printed in The National Geographical Journal of India, Vol. 33, part 4, December 1987, pp. 469–492. –––––– (1988). ‘M§ghmel§ at Pray§ga’. Pur§Öa, 30, January, pp. 60–68. Dubey, Prakash (1992). The Maha Kumbh at Prayag. New Delhi: Spantech Publishers. Dubois, Abbé J. A. (1992). Hindu Manners, Customs and Ceremonies. New Delhi: Rupa & Co. (first pub. 1906). Dumont, Louis (1960). ‘World Renunciation in Indian Religions’. Contributions to Indian Sociology, 4, pp. 33–62. –––––– (1998). Homo Heirarchicus: The Caste System and Its Implications, trans. Mark Sainsbury, Louis Dumont, and Basia Gulati. Delhi: Oxford University Press, 3rd. revised edn. (first pub. 1970). Duncan, Jonathan (1799). ‘Account of Two Fakeers, with their Portraits’, Asiatick Researches, Vol. 5, pp. 37–52. Dundas, Paul (1993). ‘The Marginal Monk and the True TÊrtha’. In Rudy Smet and Kenji Watanabe (eds), Jain Studies in Honour of Jozef Deleu, pp. 237–259. Tokyo: Hon-No-Tomosha. –––––– (2002). The Jains. London/New York: Routledge, 2nd. edn. (first pub. 1992).
312
bibliography
Dutt, K. G. (2001). ‘Sadhu akharas to be apolitical’. The Tribune [Indian daily newspaper], Chandigarh edition, 11th July, p. 3. Dutt, M. N. (2002). Vrata: Sacred Vows and Traditional Fasts. New Delhi: Indigo Books. Dutta, Manmatha Nath (trans.) (1987). Rediscovering India: The Dharma Shastra; Hindu Religious Codes, English Translation and Text (Indian Philosophical Library Series, no. 32), Vols. 1–6. Delhi: Cosmo Publications (first pub. Calcutta: Manmatha Nath Dutta, 1908). Dyczkowski, Mark S. G. (1989). The Canon of the “aiv§gama and the Kubjik§ Tantras of the Western Kaula Tadition. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1988). Eaton, Richard Maxwell (1997). The Sufis of Bijapur, 1300–1700. Michigan: UMI Dissertation Services. (Ph.D. Thesis, University of Wisconsin, 1972.) –––––– (2000). ‘Temple Desecration and Indo-Muslim States’. In David Gilmartin and Bruce B. Lawrence (eds), Beyond Turk and Hindu: Rethinking Religious Identities in Islamicate South Asia, pp. 246–281. Gainesville: University Press of Florida. –––––– (2002). Essays on Islam and Indian History. New Delhi: Oxford University Press (first pub. 2000). Eliade, Mircea (1969). Yoga, Immortality and Freedom. Princeton: Princeton University Press (first pub. 1958). –––––– (1972). Shamanism: Archaic Techniques of Ecstasy. Princeton: Princeton University Press, revised edn. (first pub. as Le Chamanisme et les Techniques archaïques de l’Extase. Paris: Librarie Payot, 1951). Entwistle, A. W. (1982). VaißÖava Tilakas: Sectarian marks worn by worshippers of VißÖu (I.A.V.R.I. Bulletin, nos. 11 and 12, December 1981–June 1982). London: International Asscociation of the Vrindaban Research Institute/School of Oriental and African Studies. Epigraphia Carnatica, Vol. VI (ed. B. Lewis Rice): Inscriptions in the Kadur District. Bangalore: Central Government Press, 1901; Vol. VII (ed. B. Lewis Rice): Inscriptions in the Shimoga District. Bangalore: Mysore Government Central Press, 1902; Vol. X (ed. B. Lewis Rice): Inscriptions in the Kolar District. Mangalore: Basel Mission Press, 1905. Epigraphia Indica (and Records of the Archaeological Survey of India), Vol. III (ed. E. Hultzsch). London: Luzac & Co., 1894–1895; Vol. XIII (ed. Sten Konow and F. W. Thomas). London: Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co., 1915–1916; Vol. XIV (ed. F. W. Thomas). London: Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co., 1917–1918. Ernst, Carl W. and Bruce B. Lawrence (2002). Sufi Martyrs of Love: The Chishti Order in South Asia and Beyond. New York/Basingstoke: Palgrave Macmillan. Farquhar, J. N. (1925a). An Outline of the Religious Literature of India. Oxford: Oxford University Press. –––––– (1925b). ‘The Organisation of the Sannyasis of the Vedanta’. Journal of the Royal Asiatic Society of Great Britain and Ireland, pp. 479–486. –––––– (1925c).‘The Fighting Ascetics of India’. Reprinted for private circulation (first pub. in Bulletin of the John Rylands Library, Vol. 9, no. 2, July 1925, pp. 431–452). Feldhaus, Anne, and Shankar Gopal Tulpule (1992). In the Absence of God: The Early Years of an Indian Sect. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. Filliozat, J. (1991). Religion, Philosophy and Yoga. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Filliozat, Vasundhara (1973). L’Épigraphie de Vijayanagar, du Début à 1377. Paris: École Française d’Extrême-Orient.
bibliography
313
–––––– (1985). ‘Iconography: Religious and Civil Monuments’. In Anna Libera Dallapiccola and Stephanie Zingel-Avé Lallemant (eds), Vijayanagara - City and Empire: New Currents of Research, pp. 308–316. Stuttgart: Steiner Verlag Wiesbaden GMBH. Findly, Ellison Banks (2002). ‘Housemistress at the Door: Vedic and Buddhist Perspectives on the Mendicant Encounter’. In Laurie L. Patton (ed.), Jewels of Authority: Women and Textual Tradition in Hindu India, pp. 13–31. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Frank, Walter A. (1974). ‘Attempt at an Ethno-Demography of Middle Nepal’. In Christoph von Fürer-Haimendorf (ed.), Contributions to the Anthroplogy of Nepal (Proceedings of a Symposium held at the School of Oriental and African Studies, University of London, June/July 1973), pp. 85–97. Warminster: Aris & Phillips Ltd. Fuller, C. J. (1992). The Camphor Flame: Popular Hinduism and Society in India. Princeton: Princeton University Press. Gaborieau, Marc (1989). ‘Pouvoir et Autorité des Soufis dans l’Himalaya’. Puruߧrtha 12, pp. 215–238. (Prêtrise, Pouvoirs et Autorité en Himalaya, études réunies par V. Bouillier et G. Toffin. Paris: Éditions de l’École des Hautes Études en Sciences Sociales.) Gadgil, J. S. (1895). ‘The Date of Shankar§ch§rya’. The Theosophist, Vol. XVI, no. 4 (Supplement), January, pp. 292–296. Gautama Dharma Såtram (Maskari Bhaßya Sahitam) (ed. Veda Mitra). New Delhi: Veda Mitra & Sons, 1969. Ghokale, V. V. (1958). ‘The Ved§nta-Philosophy Described by Bhavya in his MadhyamakahÜdaya’. Indo-Iranian Journal, Vol. 2, pp. 165–180. –––––– (1961–1962). ‘“Masters of Buddhism Adore the Brahman through NonAdoration” (Bhavya, MadhyamahÜdaya, III)’. Indo-Iranian Journal, Vol. 5, pp. 271–275. –––––– (1972). ‘The Second Chapter of Bhavya’s MadhyamakahÜdaya (Taking the Vow of an Ascetic)’. Indo-Iranian Journal, Vol. 14, pp. 40–45. Ghosh, J. M. (1923). Sanny§sis in Mymensingh. Dacca: Pran Ballav Chakrabarty. –––––– (1930). Sanny§si and Fakir Raiders in Bengal. Calcutta: Bengal Secretariat Book Depot. Ghurye, G. S. (1964). Indian Sadhus. Bombay: Popular Prakashan Pvt. Ltd., 2nd edn. (first pub. 1953). Glasenapp, Helmuth von (1992). Madhva’s Philosophy of the VißÖu Faith, trans. Shridhar B. Shrothri, ed. K. T. Pandurangi. Bangalore: Dvaita Vedanta Studies and Research Foundation. Glucklich, Ariel (1988). ‘The Royal Sceptre (daÖ·a) as Legal Punishment and Sacred Symbol’. History of Religions, Vol. 28, no. 2, November, pp. 97–122. Gnanambal, K. (1971). ‘Srivaishnavas and their Religious Institutions’. Bulletin of the Anthropological Survey of India, Vol. XX, nos. 3 & 4, pp. 97–187. –––––– (1973). Religious Institutions and Caste Panchayats in South India. Calcutta: Anthropological Survey of India. Gold, Daniel (1996). ‘The Instability of the King: Magical Insanity and the Yogis’ Power in the Politics of Jodhpur, 1803–1843’. In David N. Lorenzen (ed.), Bhakti Religion in North India: Community Identity and Political Action, pp. 120–132. Delhi: Manohar (first pub. Albany: State University Press of New York, 1995). –––––– (1999). ‘Nath Yogis as Established Alternatives: Householders and Ascetics Today’. Journal of African and Asian Studies, Vol. XXXIV, 1, February, pp. 69–85. –––––– and Ann Grodzins Gold (1984). ‘The Fate of the Nath Householder’. History of Religions, 24.2, pp. 113–132.
314
bibliography
Goldman, Robert P. (1977). Gods, Priests and Warriors: The BhÜgus of the Mah§bh§rata. New York: Columbia University Press. Gonda, Jan (1970). VißÖuism and “aivism: A Comparison. London: The Althone Press, University of London. –––––– (ed.) (1975). History of Indian Literature, Vol. 1: SaÒhit§s and Br§hmaÖas. Wiesbaden: Otto Harrasowitz. Gopalacharlu, S. T. (1893). ‘The Date of Shankar§ch§rya’. The Theosophist, Vol. XIV, no. 4, January, pp. 253–256. Gordon, Stewart N. (1969). ‘Scarf and Sword: Thugs, Marauders, and State Formation in 18th Century Malwa’. The Indian Economic and Social History Review, Vol. VI, no. 4, December, pp. 403–429. –––––– (1971). ‘Comment’ [on Kolff 1971]. Indian Economic and Social History Review, 8, pp. 209–210. –––––– (1999). ‘Hindus, Muslims and the Other in eighteenth-century India’. International Journal of Hindu Studies, Vol. 3, no. 3, December, pp. 221–240. Goudriaan, Teun, Sanjukta Gupta, and Dirk Jan Hoens (1979). Hindu Tantrism. Leiden/Köln: E. J. Brill. –––––– and Sanjukta Gupta (1981). Hindu Tantric and “§kta Literature. Wiesbaden: Otto Harrassowitz. Govinda, Lama Anagarika (1960). The Foundations of Tibetan Mysticism. London: Rider & Co. Govinda-D§sa (1894). ‘The Date of Shankar§ch§rya’. The Theosophist, Vol. XVI, no. 3, December, pp. 163–168. Goyal, S. R. (1986). A Religious History of Ancient India (up to c.1,200 A.D.), Vols. 1–2. Meerut: Kusumanjali Prakashan. Granoff, Phyllis (1984). ‘Holy Warriors: a Preliminary Study of some Biographies of Saints and Kings in the Classical Indian Tradition’. Journal of Indian Philosophy, Vol. 12, pp. 291–303. –––––– (1988a). ‘Jain Biographies of Nagarjuna: Notes on the Composing of a Biography in Medieval India’. In Phyllis Granoff and Koichi Shinohara (eds), Monks and Magicians: Religious Biographies in Asia, pp. 45–66. Oakville, Ontario: Mosaic Press. –––––– (1988b). ‘The Biographies of Arya Khapatacarya: A Preliminary Investigation into the Transmission and Adaptation of Biographical Legends’. In Phyllis Granoff and Koichi Shinohara (eds), Monks and Magicians: Religious Biographies in Asia, pp. 67–98. Oakville, Ontario: Mosaic Press. –––––– (1992). ‘Tolerance in the Tantras: Its Form and Function’. The Journal of Oriental Research, Madras (S. S. Janaki Felicitation Volume), Vols. LVI–LXII (1986–1992), pp. 283–302. –––––– (2000). ‘Other People’s Rituals: Ritual Eclecticism in Early Medieval Indian Religions’. Journal of Indian Philosophy, Vol. 28, no. 4, pp. 399–424. Grierson, George A. (1918). ‘RåkhaÜs, SåkhaÜs, —khaÜs’. In James Hastings (ed.), Encyclopaedia of Religion and Ethics, Vol. X, pp. 866–867. Edinburgh: T. & T. Clark. Griffith, Ralph H. T. (trans. and comm.) (1973). The Hymns of the Œg Veda. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub. Benares: E. J. Lazarus and Co., 1889). –––––– (trans. and comm.) (1927). The Texts of the White Yajur Veda. Benares: E. J. Lazarus and Co. –––––– (trans. and comm.) (1985). Hymns of the Atharvaveda, Vols. 1–2. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal (first pub. 1895–1896). –––––– (trans. and comm.) (1986). Hymns of the S§maveda. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal (first pub. 1895–1896).
bibliography
315
Grimes, John (1992). The Naißkarmyasiddhi of Sureávara: A Monograph. Delhi: Sri Satguru Publications. Gross, Robert Lewis (1992). The Sadhus of India: A Study of Hindu Asceticism. Jaipur: Rawat Publications. Gupta, Roxanne Poorman (1996). ‘The KÊn§ R§mÊ: Aughars and King in the Age of Cultural Contact’. In David N. Lorenzen (ed.), Bhakti Religion in North India: Community Identity and Political Action, pp. 133–142. Delhi: Manohar (first pub. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1995). –––––– (2001). ‘Aughar, Aghori, Aghoreshwara: Avadhut Bhagwan Ram and the Politics of Heterodoxy’. Proceedings of the Royal Asiatic Society for the Conference on Asceticism and Power in the Asian Context, SOAS, University of London, 2001 (private circulation). Gupta, Sanjukta (1991). ‘Women in the “aiva/“§kta Ethos’. In Julia Leslie (ed.), Roles and Rituals for Hindu Women, pp. 193–209. London: Pinter Publishers. Gurumurthy, S. (1979). Education in South India (Ancient and Medieval Periods). Madras: New Era Publications. Güven, Rasih (1991). The Absolutism of Sankaracarya as Compared with Mawlana Jalaluddin Rumi’s School of Thought. Ankara, Turkey: Rasih Güven. Hacker, Paul (ed. Wilhelm Halbfass) (1995). Philology and Confrontation: Paul Hacker on Traditional and Modern Vedanta. Albany: State University of New York Press. (The articles in this collection were first published—some in German—between 1948 and 1972.) Halbfass, Wilhelm (1983). Studies in Kum§rila and “aØkara (Studien zur Indologie und Iranistik, Monographie 9). Reinbek: Inge Wezler/Verlag für Orientastische Fachpublikationen. –––––– (1988). India and Europe: An Essay in Understanding. Albany: State University of New York Press (first pub. in German. Basel: Schwabe & Co., 1981). –––––– (1991). Tradition and Reflection: Explorations in Indian Thought. Albany: State University of New York Press. Haq, Md. Enamul (1935). ‘The ‘åfÊ Movement in India: ‘åfÊ Period of Reformation—1550 A. D. downward’. Indian Culture, Vol. II, nos. 1–4 (1935–1936), pp. 17–22. –––––– (1936). ‘The ‘åfÊ Movement in India: ‘åfÊ Orders’. Indian Culture, Vol. II, nos. 1–4 (1935–1936), pp. 435–446. Hara, Minoru (1994). ‘P§áupata Studies II’. Wiener Zeitschrift für die Kunde Südasiens und Archiv für Indische Philosophie, Band XXXVIII, pp. 322–335. –––––– (1999). ‘P§áupata and Yoga: P§áupata-Såtra 2.12 and Yoga-Såtra 3.37’. Asiatische Studien/Études Asiatiques, LIII, no. 3, pp. 593–608. Hardwicke, Captain Thomas (1801). ‘Narrative of a Journey to Srinagur’. Asiatick Researches, Vol. 6, pp. 309–347. Haridv§r Giri (Terah MaÜhi), Mahant (n.d.). Stotra - Pußp§ñjalÊ. Ghaziabad, U. P.: Narmadeávara Mah§dev Mandir (Narsipur, F§ãak, Ghaziabad, U. P.). Hartsuiker, Dolf (1993). S§dhus: Holy Men of India. London: Thames and Hudson, 2nd. edn. Hasrat, Bikrama Jit (ed. and intro.) (1970). History of Nepal (As Told by Its Own and Contemporary Chroniclers). Hoshiapur, Punjab: V. V. Research Institute. Haug, Martin (trans. and comm.) (1922). Aitareya Br§hmaÖa. Allahabad: Sudhindra Nath Vasu Publishers (first pub. 1863). Hazra, R. C. (1940). Studies in the Pur§Öic Records on Hindu Rites and Customs. Calcutta: University of Dacca. –––––– (1958). Studies in the Upapur§Öas, Vol. 1 (Saura and VaißÖava Upapur§Öas) (Calcutta Sanskrit College Research Series, no. II). Calcutta: Sanskrit College.
316
bibliography
–––––– (1963). Studies in the Upapur§Öas, Vol. 2 (“§kta and Non-sectarian Upapur§Öas) (Calcutta Sanskrit College Research Series, no. XXII). Calcutta: Sanskrit College. Heesterman, J. C. (1957). The Ancient Indian Royal Consecration: The R§jasåya Described According to The Yajus Texts and Annotated. ‘S-Gravenhage: Mouton & Co. –––––– (1963). ‘Vr§tya and Sacrifice’. Indo-Iranian Journal, 6 (1962–1963), pp. 1–37. –––––– (1964). ‘Brahmin, Ritual and Renouncer’. Wiener Zeitschrift für die Kunde Südasiens, 8, pp. 1–31. –––––– (1981). ‘Householder and Wanderer’. Contributions to Indian Sociology (n.s.), Vol. 15, nos. 1 & 2, pp. 251–271. –––––– (1985). The Inner Conflict of Tradition: Essays in Indian Ritual, Kingship and Society. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Heffernan, Thomas J. (1988). Sacred Biography: Saints and Their Biographers in the Middle Ages. New York: Oxford University Press. Hino, Shoun, and K. P. Jog (trans. and ed.) (1988). Sureávara’s V§rttika on Madhu Br§hmaÖa. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. –––––– (trans. and ed.) (1998). Sureávara’s V§rtika on Khila K§Ö·a with Half-Verse Index. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Hiriyanna, M. (1923). ‘Suresvara and Mandana-Misra’. Journal of the Bombay Royal Asiatic Society, April, pp. 259–263. –––––– (1924). ‘Suresvara and Mandana-Misra’. Journal of the Bombay Royal Asiatic Society, January, pp. 96–97. –––––– (trans., ed. and intro.) (1929). Ved§nta-S§ra: A Work of Ved§nta Philosophy by Sad§nanda. Poona: Oriental Book Agency. Hirst, Jacqueline G. (1993). ‘The Place of Bhakti in “aØkara’s Ved§nta’. In Karel Werner (ed.), Love Divine: Studies in Bhakti and Devotional Mysticism, pp. 117–146. Richmond, UK: Curzon Press. –––––– (2005). “aØkara’s Advaita Ved§nta: A Way of Teaching. London/New York: RoutledgeCurzon. Hobsbawm, Eric, and Terence Ranger (eds) (1983). The Invention of Tradition. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Holck, H. Frederick (1969). ‘Some Observations on the Motives and Purposes of Asceticism in Ancient India’. Asiatische Studien/Études Asiatiques, Vol. XXIII, 1–2, pp. 45–57. Hopkins, Steven Paul (2002). Singing the Body of God: The Hymns of Ved§ntadeáika in their South Indian Tradition. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Hopkins, Thomas J. (1971). The Hindu Religious Tradition. Belmont, California: Wadsworth. Horstmann, Monika. [See Thiel-Horstmann.] Hume, Robert E. (trans.) (1995). The Thirteen Principal Upanishads. Oxford: Oxford University Press (first pub. 1877). Hunt, J. H. (1934). Indian “Fakirs”. London: Adlard & Son Ltd. Hunter, W. W. (1885). The Imperial Gazeteer of India, Vol. V. London: Trübner & Co., 2nd. edn. Hüsken, Ute (2000). ‘The Legend of the Establishment of the Buddhist Order of Nuns in the Therav§da Vinaya-Pitaka’. Journal of the Pali Text Society, Vol. XXVI, pp. 43–69. Iltis, Linda L. (1996). ‘Women, Pilgrimage, Power, and the Concept of Place in the swast§nÊ vrata’. In Sigfried Lienhard (ed.), Change and Continuity: Studies in the Nepalese Culture of the Kathmandu Valley, pp. 304–320. Torino: Edizioni dell’ Orso.
bibliography
317
Inden, Ronald (1990). Imagining India. Oxford: Basil Blackwell. Inden, Ronald, Jonathan Walters, and Daud Ali (2000). Querying the Mediaeval: Texts and the History of Practices in South Asia. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Ingalls, Daniel H. H. (1952). ‘The Study of “aØkar§c§rya’. Annals of the Bhandarkar Oriental Research Institute, Vol. XXXIII, parts I–IV, pp. 1–14. –––––– (1962). ‘Cynics and P§áupatas: The Seeking of Dishonour’. Harvard Theological Review, Vol. LV, no. 4, pp. 281–298. Isayeva, Natalia (1993). Shankara and Indian Philosophy. Delhi: Sri Satguru Publications. Islam, Riazul (2002). Sufism in South Asia: Impact on Fourteenth Century Muslim Society. Karachi: Oxford University Press. Jaffrelot, Christoffe (1996). The Hindu Nationalist Movement and Indian Politics, 1925 to the 1990s: Strategies of Identity-Building, Implantation and Mobilisation (with special reference to Central India). London: Hurst & Company (first pub. as Les Nationalistes Hindous. Paris, 1993). Jaini, Padmanabh S. (1991). Gender and Salvation: Jaina Debates on the Spiritual Liberation of Women. Oxford: University of California Press. Jha, Makhan (1978). Aspects of a Great Traditional City in Nepal: An Anthropological Appraisal. Varanasi: Kishor Vidya Niketan. Johnson, W. J. (1995). Harmless Souls: Karmic Bondage and Religious Change in Early Jainism with special reference to Umasvati and Kundakunda. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Jolly, Julius (trans.) (1991). The Institutes of Vishnu: VißÖu-smÜti (The Sacred Books of the East, Vol. VII, ed. F. Max Müller). Delhi: Bharatiya Vidya Prakashan (reprint). Joshi, M. C. (1983). ‘Islam in the Hindu Tantras’. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bombay (n.s.), Vols. 54–55 (1979–1980 combined), pp. 51–56. Kaelber, Walter O. (1987). ‘The Brahmac§rin: Homology and Continuity in the Br§hmaÖic Religion’. History of Religions, Vol. 21, no. 1, August, pp. 77–99. –––––– (1989). Tapta M§rga: Asceticism and Initiation in Vedic India. Albany: State University of New York. Kaly§Ö (TÊrth§Øk)—(IktÊsveÖ varß ka viáeߧØk) (1997). Gorakhpur: GÊt§ Press (first pub. 1995). Kamath, M. Shanthichandra (1986). ‘The Gotras’. In K. Visvanath Kamath (ed.), Sri Sadguru Pooja: Swami Srimad Bhuvanendra Thirtha Punyatithi Centenary Commemoration Volume—1986, pp. 82–86. Basrur, Banaras: Srimad Bhuvanendra Tirtha Swami Punyatithi Shatamanotsava Samithi Sri Kashi Mutt. Kane, P. V. (1977–1990). History of Dharmaá§stra, Vols. 1–5. Poona: Bhandarkar Oriental Research Institute, 2nd. edn. (first pub. 1930–1962). –––––– (1935). ‘Gotra and Pravara in Vedic Literature’. Journal of the Bombay Branch of the Royal Asiatic Society, Vol. II, nos. 1 & 2, pp. 1–17. Kapoor, O. B. L. (1994). The Philosophy and Religion of “rÊ Caitanya (The Philosophical Background of the Hare Krishna Movement). New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal (first pub. 1976). Kapår, BadrÊn§th (1999). Prabh§t Advanced English-Hindi Dictionary (With English-Hindi Dictionary of Synonyms). New Delhi: Prabh§t Prak§áan. Karmarkar, R. D. (trans. and ed.) (1959–1964). “rÊbh§ßya of R§m§nuja, Vols. 1–3 (University of Poona Sanskrit and Prakrit Series, Vol. 1). Poona: Shri W. H. Golay, University of Poona, 1959 (Vol. 1), 1962 (Vol. 2), 1964 (Vol. 3). Katju, Kailash Nath (1961). The Days I Remember. Calcutta: New Age Publishers. Keemattam, Augusthy (1997). The Hermits of Rishikesh: A Sociological Study. New Delhi: Intercultural Publications.
318
bibliography
Khandelwal, Meena (2004). Women in Ochre Robes: Gendering Hindu Renunciation. Albany: State University of New York Press. Killingley, Dermot (1991). ‘Varna and Caste in Hindu Apologetic’. In Dermot Killingley, Werner Menski, and Shirley Firth (eds), Hindu Ritual and Society, pp. 7–31. Newcastle-upon-Tyne: S. Y. Killingley. King, Richard (1997). Early Advaita Ved§nta and Buddhism: The M§hay§na Context of the Gau·ap§dÊya-K§rik§. Sri Satguru Publications: Delhi (first pub. 1995). King, Ursula (1984). ‘The Effect of Social Change on Religious Understanding: Women Ascetics in Modern Hinduism’. In Kenneth Ballhatchet and David Taylor (eds), Changing South Asia: Religion and Society, pp. 69–84. Hong Kong: Centre of South Asian Studies, SOAS, University of London. Klostermaier, Klaus K (1994). A Survey of Hinduism. Albany: State University of New York Press. Knipe, David M. (1975). In the Image of Fire: Vedic Experiences of Heat. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Kolenda, Pauline (1976). ‘Seven Kinds of Hierarchy in Homo Hierarchicus’. Journal of Asian Studies, Vol. XXXV, no. 4, August, pp. 581–596. Kolff, Dirk. H. A. (1971). ‘Sannyasi Trader-Soldiers’. Indian Economic and Social History Review, 8, pp. 213–218. –––––– (1990). Naukar, Rajput and Sepoy: The ethnohistory of the military labour market in Hindustan, 1450–1850 (University of Cambridge Oriental Publications, no. 43). Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Koppedrayer, K. I. (1991). ‘Are “ådras Entitled to Ride in the Palanquin’. Contributions to Indian Sociology, Vol. 25, no. 2, July–December, pp. 191–210. Kramrisch, Stella (1924). The VishÖudharmottaram (Part III): A Treatise on Indian Painting. Calcutta: Calcutta University Press. Krasa, Miloslav (1965). ‘Kumbha Mel§: the greatest pilgrimage in the world’. New Orient, Vol. 4, no. 6, December, pp. 180–184. Krishnan, Murali (2002). ‘It’s Four Sides to a Triangle: the Shankaracharyas of the main peeths are bitterly opposed to the VHP’s temple movement’. Outlook, New Delhi, 1st April, pp. 28–30. Krishnaswami, A. (1964). The Tamil Country under Vijayanagar. Annamalainagar: The Annamalai University. Kulkarni, S. D. (1987). Adi Sankara: The Saviour of Mankind (Bhishma’s Study of Indian History and Culture, Vol. 11). Bombay: Shri Bhagavan Vedavyasa Itihasa Samshodana Mandir (Bhishma). Kulke, Hermann (1978a). ‘Royal Temple Policy and the Structure of Medieval Hindu Kingdoms’. In Anncharlott Eschmann, Hermann Kulke, and Gaya Charan Tripathi (eds), The Cult of Jagannath and the Regional Tradition of Orissa, pp. 125–137. Delhi: Manohar. –––––– (1978b).The Devar§ja Cult. Trans. from German by I. W. Mabbett, intro. and notes by J. M. Jacob. Ithaca, New York: Dept. of Asian Studies, Cornell University. –––––– (1985). ‘Mah§r§jas, Mahants and Historians: Reflections on the Historiography of Early Vijayanagara and Sringeri’. In Anna Libera Dallapiccola and Stephanie Zingel-Avé Lallemant (eds),Vijayanagara - City and Empire: New Currents of Research, pp. 120–143. Stuttgart: Steiner Verlag Wiesbaden GMBH. –––––– (2001). Kings and Cults: State Formation and Legitimation in India and Southeast Asia. New Delhi: Manohar (first pub. 1993). Kum§rila (1993). “lokav§rttika of “rÊ Kum§rila Bhaããa, with the Commentary Ny§yaratn§kara of “rÊ P§rthas§rathi Miára (Ratnabh§ratÊ Series, 4), ed. Ganga Sagar Rai. Varanasi: Ratna Publications.
bibliography
319
‘Kumbh’- parv (viáeߧÖk). Ed. R§m§datt “ukl and ŒitáÊl “arma. Pray§g: Par§v§ÖÊ $dhy§tmik “audh-Sansth§n, 2001. Kunhan Raja, C. (ed.) (1933). Un-Published Upanishads (Aprak§áit§ UpanisadaÈ). Madras: Adyar Library (Theosophical Society). Kunjunni Raja, K. (1960). ‘On the Date of “aØkar§c§rya and Allied Problems’. Adyar Library Bulletin, Vol. XXIV, Parts 3–4, December, pp. 125–148. –––––– (1991). ‘On the Dates of “aÒkara and MaÖ·ana’. Adyar Library Bulletin, Vol. 55, pp. 104–116. –––––– (1995). ‘A Note on “aÒkara’s Date’. Adyar Library Bulletin (C. Kunhan Raja Birth Centenary Volume), Vol. 59, p. 177. Kuppuswami, A. (1972). “rÊ Bhagavatp§da “aØkar§c§rya (Chowkhamba Sanskrit Studies, Vol. LXXXIX). Varanasi: Chowkhamba Sanskrit Series Office. –––––– (1991). “rÊ “aØkara Bhagavatpad§c§rya. Madras: S. Radhakrishnan. –––––– (2001). Sri Adi Sankaracharya’s Date Of Birth (A Research Study). K§ñcÊpuram: Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Peetham. Kuppuswami, A., and R. Seshadri (2001a). Adi Sankara. Chennai: M/s. Maniappan Agency. –––––– (2001b). Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Peetha. Chennai: M/s. Maniappan Agency. Kuppuswami Sastri, S. (trans. and intro.) (1937). Brahmasiddhi by $c§rya MaÖ·anamiára with Commentary by “ankhap§Öi (Madras Government Oriental Manuscripts Series, no. 4). Madras: Government Press. –––––– (1981). Mm. Professor Kuppuswami Sastri Birth-Centenary Commemoration Volume, Part 1: Collection of Sastri’s Writings and a Kavya on him, ed. S. S. Janaki. Madras: The Kuppuswami Sastri Research Institute. Kårma Pur§Öa, Vols. 1–2, trans. Ganesh Vasudeo Tagare (Ancient Indian Tradition and Mythology, Vols. 20–21). Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, 1982. Laine, James W. (1999). ‘The dharma of Islam and the dÊn of Hinduism: Hindus and Muslims in the age of “iv§jÊ’. International Journal of Hindu Studies, Vol. 3, no. 3, December, pp. 299–318. Lamb, Ramdas (1999). ‘The Magh Mela: Prayag’s “Other” Holy Festival’. Journal of VaißÖava Studies, Vol. 7, no. 2, Spring, pp. 195–205. –––––– (2002). Rapt in the Name: The Ramnamis, Ramnam, and Untouchable Religion in Central India. Albany: State University of New York Press. Lapidus, Ira M. (1988). A History of Islamic Societies. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Lariviere, Richard W. (1993). ‘Parallel Realms of Law’. In Robert D. Baird (ed.), Religion and Law in Independent India, pp. 351–360. New Delhi: Manohar. Leggett, Trevor (1992). “aØkara on the Yoga Såtras: A Full Translation of the Newly Discovered Text. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Leslie, I. Julia (1989). The Perfect Wife: The Orthodox Woman According to the StrÊdharmapaddhati of Tryambakayajvan. Delhi: Oxford University Press. Lester, Robert C. (1992). ‘The Practice of Renunciation in “rÊvaißÖavism’. Journal of Oriental Research, Madras, Vols. LVI–LXII (1986–1992) (Dr. S. S. Janaki Felicitation Volume), pp. 77–95. The Light of the East (A Hindu monthly review), ed. S. C. Mukhopadhyaya (1894). ‘The Life of Sri Sankaracharya’ [author, A. H. B.], Vol. II, no. 11, July, pp. 328–331. Lindtner, Christian (1985). ‘Remarks on the Gau·§pÊya-K§rik§s (GK)’. Indo-Iranian Journal, Vol. 28, no. 4, October, pp. 275–297. –––––– (1992). ‘On the Date of DharmakÊrti etc.’. Adyar Library Bulletin, Vol. 56, pp. 57–62. –––––– (1994). ‘Linking up BhartÜhari and the Bauddhas’. In Saoja Bhate and
320
bibliography
Johannes Bronkhorst (eds), BhartÜhari, Philosopher and Grammarian: Proceedings of the First International Conference on BhartÜhari, pp. 195–213. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Lipner, Julius (1986). The Face of Truth: A Study of Meaning and Metaphysics in the Ved§ntic Theology of R§m§nuja. Albany: State University of New York Press. –––––– (1994). Hindus: Their Religious Beliefs and Practices. London: Routledge. Lipski, Alexander (1977). The Life and Teachings of $nandamayÊ M§. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Llewellyn, J. E. (1995). ‘The Autobiography of a Female Renouncer’. In Donald S. Lopez (ed.), Religions of India in Practice, pp. 462–472. Princeton: Princeton University Press. Lochtefeld, James G. (1994). ‘The Vishva Hindu Parishad and the Roots of Hindu Militancy’. Journal of the American Academy of Religion, Vol. LXII, no. 2, Summer, pp. 587–602. Long, J. Bruce (1976). ‘Life out of Death: A Structural Analysis of the Myth of the ‘Churning of the Ocean of Milk’’. In Bardwell L. Smith (ed.), Hinduism: New Essays in the History of Religions, pp. 171–207. Leiden: E. J. Brill. –––––– (1982). ‘Mah§áivar§tri: The “aiva Festival of Repentance’. In Guy R. Welbon and Glenn E. Yocum (eds), Religious Festivals in South India and Sri Lanka, pp. 189–217. New Delhi: Manohar. Lorenzen, David N. (1978). ‘Warrior Ascetics in Indian History’. Journal of the American Oriental Society, 98.1, pp. 61–75. –––––– (1983). ‘The Life of “aØkar§c§rya’. In Fred W. Clothey and J. Bruce Long (eds), Experiencing “iva: Encounters with a Hindu Deity, pp. 155–175. New Delhi: Manohar. –––––– (1989). ‘New Data on the K§p§likas’. In Alf Hiltebeitel (ed.), Criminal Gods and Demon Devotees: Essays on the Guardians of Popular Hinduism, pp. 231–238. Albany: State University of New York Press. –––––– (1991). The K§p§likas and K§l§mukhas: Two Lost “aivite Sects. New Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, 2nd. edn. (first edn.1972). –––––– (1992). Kabir Legends and Ananta-Das’s Kabir Parachai. Delhi: Sri Satguru Publications (first pub. Albany: State Uninversity of New York Press, 1991). Low, Sidney (1906). A Vision of India (as seen during the tour of the Prince and Princess of Wales). London: Smith, Elder & Co. Lubin, Timothy (2001). ‘The Householder Ascetic and the Uses of Self-Discipline’. Proceedings of the Royal Asiatic Society for the Conference on Power and Asceticism in the Asian Context, SOAS, University of London, 2001 (private circulation). Lütt, Jürgen (1978). ‘The “aØkar§c§rya of Puri’. In Anncharlott Eschmann, Hermann Kulke, and Gaya Charan Tripathi (eds), The Cult of Jagannath and the Regional Tradition of Orissa, pp. 411–419. Delhi: Manohar. Macdonell, A. A. (1974). Vedic Mythology. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub. Straßburg, 1898). Maclean, Kama (2001). ‘Conflicting Spaces: The Kumbh Mela and the Fort of Allahabad’. South Asia, Vol. XXIV, no. 2, pp. 135—159. –––––– (2003). ‘Making the Colonial State Work for You, or, the Beginnings of the Ancient Kumbh Mela in Allahabad’. Journal of Asian Studies, Vol. 62, no. 3, August, pp. 873–905. Madan, T. N. (1987). Non-Renunciation: Themes and Interpretations of Hindu Culture. Oxford: Oxford University Press. M§dhava $ch§rya (1882).The Sarva-Daráana-SaÒgraha: Review of the Different Systems
bibliography
321
of Indian Philosophy, trans. E. B. Cowell and A. E. Gough. London: Trübner & Co. M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya (1986). “aØkara-dig-vijaya: The Traditional Life of Sri Sankaracharya, trans. Swami Tapasyananda. Madras: Sri Ramakrishna Math. M§dhav§ch§rya-Vidy§raÖya (1990). VivaraÖaprameyasaÒgraha, ed. R§maá§strÊ TailaØga. Varanasi: Kishore Vidya Nikatan. Mah§bh§rata (for the first time critically edited by a team of scholars). Poona: Bhandarkar Oriental Research Institute, 1933–1966. Mahadevan, T. M. P. (ed.) (1968). Preceptors of Advaita. Secunderabad: Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Sankara Mandir. Mahalingam, T. V. (1940). Administration and Social Life under Vijayanagar (Madras University Historical Series, no. 15). Madras: University of Madras. –––––– (1962). ‘The Golaki Matha’. In C. T. K. Chari (chief ed.), Essays in Philosophy (presented to T. M. P. Mahadevan), pp. 446–451. Madras: Ganesh & Co. (Madras) Private Ltd. –––––– (1969). K§ñcÊpuram in Early South Indian History. London: Asia Publishing House. Majumdar, A. K. (ed.) (1951–1977). The History and Culture of the Indian People, Vols. 1–11. Bombay: Bharatiya Vidya Bhavan,. Malamoud, Charles (1998). Cooking the World: Ritual & Thought in Ancient India, trans. David White. Calcutta/Chennai/Mumbai: Oxford University Press (first pub. as Rite et Pensée dans l’Inde ancienne. Éditions La Découverte: Paris, 1989). Malinar, Angelika (2001). ‘“aØkara as Jagadguru According to “aØkara-Digvijaya’. In Vasudha Dalmia, Angelika Malinar, and Martin Christof (eds), Charisma and Canon, pp. 93–112. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Mallappa, T. N. (1974). Kriyasakti Vidyaranya. Bangalore: Bangalore University. Mani, Vettam (1975). Pur§Öic Encyclopaedia: A Comprehensive Dictionary with Special Reference to the Epic and Pur§Öic Literature. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Manjupuria, Trilok Chandra (1981). Pashupatin§th. Gwalior: M. Devi. Mansukhani, Gobind Singh (1988). Hymns From Bhai Gurdas’s Compositions. Southall: The Sikh Missionary Society, UK. Manucci (Venetian), Niccolai (1990). Mogul India 1658–1708, or Storia do Mogor, Vols. 1–4, trans., intro. and notes by Willian Irving. Delhi: Low Price Publications [four vols. bound in two] (first pub. 1907–1908). ManusmÜti (With the Sanskrit Commentary Manvartha-Mukt§valÊ of Kullåka Bhaããa), ed. J. L. Shastri. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, 1983. Mason, Paul (1994). The Maharishi: The Biography of the Man who gave Transcendental Meditation to the West. Shaftesbury, Dorset: Element. Masson, J. Moussaieff (1976). ‘The Psychology of the Ascetic’. Journal of Asian Studies, Vol. XXXV, no. 4, August, pp. 611–625. Mayeda, Sengaku (1965a). ‘The Authenticity of the BhagavadgÊt§bh§ßya Ascribed to “aØkara’. Wiener Zeitschrift für die Kunde Süd- und Ostasiens, Vol. 9, pp. 155– 197. –––––– (1965b). ‘The Authenticity of the Upadeáas§hasrÊ Ascribed to “aØkara’. Journal of the American Oriental Society, Vol. 85, pp. 178–196. –––––– (1967–1968a). ‘On “aØkara’s Authorship of the Kenopanißadbh§ßya’. IndoIranian Journal, Vol. 10, pp. 33–55. –––––– (1967–1968b). ‘On the Authorship of the M§Ö·åkyopanißad and the Gau·ap§dÊyabh§ßya’. Adyar Library Bulletin, Vols. 31–32, pp. 73–94. –––––– (1992). A Thousand Teachings: The Upadeáas§hasrÊ of “aØkara. Albany: State University Of New York Press (first pub. University of Tokyo Press, 1979). –––––– (2000). ‘“aØkara and Buddhism’. In Bradley J. Malkovsky (ed.), New Perspec-
322
bibliography
tives on Advaita Ved§nta: Essays in Commemoration of Professor Richard de Smet, S. J. Leiden/Boston/Köln: Brill. Mayer, Adrian C. (1960). Caste and Kinship in Central India: A Village and its Region. London: Routledge & Kegan Paul. McCrindle, John W. (1877). Ancient India as Described by Megasthen¿s and Arrian: being a translation of the fragments of the Indika of Megasthen¿s collected by Dr. Schwanbeck, and the first part of the Indika of Arrian. London: Trübner & Co. –––––– (1979). Ancient India as Described in Classical Literature. New Delhi: Oriental Books Reprint Corporation, first Indian edn. (first pub. Westminster, 1901). McDaniel, June (1995). ‘A Holy Woman of Calcutta’. In Donald S. Lopez (ed.), Religions of India in Practice, pp. 418–425. Princeton: Princeton University Press. McGee, Mary (1991). ‘Desired Fruits: Motive and Intention in the Votive Rites of Hindu Women’. In Julia Leslie (ed.), Roles and Rituals for Hindu Women, pp. 71–88. London: Pinter Publishers. McKean, Lise (1996). Divine Enterprise. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. McLeod, W. H. (1976). The Evolution of the Sikh Community: Five Essays. Oxford: Oxford University Press. –––––– (1980). Early Sikh Tradition: A Study of the Janam-s§khÊs. Oxford: Clarendon Press. Meister, Michael (1990). ‘Asceticism and Monasticism as Reflected in Indian Art’. In Austin B. Creel and Vasudha Narayanan (eds), Monastic Life in the Christian Traditions: A Comparative Study, pp. 219–244. Lewiston/Queenston/Lampeter: The Edwin Mellen Press. Michaels, Axel (1994). Die Reisen der Götter: Der nepalische Paáupatin§tha-Tempel und sein rituelles Umfeld (with a supplement: Paáupatikßetra—Maps of Deopatan, by Axel Michaels and Govinda Tandan with drawings by Harald Fritzenkötter). Bonn: VGH Wissenschaftsverlag. –––––– (1996). ‘“ivar§tri at Deopatan’. In Sigfried Lienhard (ed.), Change and Continuity: Studies in the Nepalese Culture of the Kathmandu Valley, pp. 321–331. Torino: Edizioni dell’Orso. –––––– (2004). Die Kunst des einfachen Leben: Eine Kulturgeschichte der Askese. Munich: Verlag C. H. Beck. Michelis, Elizabeth De (2004). A History of Modern Yoga. London: Continuum. Michell, George (1995). ‘Dating of the Vidy§áaØkara temple at Sringeri’. In L. K. Srinivasan and S. Nagaraju (eds), “rÊ N§g§bhandinam: Dr M. S. Nagaraja Rao Festschrift (Essays on art, culture, history, archaeology, epigraphy and conservation of cultural properties of India and neighbouring countries), Vols. 1–2, pp. 269–278. Bangalore: Dr M. S. Nagaraja Rao Felicitation Committee. Miller, David M. and Dorothy C. Wertz (1976). Hindu Monastic Life: the Monks and Monasteries of Bhubaneswar. Montreal/London: McGill-Queen’s University Press. Mines, Mattison and Vijayalakshmi Gourishankar (1990). ‘Leadership and Individuality in South Asia: The Case of the South Indian Big-man’. The Journal of Asian Studies, 49, no. 4, November, pp. 761–86. Mishra, Baba (1995). Medieval Orissa and Cult of Jagannath. New Delhi: Navrang. Mishra, Haramohan (1983). Sad§nanda’s Ved§nta S§ra. Achytapur (Konark), Puri: P. K. Mishra. Mishra, Kamala Prasad (1975). Banaras in Transition (1738–1795): A Socio-Economic Study. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. Mishra, Parameshwar Nath (2001). Maãh§mn§ya Setu or Mah§nuá§sanam, of “rÊmad Jagadguru $di “aØkar§c§rya, along with “§rad§ Bh§ßyaÒ of Parameshwar Nath Mishra. Dwarka: Shri Sadanand Brahmachari (Shankaracharya Memorial Trust).
bibliography
323
Mishra, Vibhuti Bhushan (1973). Religious Beliefs and Practices of North India during the Early Mediaeval Period (Handbuch der Orientalistik, zweite Abteilung: Indien, Ergänzungband III). Leiden/Köln: E. J. Brill. Mishra, Yugal Kishore (1987). Asceticism in Ancient India: A Study of Asceticism of Different Indian Schools of Philosophical, Religious and Social Perspectives. Vaishali (Muzaffarpur, Bihar): Research Institute of Prakrit, Jainology and Ahimsa. Miára, K§meávar N§th (1996). Maãhamn§y-Mah§nuá§sanam: $dyaárÊáaØkar§c§ryaviracitam. Varanasi: Academic Publishers. –––––– (2001). Amiã K§lrekh§: $c§rya “aØkar kÊ Pravrajy§ ke PaccÊs Sau Varß (vitan·§vadÊ mat khan·an). H§v·§ (Calcutta): “aØkar§c§rya Parampar§ evaÒ SanskÜti Rakßak Parißad. Misra, R. N. (1997). ‘Pontiffs’ Empowerment in Central Indian “aivite Monachism’. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bombay (n.s.), Vol. 72, pp. 72–86. Mitchener, John E. (1982). Traditions of the Seven Œßis. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Monier-Williams, Monier (1994). SanskÜit-English Dictionary (new edition, with the collaboration of E. Leumann, C. Cappeller and other scholars). New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal (first pub. Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1899). Mookerji, Radhakund (1928). Aáoka. London: Macmillan & Co. Morinis, E. Alan (1984). Pilgrimage in the Hindu Tradition: A Case Study of West Bengal. Delhi: Oxford University Press. Mukharya, P. S. (1989). ‘Sant Pr§Ön§th and the PraÖamÊ sect’. In N. N. Bhattacharyya (ed.), Medieval Bhakti Movements in India, pp. 113–135. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. –––––– (1999). ‘Contribution of Sant Prannath to the Composite Culture of India’. In S. Settar and P. K. V. Kaimal (eds), We Lived Here, pp. 121–132. Delhi: Pragati Publications and Indian Council of Historical Research. Muller-Ortega, Paul Eduardo (1989). The Triadic Heart of “iva: Kaula Tantrism of Abhinavagupta in the Non-Dual Shaivism of Kashmir. Albany: State University of New York Press. Nagaswami, R. (1982). Tantric Cult of South India. Delhi: Agam Kala Prakashan. –––––– (1996). ‘The Sixty-Four YoginÊs and Bhåta Worship as Mentioned by “aØkara in His Commentary on the BhagavadgÊt§’. Berliner Indologische Studien, Band 9/10, pp. 237–246. –––––– (1998). ‘Eastern Indian Contact with Tamilnad’. Journal of Bengal Art, Vol. 3, pp. 17–49. Nakamura, Hajime (1962). ‘The Ved§nta as Noticed in Mediaeval Jain Literature’. In Ernest Bender (ed.), Indological Studies in Honor of W. Norman Brown (American Oriental Series, Vol. 47), pp. 186–194. New Haven, Connecticut: American Oriental Society. –––––– (1983). A History of Early Ved§nta Philosophy (Religions of Asia Series, no. 1), translated into English by Trevor Leggett, Sengakul Mayeda, Taitetz Unno and others. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Nandan, Jiwesh (2002). Mahakumbh: A Spiritual Journey. New Delhi: Rupa & Co. Nandi, Ramendra Nath (1973). Religious Institutions and Cults in the Deccan: c. A.D. 600 – A.D. 1000. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. N§rada Pur§Öa, Parts 1–5 (Ancient Indian Tradition and Mythology, Vols. 15–19), trans. Ganesh Vasudevo Tagare. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, 1980–1982. Narasimhachar, Rao Bahadur R. (1916a). ‘M§dhav§ch§rya and his younger brothers’. Indian Antiquary, Vol. XLV, January, pp. 1–6. –––––– (1916b). ‘M§dhav§ch§rya and his younger brothers’. Indian Antiquary, Vol. XLV, February, pp. 17–24. –––––– (1917). ‘M§dhav§ch§rya and his younger brothers’. Quarterly Journal of the
324
bibliography
Mythic Society, Vol. VII, July, no. 4, pp. 318–320. Narasimham, V. (1929). ‘Studies in the History of Vijayanagar’. The Indian Historical Quarterly, Vol. V, pp. 113–119. Narayanan, Vasudha (1990). ‘“Renunciation” in Saffron and White Robes’. In Austin B. Creel and Vasudha Narayanan (eds), Monastic Life in the Christian and Hindu Traditions, pp. 161–190. Lewiston/Queenston/Lampeter: The Edwin Mellen Press. –––––– (1993). ‘Renunciation and Law in India’. In Robert D. Baird (ed.), Religion and Law in Independent India, pp. 279–291. New Delhi: Manohar. Neevel, Walter G. (1977). Y§muna’s Ved§nta and P§ñcar§tra: Integrating the Classical and the Popular (Harvard Dissertations in Religion, no. 10). Missoula, Montana, USA: Scholars Press (for Harvard Theological Review). Nelson, Lance E. (1998). ‘Bhakti Preempted: Madhusådana SarasvatÊ on Devotion for the Advaitin Renouncer’. Journal of VaißÖava Studies, Vol. 6, no. 1, Winter, pp. 53–74. Nevill, H. R. (1909a). Saharanpur: A Gazeteer, being Volume II of the District Gazeteers of the United Provinces of Agra and Oudh. Allahabad: Government Press. –––––– (1909b). Banaras: A Gazeteer, being Volume XXVI of the District Gazeteers of the United Provinces of Agra and Oudh. Allahabad: Government Press. –––––– (1911). Allahabad: A Gazeteer, being Volume XXIII of the District Gazeteers of the United Provinces of Agra and Oudh. Allahabad: Government Press. Nikhilananda, Swami (1978). Ved§ntas§ra of Sad§nanda. Calcutta: Advaita Ashrama. Nizami, Khaliq Ahmad (1961). Some Aspects of Religion and Politics in India during the Thirteenth Century. Aligarh: Department of History, Aligarh Muslim University. Oberoi, Harjot (1997). The Construction of Religious Boundaries: Culture, Identity and Diversity in the Sikh Tradition. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Oddie, G. A. (1984). ‘The Character, Role and Significance of Non-Brahman “aivite Maths in Tanjore District, in the Nineteenth Century’. In Kenneth Ballhatchet and David Taylor (eds), Changing South Asia: Religion and Society, pp. 37–50. Hong Kong: Centre of South Asian Studies, SOAS, University of London. Ojha, Catherine. [See Clémentin-Ojha.] Olivelle, Patrick (trans. and ed.) (1976–1977). V§sudev§árama Yatidharmaprak§áa: A Treatise on World Renunciation (Parts 1 and 2). Vienna: De Nobili Research Library. –––––– (1978). ‘Ritual Suicide and the Rite of Renunciation’. Wiener Zeitschrift für die Kunde Südasiens und Archiv für Indische Philosophie, Band XXII, pp. 19–44. –––––– (1980a). ‘The Integration of renunciation by orthodox Hinduism’. The Journal of the Oriental Institute of Baroda, 28.1, pp. 27–36. –––––– (1980b). ‘Pañcam§áramavidhi: Rite for becoming a naked ascetic’. Wiener Zeitschrift für die Kunde Südasiens, 24, pp. 130–145. –––––– (1982). ‘$nandatÊrtha’s SaÒny§sapaddhati: A Handbook for Madhavite Ascetics’. In Radha Burnier, K. Kunjunni Raja, A. G. Krishna Warrier, and A. A. Ramanathan (eds), Dr. K. Kunjunni Raja Felicitation Volume, pp. 293–303. Adyar, Madras: The Adyar Library and Research Centre. –––––– (1984). ‘Renouncer and Renunciation in the Dharmaá§stras’. In Richard Lariviere (ed.), Studies in Dharmaá§stra, pp. 81–152. Calcutta: KLM pvt. –––––– (1986–1987). Renunciation in Hinduism: A Medieval Debate, Vols. 1–2. Vienna: Gerold and Co. –––––– (1987). ‘King and Ascetic: State Control of Asceticism in the Arthaá§stra’. Adyar Library Bulletin, Vol. 51 (Festschrift for Professor Ludo Rocher), pp. 39–59. –––––– (trans. and ed.) (1992). The SaÒny§sa Upanißads: Hindu Scriptures on Asceticism and Renunciation. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
bibliography
325
–––––– (1993). The $árama System: The History and Hermeneutics of a Religious Institution. Oxford: Oxford University Press. –––––– (trans. and ed.) (1995). Rules and Regulations of Brahmanical Asceticism: Yatidharmasamuccaya of Y§dava Prak§áa. Albany: State University of New York Press. –––––– (trans. and ed.) (1996). Upanißads. Oxford: Oxford University Press. –––––– (trans. and ed.) (1999). Dharmasåtras: The Law Codes of $pastamba, Gautama, Baudh§yana and Vasißãha. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Olson, Carl (1997). The Indian Renouncer and Postmodern Poison: A Cross-Cultural Encounter. New York: Peter Lang. Oman, John Campbell (1984). The Mystics, Ascetics and Saints of India. New Delhi: Cosmo Publications (first pub. 1903). Orr, Leslie C. (2000). Donors, Devotees, and Daughters of God: Temple Women in Medieval Tamilnadu. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Orr, W. G. (1940). Armed Religious Ascetics in North India, reprinted from the Bulletin of the John Rylands Library, Vol. XXIV, no. 1, pp. 81–100. Manchester: Manchester University Press. Padmap§da (1948). The Pañcap§dik§ of Padmap§da (Translated into English) (Gaekwad’s Orinetal Series, no. CVII), trans. D. Venkataramiah. Baroda: Oriental Institute. –––––– (1989). Panchapadika of Padmapada Acharya: A Treatise by Vedakavivamsam T. R. Srinivasan, trans. and comm. Vedakavivamsam T. R. Srinivasan. Madras: Bhavani Book Centre. Pai, D. A. (1983). Religious Sects of the Hindus. Delhi: Cosmo Publications (first pub. as Monograph on the Religious Sects in India among the Hindus. Bombay: The Times Press, 1928). Pal, Pratapaditya (1981). Hindu Religion and Iconology: According to the Tantras§ra (The Tantric Tradition, Vol. 1). Los Angeles: Vichitra Press. Pande, Govind Chandra (1978). “ramaÖa Tradition: Its History and Contribution to Indian Culture. Ahmedabad: L. D. Institute of Indology. –––––– (1994). The Life and Thought of “aØkar§c§rya. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Pandey, Rajbali (1969). Hindu SaÒsk§ras: Socio-Religious Study of the Hindu Sacraments. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, 2nd. edn. Pangborn, Cyrus R. (1976). ‘The R§makrishna Matha and Mission’. In Bardwell L. Smith (ed.), Hinduism: New Essays in the History of Religions, pp. 98–119. Leiden: E. J. Brill. Panigraha, Krishna Chandra (1981). History of Orissa (Hindu Period). Cuttack: Kitab Mahal. P§Öini (1987). Aßã§dh§yÊ of P§Öini, trans. Sumitra M. Katre. Austin: University of Texas Press. Pantalu, N. K. Venkatasam (1934). ‘Govinda Deekshita and his Literary Successors’. Journal of the Andhra Historical Research Society, Vol. IX, part 1, pp. 12–22. Paranjpe, Meenal (1991). ‘Importance of Espionage System in Kauãilya’. Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bombay (n.s.), Vols. 60–61, pp. 95–101. Parikh, Sangeeta S. (ed.) (1996). Hindi-Transliterated Hindi-English Dictionary. New Delhi: Allied Publishers Limited. Parry, J. P. (1982). ‘Sacrificial Death and the Necrophagus Ascetic’. In Maurice Bloch and Jonathan Parry (eds), Death and the Regeneration of Life, pp. 74–110. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. –––––– (1985). ‘The Aghori Ascetics of Benares’. In Richard Burghart and Audrey Cantlie (eds), Indian Religion, pp. 51–78. London: Curzon Press. Patañjali (1892–1909). The Vy§karaÖa-Mah§bh§shya of Patanjali, Vols 1–3, ed. F. Kiel-
326
bibliography
horn. Bombay: Oriental Book Depot, 2nd revised edn. . Pathak. K. B. (1882). ‘The Date of “amkar§ch§rya’. The Indian Antiquary, Vol. XI, pp. 174–175. . –––––– (1892a). ‘DharmakÊrti and “amkar§charya’. Journal of the Bombay Royal Asiatic Society, Vol. XVIII, 1890–1894, (Art. VIII) pp. 88–96. –––––– (1892b). ‘BhartÜihari and Kum§rila’, Journal of the Bombay Royal Asiatic Society, Vol. XVIII, 1890–1894, (Art. XVI) pp. 213–238. Pathak, V. S. (1960). History of “aiva Cults in Northern India from Inscriptions (700 A.D. to 1200 A.D). Varanasi: Dr. Ram Naresh Varma. Pearson, Anne Mackenzie (1996).“Because It Gives Me Peace of Mind”: Ritual Fasts in the Religious Lives of Hindu Women. Albany: State University of New York Press. Petech, Luciano (1958). Mediaeval History of Nepal (c.750–1480) (Serie Orientale Roma, X). Rome: Instituto Italiano per il Medio ed Estremo Oriente. Peterson, Indira Viswanathan (1991). Poems to “iva: The Hymns of the Tamil Saints. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Piantelli, Mario (1974). “aØkara e la Rinascita del Br§hmanesimo. Fossano (Italy): Editrice Esperienze. Pinch, William R. (1996). Peasants and Monks in British India. Berkeley: University of California Press. –––––– (1997). ‘Subaltern Sadhus? Political Ascetics in Indian Myth, Memory, and History’. www.virginia.edu/soasia/symsem/kisan/papers/sadhus.html. –––––– (1998). ‘Historicity, Hagiography, and Hierarchy in Gangetic India, 1918– 1936’. In William Radice (ed.), Swami Vivekananda and the Modernisation of Hinduism, pp. 244–263. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Pollet, Gilbert (1963). Studies in the Bhakta M§la of N§bha D§sa. Ph.D. thesis, University of London. Potter, Karl H. (ed.) (1977). Encyclopedia of Indian Philosophies, Vol. 1: Indian Metaphysics and Epistemology: The Tradition of Ny§ya-Vaiáeßika up to GaØgeáa. Princeton: Princeton University Press. –––––– (ed.) (1981). Encyclopedia of Indian Philosophies, Vol. 3: Advaita Ved§nta up to “aÒkara and his pupils. Princeton: Princeton University Press. Prabhup§da, A. C. Bhaktivedanta Swami (trans. and comm.) (1976). “rÊmad Bh§gavatam (of KÜßÖa-Dvaip§yana Vy§sa), Vols 1–10. Los Angeles: Bhaktivedanta Book Trust. Prasad, R. C. (1995). The “r§ddha: The Hindu Book of the Dead. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. –––––– (1997). The Upanayana: The Hindu Ceremonies of the Sacred Thread. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. PurÊ, “rÊ Mahant L§l (1988). “rÊ Panc§yatÊ Akh§Ü§ Mah§nirv§nÊ evaÒ Daáan§m Sankáipt Aitih§sik Paricay. KaØkhal (Haridv§r): Girdhar N§r§yaÖ PurÊ. –––––– (2001). Daáan§m N§g§ SaÒny§sÊ evaÒ “rÊ Panc§yatÊ Akh§Ü§ Mah§nirv§nÊ. KaØkhal and Dehra Dån: Vijay Giri, GaØg§ PurÊ, “rÊ Panc§yatÊ Akh§Ü§ Mah§nirv§nÊ (KaØkhal)/RavÊndra PurÊ (Dehra Dån). Quigley, Declan (1999). The Interpretation of Caste. New Delhi: Oxford University Press (first pub. 1993). Qvarnström, Olle (1999). ‘Haribhadra and the Beginnings of Doxography in India’. In N. K. Wagle and Olle Qvarnström (eds), Approaches to Jaina Studies: Philosophy, Logic, Rituals and Symbols (South Asian Studies Papers, no. 11), pp. 167–210. Toronto: Centre for South Asian Studies, University of Toronto. Radice, William (1998). Swami Vivekananda and the Modernisation of Hinduism. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Raghavan, V. (1976). ‘S§yana-M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya Literature: Some more Notes’.
bibliography
327
Journal of the Andhra Historical Research Society (Sri Mallampalli Somasekhara Sarma Commemoration Volume), Vol. XXXV (1975–1976), pp. 159–161. Hyderabad: Government of Andhra Pradesh. Rai, Subas (1993a). Rudraksa: Properties and Biomedical Implications. Varanasi: Ganga Kaveri Publishing House. –––––– (1993b). Kumbha Mela: History and Religion; Astronomy and Cosmobiology. Varanasi: Ganga Kaveri Publishing House. Rajagopalan, V. (1968). ‘Madhusudana Sarasvati’. In T. M. P. Mahadevan (ed.), Preceptors of Adaita, pp. 254–261. Secunderabad: Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Sankara Mandir. Rajamanickam, M. (1962). ‘Tamil Saiva Mathas under the Colas’. In [chief ed. C. T. K. Chari] Esssays in Philosophy (presented to T. M. P. Mahadevan), pp. 446–451. Madras: Ganesh & Co. (Madras) Private Ltd. –––––– [Rajamanikkam, M] (1964). The Development of “aivism (A.D. 300–1300). Dharmapuram: Dharmapuram Adhinam. Rajasekhara, Sindigi (1985). ‘Inscriptions at Vijayanagara’. In Anna Libera Dallapiccola and Stephanie Zingel-Avé Lallemant (eds), Vijayanagara – City and Empire: New Currents of Research, pp. 101–119. Stuttgart: Steiner Verlag Wiesbaden GMBH. Ramachandran, T. P. (1968). ‘Sadananda’. In T. M. P. Mahadevan (ed.), Preceptors of Adaita, pp. 206–211. Secunderabad: Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Sankara Mandir. Ramakrishnananda, Swami (1959). Life of Sri Ramanuja, trans. from Bengali by Swami Budhananda. Madras: Sri Ramakrishna Math. Ramanujan, A. K. (1973). Speaking of “iva. London: Penguin. –––––– (1982). ‘On Women Saints’. In J. S. Hawley and D. M. Wulff (eds). The Divine Consort: R§dh§ and the Goddesses of India, pp. 316–324. Berkeley: Harvard University. Ramaswamy, Vijaya (1992). ‘Rebels — Conformists?: Women Saints in Medieval South India’. Anthropos, no. 87, pp. 133–146. –––––– (1997). Walking Naked: Women, Society, Spirituality in South India. Shimla: Indian Institute of Advanced Study. [V§lmÊki] R§m§yaÖa, Vols. 1–7, critically edited by G. H. Bhatt et al. Baroda: Oriental Institute, 1960–1986. Rambachan, Anantanand (1991). Accomplishing the Accomplished: The Vedas as a Source of Valid Knowledge in “aØkara (Monographs of the Society for Asian and Comparative Philosophy, no. 10). Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. Ramesan, N. (1968). ‘Sri Kamakoti Pitha of Sankara’. In T. M. P. Mahadevan (ed.), Preceptors of Adaita, pp. 429–467. Secunderabad: Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Sankara Mandir. Ramesh, K. V. (1970). A History of South Kanara: From the Earliest Times to the Fall of Vijayanagara. Dharwar: Karnatak University. Rao, R. Rama (1930). ‘Vidy§raÖya and M§dhav§c§rya’. The Indian Historical Quarterly, Vol. VI, pp. 701–717. –––––– (1931). ‘Origin of M§dhava-Vidy§raÖya Theory’. The Indian Historical Quarterly, Vol. VII, pp. 78–92. –––––– (1934). ‘Identity of Vidy§raÖya and M§dhav§c§rya’. The Indian Historical Quarterly, Vol. X, pp. 901–810. –––––– (2000). ‘Hinduism under Vijayanagara Kings’. In S. Krishnaswami Aiyangar (ed.), Vijayanagara: History and Legacy, pp. 39–51. New Delhi: Aryan Books International. Rao, S. K. Ramachandra (1988–1992). Pratima-Kosha: Encyclopaedia of Indian Iconography, Vols. 1–6. Bangalore: Kalpatharu Research Academy.
328
bibliography
–––––– (1989–1994). $gama-Kosha: $gama Encyclopaedia, Vols. 1–12. Bangalore: Kalpatru Research Academy. –––––– (1997). Salagrama-Kosha, Vols 1–2. Bangalore: Kalpatharu Research Academy. Rao, Subha (1932). ‘The History of the Eastern Gangas of Kalinga’. Jounal of the Andhra Historical Research Society, Vol. VII, part 1, July, pp. 57–64. Ray, Jyotish Chandra [Bhaiji] (1983). Mother as Revealed to Me, trans. G. Das Gupta. Calcutta: Shree Shree Anandamayee Charitable Society, sixth edn. Rastelli, Marion (2002). ‘The $sana according to the P§rameávarasaÒhit§ or a Method of Writing a SaÒhit§’. In Gerhard Oberhammer and Marion Rastelli (eds), Studies in Hinduism III: P§ñcar§tra and Viáißã§dvaitaved§nta, pp. 9–31. Wien: Der Östereichischen Akademie der Wissenschaften. Regmi, D. R. (1965). Medieval Nepal (Part 1). Calcutta: Firma K. L. Mukhopadhyay. –––––– (ed.) (1966). Medieval Nepal (Part 3): Source Materials for the History and Culture of Nepal 740–1768 A.D. (Inscription, Chronicles and Diaries etc.). Calcutta: Firma K. L. Mukhopadhyay. –––––– (1969). Ancient Nepal. Calcutta: Firma K. L. Mukhopadhyay. –––––– (1975). Modern Nepal, Vol. 1. Calcutta: Firma K. L. Mukhopadhyay. Reynolds, Frank E. (1997). ‘Rebirth Traditions and the Lineages of Gotama: A Study in Therav§da Buddhology’. In Juliane Schober (ed.), Sacred Biography in the Buddhist Traditions of South and Southeast Asia, pp. 19–39. Honolulu: University of Hawai’i Press. Rigopoulos, Antonio (1998). Datt§treya: The Immortal Guru, Yogin, and Avat§ra. Albany: State University of New York Press. Rizvi, Saiyid Athar Abbas (1978). A History of Sufism in India (Vol. 1: Early Sufism and its History in India to AD 1600). New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. –––––– (1993). Muslim Revivalist Movements in North India in the Sixteenth and Seventeenth Centuries. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal (first pub. Agra University Press, 1965). Roebuck, Valerie J. (1992). The Circle of Stars. Shaftesbury, UK: Element Books. Rose, H. A. (compiler) (1911–1914). A Glossary of the Tribes and Castes of the Punjab and North-West Frontier Province (Vols. 2–3). Based on the Census Reports for the Punjab, by Sir Denzil Ibbetson, in 1883, and by E. D. MacLagan, in 1892. Lahore: Punjab Government Publications. Rothermund, Dietmar (1993). An Economic History of India: from Pre-Colonial Times to 1991. London and New York: Routledge (first pub. Croom Helm Ltd, 1988). Row, B. Suryanarain (1914). Sri: A Short History of the Sivaganga Mutt. Bangalore: Thumby & Co. Roy, Dilip Kumar, and Indira Devi (1955). Kumbha: India’s Ageless Festival. Bombay: Bharatiya Vidya Bhavan. Ruegg, David Seyfort (1969). La Théorie du Tath§gatagarbha et du Gotra: Études sur la Sotériologie et la Gnoséologie du Bouddhisme. Paris: École Française d’ ExtrêmeOrient. –––––– (2000). Three Studies in the History of Indian and Tibetan Madhyamaka Philosophy (Studies in Indian and Tibetan Madhyamaka Thought, Part 1) (Wiener Studien zur Tibetologie und Buddhismuskunde, Heft 50). Vienna: Arbeitskreis für Tibetische und Buddhistischen Studien, Universität Wien. Rukmani, T. S. (1998). ‘The Yogasåtrabh§ßyavivaraÖa is not a work of “aØkar§c§rya the author of the Brahmasåtrabh§ßya’. Journal of Indian Philosophy, Vol. 26, no. 3, pp. 263–274.
bibliography
329
Rüping, Klaus (1977). ‘Zur Askese in Indischen Religionen’. Zeitschrift für Missionswissenschaft und Religionswissenschaft, no. 61, pp. 81–98. Rushby, Kevin (2002). Children of Kali. London: Constable and Robinson. Russell, R. V. (1916). The Tribes and Castes of the Central Provinces of India, Vols. 1–4. London: Macmillan and Co. Sachav, Edward C. (ed. and notes) (1996). Alberuni’s India: An account of the religion, philosophy, literature, geography. chronology, astronomy, customs, laws and astrology of India about AD 1030, Vols. 1–2 [bound in one]. Delhi: Low Price Publications (first pub. London: Trübner & Co., 1888). Sad§nand Brahmac§rÊ (2000). Divya-Dv§rak§: Bhavya-“§rad§pÊãha. Dv§rak§: “§rad§pÊãha Vidy§sabh§. Sad§nanda Giri, Swami (1976). Society and Sanny§sin: A History of the Daán§mÊ Sanny§sins. Rishikesh: Kriy§yoga $árama. Sakhyananda, Swami (1983). ‘Historicity of Sankaracharya in the Light of Kerala Traditions and Tamil Epigraphic Records’. In Madhu Sen (ed.), Studies in Religion and Change, pp. 73–78. New Delhi: Books & Books. Saletore, B. A. (1934). Social and Political Life in the Vijayanagara Empire (A.D. 1346–A.D. 1646), Vols 1–2. Madras: B. G. Paul. –––––– (1935). ‘The R§j§ Guru of the Founders of Vijayanagara and the Pontiffs of “ringeri Maãha’. Journal of the Andhra Historical Research Society, Vol. IX, part 4, April, pp. 33–42. Salomon, Richard (1979). ‘TÊrtha-praty§n§y§È: Ranking of Hindu Pilgrimage Sites in Classical Sanskrit Texts’. Zeitschrift der Deutschen Morgenländischen Gesellschaft, Band 129, pp. 102–128. –––––– (1998). Indian Epigraphy: A Guide to the Study of Inscriptions in Sanskrit, Prakrit, and the other Indo-Aryan Languages. New York: Oxford University Press. Samanta, D. K. (1997). Sacred Complex of Ujjain (Reconstructing Indian History and Culture, no. 13). New Delhi: D. K. Printworld. Sanderson, Alexis (1985). ‘Purity and power among the Brahmans of Kashmir’. In Michael Carrithers, Steven Collins, and Steven Lukes (eds), The Category of the Person: Anthropology, Philosophy, History, pp. 190–216. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. –––––– (1988). ‘“aivism and the Tantric Traditions’. In Friedhelm Hardy (ed.), The World’s Religions: The Religions of Asia, pp. 128–172. London: Routledge. –––––– (1995). ‘Meaning in Tantric Ritual’. In Anne-Marie Blondeau and Kristofer Schipper (eds), Essais sur le Rituel III (Colloque du Centenaire de la Section des Sciences Religieuses de l’ École Pratique des Hautes Études), pp. 15–95. Louvain/Paris: Peters. “aØkar§c§rya (1993). Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya of “rÊ “aØkar§c§rya, trans. Swami Gambhirananda. Calcutta: Advaita Ashrama. –––––– (1965). The BÜhad§raÖyaka Upanißad, with the Commentary of “aØkar§c§rya, trans. Sw§mÊ M§dhav§nanda. Calcutta: Advaita Ashrama. –––––– (1941).The Upadeáa S§hasrÊ (A Thousand Teachings, in two parts—prose and poetry), trans. Sw§mÊ Jagad§nanda. Mylapore, Madras: Sri Ramakrishna Math. –––––– (1926). Viveka-Cå·§maÖi of “rÊ “aØkar§c§rya, trans. Sw§mÊ M§dhav§nanda. Calcutta: Advaita Ashrama, 2nd edn. Sankaranarayanan, S. (1995a). “rÊ “aØkara: His Life, Philosophy and Relevance to Man in Modern Times. (The Adyar Library General Series, Vol. 14). Adyar, Madras: The Adyar Library and Research Centre (The Theosophical Society). –––––– (1995b). ‘Date of “rÊ “aØkara—A New Perspective’. Adyar Library Bulletin (C. Kunhan Raja Birth Centenary Volume), Vol. 59, pp. 122–177. Sarkar, Benoy Kumar [assisted by Hemendra K. Rakshit] (1972). The Folk-Element
330
bibliography
in Hindu Culture. New Delhi: Oriental Books Reprint Corporation (first pub. London: Longmans, Green and Co., 1917). Sarkar, Jadunath (1958?). A History of Dasn§mÊ N§g§ Sany§sis. Allahabad: Sri Panchayati Akhara Mahanirvani. Sarkar, Vatsala (1986). ‘Gosain’. In K. S. Singh (ed.), People of India: Himachal Pradesh, Vol. XXIV, pp. 245–248. Delhi: Anthropological Survey of India (Manohar). Sarma Deepak (2003). An Introduction to M§dhva Ved§nta. Aldershot, UK: Ashgate. “arma, J§yapur Viávan§th R§jgop§l (1963). “rÊmajjagadguru-“aØkaramaãha-vimaráa. Dharmapuri, Madras: Sri Rama Printing Works. “arma, “iva (1980). ‘Ujjain ka SiÒhasth Parv’. Dharmayuga, 30 March–5 April, pp. 8–11. . Sarvajñ§tman (1972). Sam kßepaá§rÊraka (Madras University Philosophical Series, no. 18), trans. and comm. N. Veezhinathan. Madras: Centre for Advanced Study in Philosophy. Sastri, K. A. Nilakanta (1955). The CÙÏas (Madras University Historical Series, no. 9). Madras: University of Madras, 2nd. edn. –––––– (1992). Development of Religion in South India. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal (first pub.1963). Sastri, P. P. Subramanya (1937). ‘Foreword’ to S. Kuppuswami Sastri (trans. and intro.), Brahmasiddhi by $c§rya MaÖ·anamiára with Commentary by “ankhap§Öi (Madras Government Oriental Manuscripts Series, no. 4). Madras: Government Press. Sastri, S. Rajagopala (1968). ‘Totakacharya’. In T. M. P. Mahadevan (ed.), Preceptors of Adaita, pp. 63–68. Secunderabad: Sri Kanchi Kamakoti Sankara Mandir. Sastri, S. S. Suryanarayana (1930). The Sivadvaita of Srikantha. Madras: University of Madras. –––––– (1961). Collected Papers of Professor S. S. Surynarayana Sastri (Madras University Philosophical Series, no. 8), ed. T. M. P. Mahadevan. Madras: University of Madras. Sastri, V. V. Ramana (1956). ‘The Doctrinal Culture and Tradition of the Siddhas’. In Haridas Bhattacharyya (ed.), The Cultural Heritage of India, Vol. IV (‘The Religions’), pp. 300–308. Calcutta: The Ramakrishna Mission Institute of Culture. Sastry, T. S. Narayana, and T. N. Kumaraswami (1971). The Age of Sankara. Madras: B. G. Paul & Co., 2nd. edn., enlarged (first pub. 1916). “atapatha-Br§hmaÖa (according to the text of the M§dhyandina school), Part IV, Books VIII, IX and X (Sacred Books of the East, ed. by F. Max Müller, Vol. 43), trans. Julius Eggeling. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, 1995 (first pub. 1885). Satchidanandendra Sarasvati, Sri Swami (1989). The Method of the Vedanta: A Critical Account of the Advaita Tradition, trans. from the Sanskrit by A. J. Alston. London: Kegan Paul International. Savarkar, V. D. (1989). Hindutva. Bombay: S. S. Savarkar, 6th. edn. Sawai, Yoshitsugu (1985). ‘On a Legendary Biography of “aØkara—especially in regard to the date of M§dhava’s “aØkaradigvijaya’. Journal of Indian and Buddhist Studies (Indogaku BukkyÙgaku Kenkyå), Vol. XXXIV, no. 1, (67), December, pp. 454–459. –––––– (1987). ‘The Legend of “aØkara’s Birth’. Journal of Indian and Buddhist Studies (Indogaku BukkyÙgaku Kenjyå), Vol. XXXVI, no. 1, (71), December, pp. 464–468. –––––– (1992). The Faith of Ascetics and Lay Sm§rtas: A Sudy of the “aØkaran Tradition of “ÜØgeri. Vienna: Sammlung De Nobili.
bibliography
331
Sawyer, Dana W. (1993). ‘The Monastic Structure of Banarsi Dandi Sadhus’. In Bradley R. Hertel and Cynthia Ann Humes (eds), Living Banaras: Hindu Religion in Cultural Context, pp. 159–180. Albany: State University of New York Press. Sax, William S. (1991). ‘Kumbha Mel§’. In Mircea Eliade (ed.), Encyclopedia of Religions, Vol. 8, pp. 401–402. London: Macmillan. –––––– (2000). ‘Conquering the Quarters: Religion and Politics in Hinduism’. International Journal of Hindu Studies, Vol. 4, no. 1, April, pp. 39–60. van Schendel, Willem (1985). “Madmen’ of Myemsingh: Peasant resistance and the colonial process in eastern India, 1824–1833’. Indian Economic and Social History Review, no. 22 (2), pp. 139–173. Schimmel, Annemarie (1980). Islam in the Indian Subcontinent. Leiden/Köln: E. J. Brill. –––––– (1982). Islam in India and Pakistan (Iconography of Religions, Section XXII: Islam, Fasicle: 9). Leiden: E. J. Brill. –––––– (1983). Mystical Dimensions of Islam. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press (first pub. 1975). Schober, Juliane (ed.) (1997). Sacred Biography in the Buddhist Traditions of South and Southeast Asia. Honolulu: University of Hawai’i Press. Schopen, Gregory (1997). Bones, Stones and Buddhist Monks: Collected Papers on the Archaeology, Epigraphy, and Texts of Monastic Buddhism in India. Honolulu: University of Hawai’i Press. Schrader, Otto (1916). Introduction to the P§ñcar§tra and the Ahirbudhnya SaÒhit§. Madras: Adyar Library. Sen, Kshitimohan (1974). Medieval Mysticism of India. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. Sen, Makhan Lal (1988). The Ramayana (Translated from the Original of Valmiki), Vols. 1–2. New Delhi: Cosmo Publications. Sethi, V. K. (1979). Mira, the Divine Lover. Beas: Radha Soami Satsang Beas. Settar, S. (1999). ‘BaÏÏig§ve: A Medieval Urban Mosaic of Multi-Religious Communities’. In S. Settar and P. K. V. Kaimal (eds), We Lived Here, pp. 54–84. Delhi: Pragati Publications/The Indian Council of Historical Research. Sewell, Robert (1900). A Forgotten Empire (Vijayanagara): A Contribution to the History of India. London: Swan Sonnenschein & Co. Ltd. Sewell, Robert, and S. K. Aiyangar (1932). The Historical Inscriptions of Southern India (Collected till 1923), and Outlines of Political History. Madras: University of Madras. Sewell, Robert, and “ankara B§lkÜshÖa DÊkshit (1896). The Indian Calendar (with Tables for the Conversion of Hindu and Muhammadan into A.D. Dates, and vice versa). London: Sonnenschein & Co. Ltd. “rÊv§stav, R§m L§l (1994). Gorakhb§nÊ. Gorakhpur: Gorakhn§th Mandir. Shackle, Christopher (1976). ‘The Pilgrimage and the Extension of Sacred Geography in the Poetry of Khw§ja Ghul§m FarÊd’. In Attar Singh (ed.), SocioCultural Impact of Islam on India, pp. 159–170. Chandigarh: Publication Bureau, Panjab University. Sh§nt§, N. (1985). The Unknown Pilgrims: The Voice of the S§dhvÊs (The history, spirituality and life of the Jaina women ascetics), trans. Mary Rogers. Delhi: Sri Satguru Publications (first pub. as La Voie Jaina. Paris, 1985). Sharma, Shri Ram Acharya (1988). The Great Science and Philosophy of Gayatri, trans. Satya Narayan Pandya. Mathur§: Yug Nirman Yojna. Sharma, Sri Ram (1937–1938). ‘Jahangir’s Religious Policy’. Indian Culture, Vol. IV, nos. 1–4, pp. 305–323.
332
bibliography
Sharma, Vijay Prakash (1998). The Sadhus and Indian Civilisation. New Delhi: Anmol Publications. Shastry, A. K. (1982). A History of “riØg¿ri. Dharwad: Karnatak University. –––––– (1987). ‘Relation between the “ÜØgeri Maãha and the Keladi Rulers’. In A. V. Narasimha Murthy and K. V. Ramesh (eds), GiridharaárÊ Essays on Indology: Dr. G. S. Dikshit Felicitation Volume, pp. 137–141. Delhi: Agam Kala Prakashan. Sherring, M. A. (1872–1879). Hindu Tribes and Castes, Vols. 1–3. London: Trübner & Co. Shiraishi, Ryokai (1996). Asceticism and Brahmanism (Buddhica Britannica, Series Continua VI). Tring, UK: The Institute of Buddhist Studies. Siauve, Suzanne (1957). La Voie vers la Connaissance de Dieu (Brahma-Jijñ§s§), selon l’Anuvy§khyy§na de Madhva (Publications de l’institut Français d’Indologie, no. 6). Pondichéry: Institut Français d’Indologie. Siddiqi, Muhammad Suleman (1989). The Bahmani Såfis. Delhi: Idarah-I Adabiyat-I. Sikand, Yoginder (1998). ‘Sadhus in Politics: Historical Realities and Contemporary Claims’. Islamic Voice, Vol. 12-01, no. 132, January, pp. 1–3. Sinclair-Brull, Wendy (1997). Female Ascetics: Hierarchy and Purity in an Indian Religious Movement. Richmond, UK: Curzon. Singh, Jodh (trans.) (1998). V§r§Ö Bh§Ê Gurd§s (Text, Transliteration and Translation), Vols. 1–2. Patiala/New Delhi: Vision and Venture. Singh, Teja (1951). Sikhism: It’s Ideals and Institutions. Bombay/Calcutta/Madras: Orient Longmans Ltd., revised edn. Singh, Upinder (1993). Kings, Br§hmaÖas and Temples in Orissa: An Epigraphic Study AD 300–1147. New Delhi: Munshiram Manoharlal. Sinha, Surajit, and Baidyanath Saraswati (1978). Ascetics of Kashi. Varanasi: N. K. Bose Memorial Foundation. Sircar, D. C. (1973). The “§kta PÊãhas. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass, 1973, 2nd. edn. (first pub. 1948). Skilton, Andrew (1997). A Concise History of Buddhism. Birmingham: Windhorse Publications. Skurzak, Ludwik (1948). Études sur l’origine de l’ascéticisme Indien (Travaux de la Société des Sciences et des Lettres de Wroclaw, Series A, no. 15). Wroclaw: Sklad Glownyw Panstwowym Instytucie Wydawniczym. –––––– (1967). ‘Indian Asceticism in its Historical Development’. Adyar Library Bulletin, Vols. XXXI – XXXII (1967–68), pp. 202–210. Sleeman, W. H. (1903). Rambles and Recollections of an Indian Official, Vols. 1–2, ed. Vincent Arthur Smith, new edition. London: Archibald Constable and Company. Smith, Brian K. (1994). Classifying the Universe: The Ancient Indian VarÖa System and the Origins of Caste. New York/Oxford: Oxford University Press. . Smith, Frederick M. (1993). ‘The Sam ny§sanirÖaya, a “uddh§dvaita Text on Renunciation by Vallabh§c§rya’. Journal of VaißÖava Studies, Vol. 1, no. 4, Summer, pp. 135–156. Smith, Vincent A. (1966). Akbar: The Great Mogul, 1542–1605. Delhi: S. Chand & Co., 2nd. edn. (first pub. 1958). Snell, Rupert (1991). The Eighty-Four Verses of Hita HarivaÒáa: An Edition of the Caur§sÊ Pada. London: School of Oriental and African Studies. Snell, Rupert, and Winand M. Callewaert (eds) (1994). According to Tradition: Hagiographical Writing in India. Wiesbaden: Harrassowitz Verlag. Spencer, George W. (1970). ‘The Sacred Geography of the Tamil Shaivite Hymns’. Numen (International Review for the History of Religions), Vol. XVII, pp. 232–244.
bibliography
333
Sridhara Babu, D. (1975). Kingship: State and Religion in South India, According to South Indian Historical Biographies (Madhur§vijaya, Acyutar§y§bhyudaya and Vemabhålacarita). Göttingen: Georg-August-Universität zu Göttingen. Srinivasan, C. R. (1979). Kanchipuram through the Ages. Delhi: Agam Kala Prakashan. Staal, Frits (1993). Rules Without Meaning: Ritual, Mantras and the Human Sciences. New York: Peter Lang. Stanley, John M. (1977). ‘Special Time, Special Power: The Fluidity of Power in a Popular Hindu Festival’. Journal of Asian Studies, Vol. 37, no. 1, November, pp. 27–43. Steele, Arthur (1868). The Law and Custom of Hindoo Castes (within the Dekhun provinces subject to the presidency of Bombay). London: Wm H. Allen & Co. Stein, Burton (1968). ‘Social Mobility and Medieval South Indian Sects’. In James Silverberg (ed.), Social Mobility in the Caste System in India: An Interdisciplinary Symposium, pp. 78–94. The Hague/Paris: Mouton. –––––– (1973). ‘D¿vÊ Shrines and Folk Hinduism in Medieval Tamilnad’. In Edwin Gerow and Margery D. Lang (eds), Studies in the Language and Culture of South Asia, pp. 75–90. Seattle/London: University of Washington Press. –––––– (1985). ‘Vijayanagara and the Transition to Patrimonial System’. In Anna Libera Dallapiccola and Stephanie Zingel-Avé Lallemant (eds), Vijayanagara – City and Empire: New Currents of Research, pp. 73–87. Stuttgart: Steiner Verlag Wiesbaden GMBH. –––––– (1999). Peasant, State and Society in Medieval South India. Delhi: Oxford University Press, 2nd. edn. (first pub. 1980). von Stietencron, Heinrich (1978). ‘The “aiva Component in the Early Evolution of Jagann§tha’. In Anncharlott Eschmann, Hermann Kulke, and Gaya Charan Tripathi (eds), The Cult of Jagannath and the Regional Traditions of Orissa, pp. 119–123. Delhi: Manohar. –––––– (1995). ‘Religious Configurations in Pre-Muslim India and the Modern Concept of Hinduism’. In Vasudha Dalmia and Heinrich von Stietencron (eds), Representing Hinduism: The Construction of Religious Traditions and National Identity, pp. 51–81. New Delhi: Sage Publications. ––––––– (2001). ‘Charisma and Canon: The Dynamics of Legitimization and Innovation in Indian Religions’. In Vasudha Dalmia, Angelika Malinar, and Martin Christof (eds), Charisma and Canon: Essays on the Religious History of the Indian Subcontinent, pp. 14–38. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Stevenson, Jane (1995). ‘Early Irish Saints: Some Uses of Hagiography’. In Clyde Binfield (ed.), Sainthood Revisioned: Studies in Hagiography and Biography, pp. 17–26. Sheffield: Sheffield Academic Press. Subramanyam, R. (1975). ‘K§nchÊpuram Excavations’. Journal of the Andhra Historical Research Society, Vol. XXXIV, Parts 1–4 (1974–1975), pp. 23–31. Subramanyan, U. (1980). Mahamaham Festival 1980. Kumbhakonam: Arulmigu Adhi Kumbeswarar Swamy Temple. Sundaresan, Vidyasankar (2000). ‘The Jyotirmatha Sankaracharya Lineage in the 20th Century’. www.ucl.ac.uk/Öucgadkw/position/shank-jyot-ascii.html. –––––– (2002). ‘What Determines “aØkara’s Authorship? The Case of the PañcÊkarana’. Philosophy East and West, Vol. 52, part 1 (January), pp. 1–35. Suthanthiran, Thiru A. Veluswamy (1986). ‘The Role of Hindu Mutts as Centres of Learning for the Tamils’. In S. V. Subramanian and V. R. Madhavan (eds), Heritage of the Tamils: Education and Vocation, pp. 191–206. Madras: International Institute of Tamil Studies.
334
bibliography
Swaminathan, K. D. (1990). Early South Indian Temple Architecture: Study of Tiruv§liávaram Inscriptions. Trivandrum: CBH Publications. Taber, John A. (1992). ‘Further Observations on Kum§rila’s BÜhaããÊk§’. Journal of Oriental Research, Madras, Vols. LVI–LXII, 1986–1992 (Dr. S. S. Janaki Felicitation Volume), pp. 178–189. Talbot, Cynthia (2003). ‘Inscribing the Other, Inscribing the Self: Muslim-Hindu Identities in Pre-Colonial India’. In Richard M. Eaton (ed.), India’s Islamic Traditions, 711–1750, pp. 83–117. Delhi: Oxford University Press. Tambiah, S. J. (1981). ‘The Renouncer: His Individuality and His Community’. Contributions to Indian Sociology (n.s.), Vol. 15, nos. 1 & 2, pp. 299–320. •aÖ·an, “rÊgovinda (1986 [V. S. 2043]). ‘Devp§ãanko “aØkar§c§rya-MaãÈ’. Viár§nti, Year 1, no. 2, Ph§gun (February/March), pp. 19–33. Tattv§loka: The Splendour of Truth, Vol. XVII, no. 4, October/November. Bombay: T. R. Ramachandran/Sri Abhinava Vidyatheertha Mahaswamigal Education Trust, 1994. Taylor, Kathleen (2001). Sir John Woodroffe, Tantra and Bengal: ‘An Indian Soul in a European Body’? Richmond, UK: Curzon. Thakur, Anantalal (1961). ‘Cannibhaããa and the Authorship of the SarvadaráanasaÒgraha’. Adyar Library Bulletin (Jubilee Volume), Vol. XXV, parts 1–4, pp. 524–538. Thapar, Romila (1981). ‘The Householder and the Renouncer in the Brahmanical and Buddhist Traditions’. Contributions to Indian Sociology (n.s.), Vol. 15, nos. 1 & 2, pp. 273–298. –––––– (1996). ‘Renunciation: The Making of a Counter-culture’. In Thapar (ed.), Ancient Indian Social History: Some Interpretations, pp. 56–93. London: Sangam Books Limited, (first pub. 1979). –––––– (1997). ‘Syndicated Hinduism’. In Günter-Dietz Sontheimer and Hermann Kulke (eds), Hinduism Reconsidered, pp. 54–82. New Delhi: Manohar, revised edn. The Theosophist [A monthly journal devoted to oriental philosophy, art, literature, occultism, etc. Conducted by H. P. Blavatsky (H. S. Olcott)], Vol. 1, no. 1–Vol. 51, no. 3, October 1879–December 1929. Bombay/Madras: Theosophical Society, 1879–1929. Thiel-Horstmann, Monika (1991). ‘On the Dual Identity of N§g§s’. In Diana L. Eck and Franáoise Mallison (eds), Devotion Divine: Bhakti Traditions from the Regions of India. Groningen: Egbert Forsten; Paris: École Française d’Extrême-Orient, pp. 255–272. [Thiel-]––– (1997). ‘Bhakti and Monasticism’. In Günter-Dietz Sontheimer and Hermann Kulke (eds), Hinduism Reconsidered, pp. 228–245. New Delhi: Manohar, revised edn. [Thiel-]––– (2001). ‘The Institutionalisation of the militant R§m§nandÊs in Jaipur (c. 1720–1800)’. Proceedings of the Royal Asiatic Society for the Conference on Asceticism and Power in the Asian Context, SOAS, University of London, March (private circulation). Thirumoolar, Siddhar (1999). Thirumandiram: A Classic of Yoga and Tantra, Vols. 1–3, trans. B. Natarajan, ed. M. Govindan. Chidambaram: Babaji’s Kriya Order of Acharyas, USA Inc. (first pub. Eastman, Quebec, Canada: Babaji’s Kriya Yoga Publications Inc., 1993). Thomas, Job (1985). ‘Cultural Developments in Tamil Nadu during the Vijayanagara Period’. In Anna Libera Dallapiccola and Stephanie Zingel-Avé Lallemant (eds), Vijayanagara – City and Empire: New Currents of Research, pp. 5–40. Stuttgart: Steiner Verlag Wiesbaden GMBH. Thrasher, Allen Wright (1979). ‘The Dates of MaÖ·ana Miára and “aÒkara’.
bibliography
335
Wiener Zeitschrift für die Kunde Südasiens und Archiv für Indische Philosophie, Band XXIII, pp. 116–139. Thurston, Edgar (1909). Castes and Tribes of Southern India, Vols. 1–8. Madras: Government Press. Tiwari, Kapil N. (1977). Dimensions of Renunciation in Advaita Ved§nta. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass. Tod, James (1914). Annals and Antiquities of Rajast’han (or, the Central and Western Rajpoot States of India) [popular edition in two volumes]. London: George Routledge & Sons Limited. Tripathi, B. D. (1978). Sadhus of India: The Sociological View. Bombay: Popular Prakashan. TulÊ, SvarÖ L§l (ed.) (2001). AnukaraÖÊya PÊãh Parampar§. Œßikeá: Kail§svidy§ Prak§áan. Tulpule, Shankar Gopal (1979). Classical Mar§ãhÊ Literature: From the Beginning to A.D. 1818 (A History of Indian Literature, Vol. IX, Fasc. 4). Wiesbaden: Otto Harrassowitz. Umesh, R. M. (1981?). Shankara’s Date. Madras: R. M. Umesh. Ungemacht, Anton (intro. and trans.) (1992). “aÒkara-Mand§ra-Saurabha: Eine Legende über das Leben des Philosophen “aÒkara (Beiträge zur Südasienforschung, SüdasienInstitut, Universität Heidelberg, Band 153). Stuttgart: Franz Steiner Verlag. Unni, N. P. (trans. and ed.) (1998). Mattavil§sa Prahasana. Delhi: Nag Publishers. Up§dhy§y, Baldev (trans.) (1967). “rÊáaØkaradigvijay (M§dhv§c§rya-viracit). Haridv§r: Mahant Mah§devn§th, “rÊ “ravaÖn§th Jñ§n Mandir, 2nd edn. Up§dhy§y, R§mkÜßÖ (n.d.). Kumbh Mah§tmya: Aur P§van TÊrth Haridv§r-Kankhal-Œßikeá. Haridv§r: RaÖdhÊr Book Sales. Uttankita Vidya Aranya Trust [UVAT] (eds) (1985). Vidy§ranya (Vol. 1, Uttankita Sanskrit Vidya-Aranya Epigraphs). Bombay: Bharatiya Vidya Bhavan. Vajr§c§rya, Dhanavajra (1980 [V. S. 2037]). ‘Madhyak§lik Nep§lk§ ek Prakhy§t R§j§ “ivadeva’. Contributions to Nepalese Sociology, Vol. 8, no. 1, December, pp. 207–222. Vajr§c§rya, Gautamavajra (1976 [V. S. 2033]). Hanum§n 4hok§ R§jdarb§r. Kathmandu: Nep§l ra Eáiy§lÊ Adhyayan SaÒsth§n, Tribhuvan-Viávavidy§lay. Vallely, Anne (2002). Guardians of the Transcendent: An Ethnography of a Jain Ascetic Community. London: Toronto University Press. Varma, Ram Kumar (1977). Kabir: Biography and Philosophy. New Delhi: Prints India. van der Veer, Peter (1987). ‘Taming the Ascetic: Devotionalism in a Hindu Monastic Order’. Man (n.s.), Vol. 22, pp. 680–695. –––––– (1997). ‘The Concept of the Ideal Brahman as an Indological Construct’. In Günter-Dietz Sontheimer and Hermann Kulke (eds), Hinduism Reconsidered, pp. 153–172. New Delhi: Manohar, revised edn. –––––– (1998). Gods on Earth: The Management of Religious Experience and Identity in a North Indian Pilgrimage Centre. London: Althone. Venkataraman, K. R. (1950). Hoysalas in the Tamil Country (12th–14th Centuries) (Annamalai University Historical Series, no. 7). Annamalainagar: The Annamalai University. –––––– (1959). The Throne of Transcendental Wisdom: “rÊ “amkar§c§rya’s “§rad§ PÊãha in “ringeri. Trichinopoly: United Printers. –––––– (1976). The Age of Vidyarana. Calcutta: Kalpa Printers and Publishers. Venkataramanayya, N. (1974). ‘Ka·umåru Inscriptions of Harihara I’. Journal of the Andhra Reserarch Society, Vol. XXXIV, parts 1–4, 1974–1975, pp. 32–38. Verghese, Anila (1995). Religious Traditions at Vijayanagara, as Revealed by its Monuments.
336
bibliography
New Delhi: American Institute of Indian Studies (Manohar). Vetter, Tilmann (1979). Studien zur Lehre und Entwicklung “aØkaras (Publications of the de Nobili Research Library, Vol. 6). Wien: Gerold & Co. Vidy§nand Giri, “rÊkail§s PÊãh§dhÊávar $c§rya Mah§maÖ·aleávar Sv§mÊ (1993). $c§r SaÒhit§. Rishikesh: Kail§svidy§ Prak§áan. Vidy§raÖya (Sv§mÊ), “rÊ (1915). “rÊvidy§raÖyaviracitaÈ “rÊmacchaØkaradigvijayaÈ (with the Advaitar§jyalakßmÊ commentary, and with the 4iÖ·im§ of Dhanapatisåri), ed. Hari N§r§yaÖa $pãe ($nand§árama Sanskrit series, no. 22). PåÖe: $nand§árama Press, 2nd. edn. –––––– (1965). Panchadashi, trans. Hari Prasad Shastri. London: Shanti Sadan, 2nd. edn. –––––– (1975). PañcadaáÊ, trans. Sw§mÊ Sw§h§nanda. Madras: Sri Ramakrishna Math. –––––– (1996). JÊvan-mukti-viveka, trans. Sw§mÊ Mokßad§nanda. Calcutta: Advaita Ashrama. Vil§sn§th, YogÊ (1998). “rÊ N§th Rahasya. Haridv§r: Akhil Bh§ratvarßiya Avdhåt Bheß B§rah Panth YogÊ Mah§sabh§. Visuvalingam, Elizabeth-Chalier (1989). ‘Bhairava’s Royal Brahmanicide: The Problem of the Mah§br§hmaÖa’. In Alf Hiltebeitel (ed.), Criminal Gods and Demon Devotees: Essays on the Guardians of Popular Hunduism, pp. 157–229. Albany: State University of New York Press. Vy§s§cala (1954). “aØkaravijaya (Madras Government Oriental Manuscripts Series, no. 24), ed. T. Chandrasekharan. Madras: Government Press. Wagle, N. K. (1997). ‘Hindu-Muslim Interactions in Medieval Maharashtra’. In Günther-Dietz Sontheimer and Hermann Kulke (eds), Hinduism Reconsidered, pp. 134–152. New Delhi: Manohar, revised edn. Wagoner, Phillip B. (1999). ‘Fortuitous Convergences and Essential Ambiguities: Transcultural Political Elites in the Medieval Deccan’. International Journal of Hindu Studies, Vol. 3, no. 3, December, pp. 241–264. –––––– (2000). ‘Harihara, Bukka, and the Sultan: The Delhi Sultanate in the Political Imagination of Vijyayanagara’. In David Gilmartin and Bruce B. Lawrence (eds), Beyond Turk and Hindu: Rethinking Religious Identities in Islamicate South Asia, pp. 300–326. Gainesville: University Press of Florida. Warden, John (1847). ‘On the Customs of Gosawees or Gosaeens’. The Madras Journal of Literature and Science, Vol. XIV, pp. 69–76. Watters, Thomas (1904–1905). On Yuan Chwang’s Travels in India, 629–645 A.D., Vols. 1–2 (Oriental Translation Fund, New Series, Vol. XIV), eds T. W. Rhys Davids and S. W. Bushell. London: Royal Asiatic Society. Werner, Karel (1989). ‘The Longhaired Sage of Œg Veda, 10.136’. In Karel Werner (ed.), The Yogi and the Mystic: Studies in Indian and Comparative Mysticism (Durham Indological Series, no. 1), pp. 33–53. Richmond, UK: Curzon Press. White, Charles S. J. (1989). ‘Mother Guru: Jnanananda of Madras, India’. In Nancy Auer Falk and Rita M. Gross (eds), Unspoken Worlds: Women’s Religious Lives, pp. 15–24. Belmont, California: Wadsworth Publishing Company. White, David Gordon (1996). The Alchemical Body: Siddha Traditions in Medieval India. Chicago/London: University of Chicago Press. –––––– (1997). ‘Mountains of Wisdom: On the Interface between Siddha and Vidy§dhara Cults and the Siddha Orders in Medieval India’. International Journal of Hindu Studies, Vol. 1, no. 1, April, pp. 73–95. –––––– (1998). ‘Transformations in the Art of Love: K§mak§la Practices in Hindu Tantric and Kaula Traditions’. History of Religions, Vol. 38, no. 2, November, pp. 172–198.
bibliography
337
–––––– (2001). ‘Yogic and Political Power Among the Nath Siddhas of North India’. Proceedings of the Royal Asiatic Society for the Conference on Asceticism and Power in the Asian Context, SOAS, University of London (private circulation). Wilke, Annette (1995). Ein Sein—Ein Erkennen (Meister Eckharts Christologie und “aÒkaras Lehre vom $tman: Zur (Un-)Vergleichbarkeit zweier Einheitslehren) (Studia Religiosa Helvetica, Series Altera, Band 2). Bern/New York: Peter Lang. Wilson, H. H. (1976). Religions of the Hindus, Vol. 1: Essays and Lectures on Religious Sects of the Hindus. Delhi: Asian Publication Services (first pub. 1861). van Woerkens, Martine (trans. Catherine Tihanyi) (2002). The Strangled Traveler: Colonial Imaginings and the Thugs of India. Chicago/London: Chicago University Press (first pub. as Le voyageur étranglé: L’Inde des Thugs, le colonialisme et l’imaginaire. Éditions Albin Michel S.A., 1995). Wright, Daniel (ed.) (1877). History of Nep§l (Translated from the Parbatiy§ by MunshÊ Shew Shunker Singh and Pandit ShrÊ Gun§nand: with an Introductory Sketch of the Country and People of Nep§l by the Editor). London: Cambridge University Press. www.countercurrents.org/comm-anand031204.htm www.countercurrents.org/comm-anand231104.htm www.hinduismtoday.com/hpi/2004/11/17.shtml [www]http://www.iacfpa.org/p_news/nit/iacpa-archieve/2004/12/03/diary103122004.html www.indiademocracy.com/resources/presidents/rvenkataraman.jsp www.industelegraph.com/story/2004/11/12/01357/717 [www]http://in.rediff.com/news/2004/nov/17agnl.htm www.mytamil.com/n/a/ arc0- 2005.shtml [www]http://newsinfo.com/2003/01/22/2201seercase.html [www]http://onlypunjab.com/fullstory2k5-insight-news-status-24-newsID-6387. html; www.outlookindia.com/ptinews.asp?id=318369 www.parliamentofindia.nic.in/rs/whoswho/vp/rvenkatraman.htm www.prabhuprem.org.in Y§jñavalkya SmÜti (The Sacred Laws of the Aryas, as Taught in the School of Yajnavalkya and Explained by Vijnesvara, in his Well-Known Commentary Named the Mitaksara, Vol. 3, The Prayaschitta Adhyaya), trans. Samarao Narasimha Naraharayya, ed. Rai Bahadur Srisa Chandra Vasu. Allahabad: SudhÊndran§tha Vasu, 1913. Yocum, Glenn E. (1990). ‘A Non-Br§hmaÖ Tamil “aiva Mutt: A Field Study of the Thiruvavaduthurai Adheenam’. In Austin B. Creel and Vasudha Narayanan (eds), Monastic Life in the Christian and Hindu Traditions: A Comparative Study, pp. 245–279. Queenston/Lampeter: The Edwin Mellen Press. –––––– (1996). ‘The Coronation of a Guru: Charisma, Politics, and Philosophy in Contemporary India. In Raymond Brady Williams (ed.), A Sacred Thread: Modern Transmissions of Hindu Traditions in India and Abroad, pp. 68–91. New York: Columbia University Press. Young, Katherine K. (1987). ‘Hinduism’. In Arvind Sharma (ed.), Women in World Religions, pp. 59–103. Albany: State University of New York Press. Zarrilli, Phillip B. (1998). When the Body Becomes All Eyes: Paradigms, Discourses and Practices in Kalarippayattu, a South Indian Martial Art. Delhi: Oxford University Press. Zvelebil, Kamil (1973). The Smile of Murugan: On Tamil Literature of South India. Leiden: E. J. Brill. Zydenbos, Robert J. (2001). ‘Madhva and the Reform of VaißÖavism in Karnataka’.
338
bibliography
In Vasudha Dalmia, Angelika Malinar, and Martin Christof (eds), Charisma and Canon, pp. 113–128. New Delhi: Oxford University Press. Zysk, Kenneth G. (1998). Asceticism and Healing in Ancient India: Medicine in the Buddhist Monastery. Delhi: Motilal Banarsidass (first pub. 1991).
index
339
INDEX Abhay R§m D§s, B§b§, 54n.7, 249n.74 Abhinava NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ V (17th cent.), 135, 136, 137 Abhinava Saccid§nanda, 126 Abhinava Saccid§nandatÊrtha, 139, 140 Abhinava “aØkara, 126n.91 Abhinava Vidy§tÊrtha, 144 Abhinavagupta, 159n.49, 228n.4 Abu Bakr, 243 Abu-l-Faíl, 62, 228 §c§rya-guru(s) (Daáan§mÊ): arising of institution of, 78n.74; as Mah§maÖ·aleávara, 76–78; initiation by, 39, 48, 68, 93–96, 98, 122; of Agni akh§Ü§, 60 Acyutar§ya, 195, 201 Adhokßaj§nanda, 142n.148 $di Kumbheávara (temple), 201 advaita maãha(s), 8n.36, 25, 105, 114, 124– 47, 170, 176 Advaitar§jya-LakßmÊ (of Acyåta), 149n.5 Advay§nandasarasvatÊ, 226n.152 Afíal Kh§n, 236 §gama(s), 109n.15, 120, 160, 181n.16, 184, 187n.39, 188n.43, 189, 191, 202, 210n.114, 221, 222 Agastya, 120n.76, 187n.39 Aghora “iva, 187n.39 agnicayana, 88n.28 Ahirbudhnya SaÒhit§, 168n.74 Ahmad “§h, 63, 250 $jÊvika(s), 11n.57, 12, 228n.2 AkalaØka, 111n.26, 112n.34, 113n.40 Akbar, 62, 64n.40, 228, 229, 230, 234 n.25, 237, 240, 244n.57, 249n.74, 296n.33, 298 akh§Ü§(s), 17n.73, 23, 25, 28, 29n.6, 30n.10, 36, 39–44, 47, 48, 52, 86, 90, 227, 229, 230, 231, 245n.62, 246, 247, 261, 262, 267, 268, 269, 287n.3, 288, 294n.25, 299; §c§ryaguru-s in, 77, 78; affiliation to, 43, 44, 45; caste in, 39–40; definition of, 47; equipment of s§dhu-s in, 36; fights between, 61–65; for wrestling, 47n.86; founding of, 57–59, 61; initiation by, 93–98; location of/scheme of, 57–59; m§Ê-s in, 49–50; membership
of, 49–51; order of bathing for, 64– 65n.52; relationships in, 50–51; voting procedures in, 69 Agni, 1n.6, 47n.85, 49, 50, 60, 66n.43, n.45; functionaries in, 75n.66 $nanda, 49, 77 Aãal, 49, 77; funcionaries in, 75n.66 $v§han, 49, 77; functionaries in, 75n.66 (GådaÜa), 49, 66 Jån§, 42n.71, 46, 47, 49, 66, 67, 74, 78n.74,168n.74, 249 n.74; §c§ryaguru-s of, 77; camps at Kumbh Me l§s, 71n.58; functionaries, 75n.66; initiation into, 90–98; m§Ês in, 34–35, 49, 50n.96; number of initiates, 30n.11; paramahaÒsa-s affiliated to, 42n.71; property of, 261n.110 Mah§nirv§ÖÊ, 45, 47, 48, 49, 69n.56, 73, 74, 91n.39, 93n.44, 99n.57, 121n.79; female Mah§maÖ·aleávara in, 34n.33; Mah§maÖ·aleávaras of, 48, 76; §c§rya-guru-s of, 77; paramahaÒsa-s affiliated to, 42n.71; property of, 75 NirañjanÊ, 40, 42n.71, 49, 93n.44; §c§rya-guru-s of, 77; Mah§maÖ·eávaras of, 76; paramahaÒsa-s affiliated to, 42n.71 (RåkhaÜa)/(SåkhaÜa)/(—khaÜa), 66 Akhil Bh§ratÊ Kh§ls§, 55n.7 Akhil Bh§ratÊya Akh§Ü§ Parißad, 76 Alakhiya(s), 66 Al-Bad§oni, 62n.34 Alberuni, 10 ‘Ali, 243n.52, 244n.54 Ali Bah§dur, 250 All World Religions’ Federation, 263 n.116 All World Sadhus’ Federation, 263n.116 Allahabad, 37, 42, 65, 144, 251, 257, 262n.115, n.116, 158n.47, 175n.103, 295, 298n.41; akh§Ü§-s at, 57–59, 75; branch of Jyotir maãha at, 143n.149; Daáan§mÊs at, 29; fixing of order of bathing at, 64; Kumbh Mel§ at, 23n.92, 30n.11, 34, 48n.88, 53, 60,
340
index
138n.137, 141–42n.146, 287–98; M§gh Mel§ at, 40n.62, 42, 201n.86, 253n.85 All-India Hindu Sabh§, 141n.146 All-India San§tana Dharma Mah§sammelan, 138n.137, 142n.146 al-Qasim, Ibn, 232n.17 $lv§r(s), 168, 180 ¨ Amal§nanda, 123n.84 Amaradaki maãha, 176n.103, 187n.39, n.40 Amaruka (king), 152n.20, 155n.33 AmÊr Khwurd, 234n.25 Amma II, 186n.34 ammaÖ shrines, 220 §mn§ya(s), 72, 114 $nanda M§yÊ M§, 32 $nandabodha, 113, 123n.84, 126n.92, 219n.138 $nandabodh§árama (20th cent.), 145 n.161, 146 $nandadeva, 176n.103 $nandagiri, 123n.24, 86n.84, 149n.5, n.6, 163 $nandatÊrtha. See Madhva Antarkar, W. R., 24, 149 Anåp Giri, 249–51 Appar, 165, 180n.9, n.11, 181n.17, 219, 220 Appaya DÊkßit§, 107, 221n.120, 226n.155 §raÖyaka. See vanaprastha §raÖyaka(s) (texts), 7 Arjun Dev, Guru, 175 Arthaá§stra (of Kauãilya), 10n.51, 11 Asaf ud-Daulah, 249n.74 $sandi-n§·, 186n.34 ascetics/asceticism, 2, 4–12, 12n.61, 19 n.85, 20n.87, 21n.89, 23, 24, 25, 26, 36n.41, 37, 43, 53n.2, 61, 63, 67, 115, 151, 189, 244n.56, 254n.89, 255, 256, 261n.111, 267, 295, 296, 297; as spies, 11n.58; orgins of, 5n.19; rules for, 4n.15, 19–21; áaiva ascetics, 12, 67n.47, 170, 176n.103, 177, 178; statistics on, 29n.10, 30n.11, 41, 49, 256n.97; status in law, 259n.106 §árama system, 4n.17 Aßãadhy§yÊ. See P§Öini $tmabodhendra, 129n.106, 149n.5 Aurangzeb, 61n.31, 231n.15, 237, 238, 240, 242, 251, 295 Aurobindo (Aravinda Ghoßa), 142n.146 $vaÖi maãha, 133, 136–37, 207n.107
Ayas Dev N§th, 228n.4 B§dar§yaÖa, 162, 168 BadarÊn§th, 2 Bader, Jonathan, 24, 149 Bah§’uddÊn Naqshband, 240n.44 bahådaka(s), 87n.26, 101 Bair§gÊ/Vair§gÊ. See R§m§nandÊ B§l§nand, 54n.7, 247n.69, 250n.77 Ballala III, 197, 202n.87 BaÏÏig§ve, 189–90 Banaras, 29, 31n.14, 32, 34n.33, 37, 43n.31, 89n.33, n.35, 132n.115, 139, 143, 187n.37, 248, 257, 260, 261 nn.111–12, 262; Daáan§mÊs at, 41– 44; maãha-s at, 29, 31n.14, 49–50, 57–59, 66, 144–46, 173n.89, 188n.40, 192n.55; Mah§maÖ·aleávaras at, 77 n.72; s§dhu-s at, 29n.10 Bande Mataram, 255 Bankim Chandra Chatterji, 255 Basava, 152n.20, 190, 199n.79 Basavappa N§yaka II, 134 Bardesmanes (of Babylon), 10 Bassein, Treaty of, 251 Belvalkar, S. K., 105n.4 Bentick, Lord William, 255 Besant, Annie, 145n.161 Bhadrak§lÊ, 49n.91, 118, 145n.162, 165, 170 BhagavadgÊt§: “aØkar§c§rya’s commentary on, 106, 107, 162, 164 Bhagavantn§th, 248 Bh§gavata(s). See P§ñcar§tra Bhagavat§nanda, 47 Bh§Ê Pheru, 56.10 Bhairava, 32, 58, 67, 178, 238n.38 Bhaktam§la, 54n.7 245 bh§l§(s), 59, 71n.58, 116 Bh§matÊ (of V§caspatimiára), 106n.5, 112 n.31, 113, 124n.84 bh§Øg, 37, 47, 240 Bh§ratÊkÜßÖatÊrtha (20th cent.), 138, 141, 142 Bh§ratÊtÊrtha (14th cent.), 202–17, 225 Bh§ratÊtÊrtha (20th cent.), 79n.77 BhartÜhari, 109, 110n.19, 112 Bh§skara, 159n.49, 162 bhasm(a). See vibhåti Bhavya, 109n.14, 110n.20, 112n.34, 113 n.41 Bhikߧ maãha, 188n.40 bhikßu(s), 4n.15, 7, 156
index BhÜgu(s), 6n.21, 120, 245 Bijapur, 194, 232, 233, 234, 238, 239, 240, 241 Bijjala (king), 183n.20, 190, 199n.79 BijjaÖa Devarasa, 185n.34 Bhogan§tha, 210, 222 Bijay Singh, 229n.11 BJP (Bh§ratÊya Jant§ Party), 263 brahmac§rÊ(s), 46, 60, 78n.74, 89, 93, 97n.53, 140; name(s), 1n.6, 42, 47 n.85, 60, 268; rules for 97n.52 Brahm§ KumarÊ(s), 33 Brahm§nandasarasvatÊ (16th cent.), 124 n.84, 226 Brahm§nandasarasvatÊ (20th cent.), 143 Brahmasiddhi (of MaÖ·anamiára), 113, 123n.84, 166 Brahma-såtra-bh§ßya (of “aØkar§c§rya), 106, 107, 109, 113 br§hmaÖa(s) (texts), 7; tapas in, 36n.41 br§hmaÖa(s)/Brahmans: and renunciation, 38–40; as ascetics, 9–10; divisions of, 39n.57, 40n.63, 120, 156n.35 Brahmendra maãha, 146 bratabandha, 19n.82, 20, 21 BÜhaspati (Jupiter), and the Kumbh Mel§, 287–94 BÜhat-“aØkaravijaya (BÜhaccaØkaravijaya) (of Brahm§nadasarasvatÊ), 150n.12 BÜhat-“aØkaravijaya (BÜhaccaØkaravijaya) (of Citsukha), 130n.106, 149n.5 Bronkhorst, Johannes, 5n.19 Buddhaghoßa, 113n.41 Buddhism/Buddhist(s), 1n.3, 12, 70n.57, 87n.26, 109n.14, 112, 120n.73, 182, 184, 216, 296, 297n.37; hagiography, 153n.27; in “aØkara-dig-vijaya, 127 n.98, 158n.47; in south India, 113, 114n.41, 177, 179–181, 200n.83; monasteries, 183, 190; “aØkar§c§rya’s attitude to, 162, 167 Buddhist monk(s), 7n.25, 8n.35, 10n.50 Bukka I, 78n.75, 194–95, 197, 198, 200 n.81, 203, 205, 206n.103, 207, 209, 210n.114, nn.116–17, 211–13, 216; religious conversion of, 196–97 Bukka II, 195, 211, 217 Burghart, Richard, 14–15n.68, 266 Caitanya, 14n.67, 54n.7, 157n.40, 259 n.107, 296 Cakradhar, 152n.20, 235n.27
341
Cakrap§Öi (temple), 201 Caliph(s): SåfÊ descent from, 242–43 C§Ïukya: patronage of religions, 180 Campantar (Sambandar), 165, 180n.9, 220 Candrabhåáana (Kriy§áakti), 198 Candracå·a, 206 Candraáekharabh§ratÊ II (15th cent.), 125, 217 CandraáekharasarasvatÊ (=Candracå·asarasvatÊ) (16th cent.), 130, 131 CandraáekharasarasvatÊ (18th cent.), 132n.116 CandraáekharendrasarasvatÊ (16th cent.), 91 CandraáekharendrasarasvatÊ (19th cent.), 132n.116 CandraáekharendrasarasvatÊ (20th cent.), 5, 126n.91, 264n.119 Cannibhaããa, 198, 210n.114 C§rvaka(s), 12 catuÈ samprad§ya, 54–55n.7, 229n.10 Chishti(s) (SåfÊs), 234, 239, 241, 243n.51, 244n.57, 245n.58 ‘Churning of the Ocean of Milk’ (kßÊr§bdhmanthana), 289–90 Cid§nanda, Sv§mÊ, 263n.116 Cikka, 207 Cint§maÖi maãha, 137n.135, 216n.128 Cinm§y§nanda, Sv§mÊ, 263n.116 Citsukha(§carya), 113, 123n.84, 126n.92, 130n.106, 149n.5 CÙÏa: patronage of religions, 182–87 Congress Party, 262 coãÊ (‘top-knot’), 35, 86–87, 89n.32 Cuntarar (Sundarar), 180n.9, 183n.20, 220 Cynic(s), 179n.6 Dabist§n, 62, 175, 240, 243 D§då (panth), 13, 54n.7, 61; militant organisation, 228, 231 daÖ·a, 28, 89n.32, 95; in initiation procedure, 93–94, 96–98; kinds of, 86– 87, 93n.45, 97n.52 daÖ·Ê(s), 23, 28, 46, 50, 52, 60, 89, 96, 98, 103, 294n.25; and the maÜhÊ system, 68, 69n.56; caste of, 40; female, 34n.33; initiation by, 78n.74; initiation of, 90n.36, 93,122; lineages of, 39 Daáan§mÊ(s): as priests, 18; meaning of, 1; numbers of, 29–30; women, 31–35
342
index
Datt§treya, 58, 67, 71n.58, 90, 91, 117 n.53, 155n.32, 168n.74, 175n.102, 235 devar§ja, 186n.36 Devar§ya I, 195, 197, 198n.75 Devar§ya II, 195, 198, 199n.79, 200, 217, 235, 236n.30; patronage of religions by, 200 Devcand, 237 Devendravarman (king), 186n.34 Dharma Giri, 252n.83 Dharma SaØgha “Êkߧ MaÖ·ala, 43 DharmakÊrti, 109, 110, 111n.28, 112, 114n.41 Dharmap§la, 110n.20, 112n.41 Dharmapuram maãha, 188n.43 dharmaá§stra, 4, 79, 80; §árama system in, 4–5n.17; penances in, 84n.16; renunciation procedures in, 82; renunciation and caste in, 38–39; rules for renunciates in, 100; saÒny§sÊ in, 7–8, 23 dharmasåtra(s), 23; penances in, 84n.16; renunciation procedures in, 81–83; Üßi-s in, 120; rules for brahmac§rin in, 97n.52; rules for renunciates in, 4n.15, 100; saÒny§sÊ in, 8; Dholka maãha, 78, 139, 143 dhånÊ(s), 48, 51n.100, 66n.43, 67, 67n.48, 71, 91, 92, 229n.8; four, 116 dhånÊv§l§(s), 74 digambara(s), 51 Digambara anÊ, 54, 65n.42 Dign§ga, 109, 110nn.18–19, n.22, n.26, 112, 113n.41 digvijaya: of “aØkar§c§ryas, 134–36 dÊkߧ, 1, 16, 76, 97, 158; from áaiva guru-s, 185–86 4iÖ·ima (of Dhanapatisåri), 148–49nn.4– 5 Divine Life Society, 263n.116 Dumont, Louis, 8nn.36–37, 14–15n.68, 154n.29, 266 Durbeávara maãha, 77n.72 Durg§, 87n.25, 165, 170, 220n.141, 224 Durv§sa, 176n.103, 187nn.39–40 Durv§spur maãha, 139 Dv§rak§ (maãha/pÊtÈa), 2, 41n.66, 60n.30, 79, 89n.35, 115, 118, 123, 124, 126, 127, 128, 131, 132n.115, 138, 139– 40, 146n.163, 147, 150, 171n.83, 223,
227; in hagiographies, 159n.49, 172, 173; maãh§mn§ya of, 118 fakÊr(s)/phakÊr(s), 14n.67, 19n.85, 30n.11, 63, 228, 230, 240n.43, 259, 261n.111, 296, 338 GaÖapatideva (king), 186n.34 Gandhi, M. K., 256n.95, 263 GaÖeáa (GaÖapati), 49n.91, 58, 86n.23, 87n.25, 164–165, 197, 217, 219, 223, 238n.38 GaØg§ DevÊ, 194n.64 GaØg§ M§, 32 GaØg§ S§gar, 29n.6, 55n.8, 253n.85, 288n.6 Gangohi, Abd al-Quddås, 241 Garu·a, 291n.16 Gau·ap§da, 109, 152n.24, 164, 167, Gau·ap§dÊya-k§rik§, 107, 108n.9, 109, 152n.24 Gau·Êya (sect), 13, 14n.67, 54n.7, 162, 236 GaurÊ M§, 33n.28 G§yatrÊ, 59 g§yatrÊ mantra, 83nn.9–10, 91n.39, 93, 95, 101n.62 gharb§rÊ(s), 14, 15, 16n.73, 17, 20, 21, 22 gh§zÊ(s), 232, 239 GÊt§ Mandir, 47 Gobind Singh, Guru, 56n.9, 228n.7 Gokhale, VißÖub§v§ Brahmac§rÊ, 142n. 146 gol§, 59n.25, 91n.39 GÙÏakÊ/Goll§ maãha(s), 176n.103, 187– 88nn.39–40, 192n.55, 211n.120 Gop§l Rao, 250 GopÊn§tha (temple), 207 Gorakhn§th, 56n.11, 66–67n.46, 152n. 20, 155n.33 gosain(s),14, 16, 17, 18, 21, 22, 53n.3, 63, 129n.103, 141, 228n.6, 230, 232, 239, 252; definition of, 14, 177n.107; divorce by, 17–18n.78; numbers of, 30n.11; property of, 261n.111 gotra, 16, 17n.76, 60, 116, 118, 119, 268; in Buddhism and Jainism, 120nn. 73–74 Govardhan (maãha/pÊãha at PurÊ), 2, 41n. 66, 115, 121, 126n.92, 127n.99, 128n. 103, 140–42, 147, 227; maãh§mn§ya of, 118
index Govinda(§c§rya), 107, 116n.46, 151, 152, 158 Govinda maãha, 77n.72 Govind§nand, 248n.69 Govindapadi maãha, 183n.22 GovindasarasvatÊ, 226n.154 Gregory (of Tours), 154 gÜhastha(s), 5, 17n.76, 18, 97n.52, 192n. 57 Gurd§s, Bh§Ê, 175 Gurdita, B§b§, 56n.9, 245 gurumukha rite, 19n.82 GuruvaÒáa-k§vya (of LakßmaÖa-“§stri), 123 n.84, 125, 149; maãha-s in, 145–46 Hacker, Paul, 105n.4, 163–64 haÒsa(s), 87n.26, 100–1 HaÖ·iy§ B§b§, 45–46 Hanum§n, 47n.86, 49n.91, 243n.53, Haradatta, 159n.49, 222 Harby§sÊ, 54n.7 Hardwicke, Captain Thomas, 63 Hargobind, Guru, 56n.9 Haribhadrasåri, 112 Haridv§r, 23n.92, 37, 59n.26, 62, 63, 65n.41, 230, 265, 288, 289, 291, 292; Daáan§mÊs at, 29; female renouncers at, 34; maãha-s at, 29, 42n.69, 48n.88, 53n.2, 75, 76, 77n.73; mel§ at, 30n.11, 57–59, 64, 65, 287n.3, 293, 294, 295, 297, 298n.41; R§m§nandÊ initiations at, 55n.8 Harihara I, 194, 195, 196, 197, 202, 205, 209n.111, 210, 210n.114, n.116, 212, 213, 217; religious conversion of, 196 Harihara II, 78n.75, 195, 197, 198n.75, 200, 207, 208, 209n.111, 210n.114, 211, 212, 213 Harihar§nand§raÖya, 225n.151 Harßa(deva), 228n.2 Harßa Vardhana, 296 Harßdeo Joái, 248 Hasan al-Basri, 243n.52, 244n.55, n.57 Hasan, Ala-uddÊn, 234 Hast§malaka, 117n.53, 118, 119, 123n.83, 127n.97, 150n.13, 153n.26, 172, 173 n.90; works of, 106n.5, 219 Hastings, Warren, 252n.84, 253 haãha-yoga, 36, 46n.81, 229n.8 Heesterman, Jan, 5n.19 Hindu: first use of term, 236 Hindu Mah§sabh§, 138, 142, 256n.95
343
Hüang Tsang, 10, 114n.41, 295, 296 HujwÊrÊ, Shaikh al-, 212n.18, 244n.56 Ibrahim II, Sultan, 238 Imma·i NarasiÒha, 195 Irugappa DaÖ·an§yaka, 200n.81 jagadguru(s), 13, 79, 80, 122, 238; female, 34n.30 (Jagad)guru-ratna-m§lastava (of Sad§áivabrahmendra), 129n.106, 149n.5 Jagann§tha (temple), 141, 172; visit of R§m§nuja to, 168–69n.75 Jagann§th§árama, 226 Jah§ngir, 14n.67, 62n.34, 228n.6, 237n. 34, 241 Jain(a)(s)/Jainism, 1n.3, 101, 112, 113, 159n.49, 162, 182, 217, 237, 184n.25, 186n.34, 191, 200, 201n.85; ascetics, 7n.25, 9, 12, 19n.85; in south India, 113, 177, 179–81, 215–16; maãha-s, 183, 190; “vet§mbara gaccha-s/kula-s, 245; women, 31n.17, 32n.25 Jaisingh II, 247 Jam§t, 55n.8, 74, 75, 76, 90, 231 Jan SaØgh, 142 Janakpur, 18, 128n.101, 253n.85 janeå (sacred thread), 35, 91 JaØgambari maãha, 261n.111 Jasvant Singh, 229n.11 j§t(Ê), 19–20, 38n.52 JavahÊr Singh, 250 Jayalalit§, J., 265, 266 Jayaprak§á Malla, 248, 258 JayatÊrtha, 200n.80, 226 JayendrasarasvatÊ, 130, 263n.116, 264; arrest of, 264–66 Jel§li(s) (SåfÊs), 62n.36 Jesuit(s), 238n.39 JÊvanmuktiviveka (of Vidy§raÖya), 10n.51, 82n.5, 85n.21, 101–2n.66, 204n.95, 209n.112 Jñ§n§ndasarasvatÊ, 34 Junaidi, Shaikh Siraj-uddÊn, 234 Jyeßãh§, 220n.141 Jyoáimaãh/Jyotir (maãha/pÊãha), 2, 41n.66, 77–78, 115, 117n.53, 120, 121, 127n. 97, n.99, 139, 140, 141, 143–44, 146, 150, 264; in hagiographies, 172; maãh§mn§ya of, 118–19 KabÊr, 231n.16; Bijaka of, 228n.3. kalari-payattu, 49n.91
344
index
Kail§s $áram, 46 Kail§sa (mountain), 155nn.32–33, 289 K§l§mukha(s), 179, 183, 184, 190, 191, 192n.55, 201, 208, 215, 221, 222, 223; branches of, 189; maãha-s, 184n. 27, 190; r§ja-guru-s, 185n.34, 186, 197, 198, 210, 221 K§laãi, 108n.13, 136, 152 K§makoãÊ pÊãha. See K§ñcÊpuram pÊãha K§m§kßÊ, 119, 220, 223 KamalaáÊla, 109n.14, 110n.19, 111n.29, 112 Kampa I & II, 194n.63, 210 K§ñcÊpuram, 113nn.40–41; bhakta saints in, 180n.8; “aØkar§c§rya’s disappearance at, 155n.32 K§ñcÊpuram (maãha/pÊãha), 2, 41n.65, 115, 128–33, 137, 147, 167, 193, 200n.83, 206, 208, 215, 219, 220, 221, 225, 227, 264, 266, 268; landholdings of, 79n.78, 133n.120, 265; in hagiographies of “aØkar§c§rya, 150, 171 K§nphaãa. See N§th Kany§ Kum§rÊ Sth§n, 34n.30 K§p§lÊka(s), 67n.48, 162, 179, 183; in “aØkara-dig-vijaya, 127n.98, 159; maãhas, 140n.141 KaravÊra maãha. See “aØkeávara maãha/ pÊãha k§rb§rÊ(s), 74, 75, 90, 98 KarmaÖda, 4n.15 Karpatri (Sv§mÊ Harihar§nandasarasvatÊ), 143, 146 K§áÊ. See Banaras K§áÊvil§sa (Kriy§áakti $c§rya), 197, 198, 212 Kaáyapa, 118, 120, 121, 187n.39, 245 Kathmandu: Daáan§mÊs at, 57n.13, 58, 175, 176n.103, 248, 258, 297n.40 Ked§reávara (temple), 190 Ked§rn§th: “aØkar§c§rya’s disappearance at, 155n.32 keáin, 6n.20 kh§nq§h(s), 233, 234nn.24–25, 240n.43, 241–42 khil§fat system, 233 Khw§ja Ahr§r, 240n.44 Khw§ja Muinud Chishti, 239 Kitab-i Nauras, 238n.38 Ko·iya maãha, 190, 198 KoÊl Ol ugu, 167, 168, 197n.69 ¨ Koteávara (temple), 186n.34
koãv§l(s), 74, 75n.66, 93, 98 Kriy§áakti Deva, 186n.34, 198 Kriy§áakti O·eya, 198n.75 Kriy§áakti PaÖ·ita, 185n.34, 198 KÜßÖa, 162; life of, 154n.29 KÜßÖabodh§árama, 143 KÜßÖadevar§ya, 130, 137, 195, 199n.78, 201, 207n.107, 216n.128 KÜßÖ§nanda, 47 KÜßÖappa N§yaka, 134 KÜßÖar§ja Wodeyar, 125 KÜty§kalpataru (of Bhaããa LakßmÊdhara), 288n.5 kßatriya(s), 15, 19, 49n.91, 54n.7, 93n.45, 97nn.51–52, 181, 193, 230; and renunciation, 38, 39n.56; and royal consecration, 158 Kubrawi(s) (SåfÊs), 244n.57 Kulaáekhara III, 215 Kullå: saÒny§sÊ-s at, 16–17nn.73–74 KulotttuØga (king), 186n.34 Kum§ra, 153n.26, 223 Kum§ra Kampana, 78n.75, 194 Kum§rila (Bhaããa), 110, 111nn.26–28, 123–24n.84, 127n.98, 151n.16, 153n.26, 158, 217; “aØkar§c§rya’s meeting with, 158n.47, 166; school of, 168 Kumbh Mel§(s), 23n.92, 76, 77, 264; akh§Ü§-s at, 47, 53, 55n.8, 56, 57n.16, 59, 60, 65, 73, 74, 229n.9; camping of Daáan§mÊs at, 70–71; initiation at, 23, 30n.11, 48, 49, 51, 78n.74, 79, 90, 93, 97, 98; maÜhÊ-s at, 69, 70n.57; m§Ê-s at, 34; meetings of organisations at, 138n.137, 141–42n.146, 263n.116; order of bathing at, 55n.7, 65n.42 Kumbhakonam maãha, 80, 131n.113, 132–33, 136n.130 Kumudacandra-bhaãã§rakadeva, 215 Kuntu N§tha, 200n.81 Kuppuswami, A, 129 Kurkoti, Dr., 138 kuãÊcaka(s), 87n.26, 99n.57, 101–2 Kw§ãhaÖ·o maãha, 21n.90 LakßmÊ, 220n.141, 224 L§kulÊáa, 153, 154, 178, 183n.24, 184n. 29, 190n.47, 245 LiØg§yat(s). See VÊraáaiva(s) Lorenzen, David N., 67n.48, 209n.114
index Ma’bari Khandyat, 233n.20 MachlÊbandar Maãh, 40n.63, 42, 89n.33, n.35, 96n.50 Mad§ri(s) (SåfÊs), 62n.36, 228, 240, 253nn.85–86 M§dhav Rao Scindia, 250n.78 M§dhav Singh, 248 M§dhava (mantrin), 198 M§dhava(s): identity of, 202, 208–14, works of, 209 M§dhav§árama, 140 MadhusådanasarasvatÊ, 85n.21, 89n.31, 124n.84, 174, 175, 226, 230 MadhusådanatÊrtha, 138 Madhva, 54–55n.7, 107, 157, 159, 160, 167, 169, 198n.74, 199, 210n.120, 213n.124, 223n.148, 225–26, 229n. 11; hagiographies of, 152n.20, 157nn. 39–40; maãha-s and disciples of, 199– 200n.80, 201n.84; names of, 225 M§gh Mel§(s), 29n.92, 35, 40n.62, 96n. 50, 201n.86, 253n.85, 292, 294n.25, 298, 299 Mah§bh§rata, 88n.29; ascetics in, 7n.28, 11n.58, 25n.41, 101; P§áupatas in, 177 Mah§dev§nandatÊrtha, 145 Mah§dev§nandatÊrtha VI, 145n.161 Mah§devasarasvatÊ (16th cent.), 130 Mah§devasarasvatÊ (19th cent.), 132n.115 Mah§devendrasarasvatÊ (16th cent.), 149n.8, 206 Mah§devendrasarasvatÊ (18th cent.), 132n.116 Mah§m§gham/Mah§maham (festival), 136n.130, 201n.86, 294n.27 Mah§maÖ·aleávara(s), 13, 43n.74, 56n. 10, 60, 191; female, 34, 59n.28; funerals of, 37; initiation from, 41, 42, 46, 48, 93 mahant(s) (Daáan§mÊ), 13, 49, 59, 60, 63, 69, 71n.58, 73, 79, 89, 98, 129n.103, 145, 146, 228, 246, 257, 259, 260, 261n.111, 288, 299; and property rights, 21n.90, 44, 191; as temple managers, 18, 27, 67; election of, 51, 74–75; female, 34; funerals of, 37; R§m§nandÊ, 55n.8, 74n.63; rules for, 99n.57 Mah§nubh§va(s), 70n.57, 152n.20, 235n. 27 Mah§nuá§sanam. See Maãh§mn§ya
345
mah§v§kya(s), 66 Mahendravarman I, 180 Maheá Yogi, Mah§Üßi (Maharishi Mahesh Yogi), 143n.153 Maheávara(s), 162, 163, 178, 184n.30, 216, 218, 222, Maheávar§nanda, 146 m§Ê. See women renouncers MaitreyÊ, 10n.51 Makar(a) SaØkr§nti, 63, 135n.128, 287n. 3, 288n.6, 292 Malik Kufår, 194n.64, 233n.20 Malla(s) (dynasty of Nepal), Jayasthiti, 19n.84; “ivadeva, 176n.103 Mallik§rjuna (king), 195, 217 M§n Singh, 228n.4, 229n.7 MaÖ·anamiára, 110, 111, 112, 113, 123–24n.84, 152n.20, 153n.26, 158, 172n.84, 220; “aØkar§c§rya’s meeting with, 166 M§Öikkav§cakar, 180n.9 Mañju “§h, 252n.83 Manu. See ManusmÜti Manucci, Niccolau, 296 ManusmÜti, 7–8; final sacrifice in, 88n.27; renunciation and caste in, 38; renunciation procedures in, 83n.8 M§rappa, 194, 198, 210n.116, 212 maÜhÊ(s), 50n.97, 60, 90, 116 maãha(s), 2, 41–44; definition of, 3n.12; fi nances of, 260; legitimacy of, 122–47; of women renouncers, 31–34; property rights of, 44n.77, 261n.111 Maãh§mn§ya(s), 24, 26, 41n.66, 103, 170, 173, 174, 207n.107, 225, 227, 245n.58, 246, 268, 269; K§ñcÊpuram pÊãha in, 131–132; in legal cases, 133n.121, 139, 142n.148; Sumeru pÊãha in, 144–45 Maãh§mn§yasetu. See Maãh§mn§ya Maãh§mn§yastotra. See Maãh§mn§ya Maãh§mn§yaá§sanam. See Maãh§mn§ya Maãh§mn§yopanißat. See Maãh§mn§ya MaãhetivÜtta. See Maãh§mn§ya Matsyendran§th, 155n.33 Mattamayåra(s), 187n.40; 192, 215, 221; r§ja-guru-s, 186 Maulawi(s) (SåfÊs), 243 MaunÊ Am§vasy§, 287nn.2–3 Mayeda, Sengaku, 105–6n.4, 108n.9 Megasthen¿s, 9, 11
346
index
Megh§c§rya, 185n.34 MeykaÖã§r, 189 Mieselbach, Colonel John, 251 MÊr§b§Ê, 31n.15 Mirza Najaf Kh§n, 250n.78 Mohan Cand, 248 mokßa, 3, 37n.47 monk, 3n.12 Motit Giri, 252n.83 MÜtyuñj§ya maãha, 77n.72 Muddappa, 194n.63 Muhammad $dil “§h, 238–39 Muhammad bin Tughluq, 234n.24 Muhammad “§h BahmanÊ, 234 Mu’Ên al-DÊn Chishti, 161n.25 Målab§gala maãha, 132n.115, 139 Muluki Ain, 19, 21n.89 muÖ·in, 6 muni, 7 Musa “§h, 252n.83
Olivelle, Patrick, 4–6n.19
N§·uvile maãha, 138 n§g§(s), 14, 23, 26, 28, 35, 46, 53, 67n.47, 75, 90, 240, 259, 262, 269; female, 34, 49; initiation, 78n.74; 90n.36, 289; lineages, 39, 72n.60; organisation, 57–59, 68–69, 229–31; procession of, 59; R§m§nandÊ, 55n.8 Naißkarmyasiddhi (of Sureávara), 106, 218 Nakshbandi(s), 240–41, 244n.57 Nambådiri(s), 138, 151 NarasiÒha Deva, 186n.34 NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ (16th cent.), 134n.124 NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ (18th cent.), 134 NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ (19th cent.), 135 NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ (20th cent.), 216n.128 NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ VIII, 125, 135, 136n. 130 NarasiÒhasarasvatÊ (15th cent.), 235n.26 NarasiÒhasarasvatÊ (16th cent.), 226 NarasiÒh§árama (16th cent.), 85n.21 NarasiÒh§árama (16th cent.), 226 NarasiÒhavarman I, 180 NarasiÒhavarman II (R§jasiÒha), 181 N§r§yaÖa: “aØkar§c§rya’s concept of, 160–162 N§r§yaÖapåjyap§da, 212n.124 N§sik: gosain-s at, 17, N§th(s), 25, 35, 56, 61, 66–67, 70n.57, 152n.20, 200, 229n.8, 240, 249n.74; militant organisation, 228; numbers of, 30n.11; twelve divisions of, 243n.53
Padmap§da, 106, 112n.31, 118, 123n.83, 127n.97, 141, 145n.161, 150n.13, 153n.26, 163; in hagiographies, 171– 72, 173n.90; religious orientation of, 218–19; works of, 106n.5 Padmasambhava, 70n.57 Pallava: patronage of religions, 180–81, 182n.18 Pamp§devÊ, 198, 205n.98, 224 PañcadaáÊ (of Vidy§raÖya), 204n.95, 214n. 126 P§ñcaliØga maãha, 190n.49 P§ñcar§tra,n 159n.51, 160–62, 167–69, 177, 181n.16, 199n.80, 222 Pañc§rtha-bh§ßya (of KauÖ·inya), 178 pañcayatana-påj§, 223 pañc-guru-saÒsk§r, 23, 116 Panchen L§m§, 256n.96 PaÖ·arideva (O·eya), 203n.92, 205 PaÖ·ita Deva, Kriyaáakti, 185n.34 P§Ö·ya: patronage of religions, 180 P§Öini, 4n.15, 11 panthÊ, 71 paramahaÒsa(s), 23, 28, 29, 51, 53, 75, 81, 85n.22, 90, 93, 209n.112, 263, 267, 268; definition of, 87n.26, 101–2; female, 34, 43; initiation of, 41, 47, 78n.74, 89n.32, 90n.36, 93n.44, 96, 97, 98–99; lineages of, 39, 68; maãha-s at Banaras, 41n.66, 43, 261n.111 Param§rtha-s§ra (of $diáeßa), 166
N§thamuni, 54n.7, 167 Navar§tri, 13n.64, 223 N§yaÖ§r(s), 181–82 NihaØg(s), 229nn.7–8 NÊlakaÖãha, 159n.49 Nimb§rka/Nimb§rkÊ(s), 29n.9, 32, 54– 55n.7, 229 NirañjanadevatÊrtha, 142 Nirmala(s), 43n.74, 53n.3, 55, 55–56n.9, 61, 65n.42, 227n.1, 228, 229n.8; functionaries in akh§Ü§, 74n.63 Nirmohi anÊ, 54, 55n.7, 65n.42, 229n.9 Nirukta (of Y§ska), 288n.5 Niácal§nandasarasvatÊ, 142n.148 Nity§nandatÊrtha, 145n.161 Nirv§ÖÊ anÊ, 54 Nií§m ud-DÊn Aulia, 234, 243n.51 Ny§ya-Vaiáeßika, 113, 162, 217
index ParamaáivendrasarasvatÊ, 149n.9 Par§áara, 4n.15 parivr§jaka/parivr§jya, 7 P§rvatÊ, 220n.141 P§rávan§tha, 200n.82, 215 P§áupata(s), 100n.60, 153, 162, 165n.65, 183, 184, 187n.40, 190n.47, 191, 198, 210n.118, 228, 245; in Cambodia, 184n.28; maãha-s, 140, 192n.55, n.57 P§áupatasåtra, 178 Paáupatin§th (temple), 29n.6, 176n.103 PataØgaáiv§c§rya, 186n.34 Patañjali (the grammarian), 6, 10, 12n.60, 178 Patañjali (the yogi), 152n.22, n.24, 178n.2 Patañjali-carita (of R§mabhadra-DÊkßita), 148n.3 penance(s): c§ndr§yaÖa/kÜcchra/pr§j§patya, 9n.38, 84n.16, 288n.5 Periya Pur§Öam (of C¿kkiϧr), 182, 183 phal§har, 25n.43 pilgrimage, 288n.5 PiÖ·arÊ(s), 252, 254, 255 pÊr, 241; initiation by, 233 pÊãha(s), 2, 41, 68, 72, 104, 108, 114– 15, 116; and gotra-s, 120; lists of, 128–29n.103 Pr§bh§kara, 168 Prabhu PremÊ SaØgh, 77n.73 Pr§cÊna-“aØkaravijaya (of $nandagiri?), 130 n.106, 149n.5 Pragv§l(s), 298–99 praißa mantra, 82n.6, 83, 85, 86n.23, 88, 89n.32, 92n.42, 93n.43, 95, 96 Praj§pati: sacrifice to, 88, 94n.47 Prak§á§nanda, Brahmac§rÊ, 60 Prak§á§tman, 106n.5, 113, 123n.84 Prakaã§rthak§ra, 123n.84 PraÖ§mÊ (sect)/PraÖn§th, 237 Praáastap§da, 184n.30 Pratapa SiÒha, 132 PratardaÖa, 127n.97 Pray§g(a). See Allahabad PÜthvÊ N§r§yaÖ “§h, 248, 258 PÜthvÊdhara, 117n.83, 119, 125n.91, 127n.97 påj§rÊ(s) (Daáan§mÊ), 74 PuÖyaálokamañjarÊ (of Sarvajñasad§áivabodha), 129, 206 PuraÖ Gir, 256n.96 Pur§Öa(s): renunciation procedures in, 82n.4; “aØkar§c§rya’s life in, 148n.3
347
PurÊ (maãha/pÊãha), See Govardhan Purußa-såkta, 85, 94–95nn.47–48 Purußottama (cult of), 141n.144 Purußottamabh§ratÊ, 217 Pußpagiri maãha, 129n.103, 133, 187n.39, 207n.107 Q§diri(s) (SåfÊs), 234, 239, 241n.46, 244 n.57 Qalandari(s) (SåfÊs), 240n.43, 244n.57 R§dh§vallabhÊ, 229 RafaÊ, Ahmad KabÊr, 240n.43 Ragun§th Rao, 250 r§ja-guru(s), 177, 185–90, 192, 197, 198n. 75, 201n.84, 210, 215, 217, 218, 269 R§jar§ja (king), 186n.34, 187n.37 R§jar§jeávara “aØkar§árama, Sv§mÊ, 126 r§jasåya, 157–59 Rajendra Giri, 60, 63, 249–50 R§jpåt(s), 18n.79, 20n.87, 38n.54, 237, 250, 251n.79, 252n.83 R§m D§s, Guru, 175 R§m Janm BhåmÊ (dispute), 264 R§makÜßÖa (ParamahaÒsa), 23n.28, 31 R§makÜßÖa Mission/R§makÜßÖa “§rad§ Mission, 33 R§m§nanda/R§m§nandÊ(s), 13, 19n.85, 32n.25, 35, 61, 247n.60, 254n.88, 259n.107, 294n.25; conflicts with other sects, 62–65, 230 functionaries among, 55n.8, 74n.63; in catuÈ samprad§ya, 54n.7; initiation into, 35n.38, 92n.42; militant organisation, 226n.1, 229nn.10–11, 247, 249n.74, 250n.76, numbers of, 21n.10, 256n. 97 R§m§nuja, 54n.7, 83–84n.12, 87, 92n. 42, 107, 113n.37, 160, 167–69, 180 n.8, 183n.22, 188, 191, 197n.71, 210 n.120, 211n.120, 222; disciples of, 246 R§mar§ya (king), 195, 199n.78, 201 R§masv§mÊ (temple), 201 R§mn§mÊ(s), 28n.61 R§m “§h (of Gorkha), 19n.84 R§msingh II, 230n.13 ramt§(s), 20, 21 R§n§(s): JaØg Bah§dur, 19n.84 RaÖabhadra maãha, 187n.39 Üßi(s), 6n.21, 116, 120, 121, 187n.39, 205; “aØkar§c§rya’s descent from, 151
348
index
RSS (R§ßãrÊya Svayamsevak SaØgh), 263 ŒßyaáÜØga, 150 rudr§kß(a), 19n.82, 35n.36, 51, 91, 131, 181n.16 Rudraáakti Deva, 186n.34 Rufayi(s) (SåfÊs), 240n.43 RåmÊ, J§l§l al-DÊn, 242 sabh§pati(s), 74, 75n.66 Saccid§nanda “ivabhinava NarasiÒhabh§ratÊ, 125 Saccid§nandabh§ratÊ II, 125, 172 Sad§nanda Giri, 89n.32 Sad§nanda YogendrasarasvatÊ, 226; identity of, 226n.152 Sad§áiva (king), 195, 199n.78 Sad§áivabrahmendra, 129n.106, 149n.5, n.9 Sad§áivasarasvatÊ, 130n.110, 219 Sadbh§va “ambhu, 186n.34 “a··aráanasamuccaya (of Haribhadra), 112, 184n.30 s§dhu(s), 13, 14, 15, 22, 23n.92, 28, 29, 30, 31, 35, 37, 40, 43, 45, 46, 48, 53n.2, 54n.7, 58n.21, 59n.25, 62n.34, 65, 69, 76, 86, 145n.161, 255, 256, 260n.107, 263, 267, 294n.25, 297n.40, 299; definition of, 1n.4; equipment of, 35–36; finances of, 13n.66; in maÜhÊ-s, 71; in Nepal, 18; numbers of, 29– 30nn.10–11; penances of, 36–37n.44; travels of, 29n.7 s§dhvÊ(s). See women renouncers Safdar Jang, 249 “§h $lam II, 249n.74, 250n.78 “§h Jah§n, 241n.46 “§h Sultan, PÊr, 253n.85 S§Ê B§b§ of “Êrdi, 33 “aiva-Siddh§nta, 183, 186, 187, 189, 202, 216, 221, 222, initiation into, 120; maãha-s, 133–34n.122, 176n.103, 188–89, 192–93; r§ja-guru-s, 186–87, 192, 215 á§kta-pÊtha(s)/áaktipÊtha(s), 18, 54n.7, 68 á§lagr§ma, 28n.3 Salim Chishti, Shaikh, 239 S§Ïuva NarasiÒha, 195, 201n. 84; conversion to “rÊ-VaißÖavism, 199n.78 “ambhu Pañc, 73, 76 S§Òkhya, 112, 162, 177, 218 S§Òkhya maãha, 225n.151 S§Òkhya YoginÊ, 33n.30
saÒny§sa, 3; definition of, 4n.16; meaning of, 1, 4; rite of, 81–88, 93–98 SaÒny§sa Upanißad(s), 4, 23, 83n.8, 89 n.26; final sacrifice in, 88n.27; renunciation procedures in, 58n.8; rules for renunciates in, 101–3 saÒny§sÊ(s), 14, 240, 243; divorce by, 17–18n.78; first use of term, 7; funeral rites of, 19n.83, 37; in Nepal, 19–21; initiation of householder saÒny§sÊ-s, 19n.82; lifestyle of, 3–4; rules for, 99n.57; militant organisation, 228– 31; numbers of, 30n.11, 256n.97; significance of, 3–13, temporary, 16 SaÒny§sÊ SaÒskÜta Mah§vidy§laya, 43 n.74 saÒny§sinÊ(s). See women renouncers “amáer Bah§dur, 251 Sanandana (the ascetic), 127n.97, 150n. 13 SaØgama II, 210, 222 SaØgama dynasty, 194–97; patronage of religions by, 199–201 “aØkarabh§ratÊ, 35 “aØkar§bhyudaya (of R§jacå·§maÖi-DÊkßita), 149 “aØkar§bhyudaya (of Tirumala-DÊkßita), 149 “aØkar§c§rya ($di), 2n.8, 24, 26, 29, 61n.31, 67n.48, 68, 72, 78, 85n.21, 103, 141 208, 210n.120, 220, 222, 224, 226, 268–69; as avat§ra of “iva, 152–54, 163–64, 223, 224; as paramahaÒsa, 102; ascent of Throne of Omniscience, 155–58; date of, 108–14, 122–26; digvijaya of, 2, 138, 154–57, 159; final sam§dhi of, 123, 155n.32; founding of maãha-s by, 122–47; in Nepalese history, 155–56, 175–76n.103; opinion on renunciation, 38, 86 “aØkar§c§rya(s), 13, 48, 78n.74,103, 108 n.12, 264, 288, 294n.25; initiation by, 90n.36; of Banaras, 145–46; of Dv§rak§, 139–40; of Jyoáimaãh, 143–44; of K§ñcÊpuram, 5, 34, 130–32, 156n.36; of PurÊ, 140–42; of “aØkeávara, 79, 138; of “ÜØgerÊ, 79n.77, 134–37, 139 “aØkar§c§ryacarita (of Govindan§tha), 123 n.84, 149
index “aØkara-dig-vijaya (of M§dhava), 24, 123 n.84, 127, 149, 150; authorship of, 209 “aØkara-digvijaya-s§ra (of Sad§nanda), 148 n.4, 155n.32 “aØkarajayantÊ, 13n.64, 136 “aØkara-mand§ra-saurabha (of NÊlakaÖãha), 108n.13, 148n.4, 155n.32 “aØkar§nanda (14th cent.), 206, 214 “aØkar§nanda (20th cent.), 145n.161 “aØkarapåjyap§dayati, 105 “aØkaravijaya (of Anant§nandagiri), 123 n.84, 129n.105, 149, 171, 225 “aØkaravijaya (of Vy§s§cala), 149, 206 “aØkaravijaya-vil§sa (of Cidvil§sa), 24, 123 n.84, 149, 171, 172, 174, 224, 268 “aØkeávara maãha/pÊtha, 79, 138 “§nt§nandasarasvatÊ, 143 “§ntarakßita, 109n.14, 111n.27, n.29, 112, n.33 Saptam§tÜ(s), 165, 220n.141 “§rad§ devÊ, 150, 223–24 “§rad§ Mandir, 33n.28 “§rad§ (maãha/pÊãha at Dv§rak§). See Dv§rak§ “§rad§ matha-s, 138n.136 “§rad§mb§ Mah§rathotsava, 13n.64 “§raØgap§Öi (temple), 132n.117, 201 SarasvatÊ (devÊ), 87n.25, 156, 197, 224, 238n.38; in hagiographies of “aØkar§c§rya, 170n.78, 171 SarasvatÊ (river), 289n.7, 291n.17 SarasvatÊ (wife of MaÖ·anamiára), 153n. 26, 155n.33, 166 Sarkar, Jadunath, 60–61 “arma, J§yapur Viávan§th R§jgop§l, 129, 131 Sarmast, Shaikh SåfÊ, 232–33, 233n. 20 Sarva-daráana-saÒgraha (of M§dhava), 110 n.24, 178n.5; authorship of, 198n. 76, 209–10n.114 Sarvajñasad§bodha, 130 Sarvajñ§tman, 219, 220 Sarvajñaviáeáa, 226n.154 Sarveávaraáakti Deva, 185n.34 Sastry, T. S. Narayana, 108, 129 Savarkar, V. D., 256n.95 S§yaÖa, 202, 208, 209n.114, 210, 214, 291n.17 shamanism, 6, 6n.20
349
Shatt§ri(s) SåfÊs), 234, 239, 244n.57 Shuja-ud-Daulah, 64n.40, 249n.74, 250, 253n.86 Siddha(s) (See also N§th), 56n.11, 66n.44, 67, 70n.57, 181n.16, 187, 228, 228n. 4, 243n.53, 248 Sikh(s), 19n.85, 25, 35, 43n.74, 55, 55– 56n.9, 63, 175, 227n.1, 228, 228–29n. 7, 229, n.8, 231n.14, 245n.62, 249 SiÒha Deva, 185n.34 SiÒh§ßãa Mel§, 64, 293, 297 Siraj-ud-Daulah, 251 SirhindÊ, Shaikh Ahmad Faruki, 165 “iva. See “aØkar§c§rya “ivendra, ParamahaÒsa, 129n.106 “ivagaØg§ maãha, 128n.103, 135–36, 137n.136 “ivag§yatrÊ mantra, 19n.82 “iv§jÊ, 134, 236 “iv§nanda, Sv§mÊ, 263n.116 “ivar§tri, 16, 29n.6, 287n.3, 292, 297n. 40 Sleeman, William, 255, 262, sm§rta(s), 90n.36, 158n.47, 162, 169, 170, 177, 188n.40, n.43, 199n.80, 201n.85, 215, 221; divisions of, 223n.148, worship, 222–23 “obh§ M§, 32 Somadeva, 112n.36 Somaáambhupaddhati (of Somaáambhu), 221 Someávara Deva Bhålokamalla, 185n.34 ár§ddha, 84, 94n.48, 95 áramaÖa(s), 6n.25, 7, 7n.26, 9, 9n.43, 10nn.44–45, 10n.47, 11 áramaÖÊ(s), 11n.52 “rÊ Cand, 55–56n.9, 67n.48, 229n.8, 245 “rÊ Pañc, 50–53 “rÊ “§rad§ Maãha, 33 “rÊharßa, 217 “rÊkaÖãha (the P§áupata), 178 “rÊkaÖãha(n§tha), 107, 210, 215, 217, 222 “rÊ-purußottama-bh§ratÊ-carita (of VißÖu), 125, 217 “rÊraØgam, 194n.64 “rÊ-VaißÖava(s), 10n.51, 40n.61, 54n.7, 160, 167, 168–69, 199n.78, 201, 221, 222n.144, 223n.148; initiation into, 92n.42, 167n.71; kinds of renunciate, 169n.76; maãha-s, 183n.22; staff (daÖ·a) carried by, 87n.26; temples, 200
350
index
“ÜØgerÊ (maãha/pÊãha), 2, 25, 41nn.65–66, 79n.77, 80, 90n.36, 115, 115n.44, 123, 124, 127n.97, n.99, 128, 128n.103, 129, 131, 132, 140, 141, 142n.148, 144, 146n.163, 170n.80, 172, 193, 196, 221, 225, 230, 234, 268, 269; devÊ worship at, 223–24; history of, 202–4, 214–17; in hagiographies, 150, 155n.51, 157, 170–73; Ku·alÊ“ÜØgerÊ, 133–36, 147, 206, 207n.107, 227, 156; landholdings of, 79n.78, 216n.131; maãh§mn§ya of, 117nn.52– 53; 119, pontiffs of, 125–126, 139; TuØga-“ÜØgerÊ, 133–36, 147, 206, 227 Strabo, 10, 11 Sudaráan§c§rya, 185n.34 Sudhanv§, King, 126–28 áådra(s), 96n.51; and renunciation, 10–11, 11n.58, 18n.78, 38–39, 40n.61; in “aiva-Siddh§nta, 188n.43, 189; in “rÊVaiánavism, 40n.61, 168, 222n.144 SåfÊ(s), 25, 62, 237, 239; divisions of, 243–44; influence of, 239–43; militant, 230 Suhrawardi(s) (SåfÊs), 241n.46, 244n.57 Sumeru maãha, 129n.103, 144–46, 173n. 89 Sundard§s, 229n.9 Sureávara, 38, 85n.21, 106, 110, 110n. 26, 111n.28, n.31, 119, 127n.97, 128n.102, 219, 219n.140, 269; describes “aØkara, 151; identity of, 123–24n.84, 158n.46; in guruparampar§-s, 124, 125–26nn.91–92, 129–30; in hagiographies, 150n.13, 171n.82, 172, 173n.90; religious orientation of, 218, 220; works of 106n.5, 107n.8, 163n.60 Sußam§ (of $tmabodha), 130n.106, 149n.5, 155n.32 Sv§mÊ N§r§yaÖ, 33 Svaråp§nandasarasvatÊ, 140 “y§m§nandÊ, 54n.7 Tagore, Rabindranath, 255 Tanjore: maãha at, 132 Tantra/Tantric, 43n.73, 45, 67, 68–69, 70n.57, 105, 107n.8, 108n.12, 114, 145n.161, 160, 165n.65, 170, 179, 181n.16, 182n.19, 187–88nn.39– 40, 221n.143, 222, 228n.4, 246; in
Nepal, 176n.103; in “aØkara-dig-vijaya, 159n.49; “aØkar§c§rya’s attitude to, 161, 162n.58, 165; Vidy§raÖya’s links with, 214n.127 tapas/tapasy§ (See also asceticism), 36–37, 150n.14, 152, 231, 231n.16 tapasvinÊ(s) (See also women ascetics), 11n. 52 Tarakeávar (temple), 13n.65 T§r§n§tha, 110n.21 Tashu L§m§ (of Bhutan), 254 tax/tax collection, 62, 63, 65, 78n.75, 133n.120, 193, 228, 237, 257–58n. 101, 258n.103, 259n.106, 260, 261n. 111, 262, 298–99 T¿v§ram, 180n.9, 181 ãhakaá§stra, 254n.90 th§n§pati(s), 50, 51, 74, 75, 75n.64, n.66; rules for, 99n.57 Th§nesar mel§, 62 (The) Theosophist: date of “aØkar§c§rya in, 124–25 Thug(s), 254–55 Tiele, C. P., 108 Timma, 195 Timur, 230 Tirukkekkat maãha, 138 Tirumantiram (of Tirumålar), 180n.9, 181n.16 Tirumula (king), 196 TirumuÜai, 180n.9 Tirupati (temple), 40n.61, 169n.76, 194n. 64, 199, 199n.78, 201n.85 Tiruvanaikoil (temple): maãha at, 133n. 121 Toãa PurÊ, 45 Toãaka, 119, 120, 127n.97, 269; in hagiographies, 150n.13, 153n.26, 172, 173n.90; religious orientation of, 218; works of, 106n.5, 218n.132 Tripathi, B. D., 29n.9, 30n.11, 89n.32 tripuÖ·(ra), 35 223n.148 tulsÊ beads, 35n.36, 62, 92n.42, TulsÊd§s, 231n.16, 297 ty§ga, 7 ty§gÊ(s), 54, 54n.7, 55n.8 Ud§sin(s), 19n.85, 35, 43n.74, 53n.3, 55, 61, 62n.34, 65n.42, 67n.48, 228, 229n.8, 245, 262n.112; akh§Ü§-s, 53n. 3, 55–56n.9, 227n.1; four dhånÊ-s of, 56n.9, 168
index Uddyotakara, 184n.30 Ujjain, 18, 29n.9, 64, 71n.58, 116nn.47– 48, 159n.49; gosain-s at, 16, 257; initiation of R§m§nandÊs at, 55n.8; mel§ at (see also SiÒh§ßãa Mel§), 23n. 92, 30n.11, 53n.2, 55n.26, 65n.42, 287n.3, 289, 291, 293, 294, 297 Ukhimaãha, 129n.103 Um§ Bh§ratÊ, 264 Umbeka, 111n.29 Umrao Giri, 249–51 Upadeáas§hasri (of “aØkar§c§rya), 106, 107, 108n.9, 110 upanayana, 9, 19n.82, 83n.9, 96, 97nn. 51–53, 267; of “aØkar§c§rya, 152n. 23 Upanißad(s): “aØkar§c§rya’s commentary on, 102, 106, 107, 108, 110n.26, 151n.19, 161, 164 årdhvamanthin, 7 Uwaysi(s) (SåfÊs), 244n.57 V§caspatimiára, 85n.21, 111–12n.31, 113, 123n.84, 166, 297 Vaikh§nasa(s), 83n.8, 97n.53, 102n.66, 164, 245 VaikuÖãha PurÊ, 72 vaiáya(s): renunciation by, 11n.58, 38 Vallabh§c§rya/Vallabhac§rÊ, 13, 14n. 67, 32n.25, 54n.7, 157n.40, 236, 259n.107 Vamaáakti PaÖ·ita, 185n.34 vanaprastha, 5, 5n.17 V§ÖÊvil§sa (Kriy§áakti), 198 V§r§Ö (of Bh§Ê Gurd§s), 175 Vasubandhu, 110n.18, 113n.41 V§sudev§nanda, Sv§mÊ, 180 v§taraáana, 6n.19, 7 varÖa, 3, 27n.52, 38n.7 Veda(s), 4n.16, 10n.51, 36, 88n.28, 94n.47, 102n.68, 114, 185n.32, 197, 202, 207, 208, 211, 212n.124, 222, 288n.5, 291n.17; ascetics in, 5–6, 5– 6nn.19– 21; in K§l§mukha tradition, 191, 221; in P§ñcar§tra tradition, 160, 161, 162, 168; in “aiva-Siddh§nta tradition, 189, 202, 221; referred to in Maãh§mn§ya-s, 118–22, 131n.114; tapas in, 36, 36n.41 Ved§nta/Ved§ntin(s), 4, 67n.48, 68, 77, 83n.12, 101n.62, 112, 123n.84, 144n.157, 152, 149, 160, 161, 162,
351
167, 169, 177, 181n.16, 202, 203, 208, 217, 219n.138, 225–26, 230, 246; early history of, 112–13; schools of, 106n.5, 166; Ved§nta convent, 33n.28 Ven§b§Ê, 31n.15 VeØkaãa II, 199 VeØkaãa V, 133 VeØkaãa T§t§c§rya, 199n.78 Venkataraman, R. (President), 264 VeØkaãeávara (temple), 199n.78 VHP (Viáva Hindu Parißad), 263 VHS (Viá§l Hindu Sammelan), 263 vibhåti, 34, 121n.102, 153n.148 vidy§-saÒsk§r. See viraj§-homa vidy§pÊãha(s), 2, 171 Vidy§nanda (saÒny§sÊ), 47 Vidy§nanda (Jaina), 111n.31 Vidy§raÖya, 10n.51, 85n.21, 124n.84, 131, 137, 196, 197, 202, 203, 203n. 94, 205–9, 211n.121, 212–14, 216, 216n.128, n.130, 217, 224n.150, 225; works of, 150n.11, 204n.95, 214n. 126 Vidy§raÖya-sv§mÊ maãha, 216n.128 Vidy§áaØkara. See Vidy§tÊrtha Vidy§áaØkara (temple), 204 Vidy§áaØkaratÊrtha, 126n.92 Vidy§tÊrtha (14th cent.), 125, 202–18; as a Maheávara, 216n.130 Vidy§tÊrtha (20th cent.), 79n.77 Vidyeávara, 186n.34 VijayagaÖ·agop§la: grants by, 130, 132 n.119 Vijayanagara, 25, 27, 78, 78n.75, 169, 177, 185, 232, 235, 269; founding of, 193–97, 208; religious culture of, 197–201 VijayendrasarasvatÊ, 265, 266 Vikrama CÙÏa, 182n.18, 210 Vikram§ditya I, 185n.34 Vimalaáiva, 193 Vimukt§tman, 123n.84, 219n.138 VÊra NarasiÒha, 195, 201n.84 viraj§-homa/-havan, 15, 33, 46, 68, 88, 89, 89n.33, 90, 122, 267; legal status of, 90n.38 VÊraáaiva(s), 13n.62, 19n.85, 33, 152n.20, 182n.20, 190, 199 Viråp§kßa (deity), 197, 198, 199, 199n.77, 205n.98, 217, 224 Viråp§kßa maãha, 128n.103, 133, 137, 207n.107
352
index
Viråp§kßa (temple), 201n.85, 216n.128 Viråp§kßa I, 195 Viråp§kßa II, 195, 199n.78, 201n.84 Viáeßvar§nandatÊrtha, 145n.161 Vishva Kalyan Mission, 34n.30 VißÖu Pur§Öa, 166 VißÖudev§nandasarasvatÊ, 143 VißÖusv§mÊ(s), 54n.7, 229n.11 Viáv§nandasarasvatÊ, 263n.116 Viávaråpa, 82, 86n.84, 88n.91, 88n.97, 110n.46 Viáveávar§nandasarasvatÊ, 263n.116 Viáveávara “ambhu, 186n.34 Viáveávara “iva, 188n.40 Vivekacå·§maÖi (of “aØkar§c§rya), 107 Vivek§nanda, 8n.36, 33n.28, 45 vrata, 16, 36, 101, vr§tya(s), 6n.23 Vrij§nand, 247 Vy§sa: disciples of, 245 Vy§sar§ya, 199n.78, 201n.84 (Vy§s§cala) Mah§devendrasarasvatÊ, 149 n.8, 206 Vy§satÊrtha, 226 wil§yat, 234 women ascetics/renouncers, 10–11, 15, 30–35, 43; $jÊvika and Buddhist; 11 n.57; in Banaras, 32; Jaina, 31n.17; numbers of, 31n.14; terms for, 30nn. 12–13, 31
Y§dava Prak§áa, 83n.12 Yadugiri Yatir§ja Maãha, 168n.74 yajam§na, 5n.19, 156n.36, 187n.38 Y§munamuni/Y§mun§c§rya, 167, 191 yati, 6, 7 Yatidharmaprak§áa (of V§sudev§árama), 10n.51, 38n.50, 82n.5, 101n.66, 174; renunciation procedures in, 85–86, 91n.40 YatidharmasaÒgraha (of ViáveávarasarasvatÊ), 82n.5, 85n.21, 89n.31, 174 Yatidharmasamuccaya (of Y§dava Prak§áa), 83, 84–85, 101n.66; final sacrifice in, 88n.27 Yoga (doctrine), 100n.58, 162, 176n.103, 177, 178, 178n.2, 185n.32 Yogasåtra-bh§ßya-vivaraÖa (of “aØkar§c§rya), 108 yogi(s)/yogin(s)/Jogi(s), 6n.21, n.23, 14 n.67, 15n.70, 18, 30n.11, 45n.81, 56n. 11, 62, 62n.34, 66n.44, 70n.57, 91, 102n.68, 175, 189, 228, 228n.4, 230, 239, 243, 246; in Tirumantiram, 181n.16 yoginÊ(s), 165, 165n.65, 188n.40 Yuddhamalla II, 186n.34 yuga(s), 116, 128n.101 Yuvar§jadeva, 186n.34, 187n.40
BRILL’S INDOLOGICAL LIBRARY ISSN 0925-2916
1. Sharma, A. (ed.). Essays on the Mah§bh§rata. 1991. ISBN 90 04 09211 0 2. Aguilar i Matas, E. R.gvedic Society. 1991. ISBN 90 04 09352 4 3. Fuss, M. Buddhavacana and Dei Verbum. A Phenomenological and Theological Comparison of Scriptural Inspiration in the SaddharmapuÖ·arÊka Såtra and in the Christian Tradition. 1991. ISBN 90 04 08991 8 4. Sil, N.P. R§makr.ßÖa Paramaham.sa. A Psychological Profile. 1991. ISBN 90 04 09478 4 5. Nijenhuis, E. te (ed. & tr.). SaØgÊtaáiromaÖi. A Medieval Handbook of Indian Music. 1992. ISBN 90 04 09498 9 6. Harris, I.C. The Continuity of Madhyamaka and Yog§c§ra in Indian Mah§y§na Buddhism. 1991. ISBN 90 04 09448 2 7. Gethin, R.M.L. The Buddhist Path to Awakening. A Study of the Bodhi-Pakkhiy§ Dhamm§. 1992. ISBN 90 04 09442 3 8. Gommans, J.J.L. The Rise of the Indo-Afghan Empire, c. 1710-1780. 1995. ISBN 90 04 10109 8 9. Takahashi, T. Tamil Love Poetry and Poetics. 1996. ISBN 90 04 10042 3 10. Chatterjee, K. Merchants, Politics and Society in Early Modern India. Bihar: 1733-1820. 1996. ISBN 90 04 10303 1 11. Bentor, Y. Consecration of Images and Stûpas in Indo-Tibetan Tantric Buddhism. 1996. ISBN 90 04 10541 7 12. Guenther, H. The Teachings of Padmasambhava. 1996. ISBN 90 04 10542 5 13. Houben, J.E.M. (ed.). Ideology and Status of Sanskrit. Contributions to the History of the Sanskrit Language. 1996. ISBN 90 04 10613 8 14. Donkin, R.A. Dragon’s Brain Perfume. An Historical Geography of Camphor. 1999. ISBN 90 04 10983 8 15. McLeod, J. Sovereignty, Power, Control. Politics in the States of Western India, 1916-1947. 1999. ISBN 90 04 11343 6 16. Houben, J.E.M. & Van Kooij, K.R. (eds.). Violence Denied. 1999. ISBN 90 04 11344 4 17. Palsetia, J.S. The Parsis of India. Preservation of Identity in Bombay City. 2001. ISBN 90 04 121145 18. Bühnemann, G. et al. MaÖ·alas and Yantras in the Hindu Traditions. 2003. ISBN 90 04 12902 2 19. Gommans, J. & Prakash, O. (eds.). Circumambulations in South Asian History. Essays in Honour of Dirk H.A. Kolff. 2003. ISBN 90 04 13155 8
20. McGrath, K. The Sanskrit Hero. KarÖa in Epic Mah§bh§rata. 2004. ISBN 90 04 13729 7 21. Nayar, K.E. HayagrÊva in South India. Complexity and Selectivity of a Pan-Indian Hindu Deity. 2004. ISBN 90 04 13730 0 22. Patel, A. Building Communities in Gujar§t. Architecture and Society during the Twelfth through Fourteenth Centuries. 2004. ISBN 90 04 13890 0 23. Berkwitz, S.C. Buddhist History in the Vernacular. The Power of the Past in Late Medieval Sri Lanka. 2004. ISBN 90 04 13910 9 24. Sharma, A. (ed.) Goddesses and Women in the Indic Religious Tradition. 2005. ISBN 90 04 12466 7 25. Clark, M.J. The Daáan§mÊ-SaÒny§sÊs. The Integration of Ascetic Lineages into an Order. 2006. ISBN-13 978 90 04 15211 3, ISBN-10 90 04 15211 3